Transcripción de documentos
Owner’s Manual
Keep This Manual For Future Reference.
EN
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.)
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT! This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC
requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product.
2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to accessories and/or another product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST
be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to use this product in the USA.
3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with
these requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential environment will not result in harmful interference with
other electronic devices. This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used according to the instructions found in the users manual, may
cause interference harmful to the operation of other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference will not occur in all
installations. If this product is found to be the source of interference, which can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate the
problem by using one of the following measures: Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the interference. Utilize power outlets that are on
different branch (circuit breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s. In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the antenna. If the antenna lead-in
is 300 ohm ribbon lead, change the lead-in to coaxial type cable. If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results, please contact the local retailer
authorized to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corporation of America, Electronic Service
Division, 6600 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA 90620
The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its subsidiaries.
WARNING: THIS APPARATUS MUST BE EARTHED
IMPORTANT
THE WIRES IN THIS MAINS LEAD ARE COLOURED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE FOLLOWING CODE:
GREEN-AND-YELLOW :
EARTH
BLUE :
NEUTRAL
BROWN :
LIVE
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this apparatus may
not correspond with the coloured markings identifying the terminals in
your plug, proceed as follows:
The wire which is coloured GREEN and YELLOW must be
connected to the terminal in the plug which is marked by the letter E
or by the safety earth symbol
or coloured GREEN and YELLOW.
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal
which is marked with the letter N or coloured BLACK.
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the
terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured RED.
ADVARSEL!
Lithiumbatteri—Eksplosionsfare ved fejlagtig
håndtering. Udskiftning må kun ske med batteri
af samme fabrikat og type. Levér det brugte
batteri tilbage til leverandoren.
VARNING
Explosionsfara vid felaktigt batteribyte. Använd
samma batterityp eller en ekvivalent typ som
rekommenderas av apparattillverkaren.
Kassera använt batteri enligt fabrikantens
instruktion.
VAROITUS
Paristo voi räjähtää, jos se on virheellisesti
asennettu. Vaihda paristo ainoastaan
laitevalmistajan suosittelemaan tyyppiin. Hävitä
käytetty paristo valmistajan ohjeiden
mukaisesti.
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA KEMBLE
MUSIC (U.K.) LTD.
NEDERLAND / THE NETHERLANDS
• Dit apparaat bevat een lithium batterij voor geheugen back-up.
• This apparatus contains a lithium battery for memory back-up.
• Raadpleeg uw leverancier over de verwijdering van de batterij op het
moment dat u het apparaat ann het einde van de levensduur of gelieve
dan contact op te nemen met de vertegenwoordiging van Yamaha in
uw land.
• For the removal of the battery at the moment of the disposal at the end
of life please consult your retailer or Yamaha representative office in
your country.
• Gooi de batterij niet weg, maar lever hem in als KCA.
• Do not throw away the battery. Instead, hand it in as small chemical
waste.
(lithium disposal)
This product contains a high intensity lamp that contains a small amount of mercury. Disposal of this material may be regulated
due to environmental considerations. For disposal information in the United States, refer to the Electronic Industries Alliance web
site: www.eiae.org
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.
(mercury)
Important Information
3
Important Information
Warnings
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Connect this unit’s power cord only to an AC outlet of the type stated in this Owner’s Manual or as marked on the unit. Failure to do so is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
Be sure to connect to an appropriate outlet with a protective grounding connection.
Improper grounding can result in electrical shock.
Do not allow water to enter this unit or allow the unit to become wet. Fire or electrical shock
may result.
Do not place heavy objects, including this unit, on top of the power cord. A damaged power
cord is a fire and electrical shock hazard. In particular, be careful not to place heavy objects
on a power cord covered by a carpet.
Do not place a container with liquid or small metal objects on top of this unit. Liquid or
metal objects inside this unit are a fire and electrical shock hazard.
This unit is equipped with a dedicated ground connection to prevent electrical shock.
Before connecting the power plug to an AC outlet, be sure to ground the unit. If the power
cord has a three-pin plug, it will provide sufficient grounding so long as the AC outlet is
grounded correctly.
Do not scratch, bend, twist, pull, or heat the power cord. A damaged power cord is a fire
and electrical shock hazard.
Do not remove the unit’s cover. You could receive an electrical shock. If you think internal
inspection, maintenance, or repair is necessary, contact your dealer.
Do not modify the unit. Doing so is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
If lightning begins to occur, turn off the power switch of the unit as soon as possible, and
unplug the power cable plug from the electrical outlet.
If there is a possibility of lightning, do not touch the power cable plug if it is still connected.
Doing so may be an electrical shock hazard.
Use only the included power cord for this unit. Using other types may be a fire and electrical
shock hazard.
The DM2000 has six rear-panel slots for installing mini-YGDAI cards. For technical reasons, certain card combinations are not supported. Before installing any cards, check the
Yamaha web site to if your card is compatible. Installing cards that are not endorsed by
Yamaha may cause electrical shock, fire, or damage to the unit.
If the power cord is damaged (i.e., cut or a bare wire is exposed), ask your dealer for a
replacement. Using the unit with a damaged power cord is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
If you notice any abnormality, such as smoke, odor, or noise, or if a foreign object or liquid
gets inside the unit, turn it off immediately. Remove the power cord from the AC outlet. Consult your dealer for repair. Using the unit in this condition is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
Should this unit be dropped or the cabinet be damaged, turn the power switch off, remove
the power plug from the AC outlet, and contact your dealer. If you continue using the unit
without heeding this instruction, fire or electrical shock may result.
Cautions
•
Keep this unit away from the following locations:
— Locations exposed to oil splashes or steam, such as near cooking stoves, humidifiers, etc.
— Unstable surfaces, such as a wobbly table or slope.
— Locations exposed to excessive heat, such as inside a car with all the windows closed, or
places that receive direct sunlight.
— Locations subject to excessive humidity or dust accumulation.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
4
Important Information
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Hold the power cord plug when disconnecting it from an AC outlet. Never pull the cord. A
damaged power cord is a potential fire and electrical shock hazard.
Do not touch the power plug with wet hands. Doing so is a potential electrical shock hazard.
This unit has ventilation holes along the front underside and at the rear to prevent the internal temperature from rising too high. Do not block them. Blocked ventilation holes are a
fire hazard. In particular, do not operate the unit while it’s on its side, is upside down, or
while it’s covered with a cloth or dust sheet.
If you are using the optional MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge, do not hold only the MB2000
when you move the entire unit. Otherwise, the meter angle may be deformed or damaged,
the main unit may malfunction, or you may be injured if the unit falls.
This unit is heavy. Use two or more people to carry it.
When you transport or move the DM2000 with the MB2000 attached, do not permit
impact or stress on the cable connector that connects the MB2000 to the DM2000. Otherwise, malfunction may occur.
To relocate the unit, turn the power switch off, remove the power plug from the AC outlet,
and remove all connecting cables. Damaged cables may cause fire or electrical shock.
When setting up the product, make sure that the AC outlet you are using is easily accessible.
If some trouble or malfunction occurs, immediately turn off the power switch and disconnect the plug from the outlet. Even when the power switch is turned off, electricity is still
flowing to the product at the minimum level. When you are not using the product for a long
time, make sure to unplug the power cord from the wall AC outlet.
If you know you will not use this unit for a long period of time, such as when going on vacation, remove the power plug from the AC outlet. Leaving it connected is a potential fire hazard.
The inside of the unit should be cleaned periodically. Dust accumulation inside the unit may cause
malfunction and is a potential fire hazard. Consult your dealer for information about cleaning.
To prevent electrical shock when cleaning the unit, remove the power plug from the AC outlet.
Do not apply oil, grease, or contact cleaner to the faders. Doing so may cause problems with
electrical contact or fader motion.
Do not use the headphones for a long period of time at a high or uncomfortable volume
level, since this can cause permanent hearing loss. If you experience any hearing loss or ringing in the ears, consult a physician.
Operating Notes
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
XLR-type connectors are wired as follows: pin 1–ground, pin 2–hot (+), and pin 3–cold (–).
Insert TRS phone jacks are wired as follows: sleeve–ground, tip–send, and ring–return.
The performance of components with moving contacts, such switches, rotary controls, faders,
and connectors, deteriorates over time. The rate of deterioration depends on the operating
environment and is unavoidable. Consult your dealer about replacing defective components.
Using a mobile telephone near this unit may induce noise. If noise occurs, use the telephone
away from the unit.
If the message “WARNING Low Battery!” appears when you turn on this unit, contact your
dealer as soon as possible about replacing the internal data backup battery. The unit will still
operate correctly, but data other than the presets will be lost.
Before replacing the batteries, back up your data to a memory card, or another unit by using
MIDI Bulk Dump.
The digital circuits of this unit may induce a slight noise into nearby radios and TVs. If noise
occurs, relocate the affected equipment.
When connecting D-sub cables, be sure to tighten the screws on both sides of the connector
securely. To disconnect the cable, loosen the screws completely, then remove the cable by
holding the connector part. Do not remove the plug by pulling the cable while the screws
are still attached. Otherwise, the connector may be damaged, leading to malfunction.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
SmartMedia Handling Precautions
•
5
When you change the wordclock settings on any device in your digital audio system, some
devices may output noise, so turn down your power amps beforehand, otherwise your
speakers may be damaged.
SmartMedia Handling Precautions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
The CARD slot is for use with SmartMedia only. Never attempt to insert any other type of
storage media.
Use only SmartMedia of the type specified in this Owner’s Manual.
Store SmartMedia in a place free from extreme temperatures, humidity, dust, and dirt.
Always store SmartMedia in its original case.
Write only on the designated area.
When handling SmartMedia, be careful not to touch the gold contacts. Fingerprints,
smudges, scratches, or dirt can affect performance.
Fingerprints and dust should be removed by wiping gently using a soft, dry cloth. Do not
use benzene, thinner, cleaning detergent, or a chemical cloth.
If SmartMedia is stored in a cold place (e.g., overnight in a car), and then moved to a
warmer environment, or if the temperature rises sharply, condensation may form on the
surface, which may affect performance. In this case, the SmartMedia should be allowed to
acclimatize for about one hour before use.
Insert SmartMedia carefully into the CARD slot, with the gold contacts facing upward.
Do not bend or twist SmartMedia.
Do not under any circumstances attempt to use SmartMedia that is cracked or warped.
Doing so may seriously damage the CARD slot.
Do not remove SmartMedia while saving or loading data. Doing so may cause data lose.
Data stored on SmartMedia can be protected against inadvertent overwriting by attaching
a write-protect sticker (supplied with SmartMedia).
Interference
The DM2000 uses high-frequency digital circuits that may cause interference on radio and
television equipment located nearby. If interference is a problem, relocate the affected
equipment. Using a mobile telephone near the unit may induce noise. In this case use the
telephone away from the unit.
DM2000 Exclusion of Certain Responsibility
Manufacturer, importer, or dealer shall not be liable for any incidental damages including
personal injury or any other damages caused by improper use or operation of the DM2000.
Trademarks
ADAT MultiChannel Optical Digital Interface is a trademark and ADAT and Alesis are registered trademarks of Alesis Corporation. Apogee is a trademark of Apogee Electronics, Inc.
Apple, Mac, and Power Macintosh are registered trademarks and Mac OS is a trademark of
Apple Corporation, Inc. HUI is a trademark of Mackie Designs, Inc. Intel and Pentium are
registered trademarks of Intel Corporation. Nuendo is a registered trademark of Steinberg
Media Technologies AG. Pro Tools is a trademark or registered trademark of Digidesign
and/or Avid Technology, Inc. SmartMedia is a trademark of Toshiba, Corp. Sony is a registered trademark of Sony Corporation, Inc. Tascam Digital Interface is a trademark and Tascam and Teac are registered trademarks of Teac Corporation. Microsoft and Windows are
registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation, Inc. Waves is a trademark of Waves, Inc.
Yamaha is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation. Nuendo and Cubse SX are trademarks of
Steinberg Media Technologies GmbH. All other trademarks are the property of their
respective holders and are hereby acknowledged.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
6
Important Information
Copyright
No part of the DM2000, its software, or this Owner’s Manual may be reproduced or distributed in any form or by any means without the prior written authorization of Yamaha Corporation.
© 2003 Yamaha Corporation. All rights reserved.
Yamaha Web Site
Further information about the DM2000, related products, and other Yamaha professional
audio equipment is available on the Yamaha Professional Audio Web site at:
<http://www.yamahaproaudio.com/>.
Package Contents
•
•
•
•
•
DM2000 Digital Production Console
CD-ROM
Power cord
This manual
Studio Manager Installation Guide
Optional Extras
•
•
•
•
MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge
SP2000 Wooden Side Panels
LA1800 Light Gooseneck
mini YGDAI I/O cards
About this Owner’s Manual
This Owner’s Manual covers the DM2000 Digital Production Console.
All the information you need in order to operate the DM2000 Digital Production Console
is contained in this manual. Use the table of contents to familiarize yourself with the manual’s organization and to locate tasks and topics, and use the index to locate specific information. Before diving in, it’s recommend that you read the “Operating Basics” chapter,
starting on page 51.
Each chapter of this manual discusses a specific section or function of the DM2000. The
Input and Output Channels are explained in the following chapters: “Input Channels,” “Bus
Outs,” “Aux Sends,” “Matrix Sends,” and “Stereo Out.” Where possible, these chapters have
been organized in order of signal flow, from input through to output.
Functions such as EQ and Delay are common to all channels. Rather than repeat the same
information over and over, these functions are explained once in the “Common Channel
Functions” chapter, which starts on page 127. The “Input Channels,” “Bus Outs,” “Aux
Sends,” “Matrix Sends,” and “Stereo Out” chapters contain cross-references to the relevant
sections of the “Common Channel Functions” chapter.
Conventions Used in this Manual
The DM2000 features two types of button: physical buttons that you can press (e.g., ENTER
and DISPLAY) and buttons that appear on the display pages. References to physical buttons
are enclosed in square brackets, for example, “press the [ENTER] button.” References to display page buttons are not emphasized, for example, “press the ENTER button.”
Display pages can be selected by using the [DISPLAY] buttons or the Left Tab Scroll, Right
Tab Scroll, and F1–4 buttons below the display. In order to simplify explanations, only the
[DISPLAY] button method is mentioned in the procedures. See “Selecting Display Pages”
on page 53 for details on all the ways in which pages can be selected.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Installing the DM2000
7
Installing the DM2000
The DM2000 should be placed on a strong and stable surface, somewhere that complies
with the warnings and cautions listed in the previous sections.
New Functions in DM2000 Version 2
The following functions have been added to the DM2000 as part of the upgrade of the firmware from version 1.2 to version 2.0.
Control Surface
•
•
•
•
When you operate the faders (for fader levels) or Encoders (for pan settings), the corresponding fader level or pan setting appears on the channel strip display.
You can switch the indication on the channel strip display between channel name/ID and
port name/ID. → page 276
Encoder mode now features an assignable function, ALT LAYER, which enables you to control the channel level for all 48 channels without switching between layers. → page 61
There are now 50 assignable Encoder mode parameters. → page 63
Input Channels
•
•
•
•
•
Surround Pan supports 6.1 Surround. → page 97
You can change the bus assigned to each surround pan channel. → page 99
The Fader Group Master function enables you to control the overall level of the Fader group
channels simultaneously while maintaining the relative level balance of each channel.
→ page 92
The Mute Group Master function enables you to mute all channels in a Mute group simultaneously. → page 90
The on/off status of the Follow Pan button is reflected in the pan and Surround Pan settings.
→ page 93
Aux Sends
•
•
•
•
You can exclude channels from Aux Sends (Mix Minus). → page 117
You can copy the channel fader positions to Aux Sends. → page 118
You can set all Send levels to nominal simultaneously. → page 112
If an Aux Send is set to pre-fader, you can set the Pre point before or after the [ON] button.
→ page 112
Common Channel Functions
•
•
•
•
•
•
Input and Output Channel Meter pages indicate the gain reduction being applied by the
Gate and Compressor. → page 128
You can select whether the Input Channel’s Pan setting is used when the Input Channel Solo
signal is set to Pre Fader. → page 143
Raising the channel faders for soloed Channels from –∞ can unsolo the Channels.
→ page 143
The AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons enable you to solo or unsolo Aux Sends.
→ page 143
The Fader Group Master function enables you to control the overall level of the Fader group
channels simultaneously while maintaining the relative level balance of each channel.
→ page 147
The Mute Group Master function enables you to mute all channels in a Mute group simultaneously. → page 149
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
8
Important Information
Monitor
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
The level of the Surround Monitor can be reset to 85dB SPL. → page 160
A new parameter has been added to Bass Management on the Surround Monitor Setup
page. → page 162
Surround Monitor is also available when Surround mode is set to Stereo.
You can simultaneously select BUS and ASSIGN1 or BUS and ASSIGN 2 for surround
monitoring.
You can select from Slot Channel 9 through Channel 16 as Surround Monitor signal sources.
You can simultaneously select 2TRD, D2, D3, A1, or A2, and STEREO, ASSIGN1, or
ASSIGN2 as Control Monitor signal sources.
You can select the Talkback mic signal as the Studio Monitor source. → page 164
Effects, Plug-ins and GEQ
•
•
You can add optional Add-On Effects to the preset effects. → page 178
The channel faders enable you to adjust the gain for each band in the graphic EQ.
→ page 184
Scene Memory
•
•
•
•
You can globally apply the Fade Time setting to all scenes. → page 189
You can globally apply the Recall Safe setting to all scenes. → page 190
Any channel or parameter settings in the current scene can be copied and pasted into other
scenes. → page 191
You can select more parameters for the Recall Safe function. → page 190
Automix
•
•
•
You can insert the current mix parameters in a region specified in the Automix data.
→ page 203
Touching the faders can punch parameter values in and out if the corresponding OVERWRITE button is set to on. → page 194
Some parameters related to timecode synchronization have been added. → page 278
Remote Control
•
•
•
The Joystick or the controls in the SELECTED CHANNEL section enable you to control Pro
Tools Surround Pan settings.
The USER DEFINED KEYS enable you to switch windows in the included Studio Manager
application software.
You can remotely control the Yamaha AD8HR A/D Converter.
Other Functions
•
•
•
•
•
•
A user-assignable layer enables you to assign Channels to Remote layer targets. → page 269
You can also select General DAW (for DAW software that supports the Pro Tools protocol)
or Cubase SX as the target for a Remote layer. → page 253
Yamaha’s proprietary Advanced DAW protocol has been added to Nuendo, Cubase SX, and
General DAW. This enables you to control these devices using the DM2000’s SELECTED
CHANNEL section. (Controllable functions vary depending on the DAW software and version you are using.)
You can now assign any of 214 functions to the USER DEFINED KEYS. → page 283
You can assign the selected channels to a Fader or Mute group using the USER DEFINED
KEYS. → page 283
An Operation Lock function prevents unintentional edits and uses a password to restrict
access to panel operation. → page 280
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
New Functions in DM2000 Version 2
•
•
•
9
The Oscillator can output sine wave signals with different frequencies to the L and R channels and odd and even buses. → page 279
You can set the Auto Direct Out On check box so that if you change a channel’s Direct Out
destination, the channel Direct Out will automatically be enabled. → page 276
You can set the Routing ST Pair Link check box so that the routing from paired Channels to
the Stereo Bus is linked. → page 276
This product contains a battery that contains perchlorate material.
Perchlorate Material—special handling may apply,
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.
(Perchlorate)
COMPLIANCE INFORMATION STATEMENT
(DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY PROCEDURE)
Responsible Party :
Address :
Telephone :
Type of Equipment :
Model Name :
Yamaha Corporation of America
6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif. 90620
714-522-9011
Digital Production Console
DM2000
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and
2) this device must accept any interference received including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
See user manual instructions if interference to radio reception is suspected.
* This applies only to products distributed by
YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.
(FCC DoC)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
10
Contents
Contents
1
Welcome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
2
Control Surface & Rear Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Control Surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Rear Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
3
Operating Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Connecting the Power Cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Turning On & Off the DM2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
About the Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Display Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Display History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Display Page Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parameter Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Confirmation Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Title Edit Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using a Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Channel Strip Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Fader Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting Encoder Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Assigning Parameters to the ENCODER MODE Assign Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . .
4
Analog I/O & the AD Input Section . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
AD Input Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control Room Monitor Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Studio Monitor Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Omni Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2TR Analog INs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5
64
65
65
65
65
65
Digital I/O & Cascading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Wordclocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2TR Digital Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2TR Digital Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2TR In/Out Sampling Rate Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Slot I/O . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dithering Digital Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Monitoring Digital Input Channel Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cascading Consoles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6
51
51
52
53
53
54
54
54
54
55
55
58
59
60
61
62
66
68
69
69
70
73
73
74
Input & Output Patching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Input Patching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Output Patching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Naming Input & Output Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Patch Select Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Patching with the Encoders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
77
79
82
83
83
Contents
7
11
Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Patching Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Metering Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Reversing the Signal Phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Gating Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Attenuating Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
EQ’ing Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Grouping Input Channel EQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Input Channel Inserts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Compressing Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Grouping Input Channel Compressors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Delaying Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Muting Input Channels (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Grouping Input Channel Mutes (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Input Channel Mute Master . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Setting Input Channel Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Grouping Input Channel Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Group Master for Input Channel Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Routing Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Panning Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Using Surround Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Assigning Surround Channels to Buses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Sending Input Channels to Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Soloing Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Direct Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Pairing Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Viewing Input Channel Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Copying Input Channel Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Naming Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Using the MS Stereo Microphone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
8
Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Stereo Out Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Patching the Stereo Out to Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Routing Input Channels to the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Sending Bus Outs to the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Metering the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Monitoring the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Attenuating the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
EQ’ing the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Grouping Master EQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Stereo Out Inserts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Compressing the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Grouping Master Compressors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Muting the Stereo Out (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Grouping Master Mutes (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Setting the Stereo Out Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Grouping Master Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Sending the Stereo Out to the Matrix Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Balancing the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Delaying the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Inserting GEQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Viewing Stereo Out Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Copying Stereo Out Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Naming the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
12
Contents
9
Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Patching Bus Outs to Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Routing Input Channels to Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Metering Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Monitoring Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Attenuating Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EQ’ing Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grouping Master EQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bus Out Inserts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Compressing Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grouping Master Compressors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Muting Bus Outs (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grouping Master Mutes (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting Bus Out Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grouping Master Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sending Bus Outs to Matrix Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Delaying Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inserting GEQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Soloing Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pairing Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sending Bus Outs to the Stereo Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing Bus Out Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Copying Bus Out Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Naming Bus Outs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
107
107
107
107
107
107
107
107
107
107
108
108
108
108
108
108
108
108
108
109
109
109
109
10 Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Patching Aux Send Masters to Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting the Aux Send Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pre-Fader or Post-Fader Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting Aux Send Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Muting Aux Sends (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Aux Send Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing Aux Send Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Panning Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Excluding Certain Channels from Aux Sends (Mix Minus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Copying Channel Fader Positions to Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Metering Aux Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Monitoring Aux Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Attenuating Aux Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EQ’ing Aux Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grouping Master EQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Aux Send Master Inserts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Compressing Aux Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grouping Master Compressors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Muting Aux Send Masters (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grouping Master Mutes (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Settings Aux Send Master Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Grouping Master Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sending Aux Sends to Matrix Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Delaying Aux Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inserting GEQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Soloing Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pairing Aux Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing Aux Send Master Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Copying Aux Send Master Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Naming Aux Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
110
110
111
111
112
112
114
116
117
118
118
118
118
118
118
119
119
119
119
119
119
119
119
119
120
120
120
120
120
120
Contents
13
11 Matrix Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Patching Matrix Send Masters to Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Pre-Fader or Post-Fader Matrix Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Setting Matrix Send Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Muting Matrix Sends (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Matrix Send Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Panning Matrix Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Viewing Matrix Send Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Metering Matrix Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Monitoring Matrix Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Attenuating Matrix Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
EQ’ing Matrix Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Grouping Master EQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Matrix Send Master Inserts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Compressing Matrix Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Grouping Master Compressors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Muting Matrix Send Masters (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Grouping Master Mutes (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Setting Matrix Send Master Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Grouping Master Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Balancing Matrix Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Delaying Matrix Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Soloing Matrix Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Inserting GEQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Viewing Matrix Send Master Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Copying Matrix Send Master Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Naming Matrix Send Masters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
12 Common Channel Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Metering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Attenuating Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Using EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Grouping Output Channel EQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Using Inserts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Compressing Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Grouping Output Channel Compressors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Delaying Channel Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Soloing Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Pairing Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Grouping Output Channel Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Group Master for the Output Channel Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Grouping Output Channel Mutes (ON/OFF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Output Channel Mute Master . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Viewing Channel Parameter Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Viewing Channel Fader Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Copying Channel Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Naming Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
13 Monitoring & Talkback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Control Room Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Studio Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Surround Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Using Talkback & Slate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
14
Contents
14 Libraries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
About the Libraries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General Library Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Channel Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Input Patch Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Output Patch Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
GEQ Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Effects Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bus to Stereo Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gate Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Comp Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EQ Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automix Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Surround Monitor Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
165
165
166
167
167
168
168
169
170
171
172
173
173
15 Internal Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
About the Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Patching Effects Processors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Preset Effects & Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding Optional Add-On Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
About Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
About the GEQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing GEQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing the Graphic EQ Using the Channel Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
174
174
174
177
178
179
180
181
183
183
184
16 Scene Memories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
About Scene Memories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Auto Scene Memory Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Storing & Recalling Scenes with the SCENE MEMORY Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using the Scene Memory Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fading Scenes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Recalling Scenes Safely . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sorting Scenes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Copying and Pasting a Scene (Global Paste) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
191
17 Automix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
About Automix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
What’s Recorded in an Automix? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automix Main Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AUTOMIX Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Channel Strip [AUTO] Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automix Memory Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fader Edit Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selecting the Timecode Source & Frame Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Creating a Time Signature Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Recording an Automix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inserting Mix Parameters into Automix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rerecording Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parameter Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Punching In & Out Individual Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Playing Back an Automix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing Events Offline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
193
193
194
198
199
199
199
201
202
202
203
205
206
207
208
209
Contents
15
18 MIDI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
MIDI & the DM2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
MIDI I/O . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
MIDI Port Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
MIDI Channel Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Assigning Scenes to Program Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Assigning Parameters to Control Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Controlling Parameters by Using Parameter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Using Bulk Dump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
19 Pro Tools Remote Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Configuring Windows Computers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Configuring Macintosh Computers (MacOS 8.6 to 9.2.2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Configuring Macintosh Computer (MacOS X) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Configuring the DM2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Configuring Pro Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Scrolling Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Selecting Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Assigning Inputs to Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Assigning Outputs to Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Setting Channel Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Muting Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Panning Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Soloing Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Assigning Send Destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Configuring Sends as Pre or Post . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Setting Send Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Muting Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Panning Sends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Flip Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Assigning Inserts/Plug-ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Editing Plug-ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Bypassing Individual Plug-ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Bypassing all Plug-ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Resetting Faders, Sends, Panpots & Plug-ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Navigating the Edit Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Zooming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Making Fine Adjustments to the Selected Region . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Scrub & Shuttle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Automation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Panner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
20 Remote Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
About Remote Layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
About Machine Control (MMC & P2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
GPI (General Purpose Interface) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
Controlling AD8HR/AD824 A/D Converters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
21 Other Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Using the User Assignable Layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Using the User Defined Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Saving DM2000 Data to SmartMedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Setting Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Using the Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
16
Contents
Operation Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Checking the Battery and the System Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initializing the DM2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initializing the Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
280
282
282
282
Appendix A: Parameter Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
USER DEFINED KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
USER DEFINED KEYS Initial Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Input Patch Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Input Patch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Output Patch Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Output Patch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Input Channel Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Output Channel Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Input Port Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Output Port Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
GPI Trigger Source & Target List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
User Defined Remote Layer Initial Bank Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Effects Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Effects and tempo synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Preset EQ Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Preset Gate Parameters
(fs = 44.1 kHz) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Preset Compressor Parameters (fs = 44.1 kHz) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dynamics Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
283
285
286
289
290
297
298
299
300
301
302
306
310
331
332
333
334
336
Appendix B: Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
General Spec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Libraries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Analog Input Spec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Analog Output Spec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Digital Input Spec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Digital Output Spec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I/O Slot Spec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control I/O Spec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Connector Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
341
346
347
347
348
348
349
349
350
351
Appendix C: MIDI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
Scene Memory to Program Change Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
MIDI Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Format Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
352
353
369
369
Appendix D: Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386
MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386
SP2000 Wooden Side Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Welcome
17
1 Welcome
Thank you for choosing the Yamaha DM2000 Digital Production Console.
Designed with production in mind, the DM2000 Digital Production Console offers
24-bit/96 kHz digital audio processing without compromise, comprehensive surround
mixing and monitoring, including bass management and down mixing, and hands-on control of popular DAW (Digital Audio Workstation) systems.
Sonic Spec
•
•
•
•
•
Linear 24-bit, 128-times oversampling A/D converters
Linear 24-bit, 128-times oversampling D/A converters
20 Hz–40 kHz (0.5, –1.5 dB) frequency response at 96 kHz sampling rate
108 dB typical dynamic range (AD Input to Stereo Out)
32-bit internal signal processing (58-bit accumulator)
Channel Architecture
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
96 Input Channels, with Direct Outs
8 Bus Outs, with to Stereo Out routing for subgrouping
12 Aux Sends
4 stereo Matrix Sends (22 x 8 matrix)
Stereo Out
Channels can be named for easy identification
Channel library with 127 user memories
Copy and paste channel settings
I/O Architecture
•
•
24 analog mic/line inputs on balanced XLRs and phone jacks (plus 48 V phantom)
24 analog inserts on individual in/out phone jacks
•
48 inputs, 48 outputs via six mini-YGDAI slots and optional I/O cards, which offer a variety
of analog and digital I/O options, with support for all the popular digital audio interconnect formats, including AES/EBU, ADAT, Tascam TDIF-1, and mLAN.
8 assignable Omni outputs
2 AES/EBU, 1 Coaxial 2-track digital input
2 AES/EBU, 1 Coaxial 2-track digital output
2 analog 2-track inputs
XLR and phone jack stereo outputs
Large and small control room outputs
Dedicated studio monitor outputs
AES/EBU and Coaxial I/O sampling rate converters for connecting 44.1/48 kHz legacy digital audio equipment
Double channel digital I/O for use with legacy 44.1/48 kHz multitrack recorders
Cascade ports for cascading up to four DM2000s (i.e., 384 Input Channels)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
18
Chapter 1—Welcome
I/O Patching
•
•
•
•
Any available input port can be patched to the Input Channels, Insert Ins, or Effects inputs
Direct Outs, Insert Outs, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out can be
patched to any output port
Input and output ports can be named for easy identification
Patches can be stored in the Input and Output Patch libraries
EQ & GEQ
•
•
•
•
4-band parametric EQ on all Input and Output Channels
EQ library with 40 presets, 160 user memories
Six 31-band graphic equalizers that can be patched into Output Channels
GEQ library with 128 user memories
Groups & Pairs
•
•
•
•
•
•
Horizontal and vertical pairing of Input Channels
Horizontal pairing of Bus Outs, Aux Sends, and Surround Pan
8 Input Channel, 4 Output Channel Fader groups
8 Input Channel, 4 Output Channel Mute groups
4 Input Channel, 4 Output Channel EQ groups
4 Input Channel, 4 Output Channel Compressor groups
Effects
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
8 internal effects processors
Effects library with 61 presets, 67 user memories (presets 53–61 are used for optional
Add-On Effects.)
Optional Add-On Effect package includes effects that featuring new algorithms.
Multichannel effects for surround sound processing
Joystick control of early reflections and reverb with the Reverb 5.1 effect
Optional Waves 56K effects plug-in card
User defined plug-ins for external effects control via MIDI, with Learn function
Dynamics
•
•
•
•
Gates on all 96 Input Channels
Gate library with 4 presets, 124 user memories
Compressors on all Input Channels and Out Channels (126 in total)
Compressor library with 36 presets, 92 user memories
Automation
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Dynamic automation of virtually all mix parameters, with 1/4-frame accuracy
Automix library with 16 memories
Snapshot style automation with 99 Scene memories, recallable via MIDI or Automix
Individual fade time settings for all Input and Output faders
Scene and library recalls
Punch in/out entire channels with dedicated [AUTO] buttons, or individual parameters
Editing fader moves with Fader Return, Fader Takeover, Absolute/Relative modes
Offline event editing includes, erase, copy, move/merge, trim, duplicate, delete, and insert
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Welcome
19
Surround Sound
•
•
•
•
•
•
3-1, 5.1 and 6.1 Surround modes
Joystick control
Bass management
Down mixing
Surround monitor speaker alignment functions
Surround monitor library with 32 user memories
Remote Control
•
•
•
•
•
Control and manage your DM2000 from your Mac or PC by using the bundled Studio
Manager software
Remote Layers for external equipment control, including predefined targets for controlling
DAW systems, and user defined targets for controlling MIDI equipment, with Learn function
Comprehensive machine control via MMC or P2, including transport, track arming,
jog/shuttle, and built-in locator with eight Locate memories, all with independent control
of master and MTR machines
Assignable GPI (General Purpose Interface) port for external control and “Recording” light
Remote control of parameters on up to 12 Yamaha AD8HR/AD824 A/D Converters
MIDI
•
•
•
Standard MIDI ports, USB TO HOST port, or SERIAL TO HOST port
USB, and SERIAL offer multiport operation
Scene recall, mix parameter control, Bulk Dump, MTC and MIDI Clock for Automix synchronization, MMC for external machine control
Control Surface
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
25 touch-sensitive 100-mm motorized faders (touch sense used to select channels or punch
faders in/out during Automix recording)
Use the faders to set channel levels or Aux/Matrix Send levels
Use the 24 Encoders to control Pan, Aux/Matrix Send levels, or user assigned parameters
Channels arranged into four Input Layers, Master Layer, and four Remote Layers
320 x 240 dot LCD display with fluorescent backlight
Fluorescent channel strip displays, showing channel names, Encoder status, routing, etc.
Complete hands-on control of all channel functions via the SELECTED CHANNEL section
2-digit Scene memory display
4 EQ displays for frequency, gain, and Q
16 user-definable buttons make light work of repetitive tasks
Display History buttons for quick access to recently viewed display pages
SmartMedia card slot for Automix, Scene, library, and setup data storage and transfer
Optional PS/2-compatible keyboard for quick title entry
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS
(p. 26)
ENCODER
MODE (p. 23)
FADER MODE
(p. 24)
AUX SELECT
(p. 23)
MATRIX SELECT
(p. 22)
SmartMedia CARD
Slot (p. 22)
PAD
OFF
ON
3.3V CARD
INSERT
AUX
AUX
5
9
AUX
AUX
10
6
2
ASSIGN 2
OUTPUT
ASSIGN 1
INPUT
ON
2
ON
1
12
8
4
ASSIGN 3
SEND ASSIGN
SEL
3
ON
SOLO
4
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
INSERT
ASSIGN 4
6
5
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
DISPLAY
OFF
ON
INSERT
GROUP
REMOTE
DIO
INPUT
PATCH
METER
SETUP
INSERT
5
SEL
AUTO
6
ON
SOLO
1
6
2
7
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
7
3
8
SIGNAL
8
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
8
4
2
20 10
20 10
10
1
15 5
15 5
10
5 5
0
60 40
60 40
70 50
3
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
4
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
5
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
6
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
7
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
8
5
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
Channel strips (p. 21)
70 50
50 30
50 30
30
40
20
50
30 15
40 20
30 15
40 20
15
10 0
5
10
5 5
0
10 0
0
10
5
0
OUTPUT
PATCH
VIEW
UTILITY
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
INTERNAL GRAPHIC PLUG INS CHANNEL
EFFECTS EQUALIZERS
INSERTS
EFFECTS / PLUG INS
PAIR
MIDI
DATA
7
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
DISPLAY ACCESS
INSERT
SIGNAL
5
INSERT
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
CH01 CH02 CH03 CH04 CH05 CH06 CH07 CH08
SEL
SOLO
SEL
AUX
AUX
AUX
FADER MODE
11
7
3
OFF
ON
MATRIX 4
INSERT
4
SIGNAL
-60
FADER AUX / MTRX
AUX
AUX
AUX
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
ON
OFF
9
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
OFF
ON
INSERT
10
SIGNAL
10
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
12
1
11
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
F1
12
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
2
F2
INSERT
SIGNAL
11
INSERT
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
13
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
3
F3
INSERT
13
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
14
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
F4
4
INSERT
14
SIGNAL
SEL
AUTO
INSERT
15
SIGNAL
ON
15
ON
16
16
10
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
5
9
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
10
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
12
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
13
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
14
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
15
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
16
5
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
6
8
5
7
COMP ON
L
18
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
EQ ON
ATT.
EQUALIZER
19
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
R
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
INSERT
20
SIGNAL
INSERT
INSERT ON
AUX 9
AUX 5
FREQUENCY
20
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
125
kHz
Hz
dB
GAIN
LOW
R
21
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
22
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
1.00
Q
LINK
23
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
kHz
Hz
dB
GAIN
LOW MID
FREQUENCY
EVEN
ATTACK
ATTACK
DECAY
24
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
4.00
Q
10
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
5
17
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
18
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
19
10
5 5
0
20
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
21
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
22
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
23
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
LAYER (p. 34)
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
24
ON
LEVEL
FB
AUX 7
EFFECT
GAIN
HOLD
AUX 11
5
0
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
kHz
Hz
dB
GAIN
ON
LEVEL
FREQUENCY
1 24
49 72
5
0
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
REMOTE 4
REMOTE 3
B
18
10
2
C
19
11
3
D
20
12
4
TRACK ARMING
2
3
11
END
SCRUB
SHUTTLE
BACK
FF
21
LATCH
READ
4
13
5
ENTER
FORWARD
5
QUICK
PUNCH
POST
STOP
LOOP
OUT
4
RECALL
MASTER
24
16
8
SET
7
15
7
AUX
ON
TRIM
MTR
8
16
8
EQ
OFF
PLAY
DEC
REC
ROLL REHEARSAL MASTER
BACK
6
14
6
PAN SURROUND AUX
12
23
15
7
10
STUDIO
LEVEL
0
RETURN RELATIVE TOUCH
SENSE
OVERWRITE
TOUCH
ABORT / AUTOUNDO
REC
22
14
6
ALL CLEAR
LOCATE MEMORY
ONLINE
IN
3
DISPLAY HISTORY
REW
RETURN
TO ZERO
AUDITION PRE
1
ON
LOCATOR
2
10
9
DISPLAY
REC
WRITE
5
13
STORE
USER DEFINED KEYS
FADER
SUSPEND
ENABLE
AUTOMIX
00
1
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
SCENE MEMORY
TRACK ARMING GROUP
A
17
9
1
DISPLAY
10
SMALL
TRIM
0
STEREO (p. 34)
STEREO
ON
SEL
AUTO
STEREO
MASTER
73 96
REMOTE 2
REMOTE 1
kHz
Hz
dB
GAIN
LAYER
10.0
Q
HIGH
AUX 12
AUX 8
AUX 4 / MATRIX 4
25 48
MIX
AUX 3 / MATRIX 3
HIGH MID
FREQUENCY
GRAB
RELEASE
AUX 10
AUX 6
ON
ON
OFF
ON
TIME
INSERT
24
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
DELAY
OFF
ON
AUX 2 / MATRIX 2
LEVEL
DISPLAY
INSERT
23
SIGNAL
ON
LEVEL
RATIO
L
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
AUX 1 / MATRIX 1
THRESHOLD
BANK
AUX / MATRIX SEND
RANGE
COMP
22
SIGNAL
GATE / COMP
THRESHOLD
ODD
Q
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SELECTED CHANNEL
INSERT
21
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
PHASE / INSERT
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
GATE
OFF
ON
PAN / SURROUND
GATE ON
DYNAMICS
DIRECT
4
3
STEREO
2
1
INSERT
19
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SELECTED CHANNEL Section (p. 28)
CH17 CH18 CH19 CH20 CH21 CH22 CH23 CH24
17
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
PASTE
COPY
CHANNEL
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
OFF
ON
ROUTING
INSERT
18
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
FOLLOW PAN
DISPLAY
INSERT
17
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
CHANNEL COPY (p. 33)
11
10
5 5
0
10 0
0
INSERT
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SIGNAL
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SOLO
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
Display Section (p. 27)
CH09 CH10 CH11 CH12 CH13 CH14 CH15 CH16
INSERT
9
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
DISPLAY ACCESS (p. 24)
+ 48V
MATRIX 3
AUTO
SEND LEVEL
PAN
AUTO
AUX/ MTRX
PAN
ENCODER MODE
AUX
AUX 1
AUX SELECT
MATRIX 2
MATRIX SELECT
MATRIX 1
SOLO
AUTO
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
INSERT
3
1
INSERT
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
2
GAIN
26dB
+ 48V
SIGNAL
-16
ON
OFF
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
26dB
+ 48V
PEAK
GAIN
ON
OFF
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
AD Input Section (p. 21)
10
MONITOR
AUX 12
STEREO
ASSIGN 2
STEREO
2TR A2
2TR A1
BUS
ASSIGN 2
DIMMER
INC
TALKBACK
SLATE
TALKBACK
LOCATOR
(p. 37)
USER DEFINED
KEYS (p. 37)
AUTOMIX
(p. 36)
SCENE MEMORY (p. 35)
TRACK ARMING (p. 35)
MONITOR Section (p. 42)
Data Entry &
Transport (p. 39)
0
10
CONTROL ROOM LEVEL
SMALL
MONO
SURROUND
MONITOR LEVEL
ASSIGN 1
SURROUND
ASSIGN 1
2TR D3
2TR D2
2TR D1
STEREO
CONTROL ROOM
CLEAR
SOLO CONTRAST
SOLO
AUX 11
CONTROL
ROOM
STUDIO
DISPLAY
10
PHONES
LEVEL
0
PHONES
TALKBACK LEVEL
0
Monitor, Phones &
Talkback Section
(p. 41)
20
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
2 Control Surface & Rear Panel
Control Surface
Control Surface
21
AD Input Section
AD Input #1 is shown here.
A +48V ON/OFF switches
These switches turn on and off the +48 V phantom power feed to each INPUT A
(XLR-type connector). Phantom power is typically used to power condenser-type
microphones or direct boxes. See “Phantom Power” on page 64 for more information.
+ 48V
1
2
3
4
5
6
ON
OFF
PAD
26dB
B PAD switches
These switches turn on and off the 26 dB pad (attenuator) for each AD Input. See
“Pad” on page 64 for more information.
-60
-16
GAIN
PEAK
SIGNAL
1
C GAIN controls
OFF
ON
These controls adjust the gain of the AD Input Head Amps. They have an input
sensitivity of –16 dB to –60 dB or +10 dB to –34 dB when Pad is on. See “Gain” on
page 64 for more information.
INSERT
D PEAK indicators
These indicators light up when the input signal level is 3 dB below clipping. See
“PEAK & SIGNAL Indicators” on page 64 for more information.
E SIGNAL indicators
These indicators light up when the input signal level is 20 dB below nominal. See
“PEAK & SIGNAL Indicators” on page 64 for more information.
F INSERT ON/OFF switches
These switches are for turning on and off the AD Input inserts. See “AD Inserts”
on page 65 for more information.
Channel strips
Channel strip #1 is shown here.
The function of each channel strip depends on the currently selected Layer. See
“Selecting Layers” on page 58 for more information.
1
2
A Encoders
AUTO
These controls are used to edit Input and Output Channel parameters. Their exact
operation depends on the currently selected Encoder mode and Layer. There are
two preset Encoder modes, Pan and Aux/Mtrx, and four assignable modes, with
over 50 parameters to choose from. See “Selecting Encoder Modes” on page 61 for
more information.
The Encoders feature push switches that are used to punch the parameter currently assigned to the Encoders in and out during Automix recording. See
“Punching In & Out Individual Parameters” on page 207 for more information.
3
SEL
4
SOLO
5
ON
1
6
CH01
B AUTO buttons
These buttons are used to set Automix recording and playback for each channel.
Their exact operation depends on the currently selected Layer. Their indicators
light up orange in Record-Ready mode, red while recording, and green during
playback. See “Channel Strip [AUTO] Buttons” on page 199 for more information.
10
7
0
5
5
0
10
5
15
10
20
15
30
20
40
30
50
C SEL buttons
These buttons are used to select Input and Output Channels for editing with the
SELECTED CHANNEL section. Their exact operation depends on the currently
selected Layer. The [SEL] button indicator of the currently selected channel lights
up. See “Selecting Channels” on page 59 for more information. They are also used
to display the Long channel names. See “Channel Names” on page 57 for more
information. The [SEL] buttons can also be used to pair channels, and to add and
remove channels to and from the EQ, Comp, Fader, and Mute groups.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
22
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
D SOLO buttons
These buttons are used to solo Channels. The [SOLO] button indicators of channels that
are soloed light up. See “Soloing Channels” on page 142 for more information.
E ON buttons
These buttons are used to mute Input and Output Channels. Their exact operation depends
on the currently selected Layer. The [ON] button indicators of channels that are on light up.
You can also use these buttons along with the AUX SELECT buttons to turn Aux Sends on
and off (Mix Minus) (page 117).
F Channel strip displays
These fluorescent displays graphically display the value of the Input or Output Channel
parameter currently assigned to the Encoders. They also display routing settings, and the
on/off status of the EQ, Insert, Delay, Comp, and Gate functions. They also display Long
and Short channel names and indicate the currently selected channel. When you operate
the channel faders or Encoders, they display the corresponding values. See “Channel Strip
Displays” on page 55 for more information.
G Channel faders
These 100 mm touch-sensitive motorized faders are used to set the levels of Input Channels,
Bus Outs, Aux Sends, and Matrix Sends. Their exact operation depends on the currently
selected Fader mode and Layer. See “Selecting Fader Modes” on page 60 for more information. Faders can be grouped for simultaneous operation. See “Grouping Input Channel
Faders” on page 91 and “Grouping Output Channel Faders” on page 146 for more information.
Faders can also be used to select Input and Output Channels. See “Auto Channel Select &
Touch Sense Select” on page 60 for more information. They can also be used to punch channels in and out during Automix recording. See “Punching In & Out Individual Parameters”
on page 207 for more information.
Channel faders also enable you to set graphic equalizer curves. See “Editing GEQs” on page
183 for more information.
SmartMedia CARD Slot
This CARD slot is for use with SmartMedia (3.3 V), which can be
used to store DM2000 data, including Setups, Scenes, Automixes,
Libraries, and so on. See “Saving DM2000 Data to SmartMedia” on
page 271 for more information.
3.3V CARD
MATRIX SELECT
1
MATRIX SELECT
DISPLAY
MATRIX 1
MATRIX 2
MATRIX 3
MATRIX 4
2
A MATRIX SELECT DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Matrix Send, Matrix Send Pan, and Matrix
View. See “Matrix Sends” on page 121 for more information.
B MATRIX 1–4 buttons
These buttons are used to select Matrix Sends when sending Bus Out, Aux Send, and Stereo
Out signals to Matrix Sends. The button indicator of the currently selected Matrix Send
lights up. See “Matrix Sends” on page 121 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
23
AUX SELECT
1
AUX SELECT
DISPLAY
AUX 1
AUX 2
AUX 3
AUX 4
AUX 5
AUX 6
AUX 7
AUX 8
AUX 9
AUX 10
AUX 11
AUX 12
2
A AUX SELECT DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Aux Send, Aux Send Pan, and Input Channel Aux View. See “Aux Sends” on page 110 for more information.
B AUX 1–12 buttons
These buttons are used to select Aux Sends when sending Input Channel signals to Aux
Sends. The button indicator of the currently selected Aux Send lights up. If the currently
selected Aux Send is paired, the indicator of its partner flashes. See “Aux Sends” on page 110
for more information.
Using these buttons along with the channel [ON] buttons enables you to turn Aux Sends on
and off (Mix Minus) (page 117).
Using these buttons along with the LAYER buttons enables you to copy the corresponding
channel levels to the Aux Send levels.
These buttons are also used to turn the Aux Out Solo function on and off when Aux/Solo
Link is turned on (page 142).
ENCODER MODE
2 3
1
ENCODER MODE
DISPLAY
PAN
AUX/ MTRX
PAN
SEND LEVEL
ASSIGN 1
ASSIGN 2
ASSIGN 3
ASSIGN 4
INPUT
OUTPUT
SEND ASSIGN
INSERT
4
The small text labels below the ASSIGN buttons apply to the DAW Remote Layer. See
“About Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information.
A ENCODER MODE DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the Encoder Mode Assign page. See “Selecting Encoder Modes”
on page 61 for more information.
B PAN button
This button is used to select the Pan Encoder mode. Its indicator lights up when this mode
is selected. In this mode, the Encoders function as Pan controls when an Input Channel
Layer is selected. When the Master Layer is selected, Encoders 21–24 function as Matrix
Send Balance controls. The other Encoders are inactive. See “Selecting Encoder Modes” on
page 61 for more information.
C AUX/MTRX button
This button is used to select the Aux/Mtrx Encoder mode. Its indicator lights up when this
mode is selected. In this mode, the Encoders function as Aux Send level controls when an
Input Channel Layer is selected. When the Master Layer is selected, Encoders 1–20 function
as Matrix Send level controls. See “Selecting Encoder Modes” on page 61.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
24
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
D ASSIGN 1–4 buttons
These buttons are used to select the assignable Encoder modes. The button indicator for the
currently selected mode lights up. When an assignable mode is selected, the function of the
Encoders depends on the assigned parameter. Up to four parameters, from a list of 50, can
be assigned to these four buttons. See “Assigning Parameters to the ENCODER MODE
Assign Buttons” on page 62 for more information.
FADER MODE
FADER MODE
FADER AUX/ MTRX
1 2
A FADER button
This button selects Fader mode, in which the faders control Input or Output Channel levels,
depending on the currently selected Layer. Its indicator lights up when this mode is selected.
See “Selecting Fader Modes” on page 60 for more information.
B AUX/MTRX button
This button selects the Aux/Mtrx Fader mode, in which the faders control Aux Send or
Matrix Send levels, depending on the currently selected Layer. Its indicator lights up when
this mode is selected. See “Selecting Fader Modes” on page 60 for more information.
DISPLAY ACCESS
1 2 3 4
DISPLAY ACCESS
5
6
DATA
DIO
SETUP
UTILITY
MIDI
REMOTE
METER
VIEW
PAIR
GROUP
INPUT
PATCH
OUTPUT
PATCH
7
8
9 J K L
A DATA button
This button is used to select the Save, Load, and File pages, which are used to save and load
DM2000 data to SmartMedia. See “Saving DM2000 Data to SmartMedia” on page 271 for
more information.
B DIO button
This button is used to select the following pages: Word Clock Select, Dither, Cascade In,
Cascade Out, Sampling Rate Converter, and Higher Sample Rate Data Transfer Format. See
“Digital I/O & Cascading” on page 66 for more information.
C SETUP button
This button is used to select the following pages: Preferences 1, Preferences 2, Preferences 3,
MIDI/TO HOST Setup, GPI Setup, Input Port Name, Output Port Name, Time Reference,
Time Signature, Remote Port Setup, and Surround Bus Setup.
D UTILITY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Oscillator, Channel Status Monitor, Battery Check, and Operation Lock.
E REMOTE button
This button is used to select the Remote pages. See “About Remote Layers” on page 253 for
more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
25
F MIDI button
This button is used to select the following pages: MIDI Setup, Program Change Assign
Table, Control Change Assign Table, and Bulk Dump. See “MIDI” on page 215 for more
information.
G METER button
This button is used to select the following pages: Input Channel Meter, Master Meter, Effect
Input/Output Meter, Effect 1-8 Input/Output Meter, Effect 1–2 Input/Output Meter, Stereo
Meter, and Metering Position. See “Metering” on page 127 for more information.
H VIEW button
This button is used to select the following pages: Parameter View, Fader View, and Channel
Library. See “Viewing Channel Parameter Settings” on page 150, “Viewing Channel Fader
Settings” on page 151, and “Channel Library” on page 166 for more information.
I PAIR button
This button is used to select the Input and Output Pair pages. See “Pairing Channels” on
page 144 for more information.
J GROUP button
This button is used to select the following pages: Fader group, Mute group, Output Fader
group, Output Mute group, Input Equalizer Link, Output Equalizer Link, Input Comp
Link, Output Comp Link, Input Fader Group Master, and Output Fader Group Master.
K INPUT PATCH button
This button is used to select the following pages: Input Channel Patch, Input Channel Insert
In Patch, Effects 1-2 Input/Output Patch, Effects 3–8 Input/Output Patch, Input Channel
Name, and Input Patch Library. See “Input Patching” on page 77 for more information.
L OUTPUT PATCH button
This button is used to select the following pages: Slot Output Patch, Omni Out Patch, Output Insert In Patch, Input Channel Direct Out Destination, 2TR Out Digital Patch, Graphic
Equalizer Insert, Output Channel Name, and Output Patch Library. See “Output Patching”
on page 79 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
26
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS
2 3 4 5
1
EFFECTS / PLUG INS
DISPLAY
INTERNAL GRAPHIC PLUG INS CHANNEL
EFFECTS EQUALIZERS
INSERTS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
6
1
7
2
3
4
8
A EFFECTS/PLUG-INS DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Effects Edit, Effects Library, Graphic
Equalizer Edit, Graphic Equalizer Library, Plug-In Setup, and Plug-In Edit. See “Internal
Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs” on page 174 for more information.
B INTERNAL EFFECTS button
This button is used to select the internal effects processors in conjunction with the
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [1–8] buttons. Its indicator lights up when it’s pressed. See “Editing
Effects” on page 177 for more information.
C GRAPHIC EQUALIZERS button
This button is used to select the GEQs in conjunction with the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [1–6]
buttons. Its indicator lights up when it’s pressed. See “Editing GEQs” on page 183 for more
information.
D PLUG-INS button
This button is used to select the Plug-Ins in conjunction with the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS
[1–8] buttons. Its indicator lights up when it’s pressed. See “Editing Plug-Ins” on page 181
for more information.
E CHANNEL INSERTS button
If an internal effects processor or Y56K card effects chain is inserted in the currently selected
channel, the relevant Effects Edit or Plug-In Edit page appears when this button is pressed,
and its indicator lights up. In addition, the corresponding EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [1–8] button indicator flashes. If it’s a Y56K that is inserted, the [PLUG-INS] button indicator also
flashes. If it’s an internal effects processor, the [INTERNAL EFFECTS] button indicator
flashes. A warning message appears if there’s nothing inserted in the currently selected
channel. See “Editing Effects” on page 177 and “Editing Plug-Ins” on page 181 for more
information.
F EFFECTS/PLUG-INS 1–8 buttons
These buttons are used to select the internal effects processors, GEQs, and Plug-Ins in conjunction with the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [INTERNAL EFFECTS], [GRAPHIC EQUALIZERS], and [PLUG-INS] buttons. The button indicator of the currently selected internal
effects processor, GEQ, or Plug-In lights up. Since there are six GEQs, buttons [7] and [8]
are inactive when the [GRAPHIC EQUALIZERS] button’s indicator is lit. When the
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [CHANNEL INSERTS] button indicator is lit, all of these buttons are
inactive.
G Parameter Up/Down buttons
These buttons are used to select the rows of internal effects processor and Plug-In parameters for editing with Parameter controls 1–4. The parameters in the currently selected row
appear highlighted. Up to 16 parameters can be displayed at a time. If more are available,
an up or down arrow is displayed. See “Editing Effects” on page 177 and “Editing Plug-Ins”
on page 181 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
27
H Parameter controls 1–4
These are rotary controls and push switches. The rotary controls are used to edit the parameters of the currently selected internal effects processor, Plug-In, or GEQ. When the Effects
Edit page is selected, they control the currently selected row of parameters, rows being
selected by the Parameter Up/Down buttons. When the Graphic Equalizer Edit page is
selected, Parameter control #1 selects the frequency bands and Parameter control #4 sets the
gain of the selected band. Parameter controls #2 and #3 are inactive. See “Editing Effects”
on page 177, “Editing Plug-Ins” on page 181, and “Editing GEQs” on page 183 for more
information.
The push switches are used to punch the Effects or Plug-In parameters currently being controlled by the rotary controls in and out during Automix recording. See “Punching In & Out
Individual Parameters” on page 207 for more information.
Display Section
1
2
3
4
5
F1
F2
F3
F4
A Display
This 320 x 240 dot display with fluorescent backlight displays pages, information on the
currently selected Scene and channel, the sampling rate, and more. See “About the Display”
on page 52 for more information.
B Contrast control
This control is used to adjust the contrast of the display.
C F1–F4 buttons
These buttons are used to select the pages whose tabs are currently visible. See “Selecting
Display Pages” on page 53 for more information.
D Left Tab Scroll button
This button, which is active only when the left Tab Scroll arrow is displayed, is used to display the tabs of pages available to the left of the currently selected page. See “Selecting Display Pages” on page 53 for more information.
E Right Tab Scroll button
This button, which is active only when the right Tab Scroll arrow is displayed, is used to display the tabs of pages available to the right of the currently selected page. See “Selecting Display Pages” on page 53 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
28
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
SELECTED CHANNEL Section
SELECTED CHANNEL
ROUTING
PHASE / INSERT
DELAY
FB
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
1
DISPLAY
2
MIX
ON
INSERT ON
TIME
AUX / MATRIX SEND
3
4
DISPLAY
FOLLOW PAN
5
6
7
8
STEREO
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
ON
ON
ON
ON
AUX 1 / MATRIX 1
AUX 2 / MATRIX 2
AUX 3 / MATRIX 3
AUX 4 / MATRIX 4
AUX 5
AUX 6
AUX 7
AUX 8
AUX 9
AUX 10
AUX 11
AUX 12
BANK
DIRECT
DYNAMICS
DISPLAY
GATE / COMP
THRESHOLD
RANGE
ATTACK
DECAY
HOLD
THRESHOLD
RATIO
ATTACK
RELEASE
GAIN
LINK
GRAB
EFFECT
GATE
COMP
GATE ON
COMP ON
PAN / SURROUND
DISPLAY
L
L
R
ODD
EVEN
R
EQUALIZER
LOW
DISPLAY
CHANNEL
LOW MID
FREQUENCY
FREQUENCY
FREQUENCY
Q
Q
HIGH
FREQUENCY
Q
Q
GAIN
GAIN
COPY
HIGH MID
ATT.
GAIN
GAIN
EQ ON
dB
dB
125
1.00
Hz
4.00
Hz
kHz
kHz
PASTE
dB
Hz
dB
10.0
kHz
Hz
kHz
The subsections of the SELECTED CHANNEL section are explained below.
ROUTING
1
ROUTING
DISPLAY
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
STEREO
DIRECT
5
2
FOLLOW PAN
3 4
A ROUTING DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Input Channel Routing, Bus to Stereo, and
Bus to Stereo Library. See “Routing Input Channels” on page 93 and “Sending Bus Outs to
the Stereo Out” on page 109 for more information.
B FOLLOW PAN button
This button determines whether or not the currently selected Input Channel’s pan setting,
and Surround pan setting are applied to the Bus Outs. Its indicator lights up when it’s
pressed. See “Routing Input Channels” on page 93 for more information.
C STEREO button
This button is used to route the currently selected Input Channel to the Stereo Out. Its indicator lights up when it’s pressed. See “Routing Input Channels” on page 93 for more information.
D DIRECT button
This button is used to route the currently selected Input Channel to its Direct Out. Its indicator lights up when it’s pressed. See “Routing Input Channels” on page 93 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
29
E ROUTING 1–8 buttons
These buttons are used to route the currently selected Input Channel to the Bus Outs. The
button indicators of Bus Outs to which the Input Channel is routed light up. See “Routing
Input Channels” on page 93 for more information.
PHASE/INSERT
1
PHASE / INSERT
DISPLAY
INSERT ON
2
3
A PHASE/INSERT DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the Input Channel Phase and Insert pages. See “Reversing the
Signal Phase” on page 84 and “Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
B Phase [ ] button
This button is used to reverse the signal phase of the currently selected Input Channel. Its
indicator lights up when the phase is reversed. See “Reversing the Signal Phase” on page 84
for more information.
C INSERT ON button
This button is used to turn on and off the Insert of the currently selected channel. Its indicator lights up when the Insert is on. See “Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
DELAY
1
DELAY
FB
DISPLAY
MIX
ON
TIME
2 3 45
A DELAY DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the Delay pages. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page 141
for more information.
B ON button
This button is used to turn on and off the Delay of the currently selected channel. Its indicator lights up when the Delay function is on. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page 141
for more information.
C TIME control
This control is used to set the delay time of the currently selected channel’s Delay function.
See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page 141 for more information.
D FB/MIX indicators
These indicators show whether the FB/MIX control is set to control Feedback Gain or Feedback Mix. The FB indicator lights up when it’s set to control Feedback Gain; the MIX indicator, when its set to control Feedback Mix. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page 141 for
more information.
E FB/MIX control
This is a rotary control and push switch. When the currently selected channel is an Input
Channel, the push switch can be used to select either Feedback Gain (FB) or Feedback Mix
(MIX). The rotary control is used to set the Feedback Gain or Feedback Mix, as selected by
the push switch. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page 141 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
30
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
AUX/MATRIX SEND
1
AUX / MATRIX SEND
4
DISPLAY
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
5
2
BANK
3
ON
ON
ON
ON
AUX 1 / MATRIX 1
AUX 2 / MATRIX 2
AUX 3 / MATRIX 3
AUX 4 / MATRIX 4
AUX 5
AUX 6
AUX 7
AUX 8
AUX 9
AUX 10
AUX 11
AUX 12
A AUX/MATRIX SEND DISPLAY button
The pages selected by this button depends on the type of channel currently selected. If it’s
an Input Channel, it selects the Aux Send, Aux Send Pan, and Input Channel Aux View
pages. If it’s an Output Channel, it selects the Matrix Send, Matrix Send Pan, and Matrix
View pages.
B BANK button
This button is used to select Aux 1–4/Matrix 1–4, Aux 5–8, or Aux 9–12 for use with the
AUX/MATRIX LEVEL controls and [ON] buttons. When an Output Channel is selected,
the Aux 1–4/Matrix 1–4 bank is selected automatically and cannot be changed. See “Using
the SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND LEVEL Controls” on page 111 for more
information.
C Bank indicators
These indicators show which bank of Aux/Matrix Sends has been selected by the [BANK]
button. When an Output Channel is selected, the Aux 1–4/Matrix 1–4 bank is selected automatically and cannot be changed.
D LEVEL controls
These controls are used to set the levels of the Aux or Matrix Send currently selected by the
[BANK] button. If the currently selected channel is an Input Channel, they control Aux
Send levels. If it’s a Bus Out, Aux Send, or the Stereo Out, they control Matrix Send levels.
See “Setting Aux Send Levels” on page 111 and “Setting Matrix Send Levels” on page 121
for more information.
E ON buttons
These buttons are used to mute the Aux/Matrix Sends currently selected by the [BANK]
button. The button indicators of channels that are on light up. If the currently selected
channel is an Input Channel, they mute Aux Sends. If the currently selected channel is a Bus
Out, Aux Send, or the Stereo Out, they mute Matrix Sends. See “Muting Aux Sends
(ON/OFF)” on page 112 and “Muting Matrix Sends (ON/OFF)” on page 122 for more
information.
DYNAMICS
2
1
3
DYNAMICS
DISPLAY
GATE / COMP
THRESHOLD
RANGE
ATTACK
DECAY
HOLD
THRESHOLD
RATIO
ATTACK
RELEASE
GAIN
GATE
COMP
GATE ON
COMP ON
4 5
6
A DYNAMICS DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Gate Edit, Gate Library, Comp Edit, and
Comp Library. See “Gating Input Channels” on page 85 and “Compressing Channels” on
page 137 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
31
B GATE/COMP button
This button is used to set the rotary controls for either Gate or Compressor operation.
When an Output Channel is selected, Compressor is selected automatically and cannot be
changed. See “Gating Input Channels” on page 85 and “Compressing Channels” on
page 137 for more information.
C THRESHOLD, RANGE, ATTACK, DECAY, HOLD (THRESHOLD, RATIO, ATTACK,
RELEASE, GAIN) controls
When the GATE/COMP button is set to GATE, these controls set the Threshold, Range,
Attack, Decay, and Hold parameters of the currently selected Input Channel’s Gate. When
it’s set to COMP, they set the Threshold, Ratio, Attack, Release, and Gain parameters of the
currently selected channel’s Compressor. See “Gating Input Channels” on page 85 and
“Compressing Channels” on page 137 for more information.
D GATE ON button
This button is used to turn the currently selected Input Channel’s Gate on and off. Its indicator lights up when the Gate is on. See “Gating Input Channels” on page 85 for more information.
E COMP ON button
This button is used to turn the currently selected channel’s Compressor on and off. Its indicator lights up when the Compressor is on. See “Compressing Channels” on page 137 for
more information.
F GATE/COMP indicators
These indicators show whether the rotary controls are set to control either a Gate or a Compressor. The GATE indicator lights up when they’re set to control a Gate; the COMP indicator, when they’re set to control a Compressor. See “Gating Input Channels” on page 85
and “Compressing Channels” on page 137 for more information.
PAN/SURROUND
1
PAN / SURROUND
DISPLAY
L
R
ODD
EVEN
R
L
2
3
4
LINK
GRAB
EFFECT
5
6
7
8
A PAN/SURROUND DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the Input Channel Pan pages, the Surround Mode page, and
the Surround Edit pages. See “Panning Input Channels” on page 95 and “Using Surround
Pan” on page 97.
B L & R buttons
These buttons can be used to select horizontally or vertically partnered Input or Output
Channels. They can be used to select the left and right channels when a Matrix Send or the
Stereo Out is selected. For Input Channels, in Individual Pan mode, the [L] button indicator lights up when an odd/left channel is selected; the [R] button indicator, when an
even/right channel is selected. In Gang or Inverse Gang Pan mode, the button indicator of
the other channel in the pair flashes when its partner is selected.
C PAN display
This 10-segment display indicates the pan position of the currently selected Input Channel.
When pan is set to center, the center two segments light up. When a Matrix Send or the Stereo Out is selected, it displays the balance.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
32
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
D PAN control
This rotary control is used to pan the currently selected Input Channel. When a Matrix
Send or the Stereo Out is selected, it is used to set the balance. For Input Channels in Gang
or Inverse Gang Pan mode, horizontally or vertically paired Input Channels are panned
simultaneously. See “Panning Input Channels” on page 95, “Balancing the Stereo Out” on
page 106, and “Balancing Matrix Send Masters” on page 126.
E LINK button
This button, which is enabled only when a Surround mode other than Stereo is selected, is
used to link the PAN control and the Joystick so that either control can be used for normal
and surround panning. It’s a global setting that applies to all Input Channels. Its indicator
lights up when the PAN control and Joystick are linked. If the Joystick is set to control effects
(i.e., the [EFFECT] button indicator is lit), this button is disabled. See “Panning Input
Channels” on page 95 and “Using Surround Pan” on page 97 for more information.
F GRAB button
This button is used to turn on and off Joystick control for the currently selected Input Channel. Its indicator lights up when Grab is on. When Grab is on, the Joystick can be used to
control the currently selected Input Channel’s surround pan position. When turned off, the
Joystick does not control surround pan. In Stereo mode, it controls the currently-selected
Input Channel’s pan position. If the PAN control and the Joystick are linked (i.e., the
[LINK] button indicator is lit), Grab is turned off if the PAN control is adjusted. If the Joystick is set to control effects (i.e., the [EFFECT] button indicator is lit), this button is disabled.
G EFFECT button
This button is used to select the Joystick for parameter control of the Reverb 5.1 effect. Its
indicator lights up when Reverb 5.1 effect control is on, and the Joystick cannot be used for
surround panning. See “REVERB 5.1” on page 326 for more information.
H Joystick
This control can be used for surround panning, normal panning, or parameter control of
the Reverb 5.1 effect. When the [EFFECT] button indicator is lit, the Joystick controls the
Reverb 5.1 effect. See “REVERB 5.1” on page 326 for more information. When the
[EFFECT] button indicator is off and the [GRAB] button indicator is on, the Joystick controls surround panning of the currently selected Input Channel. When the [EFFECT] button and [GRAB] button indicators are both off, the Joystick can still be used for surround
panning if the Auto Grab preference is on. See “Using Surround Pan” on page 97 for more
information. When the [EFFECT] button indicator is off but the [GRAB] button and
[LINK] button indicators are both on, the Joystick can be used for normal panning in unison with the PAN control. See “Panning Input Channels” on page 95 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
33
EQUALIZER
2 3 4 5 67
1
EQUALIZER
LOW
DISPLAY
CHANNEL
LOW MID
FREQUENCY
FREQUENCY
FREQUENCY
Q
Q
HIGH
FREQUENCY
Q
Q
GAIN
GAIN
COPY
HIGH MID
ATT.
GAIN
GAIN
EQ ON
dB
dB
125
PASTE
Hz
1.00
Hz
kHz
kHz
dB
4.00
Hz
kHz
dB
10.0
Hz
kHz
A EQUALIZER DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Equalizer Edit, Equalizer Library, Input
Channel Attenuator/Shifter, and Output Attenuator.
B EQ ON button
This button is used to turn the EQ of the currently selected channel on and off. Its indicator
lights up when the EQ is on. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for more information.
C ATT control
This control is used to attenuate the pre-EQ signal of the currently selected channel. See
“Attenuating Signals” on page 130 for more information.
D FREQUENCY/Q indicators
These indicators show whether each FREQUENCY/Q control is set to control frequency or
Q. The FREQUENCY indicator lights up when it’s set to control frequency; the Q indicator,
when it’s set to control Q. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for more information.
E FREQUENCY/Q controls
These are rotary controls and push switches. The push switches are used to select either frequency or Q. The current setting is shown by the FREQUENCY/Q indicators. The rotary
controls are used to set the frequency or Q, as selected by the push switches. See “Using EQ”
on page 131 for more information.
F EQ GAIN controls
These controls are used to set the gain of each EQ band. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for
more information.
G EQ displays
Normally these displays show the frequency of each band. When the GAIN is adjusted, the
gain value is displayed. When the Q is adjusted, the Q value is displayed. If the gain or Q is
not adjusted for two seconds, the frequency value reappears. See “Using EQ” on page 131
for more information.
CHANNEL COPY
CHANNEL
1
COPY
2
PASTE
A COPY button
This button is used to copy channel settings to the Copy buffer. See “Copying Channel Settings” on page 155 for more information.
B PASTE button
This button is used to paste the settings in the Copy buffer to the specified channel. See
“Copying Channel Settings” on page 155 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
34
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
LAYER
LAYER
1
1 24
REMOTE 1
25 48
REMOTE 2
49 72
REMOTE 3
73 96
REMOTE 4
3
2
MASTER
A 1–24, 25–48, 49–72 & 73–96 buttons
These buttons select the Input Channel Layers, which determine which Input Channels are
controlled by the channel strips. The LAYER button indicator for the currently selected
Layer lights up. See “Selecting Layers” on page 58 for more information.
B MASTER button
This button selects the Master Layer, from which the channel strips control Bus Outs, Aux
Sends, and Matrix Sends. Its indicator lights up when the Master Layer is selected. See
“Selecting Layers” on page 58 for more information.
C REMOTE 1–4 buttons
These buttons select the Remote Layers, which can be used to control external devices,
including DAWs. See “About Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information. The
LAYER button indicator for the currently selected Remote Layer lights up. See “Selecting
Layers” on page 58 for more information.
STEREO
A AUTO button
STEREO
1
AUTO
2
SEL
3
ON
0
5
B SEL button
The Stereo Out [SEL] button is used exclusively to select the Stereo Out for editing
with the SELECTED CHANNEL section. Its indicator lights up when the Stereo
Out is selected. Each time it’s pressed, the selection toggles between the Stereo
Out’s left and right channels. See “Selecting Channels” on page 59 for more information. It can also be used to add and remove the Stereo Out to and from EQ,
Comp, Fader, and Mute groups.
C ON button
10
This button is used exclusively to mute the Stereo Out. Its indicator lights up when
the Stereo Out is on. See “Muting the Stereo Out (ON/OFF)” on page 105 for
more information.
15
4
This button is used exclusively to set Automix recording and playback for the Stereo Out. Its indicator lights up orange in Record-Ready mode, red while recording, and green during playback. See “Channel Strip [AUTO] Buttons” on page 199
for more information.
20
30
D Fader
40
50
60
70
STEREO
This 100 mm touch-sensitive motorized fader is used exclusively to adjust the level
of the Stereo Out. See “Setting the Stereo Out Level” on page 105 for more information. It can be grouped with other Output Channel faders for simultaneous
operation. See “Grouping Output Channel Faders” on page 146 for more information. It can also be used to select the Stereo Out, see “Auto Channel Select &
Touch Sense Select” on page 60, or to punch the Stereo Out in and out during
Automix recording. See “Punching In & Out Individual Parameters” on page 207
for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
35
TRACK ARMING
1
TRACK ARMING
DISPLAY
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
A
B
C
D
2
ALL CLEAR
MASTER
4
5
TRACK ARMING GROUP
3
A TRACK ARMING DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Track Arming Group, MTR Track Arming
Configuration, and Master Track Arming Configuration. See “Arming Machine Tracks” on
page 261 for more information.
B TRACK ARMING 1–24 buttons
These buttons are used to arm tracks on the target machine (DAW, MMC or P2). Their
indicators light up when tracks are armed. See “Arming Machine Tracks” on page 261 for
more information.
C TRACK ARMING GROUP A–D buttons
These buttons arm all tracks assigned to the corresponding track arming groups A, B, C,
and D. If all tracks in the currently-selected group are armed, the button indicator for the
corresponding group lights up. See “Arming Machine Tracks” on page 261 for more information.
D ALL CLEAR button
This button is used to clear all track arming on the target machine (DAW, MMC or P2). See
“Arming Machine Tracks” on page 261 for more information.
E MASTER button
This button is used to select Master or MTR machines for track arming. Its indicator lights
up when Master is selected, and is off when MTR is selected. See “About Machine Control
(MMC & P2)” on page 256 for more information.
SCENE MEMORY
1
SCENE MEMORY
DISPLAY
00
STORE
23 4
RECALL
5
6
A SCENE MEMORY DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Scene Memory, Input Channel Fade Time,
Output Fade Time, Recall Safe, and Scene Memory Sort. See “Scene Memories” on page 185
for more information.
B Scene memory display
This displays the number of the currently selected Scene memory. See “Scene Memories” on
page 185 for more information.
C Edit indicator
This indicates that the current mix settings no longer match those of the Scene that was
recalled last. See “Edit Buffer & Edit Indicator” on page 185 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
36
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
D STORE button
This button is used to store the current Scene to the selected Scene memory. See “Storing &
Recalling Scenes with the SCENE MEMORY Buttons” on page 187.
E Scene Up/Down buttons
These buttons are used to select Scene memories. Pressing the Scene Up [ ] button increments the selection; pressing the Scene Down [ ] button decrements the selection. Holding
down a button causes the selection to increment/decrement continuously. See “Storing &
Recalling Scenes with the SCENE MEMORY Buttons” on page 187.
F RECALL button
This button is used to recall the selected Scene memory. See “Storing & Recalling Scenes
with the SCENE MEMORY Buttons” on page 187.
AUTOMIX
2345678
1
AUTOMIX
DISPLAY
ENABLE
REC
SUSPEND
WRITE
ABORT/ AUTOUNDO
REC
TOUCH
LATCH
RETURN RELATIVE TOUCH
SENSE
READ
TRIM
OFF
AUX
ON
EQ
OVERWRITE
FADER
ON
PAN SURROUND AUX
9
The small text labels below the AUTOMIX buttons apply to the DAW Remote Layer. See
“About Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information.
A AUTOMIX DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Automix Main, Automix Memory, Input
Channel Fader Edit, Event Copy, and Event Edit. See “Automix” on page 193.
B ENABLE button
This button is used to enable and disable the Automix function. It works in unison with the
ENABLED/DISABLED button on the Automix Main page. See “Automix Main Page” on
page 194.
C REC button
This button is used with Automix recording. It works in unison with the REC button on the
Automix Main page. See “REC” on page 197 for more information.
D ABORT/UNDO button
This button is used to abort Automix recording or playback. It works in unison with the
ABORT button on the Automix Main page. See “ABORT” on page 197. When not recording
or playing an Automix, it’s used to undo the Automix, in unison with the UNDO button on
the Automix Main page. See “UNDO” on page 197 for more information.
E AUTO-REC button
This button is used to arm Automix Auto Recording function. It works in unison with the
AUTO REC button on the Automix Main page. See “AUTO REC” on page 197 for more
information.
F RETURN button
This button is used to select the Automix Edit Out mode. It works in unison with the EDIT
OUT RETURN buttons on the Automix Main page. See “EDIT OUT” on page 195 for more
information.
G RELATIVE button
This button is used to set the Automix Fader Edit mode. It works in unison with the FADER
EDIT buttons on the Automix Main page. See “FADER EDIT” on page 196 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
37
H TOUCH SENSE button
This button is used to turn on and off Fader Touch Sense for Automix recording. See “Fader
Edit Pages” on page 199 for more information.
I FADER, ON, PAN, SURROUND, AUX, AUX ON & EQ buttons
These buttons are used to select the type of parameters that are recorded in an Automix.
They work in unison with their counterparts on the Automix Main and Memory pages. See
“OVERWRITE” on page 196 for more information.
USER DEFINED KEYS
1
USER DEFINED KEYS
DISPLAY
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
2
A USER DEFINED KEYS DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the User Defined Key Assign page. See “Using the User Defined
Keys” on page 270 for more information.
B USER DEFINED KEYS 1–16 buttons
Up to 16 functions, from a list of over 214, can be assigned to these buttons. See “Using the
User Defined Keys” on page 270 for more information. These buttons have specific functions when the DAW Remote Layer is selected. See “About Remote Layers” on page 253 for
more information.
LOCATOR
23456
1
78
LOCATOR
LOCATE MEMORY
DISPLAY
9
1
2
AUDITION PRE
RETURN
TO ZERO
END
3
4
5
IN
OUT
POST
ONLINE
LOOP
QUICK
PUNCH
6
7
8
SET
MTR
ROLL REHEARSAL MASTER
BACK
JKLMNOPQ
A LOCATOR DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the Locate Memory and Machine Configuration pages. See
“Setting the Locate Memories, Pre-roll, Post-roll & Roll-back” on page 260 and “Configuring Machines” on page 256 respectively for more information.
B AUDITION button
This button is used to turn on and off the Audition function on the target machine (DAW,
MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up while the Audition function is on. See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
C PRE button
Pressing this button transmits a Locate command to the target machine (DAW, MMC or
P2) in order to locate the Pre-Roll point. Its indicator lights up momentarily when it’s
pressed. The Pre-Roll point is a predefined number of seconds before the specified In point.
See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
38
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
D IN button
Pressing this button transmits a Locate command to the target machine (DAW, MMC or
P2) in order to locate the In point. Its indicator lights up momentarily when it’s pressed. See
“Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
E OUT button
Pressing this button transmits a Locate command to the target machine (DAW, MMC or
P2) in order to locate the Out point. Its indicator lights up momentarily when it’s pressed.
See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
F POST button
Pressing this button transmits a Locate command to the target machine (DAW, MMC or
P2) in order to locate the Post-Roll point. Its indicator lights up momentarily when it’s
pressed. The Post-Roll point is a predefined number of seconds after the specified Out
point. See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
G SET button
This button is used when specifying the eight Locate points, In point, Out point, and Return
to Zero point. Its indicator lights up while it’s pressed. See “Using the Locator” on page 258
for more information.
H MTR button
This button is used to select the MTR machine for Locator, Transport, Scrub, and Shuttle
control (MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up when MTR is selected (the [MASTER] button
indicator goes off). See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
I LOCATE MEMORY 1–8 buttons
Pressing these buttons transmits Locate commands to the target machine (DAW, MMC or
P2) in order to locate the Locate memory points. Their indicators light up momentarily
when they’re pressed. See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
J RETURN TO ZERO button
Pressing this button transmits a Locate command to the target machine (DAW, MMC or
P2) in order to locate the Return to Zero point. Its indicator lights up momentarily when
it’s pressed. See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
K END button
Pressing this button transmits a Locate command when using the DAW Remote Layer in
order to locate the end of the session. Its indicator lights up momentarily when it’s pressed.
See “About Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information.
L ONLINE button
This button is used to turn the Chase function on and off on the target machine (DAW,
MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up while the Chase function is on. See “Using the Locator”
on page 258 for more information.
M LOOP button
This button is used to turn on and off Loop Playback on the target machine (DAW, MMC
or P2). Its indicator lights up when Loop Playback is on. See “Using the Locator” on page
258 for more information.
N QUICK PUNCH button
This button is used to turn on and off the Quick Punch function on the target machine
(DAW, MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up when Quick Punch is on. See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
O ROLL BACK button
This button is used to roll back (i.e., rewind) the target machine (MMC or P2) from the current position by a predefined amount. Its indicator lights up momentarily when it’s pressed.
See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
39
P REHEARSAL button
This button is used to turn on and off the Rehearsal function on the target machine (MMC
or P2). Its indicator lights up when Rehearsal is on. See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for
more information.
Q MASTER button
This button is used to select the Master machine for Locator, Transport, Scrub, and Shuttle
control. Its indicator lights up when Master is selected (the [MTR] button indicator goes
off). See “Using the Locator” on page 258 for more information.
Data Entry & Transport
1
2
3
4
5
REW
FF
STOP
PLAY
REC
9
DISPLAY HISTORY
6
BACK
FORWARD
7
DEC
INC
SHUTTLE
8
SCRUB
ENTER
J
K
L
A REW button
This button starts rewind on the target machine (DAW, MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up
while rewinding is in progress. See “Transport Buttons” on page 257.
B FF button
This button starts fast forward on the target machine (DAW, MMC or P2). Its indicator
lights up while fast forwarding is in progress. See “Transport Buttons” on page 257.
C STOP button
This button stops the target machine (DAW, MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up momentarily when it’s pressed. See “Transport Buttons” on page 257.
D PLAY button
This button starts playback on the target machine (DAW, MMC or P2). Its indicator lights
up while playback is in progress. See “Transport Buttons” on page 257.
E REC button
This button is used in conjunction with the [PLAY] button to start recording on the target
machine (DAW, MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up while recording is in progress. See
“Transport Buttons” on page 257.
F DISPLAY HISTORY BACK/FORWARD buttons
These buttons work like the back and forward buttons on a Web browser, allowing you to
return to recently displayed pages. See “Display History” on page 53 for more information.
G SHUTTLE button
This button is used to set the Parameter wheel to Shuttle mode for machine control (DAW,
MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up when Shuttle mode is on. See “Using Shuttle & Scrub”
on page 258 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
40
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
H SCRUB button
This button is used to set the Parameter wheel to Scrub mode for machine control (DAW,
MMC or P2). Its indicator lights up when Scrub mode is on. See “Using Shuttle & Scrub”
on page 258 for more information.
I DEC & INC buttons
These buttons are used to adjust parameter values. Pressing the [INC] button increases the
value of the currently selected parameter by one. Pressing the [DEC] decreases it. Pressing
and holding either button causes the parameter value to change continuously.
These buttons can also be used to set on/off-type parameters, such as EQ ON/OFF. When
such a parameter is selected, pressing the [DEC] button turns the function off, pressing the
[INC] button turns it on.
These buttons can also used to scroll through Scene and library lists.
J ENTER button
This button is used to select and finalize parameter settings, to set on/off-type parameters,
such as EQ ON/OFF, and to enter characters when titling Scenes, Effects, and so on. When
a Pan control is selected on a Pan display page, pressing this button resets the pan position
to center. For certain parameters, the [ENTER] button supports double clicking (i.e., two
quick presses).
K Parameter wheel
The Parameter wheel is used to edit parameter values, scroll through Scene and library lists,
and to position the cursor when titling Scenes, Effects, and so on. Its detented action gives
it a positive feel, allowing quick and accurate parameter editing. Turning it clockwise
increases parameter values; turning it counterclockwise decreases them. Turning it fast
allows quick parameter editing.
The Parameter wheel is also used with the Shuttle and Scroll functions. See “Using Shuttle
& Scrub” on page 258 for more information.
L Cursor buttons
These buttons are used to move the cursor around the display pages, selecting parameters
and options. The cursor appears as a flashing box, making it easy to see which parameter or
option is currently selected. Holding down a cursor button moves the cursor continuously
in the respective direction.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
41
Monitor, Phones & Talkback Section
6
0
10
TALKBACK LEVEL
5
4
PHONES
0
10
0
10
0
10
SMALL
TRIM
STUDIO
LEVEL
PHONES
LEVEL
1
2
3
A SMALL TRIM control
This control is used to set the level of the SMALL CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT. See
“Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
B STUDIO LEVEL control
This control is used to set the level of the STUDIO MONITOR OUT. See “Studio Monitoring” on page 159 for more information.
C PHONES LEVEL control
This control is used to set the level of the PHONES. See “Control Room Monitoring” on
page 158 for more information.
D PHONES jack
This stereo TRS phone jack outputs the
Control room signal for monitoring via a
pair of stereo headphones.
1/4" TRS phone plug
Tip (left)
Ring (right)
Sleeve (ground)
E Talkback mic
This built-in microphone is used for talkback. See “Using Talkback & Slate” on page 163 for
more information.
F TALKBACK LEVEL control
This control is used to set the level of the built-in talkback microphone. See “Using Talkback
& Slate” on page 163 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
42
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
MONITOR Section
MONITOR
The various subsections of the MONITOR section are explained below.
DISPLAY
STUDIO
CONTROL
ROOM
STEREO
AUX 11
AUX 12
STUDIO
1
MONITOR
DISPLAY
STUDIO
SOLO
2
4
SOLO CONTRAST
3
CONTROL
ROOM
STEREO
AUX 11
AUX 12
5
CLEAR
CONTROL ROOM
STEREO
2TR D1
2TR A1
2TR D2
2TR A2
2TR D3
STEREO
ASSIGN 1
ASSIGN 2
SURROUND
BUS
ASSIGN 1
ASSIGN 2
A MONITOR DISPLAY button
This button is used to select the following pages: Solo Setting, Control Room Setup, Talkback Setup, Surround Monitor, Surround Monitor Setup, Surround Monitor Patch, and
Surround Monitor Library. See “Configuring Solo” on page 143, “Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 “Using Talkback & Slate” on page 163, and “Surround Monitoring” on
page 160 respectively for more information.
B CONTROL ROOM button
This button selects the Control Room Monitor signal as the Studio Monitor signal source.
Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Studio Monitoring” on page 159 for
more information.
C STEREO button
SURROUND
MONITOR LEVEL
MONO
DIMMER
SMALL
0
10
CONTROL ROOM LEVEL
TALKBACK
SLATE
This button selects the Stereo Out signal as the Studio Monitor signal source. Its indicator
lights up when this source is selected. See “Studio Monitoring” on page 159 for more information.
D AUX 11 button
This button selects Aux Send #11 as the Studio Monitor signal source. Its indicator lights up
when this source is selected. See “Studio Monitoring” on page 159 for more information.
E AUX 12 button
This button selects Aux Send #12 as the Studio Monitor signal source. Its indicator lights up
when this source is selected. See “Studio Monitoring” on page 159 for more information.
TALKBACK
SOLO
1
2
SOLO
SOLO CONTRAST
3
CLEAR
A SOLO indicator
This indicator flashes when one or more Channels are soloed, indicating that the Solo function is active. See “Soloing Channels” on page 142 for more information.
B SOLO CONTRAST control
This control is used to set the level balance between soloed Input Channels and the currently selected CONTROL ROOM source. It has no effect on soloed Output Channels. See
“Soloing Channels” on page 142 for more information.
C CLEAR button
This button can be used to unsolo all soloed Channels. See “Soloing Channels” on page 142
for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface
43
CONTROL ROOM
A STEREO 2TR D1 button
CONTROL ROOM
STEREO
1
2
3
7
2TR D1
2TR A1
2TR D2
2TR A2
2TR D3
STEREO
ASSIGN 1
ASSIGN 2
4
5
6
8
SURROUND
9
This button selects the 2TR IN DIGITAL AES/EBU 1 as the Control Room Monitor signal source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Control
Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
B STEREO 2TR D2 button
This button selects the 2TR IN DIGITAL AES/EBU 2 as the Control Room Monitor
signal source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Control
Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
BUS
J
ASSIGN 1
ASSIGN 2
K
This button selects the 2TR IN DIGITAL COAXIAL 3 as the Control Room Monitor signal source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Control
Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
L
SURROUND
MONITOR LEVEL
M
N
MONO
DIMMER
O
SMALL
P
0
10
CONTROL ROOM LEVEL
C STEREO 2TR D3 button
D STEREO 2TR A1 button
This button selects the 2TR IN ANALOG 1 as the Control Room Monitor signal
source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Control Room
Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
E STEREO 2TR A2 button
This button selects the 2TR IN ANALOG 2 as the Control Room Monitor signal
source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Control Room
Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
F STEREO button
This button selects the Stereo Out as the Control Room Monitor signal source. Its indicator
lights up when this source is selected. See “Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for
more information.
G STEREO ASSIGN 1 button
This button is used to select the assigned Output Channel as the Control Room Monitor
signal source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Control Room Setup”
on page 159 for more information.
H STEREO ASSIGN 2 button
This button is used to select the assigned Output Channel as the Control Room Monitor
signal source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Control Room Setup”
on page 159 for more information.
I SURROUND BUS button
This button is used to select the Bus Outs as the Surround Monitor signal source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Surround Monitoring” on page 160 for
more information.
J SURROUND ASSIGN 1 button
This button is used to select the assigned Slot’s Inputs as the Surround Monitor signal
source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Surround Monitoring” on
page 160 for more information.
K SURROUND ASSIGN 2 button
This button is used to select the assigned Slot’s Inputs as the Surround Monitor signal
source. Its indicator lights up when this source is selected. See “Surround Monitoring” on
page 160 for more information.
L SURROUND MONITOR LEVEL control
This control is used to adjust the level of the Surround Monitor signals. See “Surround
Monitoring” on page 160 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
44
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
M MONO button
This button is used to switch the Control Room Monitor signal into mono. Its indicator
lights up when mono is selected. See “Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more
information.
N DIMMER button
This button is used to dim the Control Room Monitor and Surround Monitor signals. Its
indicator lights up when these signals are dimmed. See “Control Room Monitoring” on
page 158 for more information.
O SMALL button
This button is used to route the Control Room Monitor signal to either the SMALL or
LARGE CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUTs. When it’s off (indicator off), the signal is
routed through to the LARGE CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUTs, and when it’s on
(indicator on), the signal is routed through to the SMALL CONTROL ROOM MONITOR
OUTs. See “Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
P CONTROL ROOM LEVEL control
This control is used to adjust the level of the Control Room Monitor signal. See “Control
Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
TALKBACK
TALKBACK
1
SLATE
2
TALKBACK
A SLATE button
This button turns on the Slate function, which distributes the Talkback mic signal to all Bus
Outs, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out. See “Using Talkback & Slate” on page 163 for more
information.
B TALKBACK button
This button turns on the Talkback function, which distributes the Talkback mic signal to the
Studio Monitor Outs, any Slot and Omni Outputs specified on the Talkback Setup page. See
“Using Talkback & Slate” on page 163 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Power Section (p. 50)
OMNI OUT Section (p. 47)
Analog Master I/O Section (p. 46)
Digital I/O & Control Section (p. 48)
AD Input Section (p. 46)
SLOT Section (p. 50)
Rear Panel
45
Rear Panel
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
46
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
AD Input Section
A INPUT A & B (BAL) connectors
1
2
AD Inputs 1 through 24 feature balanced XLR-3-31-type connectors and balanced 1/4-inch phone jacks, both with a nominal input range of –60 dB to
+10 dB. Phantom powering (+48 V) is supplied to the XLR-type connectors, with
individual ON/OFF switches on each input. The phone jacks, which can also be
used with unbalanced phone plugs, have priority over the XLR-type connectors,
so when a phone plug is inserted, the XLR-type connector is disconnected. These
inputs can be patched individually to the Input Channels or Insert Ins. With their
high sensitivity and PAD switches, these inputs can handle a wide range of signals,
from condenser microphones to “hot” line levels. See “AD Input Section” on page
64 for more information.
1 (ground)
Male XLR plug
Tip (hot)
1/4" TRS phone plug
3 (cold)
Ring (cold)
Sleeve (ground)
2 (hot)
B INSERT IN & OUT +4dB (BAL) connectors
These balanced 1/4-inch TRS phone jacks are used to insert
external signal processors, etc., into AD Inputs 1 through
24. They are wired: sleeve–ground, ring–cold, tip–hot. The
nominal signal level of both jacks is +4 dB. Inserts can be
turned on and off individually by using the INSERT
ON/OFF switches. See “AD Input Section” on page 64 for
more information.
1/4" TRS phone plug
Tip (hot)
Ring (cold)
Sleeve (ground)
Analog Master I/O Section
1
2
3
6
4
5
7
A STUDIO MONITOR OUT +4 dB (BAL)
Tip (hot)
These balanced 1/4-inch TRS phone jacks, nominal output
1/4" TRS phone plug
Ring (cold)
level +4 dB, output the analog Studio Monitor signal for
monitoring in the actual studio. The source, which is
Sleeve (ground)
selected by using the STUDIO buttons in the MONITOR
section, can be Aux Send #11, Aux Send #12, the Stereo Out, or Control Room. The output
level is controlled by the STUDIO LEVEL control. See “Studio Monitoring” on page 159 for
more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
47
Rear Panel
B STEREO OUT +4 dB (BAL)
2 (hot)
These balanced XLR-3-32-type connectors, nomiFemale XLR plug
3 (cold)
nal output level +4 dB, output the analog Stereo
Out signal and are typically connected the stereo
1 (ground)
inputs of a 2-track recorder. They are wired pin
1–ground, pin 2–hot (+), and pin 3–cold (–). See “Stereo Out Connectors” on page 104.
C SMALL CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT +4 dB (BAL)
These balanced XLR-3-32-type connectors, nomiFemale XLR plug
nal output level +4 dB, output the analog Small
Control Room Monitor signal and are typically used
to feed the control room’s nearfield monitors. See
“Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
2 (hot)
3 (cold)
1 (ground)
D LARGE CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT +4 dB (BAL)
These balanced XLR-3-32-type connectors, nomiFemale XLR plug
nal output level +4 dB, output the analog Large
Control Room Monitor signal and are typically used
to feed the control room’s main monitors. See
“Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
2 (hot)
3 (cold)
1 (ground)
E 2TR IN ANALOG 1 +4 dB (BAL)
Tip (hot)
These balanced 1/4-inch TRS phone jacks, nominal input
1/4" TRS phone plug
Ring (cold)
level +4 dB, are typically used to connect the analog stereo
outputs of a 2-track recorder. Signals connected here can
Sleeve (ground)
be monitored via the CONTROL ROOM MONITOR
OUT by pressing the CONTROL ROOM [2TR A1] button. In addition, this input can be
patched to Input Channels or Insert Ins. See “2TR Analog INs” on page 65.
F STEREO OUT –10 dBV (UNBAL)
These unbalanced phono connectors, nominal output level
–10 dBV, output the analog Stereo Out signal and are typically
connected to the stereo inputs of a 2-track recorder. See “Stereo
Out Connectors” on page 104.
Phono plug
Tip (hot)
Sleeve (ground)
G 2TR IN ANALOG 2 –10 dBV (UNBAL)
Tip (hot)
Phono plug
These unbalanced phono connectors, nominal input level
–10 dBV, are typically used to connect the analog stereo outputs
Sleeve (ground)
of a 2-track recorder. Signals connected here can be monitored
via the CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUTs by pressing the
CONTROL ROOM [2TR A2] button. In addition, this input can be patched to Input Channels or Insert Ins. See “2TR Analog INs” on page 65.
OMNI OUT Section
1
A OMNI OUT +4dB (BAL)
These balanced 1/4-inch TRS phone jacks, nominal output
level +4 dB, provide eight analog outputs that can be
patched to the following: Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix
Sends, the Stereo Out, Insert Outs, Direct Outs, or Surround Monitor Channels. See “Omni Outs” on page 65.
1/4" TRS phone plug
Tip (hot)
Ring (cold)
Sleeve (ground)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
48
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
Digital I/O & Control Section
1
2
N
3
4
O
5
6
7 8 9
P
J
K
Q
L
M
R
A KEYBOARD connector
A PS/2 compatible keyboard can be connected here for quick entry of scene and library
titles and channel names. See “Using a Keyboard” on page 55 for more information.
B SMPTE TIME CODE INPUT connector
This balanced XLR-3-31-type connector is used to input SMPTE timecode for synchronizing the Automix function. See “Selecting the Timecode Source & Frame Rate” on page 201.
C MTC TIME CODE INPUT connector
This 5-pin DIN connector is used to input MTC for synchronizing the Automix function.
See “Selecting the Timecode Source & Frame Rate” on page 201.
D USB TO HOST port
This USB port is for MIDI communication between the DM2000 and a host computer with
a USB port. See “MIDI I/O” on page 215 for more information.
E SERIAL TO HOST port
This 8-pin mini DIN port is for MIDI communication between the DM2000 and a host
computer with a serial port. See “MIDI I/O” on page 215 for more information.
F WORD CLOCK OUT 2 connector
This BNC connector outputs a wordclock signal at half the clock rate of the DM2000 when
using 88.2 kHz or 96 kHz. See “Wordclock Connections” on page 66 for more information.
G WORD CLOCK OUT 1 connector
This BNC connector outputs a wordclock signal at the same clock rate as the DM2000. See
“Wordclock Connections” on page 66 for more information.
H WORD CLOCK 75Ω ON/OFF termination switch
This switch applies 75Ω termination to the WORD CLOCK IN. See “Terminating External
Wordclocks” on page 68 for more information.
I WORD CLOCK IN connector
This BNC connector is for connecting an external wordclock signal. See “Selecting the
Wordclock Source” on page 67 for more information.
J 2TR OUT DIGITAL COAXIAL 3
This phono connector outputs consumer format (IEC-60958) digital audio, and is typically
connected to the digital stereo input of a 2-track recorder. The following signals can be
patched to this output: Stereo Out, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, Direct Outs, Insert
Outs, and Control Room. The sampling rate of the digital audio output can be set independently of the DM2000 sampling rate by using the internal sampling rate converter. Dither
can be applied for digital audio transfer to lower-resolution systems. See “2TR Digital Outs”
on page 68 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Rear Panel
49
K 2TR OUT DIGITAL AES/EBU 1 & 2
These XLR-3-32-type connectors output AES/EBU format digital audio, and are typically
connected to the digital stereo inputs of 2-track recorders. The following signals can be
patched to these outputs: Stereo Out, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, Direct Outs,
Insert Outs, and Control Room. The sampling rate of the digital audio output can be set
independently of the DM2000 sampling rate by using the internal sampling rate converters.
Dither can be applied for digital audio transfer to lower-resolution systems. See “2TR Digital Outs” on page 68 for more information.
L 2TR IN DIGITAL COAXIAL 3
This phono connector accepts consumer format (IEC-60958) digital audio, and is typically
used to connect the digital stereo output of a 2-track recorder. Signals connected here can
be monitored via the CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT by pressing the CONTROL
ROOM [2TR D3] button. In addition, this input can be patched to Input Channels or
Insert Ins. Unsynchronized digital audio signals can be converted by the internal sampling
rate converters. See “2TR Digital Ins” on page 69 for more information.
M 2TR IN DIGITAL AES/EBU 1 & 2
These XLR-3-31-type connectors accept AES/EBU format digital audio, and are typically
used to connect the digital stereo outputs of 2-track recorders. Signals connected here can
be monitored via the CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT by pressing the CONTROL
ROOM [2TR D1] button or [2TR D2] button. In addition, these inputs can be patched
Input Channels or Insert Ins. Unsynchronized digital audio signals can be converted by the
internal sampling rate converters. See “2TR Digital Ins” on page 69 for more information.
N METER port
This 15-pin D-sub connector is for connecting the optional MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge.
O CONTROL port
This 25-pin D-sub connector provides access to the GPI (General Purpose Interface)
through which external equipment can be triggered when specified DM2000 faders or
USER DEFINE KEYS are operated. It can also be used to control a “RECORDING” light
outside of a studio, to trigger the Solo function of an 02R Digital Recording Console, or to
turn on Talkback from an external device. See “GPI (General Purpose Interface)” on page
264 for more information.
P REMOTE port
This 9-pin D-sub connector can be used to connect an optional Yamaha AD8HR/AD824
AD Converter, providing remote and recallable control of its head amp settings. Machines
that support the Sony P2 protocol can also be controlled from the DM2000 via this port. A
straight cable should be used to connect a P2 device; a reversed cable for an AD8HR/AD824.
See “Controlling AD8HR/AD824 A/D Converters” on page 267 and “About Machine Control (MMC & P2)” on page 256 for more information.
Q MIDI IN, OUT & THRU ports
These standard MIDI IN, OUT, and THRU ports are used to connect the DM2000 to other
MIDI equipment. Supported MIDI messages include Program Changes for Scene recall,
Control Changes and Parameter Changes for real-time parameter control, Bulk Dump for
data storage, MIDI Clock, MTC, and MMC. See “MIDI I/O” on page 215 for more information.
R CASCADE IN & OUT ports
These 64-pin connectors can be used to cascade up to four DM2000s to create a multiple-unit mixing system. The DM2000 can also be cascaded with an 02R Digital Recording
Console. See “Cascading Consoles” on page 74 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
50
Chapter 2—Control Surface & Rear Panel
Power Section
1
4
2
3
A POWER ON/OFF switch
This switch is used to turn on the power to the DM2000. See “Turning On & Off the
DM2000” on page 51 for more information.
B Grounding screw
For electrical safety reasons, and correct operation of the touch-sensitive faders, it’s important that the DM2000 is grounded properly. The supplied power cord has a three-pin plug,
and if the ground terminal of the AC outlet is grounded, then the unit will be grounded sufficiently through the power cord. If the AC outlet does not provide a suitable ground, this
screw must be connected to a suitable ground point. Grounding is also an effective method
for eliminating hum, interference, and other noise.
C AC IN connector
This connector is used to connect the DM2000 to an AC outlet via the supplied power cord.
See “Connecting the Power Cord” on page 51 for more information.
D Cooling fan
The cooling fan expels air out through this outlet. If the airflow is restricted, the DM2000
may overheat, so make sure this outlet is not blocked.
SLOT Section
1
A SLOT 1–6
These six slots are for use with optional mini YGDAI cards, which offer a variety of analog
and digital I/O options. See “Slot I/O” on page 70 for more information. Slot inputs can be
patched to Input Channels or Insert Ins. See “Input Patching” on page 77 for more information. The following signals can be patched to the Slot Outputs: Bus Outs, Aux Sends,
Matrix Sends, Stereo Out, Insert Outs, Direct Outs, and Surround Monitor Channels. See
“Output Patching” on page 79 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Operating Basics
51
3 Operating Basics
Connecting the Power Cord
Warning: Turn off all equipment connected to the DM2000 before making any power connections.
Connect the socket-end of the supplied power cord to the AC IN
on the rear panel of the DM2000. Connect the plug-end to a suitable AC wall outlet, one that conforms to the power supply
requirements stated on the DM2000’s rear panel.
Turning On & Off the DM2000
To prevent loud clicks and thumps in your speakers, turn on your
audio equipment in the following order (reverse this order when turning off)—sound sources, multitrack and master recorders, DM2000,
monitoring power amplifiers.
1
To turn on the DM2000, press the [POWER] switch.
The startup page appears for a while, and then the last selected display page appears.
2
To turn off the DM2000, press the [POWER] switch again.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
52
Chapter 3—Operating Basics
About the Display
All DM2000 mix parameters can be edited on the various display pages.
EDIT indicator
MIDI indicator
Current Scene
Sampling rate/Surround mode
Selected
DISPLAY
Page title
Page #
Selected channel
Channel name
Page area
Page tab scroll arrows
Page tabs
Current Scene: The number and title of the currently selected Scene memory are displayed here. See “Storing & Recalling Scenes with the SCENE MEMORY Buttons” on page
187 for more information. If the selected Scene is write-protected, a padlock icon appears.
See “Using the Scene Memory Page” on page 188 for more information.
MIDI indicator: This indicator appears when the DM2000 is receiving MIDI data via the
MIDI IN port, USB TO HOST port, or SERIAL TO HOST port.
EDIT indicator: This indicator appears when the current mix settings no longer match
those of the Scene that was recalled last. It works in unison with the Edit indicator dot on
the SCENE MEMORY display. See “Edit Buffer & Edit Indicator” on page 185 for more
information.
Selected DISPLAY: This indicates the currently selected display page group, for example,
AUX, EQ, or AUTOMIX. Display page groups are selected by using the [DISPLAY] buttons.
Sampling rate/Surround mode: This indicates the current sampling rate—44.1 kHz
(44k), 48 kHz (48k), 88.2 kHz (88k), or 96 kHz (96k), and surround mode—6.1, 5.1, 3-1,
and ST.
Selected channel: The Input or Output Channel currently selected by the [SEL] buttons
is indicated here. See “Selecting Channels” on page 59. The first four characters are the
Channel ID (e.g., CH1–CH96, BUS1–BUS8, AUX1–AUX9, AX10–AX12, MT1L–MT4R,
ST-L, ST-R. The second four, are the channel’s Short name. See “Naming Channels” on
page 156.
Channel name: Depending on the currently selected page, this is the Long name of
either the currently selected channel or the channel selected by the cursor buttons. On some
pages, the Aux Send pages, for example, it’s possible to edit Aux Send levels without having
to select each Input Channel. Instead, Input Channel Aux Sends can be selected by using the
cursor buttons. In this case, the name displayed here is different to the name displayed in
the upper-right corner of the display.
Page title: This is the title of the currently selected page.
Page #: Depending on the group of pages currently selected, page numbers are displayed
here. For example, although you can view only one Input Channel 1–24 Aux Send page at
a time, there are in fact 12 Input Channel 1–24 Aux Send pages, one for each of the 12 Aux
Sends. Page numbers are also displayed when the following page groups are selected: Matrix
Sends, Effects, and GEQ.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Selecting Display Pages
53
Page area: This area of the display is where the various display pages appear.
Page tabs: These tabs are used when selecting pages. Up to four tabs are visible at a time.
See “Selecting Display Pages” on page 53 for more information.
Page tab scroll arrows: These arrows indicate that there are more pages available. See
“Selecting Display Pages” on page 53 for more information.
Selecting Display Pages
•
•
•
•
Display pages are grouped by function, and each group of pages can be selected by
using the following [DISPLAY] buttons: MATRIX SELECT, AUX SELECT,
DISPLAY
ENCODER MODE, EFFECTS/PLUG-INS, ROUTING, PHASE/INSERT, DELAY,
AUX/MATRIX SEND, DYNAMICS, PAN/SURROUND, EQUALIZER, TRACK
ARMING, SCENE MEMORY, AUTOMIX, USER DEFINED KEYS, LOCATOR, MONITOR. Further page groups can be selected by using the DISPLAY ACCESS buttons.
The next page in the group can be selected by pressing the [DISPLAY] button.
Previous pages can be selected by pressing and holding down the [DISPLAY] button.
The first page in the group can be selected by double-clicking the [DISPLAY] button.
Pages whose tabs are currently displayed can be
selected by using the F1–F4 buttons.
F1
F2
F3
F4
If there are more pages available than the four whose
tabs are currently displayed, depending on whether they
are located to the left or right, either the left or right Tab
Tab scroll buttons
Scroll arrow appears. Pressing either the Left or Right
Tab Scroll button displays the tabs of these pages, which
can then be selected by using the F1–F4 buttons.
When parameters are divided among several pages, for example, the Input Channel Attenuators, which are divided among four pages, the page containing the parameter for the currently selected channel is selected automatically when channels on different Layers are
selected. For example, if the Input Channel 1–24 Attenuator page is currently selected, and
then you select, say, Input Channel #25 by using the LAYER [25–48] button and [SEL] button #1, the Input Channel 25–48 Attenuator page is selected automatically.
The currently selected page in a group, and the parameter selected on that page, are remembered when you select another group of pages, so when you return to that group, by pressing its [DISPLAY] button, that page is displayed with the same parameter selected.
The Auto Display preferences can be set so that certain pages appear automatically when a
corresponding control is adjusted. For example, if the “Auto EQUALIZER Display” preference is on, the EQ page appears automatically when a SELECTED CHANNEL EQUALIZER control is operated. See page 274 for information on the Auto Display preferences.
Tab Scroll arrows
Display History
The Display History function works like the history function on a
Web browser, and allows you to return quickly to up to eight recently
BACK
FORWARD
displayed pages. Each time you view a page for more than five seconds, it’s added to the Display History buffer.
Pressing the DISPLAY HISTORY [BACK] button selects the previous page in the buffer.
Pressing the DISPLAY HISTORY [FORWARD] button selects the next page in the buffer. If
there are no pages in the buffer, nothing happens when these buttons are pressed.
You can scroll forwards or backwards through all the pages in the buffer by pressing and
holding the [BACK] or [FORWARD] button respectively. Scrolling like this continuously
cycles through all the pages in the buffer. You can clear the Display History buffer by pressing the [BACK] and [FORWARD] buttons simultaneously.
DISPLAY HISTORY
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
54
Chapter 3—Operating Basics
Display Page Controls
Operation of the various buttons, rotary controls, and faders that appear on the
display pages is straightforward. The only items that require a special mention
are the parameter boxes, such as the GEQ Insert parameter box shown here.
Operation of these boxes consists of two steps. First you select a value, typically
by using the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons. Second you confirm your
selection, while the value is flashing, by pressing the [ENTER] button. If you
select another parameter while the value is still flashing, it remains unchanged.
Parameter Windows
When a rotary control in the SELECTED CHANNEL section is operated, if the
corresponding parameter does not appear on the currently selected page, a
parameter window like the one shown here is displayed while the control is
adjusted. If the control is not adjusted for awhile, the window closes automatically. If the Auto Display preference for the adjusted parameter is on, the page containing
that parameter appears instead of this parameter window.
Confirmation Messages
For certain functions, the DM2000 prompts you for
confirmation before executing them, as shown here.
Press YES to execute the function, or press NO to cancel. If no action is taken for awhile, the confirmation
window closes automatically and the function is not
executed.
Title Edit Window
The Title Edit window is used to enter titles for Scene and library memories, automixes, and
so on. Depending on the item being titled, the number of characters that can be entered is
either 4, 12, or 16. The following screen shots show the available characters. The one on the
left shows uppercase characters and various punctuation marks. That on the right, lowercase characters and numbers.
Use the cursor buttons to select characters, and the [ENTER] button to enter them into the
title. The cursor moves to the right automatically as each character is entered. The Parameter wheel or the arrow buttons can be used to move the cursor within the title.
Use the SHIFT LOCK button to select uppercase and lowercase characters, and use the SPC
button to enter a space. To insert a space at the cursor position and move subsequent characters to the right, press the INS button. To delete the character at the cursor position, press
the DEL button.
When you’ve finished, press the OK button to enter the title, or press CANCEL to cancel
title entry.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Using a Keyboard
55
Using a Keyboard
A PS/2 compatible keyboard can be connected to the KEYBOARD port and used
for quick title entry while the Title Edit window is displayed. Note that only 101
and 104-key U.S. keyboards are supported.
Characters, including letters, numbers, and punctuation marks, supported by the
DM2000 can be entered. Characters appear directly in the Title Edit window, the
same as when they are entered on the DM2000. The following table shows how
other keys correspond to Title Edit window functions.
Key
Title Edit Window function
Description
ESC
CANCEL
RETURN/ENTER
OK
Cancels title entry
Enters the specified title
CAPS LOCK
SHIFT LOCK
Toggles between uppercase and lowercase
SHIFT
—
Switches to uppercase characters
Backspace
—
Deletes the character to the left
Cursor (left/right)
Left/right arrow buttons
Moves the cursor within the title
INSERT
INS
Toggles between insert and overwrite modes
DELETE
DEL
Deletes the selected character
SPACE bar
SPACE
Inserts a space at the current position
Channel Strip Displays
The fluorescent channel strip displays show information regarding the
channel strips, as described below.
You can adjust their brightness by using the Channel Strip Display
Brightness preference on page 277.
CH01
Selected Channel
The border of the currently selected channel’s channel strip display lights
up like this.
Fader Touch Sense
When fader knobs are touched, the corresponding Touch Sense indicators light up like this.
Routing Indicators
These indicators show to which Output Channels an Input Channel is
being routed: 1 through 8 being the Bus Outs, “S” being the Stereo Out,
and “D,” the Direct Out.
EQ, Insert, Delay, Comp & Gate Indicators
These indicators show whether a channel’s EQ, Insert, Delay, Comp, and
Gate functions are on or off.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
56
Chapter 3—Operating Basics
Encoder Displays
Operation of the Encoder displays depends on the parameter assigned to the
Encoders, as follows.
Pan Mode, Surround L/R, and Surround F/R position
(
Hard left
indicates center position)
Other position
Center
indicates at center)
Hard right
Nominal
indicates at nominal)
Maximum
(
Nominal
indicates at nominal)
Maximum
(
Nominal
indicates at nominal)
Maximum
(
(
Aux/Mtrx Mode and Alt Layer
(
Minimum (–∞)
indicates nominal position)
Other position
Surr LFE Level
(
Minimum (–96 dB)
indicates nominal position)
Other position
Attenuator Parameter
(
Minimum (–96 dB)
indicates nominal position)
Other position
Delay Feedback Gain, Delay Mix & EQ Gain Parameters
(
Negative value
indicates 0%, ±0 dB)
(
0%, ±0 dB
indicates at 0%, ±0 dB)
Positive value
On/Off & Pre/Post Parameters
EQ On/Off, Phase On/Off, Insert On/Off, EQ Type, Gate On/Off, Comp On/Off, Aux Send
Pre/Post.
On/Pre
Off/Post
Scene Fade Time Parameters
Minimum
(Off when Fade Time is minimum)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Other value
Maximum
Channel Strip Displays
57
Other Parameters
Delay Time, EQ Q, EQ Frequency, Comp Threshold, Comp Ratio, Comp Attack, Comp
Release, Comp Out Gain, Comp Knee, Gate Threshold, Gate Range, Gate Attack, Gate
Hold, Gate Decay, Compander Width, HA Input Gain, HA Insert In Gain.
Minimum
Other position
Other position
Maximum
No Assign
When the Encoders are assigned to the No Assign, Input Patch, Insert In Patch, Insert Out
Patch, Direct Out, or Surround Pan Wheel parameter, the Encoder displays are inactive.
Channel Names
The channel strip displays also display the names or IDs of all the channels on the currently
selected Layer. Each Input and Output Channel has a fixed Channel ID and Short and Long
names that you can edit. See “Naming Channels” on page 156.
You can specify whether Short names or Channel IDs are displayed in
the preferences. You can also choose whether Port names or Port IDs are
displayed. See “Preferences 2” on page 276 for more information.
CH01
1
To display a channel’s Long name, press and hold its [SEL] button.
After about one second, the channel’s Short name, Long name, and Channel ID are displayed, as shown below.
CH01
ACGT
ACOU STIC GUIT AR
Channel ID
Short Name
Long Name
All other items in the displays are turned off while the [SEL] button is held down.
2
Release the [SEL] button when you’ve finished.
The channel strip displays return to normal.
Channel Faders and Encoders
When you operate the channel faders, the corresponding levels are indicated in four digits
on the channel strip displays. The displays return to the previous indication one second
after you finish moving the faders.
If Pan, Aux Send, Matrix Send, or Alt Layer is assigned to the Encoders, four-digit parameter
values appear on the channel strip displays when you operate the Encoders. The displays
return to the previous indication one second after you finish operating the Encoders.
Input Patch, Insert In Patch, Insert Out Patch & Direct Out
When the Input Patch, Insert In Patch, Insert Out Patch, or Direct Out parameter is
assigned to the Encoders, the Encoder displays show Port IDs. See “Patching with the
Encoders” on page 83 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
58
Chapter 3—Operating Basics
Selecting Layers
Input and Output Channels are arranged into Layers, as illustrated below. There are nine
Layers altogether: four Input Channel Layers, one Master Layer (or Output Layer), and four
Remote Layers.
Input Channels [1–24]
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
[REMOTE 3]
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
[REMOTE 4]
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Input Channels [25–48]
Input Channels [49–72]
Input Channels [73–96]
Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends [MASTER]
[REMOTE 1]
[REMOTE 2]
To select Input and Output Channels for editing with the channel
strip controls, you use the LAYER buttons to select a Layer.
The LAYER button indicator for the currently selected Layer lights
up, and the channel strip displays show the Short names/Channel
IDs of the channels on the selected Layer.
The currently selected Layer determines the function of the channel strip Encoders, [AUTO] buttons, [SEL] buttons, [SOLO] buttons, [ON] buttons, channel strip displays, and faders. For
example, when Layer 1–24 is selected, [SEL] button #1 controls
Input Channel #1. When Layer 25–48 is selected, it controls Input
Channel #25. And when the Master Layer is selected, it controls
Bus Out #1.
The following table shows which Input and Output Channels are
controlled by the channel strips for each Layer.
Layers
1–8
9–16
17–20
1–24
Input Channels 1–24
Input Channels 25–48
49–72
Input Channels 49–72
73–96
Input Channels 73–96
MASTER
1 24
REMOTE 1
25 48
REMOTE 2
49 72
REMOTE 3
73 96
REMOTE 4
MASTER
Channel Strips
25–48
REMOTE
1–4
LAYER
Bus Out masters 1–8
Aux Send masters 1–12
21–24
Matrix Send masters 1–4
Operation depends on the selected target.
See “About Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information.
The exact function of each channel strip fader and Encoder also depends on the currently
selected Fader mode and Encoder mode respectively. See “Selecting Fader Modes” on
page 60 and “Selecting Encoder Modes” on page 61 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Selecting Channels
59
Selecting Channels
To select Input and Output Channels for editing with the SELECTED CHANNEL controls,
you use the LAYER buttons to select a Layer, and the [SEL] buttons to select a channel on
that Layer.
1
Select a Layer, as explained on page 58.
2
Use the [SEL] buttons to select an Input or Output Channel.
The [SEL] button indicator for the currently selected channel lights up, and the
SEL
border of its channel strip display lights up (see page 55). In addition, the Channel’s ID and Short name appear in the upper right corner of the display (see page 52).
The exact channel selected by each [SEL] button depends on the currently selected Layer.
For example, when Layer 1–24 is selected, [SEL] button #1 selects Input Channel #1. When
Layer 25–48 is selected, it selects Input Channel #25. And when the Master Layer is selected,
it selects Bus Out #1, as shown in the following table.
Layer
[SEL] Button
1–8
9–16
17–20
1–24
Input Channels 1–24
25–48
Input Channels 25–48
49–72
Input Channels 49–72
73–96
Input Channels 73–96
MASTER
REMOTE
1–4
Bus Outs 1–8
Aux Sends 1–12
21–24
Matrix Sends 1–41
Operation depends on the selected target.
See “About Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information.
1. Each time a [SEL] button is pressed, the selection toggles between the Matrix Send’s left and right
channels.
For paired Input or Output channels, the channel whose [SEL] button you press is selected,
and its indicator lights up. The [SEL] button indicator of the other channel flashes.
Vertical and horizontal Input and Output channel partners can also be selected by using the
SELECTED CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND [L] and [R] buttons, which can also be used to
select left and right channels when a Matrix Send or the Stereo Out is selected.
If the currently displayed page contains a relevant parameter, when a channel’s [SEL] button is pressed, the cursor moves to that parameter automatically. If the currently displayed
page contains no such parameter, the page that does contain such a parameter is selected
automatically. For example, if a Delay page for the Output Channels is selected when an
Input Channel [SEL] button is pressed, the Delay page showing the relevant Input Channel
Delay parameter is selected automatically.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
60
Chapter 3—Operating Basics
Stereo Out [SEL] Button
The Stereo Out [SEL] button is used exclusively to select the Stereo Out for editing with the
SELECTED CHANNEL controls. Its indicator lights up when the Stereo Out is selected.
Each time it’s pressed, the selection toggles between the Stereo Out’s left and right channels.
The SELECTED CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND [L] and [R] buttons can also be used to
select the left and right channels.
If the currently displayed page contains a Stereo Out parameter, that parameter is selected
automatically when the Stereo Out [SEL] button is pressed. If the currently selected page
contain no such parameter, the page that does contain such a parameter is selected automatically. For example, if a Delay page for the Input Channels is currently selected when the
Stereo Out [SEL] button is pressed, the Delay page showing the Stereo Out Delay parameter
is selected automatically.
Auto Channel Select & Touch Sense Select
While the Auto Channel Select preference is on (see page 275), channels can be selected by
moving the corresponding fader or Encoder, or by turning on the corresponding [AUTO],
[SOLO], or [ON] button. Note that you can use the [AUTO] buttons to select channels only
during Automix recording or in Automix record ready mode.
While the Fader Touch Sense SELECT preference is on (see page 276), channels can be
selected simply by touching the fader knobs.
Selecting Fader Modes
The exact function of each fader depends on the selected Layer and Fader mode.
1
Select a Layer, as explained on page 58.
2
Use the FADER MODE buttons to select a Fader mode.
FADER MODE
[FADER]: Channel faders control Input Channel levels or Output Channel master levels, depending on the selected Layer.
FADER AUX/ MTRX
[AUX/MTRX]: Channel faders control Aux or Matrix Send levels,
depending on the selected Layer.
The indicator of the currently selected FADER MODE button lights up.
The following table shows the channel fader functions for each Layer and Fader mode.
Layer
1–24
25–48
49–72
73–96
Fader
Mode
Fader
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
CH 25–48: Aux Send level
Fader
CH 49–72: level
Aux/Mtrx
CH 49–72: Aux Send level
Fader
CH 73–96 level
Aux/Mtrx
Fader
Aux/Mtrx
21–24
CH 25–48: level
Aux/Mtrx
Aux/Mtrx
17–20
CH 1–24: Aux Send level
Fader
Master
9–16
CH 1–24: level
Aux/Mtrx
Fader
Remote
1–4
Fader
1–8
CH 73–96: Aux Send level
Bus Out 1–8:
master level
Aux Send 1–12: master level
Matrix Send 1–4:
master level
Bus Out 1–8:
Matrix Send level
Aux Send 1–12: Matrix Send level
No operation: Faders fixed at –∞
Operation depends on the selected target.
See “About Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information.
61
Selecting Encoder Modes
Selecting Encoder Modes
The exact function of each Encoder depends on the selected Layer and Encoder
mode. There are two preset Encoder modes, Pan and Aux/Mtrx, and four assignable modes, for which you can choose from over 40 parameters.
1
Select a Layer, as explained in page 58.
2
Use the ENCODER MODE buttons to select
ENCODER MODE
an Encoder mode.
DISPLAY
[PAN]: Encoders function as Pan controls. When
PAN
AUX/ MTRX
you press the Encoder push-switches, the current
Pan positions appear on the channel strip displays.
ASSIGN 1 ASSIGN 2 ASSIGN 3 ASSIGN 4
[AUX/MTRX]: Encoders control Aux or Matrix
Send levels, depending on the selected Layer. When
you press the Encoder push-switches, the currently-selected Aux or Matrix Send levels
appear on the channel strip displays.
[ASSIGN 1–4]: Encoders control the parameters assigned to the ASSIGN buttons. See
“Assigning Parameters to the ENCODER MODE Assign Buttons” on page 62 for more
information.
The indicator of the currently selected ENCODER MODE button lights up.
The following table shows the exact Encoder functions for each Layer and Encoder mode.
Layer
Encoder
Mode
1–8
Master
Remote
1–4
9–16
17–20
Assign 1–4
CH 1–24: assigned parameter1
INSERT
21–24
CH 25–48: pan
Aux/Mtrx
CH 25–48: Aux Send level
Assign 1–4
CH 25–48: assigned parameter1
CH 49–72: pan
Aux/Mtrx
CH 49–72: Aux Send level
Assign 1–4
CH 49–72: assigned parameter1
CH 73–96 pan
Aux/Mtrx
CH 73–96: Aux Send level
Assign 1–4
CH 73–96: assigned parameter1
Pan
SEND ASSIGN
CH 1–24: pan
Pan
73–96
OUTPUT
CH 1–24: Aux Send level
Pan
49–72
INPUT
Aux/Mtrx
Pan
25–48
SEND LEVEL
Encoder
Pan
1–24
PAN
No operation
No operation
Matrix 1–4: Balance
Aux/Mtrx
Bus Out 1–8:
Matrix Send level
Aux Send 1–12:
Matrix Send level
No operation
Assign 1–4
Bus Out 1–8:
assigned parameter
Aux Send 1–12:
assigned parameter
Matrix Send 1–4:
assigned parameter
Pan
Aux/Mtrx
Operation depends on the selected target.
See “About Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information.
Assign 1–4
1. When Alt Layer is assigned, the Encoders enable you to control a parameter that is assigned to the corresponding channel fader in the partner layer. (A partner layer would be the layer of channels 25-48
if the layer of channels 1-24 is currently selected, or the layer of channels 73-96 if the layer of channels
49-72 is currently selected.)
The values of the parameters being controlled by the Encoders are displayed graphically by
the channel strip displays. See “Channel Strip Displays” on page 55 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
62
Chapter 3—Operating Basics
Assigning Parameters to the ENCODER MODE Assign Buttons
Up to four parameters can be assigned to the four ENCODER MODE ASSIGN buttons.
Initially, the following parameters are assigned to the ASSIGN buttons:
[ASSIGN 1]: Input Patch
[ASSIGN 2]: Direct Out
[ASSIGN 3]: Surr. LFE Level
[ASSIGN 4]: Surr. Pan Wheel
1
Use the ENCODER MODE [DISPLAY] button to select the Encoder Mode
Assign page.
The names of the parameters currently assigned to each ASSIGN button are displayed in the
left-hand box. The parameter currently assigned to the selected ASSIGN button appears
highlighted in the right-hand box.
2
Press an ASSIGN button, or use the Up/Down cursor buttons, to select an
ASSIGN button.
3
Use the Parameter wheel, or the INC/DEC buttons to select a parameter.
A parameter is selected when it appears inside the dotted box.
See the “Assignable Encoder Mode Parameter List” on page 63 for a complete list of assignable parameters.
4
Press the [ENTER] button to assign your choice.
Once assigned, the selected parameter appears highlighted in the right-hand box.
When channels that do not feature the currently assigned parameter are selected, the
Encoders are inactive. For example, if the assigned Encoder parameter is “Phase,” and the
Master Layer is selected, the Encoders are inactive, because the Bus Outs, Aux Sends, and
Matrix Sends do not feature Phase parameters.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Parameters to the ENCODER MODE Assign Buttons
63
Assignable Encoder Mode Parameter List
#
Parameter
Encoder Operation
Push Switch Operation
—
—
1
No Assign
2
Attenuator
Attenuator
3
Input Patch
Input Channel patch
Confirm or execute patch selection.
4
Insert In Patch
Insert In patch
Confirm or execute patch selection.
5
Insert Out Patch
Insert Out patch
Confirm or execute patch selection.
6
Direct Out
Direct Out patch
Confirm or execute patch selection.
7
Phase
Phase: normal/reverse
—
8
Insert On
Insert on/off
—
9
Aux pre/post
Aux pre/post
—
10
Delay On
Delay on/off
—
11
Delay Time
Delay Time
—
12
Delay FB.Gain
Delay FB.Gain
—
13
Delay Mix
Delay Mix
—
14
EQ On
EQ on/off
—
15
EQ Type
EQ Type
—
16
EQ Low Q
EQ Low Q
—
17
EQ Low F
EQ Low Frequency
—
18
EQ Low G
EQ Low Gain
—
19
EQ Low-Mid Q
EQ Low-Mid Q
—
20
EQ Low-Mid F
EQ Low-Mid Frequency
—
21
EQ Low-Mid G
EQ Low-Mid Gain
—
22
EQ High-Mid Q
EQ High-Mid Q
—
23
EQ High-Mid F
EQ High-Mid Frequency
—
24
EQ High-Mid G
EQ High-Mid Gain
—
25
EQ High Q
EQ High Q
—
26
EQ High F
EQ High Frequency
—
27
EQ High G
EQ High Gain
—
28
Gate On
Gate on/off
—
29
Gate Threshold
Gate Threshold
—
30
Gate Range
Gate Range
—
31
Gate Attack
Gate Attack
—
32
Gate Decay
Gate Decay
—
33
Gate Hold
Gate Hold
—
34
Comp On
Comp on/off
—
35
Comp Threshold
Comp Threshold
—
36
Comp Ratio
Comp Ratio
—
37
Comp Attack
Comp Attack
—
38
Comp Release
Comp Release
—
39
Comp Out Gain
Comp Out Gain
—
40
Comp Knee/Width
Comp Knee/Width
—
41
Surr L/R Pan
Surround L/R Pan
—
42
Surr F/R Pan
Surround F/R Pan
—
43
Surr Front DIV
Surround Front DIV
—
44
Surr Rear DIV
Surround Rear DIV
—
45
Surr. LFE Level
Surround LFE level
—
46
Surr. Pan Wheel
Surround Pan Wheel
—
47
Scene Fade Time
Scene Fade Time
—
48
Alt Layer
Alt Layer
49
HA Gain
HA Gain
—
50
Ins HA Gain
HA Insert Gain
—
—
Indicate values on the channel strip displays.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
64
Chapter 4—Analog I/O & the AD Input Section
4 Analog I/O & the AD Input Section
AD Input Section
The DM2000 features 24 AD Inputs for connecting microphone and line-level sources.
AD Inputs can be patched to Input Channels or Input Channel Insert Ins (see page 77).
They can also be patched to Output Channel Insert Ins (see page 80).
AD Input Connectors
AD Inputs feature balanced XLR-3-31-type connectors and balanced 1/4-inch
phone jacks, both with a nominal input range of –60 dB to +10 dB. The phone
jacks, which can also be used with unbalanced phone plugs, have priority over
the XLR-type connectors, so when a phone plug is inserted, the XLR-type connector is disconnected.
Phantom Power
+ 48V
ON
OFF
AD Inputs feature switchable +48 V phantom powering for use with condenser-type microphones and direct boxes. Phantom power is supplied to the
balanced XLR-3-31-type connector, and can be switched individually for each
AD Input.
Caution:
• If you don’t need phantom power, be sure to turn the switch off.
• Before you turn phantom power on, make sure that no devices other than phantom-powered devices, such as a condenser microphone, are connected. Otherwise, you risk damaging the devices.
• Do not connect or disconnect a device while phantom power is applied. Doing so can damage the connected device and/or the unit itself.
• To protect your speaker system, leave the power amps (powered speakers) turned off when
switching the phantom power on/off. We also recommend that you set all output level faders to the minimum position. Otherwise, high-volume output may damage your hearing
or equipment.
Pad
PAD
26dB
AD Inputs feature pad switches, which attenuate input signals by 26 dB, allowing the Head Amps to work with high-level signals. Pad is typically used to
attenuate “hot” signals from bass or snare drum microphones, or “hot”
line-level signals.
Gain
-60
-16
GAIN
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
AD Inputs feature detented rotary gain controls with an input sensitivity of –16
dB to –60 dB, or +10 dB to –34 dB when the Pad is on. The GAIN controls
adjust the gain of the Head Amps, allowing you to optimize input signal levels
for the best signal-to-noise performance. Ideally, the GAIN control should be
set so that the signal level is relatively high, and it’s okay for the PEAK indicator
to light up occasionally. If the PEAK indicator lights up often, however, you
should back off the GAIN control a little, otherwise, signal clipping may occur.
If the GAIN is set too low, the signal-to-noise performance will suffer.
Stereo Out
65
PEAK & SIGNAL Indicators
These indicators are used in conjunction with the GAIN controls and PAD
switches to optimize signal levels. The SIGNAL indicator lights up when the
input signal level is 20 dB below the rated level. The PEAK indicator lights up
when the input signal level is 3 dB below clipping.
PEAK
SIGNAL
AD Inserts
AD Inputs feature switchable analog inserts with individual balanced 1/4-inch
TRS phone jacks for the send and return signals. They are wired:
sleeve–ground, ring–cold, tip–hot. The rated level for both connectors is +4 dB.
OFF
ON
INSERT
AD Input inserts can be turned on and off individually by using the INSERT
ON/OFF switches, so you don’t have to disconnect your external equipment in
order to remove an insert.
Stereo Out
See page 104 for information on the Stereo Out outputs.
Control Room Monitor Outs
See page 158 for information on the Control Room Monitor outputs.
Studio Monitor Outs
See page 159 for information on the Studio Monitor outputs.
Omni Outs
The DM2000 features assignable Omni Outs on balanced 1/4-inch TRS phone jacks. Omni
Outs can be patched to Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, the Stereo Out, Input or Output
Channel Insert Outs, or Surround Monitor Channels (see page 80). In addition, Input
Channel Direct Outs can be patched to the Omni Outs (see page 81).
The maximum output level of each OMNI OUT can be set internally to either +4 dB
(–10 dB operating level) or +18 dB (+4 dB operating level). Contact your dealer for further
details.
2TR Analog INs
The DM2000 features two sets of 2-track analog inputs: 2TR IN ANALOG 1
+4 dB (BAL) uses balanced 1/4-inch TRS phone jacks. 2TR IN ANALOG 2
–10 dBV (UNBAL) uses unbalanced phono jacks. These inputs can be monitored via the Control Room monitors by pressing the CONTROL ROOM
[2TR A1] and [2TR A2] buttons. They can be patched to Input Channels (see
page 77), Input Channel Insert Ins (see page 78), or Output Channel Insert Ins
(see page 80).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
66
Chapter 5—Digital I/O & Cascading
5 Digital I/O & Cascading
Wordclocks
Unlike analog audio equipment, digital audio equipment must be synchronized when digital audio signals are transferred from one device to another, otherwise, signals may not be
received correctly and audible noise, glitches, or clicks may occur. Synchronization is
achieved using what’s called a wordclock, which is a clock signal for synchronizing all the
digital audio signals in a system. Note that wordclocks are not the same as SMPTE/EBU or
MTC timecode, which is typically used to synchronize tape machines, MIDI sequencers,
and so on. Wordclock synchronization refers to the synchronization of the digital audio
processing circuits inside each digital audio device.
In a typical digital audio system, one device operates as the wordclock master, and the other
devices operate as wordclock slaves, synchronizing to the wordclock master. Wordclock signals can be distributed via dedicated cables, typically BNC cables, or derived from digital
audio connections, including AES/EBU, ADAT, and Tascam formats.
If you’re connecting to the DM2000 using only analog inputs and outputs, no special wordclock settings are required, and the DM2000 can be set to use its own internally generated
wordclock. If you’re connecting other equipment digitally, however, you must decide which
device to use as the wordclock master and which devices to use as slaves.
The DM2000 can be used as the wordclock master running at either 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz,
88.2 kHz, or 96 kHz, or slaved to an external wordclock source. External wordclock signals
can be received via the Slot Inputs, 2TR Digital Inputs, the CASCADE IN port, or the dedicated BNC WORD CLOCK IN connector.
In a system where all devices share a common wordclock, it’s important that all devices be
turned on even if they’re not being used. Turn on the wordclock master first, and then the
slaves. When shutting down the system, turn off the slaves first, and then the master. Before
use, make sure that the wordclock slaves are correctly locked to the wordclock master. Most
devices have front panel indicators to indicate this. Refer to the relevant owner’s manuals
for more information.
Wordclock Connections
The DM2000 features one BNC wordclock input and two BNC
wordclock outputs. External wordclock signals can be connected
to the WORD CLOCK IN connector, and terminated by using the
75Ω ON/OFF switch (see page 68). WORD CLOCK OUT 1 outputs a wordclock signal at the same clock rate as the DM2000. WORD CLOCK OUT 2 outputs a wordclock signal at half the clock rate of the DM2000 when using 88.2 kHz or
96 kHz, so if the DM2000 is running at 96 kHz, a wordclock signal at 48 kHz is output here.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Wordclocks
67
Selecting the Wordclock Source
The wordclock source can be selected as follows.
Note: When you change the wordclock settings on any device in your digital audio system, some
devices may output noise, so turn down your power amps beforehand, otherwise your speakers
may be damaged.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DIO] button to locate the Word Clock Select page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the sources, and press [ENTER] to set.
The SLOT TYPE column displays the names of any installed I/O Cards. The IN and OUT
columns indicate the number of inputs and outputs available for each installed I/O Card.
The FS box in the lower-left corner displays the current wordclock status: 44.1kHz, 48kHz,
88.2kHz, 96kHz, or Unlock.
The following are possible wordclock sources:
SLOT1–6 (1/2–15/16): These buttons select the Slot Inputs as the wordclock source.
Inputs are selected in pairs, the number of pairs depending on the type of I/O Card
installed.
WC IN: This button selects the WORDCLOCK IN connector as the wordclock source.
CAS. IN: This button selects the CASCADE IN port as the wordclock source.
2TRD1, 2TRD2, 2TRD3: These buttons select the 2TR Digital Inputs as the wordclock
source.
INT44.1k, INT48k, INT88.2k, INT96k: These buttons select the internal wordclock
generator as the wordclock source.
The source select buttons have the following indications:
A usable wordclock signal is present at this input.
No wordclock signal is present at this input.
A wordclock signal is present, but it’s out of sync with the current DM2000 clock.
This is the currently selected wordclock source.
This input was selected as the wordclock source, but no usable signal was received.
This cannot be selected as the wordclock source because a wordclock signal cannot be
sourced from this input on this type of I/O Card, or no I/O Card is installed.
If an external wordclock source fails for some reason, the DM2000 automatically switches
to its internal wordclock generator at the closest frequency.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
68
Chapter 5—Digital I/O & Cascading
Terminating External Wordclocks
Wordclock signals distributed via BNC cables must be terminated correctly, otherwise, jitter
and synchronization errors may result. Ideally, you should make a separate wordclock connection to each device and terminate it. The following examples show two ways in which
wordclock signals can be distributed and how termination should be applied in each case.
Normally the WORD CLOCK 75Ω ON/OFF switch should be set to ON. The OFF setting
provides support for wordclock source devices with special specifications.
Star Distribution
In this example a dedicated wordclock distribution box is used to supply wordclock signals
to each device individually. Termination is applied at each device.
WC OUT
(BNC)
Wordclock
master
WC IN (BNC)
Wordclock
distribution box
WC IN (BNC)
WC IN (BNC)
WC IN (BNC)
Device-A
Device-B
Device-C
Device-D
Termination = ON
Wordclock slave
Termination = ON
Wordclock slave
Termination = ON
Wordclock slave
Termination = ON
Wordclock slave
Daisy Chain Distribution
In this example the wordclock signal is distributed in a “daisy-chain” fashion, with each
device feeding the wordclock signal on to the next. This method of distribution is not recommended for larger systems.
Wordclock
master
WC OUT (BNC)
WC IN
(BNC)
WC OUT
(BNC)
WC IN
(BNC)
WC OUT
(BNC)
WC IN
(BNC)
Device-A
Device-B
Device-C
Termination = ON
Wordclock slave
Termination = ON
Wordclock slave
Termination = ON
Wordclock slave
2TR Digital Outs
The DM2000 features three sets of 2-track digital outputs: 2TR OUT
DIGITAL AES/EBU 1 and AES/EBU 2 use XLR-3-32-type connectors
and output AES/EBU format digital audio. 2TR OUT DIGITAL
COAXIAL 3 uses a phono connector and outputs consumer format
(IEC-60958) digital audio. These outputs can be patched to the Bus Outs, Aux Sends,
Matrix Sends, the Stereo Out, Input or Output Channel Insert Outs, or the Control Room
signal (see page 81). They can also be patched to Direct Outs (see page 81). These outputs
can output digital audio signals at sampling rates other than the current DM2000 rate by
using the internal sampling rate converters (see page 69). Digital output signals can be dithered for transfer to lower-resolution systems (see page 73).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
2TR Digital Ins
69
2TR Digital Ins
The DM2000 features three sets of 2-track digital inputs: 2TR IN
DIGITAL AES/EBU 1 and AES/EBU 2 use XLR-3-31-type connectors and accept AES/EBU format digital audio. 2TR IN DIGITAL
COAXIAL 3 uses a phono connector and accepts consumer format
(IEC-60958) digital audio. These inputs can be monitored via the Control Room monitors
by using the CONTROL ROOM [2TR D1], [2TR D2], and [2TR D3] buttons. They can be
patched to Input Channels (see page 77), Input Channel Insert Ins (see page 78), or Output
Channel Insert Ins (see page 80). Digital audio signals received at sampling rates other than
the current DM2000 rate can be converted by the internal sampling rate converters (see
page 69). You can monitor the Channel Status of digital signals present at these inputs on
the Channel Status Monitor page (see page 73).
2TR In/Out Sampling Rate Conversion
The DM2000’s 2TR Digital Inputs and Outputs feature sampling rate converters so you can
easily connect your legacy 44.1/48 kHz digital audio equipment.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DIO] button to locate the Sampling Rate Converter page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, or [ENTER] button to set them.
The FS box in the lower-left corner displays the current wordclock status: 44.1kHz, 48kHz,
88.2kHz, 96kHz, or Unlock.
2TR IN D1–3: These buttons are used to turn on and off the sampling rate converter for
each 2TR Digital Input. When on, the sampling rate of the received digital audio is converted to the DM2000’s current sampling rate. The original sampling rate is displayed.
2TR OUT D1–3: These buttons are used to turn on and off the sampling rate converters
for each 2TR Digital Output. When on, the sampling rate of the transmitted digital audio is
converted to the specified rate, which can be set to either 44.1 kHz or 48 kHz.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
70
Chapter 5—Digital I/O & Cascading
Slot I/O
The DM2000 features six Slots for installing optional mini-YGDAI (Yamaha General Digital Audio Interface) I/O Cards, which offer various analog I/O options and digital I/O interfaces in all the popular digital audio interconnect formats, including AES/EBU, ADAT, and
Tascam.
Slot Inputs can be assigned to Input Channels or Input Channel Insert Ins (see page 77), or
to Output Channel Insert Ins (see page 80). Slot Outputs can be assigned to Bus Outs, Aux
Sends, Matrix Sends, the Stereo Out, Insert Outs, or the Surround Monitor Channels (see
page 79), or Direct Outs (see page 81).
Slot outputs can be dithered for digital audio transfer to lower-resolution systems (see
page 73).
Available Cards
The following mini-YGDAI I/O Cards are currently available. See the Yamaha Professional
Audio Web site at the following URL for up-to-date news on I/O Cards:
<http://www.yamahaproaudio.com/>.
Card
Format
In
Out
MY8-AD
MY8-AD241
MY4-AD
Connectors
20-bit, 44.1/48 kHz
8
Analog in
Phone jack (balanced) x8
—
24-bit, 44.1/48 kHz
4
MY8-AD96
XLR-3-31 type (balanced) x4
8
MY4-DA
MY8-DA96
Resolution/Sampling Rate
Analog out
—
24-bit, 44.1/48/88.2/96 kHz D-sub 25-pin
4
20-bit, 44.1/48 kHz
8
XLR-3-32 type (balanced) x4
D-sub 25-pin
24-bit, 44.1/48/88.2/96 kHz
Analog
MY8-ADDA96
in/out
8
8
MY8-AE2
8
8
MY16-AE2
16
16
8
8
8
8
8
8
Optical x2
16
16
Optical x4
8
8
MY8-AEB
AES/EBU I/O
24-bit, 44.1/48 kHz
Euroblock x4
D-sub 25-pin
BNC connector x8
MY8-AE96
MY8-AE96S3
MY8-AT2
MY16-AT2
ADAT I/O
MY8-TD2
Tascam
MY16-TD2
MY16-C2
24-bit, 44.1/48 kHz
16
16
8
8
16
16
CobraNet
16
16
ADAT
8
8
MY8-mLAN2
MY16-mLAN2
D-sub 25-pin
BNC wordclock output
D-sub 25-pin
IEEE1394
6-pin 1394 connector x2
WAVES Y56K
WAVES Y96K
24-bit, 44.1/48/88.2/96 kHz D-sub 25-pin
24-bit, 44.1/48 kHz
24-bit, 44.1/48 kHz
24-bit, 44.1/48/88.2/96 kHz
RJ-45 x2
Optical x2
1. This card is a substitution for a 20-bit MY8-AD card.
2. These cards support 24-bit/96 kHz in Double Channel mode. (Separate 96 kHz wordclock required.)
3. This card is identical to the MY8-AE96, except that it features a sampling rate converter.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Slot I/O
71
Installing I/O Cards
For technical reasons, certain card combinations are not supported. Before
installing any cards, check the Yamaha web site (see page 6) to see whether your
card is compatible.
http://www.yamahaproaudio.com/
Also check the total number of cards that can be installed in the unit. Installing cards that are
not endorsed by Yamaha may cause electrical shock, fire, or damage to the unit.
This section explains how to install I/O Cards.
1
Turn off the DM2000.
2
Undo the two fixing screws and remove the slot cover, as shown below.
Keep the cover and fixing screws in a safe place for future use.
3
Insert the card between the guide rails and slide it all the way into the slot,
as shown below. You may have to push firmly to plug the card into the internal connector.
4
Secure the card using the attached thumbscrews. Do not leave them loose,
as the card will not be grounded correctly, which may cause the DM2000 to
malfunction.
You can check which I/O Cards are installed on the Word Clock Select page (see page 67).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
72
Chapter 5—Digital I/O & Cascading
Setting the Transfer Format for Higher Sampling Rates
The data transfer format for the higher sampling rates can be set as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DIO] button to locate the Higher Sample Rate Data
Transfer Format page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, or [ENTER] button to set them.
The SLOT TYPE column displays the names of any installed I/O Cards.
IN/OUT: These parameters are used to set the input and output data transfer format of I/O
Cards when running at the higher sampling rates (i.e., 88.2 kHz or 96 kHz) to either Double
Channel, Double Speed or Single. In Double Speed mode, digital audio data is received and
transmitted at the current higher sampling rate (i.e., 88.2 kHz or 96 kHz). In Double Channel mode, digital audio data is received and transmitted at a sampling rate that is exactly half
the current higher sampling rate and data is handled by two channels, thereby reducing the
total number of inputs or outputs for an eight channel I/O Card to four. In Double Channel
mode, the even-numbered channels are disabled. Double Channel mode allows you to
record 96 kHz audio to legacy 44.1/48 kHz digital multitrack recorders. In Single mode,
digital audio data is received and transmitted at a sampling rate that is exactly half the current higher sampling rate. This is useful for digital MTR recording and playback situations.
The IN and OUT parameters are only available when a higher sampling rate (i.e., 88.2 kHz
or 96 kHz) is selected. When the sampling rate is 44.1 kHz or 48 kHz, all parameters on this
page are unavailable. As are individual parameters for Slots with analog I/O Cards installed,
or no I/O Card installed. When a digital I/O card that does not support 88.2/96 kHz is
installed, such as the MY8-AE, MY8-AT, or MY8-TD, its IN and OUT formats cannot be
set to Double Speed mode.
SRC: These parameters are used to turn on and off the sampling rate converter for each
pair of Slot Inputs. When on, the sampling rate of the received digital audio is converted to
the DM2000’s current sampling rate. The original sampling rate is displayed. These parameters are available only when an I/O Card with onboard sampling rate converters is
installed, such as the MY8-AE96S.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Dithering Digital Outputs
73
Dithering Digital Outputs
For digital audio transfer to lower-resolution systems, the 2TR Digital Outputs and Slot
Outputs can be dithered to 16-bit, 20-bit, or 24-bit.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DIO] button to locate the Dither page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the Dither parameters, and use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to set them.
The SLOT column displays the names of any installed I/O Cards.
You can copy the currently selected setting to all Dither parameters by double-clicking the
[ENTER] button.
Monitoring Digital Input Channel Status
You can monitor the Channel Status of digital audio signals connected to the 2TR Digital
Inputs and Slot Inputs as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [UTILITY] button to locate the Channel Status Monitor page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the SLOT 1–6 and 2TR IN buttons, then press
[ENTER].
Displayed Channel Status information includes sampling rate (FS), emphasis, category, and
copy protection.
However, if a mini-YGDAI I/O card other than AES/EBU format is installed, Channel Status
information will be grayed out.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
74
Chapter 5—Digital I/O & Cascading
3
If you select the SLOT button for a slot that has an
MY16-AE card installed, use the 01–08 and 09–16 buttons located in the lower-right corner of the screen
to select a channel group you wish to display.
Cascading Consoles
Total four DM2000s or 02R96s can be cascaded, offering a maximum of 384 Input Channels. Several functions are linked between all cascaded consoles, including Solo, Scene
Recall and Store, so that all consoles work just like one big console. A single Yamaha 02R
Digital Recording Console can be included in the cascade system.
The CASCADE IN and CASCADE OUT ports are used
to transmit and receive Cascade and control signals.
Only use the optional dedicated Cascade cables for connecting.
Linked Functions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
The following DM2000 functions are linked via the cascade ports:
AUX SELECT (Aux 9–12 are not linked with the 02R96.)
MATRIX SELECT (Not linked with the 02R96.)
Display page selection (Not linked with the 02R96.)
Solo function
FADER MODE
ENCODER MODE
Metering position setting
Peak Hold On/Off
Meter Fast Fall on/off
Scene Store, Recall, and Title Edit
When a Scene is recalled on the master console, that scene is recalled on all cascaded consoles.
The following Automix functions: Make New Automix, Store, Recall, Title Edit, Transport
(AutoREC, REC, PLAY, STOP, ABORT).
The following Automix parameters: Automix Enable/Disable, Internal Start Time, Offset
Time, Frame Rate, Overwrite (FADER, ON, PAN, SURR, AUX, AUX ON, EQ), Motor
ON/OFF, Edit Out Mode OFF/RETURN/TAKEOVER, Return Time, Update To End
On/Off, ABSOLUTE/RELATIVE Fader Edit Mode, Touch Sense Edit Off/Touch/Latch.
Function and parameter linking can be turned on or off by using the Cascade COMM Link
preference (see page 276). The Solo function is always linked regardless of this preference.
Note: When the Cascade COMM Link preference is on, do not make any MIDI connections
between cascaded DM2000s/02R96s. If two DM2000s/02R96s are cascaded and connected via
MIDI, and the Cascade COMM Link preference is on, when a store operation is performed
on the master console, a loop will be created, causing both consoles to execute endless store operations.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Cascading Consoles
75
Cascade Hookup Examples
Cascading Two DM2000s
Master: Off
Bi-directional: –
Master: On
Bi-directional: On
CASCADE OUT
CASCADE IN
DM2000 #1
DM2000 #2
CASCADE IN
CASCADE OUT
Final signals can be output by
the Slot Outputs or Omni Outs.
Final signals can be output by
the Slot Outputs or Omni Outs.
Cascading Three or More DM2000s
Master: Off
Bi-directional: –
Master: Off
Bi-directional: –
CASCADE OUT
CASCADE OUT
CASCADE IN
DM2000 #1
Master: On
Bi-directional: On
DM2000 #2/3
CASCADE OUT
CASCADE IN
DM2000 #4
CASCADE IN
Final signals can be output by
the Slot Outputs or Omni Outs.
Final signals can be output by
the Slot Outputs or Omni Outs.
Cascading an 02R Digital Recording Console
Master: Off
Bi-directional: –
Cascade In from: 02R
CASCADE OUT
02R
CASCADE IN
Master: On
Bi-directional: Off
CASCADE OUT
DM2000 #1/2
Aux Sends 9–12 are cascaded
between the DM2000s only.
CASCADE IN
DM2000 #3
Final signals can be output by
the Slot Outputs or Omni Outs.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
76
Chapter 5—Digital I/O & Cascading
Attenuating Cascade Inputs
Cascade Inputs can be attenuated, and the Cascade mode and Cascade source can be specified on the Cascade In page.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DIO] button to locate the Cascade In page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, or [ENTER] button to set them.
CASCADE MODE: When you want to output the same signals from two DM2000s, turn
on the BI-DIRECTIONAL button. In this case, the Cascade connections are looped. Turn
on the CASCADE MASTER option on one of the DM2000s to make it the master console.
When the BI-DIRECTIONAL button is off, the last DM2000 in the cascade is automatically
configured as the master console and it output the final signals.
CASCADE IN FROM: This is used to specify the type of device connected to the CASCADE IN port, either DM2000 or 02R. When a DM2000 or 02R96 is connected to the CASCADE IN port, DM2000 is specified automatically.
CASCADE IN ATTENUATOR: These controls are used to attenuate Cascade Input signals. You can copy the currently selected setting to all Attenuator parameters by double-clicking the [ENTER] button.
Turning On & Off Cascade Outputs
Individual Cascade Outputs can be turned on or off as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DIO] button to locate the Cascade Out page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the ON/OFF buttons, and use the [ENTER]
button to set them.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Input & Output Patching
77
6 Input & Output Patching
Input Patching
Input and Output signals for the Input Channels, Input Channel Insert Ins, and internal
effects processors are selected on the Input Patch pages, which you select using the DISPLAY
ACCESS [INPUT PATCH] button. Use the cursor buttons to select the patch parameters,
use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select a source, and press [ENTER] to set.
Patch parameters display Short Port names. The Long Port name of the currently selected
patch parameter is displayed in the upper-right corner of each page.
Patching can also be done by using the Patch Select Window (see page 83). Input Channel
Inputs, Insert Ins, and Insert Outs can also be patched by using the Encoders (see page 83).
See page 286 for a complete list of input patch sources. See page 289 for a list of initial input
patches.
Input Patch settings can be stored in the Input Patch library, which contains 1 preset memory and 32 user memories. See “Input Patch Library” on page 167 for more information.
Patching Input Channels
AD Inputs, Slot Inputs, internal effects Processor outputs, Digital or Analog 2TR Inputs,
Bus Outs, or Aux Sends can be patched to the Input Channel Inputs.
The Input Channel Patch parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided between two
pages. The Input Channel 1–48 Patch page is shown below. The layout of the other page is
the same. When Vertical Input Channel pairing mode is selected, patch parameters for vertical partners are displayed, for example, CH1, CH25, CH2, CH26, and so on.
In addition to using the cursor buttons, Patch parameters can also be selected by using the
[SEL] buttons and the Input Layers.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
78
Chapter 6—Input & Output Patching
Patching Input Channel Insert Ins
AD Inputs, Slot Inputs, internal effects processor outputs, Digital or Analog 2TR Inputs can
be patched to the Input Channel Insert Ins.
The Input Channel Insert In Patch parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided
between two pages. The Input Channel 1–48 Insert In Patch page is shown below. The layout of the other page is the same. When Vertical Input Channel pairing mode is selected,
patch parameters for vertical partners are displayed, for example, CH1, CH25, CH2, CH26,
and so on.
In addition to using the cursor buttons, Patch parameters can also be selected by using the
[SEL] buttons.
Patching Effects Inputs and Outputs
Aux Sends, internal effects processor outputs (OUT1 and OUT2 only), or Output Channel
Insert Outs can be patched to the internal effects processor inputs.
Input Channels, or Insert Ins can be patched to the internal effects processor outputs. Internal effects processor inputs can be also patched to the internal effects processor outputs
(OUT1 and OUT2 only).
The internal effects processor Input Patch parameters are divided between two pages: One
for Effects Processors #1 and #2, and one for Effects Processors 3–8. The effects type for each
Effects Processor is displayed in the boxes.
FOLLOW SURROUND: When surround effects are recalled to Effects processor 1 or 2,
this button sorts the effect inputs and outputs displayed in the list in the order specified on
the Surround Bus Setup page (see page 99). If the recalled surround effects are compatible
with 5.1 Channel systems, the surround bus setting for 5.1 surround mode will be used.
: Press this button repeatedly until an Effect Edit (1–8) page for the effects processor you
wish to edit appears.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Output Patching
79
Output Patching
Signal sources for the Slot Outputs, Omni Outs, Output Channel Inserts Ins, Direct Outs,
2TR Digital Outputs, and GEQs are selected on the Output Patch pages, which are selected
by using the DISPLAY ACCESS [OUTPUT PATCH] button. Use the cursor buttons to select
the patch parameters, use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select a source, and
press [ENTER] to set.
Depending on the patch page, patch parameters display either Short Channel or Short Port
names. The Long Channel or Port name of the currently selected patch parameter is displayed in the upper-right corner of each page.
Signal sources can also be selected by using the Patch Select Window (see page 83). Insert
Ins, Insert Outs, and Direct Outs can also be patched by using the Encoders (see page 83).
See page 290 for a complete list of output patch sources. See page 297 for a list of initial output patches.
Output Patch settings can be stored in the Output Patch library, which contains 1 preset
memory and 32 user memories. See “Output Patch Library” on page 167 for more information.
Patching Slot Outputs
Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, the Stereo Out, Input or Output Channel Insert Outs,
or Surround Monitor Channels can be patched to the Slot Outputs. Slot Outputs can be
patched to Direct Outs on the Direct Out Destination pages (see page 81).
The Slot Output Patch parameters for the six Slots are arranged into three pages. The Slot
1–2 Output Patch page is shown below. The layout of the other two pages is the same.
When a Slot Output is patched to a Direct Out (see page 81), and that Direct Out is assigned
on an Input Channel Routing page, the Slot Output patch cannot be changed here. If the
higher sampling rate (88.2 kHz/96 kHz) data format is set to Double Channel mode, the
Slot’s even channel patch is disabled and cannot be changed.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
80
Chapter 6—Input & Output Patching
Patching Omni Outs
Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, the Stereo Out, Input or Output Channel Insert Outs,
or Surround Monitor Channels can be patched to the Omni Outs. Omni Outs can be
patched to Direct Outs on the Direct Out Destination pages (see page 81).
When an Omni Out is patched to a Direct out (see page 81), and that Direct Out is assigned
on an Input Channel Routing page, the Omni Out patch cannot be changed here.
Output Channel Inserts Ins
AD Inputs, Slot Inputs, internal effects processor outputs, or Digital or Analog 2TR Inputs
can be patched to the Output Channel Insert Ins. The left and right channels of the Matrix
Sends and the Stereo Out can be patched individually.
In addition to using the cursor buttons, Patch parameters can also be selected by using the
[SEL] buttons.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Output Patching
81
Patching Direct Outs
Direct Outs can be patched to the Slot Outputs, Omni Outs, or 2TR Digital Outputs.
The Direct Out Destination parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided between two
pages. The Input Channel 1–48 Direct Out Destination page is shown below. The layout of
the other page is the same.
In addition to using the cursor buttons, Patch parameters can also be selected by using the
[SEL] buttons.
Patching the 2TR Digital Outputs
Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, the Stereo Out, Input or Output Channel Insert Outs,
or the Control Room signal can be patched to the 2TR Digital Outputs. 2TR Digital Outputs can be patched to Direct Outs on the Direct Out Destination pages (see page 81). The
left and right channels of each Digital Output can be patched individually.
When a 2TR Digital Output is patched to a Direct out (see page 81), and that Direct Out is
assigned on an Input Channel Routing page, the 2TR Digital Output patch cannot be
changed here.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
82
Chapter 6—Input & Output Patching
Patching the GEQs
The six 31-band graphic equalizers can be inserted into the Bus Outs, Aux Sends, or the left
or right channels of the Matrix Sends or Stereo Out on the Graphic Equalizer Insert page.
GEQs can also be patched on the Graphic Equalizer Edit page (see page 183) or the Output
Channel Insert page (see page 135).
Naming Input & Output Ports
You can specify Long and Short names for the Input and Output Ports as follows. These
names appear on the Input and Output Patch pages and the channel strip displays when
patching with the Encoders.
See page 300 for a list of the initial Input Port names; page 301 for Output Port names.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to locate the Input Port or Output
Port Name page.
2
Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select the ports.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the Long or Short name, and then press
[ENTER].
When the Title Edit window appears, edit the port name, and press OK when you’ve finished. See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
When the Name Input Auto Copy option is on, the first four characters of a newly entered
Long name are automatically copied to the Short name and vice versa.
You can reset all port names back to their initial values by pressing the INITIALIZE button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Patch Select Window
83
Patch Select Window
Input and Output patches can be made by using the Patch Select window, shown below,
which appears when the [ENTER] button is pressed while a patch parameter is selected.
Available input and output sources and destinations are displayed in a hierarchical format
in three panes. The existing source or destination is displayed in the upper-right corner of
the window. Use the cursor buttons to move the cursor to the pane on the left, and use the
Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select the top level item. Then move the cursor to
the center pane, and select an item at the next level. Select an item in the right pane, if available, and then select the YES button and press [ENTER].
Patching with the Encoders
The following patches can be made by using the Encoders: Input Channel Inputs, Insert
Outs, Insert Ins, and Direct Outs.
1
Assign one of the above parameters to an Encoder ASSIGN button, as
explained on page 62.
To set the Input Channel Input or Direct Out patches, you must select an Input Channel
Layer. For Insert Out or Insert In patches, you can select an Input Channel Layer or the Master Layer.
2
Press the ASSIGN button to which you assigned the patch parameter.
If no further action is taken within five seconds, the channel strip displays
return to normal, and you must press the ASSIGN button again.
Depending on the “Port ID/Name on FL Display” preference on page 276, the
AD1
channel strip displays show the Port IDs or Short Port names for the current
patches.
3
Use the Encoders to select ports, and press the Encoder push switches to set
them.
If you don’t activate your selection within five seconds (i.e., while the Port ID or Short
Channel name flashes), or you operate another Encoder, the selection is cancelled and the
patch is left unchanged.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
84
Chapter 7—Input Channels
7 Input Channels
Patching Input Channels
AD Inputs, Slot Inputs, internal effects processor outputs, Digital or Analog 2TR Inputs,
Bus Outs, or Aux Sends can be patched to the Input Channel Inputs. See “Patching Input
Channels” on page 77 for more information.
Metering Input Channels
Input Channel signal levels can be metered on the Meter pages. See “Metering” on page 127
for more information.
Reversing the Signal Phase
The signal phase of each Input Channel can be reversed as follows.
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT [ ] Button
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select Input Channel Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select Input Channels.
2
Use the Phase [ ] button to set the phase.
Phase is reversed when the Phase [ ] button indicator is lit.
Phase Pages
Phase settings can be viewed and set on the Phase pages. If the Auto PHASE/INSERT Display preference is on, these pages appear automatically when you press the Phase [ ] button
in the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT section, turning on the button indicator.
See “Auto PHASE/INSERT Display” on page 274.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT [DISPLAY] button to select the
Phase pages.
The Phase parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided between two pages. The Input
Channel 1–48 Phase page is shown below. The layout of the other page is the same.
2
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the NOR/REV buttons,
then use the [ENTER] button and INC/DEC buttons to set them.
The NOR/REV buttons can also be selected by using the [SEL] buttons.
GLOBAL NOR/REV: These buttons allow you to set the phase of all Input Channels
simultaneously.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Gating Input Channels
85
Gating Input Channels
Each Input Channel features a noise Gate for automatically shutting out unwanted noise.
Gate settings can be stored in the Gate library, which contains 4 preset memories and 124
user memories. See “Gate Library” on page 170 for more information.
Preset Gates & Types
The following table lists the preset Gates and types. See page 333 for detailed parameter
information.
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
1
Gate
GATE
Gate template
2
Ducking
DUCKING
Ducking template
3
A. Dr. BD
GATE
Gate preset for use with acoustic bass drums
4
A. Dr. SN
GATE
Gate preset for use with acoustic snare drums
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS Controls
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select Input Channel Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select Input Channels.
2
Use the [GATE ON] button to turn the currently selected Input Channel’s
Gate on or off.
DYNAMICS
DISPLAY
GATE / COMP
THRESHOLD
RANGE
ATTACK
DECAY
HOLD
THRESHOLD
RATIO
ATTACK
RELEASE
GAIN
GATE
COMP
GATE ON
3
COMP ON
Use the [GATE/COMP] button to set the DYNAMICS controls to GATE (GATE
indicator lit), and use the THRESHOLD, RANGE, ATTACK, DECAY, and HOLD
controls to set the Gate.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
86
Chapter 7—Input Channels
Gate Edit Page
Gate settings can be viewed and set on the Gate Edit page. If the Auto DYNAMICS Display
preference is on, this page appears automatically when a gate control in the SELECTED
CHANNEL DYNAMICS section is operated.
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select Input Channel Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select Input Channels.
2
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [DISPLAY] button to locate the
Gate Library page, and then recall a Gate preset that contains the gate type
that you want.
See “Gate Library” on page 170 for more information.
3
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [DISPLAY] button to locate the
Gate Edit page.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
KEYIN SOURCE: This determines the trigger source for the currently selected Input
Channel’s Gate. Trigger sources include SELF (the Gate’s own input signal), CHANNEL
(another Input Channel), or AUX (an Aux Send from 1–12). Input Channel trigger sources
are selectable in blocks of 12 channels. For example, if Input Channel #1 is currently
selected, an Input Channel from 1–12 can be selected as the trigger source. However, if
Input Channel #13 is currently selected, an Input Channel from 13–24 can be selected.
STEREO LINK: This allows you to pair Gates for stereo operation even when Input Channels are not paired. Input Channel Gates are paired either horizontally or vertically depending on the Pair mode setting for the currently selected Input Channel. See “Pairing
Channels” on page 144 for more information on horizontal and vertical pairing. When
Input Channels are paired, this parameter is turned on automatically and cannot be
changed.
CURVE: This displays the gate curve (i.e., input level vs. output level).
TYPE: This is the gate type used by the currently selected Input Channel’s Gate.
Meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Input Channel and its
horizontal or vertical partner. The GR meter indicates the amount of gain reduction being
applied by the currently selected Input Channel’s Gate.
ON/OFF: This turns the currently selected Input Channel’s Gate on and off. It works in
unison with the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [GATE ON] button.
PARAMETER: These controls are used to set the Threshold, Range, Attack, Decay, and
Hold parameters.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Attenuating Input Channels
87
Attenuating Input Channels
Input Channels signals can be attenuated pre-EQ. See “Attenuating Signals” on page 130 for
more information.
EQ’ing Input Channels
Each Input Channel features 4-band parametric EQ. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for more
information.
Grouping Input Channel EQs
Input Channel EQs can be grouped, allowing you to control the EQ of several Input Channels simultaneously. There are four Input Channel EQ groups: a, b, c, and d.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Input Equalizer Link
page.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
The corresponding group row is selected as each Input Channel Layer is selected.
3
Use the Up/Down cursor buttons to select EQ groups a–d.
The selected group is highlighted by a flashing cursor box.
4
Use the [SEL] buttons to add and remove Input Channels to and from the
selected group.
The EQ settings of the first Input Channel added to the group are applied to all subsequently added Input Channels.
When an Input Channel is added to a group, its [SEL] button indicator lights up.
Input Channel Inserts
Internal effects processors and external signal processors can be patched into the Input
Channels by using the Inserts. See “Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
Compressing Input Channels
Each Input Channel features a Compressor. See “Compressing Channels” on page 137 for
more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
88
Chapter 7—Input Channels
Grouping Input Channel Compressors
Input Channel Compressors can be grouped, allowing you to control the compression of
several Input Channels simultaneously by operating any Compressor control in the group.
There are four Input Channel Compressor groups: i, j, k, and l.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Input Comp Link
page.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
The corresponding group row is selected as each Input Channel Layer is selected.
3
Use the Up/Down cursor buttons to select Comp groups i–l.
The selected group is highlighted by a flashing cursor box.
4
Use the [SEL] buttons to add and remove Input Channels to and from the
selected group.
The Compressor settings of the first Input Channel added to the group are applied to all
subsequently added Input Channels.
When an Input Channel is added to a group, its [SEL] button indicator lights up.
Delaying Input Channels
Each Input Channel features a Delay function. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page 141
for more information.
Muting Input Channels (ON/OFF)
Input Channels can be muted as follows.
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
2
Use the [ON] buttons to mute the Input Channels on the selected Layer.
The [ON] button indicators of channels that are on are lit.
ON
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Grouping Input Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)
89
Grouping Input Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)
Input Channel Mutes can be grouped, allowing you to mute several Input Channels simultaneously. There are eight Input Channel Mute groups: I, J, K, L, M, N, O, and P.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Input Channel Mute
Group pages.
The Mute group parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided between two pages. The
Input Channel 1–48 Mute Group page is shown below. The layout of the other page is the
same.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
The corresponding Mute Group page and group row is selected as each Input Channel
Layer is selected.
3
Use the Up/Down cursor buttons to select Mute groups I–P.
The selected group is highlighted by a flashing cursor box.
4
Use the [SEL] buttons to add and remove mutes to and from the selected
group.
When an Input Channel is added to a Mute group, its [SEL] button indicator lights up.
ENABLE: These buttons are used to enable and disable the groups.
INPUT MUTE MASTER: When this check box is checked, clicking a MASTER MUTE
button mutes or unmutes all channels in the corresponding Mute group. When this check
box is unchecked, the Input Channel [ON] button status links to the mute on/off status of
the channels in the group.
MASTER MUTE: When the Input Mute Master check box is checked, use this button to
mute or unmute all channels in the corresponding Mute group.
When the Input Mute Master check box is unchecked, pressing the Input Channel [ON]
button mutes or unmutes the channels in the corresponding Mute group (Mute On channels turn off and Mute Off channels turn on).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
90
Chapter 7—Input Channels
Input Channel Mute Master
The DM2000 features a Mute Master function that enables you to mute all channels in the
Mute group using the MASTER button, much like a Mute group on an analog mixing console. When the Mute Master function is enabled, the channel [ON] button status does not
link to the corresponding Mute group.
1
Follow Steps 1–4 as described in the “Grouping Input Channel Mutes
(ON/OFF)” section on the previous page, select the Input Mute Master check
box, then press the [ENTER] button to check or uncheck the Input Mute Master check box.
2
When the Input Mute Master check box is checked, the MASTER MUTE button for each Mute group turns mute on or off for the channels in the corresponding Mute group.
If the channels are muted by the Mute Master function, the corresponding channel [ON]
button indicators flash. You can assign the MASTER MUTE button function to one of the
USER DEFINED KEYS for convenient operation.
Setting Input Channel Levels
Input Channel levels can be set as follows.
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
2
Press the FADER MODE [FADER] button to select Fader mode.
3
Use the faders to set the Input Channel levels.
Refer to the legend on the left side of the faders when setting Input Channel levels.
You can view the fader level values on the channel strip displays while you operate
the faders.
You can also view fader positions on the Fader View pages, which you can access
by pressing the DISPLAY ACCESS [VIEW] button. See “Viewing Channel Fader
Settings” on page 151 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
10
0
5
5
0
10
5
15
10
20
15
30
20
40
30
50
40
60
50
70
Grouping Input Channel Faders
91
Grouping Input Channel Faders
Input Channel faders can be grouped, allowing you to control the level of several Input
Channels simultaneously. There are eight Input Channel Fader groups: A, B, C, D, E, F, G,
and H.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Input Channel Fader
Group pages.
The Fader Group parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided between two pages. The
Input Channel 1–48 Fader Group page is shown below. The layout of the other page is the
same.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
The corresponding Fader Group page and group row is selected as each Input Channel
Layer is selected.
3
Use the Up/Down cursor buttons to select Fader groups A–H.
The selected group is highlighted by a flashing cursor box.
4
Use the [SEL] buttons to add and remove faders to and from the selected
group.
When an Input Channel is added to a group, its [SEL] button indicator lights up.
ENABLE: These buttons are used to enable and disable the groups.
INPUT FADER MASTER: When this check box is unchecked, the Input Channel fader
positions link to the fader levels for the channels in the corresponding Fader group. When
this check box is checked, you can set the master level for the corresponding Input Channel
Fader group in the Master column. The resultant Input Channel level equals the corresponding Input Channel fader level plus the Group Master level. See “Group Master for
Input Channel Faders” on page 92.
When the Input Fader Master check box is not checked, operating the channel faders will
affect the input levels for the corresponding Fader group. Pressing and holding down the
[SEL] button while operating the fader of an Input Channel will temporarily cancel the corresponding Fader group, which is convenient if you want to adjust the relative balance
between channels.
Fader groups are active only in Fader mode (i.e., when the FADER MODE [FADER] button
indicator is on). See “Selecting Fader Modes” on page 60 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
92
Chapter 7—Input Channels
Group Master for Input Channel Faders
The DM2000 features a Fader Group Master function that enables you to control the level
of all channels using the Group Master level while maintaining the relative balance between
channels, much like a VCA group on an analog mixing console. While this function is
enabled, channel fader operation does not affect channel levels in the corresponding Fader
group.
1
Follow Steps 1-4 as described in the “Grouping Input Channel Faders” section on the previous page, select the Input Fader Master check box, then
press the [ENTER] button to check or uncheck the Input Fader Master check
box.
2
When the Input Fader Master check box is checked, you can set channel levels of the Fader groups in the Master column.
When the Master column is selected, repeatedly pressing the [ENTER] button turns the
Input Fader group on and off.
You can also make these settings in the Input Fader Group Master page, as shown below.
3
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Input Fader Group
Master page.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select parameters, then use the Parameter wheel,
INC/DEC buttons, or [ENTER] button to set the parameters.
INPUT FADER MASTER: When this check box is checked, you can set the master levels
for the Input Fader groups. The resultant Input Channel level equals the corresponding
Input Channel fader level plus the Group Master level.
ALL NOMINAL: This button resets the master levels for all Input Fader groups to nominal.
ON/OFF: This turns each Input Fader group on or off. This function works like a VCA
mute on an analog mixing console.
Faders: These faders adjust the master levels of the Fader groups. Fader knobs are highlighted when faders are set to 0.0 dB. Press the [ENTER] button to set the currently-selected
fader to 0.0 dB.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
93
Routing Input Channels
You can also control the parameters from the channel strips on the control surface as
described below by using the User Assignable Layer of the Remote Layers. See page 269 for
information on the User Assignable Layer.
Encoders: The Encoders are not available.
[AUTO] buttons: These buttons are used to control the Fader Group Master On/Off and
the master level during Automix.
[SEL] buttons: These buttons move the cursor on the Input Fader Group Master page.
[SOLO] buttons: These buttons turn the Solo function of each Fader group on and off.
You can monitor all the channels in each Fader group.
Channel Strip Displays: The displays indicate the Group names (GrpA – GrpH). When
you operate the channel faders, the displays indicate the corresponding master level values.
Channel Faders: The channel faders enable you to set the master level for each Fader
group.
Routing Input Channels
Each Input Channel can be routed to the Bus Outs, Stereo Out, or its own Direct Out.
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL ROUTING Controls
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers,
and use the [SEL] buttons to select the Input Channels.
ROUTING
DISPLAY
1
2
2
Use the [1–8], [STEREO], and [DIRECT] buttons to route the
currently selected Input Channel.
[1–8]: These buttons route the currently selected Input Channel to the
Bus Outs.
[STEREO]: This button routes the currently selected Input Channel to
the Stereo Out.
DIRECT: This button routes the currently selected Input Channel to its Direct Out.
[FOLLOW PAN]: This determines whether the Input Channel’s Pan control setting is
applied to the Bus Outs. When off, the levels of the signals fed to the odd and even Bus Outs
is the same. When on, the levels of the signals fed to the odd and even Bus Outs follows the
Pan control.
In Surround mode, when this button is turned off, the surround pan setting does not affect
signals fed to the Bus Outs. You can enable the surround pan setting when the input source
is monaural, and patch the surround sources or surround effects directly to the Surround
Buses.
FOLLOW PAN
3
4
5
6
7
8
STEREO
DIRECT
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
94
Chapter 7—Input Channels
Routing Pages
Input Channel routing settings can be viewed and set on the Routing pages. If the Auto
ROUTING Display preference is on, these pages appear automatically when a button in the
SELECTED CHANNEL ROUTING section is pressed. See “Auto ROUTING Display” on
page 274.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL ROUTING [DISPLAY] button to select the Routing pages.
The Routing parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided among four pages. The
Input Channel 1–24 Routing page is shown below. The layout of the other three pages is the
same.
2
Use the cursor buttons and Parameter wheel to select the parameters, and
use the [ENTER] button or INC/DEC buttons to set them.
Channels can also be selected by using the Input Channel Layer buttons and [SEL] buttons.
ALL STEREO: This button assigns all Input Channels that are currently displayed to the
Stereo Out.
ALL BUS: This button assigns all Input Channels that are currently displayed to all Bus
Outs
ALL CLEAR: This button clears all routing assignments that are currently displayed.
The currently selected Surround mode is displayed in the lower-left corner. When Stereo
mode is selected, the Bus Out routing buttons display numbers from 1 through 8. When a
Surround Pan mode is selected, they display abbreviations of the Surround Channel names,
as shown in the following table. See “Using Surround Pan” on page 97 for more information.
Surround Mode
Bus Outs
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Stereo
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
3-1
L
R
C
S
5
6
7
8
7
8
E
8
5.1
L
R
Ls
Rs
C
E1
6.1
L
R
Ls
Rs
C
Bs
1. Short for LFE (Low frequency Effects).
This table shows the default assignments. The actual assignments may vary depending on
the settings on the Surround Bus Setup page. See “Assigning Surround Channels to Buses”
on page 99 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Panning Input Channels
95
Panning Input Channels
Input Channels can be panned between the left and right channels of the Stereo Out.
Using the Encoders
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
2
Press the ENCODER MODE [PAN] button to select the Pan Encoder
mode.
3
Use the Encoders to pan the input channels.
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND Controls
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers, and use the [SEL]
buttons to select the Input Channels.
PAN / SURROUND
DISPLAY
L
2
R
L
R
ODD
EVEN
LINK
GRAB
EFFECT
Use the Pan control to pan the currently selected Input Channel.
The pan display indicates the pan position of the currently selected Input Channel. When
pan is set to center, the center two segments light up. You can use the [L] and [R] buttons
to select horizontal or vertical Input Channel partners.
The [LINK] button, which is enabled only when a Surround mode other than Stereo is
selected, is used to link the Pan control and the Joystick so that either control can be used
for panning. This setting applies only to Input Channels that are currently selected. For this
to work, the [EFFECT] button indicator must be off and the [GRAB] and [LINK] button
indicators must be on.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
96
Chapter 7—Input Channels
Pan Pages
Pan settings can be viewed and set on the Pan pages. If the Auto PAN/SURROUND Display
preference is on, these pages appear automatically when a control in the SELECTED
CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND section is operated.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND [DISPLAY] button to select
the Input Channel Pan pages.
The Pan parameters for the 96 Input Channels are arranged into four pages. The Input
Channel 1–24 Pan page is shown below. The layout of the other three pages is the same.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the Pan controls, and use the Parameter
wheel and INC/DEC buttons to set them.
Pan parameters can also be selected by using the Input Channel Layer buttons and [SEL]
buttons.
The currently selected Pan control can be set to center by pressing [ENTER].
MODE: There are three Pan modes that determine how horizontally and vertically paired
Input Channels are panned: Individual, Gang, and Inverse Gang. This is a global setting that
applies to all paired Input Channels.
In individual mode, paired Input Channel pan controls operate independently.
In Gang mode, paired Input Channel pan controls operate in unison.
In Inverse Gang mode, paired Input Channel pan controls operate in unison but
move in opposite directions.
Aux Send Pan controls can be linked to Input Channel Pan controls so that operating an
Input Channel Pan control also operates the corresponding Aux Send Pan control, and vice
versa (see page 116). While linked, the Pan mode can be set on the Aux Pan page or the
Input Channel Pan page.
Note: While the PAN/SURROUND [LINK] button is turned on, the Pan mode is automatically set to Individual. When the Pan mode is switched from Gang mode to Inverse Gang mode,
the [LINK] button is turned off.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
97
Using Surround Pan
Using Surround Pan
The DM2000 supports 3-1, 5.1 and 6.1 Surround modes. Surround pan is independent of
normal panning. Normal panning determines how the Input Channel signal is panned
between the left and right channels of the Stereo out. Whereas surround panning determines how the Input Channel signal is panned among the Surround channels (i.e., the Bus
Outs).
If Input Channel Follow Pan is off, you can patch signals to the corresponding Bus Outs
without being affected by the surround pan setting. This is useful when you want to assign
the surround source or surround effect return to Bus Outs.
When the Nominal Pan preference is on (see page 275), signals will be at nominal level
when panned hard left or hard right, and at +3 dB when the preference is turned off.
Note: If you have saved a scene with the Follow Pan function turned off on a DM2000 that is
older than Version 2.0, the surround setting may not be reproduced
The following table shows how Surround channels are handled by the Bus Outs.
The table may vary depending on the settings on the Surround Bus Setup page (see
page 99).
Surround
Mode
3-1
5.1
6.1
Bus Outs
1
2
3
4
L
R
C
S
Front left
Front right
Center
Surround
5
6
7
—
—
—
L
R
Ls
Rs
C
LFE
Front left
Front right
Rear left
Rear right
Center
Subwoofer
—
L
R
Ls
Rs
C
Bs
LFE
Front left
Front right
Rear left
Rear right
Center
Rear center
Subwoofer
Selecting Surround Pan Modes
The Surround mode can be selected as follows.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND [DISPLAY] button to select
the Surround Mode page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
98
Chapter 7—Input Channels
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the surround mode buttons, and press
[ENTER] to activate the selected mode.
The diagram on each page shows the typical sound image placement and the Surround
channel to Bus Out configuration.
3-1 Surround
5.1 Surround
6.1 Surround
Select the SURR/BUS SETUP button, then press the [ENTER] button to display the Surround Bus Setup page, which enables you to change the Surround Channel to Bus Out
assignment. See “Assigning Surround Channels to Buses” on page 99 for more information
on the Surround Bus Setup page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Surround Channels to Buses
99
Assigning Surround Channels to Buses
You can modify the Surround Channel to Bus assignment.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to locate the Surround Bus Setup
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the bus for which you want to change the
surround channel assignment, then use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC
buttons to select a surround channel.
INIT: These buttons reset the channel assignment to the default setting.
Using the Joystick
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers, and use the [SEL]
buttons to select the Input Channels.
PAN / SURROUND
DISPLAY
L
2
R
L
R
ODD
EVEN
LINK
GRAB
EFFECT
Press the [GRAB] button to grab the current Joystick position, and then use
the Joystick to set the surround pan.
This is used to turn on and off Joystick surround pan control for the currently selected Input
Channel. While Grab is on, the Joystick can be used to set the surround pan position of the
currently selected Input Channel. If the Joystick is set to control effects (i.e., the [EFFECT]
button indicator is lit), the [GRAB] button is disabled.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
100
Chapter 7—Input Channels
Selected Channel Surround Edit Page
Surround pan settings can be viewed and set on the Input Channel Surround Edit page. If
the Auto PAN/SURROUND Display preference is on, and a Surround Pan mode other than
Stereo is selected, this page appears automatically when a PAN/SURROUND control other
than the [EFFECT] button is operated. See “Auto PAN/SURROUND Display” on page 275.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND [DISPLAY] button to select
the Surround Edit page.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers, and use the [SEL]
buttons to select the Input Channels.
The Surround Edit page displays surround pan parameters for the currently selected Input
Channel and its horizontal or vertical partner. The current surround pan position of each
Input Channel is indicated by a small circle. It’s also indicated numerically next to each
Input Channel number, for example, “CH1 (L9, R10).”
The graph of the currently selected Input Channel displays a small square, which indicates
the current position of the Joystick. If the Auto Grab preference is on (see page 276), when
the Joystick is moved to the current surround pan position, the Joystick kicks in as surround
pan control and the small square disappears.
The number of speaker icons and meters around the surround graph depends on the currently selected Surround mode. The meters indicate Bus Out signal levels.
You can move the surround pan directly to one of the speaker icons, including the box icons
without speakers, by selecting its icon, and then pressing [ENTER].
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
Patterns: These buttons are used to select the seven patterns that determine how the surround pan moves by the Parameter wheel and INC/DEC buttons.
FAST: This sets the speed of surround pan control when using the Parameter wheel and
INC/DEC buttons.
WIDTH: This sets the left-to-right width of the selected pattern.
DEPTH: This sets the front-to-rear depth of the selected pattern.
WIDTH OFFSET: This can be used to offset the left-to-right direction of the selected pattern.
DEPTH OFFSET: This can be used to offset the front-to-rear direction of the selected pattern.
LFE: This sets the level of the LFE (Low Frequency Effects) Channel (5.1 and 6.1 mode
only).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Surround Channels to Buses
101
DIV (divergence): This determines how the Center signal is fed to the Left, Right, and
Center channels. When set to 0, the Center signal is fed only to the Left and Right channels
(i.e., Phantom Center). When set to 50, the Center signal is fed equally to the Left, Right,
and Center channels. When set to 100, it’s fed to only the Center channel (i.e., Real Center)
(3-1 and 5.1 mode only).
DIV F/R: The F parameter control determines how the Front Center signal is fed to the Left
and Right channels. The R parameter control determines how the rear surround signal is
fed to the Left and Right surround channels (only for 6.1 surround).
DIV LINK: When DIV LINK is on, the F and R parameter controls are set to the same value
and linked to each other (only for 6.1 Surround).
ST LINK: This can be used to link the surround pan parameters of the currently selected
Input Channel and its horizontal or vertical partner regardless of whether they are paired.
PATTERN: When Input Channels are linked, the eight patterns selectable here determine
how the linked surround pan moves by the Parameter wheel and INC/DEC buttons.
Input Channel Surround Pages
Surround pan positions can be viewed and set on the Surround pages.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND [DISPLAY] button to select
the Input Channel Surround pages.
The Surround parameters for the 96 Input Channels are arranged into four pages. The
Input Channel 1–24 Surround page is shown below. The layout of the other three pages is
the same.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the Surround parameters, and use the
Parameter wheel and INC/DEC buttons to set them.
Input Channels can also be selected by using the Input Channel Layer buttons and [SEL]
buttons. The graph for the currently selected Input Channel displays a small square, which
indicates the current position of the Joystick.
L/R: These parameters are used to set the left/right surround position. While selected, they
can quickly be set to center by pressing [ENTER].
F/R: These parameters are used to set the front/rear surround position. While selected, they
can quickly be set to center by pressing [ENTER].
You can jump to the more detailed Surround Edit page by pressing [ENTER] while an Input
Channel’s surround graph is selected.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
102
Chapter 7—Input Channels
Sending Input Channels to Aux Sends
Input Channel signals can be sent to Aux Sends 1–12. See “Setting Aux Send Levels” on
page 111, “Muting Aux Sends (ON/OFF)” on page 112, and “Pre-Fader or Post-Fader Aux
Sends” on page 111.
Soloing Input Channels
Input Channels can be soloed. See page 142 for more information.
Direct Outs
Each Input Channel features a Direct Out, which can be patched to the Slot Outputs, Omni
Outs, or the 2TR Digital Outputs. Direct Out signals can be sourced pre-EQ, pre-fader, or
post-fader. See “Patching Direct Outs” on page 81 and “Routing Input Channels” on
page 93 for more information.
Pairing Input Channels
Horizontal or vertical Input Channel partners can be paired for stereo operation. See “Pairing Channels” on page 144 for more information.
Viewing Input Channel Settings
Parameter and fader settings for each Input Channel can be viewed on the View pages. See
“Viewing Channel Parameter Settings” on page 150 and “Viewing Channel Fader Settings”
on page 151 for more information.
Copying Input Channel Settings
Input Channel settings can be copied to other Input Channels by using the Channel Copy
function. See “Copying Channel Settings” on page 155 for more information.
Naming Input Channels
Input Channels can be named for easy identification. See “Naming Channels” on page 156
for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Using the MS Stereo Microphone
103
Using the MS Stereo Microphone
The MS system is a type of stereo recording that uses two microphones: mono-directional
M (Middle) and bi-directional S (Side) microphones. An M microphone picks up main signals, and an S microphone picks up directional signals. These two signals are decoded by
calculating a sum (M plus S) and a difference (M minus S), and are recorded to L and R
channels.
An MS microphone is usually a stereo microphone that features both M and S functions.
To use an MS microphone, do the following:
1
Connect the L connector of an MS microphone to an odd channel input jack,
and the R connector to an even channel input jack.
Signals from the MS microphone are
MS microphone
input from the L and R connectors. To
use an MS microphone with the
DM2000, connect the L connector to
the input jack of an odd Input Channel, and connect the R connector to
the input jack of the partner channel.
R connector
L connector
2
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [PAIR] button to locate the Pair pages.
3
Turn on the MS button for the channels to which the MS microphone is connected.
The two channels are automatically paired and MS Decoding is turned on. With MS Decoding turned on, the faders and Encoders (Pan parameters) function as follows:
• Odd-channel faders.................M level (Controls the volume level.)
• Odd-channel Encoders ...........ML/MR balance
• Even-channel faders ................S level (Controls the left and right directional spread.)
• Even-channel Encoders ..........SL/SR balance
4
Use the faders and Encoders to adjust the MS microphone level and balance.
When the signals are routed to paired Buses or the Stereo Bus, a sum of signals (ML plus
SL) is sent to the odd-numbered Bus, and a difference of signals (ML minus SL) is sent to
the even-numbered Bus.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
104
Chapter 8—Stereo Out
8 Stereo Out
Stereo Out Connectors
The Stereo Out is output by the STEREO OUT +4 dB (BAL) balanced
XLR-3-32-type connectors and the STEREO OUT –10 dBV (UNBAL)
unbalanced phono connectors.
Patching the Stereo Out to Outputs
The left and right channels of the Stereo Out can be patched to the Slot Outputs, Omni
Outs, or the 2TR Digital Outputs. See “Output Patching” on page 79 for more information.
Routing Input Channels to the Stereo Out
Input Channels can be routed and panned to the Stereo Out. See “Routing Input Channels”
on page 93 for more information.
Sending Bus Outs to the Stereo Out
Bus Out signals can be sent to the Stereo Out. See “Sending Bus Outs to the Stereo Out” on
page 109 for more information.
Metering the Stereo Out
Stereo Out signal levels can be metered on the Meter pages. See “Metering” on page 127 for
more information.
Monitoring the Stereo Out
The Stereo Out can be monitored via the LARGE and SMALL CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUTs and the PHONES (see page 158) or the STUDIO MONITOR OUT (see
page 159).
Attenuating the Stereo Out
Stereo Out signals can be attenuated pre-EQ. See “Attenuating Signals” on page 130 for
more information.
EQ’ing the Stereo Out
The Stereo Out features 4-band parametric EQ. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for more information.
Grouping Master EQs
The Stereo Out EQ can be grouped with the EQs of other Output Channels. See “Grouping
Output Channel EQs” on page 135 for more information.
Stereo Out Inserts
Internal effects processors and external signal processors can be patched into the Stereo Out
by using the Inserts. See “Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
105
Compressing the Stereo Out
Compressing the Stereo Out
Signal dynamics can be controlled by using the Stereo Out Compressor. See “Compressing
Channels” on page 137 for more information.
Grouping Master Compressors
The Stereo Out Compressor can be grouped with the Compressors of other Output Channels. See “Grouping Output Channel Compressors” on page 140 for more information.
Muting the Stereo Out (ON/OFF)
ON
The Stereo Out can be muted by using the STEREO [ON] button, which is used
exclusively for this task and is not affected by the Layers. Its indicator lights up
when the Stereo Out is on.
Grouping Master Mutes (ON/OFF)
The Stereo Out Mute can be grouped with the Mutes of other Output Channels. See
“Grouping Output Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)” on page 149 for more information.
Setting the Stereo Out Level
The Stereo Out level is set by using the STEREO fader, which is used exclusively for this task and is not affected by the Layers or Fader modes.
0
5
10
15
20
30
40
50
60
70
Grouping Master Faders
STEREO
The Stereo Out fader can be grouped with the faders of other Output Channels. See
“Grouping Output Channel Faders” on page 146 for more information.
Sending the Stereo Out to the Matrix Sends
The left and right channels of the Stereo Out can be sent individually to the Matrix Sends.
See “Matrix Sends” on page 121 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
106
Chapter 8—Stereo Out
Balancing the Stereo Out
The left and right channels of the Stereo Out can be balanced as follows.
1
Press the STEREO [SEL] button to select the Stereo Out.
PAN / SURROUND
DISPLAY
L
2
L
R
ODD
EVEN
R
Use the Pan control to set the balance.
The pan display indicates the balance. When the balance is set to center, the center two segments light up.
The Stereo Out balance can also be set on the Stereo Fader View page. See “Viewing Channel
Fader Settings” on page 151 for more information.
Delaying the Stereo Out
The left and right channels of the Stereo Out can be delayed independently by using the Stereo Out Delay. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page 141 for more information.
Inserting GEQs
Internal GEQs can be inserted into the left and right channels of the Stereo Out. See “About
the GEQs” on page 183 for more information.
Viewing Stereo Out Settings
Parameter and fader settings for the Stereo Out can be viewed and set on the View pages.
See “Viewing Channel Parameter Settings” on page 150 and “Viewing Channel Fader Settings” on page 151 for more information.
Copying Stereo Out Settings
Settings can be copied between the left and right channels of the Stereo Out by using the
Channel Copy function. See “Copying Channel Settings” on page 155 for more information.
Naming the Stereo Out
The Stereo Out can be named for easy identification. See “Naming Channels” on page 156
for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Bus Outs
107
9 Bus Outs
Patching Bus Outs to Outputs
Bus Outs can be patched to the Slot Outputs, Omni Outs, or the 2TR Digital Outputs. See
“Output Patching” on page 79 for more information.
Routing Input Channels to Bus Outs
Input Channels can be routed to the Bus Outs. See “Routing Input Channels” on page 93
for more information.
Metering Bus Outs
Bus Out signal levels can be metered on the Meter pages. See “Metering” on page 127 for
more information.
Monitoring Bus Outs
Bus Outs can be assigned to the CONTROL ROOM [ASSIGN 1] or [ASSIGN 2] button for
monitoring. See “Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
Attenuating Bus Outs
Bus Out signals can be attenuated pre-EQ. See “Attenuating Signals” on page 130 for more
information.
EQ’ing Bus Outs
Each Bus Out features 4-band parametric EQ. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for more information.
Grouping Master EQs
Bus Out EQs can be grouped with the EQs of other Output Channels. See “Grouping Output Channel EQs” on page 135 for more information.
Bus Out Inserts
Internal effects processors and external signal processors can be patched into the Bus Outs
by using the Inserts. See “Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
Compressing Bus Outs
Signal dynamics can be controlled by using the Bus Out Compressors. See “Compressing
Channels” on page 137 for more information.
Grouping Master Compressors
Bus Out Compressors can be grouped with the Compressors of other Output Channels. See
“Grouping Output Channel Compressors” on page 140 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
108
Chapter 9—Bus Outs
Muting Bus Outs (ON/OFF)
Bus Outs can be muted by using the channel strip [ON] buttons.
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Use channel strip [ON] buttons 1–8 to mute the Bus Outs.
The [ON] button indicators of Bus Outs that are on light up.
ON
Grouping Master Mutes (ON/OFF)
Bus Out Mutes can be grouped with the Mutes of other Output Channels. See “Grouping
Output Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)” on page 149 for more information.
Setting Bus Out Levels
Bus Out levels can be set as follows.
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Press the FADER MODE [FADER] button to select Fader mode.
3
Use faders 1–8 to set the Bus Out levels.
Refer to the legend on the right side of the faders when setting Bus Out levels.
10
0
5
5
0
10
5
15
10
20
15
30
20
40
30
50
40
60
50
70
Grouping Master Faders
Bus Out faders can be grouped with the faders of other Output Channels. See “Grouping
Output Channel Faders” on page 146 for more information.
Sending Bus Outs to Matrix Sends
Bus Out signals can be sent to the Matrix Sends. See “Matrix Sends” on page 121 for more
information.
Delaying Bus Outs
Each Bus Out features a Delay function. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page 141 for
more information.
Inserting GEQs
Internal GEQs can be inserted into the Bus Outs. See “About the GEQs” on page 183 for
more information.
Soloing Bus Outs
Bus Outs can be soloed. See page 142 for more information.
Pairing Bus Outs
Bus Outs can be paired for stereo operation. See “Pairing Channels” on page 144 for more
information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Sending Bus Outs to the Stereo Out
109
Sending Bus Outs to the Stereo Out
Bus Outs can be routed to the Stereo Out buses as follows. Bus Out to Stereo Out settings
can be stored in the Bus to Stereo library, which contains 1 preset memory and 32 user
memories. See “Bus to Stereo Library” on page 169 for more information.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL ROUTING [DISPLAY] button to locate the Bus
to Stereo page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
PAN: These controls are used to pan the Bus Out signals between the left and right Stereo
Out buses. The currently selected Pan control can be set to center by pressing [ENTER].
ON/OFF: These buttons are used to turn on and off the Bus Out to Stereo Out routing.
Faders: These faders are used to set the Bus Out to Stereo Out levels. Fader knobs appear
highlighted when faders are set to 0.0 dB.
Press the [ENTER] button to set the currently-selected fader to 0.0 dB. You can copy the
currently-selected fader position to other faders by double-clicking the [ENTER] button.
Viewing Bus Out Settings
Parameter and fader settings for each Bus Out can be viewed and set on the View pages. See
“Viewing Channel Parameter Settings” on page 150 and “Viewing Channel Fader Settings”
on page 151 for more information.
Copying Bus Out Settings
Bus Out settings can be copied to other Bus Outs by using the Channel Copy function. See
“Copying Channel Settings” on page 155 for more information.
Naming Bus Outs
Bus Outs can be named for easy identification. See “Naming Channels” on page 156 for
more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
110
Chapter 10—Aux Sends
10 Aux Sends
Patching Aux Send Masters to Outputs
Aux Send Masters can be patched to the Slot Outputs, Omni Outs, or the 2TR Digital Outputs. See “Output Patching” on page 79 for more information.
Setting the Aux Send Mode
Aux Sends have two operating modes—Variable and Fixed—which can be set individually
for each of the 12 Aux Sends. In Variable mode, Aux Send levels are variable and the signal
source point can be either pre-fader or post-fader. In Fixed mode, Aux Send levels are fixed
at nominal and the signal source point is fixed to post-fader.
1
Use the AUX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Aux Send pages.
The Aux Send parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided among four pages. The
Input Channel 1–24 Aux Send page is shown below: Variable mode on the left, Fixed mode
on the right. The layout of the other three pages is the same.
On the Fixed mode page, “GLOBAL POST” is displayed in the lower-right corner, indicating that the Aux Send Pre/Post parameter is fixed at Post.
2
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons to select Aux Sends 1–12.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the FIXED and VARIABLE buttons, and press
[ENTER] to select a mode.
When the Aux mode is changed, the parameters of the selected Aux Send are set as follows.
Parameters
Level
Change from Variable to Fixed
Change from Fixed to Variable
All set to nominal
All set to –∞
Pre/Post
On/Off
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
All set to Post
All turned off
All turned on
Pre-Fader or Post-Fader Aux Sends
111
Pre-Fader or Post-Fader Aux Sends
Aux Sends can be configured individually as either pre-fader or post-fader on the Aux Send
pages (see page 112) or the Aux View pages (see page 115). If Aux Sends are configured as
pre-fader, you can position the send points before or after the [ON] buttons.
Setting Aux Send Levels
Aux Send levels can be set by using the SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND
LEVEL controls, the faders, or the Encoders.
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND LEVEL Controls
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers, and use the [SEL]
buttons to select Input Channels.
2
Use the [BANK] button to select Aux 1–4, Aux 5–8, or Aux 9–12.
3
Use the LEVEL controls to set the Aux Send levels.
AUX / MATRIX SEND
DISPLAY
LEVEL
BANK
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
ON
ON
ON
ON
AUX 1 / MATRIX 1
AUX 2 / MATRIX 2
AUX 3 / MATRIX 3
AUX 4 / MATRIX 4
AUX 5
AUX 6
AUX 7
AUX 8
AUX 9
AUX 10
AUX 11
AUX 12
Using the Faders
10
0
5
5
0
10
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
2
Press the FADER MODE [AUX/MTRX] button to select the Aux/Mtrx
Fader mode.
5
15
10
20
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons to select Aux Sends
1–12.
15
30
20
40
30
50
40
60
50
70
3
4
Use the faders to set the Aux Send levels.
Refer to the legend on the left side of the faders when setting Aux Send levels.
Using the Encoders
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers.
2
Press the ENCODER MODE [AUX/MTRX] button to select the Aux/Mtrx
Encoder mode.
3
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons to select Aux Sends 1–12.
4
Use the Encoders to set the Aux Send levels.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
112
Chapter 10—Aux Sends
Muting Aux Sends (ON/OFF)
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers, and use the [SEL]
buttons to select the Input Channels.
2
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND [BANK] button to select
Aux 1–4, Aux 5–8, or Aux 9–12.
3
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND [ON] buttons to turn the
Aux Sends of the selected Input Channel on or off.
AUX / MATRIX SEND
DISPLAY
LEVEL
BANK
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
ON
ON
ON
ON
AUX 1 / MATRIX 1
AUX 2 / MATRIX 2
AUX 3 / MATRIX 3
AUX 4 / MATRIX 4
AUX 5
AUX 6
AUX 7
AUX 8
AUX 9
AUX 10
AUX 11
AUX 12
Aux Send Pages
You can view and set the Aux Send parameters of all Input Channels on the Aux Send pages.
Operation of the Aux Send pages in Variable and Fixed mode is explained separately.
Variable Mode
See page 110 for information on how to select Variable Aux mode.
1
Use the AUX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Aux Send pages.
The Aux Send parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided among four pages. The
Input Channel 1–24 Aux Send page in Variable mode is shown below. The layout of the
other three pages is the same.
2
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons to select Aux Sends 1–12.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the Input Channel Aux Send controls.
Input Channels can also be selected by using the Input Channel Layer buttons and [SEL]
buttons.
4
To turn Aux Sends on and off, select the rotary controls, and press [ENTER].
The rotary controls of Aux Sends that are turned off, appear gray, and “OFF” appears in
place of the level value. Aux Send levels can still be changed even when Aux Sends are off.
5
To set Aux Send levels, select the rotary controls, and use the Parameter
wheel or INC/DEC buttons.
To set Aux Send levels for all Input Channels to nominal, select the ALL NOMINAL button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Aux Send Pages
113
6
To set the Pre Fader and Post Fader parameters, select the PRE/POST buttons, then use the [ENTER] button or INC/DEC buttons.
7
To set all Input Channels for the selected Aux Send to pre-fader or post-fader
simultaneously, select the GLOBAL PRE or POST button, and then press
[ENTER].
The PRE or POST button is highlighted, and remains highlighted as long as all Input Channel pre or post settings remain unchanged, so you can quickly see if all Input Channels are
set to either pre-fader or post-fader.
8
If you selected pre-fader, turn on the PRE ON button or POST ON button to
set the Pre point before or after each channel’s [ON] button.
Fixed Mode
See page 110 for information on how to select Fixed Aux mode.
1
Use the AUX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Aux Send pages.
The Input Channel 1–24 Aux Send page in Fixed mode is shown below. The layout of the
other three Aux Send pages in Fixed mode is the same.
2
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons to select Aux Sends 1–12.
3
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the Aux Send buttons.
Input Channels can also be selected by using the Input Channel Layer buttons and [SEL]
buttons.
4
Use the [ENTER] button or INC/DEC buttons to turn Aux Sends on and off.
If the Fader mode is set to Aux/Mtrx, the faders provide a visual indication of the On/Off
status of each Input Channel for the currently selected Aux Send. For Aux Sends that are on,
faders move to the nominal position. Aux Sends that are off, they move to the –∞ position.
On/Off settings cannot be changed by using the faders.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
114
Chapter 10—Aux Sends
Viewing Aux Send Settings
You can view and set settings of all Aux Sends on the Aux View pages. Level and Pre/Post
parameters are displayed separately. If the Auto AUX/MATRIX Display preference is on, and
an Input Channel is currently selected, these pages appear automatically when a
SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND control is operated. See “Auto
AUX/MATRIX Display” on page 275 for more information.
Level Parameters
In Level mode, the Aux View pages display Aux Send Level and On/Off parameters. Fixed
mode Aux Sends can be turned on and off only.
1
Use the AUX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Aux View pages.
2
Select the DISPLAY LEVEL button, and press [ENTER].
The Aux View parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided among four pages. The
Input Channel 1–24 Aux View page is shown below in Level mode. The layout of the other
three pages is the same.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the Input Channel Aux Sends.
Input Channels can also be selected by using the Input Channel Layer buttons and [SEL]
buttons. Aux Sends can also be selected by using the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons.
4
Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to set the Aux Send levels.
5
Use the [ENTER] button to turn on and off the selected Aux Send.
The various Aux View page indicators are as follows:
Send level set to –∞, or Fixed mode Aux Send set to off.
Send level bar.
Send set to off.
Send level set to nominal.
Send off, level set to nominal.
Fixed mode Aux Send set to on.
In Variable Aux mode, the Level and On/Off parameter values for the selected Aux Send are
displayed in the lower-right corner of the page, for example, “LEVEL: –2.0 dB ON/OFF:
ON.”
In Fixed Aux mode, the On/Off parameter values for the selected Aux Send are displayed in
the lower-right corner of the page, for example, “LEVEL: FIXED ON/OFF: ON.”
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Viewing Aux Send Settings
115
Pre/Post Parameters
In Pre/Post mode, the Aux View pages display Aux Send Pre/Post parameters. Fixed mode
Aux Sends can be turned on and off only.
1
Use the AUX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Aux View pages.
2
Select the DISPLAY PRE/POST button, and press [ENTER].
The Input Channel 1–24 Aux View page is shown below in Pre/Post mode. The layout of the
other three Aux View pages in Pre/Post mode is the same.
3
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the Input Channel Aux
Sends.
Input Channels can also be selected by using the Input Channel Layer buttons and [SEL]
buttons. Aux Sends can also be selected by using the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons.
4
Use the [ENTER] button or INC/DEC buttons to set the selected Aux Send to
either pre-fader or post-fader.
The various Aux View page indicators are as follows:
Aux Send configured pre-fader.
Aux Send configured post-fader.
Fixed mode Aux Send.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
116
Chapter 10—Aux Sends
Panning Aux Sends
When Aux Sends are paired, Aux Sends can be panned between the paired Aux buses. See
“Pairing Channels” on page 144 for more information. If the selected Aux Send is not
paired, the message “AUXx–x are not paired” appears.
If the currently selected pair of Aux Send Masters is set to Follow Surround on the Output
Pair page, Aux Sends follow the Input Channel Surround Pan settings and cannot be set
here, in which case the message “AUX x-x are Following Surround” appears. See “Pairing
Aux Sends” on page 120 for more information.
1
Use the AUX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Aux Pan pages.
The Aux Pan parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided among four pages. The
Input Channel 1–24 Aux Pan page is shown below. The layout of the other three pages is the
same.
2
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons to select the Aux Sends 1–12.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select Input Channel Aux Send pan controls, and
use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to set them.
Input Channels can also be selected by using the Input Channel Layer buttons and [SEL]
buttons.
The currently selected Pan control can be set to center by pressing [ENTER].
MODE: There are three Pan modes that determine how paired Aux Sends are panned:
Individual, Gang, and Inverse Gang. This is an individual setting that applies to each send
in a pair of Aux Sends.
In individual mode, Aux Send pan controls operate independently.
In Gang mode, the Aux Send pan controls of paired Input Channels operate in
unison.
In Inverse Gang mode, the Aux Send pan controls of paired Input Channels
operate in unison but move in opposite directions.
INPUT PAN LINK: This is used to link Aux Send Pan controls to Input Channel Pan controls so that operating an Input Channel Pan control also operates the corresponding Aux
Send Pan control, and vice versa. This can be set individually for each pair of Aux Send Masters. When a link is established, the pan positions and Pan mode of the Input Channels are
copied to the Aux Sends. While linked, the Pan mode can be set from either the Aux Pan
page or the Input Channel Pan page (see page 96). The Pan mode setting for Aux Sends is
linked to the Pan mode setting for Input Channels.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Excluding Certain Channels from Aux Sends (Mix Minus)
117
Excluding Certain Channels from Aux Sends (Mix Minus)
You can quickly exclude certain channel signals from Aux Sends by using the controls on
the top panel. This operation is called “Mix Minus.”
For example, when Aux Sends are being used as monitors for the musicians or a narrator,
you can turn off the audio signals of the musicians or narrator, excluding them from the
monitor sound.
1
Press and hold down the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons of the
desired Aux Sends.
The [ON] button indicators in the channel strip remain lit while you hold down the button.
This means that signals routed from channels with a lit [ON] button indicator to the Aux
Send are turned on.
Note: If you release the AUX SELECT button before you proceed to Step 2, you will be unable
to complete the Mix Minus operation.
2
Press the [ON] buttons of the Input Channels you wish to exclude from the
Aux Send. You can select multiple channels.
The selected channels’ [ON] button indicators turn off, and signals routed from those
channels to the corresponding Aux Send are turned off. “MIX MINUS FOR AUX * ”
appears at the bottom of the screen. (The asterisk represents an Aux number.)
Tip: At this time, the Send Level controls on the Aux Send page are grayed out.
3
To reset the setting, while pressing and holding down the AUX SELECT
[AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons you pressed in Step 1, press the [ON] buttons you
pressed in Step 2.
The corresponding [ON] button indicators light up.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
118
Chapter 10—Aux Sends
Copying Channel Fader Positions to Aux Sends
While Aux Sends are in Variable mode, you can copy all Input Channel fader positions on
one layer to the corresponding Aux Sends.
This is convenient when you wish to send to the musicians monitor signals that have the
same balance setting as the Stereo Out signals.
1
Locate the copy source layer button from the Input Channel Layer buttons,
then press and hold down the button.
Note: If you release the button in the LAYER section before you proceed to Step 2, you will be
unable to complete the Copy operation.
2
Press one of the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons to select the desired
Aux Send copy destination.
The confirmation message appears.
3
To execute the Copy operation, move the cursor to the [YES] button, then
press [ENTER].
To cancel the Copy operation, move the cursor to the [NO] button, then press [ENTER].
Tip: If the copy destination Input Channel has been paired with a vertical partner in another
Layer, the fader position will be copied to the partner’s Aux Send.
Metering Aux Send Masters
Aux Send Master levels can be metered on the Meter pages. See “Metering” on page 127 for
more information.
Monitoring Aux Send Masters
Aux Send Masters can be assigned to the CONTROL ROOM [ASSIGN 1] or [ASSIGN 2]
button for monitoring. See “Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information. Aux 11 and Aux 12 can be monitored via the STUDIO MONITOR OUT (see
page 159).
Attenuating Aux Send Masters
Aux Send Master signals can be attenuated pre-EQ. See “Attenuating Signals” on page 130
for more information.
EQ’ing Aux Send Masters
Each Aux Send Master features 4-band parametric EQ. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for
more information.
Grouping Master EQs
Aux Send Master EQs can be grouped with the EQs of other Output Channels. See “Grouping Output Channel EQs” on page 135 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
119
Aux Send Master Inserts
Aux Send Master Inserts
Internal effects processors and external signal processors can be patched into the Aux Send
Masters by using the Inserts. See “Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
Compressing Aux Send Masters
Signal dynamics can be controlled by using the Aux Send Master Compressors. See “Compressing Channels” on page 137 for more information.
Grouping Master Compressors
Aux Send Master Compressors can be grouped with the Compressors of other Output
Channels. See “Grouping Output Channel Compressors” on page 140 for more information.
Muting Aux Send Masters (ON/OFF)
Aux Send Masters can be muted as follows.
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Use channel strip [ON] buttons 9–20 to mute the Aux Send Masters.
The [ON] button indicators of Aux Send Masters that are on light up.
ON
Grouping Master Mutes (ON/OFF)
Aux Send Master Mutes can be grouped with the Mutes of other Output Channels. See
“Grouping Output Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)” on page 149 for more information.
Settings Aux Send Master Levels
Aux Send Master levels can be set as follows.
10
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Press the FADER MODE [FADER] button to select the Fader mode.
3
Use faders 9–20 to set the Aux Send Master levels.
Refer to the legend on the right side of the faders when setting Aux Send Master
levels.
Grouping Master Faders
0
5
5
0
10
5
15
10
20
15
30
20
40
30
50
40
60
50
70
Aux Send Master faders can be grouped with the faders of other Output Channels.
See “Grouping Output Channel Faders” on page 146 for more information.
Sending Aux Sends to Matrix Sends
Aux Send Master signals can be sent to the Matrix Sends. See “Matrix Sends” on page 121
for more information.
Delaying Aux Send Masters
Each Aux Send Master features a Delay function. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page
141 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
120
Chapter 10—Aux Sends
Inserting GEQs
Internal GEQs can be inserted into the Aux Send Masters. See “About the GEQs” on page
183 for more information.
Soloing Aux Sends
Aux Sends can be soloed. See page 142 for more information.
Pairing Aux Sends
Aux Sends can be paired for stereo operation. See “Pairing Channels” on page 144 for more
information.
Viewing Aux Send Master Settings
Parameter and fader settings for each Aux Send Master can be viewed and set on the View
pages. See “Viewing Channel Parameter Settings” on page 150 and “Viewing Channel Fader
Settings” on page 151 for more information.
Copying Aux Send Master Settings
Aux Send Master settings can be copied to other Aux Sends by using the Channel Copy
function. See “Copying Channel Settings” on page 155 for more information.
Naming Aux Send Masters
Aux Send Masters can be named for easy identification. See “Naming Channels” on page
156 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Matrix Sends
121
11 Matrix Sends
Patching Matrix Send Masters to Outputs
The left and right channels of the Matrix Send Masters can be patched to the Slot Outputs,
Omni Outs, or the 2TR Digital Outputs. See “Output Patching” on page 79 for more information.
Pre-Fader or Post-Fader Matrix Sends
Matrix Sends can be configured globally as either pre-fader or post-fader on the Matrix
View page. See “Viewing Matrix Send Settings” on page 124 for more information.
Setting Matrix Send Levels
Matrix Send levels can be set by using the SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND
LEVEL controls, the faders, or the Encoders.
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND LEVEL Controls
1
Use the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Use [SEL] buttons 1–20 to select the Bus Outs and Aux Sends, and use the
STEREO [SEL] button to select the Stereo Out.
The Matrix Sends for the left and right channels of the Stereo Out can be set individually.
Use the STEREO [SEL] button to select the left and right channels.
3
Use the LEVEL controls to set the Matrix Send levels.
AUX / MATRIX SEND
DISPLAY
LEVEL
BANK
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
ON
ON
ON
ON
AUX 1 / MATRIX 1
AUX 2 / MATRIX 2
AUX 3 / MATRIX 3
AUX 4 / MATRIX 4
AUX 5
AUX 6
AUX 7
AUX 8
AUX 9
AUX 10
AUX 11
AUX 12
Using the Faders
10
Stereo Out Matrix Sends cannot be set using the faders.
1
Use the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Press the FADER MODE [AUX/MTRX] button to select the Aux/Mtrx
Fader mode.
3
Use the MATRIX SELECT [1–4] buttons to select Matrix Sends 1–4.
4
Use faders 1–20 to set the Matrix Send levels.
Faders 21–24 are inactive because Matrix Send Masters do not feature Matrix Send
controls.
Refer to the legend on the left side of the faders when setting Matrix Send levels.
0
5
5
0
10
5
15
10
20
15
30
20
40
30
50
40
60
50
70
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
122
Chapter 11—Matrix Sends
Using the Encoders
Stereo Out Matrix Sends cannot be set using the Encoders.
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Press the ENCODER MODE [AUX/MTRX] button to select the Aux/Mtrx
Encoder mode.
3
Use the MATRIX SELECT [1–4] buttons to select Matrix Sends 1–4.
4
Use Encoders 1–20 to set the Matrix Send levels.
Encoders 21–24 are inactive because Matrix Send Masters do not feature Matrix
Send controls.
Muting Matrix Sends (ON/OFF)
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Use [SEL] buttons 1–20 to select the Bus Outs and Aux Sends, and use the
STEREO [SEL] button to select the Stereo Out.
The Matrix Sends for the left and right channels of the Stereo Out can be muted individually. Use the STEREO [SEL] button to select the left and right channels.
3
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND [ON] buttons to turn the
Matrix Sends on the selected Output Channel on and off.
AUX / MATRIX SEND
DISPLAY
LEVEL
BANK
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
ON
ON
ON
ON
AUX 1 / MATRIX 1
AUX 2 / MATRIX 2
AUX 3 / MATRIX 3
AUX 4 / MATRIX 4
AUX 5
AUX 6
AUX 7
AUX 8
AUX 9
AUX 10
AUX 11
AUX 12
Matrix Send Pages
Matrix Send parameters for the Bus Outs, Aux Sends, and the Stereo Out can be viewed and
set on the Matrix Send page.
1
Use the MATRIX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Matrix Send page.
2
Use the Matrix SELECT [1–4] buttons to select Matrix Sends 1–4.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the Output Channel Matrix Send controls.
If the Master Layer is selected, [SEL] buttons 1–20 can also be used to select Output Channels.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Panning Matrix Sends
123
4
To turn Matrix Sends on and off, select the rotary controls, and press
[ENTER].
The rotary controls of Matrix Sends that are turned off, appear gray, and “OFF” appears in
place of the level value. Matrix Send levels can still be changed even when Matrix Sends are
off.
5
To set Matrix Send levels, select the rotary controls, and use the Parameter
wheel or INC/DEC buttons.
ALL NOMINAL: This button resets the levels for all Matrix Sends to nominal.
Panning Matrix Sends
Matrix Sends can be panned on the Matrix Send Pan page. The Matrix Sends for the left and
right channels of the Stereo Out can be panned individually.
1
Use the MATRIX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Matrix Send Pan
page.
2
Use the MATRIX SELECT [1–4] buttons to select Matrix Sends 1–4.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select Output Channel Matrix Send pan controls,
and use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to set them.
If the Master Layer is currently selected, [SEL] buttons 1–20 can also be used to select Output Channels.
The currently selected Pan control can quickly be set to center by pressing [ENTER].
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
124
Chapter 11—Matrix Sends
Viewing Matrix Send Settings
You can view and set the Matrix Send Level and On/Off parameters of all Matrix Sends on
the Matrix View page. If the Auto AUX/MATRIX Display preference is on, and a Bus Out,
Aux Send, or the Stereo Out is currently selected, this page appears automatically when a
SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND control is operated. See “Auto
AUX/MATRIX Display” on page 275 for more information.
1
Use the MATRIX SELECT [DISPLAY] button to select the Matrix Send View
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the PRE FADER and POST FADER buttons,
and press [ENTER] to set all Matrix Sends to either pre-fader or post-fader.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the Output Channel Matrix Sends.
If the Master Layer is currently selected, [SEL] buttons 1–20 can also be used to select Output Channels. Matrix Sends can also be selected by using the MATRIX SELECT [1–4] buttons.
4
Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to set the levels of the Matrix
Sends.
5
Use the [ENTER] button to turn on and off the selected Matrix Send.
The various Matrix View page indicators are as follows:
Send level set to –∞.
Send level bar.
Send set to off.
Send level set to nominal.
Send off, level set to nominal.
The level in dB and the on/off values of the currently selected Matrix Send are displayed in
the lower-right corner of the page.
Metering Matrix Send Masters
Matrix Send Master levels can be metered on the Meter pages. See “Metering” on page 127
for more information.
Monitoring Matrix Send Masters
Matrix Send Masters can be assigned to the CONTROL ROOM [ASSIGN 1] or [ASSIGN 2]
button for monitoring. See “Control Room Monitoring” on page 158 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Attenuating Matrix Send Masters
125
Attenuating Matrix Send Masters
Matrix Send Master signals can be attenuated pre-EQ. See “Attenuating Signals” on page
130 for more information.
EQ’ing Matrix Send Masters
Each Matrix Send Master features 4-band parametric EQ. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for
more information.
Grouping Master EQs
Matrix Send Master EQs can be grouped with the EQs of other Output Channels. See
“Grouping Output Channel EQs” on page 135 for more information.
Matrix Send Master Inserts
Internal effects processors and external signal processors can be patched into the Matrix
Send Masters by using the Inserts. See “Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
Compressing Matrix Send Masters
Signal dynamics can be controlled by using the Matrix Send Master Compressors. See
“Compressing Channels” on page 137 for more information.
Grouping Master Compressors
Matrix Send Master Compressors can be grouped with the Compressors of other Output
Channels. See “Grouping Output Channel Compressors” on page 140 for more information.
Muting Matrix Send Masters (ON/OFF)
Matrix Send Masters can be muted as follows.
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Use channel strip [ON] buttons 21–24 to mute the Matrix Sends Masters.
The [ON] button indicators of Matrix Send Masters that are on light up.
ON
Grouping Master Mutes (ON/OFF)
Matrix Send Master Mutes can be grouped with the Mutes of other Output Channels. See
“Grouping Output Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)” on page 149 for more information.
Setting Matrix Send Master Levels
10
Matrix Send Master levels can be set as follows.
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer.
2
Press the FADER MODE [FADER] button to select the Fader mode.
3
Use faders 21–24 to set the Matrix Send Master levels.
Refer to the legend on the right side of the faders when setting Matrix Send Master
levels.
0
5
5
0
10
5
15
10
20
15
30
20
40
30
50
40
60
50
70
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
126
Chapter 11—Matrix Sends
Grouping Master Faders
Matrix Send Master faders can be grouped with the faders of other Output Channels. See
“Grouping Output Channel Faders” on page 146 for more information.
Balancing Matrix Send Masters
The left and right channels of the Matrix Send Masters can be balanced as follows.
1
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button to select the Master Layer, and use [SEL]
buttons 21–24 to select the Matrix Send Masters.
PAN / SURROUND
DISPLAY
L
2
L
R
ODD
EVEN
R
Use the Pan control to set the balance of the currently selected Matrix Send
Master.
The pan display indicates the balance. When the balance is set to center, the center two segments light up. Balance can be set to center by pressing [ENTER].
Matrix Send Master balance can also be set on the Matrix Fader View pages. See “Viewing
Channel Fader Settings” on page 151 for more information.
Delaying Matrix Send Masters
Each Matrix Send Master features a Delay function. See “Delaying Channel Signals” on page
141 for more information.
Soloing Matrix Sends
Matrix Sends can be soloed. See page 142 for more information.
Inserting GEQs
Internal GEQs can be inserted into the left and right channels of the Matrix Send Masters.
See “About the GEQs” on page 183 for more information.
Viewing Matrix Send Master Settings
Parameter and fader settings for each Matrix Send Master can be viewed and set on the View
pages. See “Viewing Channel Parameter Settings” on page 150 and “Viewing Channel Fader
Settings” on page 151 for more information.
Copying Matrix Send Master Settings
Matrix Send Master settings can be copied to other Matrix Sends by using the Channel
Copy function. See “Copying Channel Settings” on page 155 for more information.
Naming Matrix Send Masters
Matrix Send Masters can be named for easy identification. See “Naming Channels” on page
156 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Common Channel Functions
127
12 Common Channel Functions
Metering
Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, the Stereo Out, and the Effects processors can be metered on the various Meter pages, which are located by using the DISPLAY
ACCESS [METER] button.
Input and Output Channel Meter pages also display fader positions numerically. The Peak
Hold function, which applies to all level meters, can be turned on or off on any of the Meter
pages.
Setting the Metering Position
Input and Output Channels can be metered pre-EQ, pre-fader, or post-fader. This setting,
which can be set independently for the Input and Output Channels, can be set on the
Metering Position page shown below, or any of the Input and Output Channel Meter pages.
PRE EQ: Channels are metered pre-EQ.
PRE FADER: Channels are metered pre-fader.
POST FADER: Channels are metered post-fader.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
128
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
Metering Input Channels
There are two types of Input Channel Meter page: 24-channel and 48-channel.
There are four 24-channel Meter pages. The Input Channel 1–24 Meter page is shown
below. The layout of the other three pages is the same. These pages feature two level meters
for each Input Channel. When Input Channels are vertically paired, both meters operate.
When Input Channels are horizontally paired, only the left-hand meter operates.
GATE GR: The meters indicate the gain reduction being applied by the Gate.
COMP GR: The meters indicate the gain reduction being applied by the Compressor.
There are two 48-channel Meter pages. The Input Channel 1–48 Meter page is shown below.
The layout of the other page is the same.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Metering
129
Metering Output Channels
Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out can all be metered on the Master
Meter page.
Metering Effects
There are two Effects Input/Output Meter pages: Effects 1–8 and Effects 1–2.
The Effects 1–8 Input/Output Meter page features two input and output level meters for
each of the internal effects processors.
The Effects 1–2 Input/Output Meter page features individual level meters for the eight
inputs and outputs of internal effects processors #1 and #2.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
130
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
Metering the Stereo out
The Stereo Out can be metered on the Stereo Meter page. Peak signal levels for the left and
right channels are displayed numerically.
Attenuating Signals
Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out all feature pre-EQ
attenuation, which is useful for attenuating “hot” signals before EQ’ing.
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL EQUALIZER ATT Control
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
2
Use the ATT control to set the amount of attenuation.
Attenuator Pages
ATT.
Attenuator settings can be viewed and set on the Attenuator pages.
1
Use the EQUALIZER [DISPLAY] button to select the Attenuator pages.
The Attenuator parameters for the 96 Input Channels are arranged into four pages. The
Input Channel 1–24 Attenuator/Shifter page is shown below. The layout of the other three
pages is the same.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Using EQ
131
The attenuator parameters for the Output Channels appear on the Output Attenuator page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the channels, and use the Parameter wheel
or INC/DEC buttons to set the amount of attenuation.
Input and Output Channels can also be selected by using the LAYER and [SEL] buttons.
You can copy the currently selected Input or Output Channel attenuation setting to all
Input or Output Channels respectively by double-clicking the [ENTER] button.
For Input Channels, you can also set the amount of attenuation in bits from +2 bits to –24
bits. Use the cursor buttons to select the bit shift parameters, then use the Parameter wheel
or INC/DEC buttons to set them. The rotary attenuators and the bit shift parameters can
be set independently.
You can set the attenuator parameters for individual Input and Output Channels on the
Input Attenuator and Output Attenuator pages, regardless of paired channels. The changes
made on the Attenuator pages, along with the level balance between channels, will be
reflected in the settings in the SELECTED CHANNEL section, in the EQUALIZER [ATT]
controls, and on the EQ Edit page.
Using EQ
Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out all feature 4-band
parametric EQ. The LOW-MID and HIGH-MID bands are peaking type. The LOW and
HIGH bands can be set to shelving, peaking, or HPF and LPF respectively. EQ settings can
be stored in the EQ library, which contains 40 preset memories and 160 user memories. See
“EQ Library” on page 172 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
132
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
Preset EQs
The following table lists the preset EQs. See page 332 for detailed parameter information.
#
Preset Name
Description
1
Bass Drum 1
Emphasizes the low range of a bass drum and the attack created by the beater.
2
Bass Drum 2
Creates a peak around 80 Hz, producing a tight, stiff sound.
3
Snare Drum 1
Emphasizes “snappy” and rimshot sounds.
4
Snare Drum 2
Emphasizes various ranges for that classic rock snare drum sound.
5
Tom-tom 1
Emphasizes the attack of tom-toms, and creates a long, “leathery” decay.
6
Cymbal
Emphasizes the attack of crash cymbals, extending the “sparkling” decay.
7
High Hat
Use on a tight high-hat, emphasizing the mid to high range.
8
Percussion
Emphasizes attack and adds clarity to the high-range of instruments, such as
shakers, cabasas, and congas.
9
E. Bass 1
Produces a tight electric bass sound by cutting very low frequencies.
10 E. Bass 2
Unlike preset 9, this preset emphasizes the low range of an electric bass.
11 Syn. Bass 1
Use on a synth bass with emphasized low range.
12 Syn. Bass 2
Emphasizes the attack that is peculiar to synth bass.
13 Piano 1
Makes pianos sound brighter.
14 Piano 2
Used in conjunction with a compressor, this preset emphasizes the attack and
low range of pianos.
15 E. G. Clean
Use for line-level recording of an electric or semi-acoustic guitar to get a
slightly harder sound.
16 E. G. Crunch 1
Adjusts the tonal quality of a slightly distorted guitar sound.
17 E. G. Crunch 2
A variation on preset 16.
18 E. G. Dist. 1
Makes a heavily distorted guitar sound clearer.
19 E. G. Dist. 2
A variation on preset 18.
20 A. G. Stroke 1
Emphasizes the bright tones of acoustic guitars.
21 A. G. Stroke 2
A variation on preset 20. You can also use it with gutsy guitar sounds.
22 A. G. Arpeg. 1
Ideal for arpeggio playing on acoustic guitars.
23 A. G. Arpeg. 2
A variation on preset 22.
24 Brass Sec.
Use with trumpets, trombones, or saxes. When used with a single instrument,
try adjusting the HIGH or HIGH-MID frequency.
25 Male Vocal 1
An EQ template for male vocals. Try adjusting the HIGH or HIGH-MID parameters according to the voice quality.
26 Male Vocal 2
A variation on preset 25.
27 Female Vo. 1
An EQ template for female vocals. Try adjusting the HIGH or HIGH-MID parameters according to the voice quality.
28 Female Vo. 2
A variation on preset 27.
29 Chorus&Harmo
An EQ template for brightening choruses.
30 Total EQ 1
Use on a stereo mix during mixdown. Sounds even better when used with a
compressor.
31 Total EQ 2
A variation on preset 30.
32 Total EQ 3
A variation on preset 30. Can also be used with paired Input or Output Channels.
33 Bass Drum 3
A variation on preset 1, with low and mid range reduced.
34 Snare Drum 3
A variation on preset 3, creating a thicker sound.
35 Tom-tom 2
A variation on preset 5, emphasizing the mid and high ranges.
36 Piano 3
A variation on preset 13.
37 Piano Low
Emphasizes the low range of pianos recorded in stereo.
38 Piano High
Emphasizes the high range of pianos recorded in stereo.
39 Fine-EQ Cass
Add clarity when recording to or from cassette tape.
40 Narrator
Ideal for recording narration.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Using EQ
133
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL EQUALIZER Controls
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
EQUALIZER
LOW
DISPLAY
CHANNEL
LOW MID
FREQUENCY
FREQUENCY
Q
FREQUENCY
Q
GAIN
COPY
HIGH MID
HIGH
ATT.
FREQUENCY
Q
Q
GAIN
GAIN
GAIN
EQ ON
dB
dB
125
Hz
1.00
4.00
kHz
kHz
PASTE
Hz
dB
Hz
dB
10.0
kHz
Hz
kHz
2
Use the [EQ ON] button to turn the EQ on or off.
3
Use the GAIN controls to set the gain of each band.
When a GAIN control is adjusted, the gain in dB is displayed on the corresponding EQ display. If the GAIN control is not adjusted for two seconds, the EQ display returns to displaying the frequency.
4
To set the frequency, press a FREQUENCY/Q control so that the FREQUENCY
indicator lights up, and use the FREQUENCY/Q control to set the frequency.
The frequency is displayed by the corresponding EQ display.
5
To set the Q, press a FREQUENCY/Q control so that the Q indicator lights
up, and use the FREQUENCY/Q control to set the Q.
The Q value is displayed by the corresponding EQ display. If the Q control is not adjusted
for two seconds, the EQ display returns to displaying the frequency.
To reset an individual gain control, hold down the corresponding FREQUENCY/Q control.
To reset all gain controls, press the LOW and HIGH FREQUENCY/Q controls.
The EQ parameter ranges are as follows.
Parameter
LOW
LOW-MID
HIGH
–18.0 dB to +18.0 dB (0.1 dB steps)1
Gain
Frequency
Q
HIGH-MID
21.2 Hz to 20.0 kHz (120 steps per 1/12 octave)
HPF, 10.0 to 0.10
(41 steps), L.SHELF
10.0 to 0.10 (41 steps)
LPF, 10.0 to 0.10
(41 steps), H.SHELF
1. The LOW and HIGH GAIN controls function as filter on/off controls when Q is set to HPF or LPF respectively.
The initial EQ parameter settings are as follows.
Parameter
LOW
LOW-MID
Frequency
125 Hz
1.00 kHz
Q
L.SHELF
Gain
HIGH-MID
HIGH
4.00 kHz
10.0 kHz
0 dB
0.70
H.SHELF
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
134
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
EQ Edit Pages
EQ parameters can also be set on the EQ Edit page. If the Auto EQUALIZER Display preference is on, this page appears automatically when a control in the SELECTED CHANNEL
EQUALIZER section is operated. See “Auto EQUALIZER Display” on page 275.
1
Use the EQUALIZER [DISPLAY] button to select the EQ Edit page.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel and INC/DEC buttons to set them.
EQ ON: This turns the EQ on and off. The [ENTER] button can be used to turn this on
and off so long as any parameter other than TYPE is selected.
TYPE: This selects the type of EQ: TYPE I (the EQ type used on legacy Yamaha digital mixing consoles) or TYPE II (a newly developed algorithm).
ATT: This can be used to attenuate signals pre-EQ. It’s the same Attenuator parameter that
appears on the Attenuator pages. See “Attenuating Signals” on page 130 for more information.
CURVE: This displays the EQ curve of the currently selected Input Channel.
Level meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Input Channel
and its horizontal or vertical partner.
LOW, L-MID, H-MID, HIGH: These are the Q, Frequency (F), and Gain (G) parameters
for the four bands. The parameter (F or Q) you selected using the FREQUENCY/Q control
is highlighted.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Grouping Output Channel EQs
135
Grouping Output Channel EQs
The Bus Out, Aux Send, Matrix Send, and Stereo Out EQs can be grouped, allowing you to
control the EQ of several Output Channels simultaneously. There are four Output Channel
EQ groups: e, f, g, and h.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Output Equalizer
Link page.
2
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button.
3
Use the Up/Down cursor buttons to select EQ groups e–h.
The selected group is highlighted by a flashing cursor box.
4
Use the [SEL] buttons to add and remove Output Channels to and from the
selected group.
The EQ settings of the first Output Channel added to the group are applied to all subsequently added Output Channels.
When an Output Channel is added to a group, its [SEL] button indicator lights up.
Using Inserts
Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out all feature assignable Inserts.
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT [INSERT ON] Button
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
2
Use the [INSERT ON] button to turn the currently selected channel’s
Insert on or off.
INSERT ON
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
136
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
Insert Pages
Inserts can be configured on the Insert page. If the Auto PHASE/INSERT Display preference
is on, this page appears automatically when you press the SELECTED CHANNEL
PHASE/INSERT [INSERT ON] button, turning on the button indicator. See “Auto
PHASE/INSERT Display” on page 274.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT [DISPLAY] button to select the
Insert page.
The Insert page for the Input Channels is shown on the left; the Insert page for the Bus Outs,
Aux Sends, and the Stereo out, on the right.
The Insert page for the Matrix Sends is shown below.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
POSITION: This determines the position of the Insert and Compressor within the channel, and can be set to pre-EQ, pre-fader, or post-fader. Click the desired [COMP] and
[INSERT] buttons in the POSITION block diagram to select the Compressor and Insert
positions.
INSERT ON/OFF: This turns the currently selected channel’s Insert on and off. It works
in unison with the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT [INSERT ON] button.
INSERT OUT: This selects the destination for the Insert Out, which can be a Slot Output,
Omni Out, 2TR Digital Output, or the input to an internal effects processor. See page 286
and page 290 for Input and Output patch parameter lists. The Port ID of the currently
selected destination is displayed below the currently selected channel’s Long name in the
upper-right corner of the page. The destination port can also be selected by using the Patch
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Compressing Channels
137
Select window (see page 83), which is accessed by pressing [ENTER] while this parameter
is selected. Insert Outs can also be patched on the Output Patch pages. See “Output Patching” on page 79 for more information.
INSERT IN: This selects the source for the Insert In, which can be an AD Input, Slot Input,
2TR Digital or Analog Input, or the output of an internal effects processor. See page 286 for
a list of Input Channel Insert In sources; page 290 for a list of Output Channel Insert In
sources. The Port ID of the currently selected source is displayed below the currently
selected channel’s Long name in the upper-right corner of the page. The source port can
also be selected by using the Patch Select window (see page 83), which is accessed by pressing [ENTER] while this parameter is selected. Insert Ins can also be patched on the Input
Channel Insert In Patch pages. See “Patching Input Channel Insert Ins” on page 78 for more
information.
COMP ON/OFF: This turns the currently selected channel’s Compressor on and off. It
works in unison with the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [COMP ON] button, and
the ON/OFF button on the Comp Edit page. See “Compressing Channels” on page 137 for
more information.
COMP ORDER: If the Insert and Compressor are set to the same position in the channel
(i.e., INSERT POSITION and COMP POSITION are the same), you can use this parameter
to set the order of the Insert and Compressor to either Comp->Ins or Ins->Comp.
GEQ: This parameter allows you to insert a GEQ into the output of the currently selected
Output Channel. This parameter can also be set on the Graphic Equalizer Edit page (see
page 183) and the Graphic Equalizer Insert page (see page 82).
When a Y56K card effect, or an internal effects processor is inserted in the currently selected
channel, when the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [CHANNEL INSERTS] button is pressed, the corresponding EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [1–8] button indicator flashes, and the corresponding
Effects, or Plug-In edit page appears. If it’s a Y56K card that’s inserted, the [PLUG-INS] button indicator also flashes. If it’s an internal effects processor, the [INTERNAL EFFECTS]
button indicator also flashes. This applies only to effects that are inserted into channels. If
there’s nothing inserted in the currently selected channel, a message appears.
Compressing Channels
Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out all feature a Compressor. Settings can be stored in the Comp library, which contains 36 preset memories and
92 user memories. See “Comp Library” on page 171 for more information.
Preset Comps & Types
The following table lists the preset Comps and types. See page 334 for detailed parameter
information.
#
1
Preset Name
Type
Description
Compressor intended to reduce the overall volume level.
Use it on the stereo output during mixdown, or with
paired Input or Output Channels.
Comp
COMP
2
Expand
EXPAND
Expander template.
3
Compander (H)
COMPAND-H
Hard-kneed compressor template.
Soft-kneed compressor template.
4
Compander (S)
COMPAND-S
5
A. Dr. BD
COMP
Compressor for use with acoustic bass drum.
6
A. Dr. BD
COMPAND-H
Hard-kneed compander for use with acoustic bass drum.
7
A. Dr. SN
COMP
Compressor for use with acoustic snare drum.
8
A. Dr. SN
EXPAND
Expander for use with acoustic snare drum.
9
A. Dr. SN
COMPAND-S
Soft-kneed compander for use with acoustic snare drum.
EXPAND
Expander for use with acoustic tom toms, which automatically reduces the volume when the tom toms are not
played, improving mic separation.
10 A. Dr. Tom
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
138
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
11 A. Dr. OverTop
COMPAND-S
Soft-kneed compander for emphasizing the attack and
ambience of cymbals recorded with overhead mics. It
automatically reduces the volume when the cymbals are
not played, improving mic separation.
12 E. B. Finger
COMP
Compressor for leveling the attack and volume of a finger-picked electric bass guitar.
13 E. B. Slap
COMP
Compressor for leveling the attack and volume of a
slapped electric bass guitar.
14 Syn. Bass
COMP
Compressor for controlling or emphasizing the level of a
synth bass.
15 Piano1
COMP
Compressor for brightening the tonal color of a piano.
16 Piano2
COMP
A variation on preset 15, using a deep threshold to change
the overall attack and level.
17 E. Guitar
COMP
Compressor for electric guitar “cutting” or arpeggio-style
backing. The sound color can be varied by playing different styles.
18 A. Guitar
COMP
Compressor for acoustic guitar “stroke” or arpeggio-style
backing.
19 Strings1
COMP
Compressor for use with strings.
20 Strings2
COMP
A variation on preset 19, intended for violas or cellos.
21 Strings3
COMP
A variation on preset 20, intended for string instruments
with a very low range, such as cellos or contrabass.
22 BrassSection
COMP
Compressor for brass sounds with a fast and strong attack.
23 Syn. Pad
COMP
Compressor for synth pad, intended to prevent diffusion
of the sound.
24 SamplingPerc
COMPAND-S
Compressor for making sampled percussion sound like real
acoustic percussion.
25 Sampling BD
COMP
A variation on preset 24, intended for sampled bass drum
sounds.
26 Sampling SN
COMP
A variation on preset 25, intended for sampled snare drum
sounds.
27 Hip Comp
COMPAND-S
A variation on preset 26, intended for sampled loops and
phrases.
28 Solo Vocal1
COMP
Compressor for use with main vocals.
29 Solo Vocal2
COMP
A variation on preset 28.
30 Chorus
COMP
A variation on preset 28, intended for choruses.
31 Click Erase
EXPAND
Expander for removing a click track that may bleed
through from a musicians headphones.
32 Announcer
COMPAND-H
Hard-kneed compander for reducing the level of the music
when an announcer speaks.
33 Limiter1
COMPAND-S
A soft-kneed compander with a slow release.
34 Limiter2
COMP
A “peak-stop” compressor.
35 Total Comp1
COMP
Compressor for reducing the overall volume level. Use it
on the stereo output during mixdown, or with paired
Input or Output Channels.
36 Total Comp2
COMP
A variation on preset 35, but with more compression.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Compressing Channels
139
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS Controls
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
2
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [COMP ON] button to turn the currently selected channel’s Compressor on or off.
DYNAMICS
DISPLAY
GATE / COMP
THRESHOLD
RANGE
ATTACK
DECAY
HOLD
THRESHOLD
RATIO
ATTACK
RELEASE
GAIN
GATE
COMP
GATE ON
3
COMP ON
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [GATE/COMP] button to set the
DYNAMICS controls to COMP (COMP indicator lit), and use the THRESHOLD, RATIO, ATTACK, RELEASE, and GAIN controls to set the Compressor.
While an output Channel is selected, the [GATE/COMP] button is fixed at COMP.
Comp Edit Page
Compressor settings can be viewed and set on the Comp Edit page. If the Auto DYNAMICS
Display preference is on, this page appears automatically when a Compressor control in the
SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS section is operated. See “Auto DYNAMICS Display”
on page 275.
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
2
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [DISPLAY] button to locate the
Comp Library page, and recall a preset Compressor that contains the comp
type that you want.
See “Comp Library” on page 171 for more information.
3
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [DISPLAY] button to locate the
Comp Edit page.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
POSITION: This determines the position of the Compressor within the channel, and can
be set to pre-EQ, pre-fader, or post-fader. It works in unison with the COMP POSITION
parameter on the Insert page. See “Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
STEREO LINK: This allows you to pair Comps for stereo operation even when channels
are not paired. Input Channel Comps are paired either horizontally or vertically depending
on the Pair mode setting for the currently selected Input Channel. See “Pairing Channels”
on page 144 for more information on horizontal and vertical pairing. When channels are
paired, this parameter is turned on automatically and cannot be changed.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
140
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
CURVE: This displays the Compressor curve (i.e., input level vs. output level).
TYPE: This is the comp type used by the currently selected channel’s Compressor.
Meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Input Channel and its
horizontal or vertical partner. The GR meter indicates the amount of gain reduction being
applied by the currently selected channel’s Compressor.
ON/OFF: This turns the currently selected channel’s Compressor on and off. It works in
unison with the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS [COMP ON] button.
PARAMETER: These controls are used to set the Threshold, Ratio, Attack, Release, Out
Gain, and Knee (Width) parameters.
Grouping Output Channel Compressors
The Bus Out, Aux Send, Matrix Send, and Stereo Out Compressors can be grouped, allowing you to control the compression of several Output Channels simultaneously. There are
four Output Channel Compressor groups: m, n, o, and p.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Output Comp Link
page.
2
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button.
3
Use the Up/Down cursor buttons to select Comp groups m–p.
The selected group is highlighted by a flashing cursor box.
4
Use the [SEL] buttons to add and remove Output Channels to and from the
selected group.
The Compressor settings of the first Output Channel added to the group are applied to all
subsequently added Output Channels.
When an Output Channel is added to a group, its [SEL] button indicator lights up.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Delaying Channel Signals
141
Delaying Channel Signals
Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out all feature independent Delay functions. Input Channel Delays feature feedback, with independent Mix
and Gain parameters.
Using the SELECTED CHANNEL DELAY Controls
1
DELAY
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use
the [SEL] buttons to select channels.
Use the STEREO [SEL] button to toggle between the left
and right channels of the Stereo Out. On the Master Layer, use [SEL] buttons 21–24 to toggle between the left and right channels of the Matrix Sends.
FB
DISPLAY
MIX
ON
TIME
2
Use the [ON] button to turn the Delay function on and off.
3
Use the TIME control to set the delay time.
If the currently selected channel is an Input Channel, you can also set the Feedback Gain
(FB) and Feedback Mix (MIX) parameters. Use the FB/MIX push switch to select either FB
or MIX, and use the FB/MIX control to set it.
Delay Pages
Delay settings can be viewed and set on the Delay pages. If the Auto DELAY Display preference is on, these pages appear automatically when a control in the SELECTED CHANNEL
DELAY section is operated. See “Auto DELAY Display” on page 274.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL DELAY [DISPLAY] button to select the Delay
pages.
The Delay parameters for the 96 Input Channels are arranged into four pages. The Input
Channel 1–24 Delay page is shown below. The layout of the other three pages is the same.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
142
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
The Delay parameters for the Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out
appear on the Output Delay page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the Delay parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
Input and Output Channels can also be selected by using the LAYER and [SEL] buttons.
DELAY SCALE: These buttons determine the units of the delay value shown below the
msec value. Units can be set to meters, feet, samples, beats, or timecode frames.
GANG: When this option is turned on, the delay time for paired channels can be set simultaneously. Ganging is relative, so any delay time difference between the two channels is
maintained when this is turned on.
ON/OFF: These buttons turn the individual Delay functions on and off. The [ENTER]
button can be used to turn a Delay on and off regardless of which parameter is selected.
msec: This sets the delay time in milliseconds. The delay time can also be set by using the
parameter below, which is the delay time in the units selected by the DELAY SCALE buttons. You can copy the currently selected Input or Output Channel delay setting to all Input
or Output Channels respectively by double-clicking the [ENTER] button.
MIX: This parameter, available only on the Input Channel Delay pages, sets the mix of dry
and wet signals.
FB.GAIN: This parameter, available only on the Input Channel Delay pages, sets the
amount of feedback.
Soloing Channels
Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, and Matrix Sends can be soloed as follows.
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers if you want to solo
Input Channels, or select the Master Layer if you want to solo Output Channels.
Input and Output Channels cannot be soloed simultaneously. Soled Input Channels will be
unsoled when an Output Channel is soloed, and vice versa.
2
Use the [SOLO] buttons to solo the channels on the selected Layer.
The [SOLO] button indicators of channels that are soloed light up.
SOLO
The SOLO indicator in the MONITOR section flashes when the Solo function
is active. You can unsolo all soloed channels by pressing the SOLO [CLEAR]
button. You can adjust the level contrast between the soloed channels and the
currently selected Control Room Monitor source by adjusting the SOLO
CONTRAST control.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
SOLO
SOLO CONTRAST
CLEAR
Soloing Channels
143
Configuring Solo
The Solo function is configured on the Solo Setup page. If the Auto SOLO Display preference is on, this page appears automatically when a channel is soloed. See “Auto SOLO Display” on page 275.
1
Use the MONITOR [DISPLAY] button to locate the Solo Setup page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
SOLO: This is used to enable and disable the Solo function.
STATUS: This determines the Solo mode: Recording or Mixdown.
In Recording Solo mode, soloed Input Channel signals are fed to the Solo bus and output
via the Control Room Outputs. Other buses are unaffected by this mode. If the Listen
parameter is set to AFTER PAN, the signal source for Input Channels that are off, is pre
fader.
In Mixdown Solo mode, soloed Input Channel signals are fed to the Stereo bus and output
via the Stereo Out and Control Room Outputs. Unsoloed Input Channels are muted and
their [ON] button indicators flash (unless they are Solo Safe enabled). Only Input Channels
that are routed to the Stereo Out can be soloed in this mode. Input Channels that are off are
temporarily turned on when they are soloed.
SEL MODE: This determines the Solo Select mode: Mix Solo or Last Solo. In Mix Solo
mode, any number of channels can be soloed simultaneously. In Last Solo mode, only one
channel can be soloed at a time.
LISTEN: This determines the source of the Input Channel Solo signal: Pre Fader or After
Pan. This parameter does not affect Mixdown Solo mode. Output Channels are fixed at
After Pan. If you select Pre Fader, turning on the PAN button below it enables you to solo
the channel with the Pan setting still applied.
SOLO TRIM: This is used to trim the level of the Solo signal. This parameter does not
affect Mixdown Solo mode.
SOLO SAFE CHANNEL: For Mixdown Solo mode, Input Channels can be configured
individually so that they are not muted when other Input Channels are soloed. Use the
[SEL] buttons, cursor buttons, or Parameter wheel to select the SOLO SAFE CHANNEL
buttons. Use the [ENTER] or INC/DEC buttons to set Solo Safe for each Input Channel.
These settings do not affect Recording Solo mode. You can clear all Solo Safe settings by
selecting the ALL CLEAR button and pressing [ENTER].
AUX/SOLO LINK: When this check box is checked, you can solo or unsolo the Aux Sends
using the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 12] buttons without changing the Master layer.
This is convenient when you want to solo or unsolo Aux Outs while controlling the Aux
Sends from the Input Channels. Press the AUX SELECT key for the AUX send that you want
to solo, making it light. Then press that key once again to solo only the selected AUX send.
When Aux Sends are soloed, the corresponding AUX SELECT button indicators flash.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
144
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
FADER/SOLO RELEASE: When you check this check box, raising the channel faders of
soloed Channels from –∞ will unsolo the Channels. If the channel fader position is higher
than –∞, you cannot solo the corresponding channel.
This function is disabled in Mixdown Solo mode and for the Output Channels.
Note: When the AUX/SOLO LINK or FADER/SOLO RELEASE check box is checked, the solo
setting is cancelled.
Pairing Channels
Input Channels, Bus Outs, and Aux Sends can be paired for stereo operation. Input Channels can be paired either horizontally, that is, adjacent odd-even channels on the same Layer
(e.g., 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, etc) or vertically, that is, counterpart channels on adjacent Layers (e.g.,
1-25, 2-26, 49-73, 50-74, etc). Bus Outs and Aux Sends can be paired only horizontally.
Pairing Channels by Using the [SEL] Buttons
Only horizontal pairing can be set by using the [SEL] buttons.
1
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Layer containing the channels that you
want to pair.
2
While holding down the [SEL] button of the first channel, press the [SEL] button of the second channel.
The settings of the first channel are copied to the second channel and the channels are
paired. The [SEL] button indicator of the currently selected channel lights up, while the
[SEL] button indicator of the other channel flashes.
To cancel a pair, while holding down the [SEL] button of the first channel, press the [SEL]
button of the second channel.
The following channel parameters are copied, and controlled together, when channels are
paired: Fader, On/Off, Insert On/Off, Aux/Matrix On/Off, Aux Send Mode, Aux/Matrix
Send Level, Aux/Matrix Pre/Post, Aux Pre Point, Gate parameters, Compressor parameters,
Comp Position, EQ parameters, Fader group, Mute group, EQ group, Comp group, Solo,
Solo Safe, [AUTO] button, Fade Time, Recall Safe, Bus to Stereo On/Off, Bus to Stereo
Level.
The following channel parameters are not copied, or controlled together, when channels are
paired: Input Patch, Insert Patch, Output Patch, Phase, Delay On/Off, Delay Time, Delay
Feedback, Delay Mix, Routing, Pan, Follow Pan, Surround Pan, Bus to Stereo Pan,
Aux/Matrix Send Pan, Balance.
When channels are paired, the Attenuator value is copied, but the changes made in the
Attenuator page are not reflected in the pair partner. However, if you change the values in
the EQ Edit page, Parameter view page, or on the control surface, the changes will be
reflected in the pair partner while maintaining the relative level difference.
When Aux Send Mode is set to Fixed, Aux Send On/Off is not controlled together.
Check the Routing ST Pair Link check box to link the routing from the paired channels to
the Stereo Bus. See “Setting Preferences” on page 274 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Pairing Channels
145
Pairing Channels by Using the Pair Pages
Both horizontal and vertical pairing can be set on the Pair pages.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [PAIR] button to locate the Pair pages.
The Pair parameters for the 96 Input Channels are divided between two pages. The Input
Channel 1–48 Pair page is shown below. The layout of the other page is the same.
2
To set the pair mode, select the PAIR MODE HORIZONTAL or VERTICAL buttons, and press [ENTER].
The Pair mode can be set independently for Input Channels 1–48 and Input Channels
49–96. The Input Channel 1–48 Pair page in Vertical mode is shown below.
Pair parameters for the Bus Outs and Aux Sends appear on the Output Pair page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
146
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
3
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the channel pair buttons, and press [ENTER] to make or break pairs.
Input and Output Channels can also be selected by using the LAYER and [SEL] buttons.
A dialog box appears with options for copying the settings of the first channel to the second
channel, the second channel to the first channel, and for resetting both channels to their initial settings. Choose the option required, and then press [ENTER].
On other display pages, paired channels have a heart icon, or a dash between their channel
numbers.
When Input Channels are paired, MS Decoding can be used to decode signals from microphones arranged as MS pairs. MS Decoding is set on the Input Channel Pair pages. This can
be turned on and off for each pair of channels by using the MS buttons.
The Output Pair page displays the currently selected Surround mode (i.e., Stereo, 3-1, 5.1,
or 6.1), which can be set on the Surround Mode page (see page 97). When a Surround mode
other than Stereo is selected, the names of the Surround channels are shown below the Bus
Out and Aux Send pair buttons, as shown in the following table.
Surround Mode
Bus Out/Aux Send
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
3-1
L
R
C
S
—
—
—
—
5.1
L
R
Ls
Rs
C
LFE
—
—
6.1
L
R
Ls
Rs
C
Bs
LFE
—
This table shows the default assignment. The assignment may vary depending on the settings in the Surround Bus Setup page (see page 99).
When a Surround mode other than Stereo is selected, Aux Sends can be set to follow the
same Input Channel Surround Pan that applies to the Bus Outs, which is useful for feeding
Surround channel signals to external effects processors. This is turned on and off by using
the F.S buttons that appear below the Aux Send Pair buttons. When a pair of Aux Sends are
set to follow Surround Pan, their Aux Send Pair button is unavailable, and their Aux Pan
parameters (see page 116) are unavailable.
Grouping Output Channel Faders
The Bus Out, Aux Send, Matrix Send, and Stereo Out faders can be grouped, allowing you
to control the level of several Output Channels simultaneously. There are four Output
Channel Fader groups: Q, R, S, and T.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Output Fader Group
page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Group Master for the Output Channel Faders
147
2
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button.
3
Use the Up/Down cursor buttons to select Fader groups Q–T.
The selected group is highlighted by a flashing cursor box.
4
Use the [SEL] buttons to add and remove Output Channel faders to and from
the selected group.
When an Output Channel is added to a group, its [SEL] button indicator lights up.
ENABLE: These buttons are used to enable and disable the groups.
OUTPUT FADER MASTER: When this check box is not checked, the Output Channel
fader positions determine the fader levels in the Output Channel Fader groups. When this
check box is checked, you can set the master level for the corresponding Output Channel
Fader group in the Master column. The resultant Output Channel level equals the corresponding Output Channel fader level plus the Group master level. See “Group Master for
the Output Channel Faders” on page 147 for more information.
When the Output Fader Master check box is not checked, operating the channel faders will
affect the Output Channel levels in the corresponding Fader group. Pressing and holding
down the [SEL] button while operating the fader of an Output Channel will temporarily
cancel the corresponding Fader group, which is convenient if you want to adjust the relative
balance between channels.
Fader groups are active only in Fader mode. See “Selecting Fader Modes” on page 60 for
more information.
Group Master for the Output Channel Faders
The DM2000 also features a Fader Group Master function that enables you to control the
level of all channels using the Group Master level while maintaining the balance between
the channels, much like a VCA Group on an analog mixing console. While this function is
enabled, channel fader operation will not affect the channel levels of the corresponding
Fader group.
1
Follow Steps 1–4 as described in the “Grouping Output Channel Faders” section on the previous page, select the Output Fader Master check box, then
press the [ENTER] button to check or uncheck the Output Fader Master check
box.
2
When the Output Fader Master check box is checked, you can set the channel
levels of the Fader groups in the Master column.
When the Master column is selected, repeatedly pressing the [ENTER] button turns the
Output Fader Group on and off.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
148
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
You can also make these settings in the Output Fader Group Master page, as shown below.
3
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Output Fader Group
Master page.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, then use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons or [ENTER] button to set them.
OUTPUT FADER MASTER: When this check box is checked, you can set the master levels for the Output Fader groups. The resultant Output Channel level equals the corresponding Output Channel fader level plus the Group master level.
ALL NOMINAL: This button resets the master levels for all Output Fader groups to nominal.
ON/OFF: This turns each Output Fader group on or off, like a VCA mute on an analog
mixing console.
Faders: These faders adjust the master levels of the Fader groups. Fader knobs appear
highlighted when faders are set to 0.0 dB. Press the [ENTER] button to set the currently-selected fader to 0.0 dB.
You can also control the Fader Master function from the channel strips on the control surface as described below by using the User Assignable Layer of the Remote Layers. See
page 269 for information on the User Assignable Layer.
Encoders: The Encoders are not available.
[AUTO] buttons: These buttons are used to control the Fader Group Master On/Off and
the master level during Automix.
[SEL] buttons: These buttons move the cursor on the Output Fader Group Master page.
[SOLO] buttons: These buttons turn the Solo function of each Fader group on and off,
enabling you to monitor every channel in each Fader group.
Channel Strip Displays: The displays indicate the Group names (GrpQ–GrpT). When
you operate the channel faders, the displays indicate the corresponding master level values.
Channel Faders: The Channel Faders enable you to set the master level for each Fader
group.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Grouping Output Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)
149
Grouping Output Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)
The Bus Out, Aux Send, Matrix Send, and Stereo Out mutes can be grouped, allowing you
to mute several Output Channels simultaneously. There are four Output Channel Mute
groups: U, V, W, and X.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [GROUP] button to locate the Output Mute Group
page.
2
Press the LAYER [MASTER] button.
3
Use the Up/Down cursor buttons to select Mute groups U–X.
The selected group is highlighted by a flashing cursor box.
4
Use the [SEL] buttons to add and remove Output Channels to and from the
selected group.
When an Output Channel is added to a Mute group, its [SEL] button indicator lights up.
ENABLE: These buttons are used to enable and disable the groups.
OUTPUT MUTE MASTER: When this check box is checked, pressing the MASTER
MUTE button turns mute on or off for all channels in the corresponding Mute group.
When this check box is unchecked, the Output Channel [ON] button status mutes or
unmutes the channels in the group.
MASTER MUTE: When the Output Mute Master check box is checked, use this button to
mute or unmute all channels in the corresponding Mute group.
When the Output Mute Master check box is unchecked, pressing the Output Channel [ON]
button mutes or unmutes the channel in the corresponding Mute group (Mute On channels
are turned off and Mute Off channels are turned on).
Output Channel Mute Master
The DM2000 features a Mute Group Master function that enables you to mute all channels
in the Mute group using the MASTER button, much like a Mute group on an analog mixing
console. When this function is enabled, the channel [ON] buttons do not control the channels in the group collectively.
1
Follow Steps 1–4 described in the “Grouping Output Channel Mutes
(ON/OFF)” section on the previous page, select the Output Mute Master
check box, then press the [ENTER] button to check or uncheck the Output
Mute Master check box.
2
When the Output Mute Master check box is checked, the MASTER MUTE button in each group mutes or unmutes the channels in the corresponding group.
If the channels are muted by the Mute Master function, the corresponding channel [ON]
button indicators flash. You can assign the MASTER MUTE button function to one of the
USER DEFINED KEYS for convenient operation.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
150
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
Viewing Channel Parameter Settings
The parameter setting of the currently selected Input Channel, Bus Out, Aux Send, Matrix
Send, or the Stereo Out can be viewed and set on the Parameter View pages.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [VIEW] button to select the Parameter View page.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] buttons to set them.
Input Channels
This is the Parameter View page for the Input Channels.
GATE: The following Gate parameters for the currently selected Input Channel can be set:
Gate On/Off, Threshold, Range, Attack, Decay, and Hold. The GR meter indicates the
amount of gain reduction being applied by the Gate. Also displayed are the gate curve and
gate type. See “Gating Input Channels” on page 85 for more information.
COMP: The following Compressor parameters for the currently selected channel can be
set: Comp On/Off, Threshold, Ratio, Attack, Release, Gain, and Knee. The GR meter indicates the amount of gain reduction being applied by the Compressor. Also displayed are the
comp curve and comp type. See “Compressing Channels” on page 137 for more information.
INSERT: The currently selected channel’s Insert can be turned on and off and patched. See
“Using Inserts” on page 135 for more information.
EQ: The currently selected channel’s EQ and Attenuator can be set. Also displayed is the EQ
curve of the currently selected Input Channel. See “Using EQ” on page 131 for more information.
Meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected channel and its horizontal or vertical partner.
Phase: The signal phase of the currently selected Input Channel can be reversed. See
“Reversing the Signal Phase” on page 84 for more information.
DELAY: The currently selected channel’s Delay function can be set. See “Delaying Channel
Signals” on page 141 for more information.
PAIR: This heart icon indicates whether or not channels are paired. See “Pairing Channels”
on page 144 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Viewing Channel Fader Settings
151
Output Channels
This is the Parameter View page for the Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo
Out. Parameters are the same as for the Input Channel Parameter View page, minus the
GATE and Phase sections and the DELAY MIX and FB GAIN parameters. The parameter
settings of the left and right channels of the Matrix Sends and Stereo Out can be viewed
individually. Use the [SEL] buttons to toggle between the left and right channels.
Viewing Channel Fader Settings
The fader-related settings of the currently selected Input Channel, Bus Out, Aux Send,
Matrix Send, or the Stereo Out can be viewed and set on the Fader View pages.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [VIEW] button to select the Fader View page.
2
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and use the [SEL] buttons to select
channels.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] buttons to set them.
Pan and Balance controls can be set to center by pressing [ENTER] while they’re selected.
Input Channels
This is the Fader View page for the Input Channels.
PAN: This is the currently selected Input Channel’s Pan parameter. Select this parameter
using the cursor buttons, then press the [ENTER] button to set the Pan parameter to Center. See “Panning Input Channels” on page 95 for more information.
ON/OFF: This is the On/Off parameter of the currently selected Input Channel. See “Muting Input Channels (ON/OFF)” on page 88 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
152
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
Fader: This indicates the fader position of the currently selected Input Channel. The fader
knob appears highlighted when the fader is set to 0.0 dB. The fader position is displayed
numerically below the fader. See “Setting Input Channel Levels” on page 90 for more information.
SURROUND PAN: The Surround pan parameters for the currently selected Input Channel are displayed only when a Surround mode other than Stereo is selected. See “Using Surround Pan” on page 97 for more information.
BUS ROUTING: This section contains Routing and Follow Pan buttons for the currently
selected Input Channel. See “Routing Input Channels” on page 93 for more information.
The Direct Out output patch can also be set. See “Patching Direct Outs” on page 81 for more
information.
AUX: These are the currently selected Input Channel’s Aux Send Level, On/Off, and
Pre/Post parameters. While a rotary control is selected, the Aux Send can be turned on and
off by pressing [ENTER]. See “Aux Sends” on page 110 for more information.
Meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Input Channel and its
horizontal or vertical partner. The metering position is displayed below them.
GROUP: These buttons indicate which Fader, Mute, EQ, or Comp group, if any, the currently selected Input Channel is in.
Bus Outs
This is the Fader View page for the Bus Outs.
ON/OFF: This is the On/Off parameter of the currently selected Bus Out. See “Muting Bus
Outs (ON/OFF)” on page 108 for more information.
Fader: This indicates the fader position of the currently selected Bus Out. The fader knob
appears highlighted when the fader is set to 0.0 dB. The fader position is displayed numerically below the fader. See “Setting Bus Out Levels” on page 108 for more information.
TO ST PAN, ON/OFF & Fader: These are the Bus Out to Stereo Out Pan, On/Off, and
Fader parameters for the currently selected Bus Out. The fader knob appears highlighted
when the fader is set to 0.0 dB. The fader position is displayed numerically below the fader.
See “Sending Bus Outs to the Stereo Out” on page 109 for more information.
MATRIX PAN: These are the Matrix Send Pan controls for the currently selected Bus Out.
See “Panning Matrix Sends” on page 123 for more information.
MATRIX SEND: These are the Matrix Send Level controls for the currently selected Bus
Out. While a rotary control is selected, the Matrix Send can be turned on and off by pressing
[ENTER]. See “Setting Matrix Send Levels” on page 121 for more information.
Meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Bus Out and its partner.
The metering position is displayed below them.
GROUP: These buttons indicate which Fader, Mute, EQ, or Comp group, if any, the currently selected Bus Out is in.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Viewing Channel Fader Settings
153
Aux Sends
Below is the Fader View page for the Aux Sends.
ON/OFF: This is the On/Off parameter of the currently selected Aux Send. See “Muting
Aux Sends (ON/OFF)” on page 112 for more information.
Fader: This indicates the fader position of the currently selected Aux Send. The fader knob
appears highlighted when the fader is set to 0.0 dB. The fader position is displayed numerically below the fader. See “Settings Aux Send Master Levels” on page 119 for more information.
MATRIX PAN: These are the Matrix Send Pan controls for the currently selected Aux
Send. See “Panning Matrix Sends” on page 123 for more information.
MATRIX SEND: These are the Matrix Send Level controls for the currently selected Aux
Send. While a rotary control is selected, the Matrix Send can be turned on and off by pressing [ENTER]. See “Setting Matrix Send Levels” on page 121 for more information.
Meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Aux Send and its partner.
The metering position is displayed below them.
GROUP: These buttons indicate which Fader, Mute, EQ, or Comp group, if any, the currently selected Aux Send is in.
Matrix Sends
Below is the Fader View page for the Matrix Sends. The settings of the left and right channels
of the Matrix Sends can be viewed individually. Use [SEL] buttons 1–24 to toggle between
the left and right channels.
BAL: This is the Balance parameter for the currently selected Matrix Send. See “Balancing
Matrix Send Masters” on page 126 for more information.
ON/OFF: This is the On/Off parameter of the currently selected Matrix Send. See “Muting
Matrix Sends (ON/OFF)” on page 122 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
154
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
Fader: This indicates the fader position of the currently selected Matrix Send. The fader
knob appears highlighted when the fader is set to 0.0 dB. The fader position is displayed
numerically below the fader. See “Setting Matrix Send Master Levels” on page 125 for more
information.
Meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Matrix Send and its partner. The metering position is displayed below them.
GROUP: These buttons indicate which Fader, Mute, EQ, or Comp group, if any, the currently selected Matrix Send is in.
Stereo Out
Below is the Fader View page for the Stereo Out. The settings of the left and right channels
of the Stereo Out can be viewed individually. Use the STEREO [SEL] button to toggle
between the left and right channels.
BAL: This is the Balance parameter for the Stereo Out. Select this parameter using the cursor buttons, then press the [ENTER] button to set the parameter to Center. See “Balancing
the Stereo Out” on page 106 for more information.
ON/OFF: This is the On/Off parameter of the Stereo Out. See “Muting the Stereo Out
(ON/OFF)” on page 105 for more information.
Fader: This indicates the fader position of the Stereo Out. The fader knob appears highlighted when the fader is set to 0.0 dB. The fader position is displayed numerically below the
fader. See “Setting the Stereo Out Level” on page 105 for more information.
MATRIX PAN: These are the Matrix Send Pan controls for the Stereo Out. They can be set
independently for the Stereo Out’s left and right channels. See “Panning Matrix Sends” on
page 123 for more information.
MATRIX SEND: These are the Matrix Send Level controls for the Stereo Out. They can be
set independently for the Stereo Out’s left and right channels. While a rotary control is
selected, the Matrix Send can be turned on and off by pressing [ENTER]. See “Setting
Matrix Send Levels” on page 121 for more information.
Meters: These meters indicate the levels of the Stereo Out. The metering position is displayed below them.
GROUP: These buttons indicate which Fader, Mute, EQ, or Comp group, if any, the Stereo
Out is in.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Copying Channel Settings
155
Copying Channel Settings
The settings of Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, and the Stereo CHANNEL
Out can be copied among channels of the same type by using the Channel Copy
COPY
function. You can even copy to and from channels in Scenes without recalling
them. For the Matrix Sends and Stereo Out, the left and right channels are copied
and pasted independently.
PASTE
The Channel Copy Parameter buttons on the Preferences 2 page allow you to specify which channel settings will be copied. See “Channel Copy Parameter” on page 276.
Copying Channel Settings in the Same Scene
1
Use the LAYER and [SEL] buttons to select the source channel.
2
Press the CHANNEL [COPY] button.
The settings of the currently selected channel are copied to the Copy buffer.
For paired channels, only the settings of the currently selected channel are copied.
3
Use the LAYER and [SEL] buttons to select the destination channel.
4
Press the CHANNEL [PASTE] button.
If the destination channel is of the same type as the source channel, the settings in the Copy
buffer are pasted to the destination channel and its settings are updated accordingly.
Copying Channel Settings from the Current Scene to Other Scenes
1
Use the LAYER and [SEL] buttons to select the source channel.
2
Press the CHANNEL [COPY] button.
3
Use the SCENE MEMORY Up [ ] and Down [ ] buttons to select the destination Scene.
The number of the destination Scene flashes on the SCENE MEMORY display.
4
Use the LAYER and [SEL] buttons to select the destination channel.
5
Press the CHANNEL [PASTE] button.
A confirmation message appears. Choose YES to copy the source channel settings to the
destination channel.
Copying Channel Settings from Other Scenes to the Current Scene
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY Up [ ] and Down [ ] buttons to select the source
Scene.
The number of the source Scene flashes on the SCENE MEMORY display.
2
Use the LAYER and [SEL] buttons to select the source channel.
3
Press the CHANNEL [COPY] button.
4
Use the SCENE MEMORY Up [ ] and Down [ ] buttons to select the current
Scene.
The number of the current Scene lights up on the SCENE MEMORY display.
5
Use the LAYER and [SEL] buttons to select the destination channel.
6
Press the CHANNEL [PASTE] button.
The source channel settings are copied to the destination channel.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
156
Chapter 12—Common Channel Functions
Copying Channel Settings Between Noncurrent Scenes
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY Up [ ] and Down [ ] buttons to select the source
Scene.
The number of the source Scene flashes on the SCENE MEMORY display.
2
Use the LAYER and [SEL] buttons to select the source channel.
3
Press the CHANNEL [COPY] button.
4
Use the SCENE MEMORY Up [ ] and Down [ ] buttons to select the destination Scene.
The number of the destination Scene flashes on the SCENE MEMORY display.
5
Use the LAYER and [SEL] buttons to select the destination channel.
6
Press the CHANNEL [PASTE] button.
A confirmation message appears. Choose YES to copy the source channel settings to the
destination channel.
Naming Channels
You can specify Long and Short names for the Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix
Sends, and the Stereo Out as follows.
See page 298 for a list of initial Input Channel names; page 299 for Output Channel names.
Input Channels
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [INPUT PATCH] button to locate the Input Channel
Name page.
2
Use the Parameter wheel, INC/DEC buttons, or the LAYER and [SEL] buttons
to select the Input Channels.
When Vertical Input Channel pairing mode is selected, Input Channels are listed in order
of vertical partners, for example, CH1, CH25, CH2, CH26, and so on.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the Input Channel’s Long or Short name,
and then press [ENTER].
When the Title Edit window appears, edit the Input Channel name, and press OK when
you’ve finished. See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
You can reset all Input Channel names back to their initial values by pressing the INITIALIZE button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Naming Channels
157
If the Name Input Auto Copy check box in the upper right corner is checked, the first four
characters of the name entered in the LONG column are automatically copied to the
SHORT column. Also, a name entered in the SHORT column is automatically copied to the
LONG column.
Output Channels
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [OUTPUT PATCH] button to locate the Output
Channel Name page
2
Use the Parameter wheel, INC/DEC buttons, or the Master Layer and [SEL]
buttons to select the Output Channels.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the Output Channel’s Long or Short name,
and then press [ENTER].
When the Title Edit window appears, edit the Output Channel name, and press OK when
you’ve finished. See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
You can reset all Output Channel names back to their initial values by pressing the INITIALIZE button.
If the Name Input Auto Copy check box in the upper right corner is checked, the first four
characters of the name entered in the LONG column are automatically copied to the
SHORT column. Also, a name entered in the SHORT column is automatically copied to the
LONG column.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
158
Chapter 13—Monitoring & Talkback
13 Monitoring & Talkback
Control Room Monitoring
The DM2000 features independent outputs and level controls for two
sets of studio monitors. The LARGE CONTROL ROOM MONITOR
OUT +4 dB (BAL) XLR-3-32-type connectors are intended to feed to the
control room’s main monitors. The SMALL CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT +4 dB (BAL) XLR-3-32-type connectors are intended to
feed to the control room’s nearfield monitors.
The Control Room Monitor signal source is selected by using the CONTROL
ROOM STEREO buttons.
[2TR D1]: Selects the 2TR IN DIGITAL AES/EBU 1.
[2TR D2]: Selects the 2TR IN DIGITAL AES/EBU 2.
[2TR D3]: Selects the 2TR IN DIGITAL COAXIAL 3.
[2TR A1]: Selects the 2TR IN ANALOG 1.
[2TR A2]: Selects the 2TR IN ANALOG 2.
[STEREO]: Selects the Stereo Out.
[ASSIGN 1]: Selects the Output Channel assigned to this button on the Control Room
Setup page. See “Control Room Setup” on page 159.
[ASSIGN 2]: Selects the Output Channel assigned to this button on the Control Room
Setup page. See “Control Room Setup” on page 159.
STEREO
The level of the Control Room Monitor signal can be set by using the CONTROL ROOM LEVEL control. You can toggle between the LARGE CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT and SMALL CONTROL ROOM
MONITOR OUT by using the CONTROL ROOM [SMALL] button, whose
indicator is off when LARGE is selected, and on when SMALL is selected.
The Control Room Monitor signal can be switched into mono by using the
CONTROL ROOM [MONO] button. The [DIMMER] button activates the
Dimmer function, which dims the Control Room Monitor and Surround
Monitor signals by the amount specified on the Control Room Setup page
(page 159). The Dimmer function is activated automatically when the Slate,
Talkback, or Oscillator function is active.
0
10
SMALL
TRIM
PHONES
0
2TR D1
2TR A1
2TR D2
2TR A2
2TR D3
STEREO
ASSIGN 1
ASSIGN 2
MONO
DIMMER
SMALL
0
10
CONTROL ROOM LEVEL
The level of the SMALL CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT can be set by using
the SMALL TRIM control. When set at maximum, the level is the same as that of
the LARGE CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT.
The Control Room Monitor signal is also fed to the PHONES jack, the level of
which is set by using the PHONES LEVEL control.
10
PHONES
LEVEL
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Studio Monitoring
159
Control Room Setup
Control room monitoring is configured on the Control Room Setup page.
1
Use the MONITOR [DISPLAY] button to locate the Control Room Setup page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the ASSIGN buttons in the left-hand box,
and use the Parameter wheel to select an Output Channel in the right-hand
box.
Bus Outs, Aux Sends, or Matrix Sends can be assigned to the [ASSIGN 1] and [ASSIGN 2]
buttons.
3
Press [ENTER] to assign the selected Output Channel.
Once assigned, the selected Output Channel appears highlighted in the right-hand box.
The other parameters on this page are as follows.
CONTROL ROOM DIMMER LEVEL: This determines the amount of attenuation
applied to the Control Room Monitor and Surround Monitor signals by the Dimmer function. Use the cursor buttons to select it, and use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons
to set it from.
MONO: This button, which works in unison with the CONTROL ROOM [MONO] button, can be used to switch the Control Room Monitor signal into mono.
Studio Monitoring
The DM2000 features dedicated outputs, source selection, and level control.
The Studio Monitor signal is output by the STUDIO MONITOR OUT
+4 dB (BAL) 1/4-inch TRS phone jacks.
STUDIO
CONTROL
ROOM
STEREO
AUX 11
AUX 12
0
10
The Studio Monitor signal source is selected by using the STUDIO buttons.
[CONTROL ROOM]: Selects the Control Room Monitor.
[STEREO]: Selects the Stereo Out.
[AUX 11]: Selects Aux Send #11.
[AUX 12]: Selects Aux Send #12.
The level of the Studio Monitor signal can be set by using the STUDIO
LEVEL control.
STUDIO
LEVEL
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
160
Chapter 13—Monitoring & Talkback
Surround Monitoring
The DM2000 features comprehensive surround monitoring functions, including a pink
noise generator for speaker setup, Bass Management, and down mixing.
The Surround Monitor signal source is selected by using the SURROUND
buttons. The [BUS] button selects the Bus Outs as the source. The
[ASSIGN 1] and [ASSIGN 2] buttons select the Inputs of the Slots specified
on the Surround Monitor page as the source. Surround mixes from up to six
multitrack recorders can be monitored by patching Slot Inputs to Surround
Monitor Channels (see page 163) with the [ASSIGN 1] and [ASSIGN 2] buttons. The level of the Surround Monitor can be set by using the SURROUND
MONITOR LEVEL control.
Surround monitor speakers can be aligned by using the individual Attenuator and Delay
parameters on each Surround Monitor Channel. In addition to the standard Ls and Rs
speakers, the DM2000 supports Ls2 and Rs2 speakers, with independent Attenuator and
Delay parameters, for a more diffused surround monitoring environment. See “Configuring Surround Monitoring” on page 161 for more information.
Surround Monitor Channels can be patched to Slot Outputs or Omni Outputs. See “Output
Patching” on page 79 for more information.
Surround Monitor settings can be stored in the Surround Monitor library, which contains
1 preset memory and 32 user memories. See “Surround Monitor Library” on page 173 for
more information.
General surround monitoring is performed on the Surround Monitor page.
SURROUND
BUS
ASSIGN 1
ASSIGN 2
SURROUND
MONITOR LEVEL
1
Use the MONITOR [DISPLAY] button to locate the Surround Monitor page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
The number of speaker icons and meters shown on the Surround Monitor page depends on
the currently selected Surround mode. The meters indicate Bus Out signal levels.
MUTE/SOLO: These parameters are used to mute and solo Surround Channels. A Surround Channel is on when its speaker icon is highlighted. Speaker icons can be selected by
using the cursor buttons. When SOLO is on, Surround Channels can be soloed by selecting
speaker icons and pressing [ENTER].
SETTING: These buttons are used to select which Slot’s Inputs are monitored when the
SURROUND [ASSIGN 1] and [ASSIGN 2] buttons are pressed. Up to six Slots can be
assigned to each ASSIGN button, in which case the signals are mixed. Individual Slot Inputs
can be patched to Surround Monitor Channels on the Surround Monitor Patch page (see
page 163).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Surround Monitoring
161
When the MONITOR L/R to C-R button is on, the Left and Right Surround Monitor Channels are fed to the Control Room Monitors. This is useful when you want to use the same
speakers for Left and Right Surround Monitors and Control Room Monitors.
STATUS: SURROUND MODE indicates the currently selected Surround mode, which is
set on the Surround Mode page (see page 97). MONITOR LEVEL indicates the volume setting of the SURROUND MONITOR LEVEL control, which can be calibrated to 85 dB SPL,
the cinema standard for setting up Surround Channel Monitor speakers. To do this, output
pink noise from the built-in Oscillator (see page 161), set the SURROUND MONITOR
LEVEL control and the level controls on the Surround Monitor speaker amps so that the
total output is 85 dB SPL, then press the SET SPL85 button. The MONITOR LEVEL indication will then display the volume setting relative to 85 dB SPL. Press the SET SPL85 button again to return to the normal volume indication. Press the SNAP TO SPL85 button to
reset the SURROUND MONITOR LEVEL control to 85 dB SPL.
Configuring Surround Monitoring
Surround monitoring, including speaker setup, monitor matrix, Bass Management, and
monitor alignment, is configured on the Surround Monitor Setup page.
1
Use the MONITOR [DISPLAY] button to locate the Surround Monitor Setup
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
SPEAKER SETUP: These parameters are for setting the volume balance of the surround
monitor speakers. Select the OSC (Oscillator) parameter and choose from PINK NOISE,
500-2K (pink noise through a 500 Hz to 2 kHz BPF), 1K (1 kHz sinewave), or 50 Hz (50 Hz
sinewave). Use the ON/OFF button to turn the Oscillator on and off. When on, the Oscillator outputs a signal at –20 dB to the Surround Channels whose icons are highlighted. You
can turn on and off Oscillator output for speakers individually. Speaker icons can be
selected by using the cursor buttons. The signal phase of the LFE Channel can be reversed
by using the SW phase button. When ROTATE is on, the Oscillator signal is output by each
speaker in turn in a clockwise direction (3 second signal, 2 second pause).
SURR. MODE: This indicates the currently selected Surround mode, which is set on the
Surround Mode page (see page 97).
MONITOR MATRIX: This is used to select the Surround Monitor Matrix. In 6.1 Surround mode, you can select 6.1, 5.1, 3-1, or ST. In 5.1 Surround mode, you can select 5.1,
3-1, or ST. In 3-1 Surround mode, you can select 3-1 or ST.
When a down mix Monitor Matrix is selected, you can attenuate signals by using the ATT
parameters.
You can use the Surround Monitor settings in Stereo mode, but Monitor Matrix is fixed to
ST.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
162
Chapter 13—Monitoring & Talkback
The following screen shows an example in 6.1 Surround mode and 3-1 Monitor Matrix
mode.
BASS MANAGEMENT: You can set the filter and
attenuator settings for each Surround Monitor Channel using five preset Bass Management modes.
The following presets are available:
Presets
No.
Parameters
Title
HPF 1, 2, 3
LPF1
LPF2
ATT 1 & 2
AMP
1
DVD Mix w/BS
80–12
80–24
80–24
0
10
2
DVD Author w/BS
80–12
120–42
80–24
0
10
3
Film Mix w/BS
80–12
80–24
80–24
–3
10
4
Film Author w/BS
80–12
120–42
80–24
–3
10
5
Bypass
THRU
THRU
MUTE
0
0
ATT1: Adjusts the level difference between LR and LsRs.
ATT2: Adjusts the level difference between C and Bs.
AMP: Corrects the LFE channel level.
HPF1–3: Cut the low range so that the speakers’ supporting frequency ranges will not interfere with the
subwoofer signals.
HPF1–2: Cut the high range so that the subwoofer’s supporting frequency ranges will not interfere with
other speakers’ signals.
Tip: If you select 3-1 Monitor Matrix mode, use Presets 1 or 2 to establish an appropriate monitoring environment.
You can set the Bass Management parameters in the following ranges:
Parameters
Range
HPF 1, 2, 3
THRU, 80-12, 80-12L, 80-24, 80-24L
LPF1
THRU, 80-24, 80-24L, 120-42
LPF2
THRU, 80-24, 80-24L, MUTE
ATT 1 & 2
0 to –12 dB (1 dB steps)
AMP
0 to +12 dB (1 dB steps)
The HPF 1, 2, 3, and LPF 1 & 2 values indicate a cut-off frequency and a filter response. For example,
“80-12” means a cutoff frequency of 80 Hz and a filter response of –12 dB/octave.
“L” means Linkwitz filter. Other filters are Butterworth.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Using Talkback & Slate
163
MONITOR ALIGNMENT ATT & DLY ON/OFF:
These buttons are used to turn on and off the Monitor
Alignment Attenuator and Delay parameters of all Surround speakers. The MONITOR ALIGNMENT diagram
and Surround Channel Attenuator and Delay parameters,
which are displayed when either of these buttons are
selected, allow you to align the surround monitor speakers by attenuating and delaying Surround Channels as
necessary. The Attenuator parameters can be set –∞,
–12 dB to +12 dB in 0.1 dB steps. The Delay parameters
can be set from 0 to 30 msec in 0.02 msec steps.
Patching Slot Inputs to Surround Channels
Individual Slot Inputs can be patched to Surround Monitor Channels as follows.
1
Use the MONITOR [DISPLAY] button to locate the Surround Monitor Patch
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
SLOT/CH: This patching matrix is used to patch Inputs 1–16 from each of the six Slots to
the Surround Monitor Channels. Each Slot Input can be patched to only one Surround
Monitor Channel.
LEVEL: These parameters are used to set the monitor level of each Slot.
Using Talkback & Slate
The Talkback function distributes the Talkback mic signal to the Studio Monitor Outs and
any Slot or Omni Outputs specified on the Talkback Setup page.
The TALKBACK LEVEL control sets the level of the built-in talkback microphone.
0
10
TALKBACK LEVEL
TALKBACK
The [TALKBACK] button has two modes of operation: If it’s pressed once
(i.e., for less than 300 ms), the Talkback function is turned on and remains on
when the button is released. This is Latched mode (this mode can be disabled
on the Talkback Setup page). If it’s pressed and held for longer, the Talkback
function is turned on, but turns off when the button is released. This is
Unlatched mode. The [TALKBACK] button indicator flashes while the Talkback function is active.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
164
Chapter 13—Monitoring & Talkback
The Slate function distributes the Talkback mic signal to all Bus Outs, Matrix Sends, and the
Stereo Out.
The [SLATE] button has two modes of operation: If it’s pressed once (i.e.,
for less than 300 ms), the Slate function is turned on and remains on when
SLATE
the button is released. This is Latched mode. If it’s pressed and held for
longer, the Slate function is turned on, but turns off when the button is
released. This is Unlatched mode. The [SLATE] button indicator flashes
while the Slate function is active.
Talkback Setup
1
Use the MONITOR [DISPLAY] button to locate the Talkback Setup page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
OUTPUT ASSIGN: These buttons are used to assign the Talkback mic signal to Slot and
Omni Outputs.
STUDIO MONITOR: This allows you to select the Talkback mic signal as the Studio
Monitor source.
TALKBACK DIMMER LEVEL: When the Talkback function is active, this determines the
amount of attenuation applied to sound sources assigned to the Studio Monitors and
selected for Talkback.
USE AD IN x AS TALKBACK: This allows you to select an AD Input as the Talkback signal source. Use the check box to turn this option on and off, and use the number parameter
to specify the number of the AD Input. The signal from the specified AD Input is mixed
with the Talkback mic signal. Turn down the TALKBACK LEVEL if you do not want to use
the Talkback mic.
NEVER LATCH TALKBACK: This options allows you to disable Talkback latching.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Libraries
165
14 Libraries
About the Libraries
The DM2000 features 11 libraries for storing Automix, Effects, Channel, Input Patch, Output Patch, GEQ, Bus to Stereo, Gate, Comp, EQ, and Surround Monitor data.
Library data can be stored to an external MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer, by using
MIDI Bulk Dump (see page 220). It can also be stored to SmartMedia (see page 271).
General Library Operation
1
Since most library functions are the same for each library, rather than explain them several
times, they’re explained only here for conciseness.
Locate the various library pages as explained in the following sections.
The Input Patch Library page shown below is used here for explanation purposes.
2
Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select the memories.
A memory is selected when it appears inside the dotted box.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the following page buttons.
TITLE EDIT: To edit the title of the selected memory, select this and press [ENTER]. When
the Title Edit window appears, edit the title, and press OK when you’ve finished. See “Title
Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
RECALL: To recall the contents of the selected memory, select this and press [ENTER]. If
the Recall Confirmation preference is on, a confirmation window appears before the contents are recalled.
STORE: To store settings to the selected memory, select this and press [ENTER]. When the
Title Edit window appears, enter a title, and press OK. See “Title Edit Window” on page 54
for more information. You can stop the Title Edit window from appearing by turning off
the Store Confirmation preference on page 275.
CLEAR: To delete the contents and title of the selected memory, select this and press
[ENTER]. A confirmation window appears before the memory is cleared.
Read-only preset memories have an “R” icon next to their name. You cannot store, clear, or
edit the title of these memories.
Empty memories have the title “No Data!” Memory #0 is a read-only memory that you can
recall to reset settings to their initial values.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
166
Chapter 14—Libraries
Memory #U is a special read-only memory that allows you to undo and redo memory recall
and store operations. After recalling a memory, you can revert to the previously recalled
memory by recalling memory #U. After storing a memory, you can revert it to its previous
contents by recalling memory #U. You can redo either of these undo operations by recalling
memory #U again.
Channel Library
1
2
Input Channel, Bus Out, Aux Send, Matrix Send, and Stereo Out channel settings can be
stored in the Channel library, which contains 2 preset memories and 127 user memories.
Preset memories are read-only. User memories enable you to store custom settings.
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [VIEW] button to select the Channel Library page.
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and the [SEL] buttons to select channels.
When storing, the settings of the currently selected channel are stored to the selected memory. When recalling, the settings in the selected memory are applied to the currently selected
channel.
Only memories whose contents correspond to the currently selected channel can be
recalled. For example, you can recall Input Channel settings to Input Channels, but not to
Aux Sends. When the selected memory and currently selected channel don’t correspond, a
warning triangle and the word “CONFLICT” appear in the STORED FROM box.
Preset memory #0, “Reset(–∞dB),” resets all parameters of the currently selected channel to
their initial values and sets the channel level to –∞ dB. Preset memory #1, “Reset (0dB),”
also resets all parameters, but sets the channel level to 0 dB (i.e., nominal).
SEL CH: This indicates the currently selected channel.
CURRENT CONFIGURATION: If the currently selected channel is an Input Channel,
Surround mode and Aux configuration information is displayed here.
Level meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Input Channel
and its horizontal or vertical partner.
STORED FROM: This indicates the channel whose settings were originally stored in the
selected memory. If the currently selected channel is an Input channel, Pan mode and Aux
pairing information is also displayed.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Input Patch Library
167
Input Patch Library
1
Input Patch settings can be stored in the Input Patch library, which contains 1 preset memory and 32 user memories. The preset memory is read-only. User memories enable you to
store custom settings. See page 77 for information on Input Patch settings.
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [INPUT PATCH] button to select the Input Patch
Library page.
When storing, the current Input Patch settings are stored to the selected memory.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
Output Patch Library
1
Output Patch settings can be stored in the Output Patch library, which contains 1 preset
memory and 32 user memories.The preset memory is read-only. User memories enable you
to store custom settings. See page 79 for information on Output Patch settings.
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [OUTPUT PATCH] button to select the Output Patch
Library page.
When storing, the current Output Patch settings are stored to the selected memory.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
168
Chapter 14—Libraries
GEQ Library
1
2
GEQ (Graphic Equalizer) settings can be stored in the GEQ library, which contains 1 preset
memory and 128 user memories. The preset memory is read-only. User memories enable
you to store custom settings. See page 183 for information on using the GEQs.
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [DISPLAY] button to select the Graphic Equalizer
Library page.
Press the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [GRAPHIC EQUALIZERS] button, and use the
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [1–6] buttons to select the GEQs.
When storing, the settings of the currently selected GEQ, indicated in the upper-left corner,
are stored to the selected memory.
CURRENT CURVE: This is the response curve of the currently selected GEQ.
CURVE: This displays the response curve in the currently selected memory.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
Effects Library
1
Effects settings can be stored in the Effects library, which contains 61 preset memories and
67 user memories. Preset memories are read-only. User memories enable you to store custom settings. See page 174 for information on using the Effects.
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [DISPLAY] button to select the Effect Library
page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Bus to Stereo Library
2
169
Press the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [INTERNAL EFFECTS] button, and use the
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [1–8] buttons to select the internal effects processors.
When storing, the settings of the currently selected internal effects processor, indicated in
the upper-left corner, are stored to the selected memory.
EFFECT NAME: This is the name of the previously recalled Effects memory.
TYPE: This is the effects type used in the previously recalled Effects memory. Its I/O configuration is shown below this.
EDIT: Pressing this button, then the [ENTER] button, displays the Effects Edit page, which
enables you to adjust the Effects parameters. See “Editing Effects” on page 177 for more
information.
PATCH: Pressing this button, then the [ENTER] button, displays the Effects Input Patch
page, which enables you to patch internal Effects processor inputs and outputs. See “Patching Effects Inputs and Outputs” on page 78 for more information.
Level meters: These meters indicate the input and output levels of the currently selected
Effects processor. Use the IN and OUT buttons to switch between input level and output
level. There are eight meters for Effects processors #1 and #2, and two meters for Effects processors #3 through #8.
EFFECT TYPE: This is the effects type in the selected memory. Its I/O configuration is
shown below this.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
Bus to Stereo Library
1
Bus to Stereo settings can be stored in the Bus to Stereo library, which contains 1 preset
memory and 32 user memories. The preset memory is read-only. User memories enable
you to store custom settings. See page 109 for information on Bus to Stereo routing.
Use the ROUTING [DISPLAY] button to select the Bus to Stereo Library page.
When storing, the current Bus Out to Stereo Out settings are stored to the selected memory.
CURRENT CONFIGURATION: Bus Out pairing information for the current configuration is displayed here.
LIBRARY CONFIGURATION: Bus Out pairing information for the configuration stored
in the currently selected memory is displayed here.
If the Bus Out pairing configuration does not match the current configuration, the word
“CONFLICT” will appear in the LIBRARY CONFIGURATION box. In this case, if you
recall such a memory, the DM2000 will apply the current Bus Out pairing configuration
and related parameter settings to the recalled memory settings.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
170
Chapter 14—Libraries
Gate Library
1
2
Input Channel Gate settings can be stored in the Gate library, which contains 4 preset memories and 124 user memories. Preset memories are read-only. User memories enable you to
store custom settings. See page 85 for information on gating Input Channels.
Use the DYNAMICS [DISPLAY] button to select the Gate Library page.
Use the LAYER buttons to select the Input Channel Layers, and the [SEL] buttons to select Input Channels.
When storing, the Gate settings of the currently selected Input Channel, indicated in the
upper-right corner, are stored to the selected memory. When recalling, the Gate settings in
the selected memory are applied to the currently selected Input Channel.
CURRENT TYPE: This indicates the current Gate type of the currently selected channel.
CURRENT CURVE: This is the Gate curve of the currently selected channel.
GR meters: These meters indicate the amount of gain reduction being applied by the
Gate, and the levels of the currently selected channel and its adjacent channel. If Pair mode
for the currently selected channel is set to Vertical, the level of its counterpart on the adjacent Layer is displayed.
TYPE/CURVE: The type (Gate or Ducking) and curve of the currently selected memory is
displayed to the right of the memory list.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Comp Library
171
Comp Library
1
2
Comp settings can be stored in the Comp library, which contains 36 preset memories and
92 user memories. Preset memories are read-only. User memories enable you to store custom settings. See page 137 for information on the Comps.
Use the DYNAMICS [DISPLAY] button to select the Comp Library page.
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and the [SEL] buttons to select channels.
When storing, the Comp settings of the currently selected channel, indicated in the
upper-right corner, are stored to the selected memory. When recalling, the Comp settings
in the selected memory are applied to the currently selected channel.
CURRENT TYPE: This indicates the current Comp type of the currently selected channel.
CURRENT CURVE: This is the Comp curve of the currently selected channel.
GR meters: These meters indicate the amount of gain reduction being applied by the
Comp, and the levels of the currently selected channel and its adjacent channel. If Pair mode
for the currently selected channel is set to Vertical, the level of its counterpart on the adjacent Layer is displayed.
TYPE/CURVE: The type (Compressor, Expander, Compander Hard, Compander Soft)
and curve of the currently selected memory is displayed to the right of the memory list.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
172
Chapter 14—Libraries
EQ Library
1
2
Input Channel, Bus Out, Aux Send, Matrix Send, and Stereo Out EQ settings can be stored
in the EQ library, which contains 40 preset memories and 160 user memories. Preset memories are read-only. User memories enable you to store custom settings. See page 131 for
information on EQ’ing.
Use the EQUALIZER [DISPLAY] button to select the EQ Library page.
Use the LAYER buttons to select Layers, and the [SEL] buttons to select channels.
When storing, the EQ settings of the currently selected channel, indicated in the upper-left
and right corners, are stored to the selected memory. When recalling, the EQ settings in the
selected memory are applied to the currently selected channel.
CURRENT TYPE: This indicates the current EQ type (TYPE I or TYPE II) for the currently selected channel.
CURRENT CURVE: This is the EQ curve of the currently selected channel.
Level meters: These meters indicate the levels of the currently selected Input Channel
and its horizontal or vertical partner.
CURVE: This displays the EQ curve in the currently selected memory.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Automix Library
173
Automix Library
1
Up to 16 Automixes can be stored in the Automix library. See page 193 for information on
using Automix.
Use the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] button to select the Automix Memory page.
When storing, the current Automix is stored to the selected memory.
TITLE: This is the title of the current Automix.
CURRENT: This is the size of the current Automix.
UNDO: This is the size of the Automix data in the current Undo buffer.
FREE: This is the amount of free memory for storing the current Automix.
MEMORY: This is the size of the selected Automix memory.
PROTECT: To protect the contents of the selected memory, select this and press [ENTER].
A padlock icon appears next to the titles of memories that are write-protected. Automixes
cannot be stored to write-protected memories.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
Surround Monitor Library
1
Surround Monitor settings can be stored in the Surround Monitor library, which contains
1 preset memory and 32 user memories. The preset memory is read-only. User memories
enable you to store custom settings. See page 160 for information on Surround Monitoring.
Use the MONITOR [DISPLAY] button to select the Surround Monitor Library
page.
When storing, the current Surround Monitor settings are stored to the selected memory.
For details on the Store, Recall, Title Edit, and Clear functions, see “General Library Operation” on page 165.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
174
Chapter 15—Internal Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs
15 Internal Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs
About the Effects
The DM2000 features eight internal multi-effects processors, offering a whole host of effects
types, including reverbs, delays, modulation-based effects, combination effects, and multichannel effects designed especially for use with surround sound.
Effects processors 3–8 feature assignable stereo inputs and outputs. Processors #1 and #2,
which are intended for use with the multichannel surround effects, feature eight assignable
inputs and outputs. Processor inputs and outputs can be patched to various sources,
including the inputs and outputs of other Effects processors, allowing you to chain processors together in series. (The only outputs available for patching in series are effects processor outputs OUT1 and OUT2.)
The input and output signal levels of the currently selected Effects processor can be metered
on the Effects Edit page and the Effects Library page. The input and output signal levels of
all Effects processors can be metered on the Meter pages. See “Metering” on page 127 for
more information.
Effects settings can be stored in the Effects library, which contains 61 preset memories and
67 user memories. See “Effects Library” on page 168 for more information.
Patching Effects Processors
Effects processor inputs can be fed from the Aux Sends, Input and Output Channel Insert
Outs, or the outputs of another Effects processor. See “Patching Effects Inputs and Outputs”
on page 78 for more information.
Effects processor outputs can be patched to the Input Channels, Input and Output Channel
Insert Ins, or the inputs of another Effects processor. See “Output Patching” on page 79 for
more information.
Preset Effects & Types
The following tables list the preset effects and types. See page 310 for detailed parameter
information.
Reverbs
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
1
Reverb Hall
REVERB HALL
Concert hall reverberation simulation with gate
2
Reverb Room
REVERB ROOM
Room reverberation simulation with gate
3
Reverb Stage
REVERB STAGE
Reverb designed for vocals, with gate
4
Reverb Plate
REVERB PLATE
Plate reverb simulation with gate
5
Early Ref.
EARLY REF.
Early reflections without the subsequent reverb
6
Gate Reverb
GATE REVERB
Gated early reflections
7
Reverse Gate
REVERSE GATE
Gated reverse early reflections
Delays
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
8
Mono Delay
MONO DELAY
Simple mono delay
9
Stereo Delay
STEREO DELAY
Simple stereo delay
MOD.DELAY
Simple repeat delay with modulation
11 Delay LCR
DELAY LCR
3-tap (left, center, right) delay
12 Echo
ECHO
Stereo delay with crossed left/right feedback
10 Mod.delay
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Preset Effects & Types
175
Modulation-based Effects
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
13 Chorus
CHORUS
Chorus
14 Flange
FLANGE
Flanger
15 Symphonic
SYMPHONIC
Proprietary Yamaha effect that produces a richer and more
complex modulation than normal chorus
16 Phaser
PHASER
16-stage stereo phase shifter
17 Auto Pan
AUTO PAN
Auto-panner
18 Tremolo
TREMOLO
Tremolo
19 HQ.Pitch
HQ.PITCH
Mono pitch shifter, producing stable results
20 Dual Pitch
DUAL PITCH
Stereo pitch shifter
21 Rotary
ROTARY
Rotary speaker simulation
22 Ring Mod.
RING MOD.
Ring modulator
23 Mod.Filter
MOD.FILTER
Modulated filter
Guitar Effects
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
24 Distortion
DISTORTION
Distortion
25 Amp Simulate
AMP SIMULATE
Guitar amp simulation
Dynamic Effects
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
26 Dyna.Filter
DYNA.FILTER
Dynamically controlled filter
27 Dyna.Flange
DYNA.FLANGE
Dynamically controlled flanger
28 Dyna.Phaser
DYNA.PHASER
Dynamically controlled phase shifter
Combination Effects
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
29 Rev+Chorus
REV+CHORUS
Reverb and chorus in parallel
30 Rev->Chorus
REV->CHORUS
Reverb and chorus in series
31 Rev+Flange
REV+FLANGE
Reverb and flanger in parallel
32 Rev->Flange
REV->FLANGE
Reverb and flanger in series
33 Rev+Sympho.
REV+SYMPHO.
Reverb and symphonic in parallel
34 Rev->Sympho.
REV->SYMPHO.
Reverb and symphonic in series
35 Rev->Pan
REV->PAN
Reverb and auto-pan in series
36 Delay+ER.
DELAY+ER.
Delay and early reflections in parallel
37 Delay->ER.
DELAY->ER.
Delay and early reflections in series
38 Delay+Rev
DELAY+REV
Delay and reverb in parallel
39 Delay->Rev
DELAY->REV
Delay and reverb in series
40 Dist->Delay
DIST->DELAY
Distortion and delay in series
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
176
Chapter 15—Internal Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs
Others
#
Preset Name
Type
Description
41
Multi.Filter
MULTI.FILTER
3-band parallel filter (24 dB/octave)
42
Freeze
FREEZE
Simple sampler
43
Stereo Reverb
ST REVERB
441
Reverb 5.1
Stereo reverb
5.12
6-channel reverb for 5.1 surround
REVERB2
8-channel reverb for 7.1 surround
REVERB
451
Octa Reverb
OCTA
461
Auto Pan 5.1
AUTO PAN 5.1
6-channel auto pan for 5.1 surround
471
Chorus 5.1
CHORUS 5.1
6-channel chorus for 5.1 surround
481
Flange 5.1
FLANGE 5.1
6-channel flanger for 5.1 surround
491
Sympho. 5.1
SYMPHO. 5.1
6-channel symphonic effect for 5.1 surround
50
M. Band Dyna.
M. BAND DYNA.
Multi-band dynamics processor
511
Comp 5.1
COMP
521
Compand 5.1
COMPAND 5.12
533
Comp276
—
—
543
Comp276S
—
—
553
Comp260
—
—
563
Comp260S
—
—
573
Equalizer601
—
—
583
OpenDeck
—
—
593
REV-X Hall
—
—
603
REV-X Room
—
—
613
REV-X Plate
—
—
5.12
Multi-band compressor for 5.1 surround
Multi-band compander for 5.1 surround
1. These effects can be recalled only to Effects processors #1 and #2.
2. Since these effects types require four DSPs, the total number of Effects processors is reduced by three
when one of these types is used. For example, if REVERB 5.1 is used with Effects processor #1, only
processors 2–5 are available. And if, for example, REVERB 5.1 is used with both Effects processor #1
and #2, then processors 3–8 are not available.
3. Preset numbers are reserved for Add-On Effects. Effects that are not installed appear in gray and are
unavailable for use. See “Adding Optional Add-On Effects” on page 178 for more information on
Add-On Effects.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Editing Effects
177
Editing Effects
1
The internal effects processors can be edited as follows.
Press the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [INTERNAL EFFECTS] button.
2
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [1–8] buttons to select the internal effects processors.
3
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [DISPLAY] button to locate the Effects Library
page, and recall a preset effects memory that contains the effects type that
you want.
See “Effects Library” on page 168 for more information.
4
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [DISPLAY] button to locate the Effects Edit page.
The available effects parameters depends on the effects type currently selected. See page 310
for detailed parameter information.
5
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, or [ENTER] button to set them.
EFFECT NAME: This is the name of the currently-recalled Effects memory.
TYPE: This is the effects type used in the currently-recalled Effects memory. Its I/O configuration is shown below this.
LIBRARY: Select the LIBRARY button, then press [ENTER] to display the Library page for
the selected effects processor. See “Effects Library” on page 168 for more information.
PATCH: Select the PATCH button, then press [ENTER] to display the Effects Input/Output Patch page, which enables you to patch internal Effects processor inputs and outputs.
See “Patching Effects Inputs and Outputs” on page 78 for more information.
MIX BALANCE: This is used to set the balance between the wet and dry signals. When set
to 0%, only the dry signal is heard. When set to 100%, only the wet signal is heard.
BYPASS: This button is used to bypass the currently selected Effects processor.
TEMPO: The TEMPO section displays TEMPO parameters for delay and modulation-based effects. These TEMPO parameters calculate and set the delay time for delay
effects, or the modulation frequency for modulation effects, relative to the specified tempo
and note duration. Use these parameters along with the SYNC and NOTE parameters.
When you turn on the SYNC parameter, the DM2000 recalculates the delay time or modulation frequency based on the TEMPO parameter value (tempo) and the NOTE parameter
value (note). For example, if the TEMPO parameter is set to 120BPM and the NOTE
parameter is set to an eighth note, turning on the SYNC parameter sets the delay time to
250msec and the modulation frequency to 0.25Hz.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
178
Chapter 15—Internal Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs
Tip:
• If you turn on the SYNC parameter and edit the TEMPO or NOTE parameter, the
DM2000 recalculates the delay time or modulation frequency.
• If you turn on the SYNC parameter and edit the delay time or modulation frequency, the
NOTE parameter value changes based on the TEMPO parameter setting.
• See “Effects and tempo synchronization” on page 331 for more information on the tempo
sync parameters.
Level meters: The Level meters indicate the input and output levels of the currently
selected Effects processor. Select the IN or OUT button to display input or output levels
respectively. There are eight output meters for Effects processors 1 and 2, and two output
meters for Effects processors 3 through 8.
Effects parameters can also be adjusted by using Parameter controls 1–4. Use the Parameter
Up/Down buttons to select the rows of parameters. The parameters in the currently selected
row appear highlighted. Up to 16 parameters can be displayed at a time, and if more are
available, an up or down arrow is displayed.
Parameter Up/Down
1
2
3
4
Parameter controls 1–4
When a Y56K card effect, or an internal effects processor is inserted in the currently selected
channel, when the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [CHANNEL INSERTS] button is pressed, the corresponding EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [1–8] button indicator flashes, and the corresponding
Effects, or Plug-In edit page appears. If it’s a Y56K card that’s inserted, the [PLUG-INS] button indicator also flashes. If it’s an internal effects processor, the [INTERNAL EFFECTS]
button indicator also flashes. This applies only to effects that are inserted into channels. If
there’s nothing inserted in the currently selected channel, a message appears.
Adding Optional Add-On Effects
Installing an optional Add-On Effect package enables you to expand the internal Effects
processors. You can use installed Add-On Effects as preset effects #53 and up. Edited settings
can be stored in user memories #68 and up. Refer to the installation guide included in your
Add-On Effect package for information on installing the effects.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
About Plug-Ins
•
•
•
179
As of January 2004, the following Add-On Effect packages are available:
AE011 Channel Strip Package
AE021 Master Strip Package
AE031 Reverb Package
Additional packages will be released in the future. Visit the Yamaha web site for the latest
information:
http://www.yamahaproaudio.com/
About Plug-Ins
There are two types of Plug-Ins: Waves Plug-Ins and User Defined Plug-Ins. Waves Plug-Ins
are available on Y56K cards, which need to be installed in the DM2000’s mini YGDAI Slots
(Slots 4–6 only). See your Yamaha dealer for details. User Defined Plug-Ins can be used to
control up to 32 user definable parameters via MIDI Control Change or Parameter Change
messages on an external MIDI device, such as an external effects processor. Plug-In parameters can be controlled by using the four Parameter controls below the display. Plug-In
parameter settings are stored in Scenes, for snapshot-style automation.
When installing Y56K cards, mini YGDAI Slots 4–6 correspond to Plug-Ins 4–6, so if you
install, for example, a Y56K card in Slot #4, it’s automatically configured as Plug-In #4.
DM2000 signals are patched through to the Y56K card’s effect chains just like any other signal is patched through to a Slot Input or Output. Slot Outputs (i.e., effect chain inputs) can
be fed from the Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, Stereo Out, or the Input and Output
Channel Insert Outs. Slot Inputs (i.e., effect chain outputs) can be fed to the Input Channels, or the Input and Output Channel Insert Ins. See “Input & Output Patching” on
page 77.
Settings for Y56K cards are stored in memory on the card when you store a Scene, and
recalled automatically during Scene recall. Please note, however, that these settings cannot
be stored in DM2000 Scenes. Therefore, the cards do not support Scene memory global
paste, sort, and other scene related functions.
Note: Y56K cards use Scenes #1–#96. If you store or recall Scenes #97 and up, the Y56K card
settings will not reflect the Scenes. (A warning message will appear.)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
180
Chapter 15—Internal Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs
Configuring Plug-Ins
1
Plug-Ins can be configured as follows.
If you’ve installed a Y56K card into one of the Slots, the DM2000 configures itself automatically and no further configuration settings are required.
Press the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [PLUG-INS] button.
2
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [DISPLAY] button to locate the Plug-In Setup
page.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
TARGET: These are used to assign a target to each of the eight Plug-Ins. Parameters for the
specified target appear on the Plug-In Edit page when that Plug-In is selected by using the
EFFECTS PLUG-INS [1–8] buttons. In addition to using the cursor buttons, Plug-Ins can
also be selected on this page by using the EFFECTS PLUG-INS [1–8] buttons.
TITLE: If a Y56K card is installed, its name is displayed here. If the target is set to USER
DEFINED, the specified title of the bank currently selected on the Plug-In Edit page is displayed.
PORT: If a Y56K card is installed, its Slot number is displayed here. If the target is set to
USER DEFINED, you can specify the Plug-Ins MIDI port as MIDI, SERIAL 1–8, USB 1–8,
or SLOT1 1–8. Plug-In MIDI Ports can also be set on the MIDI/To Host Setup page. See
“MIDI I/O” on page 215 for more information.
Plug-In Setup settings are stored in the Setup data. See “Saving DM2000 Data to SmartMedia” on page 271 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Editing Plug-Ins
181
Editing Plug-Ins
1
Plug-Ins can be edited as follows. The settings of Waves Plug-Ins and User Defined Plug-In
banks can be stored to an external MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer, by using MIDI
Bulk Dump (see page 220), or stored to SmartMedia (see page 271).
If you’ve installed a Y56K card into one of the Slots, display pages especially for the Waves
card are displayed when the corresponding Plug-In is selected. See the Waves documentation for more information. The following explanation applies only to User Defined
Plug-Ins.
Press the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [PLUG-INS] button.
2
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [1–8] buttons to select the Plug-Ins.
3
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [DISPLAY] button to locate the Plug-In Edit page.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
TRANSMIT: This enables and disables MIDI data transmission for the currently selected
Plug-In.
INITIALIZE: This initializes the settings of the currently selected bank.
BANK: These buttons are used to select the parameter banks of the currently selected
Plug-In. Up to four parameter settings can be stored in each bank, making a total of 32
parameters per Plug-In.
TITLE: This is used to enter a title (up to 16 characters long) for each bank. To enter a title
for the currently selected bank, select this and press [ENTER]. When the Title Edit window
appears, enter a title, and press OK when you’ve finished. See “Title Edit Window” on page
54 for more information.
PARAMETER ID/NAME: This is used to select the four rotary controls at the bottom of
the Plug-In Edit page for editing, and to enter a name (up to 16 characters long) for each
control. Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select a Parameter ID from 1–4,
and then press [ENTER]. When the Title Edit window appears, enter a title, and press OK
when you’ve finished. See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
DATA: This is used to specify the MIDI message (up to 16 bytes) to be transmitted when
each parameter control is adjusted. Use the PARAMETER ID/NAME parameter to select a
Parameter ID from 1–4, and then edit as necessary. Data values can be set in hex from 00 to
FF. The VAL setting is the value of the parameter control. The END setting specifies the end
of the data. NOP means no data is transmitted.
LEARN: This button is used to turn on and off the Learn function, which can be used to
learn what MIDI messages are transmitted by external MIDI devices when their controls or
parameters are adjusted. When on, received MIDI messages are displayed by the DATA
parameter. Only the first 16 bytes of data, starting with a Status bit, are displayed.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
182
Chapter 15—Internal Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs
MIN/MAX: These parameters determine the minimum and maximum values of the
MIDI data transmitted when each parameter control is adjusted. Use the PARAMETER
ID/NAME parameter to select a Parameter ID from 1–4, and then edit as necessary.
VAL: This is used to select the format for converting parameter control values to the DATA
parameter’s VAL setting. It applies to the currently selected bank. The available options are
listed in the following table.
VAL
Description
VAL count
One byte
Transmit the lower 7 bits of the parameter value as 1 word
Up to one VAL
MSB/LSB
Transmit the lower 14 bits of the parameter value in 7-bit units
starting from the upper byte
Up to two VAL’s
LSB/MSB
Transmit the lower 14 bits of the parameter value in 7-bit units
starting from the lower byte
Up to two VAL’s
2 Nibbles M
Transmit the lower 8 bits of the parameter value in 4-bit units,
consecutively from the highest data
Up to two VAL’s
3 Nibbles M
Transmit the lower 12 bits of the parameter value in 4-bit units,
consecutively from the highest data
Up to three VAL’s
4 Nibbles M
Transmit the parameter value in 16 bit units, consecutively from
the highest data
Up to four VAL’s
2 Nibbles L
Transmit the lower 8 bits of the parameter value in 4-bit units,
consecutively from the lowest data
Up to two VAL’s
3 Nibbles L
Transmit the lower 12 bits of the parameter value in 4-bit units,
consecutively from the lowest data
Up to three VAL’s
4 Nibbles L
Transmit the parameter value in 16-bit units, consecutively from
the lowest data
Up to four VAL’s
When the controls at the bottom of the Plug-In Edit page are operated, the specified MIDI
data, along with the value of the parameter control, is transmitted.
Plug-In parameters can also be adjusted by using Parameter controls 1–4, which correspond to the four parameters shown at the bottom of the Plug-In Edit page.
1
2
3
4
Parameter controls 1–4
When a Y56K card effect, or an internal effects processor is inserted in the currently selected
channel, when the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [CHANNEL INSERTS] button is pressed, the corresponding EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [1–8] button indicator flashes, and the corresponding
Effects, or Plug-In edit page appears. If it’s a Y56K card that’s inserted, the [PLUG-INS] button indicator also flashes. If it’s an internal effects processor, the [INTERNAL EFFECTS]
button indicator also flashes. This applies only to effects that are inserted into channels. If
there’s nothing inserted in the currently selected channel, a message appears.
The parameter settings, and the target and bank for each Plug-In are stored in Scenes. When
a Scene is recalled, if the Plug-In’s Target is the same as when the Scene was stored, the
parameters are set accordingly and the corresponding MIDI data is transmitted (so long as
the REMOTE parameter is set to ENABLED). If the Target is not the same, the parameters
are set accordingly but no MIDI data is transmitted.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
About the GEQs
183
About the GEQs
The DM2000 features six 31-band graphic equalizers that can be inserted into the Bus Outs,
Aux Sends, or the left or right channels of the Matrix Sends or Stereo Out. GEQs can be
linked for simultaneous operation. GEQ settings can be stored in the GEQ library, which
contains 1 preset memory and 128 user memories. See “GEQ Library” on page 168 for more
information.
Editing GEQs
1
GEQs can be edited as follows.
Press the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [GRAPHIC EQUALIZERS] button.
2
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [1–6] buttons to select the GEQs.
3
Use the EFFECTS/PLUG INS [DISPLAY] button to locate the GEQ Edit page.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
ON/OFF: This is used to turn on and off the currently selected GEQ.
INSERT: This selects the Output Channel (Bus Out, Aux Send, or left or right channel of a
Matrix Send or the Stereo Out) into which the GEQ is inserted. This parameter can also be
set on the Output Channel Insert page (see page 135) or the Graphic Equalizer Insert page
(see page 82).
LINK: These buttons are used to link the currently selected GEQ with another GEQ for
simultaneous operation. The buttons of GEQs that are already linked are unavailable. When
you press a button to link to a GEQ, the settings of the currently selected GEQ are copied to
that GEQ.
FADER ASSIGN: Use the channel faders to set the gain for each band, much like an analog
graphic equalizer. Selecting the 20.0–4.0k button assigns a lower range to the channel faders; selecting the 100–20.0k button assigns a higher range.
LIMIT: This determines the maximum amount of boost and cut for the currently selected
GEQ. It can be set to ±15 dB, ±12 dB, ±6 dB, or –24 dB.
FLAT: Pressing this resets all bands of the currently selected GEQ to 0 dB.
Meters: These meters display pre-GEQ and post-GEQ signal levels.
CURVE: This graphically displays the settings of the currently selected GEQ.
Faders: These are used to boost and cut the level of each band. The currently selected band
can be reset to 0 dB by pressing [ENTER].
FREQUENCY: This indicates the frequency of the currently selected band.
GAIN: This indicates the gain setting of the currently selected band.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
184
Chapter 15—Internal Effects, Plug-Ins & GEQs
GEQ parameters can also be adjusted by using Parameter controls #1 and #4. Parameter
control #1 selects the frequency bands. Parameter control #4 resets the gain of the selected
band. Parameter controls #2 and #3 are inactive.
1
Band select
2
3
4
Gain
Editing the Graphic EQ Using the Channel Faders
1
Use the channel faders to set the gain for each band, much like an analog graphic equalizer.
To assign a band to a channel fader, after editing GEQs as described in the
previous paragraph, use the cursor buttons to select the 20.0–4.0k button
or the 100–20.0k button in the FADER ASSIGN section, then press the
[ENTER] button.
20.0–4.0k: This button selects 24 low range bands (20.0 Hz–4.0 kHz).
100–20.0k: This button selects 24 high range bands (100 Hz–20.0 kHz).
Each channel strip display indicates the frequency of the assigned band.
2
Move the channel faders to set the gain for each band.
When you move the faders, the corresponding channel strip displays indicate the gain value
for one second. Pressing the channel [SEL] button moves the cursor to the corresponding
band. Pressing the channel [SEL] button resets the gain for the corresponding band to
0.0 dB.
This function is available only when the Graphic Equalizer Edit page or Graphic Equalizer
Library page is selected. If you access other pages, the fader assignment is cancelled.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Scene Memories
185
16 Scene Memories
About Scene Memories
Scene memories allow you to store a snapshot of virtually every DM2000 mix setting in a
Scene. There are 99 Scene memories, and they can be titled for easy identification. A fade
time of up to 30 seconds can be set individually for each Input and Output Channel fader.
Recall Safe can be used to exclude individual Input and Output Channels and certain
parameters from Scene recalls. Stored Scenes can be sorted as necessary.
Scenes can be stored and recalled by using the SCENE MEMORY [STORE] and [RECALL]
buttons, or by using the Scene Memory page. Scenes can be assigned MIDI Program
Change numbers and recalled remotely. See “Assigning Scenes to Program Changes” on
page 218 for more information. When a Scene is recalled on the DM2000, the Program
Change number assigned to that Scene is transmitted, which can be used to recall programs,
effects, etc., on other MIDI equipment. In addition, manual Scene recalls can be recorded
on-the-fly in an Automix. When that Automix is replayed, the Scenes are recalled automatically. See “Automix” on page 193 for more information.
Scene memories can be stored to external MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer, by using
MIDI Bulk Dump (see page 220). They can also be stored to SmartMedia (see page 271).
What’s Stored in a Scene?
The following items are stored in Scenes: Input and Output Channel settings, Effects settings, GEQ settings, Group and Pair settings, Fade Time settings, and Scene title.
Edit Buffer & Edit Indicator
The Edit Buffer is where the current mix settings (i.e., the current Scene) are stored. When
a Scene is stored, the mix settings in the Edit Buffer are written to the selected Scene memory. When a Scene is recalled, the contents of the selected Scene memory are copied to the
Edit Buffer, making them the current mix settings.
When a parameter is adjusted after a Scene has been recalled, the Edit indicators—the dot
on the SCENE MEMORY display and “EDIT” on the display—appear, indicating that the
current mix settings (i.e., those in the Edit Buffer) no longer match those of the Scene that
was recalled last, as illustrated below.
02
SCENE MEMORY display
02
Display
Scene #2 has just been recalled, so
the contents of the Edit Buffer
match those of Scene #2 and the
Edit indicators are off.
A parameter has been adjusted since
Scene #2 was recalled, so the Edit
indicators appear, indicating that the
contents of the Edit Buffer no longer
match those of Scene #2.
The contents of the Edit Buffer are retained while the DM2000 is turned off.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
186
Chapter 16—Scene Memories
Scene Memories #0 & #U
Scene memory #0 is a special read-only memory that contains the initial settings of all mix
parameters. It can be recalled, but not stored. When you want to reset all mix parameters to
their initial, or default values, recall Scene memory #0. Input Channel faders are set to either
–∞dB or nominal, depending on the Initial Data Nominal preference (see page 275).
Scene memory #U is a special read-only memory that allows you to undo and redo Scene
memory recall and store operations. After recalling a Scene memory, you can revert to the
previously recalled Scene memory by recalling Scene memory #U. After storing a Scene
memory, you can revert it to its previous contents by recalling Scene memory #U. You can
redo either of these undo operations by recalling Scene memory #U again.
Auto Scene Memory Update
Normally, when a Scene is recalled and then edited, that Scene must be stored again in order
to save the edits. If the Scene MEM Auto Update preference on page 276 is on, however,
those edits are stored automatically in a Shadow memory. There’s one Shadow memory for
each Original Scene memory. The contents of the Original and Shadow memories can be
recalled alternately, which is useful for doing A/B comparisons.
When a Scene is recalled, the current mix settings are automatically stored in the Shadow
memory of the Scene memory that was recalled last. When you return to that Scene, you
can recall the Shadow or Original memory alternately.
While the Scene MEM Auto Update preference is on, Shadow memories, not Original
memories are recalled initially. To recall an Original memory, recall its Shadow memory
first, and while the Edit indicators are both off, recall again. This time the Original memory
is recalled.
When recalling Original and Shadow memories, you can easily tell which is currently active
by the Edit indicators, which are off when an Original memory is active, and on when a
Shadow memory is active. Note that when a Scene is stored, the contents of the Original and
Shadow memories will be the same and the Edit indicators will be off regardless of which
memory is active.
When storing data to SmartMedia, Shadow memories are automatically stored along with
their Original memories. When recalling Scenes in an Automix, only the Original memories
can be recalled. Operation is the same as for recalling Scenes by using the DM2000’s SCENE
MEMORY buttons or the Scene Memory page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Storing & Recalling Scenes with the SCENE MEMORY Buttons
187
Storing & Recalling Scenes with the SCENE MEMORY Buttons
As each Scene memory is selected, its number flashes on the SCENE MEMORY display, and
its number and title flash in the Scene memory section of the display. These stop flashing
when the selected Scene memory is either stored or recalled. Empty Scene memories have
the title “No Data!” and cannot be recalled. You cannot store to Scene memories that are
write-protected.
Warning: When storing Scenes, make sure that there are no settings in the Edit Buffer that
you do not want to store. Perhaps some settings have been adjusted accidentally, or by someone
else. If you are not sure of the Edit Buffer’s exact contents, recall the last Scene, make the adjustments that you really want, and then store the Scene. You may want to store the current Scene
to an unused Scene memory just in case.
Storing Scenes
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY Up [ ] and Down [ ] buttons to select a Scene
memory.
2
Press the [STORE] button.
The Title Edit window appears. This window can be disabled by the Store Confirmation
preference on page 275.
3
Enter a title.
See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
4
Press OK on the Title Edit window.
The current Scene is stored to the selected Scene memory.
You can undo Scene stores, reverting to the previous mix settings, by recalling Scene memory #U (“Ud” on the SCENE MEMORY display).
Recalling Scenes
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY Up [ ] and Down [ ] buttons to select a Scene
memory.
2
Press the [RECALL] button.
The contents of the selected Scene memory are recalled and all mix parameters are set
accordingly. If the Recall Confirmation preference is on, a confirmation window appears
before a Scene is recalled.
You can undo Scene recalls, reverting to the previous mix settings, by recalling Scene memory #U (“Ud” on the SCENE MEMORY display).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
188
Chapter 16—Scene Memories
Using the Scene Memory Page
On the Scene Memory page you can store, recall, write-protect, delete, and edit the titles of
Scenes.
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY [DISPLAY] button to locate the Scene Memory
page.
2
Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select a Scene memory.
A Scene memory is selected when it appears inside the dotted box.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the following buttons.
TITLE EDIT: To edit the title of the selected Scene memory, select this and press [ENTER].
When the Title Edit window appears, edit the title, and press OK when you’ve finished. See
“Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
RECALL: To recall the contents of the selected Scene memory, select this and press
[ENTER]. The contents of the selected Scene memory are recalled, all parameters are set
accordingly, the Scene memory’s number and title stop flashing, and the Edit indicators go
off. If the Recall Confirmation preference is on, a confirmation window appears before a
Scene is recalled.
STORE: To store the current Scene to the selected Scene memory, select this and press
[ENTER]. When the Title Edit window appears, enter a title, and press OK. See “Title Edit
Window” on page 54 for more information. When a Scene is stored, the Scene memory’s
number and title stop flashing, and the Edit indicators go off. You can stop the Title Edit
window from appearing by turning off the Store Confirmation preference on page 275.
CLEAR: To delete the contents and title of the selected Scene memory, select this, press
[ENTER], and the press YES when the confirmation window appears.
PROTECT: To protect the contents of the selected Scene memory, select this and press
[ENTER]. A padlock icon appears next to the titles of Scene memories that are write-protected. Scenes cannot be stored to write-protected Scene memories. While the PROTECT
button is selected, the selected Scene memory can be protected and unprotected by using
the INC/DEC buttons.
PATCH LINK: This indicates the Input/Output Patch library number that is linked to each
scene. When you store a scene, the number of the input/output patch that was most recently
recalled or stored will automatically be linked with that scene. When you recall that scene,
this library number will also be automatically recalled. You can also move the cursor to the
parameter boxes and change the library numbers.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Fading Scenes
189
Fading Scenes
Fade times can be specified for individual Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix
Sends, Stereo Out, and the Group Master. The fade time determines the time it takes the
Input and Output Channel faders to move to their new positions when a Scene is recalled.
Fade time settings can be specified for each Scene individually.
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY [DISPLAY] button to locate a Fade Time page.
The Fade Time parameters for Input Channels 1–48 appear on the Input CH1–48 Fade
Time page, for Input Channels 49–96 appear on the Input CH49–96 Fade Time page, and
those for the Bus Outs, Aux Sends, Matrix Sends, Stereo Out, and the Group Master appear
on the Output Fade Time page.
2
Use the cursor buttons or [SEL] buttons to select the individual Fade Time
parameters, and use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to set them.
You can copy the currently selected Input or Output Channel Fade Time setting to all Input
or Output Channels respectively by double-clicking the [ENTER] button. If the Input or
Output Group Master is selected, you can copy the setting to all Input or Output Channel
Group Master channels.
The Long name of the channel whose Fade Time parameter is currently selected appears in
the upper-right corner of the page. When a channel is selected by using the [SEL] buttons,
its Long name also appears in the upper-right corner of the display.
The Fade Time can be set from 0 to 30 seconds in 0.1 second steps.
You can reset all Input Channel Fade Time parameters to zero by selecting the ALL INPUT
CLEAR buttons, then pressing the [ENTER] button. You can reset all Output Channel Fade
Time parameters to zero by selecting the [ALL CLEAR] buttons, then pressing the [ENTER]
button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
190
Chapter 16—Scene Memories
Global Fade Time: When this check box is checked, a Scene is recalled using the Fade
Time that is applied globally to all Scenes. (The Fade Time setting stored in the recalled
Scene is temporarily ignored.)
Recalling Scenes Safely
When a Scene is recalled, all mix parameters are set accordingly. In some situations, you
may want to retain the settings of certain parameters on certain channels, and this can be
achieved by using the Recall Safe function. Recall Safe can be set individually for Input/Output Channels, Group Master, Internal Effect Processor, and the Remote Layer, etc.
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY [DISPLAY] button to locate the Recall Safe page.
2
Select the SAFE ENABLED/DISABLED button, and use the [ENTER] button or
the INC/DEC buttons to enable or disable the Recall Safe function.
3
Use the cursor buttons, [SEL] buttons, or Parameter wheel to select channels,
and use the [ENTER] button or the INC/DEC buttons to set them as Safe channels.
When a channel is Safe, its number appears highlighted.
GROUP MASTER/OTHERS: Recall Safe can be set individually not only for Input/Output Channels, but also Group Master, Internal Effect Processors, User Defined Remote
Layer, Plug-ins, HA (AD8HR/AD824), and GEQ.
4
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the MODE parameters,
and the [ENTER] button to set them.
The MODE buttons determine which Safe channel parameters are unaffected by Scene
recalls. ALL (all parameters. This option is mutually exclusive with the following options),
FADER (faders), ON (On/Off parameters), PAN (Pan parameters), EQ (EQ parameters),
COMP (Comp parameters), GATE (Gate parameters), AUX (Aux/Matrix Send levels),
AUX ON (Aux/Matrix Send On/Off parameters), DELAY (Delay parameters), ROUTING
(Routing parameters).
GLOBAL RECALL SAFE: When this check box is checked, a Scene is recalled using the
settings that are applied globally to all Scenes. The settings stored in the recalled Scene are
temporarily ignored.
Recall Safe settings are stored in Scene memories.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Sorting Scenes
191
Sorting Scenes
Scene can be sorted by using the Scene Memory Sort function.
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY [DISPLAY] button to locate the Scene Memory Sort
page.
2
Use the cursor button to the select the SOURCE list, and use the Parameter
wheel or the INC/DEC buttons to select the Scene memory you want to
move.
3
Use the cursor button to the select the DESTINATION list, and use the Parameter wheel or the INC/DEC buttons to select the position to which you want
to move the source Scene memory.
4
Press [ENTER] to move the source Scene memory to the specified destination.
The [ENTER] button executes the Sort function regardless of its position.
Copying and Pasting a Scene (Global Paste)
Any channel or parameter settings for the current scene can be copied and pasted into other
scenes. This function is useful when you want to apply edited parameter settings in the current scene to other scenes.
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY [DISPLAY] button to locate the Global Paste Source
CH Select page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
192
Chapter 16—Scene Memories
2
Use the cursor buttons, [SEL] buttons, or Parameter wheel to select the channel category, then use the [ENTER] button or the INC/DEC buttons to select
the copy source channel.
The number of the source channel is highlighted.
GROUP MASTER/OTHERS: You can also select Group Masters, internal Effects processors, a User Defined Remote layer, User Defined Plug-in, HA (AD8HR/AD824), or GEQ as
copy sources.
3
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the copy source parameter, then press the [ENTER] button.
4
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the destination channels, then press the [ENTER] button.
5
Use the SCENE MEMORY [DISPLAY] button to locate the Global Paste Destination Scene page.
6
Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select the destination
scene(s).
Scenes specified between FROM and TO (inclusive) become the paste destination. You can
paste up to 10 scenes at a time.
7
Use the cursor buttons to select the PASTE button, then use the [ENTER] button to paste the settings.
You cannot paste the settings to write-protected scenes.
UNDO: This button restores the settings used prior to the paste operation. However, if the
settings in the scene are changed after the paste operation (such as by saving, clearing, or
sorting the scene, loading scene data from SmartMedia, or receiving scene data via MIDI
Bulk Dump), the UNDO function is disabled.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Automix
193
17 Automix
About Automix
The DM2000’s Automix function allows dynamic automation of virtually all mix parameters, including Levels, Mutes, Pan, Surround Pan, Aux/Matrix Sends, Aux/Matrix Send
Mutes, EQ, effects, and Plug-Ins. You can specify which of these parameters will be
recorded, and punch channels in and out of recording on-the-fly. User Defined Remote
Layer operations, and scene and library recall operations can also be automated, combining
snap shot and dynamic mix automation. Events are recorded in real time and can be edited
either offline, with 1/4 frame accuracy, or by rerecording with punch in/out. Automix can
be synchronized to an external timecode source or to the internal timecode generator.
Up to 16 Automixes can be stored in the Automix library. See “Automix Library” on page
173 for more information. They can also be stored to an external MIDI device, such as a
MIDI data filer, by using MIDI Bulk Dump (see page 220), or stored to SmartMedia (see
page 271).
What’s Recorded in an Automix?
The following parameters can be recorded in an Automix.
Parameter
Input
Channels
Bus Out
Masters
Aux Send
Masters
Matrix Send
Masters
Stereo Out
Channel Levels (faders)
O
O
O
O
O
Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)
O
O
O
O
O
Pan
O
—
—
—
—
Surround Pan
O
—
—
—
—
EQ (F, Q, G, On/Off)
O
O
O
O
O
Aux Send 1–12 levels
O
—
—
—
—
Aux Send 1–12 mutes
O
—
—
—
—
Matrix Send 1–4 levels
—
O
O
—
O
Matrix Send 1–4 mutes
—
O
O
—
O
Feder Group Master
(Level, On/Off)
—
Scene recalls
—
EQ, Gate, Comp, Effects,
Channel library recalls
—
Effect parameters
(certain parameters)
—
User Defined Plug-Ins
(parameters 1–4)
—
User Defined Remote Layers
(faders, [ON], Encoders)
—
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
194
Chapter 17—Automix
Automix Main Page
1
2
This section explains the Automix Main page.
Use the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] button to locate the Automix Main page.
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
TITLE: This is the title of the current Automix.
TIME CODE: This counter displays the current timecode position. If the optional
MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge is installed, the current timecode position is also displayed on
its TIME CODE counter.
FREE: The amount of free Automix memory remaining is displayed here in kilobytes, percent, and graphically by a bargraph.
SIZE: The size of the current Automix and the size of any Automix data in the undo buffer
are displayed here in kilobytes.
TIME REFERENCE: This section displays the current timecode source and frame rate. If
you select this item and then press the [ENTER] button, you can jump directly to the Time
Reference page (see page 201).
INT START TIME: This parameter is used to set the start time of the internal timecode
generator in hours, minutes, seconds, frames, and subframes. Press the [ENTER] button to
reset the currently selected digits to “00.” The internal timecode generator is selected on the
Time Reference page (see page 201).
OFFSET: This parameter can be used to specify an offset relative to the external timecode
source in hours, minutes, seconds, frames, and subframes. Specify a “+” value to move
events forward relative to the incoming timecode. Specify a “–” value to move events backward relative to the incoming timecode. Press the [ENTER] button to reset the currently
selected digits to “00.” If the Timecode Display Relative preference is turned on (see
page 277), the indicated timecode is offset.
UPDATE: This button determines the fate of events that exist beyond the point at which
rerecording is stopped. When TO END is on, all events that exist beyond the point at which
rerecording is stopped for parameters that have been edited during the current pass are
erased. This function is useful when you want parameters to remain the same right through
to the end of the Automix. Events are erased only when the current pass is actually stopped,
not when a punch out occurs. When TO END is off, existing events are left as they are.
When TO END is on, the way in which Fader events are processed depends on the currently
selected Fader Edit mode and Edit Out mode. In the following table, the Fader Edit mode
is set to Absolute. If the Fader Edit mode is set to Relative, and the Edit Out mode is set to
either Takeover or Off, the fader will remain at a position relative to the position at which
recording is stopped.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Automix Main Page
195
Return
Takeover or Off
At the point at which recording is stopped, the fader
returns to the position specified by the existing fader
data, at the speed specified by the Time parameter on
the Fader Edit pages.
At the point at which recording is stopped, the fader
remains at the same position until the next Fader
event in the existing data occurs.
Existing data
Existing data
Return time
TO END is OFF
Fader edit
Fader edit
Punch in
Time
Time
Stop recording
Punch in
At the point at which recording is stopped, the fader
returns to the position specified by the existing fader
data, at the speed specified by the Time parameter,
and all subsequent events are erased so that the fader
remains at that position right through to the end of
the Automix.
Stop recording
At the point at which recording is stopped, all subsequent events are erased so that the fader remains at
that position right through to the end of the Automix.
Existing data
Existing data
Return time
TO END is ON
Fader edit
Punch in
Fader edit
Time
Stop recording
Time
Punch in
Stop recording
EDIT OUT: These buttons are used to set the Edit Out mode: Off, Takeover, or Return. The
Edit Out mode determines how rerecorded fader moves align with existing fader data at the
punch out point. Fader data includes Input Channel levels, Bus Out master levels, Aux Send
master levels, Matrix Send master levels, the Stereo Out level, User Defined Remote Layer
faders, and Group master levels. The Edit Out modes are explained in the following table.
The Edit Out mode can also be set by using the AUTOMIX [RETURN] button. The Return
Time is specified on the Fader Edit page (see page 200).
Off
At the punch out point, the fader
remains at the same position until the
next Fader event in the existing data
occurs.
Return
Takeover
At the punch out point, the fader returns
to the position specified by the existing
fader data, at the speed specified by the
Time parameter on the Fader Edit pages.
At the punch out point, recording continues until the fader position intersects
the existing fader data. If you are still
touching the fader knob at the actual
punch out point, the fader is disabled
until you release it.
Existing data
Existing data
Existing data
Return time
Fader edit
Time
Punch in
Punch out
Fader edit
Fader edit
Time
Punch in
Punch out
Punch in
Time
Punch out
Actual punch out
In this example, punch out was performed by pressing the [AUTO] button,
and the fader was moved manually
between the punch out and actual
punch out points.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
196
Chapter 17—Automix
FADER EDIT: These buttons are used to set the Fader Edit mode: Absolute or Relative. The
Fader Edit mode determines how fader moves are rerecorded. It has no effect during the
first recording pass. In Absolute mode, fader moves are rerecorded as absolute values and
existing fader data is erased. In Relative mode, fader moves are rerecorded relative to the
existing fader data.
Fader data includes Input Channel levels, Bus Out master levels, Aux Send master levels,
Matrix Send master levels, Stereo Out level, User Defined Remote Layer faders, and Group
master levels. The Fader Edit mode can also be set by using the AUTOMIX [RELATIVE]
button.
The following table explains Fader Edit mode operation (TO END: off. Edit Out: off)
Absolute
Relative
Fader edits are recorded as absolute values and
existing fader data between the punch in and out
points is erased.
Fader edits are rerecorded relative to the existing
fader data.
Existing data
Existing data
Fader edit
Fader edit
Time
Punch in
Punch out
Time
Punch in
Punch out
TOUCH SENSE: When the TOUCH button is selected, the Touch Sense function enables
you to touch the faders to punch parameter values in and out. The corresponding parameters’ OVERWRITE button must be set to on. When the LATCH button is selected, only
punch in operations are available (the punch out function is disabled).
You can also turn on or off the Touch Sense function by pressing the AUTOMIX [TOUCH
SENSE] button. This button memorizes the TOUCH and LATCH button selections on this
page. For example, if the TOUCH button is selected on this page, pressing the AUTOMIX
[TOUCH SENSE] button turns the TOUCH button on this page on or off. When the
LATCH button is selected in this page, pressing the AUTOMIX [TOUCH SENSE] button
turns the LATCH button on this page on or off.
OVERWRITE: These buttons determine which parameters can be recorded on the first
pass, and rerecorded (i.e., overwritten) on subsequent passes. They can be set while recording is in progress. Parameters for which the corresponding OVERWRITE button is not set,
cannot be edited while recording is in progress. They work in unison with the AUTOMIX
[FADER], [ON], [PAN], [SURROUND], [AUX], [AUX ON] & [EQ] buttons.
Parameter button
Description
FADER
Channel faders (Inputs Channels, Bus Out masters, Aux Send masters, Matrix
Send masters, the Stereo Out, Group master levels, and User Defined Layer faders)
ON
Channel Mutes (ON/OFF), User Defined Layer [ON] buttons, and Group master ON
PAN
Input Channel Pan, User Defined Layer Encoders
SURR
Input Channel Surround pan, LFE level, DIV parameter, and RDIV parameter
AUX
Aux/Matrix Send 1–12 levels
AUX ON
Aux/Matrix Send 1–12 mutes
EQ
EQ (F, Q, G, On/Off)
Scene and library recalls, and internal effects processors and Plug-Ins parameters can be
recorded regardless of the OVERWRITE settings.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Automix Main Page
197
AUTOMIX: This button is used to enable and disable the Automix function. It works in
unison with the AUTOMIX [ENABLE] button.
NEW: This button is used to create a new Automix. When a new Automix is created, a
Scene recall event to recall the current Scene (i.e., the last Scene recalled) is automatically
inserted at the start of the Automix. You can edit this event so that another Scene is recalled.
This initial Scene is important because it sets all the mix parameters how you’d like them at
the beginning of the Automix. Without it, mix parameters would remain the same as when
Automix playback was stopped.
UNDO: This button is used to undo various Automix operations. During each recording
pass, when a new Automix is created, when an Automix is recalled, when an offline edit is
performed, or when the Undo function is used, the current Automix data is copied to the
Undo buffer, from which it can be retrieved by pressing UNDO while Automix is stopped.
This button works in unison with the AUTOMIX [ABORT/UNDO] button.
INSERT: The INSERT button inserts the current Scene into the current Automix data. This
is useful when you want to quickly swap out a specified range of the Automix data, such as
a line of dialog. See “Inserting Mix Parameters into Automix” on page 203 for more information.
AUTO REC: This button works the same as the REC button except that it remains on when
Automix recording is stopped. It appears highlighted while Auto Record mode is on. It
works in unison with the AUTOMIX [AUTO-REC] button.
REC: This button is used to engage Record-Ready mode, in which Automix recording starts
automatically as soon as the specified timecode source starts. Unlike the AUTO REC button,
however, it’s turned off when recording is stopped. It flashes in Record-Ready mode, and is
highlighted during recording. This button can also be used to engage Automix recording
during playback. To do this, while the PLAY button is highlighted (i.e., during playback),
press the REC button (it flashes in Record-Ready mode). Then press the PLAY button to
start recording. This button works in unison with the AUTOMIX [REC] button.
PLAY: This button is used to start Automix recording and playback when the timecode
source is set to internal. When an external timecode source is selected, while the external
timecode is being received, recording and playback are started, and this button is turned on
automatically. If Automix is stopped by pressing the STOP or ABORT button, recording or
playback can be restarted by pressing this button so long as timecode is still being received.
This button can also be used in conjunction with the REC button to punch in recording
during Automix playback.
STOP: This button is used to stop Automix playback and recording. It appears highlighted
while Automix is stopped.
ABORT: This button is used to abort the current recording without updating the existing
Automix data. Automix recording can also be aborted by pressing the AUTOMIX
[ABORT/UNDO] button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
198
Chapter 17—Automix
AUTOMIX Section
Certain Automix functions and parameters can be controlled by using the buttons in the
AUTOMIX section.
AUTOMIX
DISPLAY
ENABLE
REC
SUSPEND
WRITE
ABORT/ AUTOUNDO
REC
TOUCH
LATCH
RETURN RELATIVE TOUCH
SENSE
READ
TRIM
OFF
AUX
ON
EQ
OVERWRITE
FADER
ON
PAN SURROUND AUX
[DISPLAY] button: This button is used to select the following Automix pages: Main,
Memory, Fader Edit, Event Copy, and Event Edit.
[ENABLE] button: This button is used to enable and disable the Automix function. It
works in unison with the ENABLED/DISABLED button on the Automix Main page.
[REC] button: This button can be used to engage Record-Ready mode from stop, engage
recording during playback, and to stop recording. Its indicator flashes in Record-Ready
mode, and lights continuously during recording. Pressing this button along with the
[AUTO REC] button places the DM2000 in Insert mode (see page 203).
[ABORT/UNDO] button: This button is used to abort Automix recording or playback.
While Automix is stopped, it performs the undo function, reverting to the Automix in the
Undo buffer. It works in unison with the ABORT and UNDO buttons on the Automix Main
and Memory pages.
[AUTO-REC] button: This button is used to turn Auto Recording on and off. Its indicator lights up while Auto Record is on. It works in unison with the AUTO REC button on the
Automix Main and Memory pages.
[RETURN] button: This button is used to set the Edit Out mode. It works in unison with
the EDIT OUT RETURN buttons on the Automix Main and Memory pages. When its indicator is on, Return mode is set. When its indicator is flashing, Takeover mode is set. And
when its indicator is off, neither mode is set.
[RELATIVE] button: This button is used to set the Fader Edit mode. It works in unison
with the FADER EDIT buttons on the Automix Main and Memory pages. When its indicator is off, Absolute mode is set. When its indicator is on, Relative mode is set.
[TOUCH SENSE] button: This button is used to turn Automix recording on and off via
Fader Touch Sense. It works in unison with the TOUCH buttons on the Automix Main
pages and the Fader Edit pages (see page 194 and 199).
[FADER], [ON], [PAN], [SURROUND], [AUX], [AUX ON] & [EQ] buttons:
These buttons determine which parameters can be recorded on the first pass, and rerecorded (i.e., overwritten) on subsequent passes. They work in unison with their counterparts on the Automix Main and Memory pages.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Channel Strip [AUTO] Buttons
199
Channel Strip [AUTO] Buttons
•
•
•
•
•
•
The channel strip [AUTO] buttons are used to arm channels in Record-Ready
mode, and to punch channels in and out during recording.
AUTO
The [AUTO] button indicators operate as follows:
Off: Automix playback disabled
Green: Automix stopped or playing
Orange: Record-Ready mode
Red: Recording (even for individual parameters, see page 207)
Flashing red: Takeover in progress
Flashing green: indicates that a fader is inactive, for example, when you continue touching
a fader after actual punch out has occurred when using the Takeover Edit Out mode.
Automix Memory Page
1
2
Automixes can be stored and recalled on the Automix Memory page. The lower half of this
page is identical to the Automix Main page.
Use the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] button to locate the Automix Memory page.
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
The Automix library functions are explained in “Automix Library” on page 173. The
remaining items are the same as on the Main page and are explained on page 194.
Fader Edit Pages
During playback, fader positions are displayed graphically as black bars on the Fader Edit
page, of which there are three. The CH1–48 Fader Edit page displays Faders positions for
Input Channel 1 through 48, the Bus Outs, Aux Sends, and Stereo Out. The CH49–96 Fader
Edit page displays faders positions for Input Channel 49 through 96, the Bus Outs, Aux
Sends, and Matrix Sends. The Group Fader Edit page displays the fader position for the
Input Group Master Levels and Output Group Master Levels. When the Fader mode is set
to Fader, Input and Output Channel levels are displayed. When it’s set to Aux/Mtrx mode,
Aux/Matrix Send levels are displayed.
During rerecording, arrows are displayed next to each fader bar. A
downward arrow indicates that the current fader position is higher
than that specified by the existing fader data. An upward arrow indicates that the current fader position is lower than that specified by
the existing fader data.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
200
Chapter 17—Automix
1
Use the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] button to locate the Fader Edit pages.
The CH1–48 Fader Edit page is shown here.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
The counter in the upper-left corner displays the current timecode position.
Edit Safe buttons: The numbered buttons below each fader bar are Channel Safe buttons, which can be used to prohibit automix recording on certain channels. A channel is set
to safe when its button appears highlighted.
You can make all channels safe by selecting one “non-safe” button and double-clicking the
[ENTER] button. A confirmation message appears.
You can cancel all safe channels by selecting one “safe” button and double-clicking the
[ENTER] button. A confirmation message appears.
During recording, events cannot be recorded, or rerecorded on safe channels, although
existing events are played back and faders, Encoders, [ON] buttons, and so on can still be
used, which is useful for rehearsing mix moves. Channel safe settings cannot be changed
during recording.
ABSOLUTE & RELATIVE: These buttons are the same as those on the Main and Memory
pages. See “Automix Main Page” on page 194 for more information.
MOTOR: This button is used to turn the fader motors are on and off for Automix playback. The button appears highlighted when the motors are on. The motors cannot be
turned off during recording, and are automatically turned on when recording starts.
TOUCH SENSE: This button is the same as the TOUCH SENSE button on the Automix
Main page (see page 196).
UPDATE: This button is the same as that on the Main and Memory pages. See “Automix
Main Page” on page 194 for more information.
EDIT OUT: The TAKEOVER and RETURN buttons are the same as those on the Main and
Memory pages. See “Automix Main Page” on page 194 for more information. The TIME
parameter determines the time it takes faders to return to levels specified by the existing
Automix data when the Edit Out mode is set to Return. It can be set from 0.0 to 30.0 seconds
in 0.1 second steps.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Selecting the Timecode Source & Frame Rate
201
Selecting the Timecode Source & Frame Rate
1
2
The timecode source and frame rate for Automix can be set as follows.
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to select the Time Reference page.
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
TIME REFERENCE: The following timecode sources can be selected.
Source
Description
INTERNAL
Internally generated timecode
SMPTE
SMPTE timecode received via the SMPTE TIME CODE INPUT
MIDI CLOCK
MIDI Clock received via the MIDI IN port
MTC
MTC received via the MTC TIME CODE INPUT
USB
MTC received via the USB TO HOST port
SERIAL
MTC received via the SERIAL TO HOST port
SLOT1
MTC received via Slot #1 (for use with an optional mLAN I/O Card installed in Slot #1)
MIDI
MTC received via the MIDI IN port
For the USB and SERIAL sources, you must specify a port from 1–8.
FRAMES: The frame rate can be set to: 30, 30D, 29.97, 29.97D, 25, or 24. An Automix will
playback correctly even if the frame rate is different to that which was used when the Automix was originally recorded.
The MIDI CLOCK source supports Song position Pointers, F8 TIMING CLOCK (timing
info), FA START (starts Automix from beginning), FB CONTINUE (starts Automix from
current position), and FC STOP (stops Automix).
DM2000 Version 2
Owner’s Manual
202
Chapter 17—Automix
Creating a Time Signature Map
1
2
When using the MIDI CLOCK timecode source, you’ll also need to specify the initial time
signature and any time signature changes that follow.
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to select the Time Signature page.
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel or INC/DEC buttons to specify the measure and time signature.
To insert a time signature change, use the cursor buttons to select the next available entry,
and press [ENTER], or turn the Parameter wheel.
To delete a time signature change, select it, and then press [ENTER]. The initial time signature entry at measure #1 cannot be deleted.
Recording an Automix
1
This section provides a general procedure for Automix recording.
Select the timecode source and frame rate.
See “Selecting the Timecode Source & Frame Rate” on page 201 for more information.
2
Use the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] button to locate the Automix Main page.
3
Press the AUTOMIX [ENABLE] button to enable the Automix function.
The AUTOMIX [ENABLE] button indicator lights up, and the ENABLED/DISABLED button on the Automix main page appears highlighted.
4
Use the AUTOMIX OVERWRITE buttons to select which parameters you want
to record.
The corresponding AUTOMIX OVERWRITE button indicators light up, and the corresponding OVERWRITE buttons on the Automix Main and Memory pages appear highlighted.
5
Press the AUTOMIX [REC] button.
The AUTOMIX [REC] button indicator flashes, and the REC button on the Automix Main
and Memory pages flashes.
Alternatively, you could press the AUTOMIX [AUTO-REC] button so that Automix recording starts automatically when timecode is received. The main difference between REC and
AUTO REC is that the AUTO REC functions remains on when recording is stopped.
Whereas REC must be pressed each and every time you want to start recording. Initially
however, REC may be the safer option.
6
Use the [AUTO] buttons to arm channels for Automix recording.
The [AUTO] button indicators of armed channels light up orange.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Inserting Mix Parameters into Automix
203
7
Start the timecode source.
The AUTOMIX [REC] button indicator lights up continuously, and on the Automix Main
and Memory pages, the REC and PLAY buttons appear highlighted.
8
Adjust the faders and other controls as necessary.
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL section to edit the currently selected channel. Channels are
selected automatically when the [AUTO] buttons are pressed. You can punch channels out
of recording by using the [AUTO] buttons.
9
To stop Automix recording, stop the timecode source or press the STOP button on the Automix Main or Memory page.
When the Mix Update Confirmation preference is on (see page 277), a confirmation message appears asking if you want to update the existing Automix data (i.e., keep the edits just
recorded).
Inserting Mix Parameters into Automix
You can insert the static mix parameter settings into the range specified by the IN and OUT
parameters in the current Automix data. This is useful when you want to quickly insert
static EQ settings into a specified range of the Automix data.
Before Insert
Event
No event
After Insert
Event
Event erased
Value prior to Insert
Inserted
parameter value
Time
1
IN
OUT
Time
Follow Steps 1–4 as described in the “Recording an Automix” section on the
previous page, then press the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] button to display the
Automix Main page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
204
Chapter 17—Automix
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the INSERT button, then press [ENTER].
Alternatively, press the AUTOMIX [REC] and [AUTO REC] buttons simultaneously.
A confirmation message appears.
3
Use the IN and OUT parameters to specify the region to be inserted.
The default IN and OUT parameter values use the Locate memories specified by the Insert
Time Link preference (see page 278). If you change the Locate points for the corresponding
Locate memories while the confirmation message is displayed, the IN and OUT parameter
values will be updated accordingly.
If MIDI clock is selected as a timecode source, these parameters indicate the position in
bar:beats:clocks and use the IN and OUT parameter values in the TIME SETTING section
on the Event Job page. In this case, the Insert Time Link preference is disabled.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select YES, then press [ENTER].
The DM2000 enters Insert mode, and the INSERT button is highlighted. The AUTOMIX
[REC] and [AUTO REC] button indicators flash.
The fader positions, mute function and other parameters are updated to the settings specified for the time value of the IN parameter.
5
Select the parameter you wish to insert using the AUTOMIX OVERWRITE buttons.
To select effect or plug-in parameters, locate the Effect Edit or Plug-in Edit page, then move
the cursor to the desired parameter and press [ENTER].
6
Select the insert destination channel by pressing the corresponding [AUTO]
button.
The selected [AUTO] button indicator lights up red.
7
Edit a parameter you wish to insert.
It might be helpful to use loop playback (page 259) while editing the parameter if you wish
to insert EQ parameters.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Rerecording Events
205
8
Use the cursor buttons to select the INSERT button, then press [ENTER].
Alternatively, press the AUTOMIX [REC] and [AUTO REC] buttons simultaneously.
A confirmation message appears.
9
Use the cursor buttons to select YES, then press [ENTER] to insert the data.
Once the data is inserted, Insert mode is cancelled and the INSERT button is unhighlighted.
Rerecording Events
Events can be rerecorded as many times as you like. Remember, however, that unlike the
first pass, on subsequent passes, existing events for the currently punched in parameter are
overwritten, so use the OVERWRITE buttons and [AUTO] buttons with care. Instead of
using the [AUTO] buttons to punch in an entire channel, you can reduce the risk of overwriting important data by punching in and out individual parameters (see page 207). Use
the Update To End option to determine how existing events are handled when rerecording
is stopped (see page 194). Use the Edit Out (see page 195) and Fader Edit (see page 196)
options to determine how Fader events are rerecorded.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
206
Chapter 17—Automix
Parameter Recording
The following table summarizes parameter recording operation for each parameter. Parameter adjustments made on the respective display pages are also recorded.
Parameter
Channel
OVERWRITE
Input
Channel Levels
(faders)
Bus Out, Aux Send,
Matrix Send
Stereo Out
FADER
Group Master levels
Channel Mutes
(ON/OFF)
Input
Bus Out, Aux Send,
Matrix Send
Stereo Out
Group Master
On/Off
Pan
Input
Surround Pan
Input
EQ (F, Q, G, On/Off)
Input, Bus Out, Aux
Send, Matrix Send,
Stereo Out
Aux send 1–12 levels
Input
Aux send 1–12 mutes
Input
Bus Out, Aux Send
Matrix send 1–4 levels
Bus Out, Aux Send,
Stereo Out
Matrix send 1–4 mutes Bus Out, Aux Send,
Stereo Out
Scene recalls
—
Effect parameters
(certain parameters)
Effects processors
1–8
—
User Defined Plug-Ins
(parameters 1–4)
Plug-Ins 1–8
—
FADER
[ON] buttons
ON
Encoders
PAN
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Pair/Group
Faders of paired channels
and grouped faders are
recorded together
[ON] buttons of paired
channels and grouped
mutes are recorded
together
Use Stereo Out [ON] button
Use [ON] buttons assigned to Group Master in the User Assignable Layer.
Set Layer to input, Encoder mode to Pan, If Pan mode is Gang or
PAN
use Encoders
Inverse-Gang, paired channels are recorded together.
Use Joystick (If a surround parameter is
If ST LINK button on Surassigned to the Encoders, also use Encod- round Edit page is on, adjaSURR
ers)
cent channels are recorded
together.
Use SELECTED CHANNEL EQUALIZER sec- EQ of paired channels, and
EQ
tion (If EQ parameter assigned to an
grouped EQs recorded
Encoder, also use Encoders)
together
Use SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX
Aux send levels of paired
SEND LEVEL controls (If Layer is input and channels recorded
Fader mode is Aux/Mtrx, use faders. If
together. (If the selected
AUX
Layer is input and Encoder mode is
Aux Send is paired, the
Aux/Mtrx, use Encoders)
send level to both Aux
Sends is recorded.)
Use SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX
Aux send mutes of paired
SEND [ON] buttons
channels recorded together
AUX ON
(If the selected Aux Send is
paired, mutes for both Aux
Sends recorded.)
If Layer is Master and Fader mode is
Matrix send levels of paired
Aux/Mtrx, use faders (If Layer is Master and Bus Outs or Aux Sends
AUX Encoder mode is Aux/Mtrx, use Encoders) recorded together
Use SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX
SEND controls
Use SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX
Matrix send mutes of
AUX ON SEND [ON] buttons
paired Bus Outs or Aux
Sends recorded together
Use SCENE MEMORY section or Scene
—
—
Memory page
Use corresponding library page
—
—
EQ, Gate, Comp,
Effects, Channel
Faders
Set Layer to input, Fader mode to Fader,
use faders
Set Layer to Master, Fader mode to Fader,
use faders
Use Stereo Out fader
Use faders assigned to Group Master in the
User Assignable Layer.
Set Layer to input, use [ON] buttons
Set Layer to Master, use [ON] buttons
ON
Library recalls
User Defined Remote
Layers
Operation
Use Parameter controls 1–4 (push to punch
in/out). Select the desired parameter on
the Effect Edit page, then press [ENTER]
Use Parameter controls 1–4 (push to punch
in/out). Select the desired parameter on
the Plug-in Edit page, then press [ENTER]
Select User Defined Remote Layer, use faders
Select User Defined Remote Layer, use
[ON] buttons
Select User Defined Remote Layer, use
Encoder
—
—
—
—
—
Punching In & Out Individual Parameters
207
Punching In & Out Individual Parameters
During Automix rerecording, channels can be punched in and out by pressing the channel
strip [AUTO] buttons. Individual parameters can be punched in and out as follows.
Parameter
Channel
OVERWRITE
Bus Out, Aux
Send, Matrix
Send
Stereo Out
Pan
Input
PAN
Surround Pan
Input
SURR
EQ (F, Q, G)
All channels
EQ
Aux send 1–12
Input
AUX
Aux send 1–12
mutes
Input
AUX
ON
Matrix send 1–4
levels
Bus Out, Aux
Send, Stereo
Out
AUX
Matrix send 1–4
mutes
Bus Out, Aux
Send, Stereo
Out
AUX
ON
Stereo Out fader
Set the Fader mode to Fader; Set
the Group Master in the User
Assignable Layer.
Set Layer to input, Encoder mode
to Pan
Select Input Layer and assign Surround LFE Level or Surround Pan
Wheel to the Encoders
Turn on Auto EQ Edit In preference (see page 277). Use
SELECTED CHANNEL EQUALIZER
section (If EQ parameter assigned
to an Encoder, also use Encoders)
Set Layer to input, Fader mode to
Aux/Mtrx
Press Encoder and
adjust
Press Encoder and
adjust
Effect parameters
Effects proces(certain
sors 1–8
parameters)
—
User Defined
Plug-Ins
Plug-Ins 1–8
(parameters 1–4)
—
Faders
Encoders
Release fader knob2
FADER
PAN
Press Encoder
Press Encoder
Adjust control
Press [AUTO] button
Press EQ [ON] button
Press [AUTO] button
Touch fader knob and
Release fader knob2
adjust1
Set Layer to input, Encoder mode Press Encoder and
Press Encoder
to Aux/Mtrx (Or use SELECTED
adjust
CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND
LEVEL controls)
Set Layer to input
Press SELECTED CHAN- Press [AUTO] button2
NEL AUX/ MATRIX
SEND [ON] button1
Set Layer to Master, Fader mode Touch fader knob and
to Aux/Mtrx
adjust3
Set Layer to Master, Encoder
mode to Aux/Mtrx (Also use
SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/
MATRIX SEND LEVEL controls)
Set Layer to master
Press Encoder and
adjust
Release fader knob1
Press Encoder
Press SELECTED CHAN- Press [AUTO] button2
NEL AUX/ MATRIX
SEND [ON] button1
Push Parameter 1–4
control, or select the
parameters on the
Effect Edit page, then
press [ENTER]
Select Plug-Ins
Push Parameter 1–4
control. Select the
desired parameter on
the Plug-in Edit page,
then press [ENTER]
Select User Defined Remote Layer Touch fader knob and
Push Parameter 1–4
control, or select the
parameters on the
Effect Edit page, then
press [ENTER]
Push Parameter 1–4
control. Select the
desired parameter on
the Plug-in Edit page,
then press [ENTER]
adjust1
Select User Defined Remote Layer Press Encoder and
adjust
Press Encoder
Select internal effects processors
User Defined
Remote Layers
Punch Out
FADER
Group Master
faders
EQ On/Off
Punch In
Set Layer to input, Fader mode to Touch fader knob and
Fader
adjust1
Set Layer to Master, Fader mode
to fader
Input
Channel Levels
(faders)
Operation
Release fader knob2
1. TOUCH SENSE on Fader Edit page must be TOUCH or LATCH.
2. TOUCH SENSE on Fader Edit page must be TOUCH.
3. Cannot be used to control Stereo Out to Matrix Send levels.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
208
Chapter 17—Automix
If during Automix recording you punch in an individual parameter by using the controls
listed in the above table, even if some OVERWRITE buttons are on, only the existing data
of that particular parameter will be overwritten. Likewise, when you punch out an individual parameter by using the controls listed above, only that particular parameter will be
punched out.
If during Automix recording you press an [AUTO] button to punch in a channel, the existing data of all parameters for which the corresponding OVERWRITE buttons are on will be
overwritten. When you press the [AUTO] button to punch out of recording, all of those
parameters will be punched out.
When faders are grouped with the Fader Group Master function turned off, if the OVERWRITE FADER button is on, pressing an [AUTO] button or touching the fader knob of any
fader in the group (if TOUCH SENSE on the Fader Edit page is on) puts all the corresponding channels into Record mode and all the [AUTO] button indicators light up red. The same
applies to Mute (OVERWRITE ON button) and EQ (OVERWRITE EQ button) groups.
Playing Back an Automix
So long as the Automix function is enabled, the Automix function will chase the incoming
timecode and play and stop the current Automix accordingly. Playback stops automatically
when the end of the Automix data is reached. Playback can be stopped manually by pressing
the STOP or ABORT button on the Automix Main or Memory pages, or the AUTOMIX
[ABORT/UNDO] button. Playback will stop automatically if no timecode is received for a
while, for example, if the timecode source is disconnected or turned off.
If the timecode source is set to internal, use the PLAY button on the Automix Main or Memory page to start Automix playback, and the STOP button to stop it.
You can disable Automix playback on individual channels by using the channel strip
[AUTO] buttons. During playback, the [AUTO] button indicators appear green. When
Automix playback for an individual channel is disabled, its [AUTO] button indicator goes
out.
During playback, faders move in accordance with recorded Fader events (so long as the corresponding Layer and Fader mode is selected). Fader movement can be disabled by turning
off the fader motors (see page 199). Fader events can be viewed on the Fader Edit pages (see
page 199).
Other events are reflected by the channel strip displays and various other displays and button indicators. Recorded events of the currently selected channel are displayed by the
SELECTED CHANNEL section controls and displays.
Warning: If the effects type is different to that which was used when the effects parameter edits
were recorded, the parameter edits will not be played back. However, they are not deleted.
When you rerecord effects parameter edits, it’s recommended that you delete the existing effects
events offline. See “Editing Events Offline” on page 209 for more information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Editing Events Offline
209
Editing Events Offline
Automix events can be edited offline on the Event Job and Event Edit pages. Offline editing
can be performed only while the Automix function is stopped.
Event Job Page
1
On the Event Job page, specified events on specified channels between specified in and out
points can be erased, copied, moved/merged, or trimmed.
Use the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] button to locate the Event Job page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the channels to edit, then press [ENTER] to
set them.
You can select multiple Input Channels, Bus Outs, Aux Outs, Stereo Out, and the Fader
Group Master. When you select a channel, its button is highlighted. (You can select multiple
channels.)
ALL SELECT: The ALL SELECT button selects all channels.
ALL CLEAR: The ALL CLEAR button de-selects all channels.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the IN and OUT parameters, then use the
Parameter wheel, INC/DEC buttons or [ENTER] button to specify the edit
range.
TIME SETTING: The IN and OUT parameters are used to specify the region of Automix
data to be erased, copied, moved/merged, or trimmed. The IN and OUT points can be set
on-the-fly by pressing the [ENTER] button while the IN or OUT button is selected. The
captured timecode values can be edited by using the Parameter wheel or the INC/DEC buttons. Press the [ENTER] button to reset the currently selected digits to “00.” Up to eight IN
and OUT timecode values can be captured and stored in the eight Capture memories. Use
the cursor buttons to select the Capture memory number, and use the Parameter wheel or
the INC/DEC buttons to select the Capture memories.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select a Job, then press [ENTER].
The following Jobs are available. Certain Jobs feature an additional parameter below the
TIME SETTING section.
ERASE: The ERASE button erases specified Automix data.
COPY: The COPY button copies specified Automix data. This Job features a SOURCE section and COPY TO section (below the TIME SETTING section).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
210
Chapter 17—Automix
The SOURCE section enables you to select the copy source Automix. You can select CURRENT (the current Automix) or MEM (any Automix from 1 to 16).
The TIME parameter determines the point to which the specified data is copied. The number in parentheses on the right indicates the end point of the copy destination. You can set
the TIME parameter on-the-fly by selecting the TIME button, then pressing [ENTER]. You
can edit the captured timecode value using the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons. Press
[ENTER] to reset the currently-selected digit to “00.”
The CH parameter specifies the channel to which the specified data will be copied. The
number of destination channels depends on the specified number of copy source channels.
For example, if Input Channels 1 though 8 are specified as the source, then the number of
destination channels will be eight (8). Destination channels are contiguous and only the
first channel in the range can be specified. The number in parentheses on the right indicates
the last channel in the copy destination.
You cannot copy from Input Channels to Output Channels. Also, even within Output
Channels, you cannot copy between Aux and Bus channels.
TRIM: The TRIM button trims the specified Automix data. This Job includes a TRIM
EDIT section below the TIME SETTING section.
The IN parameter determines the amount of time required for the faders to achieve the
specified trim amount. The OUT parameter determines the amount of time required for
the faders to return to the previous levels. The LEVEL parameter specifies the fader trim
amount in the range of –96 dB to +96 dB.
Existing data
Trim: –x dB
Trimmed data
TRIM IN
IN
TRIM OUT
Time
OUT
MOVE/MERGE: This Job features a SOURCE section and a MOVE TO (MERGE TO)
section below the TIME SETTING section. The function of this button changes depending
on the SOURCE section setting. If you select CURRENT (current Automix) in the
SOURCE section, this button becomes the MOVE button, which enables you to move the
specified range of Automix data to another position. If you select MEM (Automix memories 1–16) in the SOURCE section, this button becomes the MERGE button, which enables
you to merge the specified range of Automix data with other Automix data.
The SOURCE section enables you to select the move/merge source Automix. You can select
CURRENT (the current Automix) or MEM (any Automix from 1 to 16).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Editing Events Offline
211
The TIME parameter determines the point to which the specified data is moved or merged.
The number in parentheses on the right indicates the end point of the move/merge destination. You can set the TIME parameter on-the-fly by selecting the TIME button, then
pressing [ENTER]. You can edit the captured timecode value using the Parameter wheel or
the INC/DEC buttons. Press the [ENTER] button to reset the currently-selected digit to
“00.”
The CH parameter specifies the channel to which the specified data will be moved or
merged. The number of destination channels depends on the number of move/merge
source channels specified. For example, if Input Channels 1 though 8 are specified as the
source, then the number of destination channels will be eight (8). Destination channels are
contiguous and only the first channel in the range can be specified. The number in parentheses on the right indicates the last channel of the move/merge destination.
You cannot move or merge from Input Channels to Output Channels. Also, even within
Output Channels, you cannot move or merge between Aux and Bus channels.
5
Use the cursor buttons to select the EXEC button, then press [ENTER].
The PARAMETERS window appears, which enables you to select the parameters to be
edited, and to perform the selected Job.
When you select a parameter, its button is highlighted. You can specify multiple parameters.
Double-clicking a non-highlighted parameter button will display a message confirming
that you wish to highlight all parameter buttons. Double-clicking a highlighted parameter
button will display a message that you wish to unhighlight all parameter buttons.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
212
Chapter 17—Automix
These buttons correspond to the following parameters:
Button
FADER
Channel Fader events (Inputs Channels, Bus Out masters, Aux Send masters,
Matrix Send masters, Group master levels, and the Stereo Out)
ON
Channel Mute events, and Group master ON
PAN
Input Channel pan events
SURR
Input Channel surround pan, LFE level, DIV parameter events, and RDIV parameter events
EQ
Channel EQ events
LIB
6
Events
CH
Channel library recall events
GATE
Gate library recall events
COMP
Comp library recall events
EQ
EQ library recall events
SCENE
Scene recall events
FX LIB
1–8
Effects library recall events of each internal effects processor
AUX
1–12
Level events of each Aux Send
ON
1–12
Mute events of each Aux Send
MATRIX
1–4
Level events of each Matrix Send
ON
1–4
Mute events of each Matrix Send
REMOTE
1–4
User Defined Remote Layer events
EFFECT
1–8
Parameter events for each internal effects processor
PLUG-IN
1–8
Parameter events for each Plug-In
Use the cursor buttons to select the EXEC button, then press [ENTER].
When the confirmation message appears, select YES to execute the Job.
BACK: Select this button to return to the previous page without executing the Job.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Editing Events Offline
213
Event Edit Page
1
2
On the Event Edit page, you can edit, duplicate, delete, and insert new events.
Use the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] button to locate the Event Edit page.
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
Event list: Automix events are listed in chronological order. The type of events listed
depends on the Event select buttons. Use the cursor buttons to select event parameters.
While the cursor is on the SYNC, DUPLICATE, DELETE, SELECTED CH, or Event select
buttons, you can use the Parameter wheel or the INC/DEC buttons to scroll the list. While
the cursor is inside the event list, you can use these controls to edit event parameters. The
triangular cursor at the left side of the list indicates the currently selected event. When an
event’s timecode value is edited, the list is resorted automatically.
SYNC button: This button is used to synchronize the list to the current timecode position. When pressed, events closest to the current timecode position are displayed. This
function can be used during Automix playback.
DUPLICATE button: This button is used to duplicate events. Use the Parameter wheel to
select an event, select the DUPLICATE button, and then press [ENTER]. A duplicate event
is inserted below the currently selected event. If there are no events in the list, you can use
this button to insert a new event of the type specified by the Event select buttons.
DELETE button: This button is used to delete events. Use the Parameter wheel to select
an event, select the DELETE button, and then press [ENTER].
SELECTED CH: When this option is on, only events of the currently selected channel are
displayed. All Scene recall and effects library recall events are displayed regardless of this
option. For paired channels, only events of the currently selected channel are displayed.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
214
Chapter 17—Automix
Event select buttons: These buttons are used to select the type of events to be displayed
in the event list.
Button
Events Listed
List Format
SCENE/LIB
Library and Scene recall events
TIME CODE, CH, SCENE/LIB
Channel faders (Inputs Channels, Bus Out masters,
Aux Send masters, Matrix Send masters, Group master levels, and the Stereo Out)
TIME CODE, CH, dB, SEC
FADER
ON
Channel Mutes (ON/OFF)
TIME CODE, CH, ON/OFF
PAN
Pan
TIME CODE, CH, L-C-R
SURR-PAN
Surround pan
TIME CODE, CH, SURR
SURR-LFE
Surround LFE
TIME CODE, CH, dB
SURR-DIV
Surround DIV
TIME CODE, CH, DIV
SURR-RDIV
Surround RDIV
TIME CODE, CH, DIV
EQ-ON
EQ ON/OFF
TIME CODE, CH, ON/OFF
EQ-FREQ
EQ Frequency
TIME CODE, CH, BAND/Hz
EQ-Q
EQ Q
TIME CODE, CH, BAND/Q
EQ-GAIN
EQ Gain
TIME CODE, CH, BAND/dB
AUX
Aux/matrix Send 1–12 levels
TIME CODE, CH, AUX, dB
AUX ON
Aux/matrix Send 1–12 mutes
TIME CODE, CH, AUX, ON/OFF
INSERT button: This button is used to insert new events. Use the Event select buttons to
select the type of event that you want to insert. Use the Captured timecode counter to specify the point at which you want to insert the new event. Select the INSERT button, and then
press [ENTER].
LOCATE button: This button is used to locate events at the Capture memory display
position.
Capture memory display: This displays the captured timecode position. The captured
timecode values can be edited by using the Parameter wheel or the INC/DEC buttons. Press
the [ENTER] button to reset the currently selected digits to “00.”
CAPTURE button: This button is used to capture the current timecode position. Up to
eight timecode values can be captured and stored in the eight Capture memories. Use the
cursor buttons to select the Capture memory number, and use the Parameter wheel or the
INC/DEC buttons to select the Capture memories. Capture memories can be selected even
while the CAPTURE, LOCATE, or INSERT button is selected.
If the Auto Inc TC capture preference is on (see page 277), Capture memories increment
automatically each time a timecode position is captured.
If the Link Capture & Locate Memory preference is on (see page 277), the eight Capture
memories are linked to the eight Locate memories so that, for example, edits made to Capture memory #1 are reflected on Locate memory #1, and vice versa.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
MIDI
215
18 MIDI
MIDI & the DM2000
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
The DM2000 supports the following MIDI messages:
Program Changes for recalling Scenes (see page 218)
Control Changes for real-time parameter control (see page 219)
System Exclusive Parameter Changes for real-time parameter control (see page 219)
MIDI Note On/Off for Freeze effect etc. (see page 325)
Bulk Dump for transmitting Scene, library, and setup data (see page 220)
MTC and MIDI Clock for Automix synchronization (see page 201)
MMC for external machine control (see page 256)
User Defined Plug-Ins transmit user-specified MIDI data when Parameter controls 1–4 are
operated (see page 179)
User Defined Remote Layers transmit user-specified MIDI data when the channel strip faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons are operated (see page 253)
Predefined Remote Layers for controlling popular DAWs (Digital Audio Workstations),
including Pro Tools (see page 221)
MIDI I/O
•
•
•
•
The DM2000 features four types of interface for transmitting and receiving MIDI data:
Standard MIDI ports
TO HOST USB port
TO HOST SERIAL port
SLOT1 (for use with an optional mLAN I/O Card installed in Slot #1)
TO HOST SERIAL and TO HOST USB are multiport interfaces, with eight ports each.
When the DM2000 receives MIDI data via any of these interfaces, the MIDI indicator
appears on the display (see page 52).
If you are connecting a Windows computer to the TO HOST USB or TO HOST SERIAL
port, you must install and use the YAMAHA CBX Driver for Windows and the YAMAHA
USB Driver for Windows, which are included on the supplied CD-ROM.
If you plan to connect a Macintosh computer to the TO HOST USB port, you must install
and use the YAMAHA USB Driver for Macintosh, or the YAMAHA USB Driver for MacOS
X. If you are using MacOS 8.6–9.2.2, you must install OMS 2.3.3 in the Macintosh.
If you plan to connect a Macintosh computer running MacOS 8.6–9.2.2 to the TO HOST
SERIAL port on the DM2000, you must install OMS 2.3.3 in the Macintosh.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
216
Chapter 18—MIDI
MIDI Port Setup
1
2
MIDI ports are configured as follows.
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to locate the MIDI/TO HOST Setup
page.
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
TO HOST SERIAL: These buttons are used to configure the TO HOST SERIAL port for
use with either a Mac or PC.
Caution: When a PC is connected to the TO HOST SERIAL port, do not set this to Mac
because your PC may crash.
GENERAL: These parameters are used to select ports for general MIDI data transmission
and reception, including Program Changes for recalling Scenes, Control Changes for
real-time parameter control, and Note On/Off for use with the Freeze effect. Available ports
include: MIDI, SERIAL 1–8, USB 1–8, and SLOT1.
MIDI THRU: These parameters allow you to route the incoming MIDI data from one port
through to another port. Available ports include: MIDI, SERIAL 1–8, USB 1–8, and SLOT1.
REMOTE1–4: These parameters are used to select ports for the Remote Layers. Available
ports include: MIDI, SERIAL 1–8, USB 1–8, and SLOT1. If Pro Tools is selected as the target
for a Remote Layer, “Pro Tools” is displayed here and no settings can be made.
Studio Manager: These parameters are used to select a port for use with the Studio
Manager software and to assign the DM2000 an ID from 1 to 8. Available ports include:
MIDI, SERIAL 1–8, USB 1–8, and SLOT1. See the Studio Manager documentation for more
information.
DAW: These parameters are used to select ports for use with DAWs. Since four ports are
required to control DAWs, ports are selected in groups of four, as follows: 1–4, 2–5, 3–6,
4–7, 5–8. Available ports include: SERIAL, USB, and SLOT1.
PLUG-IN1–8: These parameters are used to select ports for use with the Plug-Ins. If a
Waves Plug-In card is installed in a Slot, the number of that Slot is displayed and no settings
can be made. If the Plug-In target is set to USER DEFINED, you can select a port from
MIDI, SERIAL 1–8, USB 1–8, or SLOT1. Ports for User Defined Plug-Ins can also be set on
the Plug-In Setup page (see page 180).
Note: Some functions cannot share ports. If you try to assign a port that’s already assigned to
such a function, the message “Change Port?” appears. If you select YES, the port will be assigned
to the selected function and the previously assigned function will be set to “NO ASSIGN.”
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
MIDI Channel Setup
217
MIDI Channel Setup
1
2
MIDI Channels for reception and transmission are specified as follows.
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [MIDI] button to locate the MIDI Setup page.
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the parameters, and use
the INC/DEC buttons or [ENTER] button to set them.
Select MIDI channels for transmission and reception in the CHANNEL row, and turn the
transmission and reception of each MIDI message on or off using the buttons in the parameter rows from PROGRAM CHANGE to OTHER COMMANDS.
CHANNEL
This parameter row enables you to specify MIDI Channels for MIDI message transmission
and reception. The following parameters are available in this row:
Tx: This parameter box specifies a MIDI Transmit Channel.
Rx: This parameter box specifies a MIDI Receive Channel.
PROGRAM CHANGE
This parameter row enables or disables transmission and reception of Program Changes.
Tx ON/OFF: Transmission of Program Change messages is enabled or disabled.
Rx ON/OFF: Reception of Program Change messages is enabled or disabled.
OMNI ON/OFF: When this button is turned on, Program Changes on all MIDI Channels
are received regardless of the CHANNEL row settings.
ECHO ON/OFF: This button determines whether Program Change messages received at
the MIDI IN port are echoed through to the MIDI OUT port.
CONTROL CHANGE
This parameter row enables or disables transmission and reception of Control Changes.
Tx ON/OFF: Transmission of Control Change messages is enabled or disabled.
Rx ON/OFF: Reception of Control Change messages is enabled or disabled.
ECHO ON/OFF: This button determines whether Control Change messages received at
the MIDI IN port are echoed through to the MIDI OUT port.
PARAMETER CHANGE
This parameter row enables or disables transmission and reception of Parameter Changes.
Tx ON/OFF: Transmission of Parameter Change messages is enabled or disabled.
Rx ON/OFF: Reception of Parameter Change messages is enabled or disabled.
ECHO ON/OFF: This button determines whether Parameter Change messages received
at the MIDI IN port are echoed through to the MIDI OUT port.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
218
Chapter 18—MIDI
BULK
This parameter row enables or disables reception of Bulk Dump data.
Rx ON/OFF: Reception of Bulk Dump data is enabled or disabled.
OTHER COMMANDS
ECHO ON/OFF: This button determines whether other MIDI messages received at the
MIDI IN port are echoed through to the MIDI OUT port.
Fader Resolution
HIGH/LOW: This parameter specifies the resolution of the value output when you operate the DM2000’s faders. To transfer fader value data between two cascaded DM2000s, or
to record the DM2000 operation to or play it back from a sequencer, select the HIGH button. When the LOW button is selected, the fader resolution switches to 256 steps.
Assigning Scenes to Program Changes
DM2000 Scenes can be assigned to MIDI Program Changes for remote recall. When a Scene
is recalled on the DM2000, the assigned Program Change number is transmitted. If that
Scene is assigned to more than one Program Change, the lowest Program Change is transmitted. Likewise, when a Program Change message is received, the assigned Scene is
recalled. You must set the MIDI Setup parameters in order to transmit and receive Program
Change messages (see page 217).
1
Initially, Scenes 1 through 99 are assigned sequentially to Program Changes 1 through
99. Scene #0 is assigned to Program Changes #100. A Scene to Program Change assignment table, listing initial assignments and with space to note user assignments, is provided
on page 352. This table can be stored to an external MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer,
by using MIDI Bulk Dump (see page 220), or stored to SmartMedia (see page 271).
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [MIDI] button to locate the Program Change
Assign Table page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the PGM CHG. column, and use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select the Program Changes.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the SCENE No/TITLE column, and use the
Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select Scenes.
You can initialize the Scene to Program Change assignment table by selecting the INITIALIZE button, and then pressing [ENTER].
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Assigning Parameters to Control Changes
219
Assigning Parameters to Control Changes
1
DM2000 parameters can be assigned to MIDI Control Changes for real-time control. When
a parameter is adjusted on the DM2000, the assigned Control Change message is transmitted. Likewise, when a Control Change message is received, the assigned DM2000 parameter
is set. You must set the MIDI Setup parameters in order to transmit and receive Control
Change messages (see page 217).
A Parameter to Control Change assignment table, listing the initial assignments, is provided
on page 353. This table can be stored to an external MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer,
by using MIDI Bulk Dump (see page 220), or stored to SmartMedia (see page 271).
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [MIDI] button to locate the Control Change Assign
Table page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the MODE TABLE button, and press [ENTER].
In TABLE mode, when DM2000 parameters are adjusted, MIDI Control Change messages
are transmitted in accordance with the assignments on this page. In NRPN mode, when
DM2000 parameters are adjusted, predefined NRPNs (Non Registered Parameter Number)
are transmitted.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the No. (CH) column, and use the Parameter
wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select the Control Changes.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select the three PARAMETER columns, and use the
Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select the parameters.
Parameters with more than 128 steps require two or more Control Change messages for
MIDI transmission and reception. Certain Delay parameters and the faders are divided into
L and H parameters. Delay Time parameters are divided into LOW, MID, and HIGH
parameters. For accurate transmission, all parameters (e.g., both L and H for faders) must
be assigned to individual Control Changes.
You can initialize the Parameter to Control Change assignment table by selecting the INITIALIZE button, and then pressing [ENTER].
Controlling Parameters by Using Parameter Changes
DM2000 parameters can be controlled in real time by using Parameter Change messages,
which are System Exclusive messages. When a parameter is adjusted on the DM2000, a
Parameter Change message is transmitted. Likewise, when a Parameter Change message is
received, a DM2000 parameter is adjusted. See “MIDI Data Format” on page 369 for
detailed information. You must set the MIDI Setup parameters in order to transmit and
receive Parameter Change messages (see page 217).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
220
Chapter 18—MIDI
Using Bulk Dump
1
DM2000 data can be stored to an external MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer, by using
MIDI Bulk Dump.
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [MIDI] button to locate the Bulk Dump page.
2
To transmit data, use the CATEGORY parameters to select the type of data
you want to transmit, select the TRANSMIT button, and then press [ENTER].
The INTERVAL parameter sets the interval between data packets during transmission.
The CATEGORY parameters can be set as follows:
ALL: All data.
SCENE MEM: ALL Scenes, individual Scenes, or current (i.e., the Edit buffer).
AUTOMIX: ALL Automixes, individual Automixes, or the current Automix.
LIBRARY: The following libraries: EQ, Gate, Comp, Channel, Effects, GEQ, Bus to Stereo,
Input Patch, Output Patch, Surround Monitor. For each library you can specify ALL user
memories, individual user memories, and for the Bus to Stereo, Input Patch, Output Patch,
Surround Monitor libraries you can also specify the current settings.
BANK: User Defined Remote Layer banks (RMT UDEF), User Defined Plug-Ins banks
(PLUG UDEF), User Defined Keys banks (KEYS UDEF), or the USER ASSIGNABLE
LAYER banks (USR LAYER). For each item you can specify ALL or individual banks.
SETUP MEM: DM2000 setup data (i.e., system settings).
PGM TABLE: Scene to MIDI Program Change table. See “Assigning Scenes to Program
Changes” on page 218.
CTL TABLE: Parameter to MIDI Control Change table. See “Assigning Parameters to Control Changes” on page 219.
PLUG-IN: The settings of any installed Y56K cards. You can specify ALL Slots or Slots 4–6
individually.
3
You can also transmit DM2000 data via a MIDI cable. To receive data, use
the CATEGORY parameters to select the type of data you want to receive,
select the REQUEST button, then press [ENTER].
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Pro Tools Remote Layer
221
19 Pro Tools Remote Layer
The DM2000 features a Remote Layer target especially designed for controlling Pro Tools.
If an optional MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge is installed, Pro Tools channel levels are displayed
by the meters, and timecode is displayed on the TIME CODE counter.
Configuring Windows Computers
1
Connect your PC.
The DM2000 can be connected to your Windows PC by connecting the TO HOST SERIAL
port to a suitable RS232 serial port on your PC, or by connecting the TO HOST USB port
to a USB port on your PC. If you use the TO HOST SERIAL port, make sure that the TO
HOST SERIAL parameter on the MIDI/TO HOST Setup page is set to PC-2 (see page 216).
2
Install the necessary drivers.
Once your PC is connected, you’ll need to install the TO HOST SERIAL or TO HOST USB
drivers included on the DM2000 CD-ROM.
Configuring Macintosh Computers (MacOS 8.6 to 9.2.2)
1
Connect your Mac.
The DM2000 can be connected to your Mac by connecting the TO HOST SERIAL port to
either the Printer or Modem port on your Mac, or by connecting the TO HOST USB port
to a USB port on your Mac. If you use the TO HOST SERIAL port, make sure that the TO
HOST SERIAL parameter on the MIDI/TO HOST Setup page is set to Mac (see page 216).
2
Install OMS.
The DM2000 communicates with Pro Tools via OMS (Open Music System) software. If you
already have OMS installed on your Mac, there’s no need to install it again and you can
move on to the next section. If you don’t already have OMS installed, it’s included on the
DM2000 CD-ROM. Refer to the OMS documentation included on the DM2000 CD-ROM
for more information on installing.
3
Install Yamaha USB MIDI driver 1.04 or later.
If you are using the TO HOST USB port, you must also install the Yamaha USB MIDI driver
included on the DM2000 CD-ROM. See the included documentation for more information.
Configuring Macintosh Computer (MacOS X)
1
Connect the DM2000 TO HOST USB port to a USB port on your Mac.
2
Install the Yamaha USB MIDI Driver for MacOS X on the computer.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
222
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Configuring the DM2000
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to locate the MIDI/TO HOST Setup
page, and use the DAW parameter to specify the port to which Pro Tools is
connected.
See “MIDI Port Setup” on page 216 for more information.
2
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [REMOTE] button to locate the Remote pages, and
assign Pro Tools to a Remote Layer.
See “Assigning Targets to Remote Layers” on page 253 for more information.
3
Use the LAYER [REMOTE] buttons to select the Pro Tools Remote Layer.
When the Pro Tools Remote Layer is selected, the DM2000’s control surface controls Pro
Tools, not the DM2000. In order to control the DM2000, you need to select an Input Channel Layer or the Master Layer. Audio mixing on the Input and Master Layers, and Automix
continues while the Pro Tools Layer is selected.
Configuring Pro Tools
1
Pro Tools needs to be configured as follows. For more information, see your Pro Tools documentation.
Launch Pro Tools.
2
If you are using MacOS 8.6 - 9.2.2, choose OMS Studio Setup from the Setups
menu, and configure OMS as necessary.
This screen shot shows the Yamaha USB MIDI driver with eight ports. An OMS-compatible
device profile for the DM2000 is included on the DM2000 CD-ROM. See the included documentation for more information.
3
Choose Peripherals from the Setups menu.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Configuring Pro Tools
223
4
When the Peripherals window appears, click the MIDI Controllers button.
5
Select HUI as the Type of controller for #1–#3, and select MCS PANNER for
#4 to enable use of the Joystick.
6
Select the Receive From and Send To ports, and then click OK.
The DM2000 can emulate up to three typical 8-channel Pro Tools MIDI controllers. A single MIDI port is required for every eight channels. So, you must configure MIDI Controller
#1 to use channels 1 through 8, MIDI Controller #2 to use channels 9 through 16, and MIDI
Controller #3 to use channels 17 through 24.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
224
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer
This section explains the operation of the DM2000 control surface when the Pro Tools
Remote Layer is selected. DM2000 buttons and controls are referred to by the names
printed on the DM2000 with the name of the corresponding Pro Tools function in parenthesis. For example, “Press the MATRIX SELECT [MATRIX 1] (DEFAULT) button.” In keyboard shortcuts, the Pro Tools function names are left out for simplification.
Display
This is the Pro Tools Remote Layer page, the various sections of which are explained below.
TARGET
This parameter cannot be changed here. To change the target for this Layer, you must first
select another Layer, and then use the DISPLAY ACCESS [REMOTE] button to locate the
Remote page for this Layer. See “Assigning Targets to Remote Layers” on page 253 for more
information.
COUNTER
This counter works in unison with the timecode counter
in Pro Tools. The display format is specified in Pro Tools.
The three check boxes indicate the currently selected format, as follows:
TIME CODE: Pro Tools timecode format set to “Time Code.”
FEET: Pro Tools timecode format set to “Feet:Frames.”
BEATS: Pro Tools timecode format set to “Bars:Beats.”
When the Pro Tools timecode format is set to “Minutes:Seconds” or “Samples,” no check
boxes are selected.
CURSOR MODE
The currently selected Cursor mode is displayed here: NAVIGATION, ZOOM, or SELECT. Cursor modes are selected by using the
[INC] (CURSOR MODE) button.
SELECT ASSIGN
This indicates the current function of the Encoders. For example,
Pan (PanR), SndA, SndB, SndC, SndD, or SndE.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer
225
INSERT ASSIGN/EDIT
ASSIGN: This indicator works in unison with the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [5] (ASSIGN)
button indicator. See “Assigning Inserts/Plug-ins” on page 244 for more information.
COMPARE: This indicator works in unison with the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [6] (COMPARE) button indicator. See “Editing Plug-ins” on page 245 for more information.
BYPASS: This indicator works in unison with the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [7] (BYPASS)
button indicator. See “Editing Plug-ins” on page 245 and “Bypassing Individual Plug-ins”
on page 246 for more information.
INSERT: This indicator works in unison with the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [8]
(INSERT/PARAM) button indicator. See “Editing Plug-ins” on page 245 for more information.
INSERT/PARAM Display
This section displays mainly insert and plug-in-related information, although other messages are also displayed here.
Encoder Display
This section displays information about the Parameter controls 1–4. The SEL indicators
show the on/off status of the Parameter control push-switches. The rotary control indicators show the positions of the Parameter controls. The “O” symbol below each Parameter
control shows the automation status for each Parameter control.
Channel Strips
AUTO
DM2000 channel strips correspond to Pro Tools channels from left to right, with
the leftmost Pro Tools channel being handled by DM2000 channel strip #1. You
can change the order of channel strips by dragging the channel select buttons in
Pro Tools, in which case the DM2000 automatically reorders its channel strips.
By using certain USER DEFINED KEYS, Pro Tools channels can be scrolled
individually (see page 234), or in banks of 24 (see page 234).
SEL
SOLO
ON
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
226
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Encoders & Push-Switches
The Encoders are used to set pan and send levels and select I/O assignments. The Encoder
push-switches are used to mute sends, reset send levels and panpots, and confirm I/O
assignments. Their exact operation depends on the currently selected Encoder mode, as
shown in the following table.
Encoder Mode
[PAN]
[SEND LEVEL]
[INPUT]
[OUTPUT]
[SEND ASSIGN]
Encoder
Push-switches
Pan (see page 241)
Reset pan (see page 247)
Send levels (see page 243)
Mute sends (see page 243)
Send pre/post (see page 242)
Reset send levels (see page 247)
Select input source (see page 239)
Select output destination (see page 240)
Confirm selection
Select send destination (see page 242)
[AUTO] buttons
These buttons are used in conjunction with the AUTOMIX section to set the Automation
mode of each channel. See “Setting the Automation Mode” on page 250 for more information.
[SEL] buttons
These buttons are used to select channels (see page 239), to select inserts (see page 245), and
to bypass inserts (see page 246).
[SOLO] buttons
These buttons are used to solo channels. See “Soloing Channels” on page 241 for more
information.
[ON] buttons
These buttons are used to mute channels. See “Muting Channels” on page 241 for more
information.
Faders
The faders are used to set channel levels (see page 240), or to set send levels in
Flip mode (see page 243).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
10
0
5
5
0
10
5
15
10
20
15
30
20
40
30
50
40
60
50
70
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer
227
Channel Strip Displays
Aud1
The fluorescent channel strip displays graphically display the value of the parameter currently assigned to the Encoders. The minimum and maximum segments do not work with
the Pro Tools Remote Layer. Channel strip displays also display Pro Tools channel names in
an abbreviated form. Various other information is also displayed here and this is explained
in the relevant sections.
Selected Channel
The channel strip borders of currently selected channels light up like this.
Fader Touch Sense
When fader knobs are touched, the corresponding Touch Sense indicators light up like this.
Insert Indicator
The INS indicator shows whether a channel’s plug-ins are on or off.
Pan Display
(
Hard left
indicates center position)
Other position
(
Center
indicates at center)
Hard right
Send Level
Minimum
Other value
Maximum
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
228
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
MATRIX SELECT Section
MATRIX SELECT
MATRIX 1
MATRIX 2
(DEFAULT) (SEND MUTE)
MATRIX 4
(INSERT BYPASS)
[MATRIX 1] (DEFAULT) button
This button is used in conjunction with other controls to reset faders, panpots, sends, and
plug-ins to their default values. See “Resetting Faders, Sends, Panpots & Plug-ins” on page
247 for more information.
[MATRIX 2] (SEND MUTE) button
This button is used in conjunction with the Encoder push-switches to mute sends. See
“Muting Sends” on page 243 for more information.
[MATRIX 4] (INSERT BYPASS) button
This button is used in conjunction with other controls to bypass plug-ins. See “Bypassing
Individual Plug-ins” on page 246 for more information.
AUX SELECT Section
AUX SELECT
AUX 1
(SEND A)
AUX 2
(SEND B)
AUX 3
(SEND C)
AUX 4
(SEND D)
AUX 5
(SEND E)
AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5] buttons are used to select sends A–E. The button indicator
of the currently selected send lights up.
ENCODER MODE Section
ENCODER MODE
PAN
AUX/ MTRX
PAN
SEND LEVEL
ASSIGN 1
INPUT
ASSIGN
2 ASSIGN 3 ASSIGN 4
OUTPUT
SEND ASSIGN
INSERT
[PAN] (PAN) button
When this button is pressed, the Encoders work as channel panpots. Its indicator lights up
when it’s pressed. See “Panning Channels” on page 241 for more information.
[AUX/MTRX] (SEND LEVEL) button
When this button is pressed, the Encoders work as send level controls. Its indicator lights
up when it’s pressed, and send A is selected automatically. If the Encoders are currently set
to control pan, its indicator lights automatically when one of the AUX SELECT
[AUX 1]–[AUX 5] (SEND A–E) buttons is pressed.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer
229
[ASSIGN 1] (INPUT) button
This button is used in conjunction with other controls to set channel input sources. See
“Assigning Inputs to Channels” on page 239 for more information.
[ASSIGN 2] (OUTPUT) button
This button is used in conjunction with other controls to set channel output destinations.
See “Assigning Outputs to Channels” on page 240 for more information.
[ASSIGN 3] (SEND ASSIGN) button
This button is used in conjunction with other controls to set send destinations. See “Assigning Send Destinations” on page 242 for more information.
[ASSIGN 4] (INSERT) button
This button determines the operation of the [SEL] buttons. When its indicator is off, [SEL]
buttons select channels (see page 239). When its indicator is on, they select inserts/plug-ins
(see page 245).
FADER MODE Section
FADER MODE
FADER
AUX/MTRX
[FADER] & [AUX/MTRX] buttons
These buttons are used to select Flip mode, in which faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons
can be used to control sends. See “Flip Mode” on page 243 for more information.
DISPLAY ACCESS Section
DISPLAY ACCESS
METER
[METER] button
This button is used to reset the meter clip indicators and peak hold indicators.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
230
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS Section
EFFECTS / PLUG INS
DISPLAY
(SHOW
INSERT)
(< SCROLL)
5
(ASSIGN)
6
7
8
(SCROLL >)
1
2
3
4
(COMPARE) (BYPASS) (INSERT/PARAM)
[DISPLAY] (SHOW INSERT) button
This button is used to open and close plug-in windows.
[5] (ASSIGN) button
This button is used in conjunction with other controls to assign inserts/plug-ins to channels. See “Assigning Inserts/Plug-ins” on page 244 for more information.
[6] (COMPARE) button
This button is used to compare plug-in edits before and after. See “Editing Plug-ins” on page
245 for more information.
[7] (BYPASS) button
This button is used to bypass plug-ins. See “Editing Plug-ins” on page 245 and “Bypassing
Individual Plug-ins” on page 246 for more information.
[8] (INSERT/PARAM) button
This button is used in conjunction with other controls when editing plug-ins. See “Editing
Plug-ins” on page 245 for more information.
Parameter Up (< SCROLL) & Parameter Down (SCROLL >) buttons
These buttons are used to scroll parameters when assigning inserts and editing plug-ins. See
“Assigning Inserts/Plug-ins” on page 244 and “Editing Plug-ins” on page 245 for more
information.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer
231
SELECTED CHANNEL Section
■ ROUTING
ROUTING
DISPLAY
FOLLOW PAN
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
STEREO
DIRECT
[1] button
Selects the previous track to be controlled by the Joystick.
[2] button
Selects the next track to be controlled by the Joystick.
[3] button
Functions the same as the [OPTION] key on a computer keyboard.
[4] button
Switches between L and R of the selected track. The [4] button indicator lights up when the
R channel is selected.
[5] button
Selects Main, or Send (in this order) for the selected track.
[6] button
Switches the mode of the knob controls for the panner. The [6] button indicator lights up
or turns off.
[7] button
Selects Send, or Main (in this order) for the selected track.
[8] button
Mutes or unmutes the selected track. The [8] button indicator lights up while the track is
muted.
[DIRECT] button
Functions the same as the [SHIFT] key on the computer keyboard.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
232
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
■ DYNAMICS
DYNAMICS
DISPLAY
GATE / COMP
THRESHOLD
RANGE
ATTACK
DECAY
HOLD
THRESHOLD
RATIO
ATTACK
RELEASE
GAIN
GATE
COMP
GATE ON
COMP ON
[THRESHOLD] control
If the ROUTING [6] button indicator is off, the [THRESHOLD] control adjusts the front
position. If the ROUTING [6] button indicator is lit, the control adjusts the front divergence.
[RANGE/RATIO] control
If the ROUTING [6] button indicator is off, the [RANGE/RATIO] control adjusts the rear
position. If the ROUTING [6] button indicator is lit, the control adjusts the rear divergence.
[ATTACK] control
If the ROUTING [6] button indicator is off, the [ATTACK] control adjusts the F/R
(front/rear) position. If the ROUTING [6] button indicator is lit, the control adjusts the F/R
(front/rear) divergence.
[DECAY/RELEASE] control
If the ROUTING [6] button indicator is off, the [DECAY/RELEASE] control adjusts the
LFE level. If the ROUTING [6] button indicator is lit, this control adjusts the center percentage.
[HOLD/GAIN] control
Adjusts the channel volume.
■ PAN/SURROUND
PAN / SURROUND
DISPLAY
L
R
L
R
ODD
EVEN
LINK
GRAB
EFFECT
[GRAB] button
Press this button, turning on the button indicator, then operate the Joystick to quickly set
the pan position.
Joystick
Operating the Joystick while the [GRAB] button indicator is turned on enables you to
quickly set the pan position.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer
233
TRACK ARMING Section
TRACK ARMING
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
MASTER
(REC/RDY ALL)
[1–24] (REC/RDY) buttons
These buttons are used to arm Pro Tools channels for recording. The button indicators of
channels that are armed flash. The button indicators of armed channels light continuously
when recording starts.
[MASTER] (REC/RDY ALL) button
This button is used to arm all Pro Tools channels for recording. The button indicators of all
channels flash when this button is pressed. All channels can be disarmed by pressing it
again, in which case all button indicators go out. The number of channels that can be armed
depends on the number of recordable tracks in the current Pro Tools session.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Arm all channels (same as [MASTER]
(REC/RDY ALL) button
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + TRACK ARMING [1–24]
Arm all selected channels
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + TRACK
ARMING [1–24]
AUTOMIX Section
AUTOMIX
DISPLAY
(AUTO STATUS)
ENABLE
REC
SUSPEND
WRITE
ABORT/ AUTOUNDO
REC
TOUCH
LATCH
RETURN RELATIVE TOUCH
SENSE
READ
TRIM
OFF
OVERWRITE
FADER
ON
PAN
AUX
AUX
ON
EQ
(FADER)
(MUTE)
PAN
(SEND)
(SEND
MUTE)
(PLUG-IN)
[DISPLAY] (AUTO STATUS) button
When this button is pressed, the Automation modes of all channels are displayed on the
channel strip displays. See “Viewing the Automation Mode” on page 250 for more information.
[ENABLE] (SUSPEND) button
This button is used to suspend all automation recording and playback operations. Its button indicator flashes while automation is suspended. Level and other channel strip settings
are left as they are while automation is suspended.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
234
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
[REC] (WRITE), [ABORT/UNDO] (TOUCH), [AUTOREC] (LATCH),
[RETURN] (READ), [RELATIVE] (TRIM) & [TOUCH SENSE] (OFF) buttons
These buttons are used to select the channel Automation modes. See “Setting the Automation Mode” on page 250 for more information.
OVERWRITE [FADER] (FADER), [ON] (MUTE), [PAN] (PAN), [AUX]
(SEND), [AUX ON] (SEND MUTE) & [EQ] (PLUG-IN) buttons
These buttons are used to select parameters for automation recording and playback. See
“Arming Parameters for Automation” on page 251 for more information.
USER DEFINED KEYS Section
USER DEFINED KEYS
DISPLAY (STATUS)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
(TRANSPORT) ( BANK) (BANK ) (SHIFT/ADD)(OPTION/ALL) (GROUP) (SUSPEND) (CREATE)
9
10
11
(MIX/EDIT)
( CH)
(CH )
12
13
14
15
(CTRL/ (Command (MONITOR) (UNDO)
CLUTCH) ALT/FINE)
16
(SAVE)
[DISPLAY] (STATUS) button
This button is used to open and close the Session Setup window.
[1] (TRANSPORT) button
This button is used to open and close the Transport window. Its indicator lights up while
the Transport window is open.
[2] (< BANK) & [3] (BANK >) buttons
These buttons are used to swap channel banks 24 channels at a time.
[4] (SHIFT/ADD) & [5] (OPTION/ALL) buttons
These buttons are used in conjunction with other buttons to modify function operation.
They correspond to the Shift and Option modifier keys found on Macintosh keyboards.
[6] (GROUP) button
This button is used to display group information for all channels. While it’s pressed, the
channel strip displays show the ID of any group in which each channel is assigned.
[7] (SUSPEND) button
This button is used to temporarily suspend all mix groups (not edit groups). Its indicator
flashes while mix groups are suspended.
[8] (CREATE) button
This button is used to open the New Group window (Command-G in Pro Tools).
[9] (MIX/EDIT)
This button is used to toggle between the Mix and Edit windows.
[10] (< CH) & [11] (CH >) buttons
These buttons are used to scroll channels one at a time.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer
235
[12] (CTRL/CLUTCH) & [13] (Command-ALT/FINE) buttons
These buttons are used in conjunction with other buttons to modify function operation.
They correspond to the Control and Command modifier keys found on Macintosh keyboards.
[14] (MONITOR) button
This button is used to display the monitor mode currently selected in the Pro Tools Operations menu. When the monitor mode is set to “Auto Input Monitor,” “Auto” is displayed.
When it’s set to “Input Only Monitor,” “Inpt” is displayed. Aux Input channels always display “AUX.” Master fader channels always display “Mstr.” And MIDI Tracks always display
“MIDI.”
[15] (UNDO) button
This button is used to undo and redo the last operation. Its indicator lights up when the last
operation can be undone, and it flashes when the last operation can be redone.
[16] (SAVE)
This button is used to save the current session (same as Save Session command in the File
menu). Its indicator lights up when there are unsaved changes, and goes out when there are
no unsaved changes. When pressed, the indicator flashes and you can press it again to go
ahead and save the current session, or press [ESC] to cancel.
LOCATOR Section
LOCATOR
LOCATE MEMORY
DISPLAY (MEM-LOC)
1
2
AUDITION PRE
RETURN
TO ZERO
END
3
4
5
IN
OUT
POST
ONLINE
LOOP
QUICK
PUNCH
6
7
8
[DISPLAY] (MEM-LOC) button
This button is used to open and close the Memory Locations window.
LOCATE MEMORY [1–8] buttons
These buttons perform the same transport-related functions as the 1–8 number keys on a
Macintosh keyboard. If you set the Numeric keypad Mode in Pro Tools to “Classic” (Setups
menu, Preferences), these buttons can be used to directly locate markers 1–8.
•
•
•
[AUDITION] button
This button is used in conjunction with the [PRE], [IN], [OUT], and [POST] buttons for
auditioning. Its indicator lights up while auditioning is on and operation is as follows:
Press the [PRE] button to audition the section between the pre-roll point and the in point
of the selected region.
Press the [IN] button to audition from the in point of the selected region, continuing for
the specified pre-roll time.
Press the [OUT] button to audition the section before the out point of the selected region.
The length of the section is determined by the post-roll time.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
236
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
•
Press the [POST] button to audition from the out point of the selected region, continuing
for the specified post-roll time.
Auditioning stops when you press the [STOP] button in the transport section, or when
playback reaches the end of a section.
[PRE] & [POST] buttons
These buttons are used to turn on and off pre-roll and post-roll. While the [AUDITION]
button indicator is lit, they are used for auditioning.
[IN] & [OUT] buttons
These buttons are used to set in and out points during playback. While the [AUDITION]
button indicator is lit, they are used for auditioning.
[RETURN TO ZERO] button
Pressing this button moves the playback cursor to the beginning of the session.
[END] button
Pressing this button moves the playback cursor to the end of the session.
[ONLINE] button
This button is used to take Pro Tools online and offline (same as the Online command in
the Operations menu). Its indicator lights up when Pro Tools is online.
[LOOP] button
This button is used to turn loop playback on and off (same as the Loop Playback command
in the Operations menu). Its indicator lights up when loop playback is on.
[QUICK PUNCH] button
This button is used to turn quick punch on and off (same as the Quick Punch command in
the Operations menu). Its indicator lights up when quick punch is on.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Control Surface Operation with the Pro Tools Remote Layer
237
Data Entry & Transport Section
REW
FF
STOP
PLAY
REC
DISPLAY HISTORY
BACK
FORWARD
(EDIT MODE) (EDIT TOOLS)
DEC
(ESC)
SHUTTLE
INC
(CURSOR MODE)
SCRUB
ENTER
[REW] button
This button rewinds from the current cursor position (it’s non-latching).
[FF] button
This button fast forwards from the current cursor position (it’s non-latching).
[STOP] button
This button stops playback and recording.
[PLAY] button
This button starts playback from the current cursor position.
[REC] button
This button arms Pro Tools for recording ([REC] button indicator flashing), recording is
started by pressing the [PLAY] button ([REC] button indicator lit continuously).
[BACK] (EDIT MODE) button
This button is used to select the following edit modes: Shuffle, Slip, Spot, and Grid.
[FORWARD] (EDIT TOOLS) button
This button is used to select the following edit tools: Zoomer, Trimmer, Selector, Grabber,
SmartTool, Scrubber, and Pencil.
Parameter Wheel
The Parameter wheel is used for shuttling and scrubbing (see page 249). It’s also used for
making fine adjustments to the selected region (see page 248).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
238
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
[SHUTTLE] & [SCRUB] buttons
These buttons are used to select the Shuttle and Scrub modes. See “Scrub & Shuttle” on page
249 for more information. These buttons are mutually exclusive with the [QUICK
PUNCH] and [LOOP] buttons. Also, the cursor in the window on the computer monitor
disappears.
[ENTER] button
This button works the same as the Enter key on your computer keyboard. Pressing it opens
the New Memory Location dialog box. While a dialog box is open, pressing it performs the
same action as clicking the OK button.
[–/DEC] (ESC) button
For the most part, this button works the same as the Esc key on your computer keyboard.
While a dialog box is open, pressing it performs the same action as clicking the Cancel button.
[+INC] (CURSOR MODE) button
This button is used to select the following cursor modes: Navigation (see page 247), Zoom
(see page 248), and Select (see page 248).
Cursor buttons
These buttons can be used to scroll the Mix and Edit windows (see page 238), navigate the
Edit window (see page 247), zoom waveforms (see page 248), and to make fine adjustments
to the selected region (see page 248). Their exact operation depends on the currently
selected cursor mode.
Scrolling Windows
The following shortcuts can be used to scroll the Mix and Edit windows.
Scroll window to the left
USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + Left cursor button
Scroll window to the right
USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + Right cursor button
Scroll window up
USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + Up cursor button
Scroll window down
USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + Down cursor button
Scroll window to the beginning
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + Left cursor button
Scroll window to the end
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + Right
cursor button
Scroll window to the top
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + Up cursor button
Scroll window to the bottom
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + Down
cursor button
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Selecting Channels
239
Selecting Channels
1
2
Channels can be selected as follows.
(Make sure the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 4] (INSERT) button indicator is not lit before
proceeding.)
Use the [SEL] buttons to select channels.
The [SEL] button indicators of selected channels light up. The border of the corresponding
channel strip displays also light up.
To select multiple channels in each eight-channel block (e.g., 1–8, 9–16, or
17–24), while holding down one [SEL] button, use the [SEL] buttons of the
other channels in the same block to add and remove channels.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Select multiple channels
Do this!
USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + [SEL]
Select all channels
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + [SEL]
Inverse the channel selection
USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + [SEL]
Assigning Inputs to Channels
1
Channels can be assigned to input sources as follows. Before starting the steps below, stop
the Pro Tools transport section.
You can view the current input source assignment for each channel on the channel strip displays by pressing and holding the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 1] (INPUT) button.
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3] (SEND ASSIGN) button.
Its button indicator flashes, and the SELECT ASSIGN section of the display shows “ASGN.”
2
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 1] (INPUT) button.
Its button indicator lights up, and the channel strip displays show the current input source
for each channel.
3
Use the Encoders to select input sources.
The names of the input sources appear on the channel strip displays in abbreviated form.
When you select a source other than the current, the ring of the corresponding channel strip
display flashes.
4
To confirm your selection, press the Encoder’s push-switch.
The channel strip display ring stops flashing.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Set all channels to the same input
source
ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3], ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 1],
Encoder, USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + Encoder push-switch
Set all selected channels to the same
input source
ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3], ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 1],
Encoder, USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] +
Encoder push-switch
You can cancel this function by pressing the [–/DEC] (ESC) button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
240
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Assigning Outputs to Channels
1
Channels can be assigned to output destinations as follows. Before starting the steps below,
stop the Pro Tools transport section.
You can view the current output destination assignment for each channel on the channel
strip displays by pressing and holding the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 2] (OUTPUT) button.
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3] (SEND ASSIGN) button.
Its indicator flashes, and the SELECT ASSIGN section of the display shows “ASGN.”
2
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 2] (OUTPUT) button.
Its indicator lights up, and the channel strip displays show the current output destination
for each channel.
3
Use the Encoders to select output destinations.
The names of the output destinations appear on the channel strip displays in abbreviated
form. When you select a destination other than the current, the ring of the corresponding
channel strip display flashes.
4
To confirm your selection, press the Encoder’s push-switch.
The channel strip display ring stops flashing.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Set all channels to the same output
destination
ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3], ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 2],
Encoder, USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + Encoder push-switch
Set all selected channels to the same
output destination
ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3], ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 2],
Encoder, USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] +
Encoder push-switch
You can cancel this function by pressing the [–/DEC] (ESC) button.
Setting Channel Levels
1
Channel levels can be set as follows.
(Make sure the FADER MODE [FADER] and [AUX/MTRX] button indicators are not
flashing before proceeding.)
Use the faders to set channels levels.
Faders in a mix group are controlled together. You can temporarily disable a mix group in
order to make adjustments to individual faders by pressing and holding the USER
DEFINED KEYS [12] (CTRL/CLUTCH) button. Alternatively, you can make adjustments
to individual faders while touching the knob of at least one fader in that mix group.
You can view channel levels in dB on the channel strip displays by holding down the USER
DEFINED KEYS [13] (ALT/FINE) button while adjusting faders.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Muting Channels
241
Muting Channels
1
2
Channels can be muted as follows.
Use the [ON] buttons to mute channels.
The [ON] button indicators of muted channels go out.
Press the [ON] buttons again to unmute channels.
The [ON] button indicators of unmuted channels are lit.
Grouped channels are muted together. You can temporarily disable a group in order to
mute individual channels by pressing and holding the USER DEFINED KEYS [12]
(CTRL/CLUTCH) button.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Mute all channels
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + [ON]
Mute all selected channels
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + [ON]
Panning Channels
1
2
Channels can be panned as follows.
Press the ENCODER MODE [PAN] (PAN) button.
Its indicator lights up.
Use the Encoders to pan the channels.
Pan positions are displayed by the channel strip displays. See “Pan Display” on page 227 for
more information.
You can view pan settings numerically on the channel strip displays by holding down the
USER DEFINED KEYS [13] (ALT/FINE) button while adjusting the Encoders.
For stereo aux input channels (i.e., channels with two panpots), use the ENCODER MODE
[PAN] (PAN) button to toggle between the left and right panpots, and pan with the
Encoder. When the left panpot is active, the ENCODER MODE [PAN] (PAN) button indicator is lit continuously and the SELECT ASSIGN section of the display shows “Pan.” When
the right panpot is active, the ENCODER MODE [PAN] (PAN) button indicator flashes
and the SELECT ASSIGN section of the display shows “PanR.”
Soloing Channels
1
2
Channels can be soloed as follows.
Use the [SOLO] buttons to solo channels.
The [SOLO] button indicators of soloed channels light up and the [ON] button indicators
of unsoloed channels flash.
Press the [SOLO] buttons again to unsolo channels.
Grouped channels are soloed together. You can temporarily disable a mix group in order to
solo individual channels by pressing and holding the USER DEFINED KEYS [12]
(CTRL/CLUTCH) button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
242
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Assigning Send Destinations
1
Sends can be assigned to output destinations as follows. Before starting the steps below, stop
the Pro Tools transport section.
You can view the current output destination assignment for each send on the channel strip
displays by pressing and holding the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5] (SEND A–E) buttons.
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3] (SEND ASSIGN) button.
Its indicator flashes, and the SELECT ASSIGN section of the display shows “ASGN.”
2
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5] (SEND A–E) buttons to select the
sends.
The button indicator of the selected send lights up, and the channel strip displays show the
current send destinations of all channels. If the currently selected send is not assigned to a
channel, “—” is displayed.
3
Use the Encoders to select send destinations.
The names of the send destinations appear on the channel strip displays in abbreviated
form. When you select a different destination, the ring of the corresponding channel strip
display flashes. When a stereo send destination is selected, its name flashes and continues to
flash even after its been confirmed.
4
To confirm your selection, press the Encoder’s push-switch.
The channel strip display ring stops flashing.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Set all channels to the same send destination
ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3], AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5],
Encoder, USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + Encoder push-switch
Set all selected channels to the same
send destination
ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 3], AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5],
Encoder, USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] +
Encoder push-switch
You can cancel this function by pressing the [–/DEC] (ESC) button.
Configuring Sends as Pre or Post
1
Sends can be configured as either pre or post as follows.
(Make sure the MATRIX SELECT [MATRIX 2] (SEND MUTE) button indicator is not lit
before proceeding.)
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5] (SEND A–E) buttons to select the
sends.
The ENCODER MODE [AUX/MTRX] (SEND LEVEL) button indicator lights up, as does
the button indicator of the selected send.
2
Use the Encoder push-switches to toggle between pre and post.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Setting Send Levels
243
Setting Send Levels
1
2
Send levels can be set as follows.
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5] (SEND A–E) buttons to select the
sends.
The ENCODER MODE [AUX/MTRX] (SEND LEVEL) button indicator lights up, as does
the button indicator of the selected send.
The levels for the selected send are displayed by the channel strip displays. See “Send Level”
on page 227 for more information.
Use the Encoders to set the send levels.
You can view send levels in dB on the channel strip displays by holding down the USER
DEFINED KEYS [13] (ALT/FINE) button while adjusting the Encoders.
Send levels can also be set by using the faders in Flip mode. See “Flip Mode” on page 243 for
more information.
Muting Sends
1
Sends can be muted as follows.
Press the MATRIX SELECT [MATRIX 2] (SEND MUTE) button.
2
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5] (SEND A–E) buttons to select the
sends.
The ENCODER MODE [AUX/MTRX] (SEND LEVEL) button indicator lights up, as does
the button indicator of the selected send.
3
Use the Encoder push-switches to mute the sends.
When a send is muted, the ring of the corresponding channel strip display flashes.
Sends can also be muted by using the [ON] buttons in Flip mode. See “Flip Mode” on page
243 for more information.
Panning Sends
Only sends assigned to stereo destinations can be panned. Sends can be panned by using the
Encoders in Flip mode. See “Flip Mode” on page 243 for more information.
Flip Mode
In Flip mode, the faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons can be used to control sends, as
shown in the following table.
Control
Normal mode
Flip mode
Fader
Channel level
Send level
Encoder
Channel pan/send level
Send pan
[ON] button
Channel mute
Send mute
1
Press the FADER MODE [FADER] or [AUX/MTRX] button.
The FADER MODE [FADER] and [AUX/MTRX] button indicators flash alternately, and
both the ENCODER MODE [PAN] (PAN) and [AUX/MTRX] (SEND LEVEL) button
indicators light up. The SELECT ASSIGN section of the display shows “FLIP.”
2
Use the AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5] (SEND A–E) buttons to select the
sends.
The button indicator of the selected send lights up.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
244
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
3
Use the faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons to control the currently selected
send.
For stereo aux input channels (i.e., channels with two send panpots), use the ENCODER
MODE [PAN] (PAN) button to toggle between the left and right panpots, and pan with the
Encoder. When the left panpot is active, the ENCODER MODE [PAN] (PAN) button indicator is lit continuously. When the right panpot is active, the ENCODER MODE [PAN]
(PAN) button indicator flashes.
Assigning Inserts/Plug-ins
1
Inserts can be assigned to channels as follows. The Pro Tools transport must be stopped in
order to make these assignments.
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 4] (INSERT) button.
Its indicator lights up and the [SEL] buttons are set to Insert Select mode.
2
Use the [SEL] buttons to select channels for insert assignment.
The name of the selected channel appears in the INSERT/PARAM section of the display.
The border of the corresponding channel name in the Pro Tools Mix window is highlighted
red.
3
Press the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [5] (ASSIGN) button.
Its indicator flashes, as does the ASSIGN indicator on the display.
4
Use Parameter controls 1–4 to select inserts/plug-ins.
The names of the inserts/plug-ins appear on the display in abbreviated form. When you
select an insert/plug-in other than the current, the corresponding SEL button flashes on the
display.
5
To confirm your selection, press the relevant Parameter control’s
push-switch.
The SEL button stops flashing.
While the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [5] (ASSIGN) button indicator is still flashing, you can
assign more inserts/plug-ins to the same channel. To set insert #5, press the Parameter
Down (SCROLL >) button. Press the Parameter Up (< SCROLL) button to view inserts 1–4
again.
To assign inserts/plug-ins to other channels, use the [SEL] buttons to select them. You’ll
need to press the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [5] (ASSIGN) button each time you select another
channel.
To assign the same insert/plug-in to all channels, while holding down the USER DEFINED
KEYS [5] (OPTION/ALL) button, press the Parameter control push-switch. (The number
of assignments possible depends on the available CPU power.)
To assign the same insert/plug-in to a selection of channels, press the ENCODER MODE
[ASSIGN 4] (INSERT) button (indicator off) so that the [SEL] buttons can be used to select
channels. Select the channels as explained on page 239, then press the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS
[5] (ASSIGN) button. While its indicator is flashing, use Parameter controls 1–4 to select an
insert/plug-in, and while holding down the USER DEFINED KEYS [5] (OPTION/ALL)
button and USER DEFINED KEYS [4] (SHIFT/ADD) button, press the Parameter control’s
push-switch. (The number of assignments possible depends on the available CPU power.)
You can cancel this function by pressing the [–/DEC] (ESC) button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Editing Plug-ins
245
Editing Plug-ins
1
Plug-ins can be edited as follows.
(Make sure the MATRIX SELECT [MATRIX 4] (INSERT BYPASS) button indicator is not
lit before proceeding.)
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 4] (INSERT) button.
Its indicator lights up and the [SEL] buttons are set to Insert Select mode.
2
Use the [SEL] buttons to select the channel whose plug-in you want to edit.
That channel’s [SEL] button indicator lights up, and the border of the corresponding channel name in the Pro Tools Mix window is highlighted red. The names of the Plug-ins
inserted in the channel are displayed in the INSERT ASSIGN/EDIT section of the display.
3
Use the Parameter control 1–4 push-switches to select the plug-in that you
want to edit.
Plug-in Edit mode is set and the plug-in’s parameters are displayed in the INSERT
ASSIGN/EDIT section of the display. The EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [8] (INSERT/PARAM)
button indicator lights up and the PARAM indicator on the display appears highlighted.
4
Use Parameter controls 1–4 and their push-switches to edit the displayed
parameters.
Parameters displayed on the top row can be edited by using the push-switches. Parameters
displayed on the bottom row can be edited by using the Parameter controls.
5
Use the Parameter Down (SCROLL >) button and Parameter Up (< SCROLL)
button to select the parameter pages.
When a parameter page is first selected, the number of the current parameter page and the
total number of parameter pages is displayed momentarily. For example, “1/2” indicates
that the first page of two is currently selected. While “3/4” indicates that the third page of
four is currently selected. The title of the plug-in is also displayed.
While editing a plug-in you can bypass it by pressing the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [7]
(BYPASS) button. In which case, the BYPASS indicator on the display appears highlighted.
As soon as you begin editing a plug-in, the COMPARE indicator on the display appears
highlighted. You can compare your edits with the original settings by pressing the
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [6] (COMPARE) button. The COMPARE indicator on the display
appears highlighted while the original settings are active, and unhighlighted while your
edits are active.
6
To edit another plug-in, press the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [8] (INSERT/PARAM)
button (its indicator goes out), use the [SEL] buttons to select the channel
(same as step #2), and use the Parameter control 1–4 push-switches to select
the plug-in (same as step #3).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
246
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Bypassing Individual Plug-ins
1
Individual plug-ins can be bypassed as follows.
(Make sure the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [8] (INSERT/PARAM) button indicator is not lit
before proceeding.)
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 4] (INSERT) button.
Its indicator lights up and the [SEL] buttons are set to Insert Select mode.
2
Use the [SEL] buttons to select plug-ins.
3
While holding down the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS [7] (BYPASS) button, use
Parameter control 1–4 push switches to bypass the plug-ins.
To bypass plug-in #5, press the Parameter Down (SCROLL >) button, and then perform
step 3. Press the Parameter Up (< SCROLL) button to view plug-ins 1–4 again.
The titles of bypassed plug-ins are displayed in uppercase characters. For example, the title
of the plug in “D-Verb” appears as “d-verb” when it’s not bypassed, and appears as
“D-VERB” when it is bypassed.
Bypassing all Plug-ins
1
All plug-ins on a channel can be bypassed as follows.
Press the MATRIX SELECT [MATRIX 4] (INSERT BYPASS) button.
Its indicator lights up.
The INS indicators on the channel strip displays work as follows.
INS indicator = off: None of the channel’s plug-ins are bypassed.
INS indicator = lit: All of the channel’s plug-ins are bypassed.
INS indicator = flashing: Some of the channel’s plug-ins are bypassed.
2
Press the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 4] (INSERT) button.
Its indicator flashes.
3
Use the [SEL] buttons to bypass all plug-ins on each channel.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Bypass all plug-ins on all channels
MATRIX SELECT [MATRIX 4], ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 4],
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + [SEL]
Bypass all plug-ins on all selected
channels
MATRIX SELECT [MATRIX 4], ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 4],
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + [SEL]
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Resetting Faders, Sends, Panpots & Plug-ins
247
Resetting Faders, Sends, Panpots & Plug-ins
Faders, panpots, sends, and plug-ins can be reset to their default values as follows. For faders
and send controls, this is “0.” For panpots, it’s center.
Make sure that the ENCODER MODE [ASSIGN 4] (INSERT) button indicator is off before
proceeding with these shortcuts.
To do this...
Do this!
Reset a channel fader
[MATRIX 1] + [SEL]
Reset all channel faders
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + [MATRIX 1] + [SEL]
Reset all selected channel faders
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + [MATRIX 1]
+ [SEL]
Reset a channel panpot
[PAN], [MATRIX 1] + [ENCODER push]
Reset all channel panpots
[PAN], USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + [MATRIX 1] + [ENCODER push]
Reset all selected channel panpots
[PAN], USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] +
[MATRIX 1] + [ENCODER push]
Reset a channel send level
AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5], [MATRIX 1] + [ENCODER push]
Reset all channel send levels
AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5], USER DEFINED KEYS [5] +
[MATRIX 1] + [ENCODER push]
Reset all selected channel send levels
AUX SELECT [AUX 1]–[AUX 5], USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER
DEFINED KEYS [4] + [MATRIX 1] + [ENCODER push]
Reset the currently selected plug-in
[MATRIX 1] + EFFECTS PLUG-INS [6]
While the [MATRIX 1] (DEFAULT) button is being pressed, its indicator flashes and
“DFLT” appears in the SELECT ASSIGN section of the display.
Grouped channels are reset together. You can temporarily disable a group by pressing and
holding the USER DEFINED KEYS [12] (CTRL/CLUTCH) button before pressing the
[MATRIX 1] (DEFAULT) button.
Navigating the Edit Window
1
The cursor buttons can be used to navigate the Edit window as follows.
Use the [INC] (CURSOR MODE) button to select Navigation cursor mode.
The CURSOR MODE section of the display shows “NAVIGATION.”
2
To move the edit cursor to the previous region boundary, or to the previous
marker, press the Left cursor button.
3
To move the edit cursor to the next region boundary, or to the next marker,
press the Right cursor button.
4
To select the track above, press the Up cursor button.
5
To select the track below, press the Down cursor button.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Extend the selection
USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + Left or Right cursor button
Select the previous region
USER DEFINED KEYS [12] + Left cursor button
Select the next region
USER DEFINED KEYS [12] + Right cursor button
Display the in point of the selected region
in the center of the Edit window
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + Left cursor button (or LOCATE
MEMORY [IN] button)
Display the out point of the selected
region in the center of the Edit window
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + Right cursor button (or LOCATE
MEMORY [OUT] button)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
248
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Zooming
1
•
•
•
•
The cursor buttons can be used to zoom the Edit window as follows.
Use the [+INC] (CURSOR MODE) button to select Zoom cursor mode.
The CURSOR MODE section of the display shows “ZOOM.”
In Zoom cursor mode, the cursor buttons work as follows:
Left cursor button: Zoom out horizontally.
Right cursor button: Zoom in horizontally.
Up cursor button: Zoom in vertically.
Down cursor button: Zoom out vertically.
Making Fine Adjustments to the Selected Region
1
The cursor buttons can be used in conjunction with the Parameter wheel to make fine
adjustments to the selected region.
Use the [+INC] (CURSOR MODE) button to select Select cursor mode.
The CURSOR MODE section of the display shows “SELECT.”
2
While holding down the left cursor button, turn the Parameter wheel to
make fine adjustments to the in point of the selected region.
3
While holding down the right cursor button, turn the Parameter wheel to
make fine adjustments to the out point of the selected region.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Move the edit cursor to the in point of the
selected region
Double-click the Left cursor button
Move the edit cursor to the out point of
the selected region
Double-click the Right cursor button
The following shortcuts can be used in either Navigation or Select cursor mode.
To do this...
Do this!
Select the track/region below
Down cursor button
Select the track/region above
Up cursor button
Extend the selection to include the same
region on the track below
USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + Down cursor button
Extend the selection to include the same
region on the track above
USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + Up cursor button
Shorten the selection by unselecting the
region on the lowest track
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + Down cursor button
Shorten the selection by unselecting the
region on the highest track
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + Up cursor button
Move the selection (not the audio) backwards or forwards
Left cursor button+Right cursor button+Parameter wheel
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Scrub & Shuttle
249
Scrub & Shuttle
1
The Parameter wheel can be used to scrub and shuttle as follows.
Make sure that Pro Tools is stopped.
2
Press the [SCRUB] button if you want to scrub, press the [SHUTTLE] button
if you want to shuttle.
The corresponding button indicator lights up. The [REW] and [FF] button indicators also
light up, and the cursor mode is set to Navigation (the CURSOR MODE section of the display shows “NAVIGATION”).
3
Turn the Parameter wheel clockwise to scrub/shuttle forwards. Turn it counterclockwise to scrub/shuttle backwards.
Scrub/shuttle starts at the in point of the selected region. If no region is selected, the edit
cursor position is used. If you hold down the USER DEFINED KEYS [5] (OPTION/ALL)
button when pressing the [SCRUB] or [SHUTTLE] button, scrub/shuttle will start at the
out point of the selected region.
If the Edit Insertion Follows Scrub/Shuttle preference is turned on in Pro Tools (Setups
menu, Preferences command, Operation page), the currently selected region will be cancelled when the [SCRUB] or [SHUTTLE] button is pressed. To maintain the currently
selected region, hold down the USER DEFINED KEYS [4] (SHIFT/ADD) button when
pressing the [SCRUB] or [SHUTTLE] button.
You can toggle between scrub and shuttle by pressing the [SCRUB] and [SHUTTLE] buttons, in which case scrub or shuttle continues from the current position.
4
To expand or shrink the selected region, while holding down the USER
DEFINED KEYS [4] (SHIFT/ADD) button, rotate the Parameter wheel.
Press the left cursor button when you want to move the in point. Press the right cursor button, to move the out point.
To start Scrub/Shuttle from the top of the selected region, while holding down the USER
DEFINED KEYS [5] (OPTION/ALL) button, press the left cursor button. Similarly, to start
Scrub/Shuttle from the end of the selected region, while holding down the USER DEFINED
KEYS [5] (OPTION/ALL) button, press the right cursor button.
5
To stop scrub/shuttle, press the [SCRUB] or [SHUTTLE] button again, or press
the [STOP] button.
If you press the [REW], [FF], or [PLAY] button, scrub/shuttle operation is stopped before
rewind, fast forward, or playback commences.
While scrub/ shuttle is active, only the following Pro Tools/DM2000 controls can be used:
[SCRUB] and [SHUTTLE] buttons, Parameter wheel, transport buttons, faders, [ON] buttons, and [SOLO] buttons. The current position can be stored as a marker by pressing the
[ENTER] button.
The scrub resolution depends on the current zoom setting, the more zoomed in you are, the
higher the resolution. If you hold down the USER DEFINED KEYS [13] (ALT/FINE) button while scrubbing, you can scrub at the highest resolution regardless of the current zoom
setting.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
250
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Automation
Viewing the Automation Mode
1
The Automation mode setting of each channel can be viewed as follows.
Press and hold a channel’s [AUTO] button.
The channel’s Automation mode is displayed on the corresponding channel strip display
while the [AUTO] button is pressed.
Pro Tools
Channel Strip Displays
Auto write
Wrt
Auto touch
Tch
Auto latch
Ltch
Auto read
Read
Auto off
Off
[AUTO] Button Indicators
Flashing red (Record Ready)
Red (Recording)
Green
Off
The Automation mode settings of all channels can be viewed as follows.
2
Press and hold the AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] (AUTO STATUS) button.
The Automation modes of all channels are displayed on the channel strip displays while the
AUTOMIX [DISPLAY] (AUTO STATUS) button is pressed.
Setting the Automation Mode
1
The Automation mode can be set as follows.
While holding down a channel’s [AUTO] button, press the AUTOMIX
[WRITE], [TOUCH], [LATCH], [TRIM], [READ], or [OFF] button.
The channel’s Automation mode is displayed on the corresponding channel strip display
while the [AUTO] button is pressed.
Grouped channels are set together. You can temporarily disable a group in order to set individual channels by pressing and holding the USER DEFINED KEYS [12] (CTRL/CLUTCH)
button.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Set the Automation mode of all channels
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + AUTOMIX [WRITE], [TOUCH],
[LATCH], [TRIM], [READ], or [OFF]
Set the Automation mode of all selected
channels
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] + AUTOMIX [WRITE], [TOUCH], [LATCH], [TRIM], [READ], or [OFF]
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Automation
251
Trim Mode
1
Trim mode can be set as follows.
While holding down a channel’s [AUTO] button, press the AUTOMIX [RELATIVE] (TRIM) button.
The channel’s Automation mode is displayed on the corresponding channel strip display
while its [AUTO] button is pressed.
Pro Tools
Channel Strip Displays
Auto trim/write
TWrt
Auto trim/touch
TTch
Auto trim/latch
TLch
Auto trim/read
TRd
[AUTO] Button Indicators
Flashing red/orange (Record Ready)
Orange (Recording)
Flashing green/orange
Grouped channels are set together. You can temporarily disable a group in order to set individual channels by pressing and holding the USER DEFINED KEYS [12] (CTRL/CLUTCH)
button.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Set Trim mode for all channels
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + AUTOMIX [RELATIVE]
Set Trim mode of all selected channels
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + USER DEFINED KEYS [4] +
AUTOMIX [RELATIVE]
In Trim mode, you can display channel and send level values relatively (instead of absolute
decibel values) on the channel strip displays by holding down the USER DEFINED KEYS
[13] (ALT/FINE) button while adjusting the faders and Encoders.
Arming Parameters for Automation
Parameters can be selected for automation recording as follows.
1
Use the following AUTOMIX-OVERWRITE buttons to arm parameters.
AUTOMIX-OVERWRITE Buttons
Pro Tools
[FADER] (FADER)
Volume
[ON] (MUTE)
Mute
[PAN] (PAN)
Pan
[AUX] (SEND)
Send level
[AUX ON] (SEND MUTE)
Send mute
[EQ] (PLUG-IN)
Plug-in
The button indicators for armed parameters light up.
The following shortcuts apply.
To do this...
Do this!
Arm all parameters
USER DEFINED KEYS [5] + AUTOMIX-OVERWRITE [FADER],
[ON], [PAN], [AUX], [AUX ON], or [EQ]
Inverse armed parameter selection
USER DEFINED KEYS [13] + AUTOMIX-OVERWRITE [FADER],
[ON], [PAN], [AUX], [AUX ON], or [EQ]
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
252
Chapter 19—Pro Tools Remote Layer
Panner
Selecting a Track
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL ROUTING buttons to manipulate the following track
operations.
To do this...
Use these buttons:
Selecting the previous track
ROUTING [1] button
Selecting the next track
ROUTING [2] button
Selecting the top track
ROUTING [3] + [1] buttons
Selecting the last track
ROUTING [3] + [2] buttons
Selecting the main output of the selected track
ROUTING [3] + [5] buttons
Selecting Send 5 of the selected track
ROUTING [3] + [7] buttons
Selecting the output/send of the selected track
ROUTING [5] + [7] buttons
Stereo Track Link
You can control the panner for the L and R channels of stereo tracks simultaneously or individually, depending on the stereo link status.
To cancel the stereo panner link, press and hold down the [Control] key on the keyboard
and move the Joystick.
Panner Operation via the Joystick
1
Select the track you wish to pan.
2
Press the [GRAB] button, turning on the [GRAB] button indicator.
3
While the [GRAB] button indicator is lit, operate the Joystick.
If you move the Joystick for direct panning while the [GRAB] button indicator is lit, the pan
position is specified as an absolute value, which may cause the pan position to jump drastically.
You can also restrict the trajectory direction of the Joystick. To limit movement to the L and
R directions, press and hold down the [DIRECT] button and move the Joystick. To limit
movement to the up and down (front and rear) directions, select 3 Knob mode in the Pro
Tools Panner window.
Panner Operation via Knob Controls
You can control the following parameters using the DYNAMICS controls.
Controls
ROUTING [6] indicator is off
ROUTING [6] indicator is on
THRESHOLD
Front position
Front divergence
RANGE/RATIO
Rear position
Rear divergence
ATTACK
F/R position
F/R divergence
DECAY/RELEASE
LFE level
Center percentage
HOLD/GAIN
Channel volume
1
Select the track and output, if desired.
2
Press the ROUTING [6] button to select the knob control mode that is appropriate for the parameter you wish to control.
3
Use the appropriate control to adjust the parameter.
Pressing and holding down the [Command] key on the keyboard and rotating the controls
reduces the change in the parameter values.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Remote Control
253
20 Remote Control
About Remote Layers
The DM2000’s four Remote Layers allow you to control external MIDI equipment directly
from the DM2000. The type of device to be controlled (i.e., the target) can be specified for
each Remote Layer. There are six types of target: User Defined, Pro Tools, Nuendo, Cubase
SX, General DAW, and User Assignable Layer. User Defined targets allow you to specify the
MIDI data that will be transmitted when the 24 channel strip faders, Encoders, and [ON]
buttons are operated. These settings are stored in Scenes, for snapshot-style automation.
The Pro Tools, Nuendo, Cubase SX, and General DAW targets use a specially designed protocol that supports Pro Tools, Nuendo, Cubase SX, and other DAW software protocols.
The User Assignable Layer target enables you to combine DM2000 channels to create a custom layer. See page 269 for more information on the User Assignable Layer.
Assigning Targets to Remote Layers
Targets are assigned to Remote Layers as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [REMOTE] button to locate the Remote 1–4 pages.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the TARGET parameter, use the Parameter
wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select a target, and then press [ENTER].
TARGET: This can be set to NO ASSIGN, USER DEFINED, Pro Tools, Nuendo, Cubase
SX, General DAW, or User Assignable Layer. Only one Remote Layer can be set to Pro Tools,
Nuendo, Cubase SX, or General DAW. See page 254 for more information on the User
Defined target. See page 221 for more information on the Pro Tools target. See page 269 for
more information on the User Assignable Layer.
To conrol Nuendo or Cubase SX remotely, make the following settings in addition to the
TARGET parameter.
3
Select the desired port for the DAW parameter on the MIDI/To Host Setup
page (see page 216).
4
Select an appropriate device in the Device menu of Nuendo or Cubase SX
and specify the DM2000 as a controller.
For more information on the necessary settings, refer to the Owner’s Manual that came
with Nuendo or Cubase SX.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
254
Chapter 20—Remote Control
Configuring User Defined Remote Layers
User Defined Remote Layers can be configured as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [REMOTE] button to locate the Remote 1–4 pages.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
TARGET: This is used to select the target for the currently selected Remote Layer (the User
Defined target is explained here).
TRANSMIT: This enables and disables MIDI data transmission for the selected Remote
Layer.
INITIALIZE: This initializes the settings of the currently selected bank.
BANK: These buttons are used to select banks 1, 2, 3, and 4. Each bank can contain MIDI
settings for the 24 faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons. Banks can be stored to an external
MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer, by using MIDI Bulk Dump (see page 220), or stored
to SmartMedia (see page 271). Initially, bank 1 contains General MIDI (GM) volume and
pan settings; bank 2, GM volume and effect; bank 3, XG volume and pan; bank 4, Nuendo
VST mixer.
ID/SHORT/LONG: On Remote Layers, channel strips 1–24 are identified by the fixed IDs
RM01–RM24. You can enter a Short and Long name for each Remote channel strip. Short
names appear on the channel strip displays. To enter a name, use the cursor buttons to select
the SHORT or LONG name, use the [SEL] buttons, Parameter wheel, or INC/DEC buttons
to select the channel strips, and then press [ENTER]. When the Title Edit window appears,
enter a name, and press OK when you’ve finished. See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for
more information.
ON: These parameters are used to specify the MIDI message (up to 16 bytes) to be transmitted when an [ON] button is pressed. Use the [SEL] buttons to select the channel strips,
and then edit as necessary. When a value from 00 to FF is specified, that value is transmitted
when an [ON] button is pressed. For the SW setting, data value 7F is transmitted when an
[ON] button is turned on, and data value 00 is transmitted when an [ON] button is turned
off. The END setting specifies the end of the data. “–” means no data is transmitted.
UNLATCH/LATCH: This parameter determines the operation of the [ON] buttons:
Latching or Non-latching. When set to UNLATCH, an ON value is transmitted when an
buttons is pressed, and an OFF value is transmitted when it’s released. When set to LATCH,
an ON value is transmitted when the button is pressed and that value is maintained when
the button is released. The next time you press that button, the OFF value is transmitted.
LEARN: This button is used to turn on and off the Learn function, which can be used to
learn what MIDI messages are being transmitted by external MIDI devices when their controls or parameters are adjusted. When on, received MIDI messages are displayed in the
DATA area. Only the first 16 bytes of data, starting with a Status bit, are displayed.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
About Remote Layers
255
ENCODER: These parameters are used to specify the MIDI message (up to 16 bytes) to be
transmitted when an Encoder is operated. Use the [SEL] buttons to select the channel strips,
and then edit as necessary. When a value from 00 to FF is specified, that value is transmitted
when an Encoder is adjusted. For the ENC setting, the Encoder’s current value from 0–127
is transmitted when it’s adjusted. The END setting specifies the end of the data. “–” means
no data is transmitted.
LEARN: This works the same as the [ON] button Learn function above, except the received
MIDI messages are displayed in the ENCODER DATA area. Only one Learn function can
be used at a time.
FADER: These parameters are used to specify the MIDI message (up to 16 bytes) to be
transmitted when a fader is operated. Use the [SEL] buttons to select the channel strips, and
then edit as necessary. When a value from 00 to FF is specified, that value is transmitted
when a fader is adjusted. For the FAD setting, a fader’s current value from 0–127 is transmitted when it’s adjusted. The END setting specifies the end of the data. “–” means no data
is transmitted.
LEARN: This works the same as the [ON] button Learn function above, except the received
MIDI messages are displayed in the FADER DATA area. Only one Learn function can be
used at a time.
Using User Defined Remote Layers
Once configured, User Defined Remote Layers can be used as follows.
1
Use the LAYER REMOTE [1–4] buttons to select the User Defined Remote Layers.
While a User Defined Remote Layer is selected, operating the channel strip faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons causes the specified MIDI data to be transmitted.
When a User Defined Remote Layer is selected, the corresponding Remote page appears.
Since this is the same page as that selected by the DISPLAY ACCESS [REMOTE] button,
User Defined Remote Layers can be configured here as well, even the target can be changed.
When a User Defined Remote Layer is selected, the channel strip displays
show Remote channel strip Short names. The border of the currently
selected channel’s channel strip display lights up. The Encoder displays
indicate the positions of the Encoders.
The settings of the channel strip faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons,
and the current target and bank setting for each Remote Layer are stored
in Scenes. When a Scene is recalled, if the Remote Layer’s target is the same as when the
Scene was stored, the faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons are set accordingly and the corresponding MIDI data is transmitted (so long as the TRANSMIT parameter is set to
ENABLED). If the target is not the same, the faders, Encoders, and [ON] buttons are set
accordingly, but no MIDI data is transmitted.
GM01
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
256
Chapter 20—Remote Control
About Machine Control (MMC & P2)
The DM2000 can control the transport, locate functions, track arming, and chase function
of up to eight external recording machines that support the MMC or P2 control protocol.
Machines can be specified as either MTR or Master and controlled independently.
Machines that support the P2 protocol can be controlled by connecting them to the
DM2000’s REMOTE port using a 9-pin straight cable. Wiring details are provided on
page 350. The REMOTE port must be set for P2 control on the Remote Port Setup page (see
page 257).
Machines that support MMC can be controlled by connecting them to the DM2000’s
MIDI, SERIAL, USB, or SLOT1 (with optional mLAN I/O Card installed in Slot #1).
MMC and P2 protocol support varies from machine to machine. Some machines may not
operate exactly as explained in this section.
Configuring Machines
Up to eight machines can be configured as follows.
1
Use the LOCATOR [DISPLAY] button to locate the Machine Configuration
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
MACHINE CONTROL/DAW CONTROL: When the MACHINE CONTROL option is
on, the MACHINE CONTROL section controls external MMC machines, regardless of the
layer selection. When the DAW CONTROL option is on, the MACHINE CONTROL section controls DAWs, regardless of the layer selection.
TYPE: This is used to specify the type of machine: MMC or P2. Only one machine can be
set to P2.
PORT: When the machine TYPE is MMC, use this parameter to specify the port for MMC
communications. Available ports include: MIDI, SERIAL 1–8, USB 1–8, and SLOT1.
DEVICE ID: When the machine TYPE is MMC, use this parameter to specify the device ID
from 1 to 127 or ALL. The target machine must be set to the same ID. The same ID cannot
be assigned to more than one SERIAL, USB, or SLOT1 port.
TRANSPORT CONTROL: This parameter determines whether or not the DM2000’s
transport buttons control the machine. Only one Master and one MTR machine can be
enabled at a time.
CHASE CONTROL: This parameter determines whether or not a Chase On/Off command is transmitted from the DM2000 to a machine when the LOCATOR [ONLINE] button is pressed.
MASTER/MTR: This parameter is used to specify which machines are Masters and which
are MTRs. Multiple machines can be set to Master and MTR.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
About Machine Control (MMC & P2)
257
Configuring the REMOTE Port
If you are using the P2 protocol to control a machine, the REMOTE port
must be configured as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to select the Remote Port Setup
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the REMOTE FUNCTION parameter, use the
INC/DEC buttons to select P2-DFLT, then press [ENTER].
P2-DFLT: A P2 protocol used by the Tascam DA-98HR and other professional video
machines.
HA: A protocol used to control Yamaha AD8HR/AD824 A/D converters.
P2-VTR1–3: An expanded version of the P2 protocol intended for future use. Currently,
this is the same as P2-DFLT.
Transport Buttons
The DM2000’s transport can be used to control external machines. Transport control can
be enabled and disabled for individual machines on the Machine Configuration page (see
page 256).
REW
FF
STOP
PLAY
REC
[REW] button
This button starts rewind on the external machines.
[FF] button
This button starts fast forward on the external machines.
[STOP] button
This button stops the external machines.
[PLAY] button
This button starts playback on the external machines. It’s also used to punch out of recording.
[REC] button
This button is used in conjunction with the [PLAY] button to start recording on the external
machines.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
258
Chapter 20—Remote Control
Using Shuttle & Scrub
The Parameter wheel can be used to shuttle and scrub the external machines.
SHUTTLE
SCRUB
When the [SHUTTLE] button indicator is lit, the Parameter wheel can be used to shuttle.
When the [SCRUB] button indicator is lit, the Parameter wheel can be used to scrub. Turn
the Parameter wheel clockwise to shuttle/scrub forwards. Turn it counterclockwise to shuttle/scrub backwards.
Using the Locator
The LOCATOR section can be used to control the external machines.
LOCATOR
LOCATE MEMORY
DISPLAY
1
2
AUDITION PRE
RETURN
TO ZERO
3
4
5
IN
OUT
POST
ONLINE
LOOP
QUICK
PUNCH
6
7
8
SET
MTR
ROLL REHEARSAL MASTER
BACK
LOCATE MEMORY [1–8] buttons
These buttons are used to set and to locate to the eight Locate memories. Locate memories
can be set on the Locate Memory page (see page 260). To set a locate memory on-the-fly,
while holding down the [SET] button, press a LOCATE MEMORY [1–8] button. The
DM2000 must be receiving timecode in order to do this. Once set, the stored position can
be located by pressing the corresponding button. If the button is pressed while the machine
is stopped, the stored position is located. If the button is pressed while the machine is playing, the stored position is located and then playback continues from that position.
When using P2, locate operations are based on the control information received at the
REMOTE port. In order to synchronize the MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge’s time counter, it’s
recommended that you set the DM2000 to the same timecode source as the machine.
•
•
•
•
[AUDITION] button
This button is used in conjunction with the [PRE], [IN], [OUT], and [POST] buttons for
auditioning. Its indicator lights up while auditioning is on and operation is as follows:
Press the [PRE] button to locate and audition from the pre-roll point.
Press the [IN] button to locate and audition from the in point.
Press the [OUT] button to locate and audition from the out point.
Press the [POST] button to locate and audition from the post-roll point.
[PRE] & [POST] buttons
These buttons are used to locate the pre-roll and post-roll points. If the [AUDITION] button indicator is lit, playback starts when a point is located. The pre-roll point is the in point
minus the specified pre-roll time. The post-roll point is the out point plus the specified
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
About Machine Control (MMC & P2)
259
post-roll time. The pre-roll and post-roll times can be specified on the Locate Memory page
(see page 260). If a button is pressed while the machine is stopped, the stored position is
located. If a button is pressed while the machine is playing, the stored position is located and
then playback continues from that position.
[IN] & [OUT] buttons
These buttons are used to set and to locate the in and out points. These points can be set on
the Locate Memory page (see page 260). To set a point on-the-fly, while holding down the
[SET] button, press the [IN] or [OUT] button. The DM2000 must be receiving timecode
in order to do this. Once set, the stored position can be located by pressing the corresponding button. If the button is pressed while the machine is stopped, the stored position is
located. If the button is pressed while the machine is playing, the stored position is located
and then playback continues from that position. If the [AUDITION] button indicator is lit,
playback starts when a point is located.
[SET] button
This button is used in conjunction with the LOCATE MEMORY [1–8], [IN], [OUT], and
[RETURN TO ZERO] buttons to set the locate points.
[RETURN TO ZERO] button
This button is used to set and to locate the return to zero point. This point can be set on the
Locate Memory page (see page 260). To set it on-the-fly, while holding down the [SET] button, press the [RETURN TO ZERO] button. The DM2000 must be receiving timecode in
order to do this. Once set, the stored position can be located by pressing the [RETURN TO
ZERO] button. If the button is pressed while the machine is stopped, the stored position is
located. If the button is pressed while the machine is playing, the stored position is located
and then playback continues from that position.
[ONLINE] button
This button is used to switch the external machines online and offline. Its indicator lights
up when machines are online. Essentially, this turns the machine’s chase function on and
off. This function can be enabled and disabled for individual machines on the Machine
Configuration page (see page 256).
When chase is on, the machine automatically chases its specified timecode source, and the
following DM2000 controls are ineffective: transport, [SHUTTLE], [SCRUB], [PRE],
[POST], [IN], [OUT], [RETURN TO ZERO], [LOOP], and [QUICK PUNCH].
[LOOP] button
This button is used to turn loop playback on and off, in which playback cycles between the
pre-roll and post-roll points. Its indicator lights up when loop playback is on. If Loop playback is turned on during playback, loop playback will not start until the post-roll point is
reached.
This button is mutually exclusive with the [QUICK PUNCH], [SHUTTLE], and [SCRUB]
buttons.
•
•
[QUICK PUNCH] button
This button is used to turn quick punch (also known as auto punch) on and off. Its indicator lights up when quick punch is on.
This button is mutually exclusive with the [LOOP], [SHUTTLE], and [SCRUB] buttons.
When the [QUICK PUNCH] button indicator is lit, pressing the [PLAY] button will locate
to the pre-roll point and start playback. At the post-roll point, the machine will stop playback, locate the pre-roll point, and then stop.
When the [QUICK PUNCH] button indicator is lit, pressing the [PLAY] and [REC] buttons together will locate to the pre-roll point and start playback. At the in point, the
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
260
Chapter 20—Remote Control
machine switches to input monitor and starts recording. At the out point, the machine
switches to playback monitor and stops recording. At the post-roll point, the machine
locates the pre-roll point and then stops. If the [REHEARSAL] button indicator is lit, the
machine goes into Record-Rehearsal mode between the in and out points (i.e., nothing is
recorded).
[ROLL BACK] button
This button is used to roll back the machine by the amount specified on the Locate Memory
page (see page 260). If its pressed while the machine is stopped, the machine rolls back the
specified amount and stops. If its pressed during playback, the machine rolls back the specified amount and then continues playing.
[REHEARSAL] button
This button is used to turn Rehearsal mode on and off. Its indicator lights up when
Rehearsal mode is on. In Rehearsal mode, the machine enters Record-Rehearsal mode
instead of actually recording when the [PLAY] and [REC] buttons are pressed together.
Rehearsal mode can also be used with quick punch.
[MTR] & [MASTER] buttons
These mutually exclusive buttons are used to select the MTR or Master machines for control
with the LOCATOR section. When the [MTR] button indicator is lit, the LOCATOR section
controls machines set to MTR. When the [MASTER] button indicator is lit, the LOCATOR
section controls machines set to MASTER. See “Configuring Machines” on page 256.
Setting the Locate Memories, Pre-roll, Post-roll & Roll-back
The locate points and the pre-roll, post-roll, and roll-back times can be set as follows.
1
Use the LOCATOR [DISPLAY] button to locate the Locate Memory page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
MACHINE CONTROL/DAW CONTROL: When the MACHINE CONTROL option is
on, the MACHINE CONTROL section controls external MMC machines, regardless of the
layer selection. When the DAW CONTROL option is on, the MACHINE CONTROL section controls DAWs, regardless of the layer selection.
LOCATE MEMORY 1–8, IN, OUT, and RTZ: These time values determine the points
that will be located when the LOCATOR [1–8], [IN], [OUT], and [RTZ] buttons are
pressed. Locate points can be specified in hours, minutes, seconds, and frames, the frame
range being dependent on the frame rate setting on the Time Reference page (see page 201).
These points can also be set on-the-fly, so long as the DM2000 is receiving timecode. To do
this, while holding down the LOCATOR [SET] button, press the [1–8], [IN], [OUT], or
[RTZ] button.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
About Machine Control (MMC & P2)
261
PREROLL TIME: In conjunction with the in point, this determines the position that will
be located when the LOCATOR [PRE] button is pressed. For example, if the in point is
00:01:00.00 and the pre-roll time is 5 seconds, 00:00:55.00 will be located.
POSTROLL TIME: In conjunction with the out point, this determines the position that
will be located when the LOCATOR [POST] button is pressed. For example, if the out point
is 00:01:00.00 and the post-roll time is 5 seconds, 00:01:05.00 will be located.
ROLLBACK TIME: This determines how many seconds the machines roll back from the
current position when the LOCATOR [ROLL BACK] button is pressed.
FRAMES: This parameter selects the timecode frame rate.
Arming Machine Tracks
The TRACK ARMING section can be used to arm tracks on external machines.
TRACK ARMING
DISPLAY
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
A
B
C
D
ALL CLEAR
MASTER
TRACK ARMING GROUP
[1–24] buttons
These buttons are used to arm tracks on the external MTR and Master machines. Their
indicators light up when tracks are armed. These buttons can be configured to arm any
track of any machine. See “Configuring MTR Track Arming” on page 262 and “Configuring
Master Track Arming” on page 262 for more information.
TRACK ARMING GROUP [A–D] buttons
These buttons are used to select track arming groups A, B, C, and D. The indicator of the
currently selected group lights up. See “Configuring Track Arming Groups” on page 263 for
more information.
[ALL CLEAR] button
This button is used to clear all track arming on the external machines.
[MASTER] button
This button is used to select the MTR or Master machines for track arming. When its button
indicator is off, the TRACK ARMING section controls machines set to MTR. When the button indicator is lit, the TRACK ARMING section controls machines set to MASTER. See
“Configuring Machines” on page 256.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
262
Chapter 20—Remote Control
Configuring MTR Track Arming
You can assign MTR machine tracks to the TRACK ARMING [1–24] buttons as follows.
These assignments are effective only when the TRACK ARMING [MASTER] button indicator is off.
1
Use the TRACK ARMING [DISPLAY] button to locate the MTR Track Arming
Configuration page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
MACHINE CONTROL/DAW CONTROL: When the MACHINE CONTROL option is
on, the MACHINE CONTROL section controls external MMC or P2 machines, regardless
of the layer selection. When the DAW CONTROL option is on, the MACHINE CONTROL
section controls DAWs, regardless of the layer selection.
MACHINE: This parameter is used to specify the MTR machine whose track is to be
armed when each TRACK ARMING button is pressed. Only machines configured as MTRs
on the Machine Configuration page (see page 256) can be selected.
TARGET TRACK: This parameter is used to specify the MTR machine track that is to be
armed when each TRACK ARMING button is pressed.
Configuring Master Track Arming
You can assign Master machine tracks to the TRACK ARMING [1–24] buttons as follows.
These assignments are effective only when the TRACK ARMING [MASTER] button indicator is lit.
1
Use the TRACK ARMING [DISPLAY] button to locate the Master Track Arming
Configuration page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
About Machine Control (MMC & P2)
2
263
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, and [ENTER] button to set them.
MACHINE CONTROL/DAW CONTROL: When the MACHINE CONTROL option is
on, the MACHINE CONTROL section controls external MMC or P2 machines, regardless
of the layer selection. When the DAW CONTROL option is on, the MACHINE CONTROL
section controls DAWs, regardless of the layer selection.
MACHINE: This parameter is used to specify the Master machine whose track is to be
armed when each TRACK ARMING button is pressed. Only machines configured as Masters on the Machine Configuration page (see page 256) can be selected.
TARGET TRACK: This parameter is used to specify the Master machine track that is to be
armed when each TRACK ARMING button is pressed.
Configuring Track Arming Groups
Track arming groups A, B, C, and D provide a quick way to arm multiple MTR or Master
machine tracks.
1
Use the TRACK ARMING [DISPLAY] button to locate the Track Arming Group
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the track buttons, and
use the INC/DEC buttons or [ENTER] button to add and remove tracks from
the groups.
A track is in a group when its button appears highlighted, and tracks can be in multiple
groups. The CLEAR buttons can be used to clear all assignments in each group.
When a TRACK ARMING GROUP [A–D] button is pressed, that button’s indicator, and
the button indicators of the tracks in that group light up. If one of those tracks is subsequently unarmed, the TRACK ARMING GROUP [A–D] button indicator goes out.
MACHINE CONTROL/DAW CONTROL: When the MACHINE CONTROL option is
on, the MACHINE CONTROL section controls external MMC or P2 machines, regardless
of the layer selection. When the DAW CONTROL option is on, the MACHINE CONTROL
section controls DAWs, regardless of the layer selection.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
264
Chapter 20—Remote Control
GPI (General Purpose Interface)
The DM2000’s CONTROL port (25-pin D-sub connector) provides
a GPI (General Purpose Interface). You can configure the GPI so that
it will output 8-channel trigger signals when you operate the faders
or User Defined Keys, or receive 2-channel trigger signals to control
DM2000 parameters.
You can assign any function to these trigger signals. In this way, for example, you can control a “RECORDING” warning light outside a studio from the DM2000, or you can control
the DM2000’s Talkback function or Dimmer function using an outside switch.
See page 350 for more information on pin assignment.
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
1
2
3
This is an example of the external circuit that operates GPI.
In this example, a trigger signal causes the LEDs to light up
when the
button is selected as the trigger signal polarity
in the OUTPUT section. A trigger signal causes the LEDs to
turn off when the
button is selected as the trigger signal
polarity.
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
GPO0
13
9
GPO1
1
21
GPO4
9
14
9
GPO5
3
21
GPI0
22
GPO2
GPO3
2
21
GPO6
16
9
15
GPO7
4
21
17
GPI1
5
10
6
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to select the GPI Setup page.
2
To assign functions to incoming trigger signals, use the cursor buttons to
select INPUT 1 or 2.
3
Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select a parameter, then
press [ENTER].
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
GPI (General Purpose Interface)
4
265
Select one of two buttons located to the right of trigger signal parameters
INPUT 1 & 2 to specify how the incoming trigger signals will be detected.
: When the switch is grounded (Low), the trigger signal is active and the selected parameter changes.
: When the GPI Input goes High (open), the trigger signal is active and the selected
parameter changes.
You can execute functions assigned to the MONITOR section buttons and User Defined
Keys, and turn channels on and off. See “GPI Trigger Source & Target List” on page 302 for
a complete list of assignable functions.
Note: “xxx UNLATCH” means that the assigned function is enabled only while the incoming
trigger signal is active. For example, if CH1 ON is selected, the channel on/off status changes
each time the trigger signal is detected. If CH1 ON UNLATCH is selected, Channel 1 turns
on only while the trigger signal is active.
Trigger =
Input signals from
the CONTROL connector
Executes the function.
Executes the function.
Trigger =
Input signals from
the CONTROL connector
Executes the function.
Executes the function.
At this point, when the DM2000 receives the trigger signal at the CONTROL connector, the
selected parameter changes.
Tip: Refer to the page 302 for a complete list of assignable parameters.
TALKBACK - SMALL: Functions the same as the MONITOR section buttons.
SR xxx: Functions the same as the SURROUND buttons in the MONITOR section.
CR xxx: Functions the same as the CONTROL ROOM buttons in the MONITOR section.
SM xxx: Functions the same as the STUDIO buttons in the MONITOR section.
xxx UNLATCH: The assigned function is enabled only while the incoming trigger signal
is active.
xxx ON: The corresponding channels turn on or off each time the incoming trigger signal
becomes active.
xxx ON UNLATCH: The corresponding channels turn on only while the incoming trigger signal is active.
UDEFxxx: Functions the same as the USER DEFINED KEYS.
5
To select parameters or controls as trigger signal sources, use the cursor buttons to select an output from OUTPUT 1–8, then select trigger signal parameters as you would for the INPUT section.
See “GPI Trigger Source & Target List” on page 302 for a complete list of assignable parameters.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
266
Chapter 20—Remote Control
6
Use the buttons located to the right of the OUTPUT (1–8) parameters to
switch the polarity of the trigger signals that are output when you control
the trigger sources.
: The GPI Output goes High (open) when the trigger signal source is active.
: The GPI Output goes Low (ground) when the trigger signal source is active.
Trigger signal polarity =
Output signals from the
CONTROL connector
Trigger signal polarity =
Output signals from the
CONTROL connector
At this time, the trigger signal is output from the CONTROL connector when you operate
the assigned parameters or controls.
Tip: Refer to page 302 for a complete list of assignable parameters and controls.
xxx FADER ON: A trigger signal of 250 ms is transmitted when you raise a fader from –∞.
xxx FADER OFF: A trigger signal of 250 ms is transmitted when you lower a fader to –∞.
xxx FADER TALLY: The trigger signal becomes active when the fader is set to any level
other than –∞, and the trigger signal turns off when the fader is set to –∞.
UDEFxx LATCH: Pressing the corresponding button in the USER DEFINED KEYS section activates the trigger signal, and pressing the button again turns it off.
UDEF xx UNLATCH: A trigger signal of 250 ms is transmitted each time you press the
corresponding button in the USER DEFINED KEYS section.
REC LAMP: This source can be used to control a “RECORDING” warning light outside a
studio. The trigger signal is active while the [REC] button indicator is lit.
POWER ON: The trigger signal is active while the power to the DM2000 is on.
Important note: GPI outputs are open collector outputs. GPI inputs have an internal pull-up
to 5 V.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Controlling AD8HR/AD824 A/D Converters
267
Controlling AD8HR/AD824 A/D Converters
You can control the parameters of up to 12 Yamaha AD8HR/AD824 A/D
Converters from the DM2000 by connecting them to the DM2000’s
REMOTE port using a 9-pin reversed cable. Pinouts are provided on
page 350.
Configuring the REMOTE Port & Assigning Slots to HA
(AD8HR/AD824) IDs
The REMOTE port can be configured, and Slots assigned to HA IDs as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to select the Remote Port Setup
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the REMOTE FUNCTION button, use the
INC/DEC buttons to select HA, then press [ENTER].
3
Use the cursor buttons to select the HA SLOT parameters, and use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select the Slots.
The ID column lists names of connected devices (AD8HR or AD824). The number of available IDs depends on the number of AD8HR/AD824s connected to the DM2000.
Note: To control multiple AD8HR/AD824 Converters, connect them with the DM2000 in a
daisy chain. Note that you must connect AD8HRs closer to the DM2000 if both AD8HRs and
AD824s are connected in a system.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
268
Chapter 20—Remote Control
Controlling AD8HR/AD824s from the DM2000
Connected AD8HR/AD824s are controlled from the HA Control page.
1
Use the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT [DISPLAY] button to select the
HA Control page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the ID of the HA (AD8HR/AD824) that you
want to control, and then press [ENTER].
3
Use the rotary controls to set the gain of each HA channel, and use the +48V
buttons to turn phantom power on or off for each channel.
If you connected an AD8HR, you can monitor the +48V MASTER switch on/off status on
the AD8HR.
4
If you connected an AD8HR, turn the rotary controls to set the HPF (high
pass filter) cutoff frequency for each HA channel, and use the HPF buttons
to turn HPF on or off for each channel.
All parameter settings, excluding the phantom power on/off setting, will be saved as part of
a scene.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Other Functions
269
21 Other Functions
Using the User Assignable Layers
If you set the Remote layer target to “USER ASSIGNABLE,” you can create a custom layer
by combining any DM2000 channels (excluding the Stereo Out).
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [REMOTE] button to locate Remote 1–4 page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the TARGET parameter, use the Parameter
wheel or INC/DEC buttons to select USER ASSIGNABLE LAYER, then press
[ENTER].
A confirmation message appears. Select the YES button and press [ENTER].
3
Use the cursor buttons to select parameter 1–24, use the Parameter wheel
or INC/DEC buttons to select a channel you want to assign, then press
[ENTER].
You can store up to four 24-channel setups in four banks by switching Banks 1–4 via the
BANK 1–4 buttons.
Pressing the [ENTER] button prior to selecting assigned channels enables you to select a
channel in the User CH Select window.
4
Use the LAYER [REMOTE 1]–[REMOTE 4] button to recall the User Assignable
layer assigned to the Remote layer.
You can use the faders, Encoders, [ON] buttons, [AUTO] buttons, and [SOLO] buttons to
control assigned channels. If you connected an optional MB2000 Meter Bridge, its meters
indicate the level of the channels currently-assigned to layer channels 1–24.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
270
Chapter 21—Other Functions
Using the User Defined Keys
Up to 16 functions from a list of over 200 can be
assigned to the USER DEFINED KEYS, and up to
eight assignment setups can be stored in banks A to
H. See page 283 for a list of initial bank assignments.
USER DEFINED KEYS
DISPLAY
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
1
Use the USER DEFINED KEYS [DISPLAY] button to locate the User Defined
Key Assign page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the BANK buttons, A to H, and press [ENTER]
to select a bank.
The TITLE parameter box displays the name of the selected bank. Select the TITLE parameter box, then press [ENTER]. The Title Edit window appears, enabling you to enter a
name.
3
Use the cursor buttons to select from 1–16, then press [ENTER].
The following User Define Select window opens.
4
Move the cursor to the left column, then rotate the Parameter wheel or press
the [INC]/[DEC] buttons to select the function you wish to assign.
5
Select options in the center and right columns in the same way.
The items displayed in the center and right columns vary depending on the function
assigned in Step 4.
6
Use the cursor buttons to select YES, then press [ENTER].
When the window closes, the specified function is assigned to the selected User Defined
button.
When you select a function that recalls a specific Scene or library memory, you need to specify the number of the memory that you want recalled when the USER DEFINED KEY is
pressed. To do this, in the left-hand box, select the number parameter next to the Assign
button, and use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to specify the number.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Saving DM2000 Data to SmartMedia
271
You can initialize the assignments of the currently selected bank by selecting the INITIALIZE button, and pressing [ENTER].
User Defined Keys banks can be stored to an external MIDI device, such as a MIDI data filer,
by using MIDI Bulk Dump (see page 220), or stored to SmartMedia (see page 271).
Saving DM2000 Data to SmartMedia
Saving
DM2000 Data can be saved to SmartMedia as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DATA] button to locate the Save page.
2
Insert your SmartMedia card into the CARD slot.
If the card doesn’t have a “/YPE/DM2000” directory, a confirmation message appears and
you should choose YES to make the directory.
The LIST box displays files and directories alphabetically. Only files of the currently selected
CATEGORY are displayed. All files are displayed when the CATEGORY is set to ALL. Use
the cursor buttons to select the LIST box, and then use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC
buttons to select files and directories. Directories have a small “D” next to their name. You
can open the currently selected directory by pressing [ENTER]. To move up the directory
structure, select “up,” and then press [ENTER]. You cannot move up beyond the
“/YPE/DM2000” directory.
The PATH box indicates the path of the currently selected file. The SmartMedia icon to the
right of the PATH box indicates whether or not a SmartMedia card is inserted: “O” when a
card is inserted, “X” when no card is inserted.
3
To save data, use the CATEGORY parameters to select the type of data you
want to save, use the LIST box to select where you want to save the data,
select the SAVE button, and then press [ENTER].
When the Title Edit window appears, enter a filename, and press OK when you’ve finished.
See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
You can save data with a different name by using the SAVE AS button.
When saving individual items, such as Scenes or library memories, you can use the SAVE
OPTIONS APPEND and OVERWRITE to append individual memories to existing files or
to overwrite them. The SAVE OPTIONS are unavailable and the existing files are overwritten when ALL, or SCENE MEM ALL, AUTOMIX ALL, LIBRARY ALL, BANK ALL, or
PLUG IN ALL is selected.
The CATEGORY parameters can be set as follows:
ALL: Saves all data.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
272
Chapter 21—Other Functions
SCENE MEM: Saves Scenes. You can save ALL Scenes, individual Scenes, or the Edit Buffer
(i.e., the current Scene).
AUTOMIX: Saves Automixes. You can save ALL Automixes, individual Automixes, or the
current Automix.
LIBRARY: Saves the following libraries: EQ, Gate, Comp, Channel, Effects, GEQ, Bus to
Stereo, Input Patch, Output Patch, Surround Monitor. For each library you can select ALL
user memories, individual user memories, and for the Bus to Stereo, Input Patch, Output
Patch, Surround Monitor libraries you can also select the current settings.
BANK: Saves the User Defined Remote banks (RMT UDEF), User Defined Plug-Ins banks
(PLUG UDEF), USER DEFINED KEYS banks (KEYS UDEF), or the USER ASSIGNABLE
LAYER banks (USR LAYER). For each item you can select ALL or individual banks.
SETUP MEM: Saves the DM2000 setup data (i.e., system settings).
PGM TABLE: Saves the Scene to MIDI Program Change table. See “Assigning Scenes to
Program Changes” on page 218.
CTL TABLE: Saves the Parameter to MIDI Control Change table. See “Assigning Parameters to Control Changes” on page 219.
PLUG-IN: Saves the settings of the effects processing cards installed in the Slots. You can
save ALL Slots or individual Slots.
Note: You cannot save data that exceeds the remaining space on a SmartMedia card. Even if
you try to overwrite the existing data, you will require a space equivalent to the size of the data
you are trying to save.
Loading
DM2000 data can be loaded from SmartMedia as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DATA] button to locate the Load page.
2
Insert your SmartMedia card into the CARD slot.
3
To load data, use the buttons in the CATEGORY box to select the type of file
you want to load, select a file in the LIST box, select the LOAD button, and
then press [ENTER].
The FILE INFORMATION box displays the filename and the date when the currently
selected file was last stored. See “Saving” on page 271 for information on the PATH and
LIST boxes and the SmartMedia icon.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Saving DM2000 Data to SmartMedia
273
Managing Files & SmartMedia
Files stored on SmartMedia can be renamed and deleted as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [DATA] button to locate the File page.
2
Insert your SmartMedia card into the CARD slot.
If the card doesn’t have a “/YPE/DM2000” directory, a confirmation message appears and
you should choose YES to make the directory.
The FILE INFORMATION box displays the filename and the date when the currently
selected file was last stored. See “Saving” on page 271 for information on the PATH and
LIST boxes and the SmartMedia icon.
The STATUS box displays information about the currently inserted SmartMedia card,
including, its Volume Label, total Capacity, amount of Used space, and amount of Free space.
3
To create a new directory, use the LIST box to select the directory in which
you want to create the new directory, select the CREATE DIRECTORY button,
and then press [ENTER].
When the Title Edit window appears, enter a name for the new directory, and press OK
when you’ve finished. See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
4
To rename a file or directory, use the LIST box to select that file or directory,
select the RENAME button, and then press [ENTER].
When the Title Edit window appears, edit the name, and press OK when you’ve finished.
See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information.
5
To delete a file or directory, use the LIST box to select that file or directory,
select the DELETE button, and then press [ENTER].
6
To format a SmartMedia card, select the FORMAT button, and press [ENTER].
When the Title Edit window appears, enter a volume label for the card, and press OK when
you’ve finished. See “Title Edit Window” on page 54 for more information. The directory
“/YPE/DM2000” is created automatically.
Note: During formatting, the DM2000 system is busy. You should format a card while the
DM2000 is not performing other operations. During the Automix operation or while you are
using included Card Filer application, you cannot access the SmartMedia card from the Save,
Load, and File pages.
You can use the Studio Manager to save DM1000, 02R96, or 01V96 data to, and load data
from, a SmartMedia card. When saving data to a SmartMedia card, use a card formatted
using the format option on the File page of the DM2000, and save data to a directory called
“/YPE/DM2000” or lower hierarchical directory.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
274
Chapter 21—Other Functions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
The following file types are compatible between these different consoles:
Scene Memory (file extension: .D2M)
Equalizer Library (file extension: .D2Q)
Gate Library (file extension: .D2G)
Compressor Library (file extension: .D2Y)
Effect Library (file extension: .D2F)
Channel Library (file extension: .D2H)
Automix Memory (file extension: .D2A)
You can also load ALL data for each console (file extension: .02X, .D1X, .01X) by changing
the extension to .D2X. In this case, you can load the following compatible data:
Scene Memory, Equalizer Library, Gate Library, Compressor Library, Effect Library, Channel Library, Bus To Stereo Library, Surround Monitor Library, Automix Memory, User
Defined Remote Layer, User Defined Plug-In, Program Change Table, Plug-In Card Memory, User Assignable Layer.
Note: Some of the data listed above may use default settings or may not be updated due to
differences in parameters or numbers of channels.
Setting Preferences
You can customize the operation of the DM2000 by using the preferences pages.
Preferences 1
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to locate the Preferences 1 page.
2
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the preferences, and
use the INC/DEC buttons or [ENTER] button to set them.
Auto ROUTING Display: When this preference is on, the Routing pages appear automatically when a button in the SELECTED CHANNEL ROUTING section is pressed (see
page 93).
Auto PHASE/INSERT Display: When this preference is on, the Phase pages appear
automatically when the Phase [ ] button in the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT
section is switched from off to on (see page 84), and the Insert page appears automatically
when the SELECTED CHANNEL PHASE/INSERT [INSERT ON] button is pressed (see
page 135).
Auto DELAY Display: When this option is on, the Delay pages appear automatically
when a control in the SELECTED CHANNEL DELAY section is operated (see page 141).
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Setting Preferences
275
Auto AUX/MATRIX Display: When this preference is on, the Aux View pages appear
automatically when a SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND control is operated
while an Input Channel is selected (see page 114), and the Matrix View page appears automatically when a SELECTED CHANNEL AUX/MATRIX SEND control is operated while a
Bus Out, Aux Send, or the Stereo Out is selected (see page 124).
Auto DYNAMICS Display: When this preference is on, the Gate Edit page appears automatically when a gate control in the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS section is operated (see page 85), and the Comp Edit page appears automatically when a Compressor
control in the SELECTED CHANNEL DYNAMICS section is operated (see page 137).
Auto PAN/SURROUND Display: When this preference is on and Input Channels have
been selected, the Pan pages appears automatically when a control in the SELECTED
CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND section is operated (see page 96). Similarly, when a Surround Pan mode other than Stereo is selected, the Input Channel Surround Edit page
appears automatically when the Joystick is operated (see page 100). Also, when Stereo or
Matrix is selected, the Fader View page appears automatically when the Pan controls are
operated.
Auto EQUALIZER Display: When this preference is on, the EQ Edit page appears automatically when a control in the SELECTED CHANNEL EQUALIZER section is operated
(see page 134).
Auto SOLO Display: When this option is on, the Solo Setup page appears automatically
when an channel is soloed (see page 143).
Auto WORD CLOCK Display: When this preference is on, the Word Clock Select page
appears automatically if the currently selected external wordclock source fails (see page 67).
Auto Channel Select: When this preference is on, channels can be selected by moving
the corresponding fader or Encoder, or by turning on the corresponding [AUTO], [SOLO],
or [ON] button.
Store Confirmation: When this preference is on, the Title Edit window appears when
you store a Scene (page 187) or library memory (page 165). However, when you store an
Automix library memory, the Title Edit window appears regardless of whether this preference is set to on or off.
Recall Confirmation: When this preference is on, a confirmation message appears when
you recall a Scene (page 187) or library memory (page 165).
Patch Confirmation: When this preference is on, a confirmation message appears when
you edit the Input and Output Patches (see page 77).
Pair Confirmation: When this preference is on, a confirmation message appears when
you pair channels using the [SEL] buttons.
Nominal Pan: When this preference is on, left/odd and right/even signals will be at nominal level when Input Channel, Bus to Stereo, Bus to Matrix, or Aux to Matrix signals are
panned hard left or hard right, and at –3 dB when panned center. When this preference is
off, signals panned hard left or hard right will be at 3 dB, and at nominal level when panned
center. In Surround mode, this preference setting is used for the signal of any Surround Pan
channel that is fully panned.
Fast Meter Fall Time: When this preference is on, the level meters fall quicker.
TC Drop Warning: When this preference is on, a warning message appears if a dropout
is detected in the incoming timecode.
DIO Warning: When this preference is on, a warning message appears if any errors are
detected in digital audio signals received by the Slot Inputs or 2TR Digital Inputs.
MIDI Warning: When this preference is on, a warning message appears if any errors are
detected in the incoming MIDI messages.
Initial Data Nominal: When this preference is on, Input Channel faders are set to nominal when Scene #0 is recalled.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
276
Chapter 21—Other Functions
Meter Follow Layer: When this preference is on, the optional MB2000 Peak Meter
Bridge automatically follows the Layer selection on the DM2000.
Scene MEM Auto Update: When this preference is on, the Shadow Scene memories
can be used (see page 186).
Joystick Auto Grab: When this preference is on, the Joystick automatically kicks in as the
surround pan control when it’s moved to the current surround pan position (see page 100).
Cascade COMM Link: When this preference is on, various functions are linked between
cascaded DM2000s (see page 74). When this preference is off, only digital audio signals are
distributed among the cascaded DM2000s.
Solo Bus to Studio Out: When this preference is on and all STUDIO buttons ([CONTROL ROOM], [STEREO], [AUX 11], [AUX 12]) in the MONITOR section are turned off,
soloed Input Channel signals are output via the STUDIO MONITOR OUT.
Auto Direct Out On: When this preference is on and you change the channel Direct Out
destination from “–” to any other output, the channel Direct Out is automatically enabled.
If you change the channel Direct Out destination from an output to “–,” the channel Direct
Out is automatically disabled.
Routing ST Pair Link: When this preference is on, routing from paired channels to the
Stereo Bus is linked.
Preferences 2
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to locate the Preferences 2 page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the preferences, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC buttons, or [ENTER] button to set them.
Channel ID: The Channel Strip Displays indicate the corresponding Channel ID.
Channel Short Name: The Channel Strip Displays indicate the corresponding Channel
Short Name.
Port ID/Name on FL Display: The Channel Strip Displays indicate the Port ID or Port
Name. You can choose an identifier by using the Port ID or Port Short Name option.
Port ID: The Channel Strip Displays indicate the Port ID.
Port Short Name: The Channel Strip Displays indicate the Port Short Name.
Channel Copy Parameter: These buttons allow you to choose which channel parameters are copied by the Channel Copy function: ALL parameters, or any combination of
FADER, ON, PAN, SURR, AUX, AUX ON, and EQ. See “Copying Channel Settings” on
page 155.
Fader Touch Sense: These parameters control the Touch Sense function. If the CONTROL button is turned on and the touch sensors are not triggered, fader operation is
ignored. During Automix recording, you can “cut-in” by touching a fader. When this button
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Setting Preferences
277
is off, the DM2000 always recognizes fader movements. If the SELECT button is on, you can
select channels using the Touch Sense function.
The Sensitivity parameter adjusts touch sensitivity. If you’re having trouble selecting channels because the fader knobs are insufficiently sensitive, try increasing this value. If they are
too sensitive, try reducing it. It’s important that the DM2000 is grounded properly for
Touch Select to work correctly. See “Grounding screw” on page 50 for more information.
Display Brightness: This preference is used to set the brightness of the fluorescent and
LED displays and indicators.
Date: These parameters are used to set the date and time that is applied to files when they
stored to SmartMedia. Use the Parameter wheel or INC/DEC buttons to set the parameters,
and then press the SET button, or press CANCEL to cancel.
Preferences 3
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [SETUP] button to locate the Preferences 3 page.
2
Use the cursor buttons or Parameter wheel to select the preferences, and
use the INC/DEC buttons or [ENTER] button to set them.
Mix Update Confirmation: When this preference is on, a confirmation message asking
if you want to update the current Automix with the latest edits appears when Automix
recording is stopped.
Auto EQ Edit In: When this preference is on, EQ is automatically punched into Automix
recording when an EQ control is adjusted.
Copy Initial Fader: When this preference is on, when Fader events are copied or moved
on the Automix Event Copy page, the fader value at the specified IN point is copied to the
specified TO point. This eliminates fader position matching problems when no fader event
exists at the specified TO point.
Auto Inc TC Capture: When this preference is on, the Timecode Capture memory is
incremented automatically each time a timecode address is captured on the Automix Event
Edit page (see page 209).
Link Capture & Locate Memory: When this preference is on, the eight Capture memories on the Automix Event Edit page are linked to the eight Locate memories so that, for
example, edits made to Capture memory #1 are reflected on Locate memory #1, and vice
versa.
Clear Edit Channel after REC: When this preference is on, when using Auto Rec,
channels are automatically unarmed (i.e., [AUTO] buttons are turned off) when Automix
recording stops. When this preference is off, channels remain armed when recording stops.
Timecode Display Relative: When this preference is on, the indicated timecode is offset as specified by the OFFSET parameter on the Automix Main page.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
278
Chapter 21—Other Functions
Receive Full Frame Message: When this preference is on, MTC full frame messages
are recognized and Automix follows them.
Touch Sense Edit In All: When this preference is on, using the faders’ Touch Sense
function enables you to punch in and out all parameters for which the corresponding
OVERWRITE buttons are turned on. When this preference is off, you can punch in and out
only these faders selected in Fader mode.
Show Compact Size: Automix data, except that in the Undo buffer, is compressed while
recording. When this preference is on, the compressed size of the Automix is displayed on
the Automix Memory pages. When this preference is off, the uncompressed size is displayed.
Automix Store Undo: When this preference is on, Automix Store operations can be
undone by using the Undo function.
Drop Out Time: This parameter sets an interval (in frames) between the interruption of
incoming timecode and the stoppage of Automix recording or playback.
Lock Time: This parameter sets the interval (in frames) allowed until the Automix locks
to incoming timecode messages. If the sync operation is unstable, set this value higher.
Frame Jump Error: This parameter sets the time interval (in frames) required by the
DM2000 to recognize an error after incoming timecode messages jump. If the actual interval is shorter than the value specified by this parameter, the DM2000 continues the sync
operation. If the frame jump causes the recording or playback to stop during the MTC and
SMPT sync operation, set the parameter value higher than the number of frames indicated
in the error message.
If you set the parameter to a higher value, adjust the Drop Out Time parameter value, if necessary.
Fader REC Accuracy: This parameter sets the accuracy of recording faders over time to
“Little,” “Some,” “More,” or “Most.” If you set the parameter to lower values, you will save
Automix memory space.
Insert Time Link: This parameter enables you to select the locate memory used for the
IN and OUT parameters in the Insert operation.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Using the Oscillator
279
Using the Oscillator
The DM2000 features an oscillator that can be used for calibration or diagnostic purposes.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [UTILITY] button to locate the Oscillator page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the parameters, and use the Parameter
wheel, INC/DEC button, or [ENTER] button to set them.
OSCILLATOR ON: This turns the Oscillator on or off. While the LEVEL parameter is
selected, the [ENTER] button can be used to turn on and off the Oscillator.
Note: To prevent any sudden tone burst surprises in your monitors or headphones, you may
want to set the LEVEL parameter to minimum before turning on the oscillator.
LEVEL: This sets the Oscillator output level, which is displayed by the adjacent meter. This
parameter can be set by using the Parameter wheel regardless of which parameter is currently selected.
WAVEFORM: These buttons are used to select the waveforms: SINE 100Hz, SINE 1kHz,
SINE 10kHz, 1kHz/400Hz, PINK NOISE, or BURST NOISE, which is 200 msec pink noise
pulses at four second intervals. If you select 1 kHz/400 Hz, the Oscillator outputs a sine wave
at different frequencies to L, R, and odd/even buses.
ASSIGN: These buttons are used to assign the Oscillator output to Bus Outs, Aux Sends,
Matrix Sends, and the Stereo Out.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
280
Chapter 21—Other Functions
Operation Lock
The DM2000 features the Operation Lock function, which avoids unintentional edits and
uses a password to restrict access to panel operation.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [UTILITY] button to locate the Operation Lock
page.
2
Use the cursor buttons to select the PASSWORD button, then press [ENTER].
3
Use the [SEL] buttons to set the password.
Enter a four-letter password using the Channel 1–10 [SEL] buttons (Channel 10 [SEL] button enters “0”). (The factory default password is 1234.)
Enter the current password in the PASSWORD field, and a new password in the NEW
PASSWORD field. Enter the new password again in the REENTRY field.
4
Use the cursor buttons to select the OK button, then press [ENTER] to update
the password.
If you forget the password, you will be unable to cancel Operation Lock. Be sure to remember the password.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Operation Lock
5
281
Use the buttons in the OPERATION LOCK SAFE section to select certain controls on the panel to exclude from Operation Lock.
Buttons
Controls excluded from Operation Lock
CHANNEL FADER
Channel faders (1–24, STEREO)
CHANNEL ENCODER
Channel Encoders (1–24)
CHANNEL ON
Channel [ON] buttons (1–24, STEREO)
CHANNEL SOLO
Channel [SOLO] buttons (1–24)
CHANNEL SEL
Channel [SEL] buttons (1–24, STEREO)
FADER MODE
All buttons in the FADER MODE section
ENCODER MODE
All buttons in the ENCODER MODE section
AUX SELECT
All buttons in the AUX SELECT section
MATRIX SELECT
All buttons in the MATRIX SELECT section
SCENE MEMORY
All buttons in the SCENE MEMORY section (excluding the [STORE] button)
SELECTED CHANNEL
All controls in the SELECTED CHANNEL section (excluding the [COPY] and
[PASTE] buttons)
LAYER
All buttons in the LAYER section
USER DEFINED KEYS
All buttons in the USER DEFINED KEYS section
EFFECTS/PLUGINS
All buttons in the EFFECTS/PLUG-INS section (including the Parameter controls 1–4)
MONITOR
All controls in the MONITOR section
MACHINE CONTROL1
All buttons in the LOCATOR and TRACK ARMING sections, and all Transport
buttons
AUTOMIX
All buttons in the AUTOMIX section and Channel [AUTO] buttons (1–24,
STEREO)
1. The Parameter wheel is also excluded from Operation Lock when the [SHUTTLE] or [SCRUB] button is
on.
6
Use the cursor buttons to select the OPERATION LOCK button, then press
[ENTER].
The Password window appears.
7
Use the [SEL] buttons to enter the password you set in Step 4.
The Operation Lock function is activated.
To cancel Operation Lock, press [ENTER]. The Password window opens again. Enter the
same password again, and Operation Lock is cancelled.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
282
Chapter 21—Other Functions
Checking the Battery and the System Version
The condition of the internal memory-backup battery can be checked as follows.
1
Use the DISPLAY ACCESS [UTILITY] button to locate the Battery Check page.
If the Status is “Okay,” the battery is okay. If the Status is “Getting Low,” ask your Yamaha
dealer to replace the battery as soon as possible. Do not attempt to replace the battery yourself. Failure to replace a low battery may result in data loss.
Ver x.xx: This description identifies the system version number. Check the current system
version number against this description before you update the firmware. Visit the following
website to check the latest system version number:
http://www.yamahaproaudio.com/
Initializing the DM2000
The DM2000 can be initialized as follows.
Warning: This procedure will clear all user memories and reset all settings to their initial values. You may want to back up any important data beforehand via MIDI Bulk Dump (see
page 220), or to SmartMedia (see page 271). If you want to reset just the mix settings, recall
scene memory #0 instead (see page 186).
1
Turn off the DM2000.
2
While holding down the SCENE MEMORY [STORE] button, turn on the DM2000.
3
When the confirmation message appears, release the SCENE MEMORY
[STORE] button, select [INITIALIZE] button, and press [ENTER].
The following message is displayed while initialization is in progress: “Loading Factory Presets & Calibrating the Faders... Do Not Touch the Faders!”
It’s important that you do not touch the faders while this message is displayed, as the faders may not be calibrated correctly.
The display returns to normal when initialization is complete.
Initializing the Password
Follow the steps below to initialize the password for the Operation Lock function.
1
Turn off the power to the DM2000.
2
Hold down the SCENE MEMORY[STORE] button, and turn on the power to
the DM2000.
3
When a confirmation message appears, release the SCENE MEMORY
[STORE] button. Use the cursor buttons to select the PASSWORD button,
then press [ENTER].
The password is reset to “1234”.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
USER DEFINED KEYS
283
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
USER DEFINED KEYS
#
Function
Display
#
Function
Display
0
No ASSIGN
No Assign
53
GEQ2 Lib. Recall No. XX
GEQ2 LibXXX RCL.
1
Scene MEM. Recall +1
Scene +1 Recall
54
GEQ3 Lib. Recall +1
GEQ3 Lib+1 RCL.
2
Scene MEM. Recall –1
Scene –1 Recall
55
GEQ3 Lib. Recall –1
GEQ3 Lib–1 RCL.
3
Scene MEM. Recall No. XX
Scene XX Recall
56
GEQ3 Lib. Recall No. XX
GEQ3 LibXXX RCL.
4
Effect-1 Lib. Recall +1
Fx1 Lib+1 Recall
57
GEQ4 Lib. Recall +1
GEQ4 Lib+1 RCL.
5
Effect-1 Lib. Recall –1
Fx1 Lib –1 Recall
58
GEQ4 Lib. Recall –1
GEQ4 Lib–1 RCL.
6
Effect-1 Lib. Recall No. XX
Fx1 LibXXX RCL.
59
GEQ4 Lib. Recall No. XX
GEQ4 LibXXX RCL.
7
Effect-2 Lib. Recall +1
Fx2 Lib+1 Recall
60
GEQ5 Lib. Recall +1
GEQ5 Lib+1 RCL.
8
Effect-2 Lib. Recall –1
Fx2 Lib–1 Recall
61
GEQ5 Lib. Recall –1
GEQ5 Lib–1 RCL.
9
Effect-2 Lib. Recall No.XX
Fx2 LibXXX RCL.
62
GEQ5 Lib. Recall No. XX
GEQ5 LibXXX RCL.
10
Effect-3 Lib. Recall +1
Fx3 Lib+1 Recall
63
GEQ6 Lib. Recall +1
GEQ6 Lib+1 RCL.
11
Effect-3 Lib. Recall –1
Fx3 Lib–1 Recall
64
GEQ6 Lib. Recall –1
GEQ6 Lib–1 RCL.
12
Effect-3 Lib. Recall No.XX
Fx3 LibXXX RCL.
65
GEQ6 Lib. Recall No. XX
GEQ6 LibXXX RCL.
13
Effect-4 Lib. Recall +1
Fx4 Lib+1 Recall
66
GEQ-1 On/Off
GEQ1 ON/OFF
14
Effect-4 Lib. Recall –1
Fx4 Lib–1 Recall
67
GEQ-2 On/Off
GEQ2 ON/OFF
15
Effect-4 Lib. Recall No.XX
Fx4 LibXXX RCL.
68
GEQ-3 On/Off
GEQ3 ON/OFF
16
Effect-5 Lib. Recall +1
Fx5 Lib+1 Recall
69
GEQ-4 On/Off
GEQ4 ON/OFF
17
Effect-5 Lib. Recall –1
Fx5 Lib–1 Recall
70
GEQ-5 On/Off
GEQ5 ON/OFF
18
Effect-5 Lib. Recall No.XX
Fx5 LibXXX RCL.
71
GEQ-6 On/Off
GEQ6 ON/OFF
19
Effect-6 Lib. Recall +1
Fx6 Lib+1 Recall
72
SURR. MONI MUTE Mute L On/Off
Surr.Mon L Mute
20
Effect-6 Lib. Recall –1
Fx6 Lib–1 Recall
73
SURR. MONI MUTE Mute R On/Off
Surr.Mon R Mute
21
Effect-6 Lib. Recall No.XX
Fx6 LibXXX RCL.
74
SURR. MONI MUTE Mute Ls On/Off
Surr.Mon Ls Mute
22
Effect-7 Lib. Recall +1
Fx7 Lib+1 Recall
75
SURR. MONI MUTE Mute Rs On/Off
Surr.Mon Rs Mute
23
Effect-7 Lib. Recall –1
Fx7 Lib–1 Recall
76
SURR. MONI MUTE Mute C On/Off
Surr.Mon C Mute
24
Effect-7 Lib. Recall No.XX
Fx7 LibXXX RCL.
77
SURR. MONI MUTE Mute LFE On/Off
Surr.Mon LFEMute
25
Effect-8 Lib. Recall +1
Fx8 Lib+1 Recall
78
SURR.MONI ASSIGN X SLOT1 ON/OFF Surr.ASGNX SL1 ON
26
Effect-8 Lib. Recall –1
Fx8 Lib–1 Recall
79
SURR.MONI ASSIGN X SLOT2 ON/OFF Surr.ASGNX SL2 ON
27
Effect-8 Lib. Recall No.XX
Fx8 LibXXX RCL.
80
SURR.MONI ASSIGN X SLOT3 ON/OFF Surr.ASGNX SL3 ON
28
Effect-1 Bypass On/Off
Fx1 Bypass
81
SURR.MONI ASSIGN X SLOT4 ON/OFF Surr.ASGNX SL4 ON
29
Effect-2 Bypass On/Off
Fx2 Bypass
82
SURR.MONI ASSIGN X SLOT5 ON/OFF Surr.ASGNX SL5 ON
30
Effect-3 Bypass On/Off
Fx3 Bypass
83
SURR.MONI ASSIGN X SLOT6 ON/OFF Surr.ASGNX SL6 ON
31
Effect-4 Bypass On/Off
Fx4 Bypass
84
SURR. MONI BASS MANAGE ON/OFF
Bass Manage ON
32
Effect-5 Bypass On/Off
Fx5 Bypass
85
Input Fader Group Enable A
IN Fader Group A
33
Effect-6 Bypass On/Off
Fx6 Bypass
86
Input Fader Group Enable B
IN Fader Group B
34
Effect-7 Bypass On/Off
Fx7 Bypass
87
Input Fader Group Enable C
IN Fader Group C
35
Effect-8 Bypass On/Off
Fx8 Bypass
88
Input Fader Group Enable D
IN Fader Group D
36
Channel Lib. Recall +1
CH Lib+1 Recall
89
Input Fader Group Enable E
IN Fader Group E
37
Channel Lib. Recall –1
CH Lib–1 Recall
90
Input Fader Group Enable F
IN Fader Group F
38
Channel Lib. Recall No. XX
CH LibXXX Recall
91
Input Fader Group Enable G
IN Fader Group G
39
GATE Lib. Recall +1
Gate Lib+1 RCL.
92
Input Fader Group Enable H
IN Fader Group H
40
GATE Lib. Recall –1
Gate Lib–1 RCL.
93
Input MUTE Group Enable I
IN Mute Group I
41
GATE Lib. Recall No. XX
Gate LibXXX RCL.
94
Input MUTE Group Enable J
IN Mute Group J
42
COMP Lib. Recall +1
Comp Lib+1 RCL.
95
Input MUTE Group Enable K
IN Mute Group K
43
COMP Lib. Recall –1
Comp Lib–1 RCL.
96
Input MUTE Group Enable L
IN Mute Group L
44
COMP Lib. Recall No. XX
Comp LibXXX RCL.
97
Input MUTE Group Enable M
IN Mute Group M
45
EQ Lib. Recall +1
EQ Lib+1 Recall
98
Input MUTE Group Enable N
IN Mute Group N
46
EQ Lib. Recall –1
EQ Lib–1 Recall
99
Input MUTE Group Enable O
IN Mute Group O
47
EQ Lib. Recall No. XX
EQ LibXXX Recall
100 Input MUTE Group Enable P
IN Mute Group P
48
GEQ1 Lib. Recall +1
GEQ1 Lib+1 RCL.
101 Output Fader Group Enable Q
OutFader Group Q
49
GEQ1 Lib. Recall –1
GEQ1 Lib–1 RCL.
102 Output Fader Group Enable R
OutFader Group R
50
GEQ1 Lib. Recall No. XX
GEQ1 LibXXX RCL.
103 Output Fader Group Enable S
OutFader Group S
51
GEQ2 Lib. Recall +1
GEQ2 Lib+1 RCL.
104 Output Fader Group Enable T
OutFader Group T
52
GEQ2 Lib. Recall –1
GEQ2 Lib–1 RCL.
105 Output MUTE Group Enable U
Out Mute Group U
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
284
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
#
Function
106 Output MUTE Group Enable V
Display
#
Function
Display
Out Mute Group V
165 SURR. MONI SNAP TO 85dB SPL
SNAP TO SPL85
107 Output MUTE Group Enable W
Out Mute Group W
166 Bus to ST Lib. Recall +1
BUS To ST LIB+1
108 Output MUTE Group Enable X
Out Mute Group X
167 Bus to ST Lib. Recall –1
BUS To ST LIB–1
109 PEAK HOLD On/Off
Peak Hold
168 Bus to ST Lib. Recall No. XX
BUS To ST LIBXX
110 OSCILLATOR On/Off
OSC. ON/OFF
169 Input Fader Group Assign X
IN Fader Assign X
111 SOLO Enable
SOLO ENABLE
170 Input Mute Group Assign X
IN Mute Assign X
112 Input Patch Lib. Recall +1
IN Patch Lib+1
171 Input EQ Group Assign X
IN EQ Assign x
113 Input Patch Lib. Recall –1
IN Patch Lib-1
172 Input COMP Group Assign X
IN COMP Assign x
114 Input Patch Lib. Recall No. XX
IN Patch LibXX
173 Output Fader Group Assign X
OutFader Assign X
115 Output Patch Lib. Recall +1
Out Patch Lib+1
174 Output Mute Group Assign X
Out Mute Assign X
116 Output Patch Lib. Recall –1
Out Patch Lib-1
175 Output EQ Group Assign X
Out EQ Assign x
117 Output Patch Lib. Recall No. XX
Out Patch LibXX
176 Output COMP Group Assign X
Out COMP Assign x
118 Channel Name ID/Short
CH Name ID/Short
177 Input Mute Group Master X
In Mute Master X
119 Port Name ID/Short
PortNameID/Short
178 Output MUTE Group Master X
Out Mute Master X
120 Automix REC
Automix REC
179 Automix UPDATE TO END
Amx UPDATE TO END
121 Automix PLAY
Automix PLAY
180 AUX/SOLO LINK Mode On/Off
AUX/SOLO LINK
122 Automix STOP
Automix STOP
181 FADER/SOLO RELEASE Mode On/Off
FaderSoloRELEASE
123 Automix ABORT
Automix ABORT
182 Talkback Assign SLOT1
Talkback SLOT1-XX
124 Automix AUTO REC
Automix AUTOREC
183 Talkback Assign SLOT2
Talkback SLOT2-XX
125 Automix ENABLE
Automix ENABLE
184 Talkback Assign SLOT3
Talkback SLOT3-XX
126 Automix RETURN
Automix RETURN
185 Talkback Assign SLOT4
Talkback SLOT4-XX
127 Automix TAKEOVER
Automix TAKEOVER
186 Talkback Assign SLOT5
Talkback SLOT5-XX
128 Automix RELATIVE
Automix RELATIVE
187 Talkback Assign SLOT6
Talkback SLOT6-XX
129 Automix TOUCH SENSE
Automix T.SENSE
188 Talkback Assign OMNI OUT
Talkback OMNI-XX
130 Overwrite FADER
Overwrite FADER
189 Talkback Studio Monitor Out On/Off
Talkback S.Moni
131 Overwrite ON
Overwrite ON
190 FL DISPLAY Channel/Port
FL DISP CH/Port
132 Overwrite PAN
Overwrite PAN
191 User Defined Keys BANK +1
UDEF KEYS BANK+1
133 Overwrite SURROUND
Overwrite SURR.
192 User Defined Keys BANK –1
UDEF KEYS BANK–1
134 Overwrite EQ
Overwrite EQ
193 User Defined Keys BANK X
UDEF KEYS BANK X
135 Overwrite AUX
Overwrite AUX
194 Remote User defined BANK +1
RMT UDEF BANK+1
136 Overwrite AUX ON
Overwrite AUX ON
195 Remote User defined BANK –1
RMT UDEF BANK–1
137 Track Arming 1 ON/OFF
Track Arming 1
196 Remote User defined BANK X
RMT UDEF BANK X
138 Track Arming 2 ON/OFF
Track Arming 2
197 User Assignable Layer BANK +1
USER LAYER BANK+1
139 Track Arming 3 ON/OFF
Track Arming 3
198 User Assignable Layer BANK –1
USER LAYER BANK–1
140 Track Arming 4 ON/OFF
Track Arming 4
199 User Assignable Layer BANK x
USER LAYER BANK x
141 Track Arming 5 ON/OFF
Track Arming 5
200 MIDI NOTE No.XX
MIDI NOTE XXX
142 Track Arming 6 ON/OFF
Track Arming 6
201 MIDI Program change No.XX
MIDI PGM XXX
143 Track Arming 7 ON/OFF
Track Arming 7
202 MIDI Control Change No.XX
MIDI CC XXX
144 Track Arming 8 ON/OFF
Track Arming 8
203 Studio Manager Window Control Close SM CTRL Close
145 Track Arming 9 ON/OFF
Track Arming 9
146 Track Arming 10 ON/OFF
Track Arming 10
147 Track Arming 11 ON/OFF
Track Arming 11
148 Track Arming 12 ON/OFF
Track Arming 12
149 Track Arming 13 ON/OFF
Track Arming 13
150 Track Arming 14 ON/OFF
Track Arming 14
151 Track Arming 15 ON/OFF
Track Arming 15
152 Track Arming 16 ON/OFF
Track Arming 16
153 Track Arming 17 ON/OFF
Track Arming 17
154 Track Arming 18 ON/OFF
Track Arming 18
155 Track Arming 19 ON/OFF
Track Arming 19
156 Track Arming 20 ON/OFF
Track Arming 20
157 Track Arming 21 ON/OFF
Track Arming 21
158 Track Arming 22 ON/OFF
Track Arming 22
159 Track Arming 23 ON/OFF
Track Arming 23
Studio Manager Window Control
212
Meter
160 Track Arming 24 ON/OFF
Track Arming 24
213 Studio Manager Window Control Layer SM CTRL Layer
161 SURR Lib. Recall +1
Surr Lib+1 RCL
162 SURR Lib. Recall –1
Surr Lib–1 RCL
163 SURR Lib. Recall No.XX
Surr LibXX RCL
164 SURR. MONI MUTE Mute Bs On/Off
Surr.Mon Bs Mute
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
204
Studio Manager Window Control Close
SM CTRL Close All
All
205
Studio Manager Window Control
Selected Channel
SM CTRL Sel Ch
206
Studio Manager Window Control
Library
SM CTRL Library
207
Studio Manager Window Control Patch
SM CTRL Patch
Editor
208
Studio Manager Window Control Surround Editor
209
Studio Manager Window Control Time
SM CTRL TimeCount
Counter
210
Studio Manager Window Control Effect
SM CTRL Effect
Editor
211
Studio Manager Window Control GEQ
Editor
214
SM CTRL Surround
SM CTRL GEQ
SM CTRL Meter
Studio Manager Window Control MasSM CTRL Master
ter
USER DEFINED KEYS Initial Assignments
285
USER DEFINED KEYS Initial Assignments
No.
Bank A
(Surround
Monitor)
Bank B
(Scene
Recall)
Bank C
(Group
Enable)
Bank D
(No Assign)
Bank E
(Effect
Library)
Bank F
(Group
Assign)
Bank G
(Mute
Master)
Bank H
(Program
Change)
1
SNAP TO SPL Scene 1
85
Recall
IN Fader
Group A
No Assign
Fx 1 Lib+1
Recall
IN Fader
Assign A
IN Mute
Master I
MIDI PGM 1
2
No Assign
Scene 2
Recall
IN Fader
Group B
No Assign
Fx 2 Lib+1
Recall
IN Fader
Assign B
IN Mute
Master J
MIDI PGM 2
3
Surr Lib 0
Recall
Scene 3
Recall
IN Fader
Group C
No Assign
Fx 3 Lib+1
Recall
IN Fader
Assign C
IN Mute
Master K
MIDI PGM 3
4
Surr Lib–1
Recall
Scene 4
Recall
IN Fader
Group D
No Assign
Fx 4 Lib+1
Recall
IN Fader
Assign D
IN Mute
Master L
MIDI PGM 4
5
Surr Lib+1
Recall
Scene 5
Recall
IN Fader
Group E
No Assign
Fx 5 Lib+1
Recall
IN Fader
Assign E
IN Mute
Master M
MIDI PGM 5
6
Surr Mon L
Mute
Scene 6
Recall
IN Fader
Group F
No Assign
Fx 6 Lib+1
Recall
IN Fader
Assign F
IN Mute
Master N
MIDI PGM 6
7
Surr Mon C
Mute
Scene 7
Recall
IN Fader
Group G
No Assign
Fx 7 Lib+1
Recall
IN Fader
Assign G
IN Mute
Master O
MIDI PGM 7
8
Surr Mon R
Mute
Scene +1
Recall
IN Fader
Group H
No Assign
Fx 8 Lib+1
Recall
IN Fader
Assign H
IN Mute
Master P
MIDI PGM 8
9
Bass Manage ON
Scene 8
Recall
IN Mute
Group I
No Assign
Fx 1 Lib–1
Recall
IN Mute
Assign I
OUT Mute
Master U
MIDI PGM 9
10
No Assign
Scene 9
Recall
IN Mute
Group J
No Assign
Fx 2 Lib–1
Recall
IN Mute
Assign J
OUT Mute
Master V
MIDI PGM
10
11
No Assign
Scene 10
Recall
IN Mute
Group K
No Assign
Fx 3 Lib–1
Recall
IN Mute
Assign K
OUT Mute
Master W
MIDI PGM
11
12
No Assign
Scene 11
Recall
IN Mute
Group L
No Assign
Fx 4 Lib–1
Recall
IN Mute
Assign L
OUT Mute
Master X
MIDI PGM
12
13
Surr.Mon
LFEMute
Scene 12
Recall
IN Mute
Group M
No Assign
Fx 5 Lib–1
Recall
IN Mute
Assign M
No Assign
MIDI PGM
13
14
Surr.Mon Ls
Mute
Scene 13
Recall
IN Mute
Group N
No Assign
Fx 6 Lib–1
Recall
IN Mute
Assign N
No Assign
MIDI PGM
14
15
Surr.Mon Bs
Mute
Scene 14
Recall
IN Mute
Group O
No Assign
Fx 7 Lib–1
Recall
IN Mute
Assign O
No Assign
MIDI PGM
15
16
Surr.Mon Rs
Mute
Scene –1
Recall
IN Mute
Group P
No Assign
Fx 8 Lib–1
Recall
IN Mute
Assign P
No Assign
MIDI PGM
16
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
286
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Input Patch Parameters
input Channel Inputs
Port ID
Input Channel insert Ins
Description
Port ID
Internal Effects Processor Inputs
Description
Port ID
Description
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
AD1
AD IN 1
AD1
AD IN 1
AUX1
AUX1
AD2
AD IN 2
AD2
AD IN 2
AUX2
AUX2
AD3
AD IN 3
AD3
AD IN 3
AUX3
AUX3
AD4
AD IN 4
AD4
AD IN 4
AUX4
AUX4
AD5
AD IN 5
AD5
AD IN 5
AUX5
AUX5
AD6
AD IN 6
AD6
AD IN 6
AUX6
AUX6
AD7
AD IN 7
AD7
AD IN 7
AUX7
AUX7
AD8
AD IN 8
AD8
AD IN 8
AUX8
AUX8
AD9
AD IN 9
AD9
AD IN 9
AUX9
AUX9
AD10
AD IN 10
AD10
AD IN 10
AUX10
AUX10
AD11
AD IN 11
AD11
AD IN 11
AUX11
AUX11
AD12
AD IN 12
AD12
AD IN 12
AUX12
AUX12
AD13
AD IN 13
AD13
AD IN 13
INSCH1
InsertOut-CH1
AD14
AD IN 14
AD14
AD IN 14
INSCH2
InsertOut-CH2
AD15
AD IN 15
AD15
AD IN 15
INSCH3
InsertOut-CH3
AD16
AD IN 16
AD16
AD IN 16
INSCH4
InsertOut-CH4
AD17
AD IN 17
AD17
AD IN 17
INSCH5
InsertOut-CH5
AD18
AD IN 18
AD18
AD IN 18
INSCH6
InsertOut-CH6
AD19
AD IN 19
AD19
AD IN 19
INSCH7
InsertOut-CH7
AD20
AD IN 20
AD20
AD IN 20
INSCH8
InsertOut-CH8
AD21
AD IN 21
AD21
AD IN 21
INSCH9
InsertOut-CH9
AD22
AD IN 22
AD22
AD IN 22
INSCH10
InsertOut-CH10
AD23
AD IN 23
AD23
AD IN 23
INSCH11
InsertOut-CH11
AD24
AD IN 24
AD24
AD IN 24
INSCH12
InsertOut-CH12
S1-1
Slot1 CH1 IN
S1-1
Slot1 CH1 IN
INSCH13
InsertOut-CH13
S1-2
Slot1 CH2 IN
S1-2
Slot1 CH2 IN
INSCH14
InsertOut-CH14
S1-3
Slot1 CH3 IN
S1-3
Slot1 CH3 IN
INSCH15
InsertOut-CH15
S1-4
Slot1 CH4 IN
S1-4
Slot1 CH4 IN
INSCH16
InsertOut-CH16
S1-5
Slot1 CH5 IN
S1-5
Slot1 CH5 IN
INSCH17
InsertOut-CH17
S1-6
Slot1 CH6 IN
S1-6
Slot1 CH6 IN
INSCH18
InsertOut-CH18
S1-7
Slot1 CH7 IN
S1-7
Slot1 CH7 IN
INSCH19
InsertOut-CH19
S1-8
Slot1 CH8 IN
S1-8
Slot1 CH8 IN
INSCH20
InsertOut-CH20
S1-9
Slot1 CH9 IN
S1-9
Slot1 CH9 IN
INSCH21
InsertOut-CH21
S1-10
Slot1 CH10 IN
S1-10
Slot1 CH10 IN
INSCH22
InsertOut-CH22
S1-11
Slot1 CH11 IN
S1-11
Slot1 CH11 IN
INSCH23
InsertOut-CH23
S1-12
Slot1 CH12 IN
S1-12
Slot1 CH12 IN
INSCH24
InsertOut-CH24
S1-13
Slot1 CH13 IN
S1-13
Slot1 CH13 IN
INSCH25
InsertOut-CH25
S1-14
Slot1 CH14 IN
S1-14
Slot1 CH14 IN
INSCH26
InsertOut-CH26
S1-15
Slot1 CH15 IN
S1-15
Slot1 CH15 IN
INSCH27
InsertOut-CH27
S1-16
Slot1 CH16 IN
S1-16
Slot1 CH16 IN
INSCH28
InsertOut-CH28
S2-1
Slot2 CH1 IN
S2-1
Slot2 CH1 IN
INSCH29
InsertOut-CH29
S2-2
Slot2 CH2 IN
S2-2
Slot2 CH2 IN
INSCH30
InsertOut-CH30
S2-3
Slot2 CH3 IN
S2-3
Slot2 CH3 IN
INSCH31
InsertOut-CH31
S2-4
Slot2 CH4 IN
S2-4
Slot2 CH4 IN
INSCH32
InsertOut-CH32
S2-5
Slot2 CH5 IN
S2-5
Slot2 CH5 IN
INSCH33
InsertOut-CH33
S2-6
Slot2 CH6 IN
S2-6
Slot2 CH6 IN
INSCH34
InsertOut-CH34
S2-7
Slot2 CH7 IN
S2-7
Slot2 CH7 IN
INSCH35
InsertOut-CH35
S2-8
Slot2 CH8 IN
S2-8
Slot2 CH8 IN
INSCH36
InsertOut-CH36
S2-9
Slot2 CH9 IN
S2-9
Slot2 CH9 IN
INSCH37
InsertOut-CH37
S2-10
Slot2 CH10 IN
S2-10
Slot2 CH10 IN
INSCH38
InsertOut-CH38
S2-11
Slot2 CH11 IN
S2-11
Slot2 CH11 IN
INSCH39
InsertOut-CH39
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Input Patch Parameters
input Channel Inputs
Port ID
Input Channel insert Ins
Description
Port ID
Description
287
Internal Effects Processor Inputs
Port ID
Description
S2-12
Slot2 CH12 IN
S2-12
Slot2 CH12 IN
INSCH40
InsertOut-CH40
S2-13
Slot2 CH13 IN
S2-13
Slot2 CH13 IN
INSCH41
InsertOut-CH41
S2-14
Slot2 CH14 IN
S2-14
Slot2 CH14 IN
INSCH42
InsertOut-CH42
S2-15
Slot2 CH15 IN
S2-15
Slot2 CH15 IN
INSCH43
InsertOut-CH43
S2-16
Slot2 CH16 IN
S2-16
Slot2 CH16 IN
INSCH44
InsertOut-CH44
S3-1
Slot3 CH1 IN
S3-1
Slot3 CH1 IN
INSCH45
InsertOut-CH45
S3-2
Slot3 CH2 IN
S3-2
Slot3 CH2 IN
INSCH46
InsertOut-CH46
S3-3
Slot3 CH3 IN
S3-3
Slot3 CH3 IN
INSCH47
InsertOut-CH47
S3-4
Slot3 CH4 IN
S3-4
Slot3 CH4 IN
INSCH48
InsertOut-CH48
S3-5
Slot3 CH5 IN
S3-5
Slot3 CH5 IN
INSCH49
InsertOut-CH49
S3-6
Slot3 CH6 IN
S3-6
Slot3 CH6 IN
INSCH50
InsertOut-CH50
S3-7
Slot3 CH7 IN
S3-7
Slot3 CH7 IN
INSCH51
InsertOut-CH51
S3-8
Slot3 CH8 IN
S3-8
Slot3 CH8 IN
INSCH52
InsertOut-CH52
S3-9
Slot3 CH9 IN
S3-9
Slot3 CH9 IN
INSCH53
InsertOut-CH53
S3-10
Slot3 CH10 IN
S3-10
Slot3 CH10 IN
INSCH54
InsertOut-CH54
S3-11
Slot3 CH11 IN
S3-11
Slot3 CH11 IN
INSCH55
InsertOut-CH55
S3-12
Slot3 CH12 IN
S3-12
Slot3 CH12 IN
INSCH56
InsertOut-CH56
S3-13
Slot3 CH13 IN
S3-13
Slot3 CH13 IN
INSCH57
InsertOut-CH57
S3-14
Slot3 CH14 IN
S3-14
Slot3 CH14 IN
INSCH58
InsertOut-CH58
S3-15
Slot3 CH15 IN
S3-15
Slot3 CH15 IN
INSCH59
InsertOut-CH59
S3-16
Slot3 CH16 IN
S3-16
Slot3 CH16 IN
INSCH60
InsertOut-CH60
S4-1
Slot4 CH1 IN
S4-1
Slot4 CH1 IN
INSCH61
InsertOut-CH61
S4-2
Slot4 CH2 IN
S4-2
Slot4 CH2 IN
INSCH62
InsertOut-CH62
S4-3
Slot4 CH3 IN
S4-3
Slot4 CH3 IN
INSCH63
InsertOut-CH63
S4-4
Slot4 CH4 IN
S4-4
Slot4 CH4 IN
INSCH64
InsertOut-CH64
S4-5
Slot4 CH5 IN
S4-5
Slot4 CH5 IN
INSCH65
InsertOut-CH65
S4-6
Slot4 CH6 IN
S4-6
Slot4 CH6 IN
INSCH66
InsertOut-CH66
S4-7
Slot4 CH7 IN
S4-7
Slot4 CH7 IN
INSCH67
InsertOut-CH67
S4-8
Slot4 CH8 IN
S4-8
Slot4 CH8 IN
INSCH68
InsertOut-CH68
S4-9
Slot4 CH9 IN
S4-9
Slot4 CH9 IN
INSCH69
InsertOut-CH69
S4-10
Slot4 CH10 IN
S4-10
Slot4 CH10 IN
INSCH70
InsertOut-CH70
S4-11
Slot4 CH11 IN
S4-11
Slot4 CH11 IN
INSCH71
InsertOut-CH71
S4-12
Slot4 CH12 IN
S4-12
Slot4 CH12 IN
INSCH72
InsertOut-CH72
S4-13
Slot4 CH13 IN
S4-13
Slot4 CH13 IN
INSCH73
InsertOut-CH73
S4-14
Slot4 CH14 IN
S4-14
Slot4 CH14 IN
INSCH74
InsertOut-CH74
S4-15
Slot4 CH15 IN
S4-15
Slot4 CH15 IN
INSCH75
InsertOut-CH75
S4-16
Slot4 CH16 IN
S4-16
Slot4 CH16 IN
INSCH76
InsertOut-CH76
S5-1
Slot5 CH1 IN
S5-1
Slot5 CH1 IN
INSCH77
InsertOut-CH77
S5-2
Slot5 CH2 IN
S5-2
Slot5 CH2 IN
INSCH78
InsertOut-CH78
S5-3
Slot5 CH3 IN
S5-3
Slot5 CH3 IN
INSCH79
InsertOut-CH79
S5-4
Slot5 CH4 IN
S5-4
Slot5 CH4 IN
INSCH80
InsertOut-CH80
S5-5
Slot5 CH5 IN
S5-5
Slot5 CH5 IN
INSCH81
InsertOut-CH81
S5-6
Slot5 CH6 IN
S5-6
Slot5 CH6 IN
INSCH82
InsertOut-CH82
S5-7
Slot5 CH7 IN
S5-7
Slot5 CH7 IN
INSCH83
InsertOut-CH83
S5-8
Slot5 CH8 IN
S5-8
Slot5 CH8 IN
INSCH84
InsertOut-CH84
S5-9
Slot5 CH9 IN
S5-9
Slot5 CH9 IN
INSCH85
InsertOut-CH85
S5-10
Slot5 CH10 IN
S5-10
Slot5 CH10 IN
INSCH86
InsertOut-CH86
S5-11
Slot5 CH11 IN
S5-11
Slot5 CH11 IN
INSCH87
InsertOut-CH87
S5-12
Slot5 CH12 IN
S5-12
Slot5 CH12 IN
INSCH88
InsertOut-CH88
S5-13
Slot5 CH13 IN
S5-13
Slot5 CH13 IN
INSCH89
InsertOut-CH89
S5-14
Slot5 CH14 IN
S5-14
Slot5 CH14 IN
INSCH90
InsertOut-CH90
S5-15
Slot5 CH15 IN
S5-15
Slot5 CH15 IN
INSCH91
InsertOut-CH91
S5-16
Slot5 CH16 IN
S5-16
Slot5 CH16 IN
INSCH92
InsertOut-CH92
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
288
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
input Channel Inputs
Port ID
Input Channel insert Ins
Description
Port ID
Description
Internal Effects Processor Inputs
Port ID
Description
S6-1
Slot6 CH1 IN
S6-1
Slot6 CH1 IN
INSCH93
InsertOut-CH93
S6-2
Slot6 CH2 IN
S6-2
Slot6 CH2 IN
INSCH94
InsertOut-CH94
S6-3
Slot6 CH3 IN
S6-3
Slot6 CH3 IN
INSCH95
InsertOut-CH95
S6-4
Slot6 CH4 IN
S6-4
Slot6 CH4 IN
INSCH96
InsertOut-CH96
S6-5
Slot6 CH5 IN
S6-5
Slot6 CH5 IN
INSBUS1
InsertOut-BUS1
S6-6
Slot6 CH6 IN
S6-6
Slot6 CH6 IN
INSBUS2
InsertOut-BUS2
S6-7
Slot6 CH7 IN
S6-7
Slot6 CH7 IN
INSBUS3
InsertOut-BUS3
S6-8
Slot6 CH8 IN
S6-8
Slot6 CH8 IN
INSBUS4
InsertOut-BUS4
S6-9
Slot6 CH9 IN
S6-9
Slot6 CH9 IN
INSBUS5
InsertOut-BUS5
S6-10
Slot6 CH10 IN
S6-10
Slot6 CH10 IN
INSBUS6
InsertOut-BUS6
S6-11
Slot6 CH11 IN
S6-11
Slot6 CH11 IN
INSBUS7
InsertOut-BUS7
S6-12
Slot6 CH12 IN
S6-12
Slot6 CH12 IN
INSBUS8
InsertOut-BUS8
S6-13
Slot6 CH13 IN
S6-13
Slot6 CH13 IN
INSAUX1
InsertOut-AUX1
S6-14
Slot6 CH14 IN
S6-14
Slot6 CH14 IN
INSAUX2
InsertOut-AUX2
S6-15
Slot6 CH15 IN
S6-15
Slot6 CH15 IN
INSAUX3
InsertOut-AUX3
S6-16
Slot6 CH16 IN
S6-16
Slot6 CH16 IN
INSAUX4
InsertOut-AUX4
FX1-1
Effect1 OUT 1
FX1-1
Effect1 OUT 1
INSAUX5
InsertOut-AUX5
FX1-2
Effect1 OUT 2
FX1-2
Effect1 OUT 2
INSAUX6
InsertOut-AUX6
FX1-3
Effect1 OUT 3
FX1-3
Effect1 OUT 3
INSAUX7
InsertOut-AUX7
FX1-4
Effect1 OUT 4
FX1-4
Effect1 OUT 4
INSAUX8
InsertOut-AUX8
FX1-5
Effect1 OUT 5
FX1-5
Effect1 OUT 5
INSAUX9
InsertOut-AUX9
FX1-6
Effect1 OUT 6
FX1-6
Effect1 OUT 6
INSAUX10
InsertOut-AUX10
FX1-7
Effect1 OUT 7
FX1-7
Effect1 OUT 7
INSAUX11
InsertOut-AUX11
FX1-8
Effect1 OUT 8
FX1-8
Effect1 OUT 8
INSAUX12
InsertOut-AUX12
FX2-1
Effect2 OUT 1
FX2-1
Effect2 OUT 1
INSMTX1L
InsertOut-MTX1L
FX2-2
Effect2 OUT 2
FX2-2
Effect2 OUT 2
INSMTX1R
InsertOut-MTX1R
FX2-3
Effect2 OUT 3
FX2-3
Effect2 OUT 3
INSMTX2L
InsertOut-MTX2L
FX2-4
Effect2 OUT 4
FX2-4
Effect2 OUT 4
INSMTX2R
InsertOut-MTX2R
FX2-5
Effect2 OUT 5
FX2-5
Effect2 OUT 5
INSMTX3L
InsertOut-MTX3L
FX2-6
Effect2 OUT 6
FX2-6
Effect2 OUT 6
INSMTX3R
InsertOut-MTX3R
FX2-7
Effect2 OUT 7
FX2-7
Effect2 OUT 7
INSMTX4L
InsertOut-MTX4L
FX2-8
Effect2 OUT 8
FX2-8
Effect2 OUT 8
INSMTX4R
InsertOut-MTX4R
FX3-1
Effect3 OUT 1
FX3-1
Effect3 OUT 1
INSSTL
InsertOut-STL
FX3-2
Effect3 OUT 2
FX3-2
Effect3 OUT 2
INSSTR
InsertOut-STR
FX4-1
Effect4 OUT 1
FX4-1
Effect4 OUT 1
FX1-1
Effect1 OUT 1
FX4-2
Effect4 OUT 2
FX4-2
Effect4 OUT 2
FX1-2
Effect1 OUT 2
FX5-1
Effect5 OUT 1
FX5-1
Effect5 OUT 1
FX2-1
Effect2 OUT 1
FX5-2
Effect5 OUT 2
FX5-2
Effect5 OUT 2
FX2-2
Effect2 OUT 2
FX6-1
Effect6 OUT 1
FX6-1
Effect6 OUT 1
FX3-1
Effect3 OUT 1
FX6-2
Effect6 OUT 2
FX6-2
Effect6 OUT 2
FX3-2
Effect3 OUT 2
FX7-1
Effect7 OUT 1
FX7-1
Effect7 OUT 1
FX4-1
Effect4 OUT 1
FX7-2
Effect7 OUT 2
FX7-2
Effect7 OUT 2
FX4-2
Effect4 OUT 2
FX8-1
Effect8 OUT 1
FX8-1
Effect8 OUT 1
FX5-1
Effect5 OUT 1
FX8-2
Effect8 OUT 2
FX8-2
Effect8 OUT 2
FX5-2
Effect5 OUT 2
2TD1L
2TR IN Dig.1 L
2TD1L
2TR IN Dig.1 L
FX6-1
Effect6 OUT 1
2TD1R
2TR IN Dig.1 R
2TD1R
2TR IN Dig.1 R
FX6-2
Effect6 OUT 2
2TD2L
2TR IN Dig.2 L
2TD2L
2TR IN Dig.2 L
FX7-1
Effect7 OUT 1
2TD2R
2TR IN Dig.2 R
2TD2R
2TR IN Dig.2 R
FX7-2
Effect7 OUT 2
2TD3L
2TR IN Dig.3 L
2TD3L
2TR IN Dig.3 L
FX8-1
Effect8 OUT 1
2TD3R
2TR IN Dig.3 R
2TD3R
2TR IN Dig.3 R
FX8-2
2TA1L
2TR IN Analog1 L
2TA1L
2TR IN Analog1 L
—
—
2TA1R
2TR IN Analog1 R
2TA1R
2TR IN Analog1 R
—
—
2TA2L
2TR IN Analog2 L
2TA2L
2TR IN Analog2 L
—
—
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Effect8 OUT 2
289
Initial Input Patch Settings
input Channel Inputs
Port ID
Input Channel insert Ins
Description
Port ID
2TA2R
Internal Effects Processor Inputs
Description
2TR IN Analog2 R
Port ID
Description
2TA2R
2TR IN Analog2 R
—
—
BUS1
BUS1
—
—
—
—
BUS2
BUS2
—
—
—
—
BUS3
BUS3
—
—
—
—
BUS4
BUS4
—
—
—
—
BUS5
BUS5
—
—
—
—
BUS6
BUS6
—
—
—
—
BUS7
BUS7
—
—
—
—
BUS8
BUS8
—
—
—
—
AUX1
AUX1
—
—
—
—
AUX2
AUX2
—
—
—
—
AUX3
AUX3
—
—
—
—
AUX4
AUX4
—
—
—
—
AUX5
AUX5
—
—
—
—
AUX6
AUX6
—
—
—
—
AUX7
AUX7
—
—
—
—
AUX8
AUX8
—
—
—
—
AUX9
AUX9
—
—
—
—
AUX10
AUX10
—
—
—
—
AUX11
AUX11
—
—
—
—
AUX12
AUX12
—
—
—
—
Initial Input Patch Settings
Input Channel Inputs
Effects Processors inputs
Ch # Source Ch # Source Ch # Source Ch # Source
#
Source
#
Source
1
AD01
25
S1-01
49
S4-01
73
FX1-1
1-1
AUX1
2-7
NONE
2
AD02
26
S1-02
50
S4-02
74
FX1-2
1-2
NONE
2-8
NONE
3
AD03
27
S1-03
51
S4-03
75
FX2-1
1-3
NONE
3-1
AUX3
4
AD04
28
S1-04
52
S4-04
76
FX2-2
1-4
NONE
3-2
NONE
5
AD05
29
S1-05
53
S4-05
77
FX3-1
1-5
NONE
4-1
AUX4
6
AD06
30
S1-06
54
S4-06
78
FX3-2
1-6
NONE
4-2
NONE
7
AD07
31
S1-07
55
S4-07
79
FX4-1
1-7
NONE
5-1
AUX5
8
AD08
32
S1-08
56
S4-08
80
FX4-2
1-8
NONE
5-2
NONE
9
AD09
33
S2-01
57
S5-01
81
FX5-1
2-1
AUX2
6-1
AUX6
10
AD10
34
S2-02
58
S5-02
82
FX5-2
2-2
NONE
6-2
NONE
11
AD11
35
S2-03
59
S5-03
83
FX6-1
2-3
NONE
7-1
AUX7
12
AD12
36
S2-04
60
S5-04
84
FX6-2
2-4
NONE
7-2
NONE
13
AD13
37
S2-05
61
S5-05
85
FX7-1
2-5
NONE
8-1
AUX8
14
AD14
38
S2-06
62
S5-06
86
FX7-2
2-6
NONE
8-2
NONE
15
AD15
39
S2-07
63
S5-07
87
FX8-1
16
AD16
40
S2-08
64
S5-08
88
FX8-2
17
AD17
41
S3-01
65
S6-01
89
2TD1L
18
AD18
42
S3-02
66
S6-02
90
2TD1R
19
AD19
43
S3-03
67
S6-03
91
2TD2L
20
AD20
44
S3-04
68
S6-04
92
2TD2R
21
AD21
45
S3-05
69
S6-05
93
2TA1L
22
AD22
46
S3-06
70
S6-06
94
2TA1R
23
AD23
47
S3-07
71
S6-07
95
2TA2L
24
AD24
48
S3-08
72
S6-08
96
2TA2R
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
290
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Output Patch Parameters
Output patch parameters are split into two tables. The first table contains parameters for
the Slot Outputs, Omni Outs, and Output Channel Insert Ins. The second table, Direct
Outs, 2TR Digital Outputs, and the GEQs.
Output Patch Table 1
Slot Outputs
Source
Description
Omni Outs
Source
Description
Output Channel Insert Ins
Source
Description
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
BUS1
BUS1
BUS1
BUS1
AD1
AD IN 1
BUS2
BUS2
BUS2
BUS2
AD2
AD IN 2
BUS3
BUS3
BUS3
BUS3
AD3
AD IN 3
BUS4
BUS4
BUS4
BUS4
AD4
AD IN 4
BUS5
BUS5
BUS5
BUS5
AD5
AD IN 5
BUS6
BUS6
BUS6
BUS6
AD6
AD IN 6
BUS7
BUS7
BUS7
BUS7
AD7
AD IN 7
BUS8
BUS8
BUS8
BUS8
AD8
AD IN 8
AUX1
AUX1
AUX1
AUX1
AD9
AD IN 9
AUX2
AUX2
AUX2
AUX2
AD10
AD IN 10
AUX3
AUX3
AUX3
AUX3
AD11
AD IN 11
AUX4
AUX4
AUX4
AUX4
AD12
AD IN 12
AUX5
AUX5
AUX5
AUX5
AD13
AD IN 13
AUX6
AUX6
AUX6
AUX6
AD14
AD IN 14
AUX7
AUX7
AUX7
AUX7
AD15
AD IN 15
AUX8
AUX8
AUX8
AUX8
AD16
AD IN 16
AUX9
AUX9
AUX9
AUX9
AD17
AD IN 17
AUX10
AUX10
AUX10
AUX10
AD18
AD IN 18
AUX11
AUX11
AUX11
AUX11
AD19
AD IN 19
AUX12
AUX12
AUX12
AUX12
AD20
AD IN 20
MATRIX1L
MATRIX1 L
MATRIX1L
MATRIX1 L
AD21
AD IN 21
MATRIX1R
MATRIX1 R
MATRIX1R
MATRIX1 R
AD22
AD IN 22
MATRIX2L
MATRIX2 L
MATRIX2L
MATRIX2 L
AD23
AD IN 23
MATRIX2R
MATRIX2 R
MATRIX2R
MATRIX2 R
AD24
AD IN 24
MATRIX3L
MATRIX3 L
MATRIX3L
MATRIX3 L
S1-1
Slot1 CH1 IN
MATRIX3R
MATRIX3 R
MATRIX3R
MATRIX3 R
S1-2
Slot1 CH2 IN
MATRIX4L
MATRIX4 L
MATRIX4L
MATRIX4 L
S1-3
Slot1 CH3 IN
MATRIX4R
MATRIX4 R
MATRIX4R
MATRIX4 R
S1-4
Slot1 CH4 IN
STEREO-L
STEREO L
STEREO-L
STEREO L
S1-5
Slot1 CH5 IN
STEREO-R
STEREO R
STEREO-R
STEREO R
S1-6
Slot1 CH6 IN
INSCH1
InsertOut-CH1
INSCH1
InsertOut-CH1
S1-7
Slot1 CH7 IN
INSCH2
InsertOut-CH2
INSCH2
InsertOut-CH2
S1-8
Slot1 CH8 IN
INSCH3
InsertOut-CH3
INSCH3
InsertOut-CH3
S1-9
Slot1 CH9 IN
INSCH4
InsertOut-CH4
INSCH4
InsertOut-CH4
S1-10
Slot1 CH10 IN
INSCH5
InsertOut-CH5
INSCH5
InsertOut-CH5
S1-11
Slot1 CH11 IN
INSCH6
InsertOut-CH6
INSCH6
InsertOut-CH6
S1-12
Slot1 CH12 IN
INSCH7
InsertOut-CH7
INSCH7
InsertOut-CH7
S1-13
Slot1 CH13 IN
INSCH8
InsertOut-CH8
INSCH8
InsertOut-CH8
S1-14
Slot1 CH14 IN
INSCH9
InsertOut-CH9
INSCH9
InsertOut-CH9
S1-15
Slot1 CH15 IN
INSCH10
InsertOut-CH10
INSCH10
InsertOut-CH10
S1-16
Slot1 CH16 IN
INSCH11
InsertOut-CH11
INSCH11
InsertOut-CH11
S2-1
Slot2 CH1 IN
INSCH12
InsertOut-CH12
INSCH12
InsertOut-CH12
S2-2
Slot2 CH2 IN
INSCH13
InsertOut-CH13
INSCH13
InsertOut-CH13
S2-3
Slot2 CH3 IN
INSCH14
InsertOut-CH14
INSCH14
InsertOut-CH14
S2-4
Slot2 CH4 IN
INSCH15
InsertOut-CH15
INSCH15
InsertOut-CH15
S2-5
Slot2 CH5 IN
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Output Patch Parameters
Slot Outputs
Source
Description
Omni Outs
Source
Description
291
Output Channel Insert Ins
Source
Description
INSCH16
InsertOut-CH16
INSCH16
InsertOut-CH16
S2-6
Slot2 CH6 IN
INSCH17
InsertOut-CH17
INSCH17
InsertOut-CH17
S2-7
Slot2 CH7 IN
INSCH18
InsertOut-CH18
INSCH18
InsertOut-CH18
S2-8
Slot2 CH8 IN
INSCH19
InsertOut-CH19
INSCH19
InsertOut-CH19
S2-9
Slot2 CH9 IN
INSCH20
InsertOut-CH20
INSCH20
InsertOut-CH20
S2-10
Slot2 CH10 IN
INSCH21
InsertOut-CH21
INSCH21
InsertOut-CH21
S2-11
Slot2 CH11 IN
INSCH22
InsertOut-CH22
INSCH22
InsertOut-CH22
S2-12
Slot2 CH12 IN
INSCH23
InsertOut-CH23
INSCH23
InsertOut-CH23
S2-13
Slot2 CH13 IN
INSCH24
InsertOut-CH24
INSCH24
InsertOut-CH24
S2-14
Slot2 CH14 IN
INSCH25
InsertOut-CH25
INSCH25
InsertOut-CH25
S2-15
Slot2 CH15 IN
INSCH26
InsertOut-CH26
INSCH26
InsertOut-CH26
S2-16
Slot2 CH16 IN
INSCH27
InsertOut-CH27
INSCH27
InsertOut-CH27
S3-1
Slot3 CH1 IN
INSCH28
InsertOut-CH28
INSCH28
InsertOut-CH28
S3-2
Slot3 CH2 IN
INSCH29
InsertOut-CH29
INSCH29
InsertOut-CH29
S3-3
Slot3 CH3 IN
INSCH30
InsertOut-CH30
INSCH30
InsertOut-CH30
S3-4
Slot3 CH4 IN
INSCH31
InsertOut-CH31
INSCH31
InsertOut-CH31
S3-5
Slot3 CH5 IN
INSCH32
InsertOut-CH32
INSCH32
InsertOut-CH32
S3-6
Slot3 CH6 IN
INSCH33
InsertOut-CH33
INSCH33
InsertOut-CH33
S3-7
Slot3 CH7 IN
INSCH34
InsertOut-CH34
INSCH34
InsertOut-CH34
S3-8
Slot3 CH8 IN
INSCH35
InsertOut-CH35
INSCH35
InsertOut-CH35
S3-9
Slot3 CH9 IN
INSCH36
InsertOut-CH36
INSCH36
InsertOut-CH36
S3-10
Slot3 CH10 IN
INSCH37
InsertOut-CH37
INSCH37
InsertOut-CH37
S3-11
Slot3 CH11 IN
INSCH38
InsertOut-CH38
INSCH38
InsertOut-CH38
S3-12
Slot3 CH12 IN
INSCH39
InsertOut-CH39
INSCH39
InsertOut-CH39
S3-13
Slot3 CH13 IN
INSCH40
InsertOut-CH40
INSCH40
InsertOut-CH40
S3-14
Slot3 CH14 IN
INSCH41
InsertOut-CH41
INSCH41
InsertOut-CH41
S3-15
Slot3 CH15 IN
INSCH42
InsertOut-CH42
INSCH42
InsertOut-CH42
S3-16
Slot3 CH16 IN
INSCH43
InsertOut-CH43
INSCH43
InsertOut-CH43
S4-1
Slot4 CH1 IN
INSCH44
InsertOut-CH44
INSCH44
InsertOut-CH44
S4-2
Slot4 CH2 IN
INSCH45
InsertOut-CH45
INSCH45
InsertOut-CH45
S4-3
Slot4 CH3 IN
INSCH46
InsertOut-CH46
INSCH46
InsertOut-CH46
S4-4
Slot4 CH4 IN
INSCH47
InsertOut-CH47
INSCH47
InsertOut-CH47
S4-5
Slot4 CH5 IN
INSCH48
InsertOut-CH48
INSCH48
InsertOut-CH48
S4-6
Slot4 CH6 IN
INSCH49
InsertOut-CH49
INSCH49
InsertOut-CH49
S4-7
Slot4 CH7 IN
INSCH50
InsertOut-CH50
INSCH50
InsertOut-CH50
S4-8
Slot4 CH8 IN
INSCH51
InsertOut-CH51
INSCH51
InsertOut-CH51
S4-9
Slot4 CH9 IN
INSCH52
InsertOut-CH52
INSCH52
InsertOut-CH52
S4-10
Slot4 CH10 IN
INSCH53
InsertOut-CH53
INSCH53
InsertOut-CH53
S4-11
Slot4 CH11 IN
INSCH54
InsertOut-CH54
INSCH54
InsertOut-CH54
S4-12
Slot4 CH12 IN
INSCH55
InsertOut-CH55
INSCH55
InsertOut-CH55
S4-13
Slot4 CH13 IN
INSCH56
InsertOut-CH56
INSCH56
InsertOut-CH56
S4-14
Slot4 CH14 IN
INSCH57
InsertOut-CH57
INSCH57
InsertOut-CH57
S4-15
Slot4 CH15 IN
INSCH58
InsertOut-CH58
INSCH58
InsertOut-CH58
S4-16
Slot4 CH16 IN
INSCH59
InsertOut-CH59
INSCH59
InsertOut-CH59
S5-1
Slot5 CH1 IN
INSCH60
InsertOut-CH60
INSCH60
InsertOut-CH60
S5-2
Slot5 CH2 IN
INSCH61
InsertOut-CH61
INSCH61
InsertOut-CH61
S5-3
Slot5 CH3 IN
INSCH62
InsertOut-CH62
INSCH62
InsertOut-CH62
S5-4
Slot5 CH4 IN
INSCH63
InsertOut-CH63
INSCH63
InsertOut-CH63
S5-5
Slot5 CH5 IN
INSCH64
InsertOut-CH64
INSCH64
InsertOut-CH64
S5-6
Slot5 CH6 IN
INSCH65
InsertOut-CH65
INSCH65
InsertOut-CH65
S5-7
Slot5 CH7 IN
INSCH66
InsertOut-CH66
INSCH66
InsertOut-CH66
S5-8
Slot5 CH8 IN
INSCH67
InsertOut-CH67
INSCH67
InsertOut-CH67
S5-9
Slot5 CH9 IN
INSCH68
InsertOut-CH68
INSCH68
InsertOut-CH68
S5-10
Slot5 CH10 IN
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
292
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Slot Outputs
Source
Description
Omni Outs
Source
Description
Output Channel Insert Ins
Source
Description
INSCH69
InsertOut-CH69
INSCH69
InsertOut-CH69
S5-11
Slot5 CH11 IN
INSCH70
InsertOut-CH70
INSCH70
InsertOut-CH70
S5-12
Slot5 CH12 IN
INSCH71
InsertOut-CH71
INSCH71
InsertOut-CH71
S5-13
Slot5 CH13 IN
INSCH72
InsertOut-CH72
INSCH72
InsertOut-CH72
S5-14
Slot5 CH14 IN
INSCH73
InsertOut-CH73
INSCH73
InsertOut-CH73
S5-15
Slot5 CH15 IN
INSCH74
InsertOut-CH74
INSCH74
InsertOut-CH74
S5-16
Slot5 CH16 IN
INSCH75
InsertOut-CH75
INSCH75
InsertOut-CH75
S6-1
Slot6 CH1 IN
INSCH76
InsertOut-CH76
INSCH76
InsertOut-CH76
S6-2
Slot6 CH2 IN
INSCH77
InsertOut-CH77
INSCH77
InsertOut-CH77
S6-3
Slot6 CH3 IN
INSCH78
InsertOut-CH78
INSCH78
InsertOut-CH78
S6-4
Slot6 CH4 IN
INSCH79
InsertOut-CH79
INSCH79
InsertOut-CH79
S6-5
Slot6 CH5 IN
INSCH80
InsertOut-CH80
INSCH80
InsertOut-CH80
S6-6
Slot6 CH6 IN
INSCH81
InsertOut-CH81
INSCH81
InsertOut-CH81
S6-7
Slot6 CH7 IN
INSCH82
InsertOut-CH82
INSCH82
InsertOut-CH82
S6-8
Slot6 CH8 IN
INSCH83
InsertOut-CH83
INSCH83
InsertOut-CH83
S6-9
Slot6 CH9 IN
INSCH84
InsertOut-CH84
INSCH84
InsertOut-CH84
S6-10
Slot6 CH10 IN
INSCH85
InsertOut-CH85
INSCH85
InsertOut-CH85
S6-11
Slot6 CH11 IN
INSCH86
InsertOut-CH86
INSCH86
InsertOut-CH86
S6-12
Slot6 CH12 IN
INSCH87
InsertOut-CH87
INSCH87
InsertOut-CH87
S6-13
Slot6 CH13 IN
INSCH88
InsertOut-CH88
INSCH88
InsertOut-CH88
S6-14
Slot6 CH14 IN
INSCH89
InsertOut-CH89
INSCH89
InsertOut-CH89
S6-15
Slot6 CH15 IN
INSCH90
InsertOut-CH90
INSCH90
InsertOut-CH90
S6-16
Slot6 CH16 IN
INSCH91
InsertOut-CH91
INSCH91
InsertOut-CH91
FX1-1
Effect1 OUT 1
INSCH92
InsertOut-CH92
INSCH92
InsertOut-CH92
FX1-2
Effect1 OUT 2
INSCH93
InsertOut-CH93
INSCH93
InsertOut-CH93
FX1-3
Effect1 OUT 3
INSCH94
InsertOut-CH94
INSCH94
InsertOut-CH94
FX1-4
Effect1 OUT 4
INSCH95
InsertOut-CH95
INSCH95
InsertOut-CH95
FX1-5
Effect1 OUT 5
INSCH96
InsertOut-CH96
INSCH96
InsertOut-CH96
FX1-6
Effect1 OUT 6
INSBUS1
InsertOut-BUS1
INSBUS1
InsertOut-BUS1
FX1-7
Effect1 OUT 7
INSBUS2
InsertOut-BUS2
INSBUS2
InsertOut-BUS2
FX1-8
Effect1 OUT 8
INSBUS3
InsertOut-BUS3
INSBUS3
InsertOut-BUS3
FX2-1
Effect2 OUT 1
INSBUS4
InsertOut-BUS4
INSBUS4
InsertOut-BUS4
FX2-2
Effect2 OUT 2
INSBUS5
InsertOut-BUS5
INSBUS5
InsertOut-BUS5
FX2-3
Effect2 OUT 3
INSBUS6
InsertOut-BUS6
INSBUS6
InsertOut-BUS6
FX2-4
Effect2 OUT 4
INSBUS7
InsertOut-BUS7
INSBUS7
InsertOut-BUS7
FX2-5
Effect2 OUT 5
INSBUS8
InsertOut-BUS8
INSBUS8
InsertOut-BUS8
FX2-6
Effect2 OUT 6
INSAUX1
InsertOut-AUX1
INSAUX1
InsertOut-AUX1
FX2-7
Effect2 OUT 7
INSAUX2
InsertOut-AUX2
INSAUX2
InsertOut-AUX2
FX2-8
Effect2 OUT 8
INSAUX3
InsertOut-AUX3
INSAUX3
InsertOut-AUX3
FX3-1
Effect3 OUT 1
INSAUX4
InsertOut-AUX4
INSAUX4
InsertOut-AUX4
FX3-2
Effect3 OUT 2
INSAUX5
InsertOut-AUX5
INSAUX5
InsertOut-AUX5
FX4-1
Effect4 OUT 1
INSAUX6
InsertOut-AUX6
INSAUX6
InsertOut-AUX6
FX4-2
Effect4 OUT 2
INSAUX7
InsertOut-AUX7
INSAUX7
InsertOut-AUX7
FX5-1
Effect5 OUT 1
INSAUX8
InsertOut-AUX8
INSAUX8
InsertOut-AUX8
FX5-2
Effect5 OUT 2
INSAUX9
InsertOut-AUX9
INSAUX9
InsertOut-AUX9
FX6-1
Effect6 OUT 1
INSAUX10
InsertOut-AUX10
INSAUX10
InsertOut-AUX10
FX6-2
Effect6 OUT 2
INSAUX11
InsertOut-AUX11
INSAUX11
InsertOut-AUX11
FX7-1
Effect7 OUT 1
INSAUX12
InsertOut-AUX12
INSAUX12
InsertOut-AUX12
FX7-2
Effect7 OUT 2
INSMTX1L
InsertOut-MTX1L
INSMTX1L
InsertOut-MTX1L
FX8-1
Effect8 OUT 1
INSMTX1R
InsertOut-MTX1R
INSMTX1R
InsertOut-MTX1R
FX8-2
Effect8 OUT 2
INSMTX2L
InsertOut-MTX2L
INSMTX2L
InsertOut-MTX2L
2TD1L
2TR IN Dig.1 L
INSMTX2R
InsertOut-MTX2R
INSMTX2R
InsertOut-MTX2R
2TD1R
2TR IN Dig.1 R
INSMTX3L
InsertOut-MTX3L
INSMTX3L
InsertOut-MTX3L
2TD2L
2TR IN Dig.2 L
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Output Patch Parameters
Slot Outputs
Omni Outs
293
Output Channel Insert Ins
Source
Description
Source
Description
Source
Description
INSMTX3R
InsertOut-MTX3R
INSMTX3R
InsertOut-MTX3R
2TD2R
INSMTX4L
InsertOut-MTX4L
INSMTX4L
InsertOut-MTX4L
2TD3L
2TR IN Dig.3 L
INSMTX4R
InsertOut-MTX4R
INSMTX4R
InsertOut-MTX4R
2TD3R
2TR IN Dig.3 R
INSSTL
InsertOut-STL
INSSTL
InsertOut-STL
2TA1L
2TR IN Analog1 L
INSSTR
InsertOut-STR
INSSTR
InsertOut-STR
2TA1R
2TR IN Analog1 R
Surr L
Surround Monitor L
Surr L
Surround Monitor L
2TA2L
2TR IN Analog2 L
2TA2R
2TR IN Dig.2 R
Surr R
Surround Monitor R
Surr R
Surround Monitor R
Surr Ls
Surround Monitor Ls
Surr Ls
Surround Monitor Ls
—
2TR IN Analog2 R
—
Surr Rs
Surround Monitor Rs
Surr Rs
Surround Monitor Rs
—
—
Surr C
Surround Monitor C
Surr C
Surround Monitor C
—
—
Surr LFE
Surround Monitor LFE
Surr LFE
Surround Monitor LFE
—
—
Surr Ls2
Surround Monitor Ls2
Surr Ls2
Surround Monitor Ls2
—
—
Surr Rs2
Surround Monitor Rs2
Surr Rs2
Surround Monitor Rs2
—
—
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
294
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Output Patch Table 2
Direct Outs
Source
2TR Digital Outs
Description
Source
GEQs
Description
Source
Description
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
S1-1
Slot1 CH1 OUT
BUS1
BUS1
BUS1
BUS1
S1-2
Slot1 CH2 OUT
BUS2
BUS2
BUS2
BUS2
S1-3
Slot1 CH3 OUT
BUS3
BUS3
BUS3
BUS3
S1-4
Slot1 CH4 OUT
BUS4
BUS4
BUS4
BUS4
S1-5
Slot1 CH5 OUT
BUS5
BUS5
BUS5
BUS5
S1-6
Slot1 CH6 OUT
BUS6
BUS6
BUS6
BUS6
S1-7
Slot1 CH7 OUT
BUS7
BUS7
BUS7
BUS7
S1-8
Slot1 CH8 OUT
BUS8
BUS8
BUS8
BUS8
S1-9
Slot1 CH9 OUT
AUX1
AUX1
AUX1
AUX1
S1-10
Slot1 CH10 OUT
AUX2
AUX2
AUX2
AUX2
S1-11
Slot1 CH11 OUT
AUX3
AUX3
AUX3
AUX3
S1-12
Slot1 CH12 OUT
AUX4
AUX4
AUX4
AUX4
S1-13
Slot1 CH13 OUT
AUX5
AUX5
AUX5
AUX5
S1-14
Slot1 CH14 OUT
AUX6
AUX6
AUX6
AUX6
S1-15
Slot1 CH15 OUT
AUX7
AUX7
AUX7
AUX7
S1-16
Slot1 CH16 OUT
AUX8
AUX8
AUX8
AUX8
S2-1
Slot2 CH1 OUT
AUX9
AUX9
AUX9
AUX9
S2-2
Slot2 CH2 OUT
AUX10
AUX10
AUX10
AUX10
S2-3
Slot2 CH3 OUT
AUX11
AUX11
AUX11
AUX11
S2-4
Slot2 CH4 OUT
AUX12
AUX12
AUX12
AUX12
S2-5
Slot2 CH5 OUT
MATRIX1L
MATRIX1 L
MATRIX1L
MATRIX1 L
S2-6
Slot2 CH6 OUT
MATRIX1R
MATRIX1 R
MATRIX1R
MATRIX1 R
S2-7
Slot2 CH7 OUT
MATRIX2L
MATRIX2 L
MATRIX2L
MATRIX2 L
S2-8
Slot2 CH8 OUT
MATRIX2R
MATRIX2 R
MATRIX2R
MATRIX2 R
S2-9
Slot2 CH9 OUT
MATRIX3L
MATRIX3 L
MATRIX3L
MATRIX3 L
S2-10
Slot2 CH10 OUT
MATRIX3R
MATRIX3 R
MATRIX3R
MATRIX3 R
S2-11
Slot2 CH11 OUT
MATRIX4L
MATRIX4 L
MATRIX4L
MATRIX4 L
S2-12
Slot2 CH12 OUT
MATRIX4R
MATRIX4 R
MATRIX4R
MATRIX4 R
S2-13
Slot2 CH13 OUT
STEREO-L
STEREO L
STEREO-L
STEREO L
S2-14
Slot2 CH14 OUT
STEREO-R
STEREO R
STEREO-R
STEREO R
S2-15
Slot2 CH15 OUT
INSCH1
InsertOut-CH1
—
—
S2-16
Slot2 CH16 OUT
INSCH2
InsertOut-CH2
—
—
S3-1
Slot3 CH1 OUT
INSCH3
InsertOut-CH3
—
—
S3-2
Slot3 CH2 OUT
INSCH4
InsertOut-CH4
—
—
S3-3
Slot3 CH3 OUT
INSCH5
InsertOut-CH5
—
—
S3-4
Slot3 CH4 OUT
INSCH6
InsertOut-CH6
—
—
S3-5
Slot3 CH5 OUT
INSCH7
InsertOut-CH7
—
—
S3-6
Slot3 CH6 OUT
INSCH8
InsertOut-CH8
—
—
S3-7
Slot3 CH7 OUT
INSCH9
InsertOut-CH9
—
—
S3-8
Slot3 CH8 OUT
INSCH10
InsertOut-CH10
—
—
S3-9
Slot3 CH9 OUT
INSCH11
InsertOut-CH11
—
—
S3-10
Slot3 CH10 OUT
INSCH12
InsertOut-CH12
—
—
S3-11
Slot3 CH11 OUT
INSCH13
InsertOut-CH13
—
—
S3-12
Slot3 CH12 OUT
INSCH14
InsertOut-CH14
—
—
S3-13
Slot3 CH13 OUT
INSCH15
InsertOut-CH15
—
—
S3-14
Slot3 CH14 OUT
INSCH16
InsertOut-CH16
—
—
S3-15
Slot3 CH15 OUT
INSCH17
InsertOut-CH17
—
—
S3-16
Slot3 CH16 OUT
INSCH18
InsertOut-CH18
—
—
S4-1
Slot4 CH1 OUT
INSCH19
InsertOut-CH19
—
—
S4-2
Slot4 CH2 OUT
INSCH20
InsertOut-CH20
—
—
S4-3
Slot4 CH3 OUT
INSCH21
InsertOut-CH21
—
—
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
295
Output Patch Parameters
Direct Outs
Source
Description
2TR Digital Outs
Source
Description
GEQs
Source
Description
S4-4
Slot4 CH4 OUT
INSCH22
InsertOut-CH22
—
—
S4-5
Slot4 CH5 OUT
INSCH23
InsertOut-CH23
—
—
S4-6
Slot4 CH6 OUT
INSCH24
InsertOut-CH24
—
—
S4-7
Slot4 CH7 OUT
INSCH25
InsertOut-CH25
—
—
S4-8
Slot4 CH8 OUT
INSCH26
InsertOut-CH26
—
—
S4-9
Slot4 CH9 OUT
INSCH27
InsertOut-CH27
—
—
S4-10
Slot4 CH10 OUT
INSCH28
InsertOut-CH28
—
—
S4-11
Slot4 CH11 OUT
INSCH29
InsertOut-CH29
—
—
S4-12
Slot4 CH12 OUT
INSCH30
InsertOut-CH30
—
—
S4-13
Slot4 CH13 OUT
INSCH31
InsertOut-CH31
—
—
S4-14
Slot4 CH14 OUT
INSCH32
InsertOut-CH32
—
—
S4-15
Slot4 CH15 OUT
INSCH33
InsertOut-CH33
—
—
S4-16
Slot4 CH16 OUT
INSCH34
InsertOut-CH34
—
—
S5-1
Slot5 CH1 OUT
INSCH35
InsertOut-CH35
—
—
S5-2
Slot5 CH2 OUT
INSCH36
InsertOut-CH36
—
—
S5-3
Slot5 CH3 OUT
INSCH37
InsertOut-CH37
—
—
S5-4
Slot5 CH4 OUT
INSCH38
InsertOut-CH38
—
—
S5-5
Slot5 CH5 OUT
INSCH39
InsertOut-CH39
—
—
S5-6
Slot5 CH6 OUT
INSCH40
InsertOut-CH40
—
—
S5-7
Slot5 CH7 OUT
INSCH41
InsertOut-CH41
—
—
S5-8
Slot5 CH8 OUT
INSCH42
InsertOut-CH42
—
—
S5-9
Slot5 CH9 OUT
INSCH43
InsertOut-CH43
—
—
S5-10
Slot5 CH10 OUT
INSCH44
InsertOut-CH44
—
—
S5-11
Slot5 CH11 OUT
INSCH45
InsertOut-CH45
—
—
S5-12
Slot5 CH12 OUT
INSCH46
InsertOut-CH46
—
—
S5-13
Slot5 CH13 OUT
INSCH47
InsertOut-CH47
—
—
S5-14
Slot5 CH14 OUT
INSCH48
InsertOut-CH48
—
—
S5-15
Slot5 CH15 OUT
INSCH49
InsertOut-CH49
—
—
S5-16
Slot5 CH16 OUT
INSCH50
InsertOut-CH50
—
—
S6-1
Slot6 CH1 OUT
INSCH51
InsertOut-CH51
—
—
S6-2
Slot6 CH2 OUT
INSCH52
InsertOut-CH52
—
—
S6-3
Slot6 CH3 OUT
INSCH53
InsertOut-CH53
—
—
S6-4
Slot6 CH4 OUT
INSCH54
InsertOut-CH54
—
—
S6-5
Slot6 CH5 OUT
INSCH55
InsertOut-CH55
—
—
S6-6
Slot6 CH6 OUT
INSCH56
InsertOut-CH56
—
—
S6-7
Slot6 CH7 OUT
INSCH57
InsertOut-CH57
—
—
S6-8
Slot6 CH8 OUT
INSCH58
InsertOut-CH58
—
—
S6-9
Slot6 CH9 OUT
INSCH59
InsertOut-CH59
—
—
S6-10
Slot6 CH10 OUT
INSCH60
InsertOut-CH60
—
—
S6-11
Slot6 CH11 OUT
INSCH61
InsertOut-CH61
—
—
S6-12
Slot6 CH12 OUT
INSCH62
InsertOut-CH62
—
—
S6-13
Slot6 CH13 OUT
INSCH63
InsertOut-CH63
—
—
S6-14
Slot6 CH14 OUT
INSCH64
InsertOut-CH64
—
—
S6-15
Slot6 CH15 OUT
INSCH65
InsertOut-CH65
—
—
S6-16
Slot6 CH16 OUT
INSCH66
InsertOut-CH66
—
—
OMNI1
OMNI OUT 1
INSCH67
InsertOut-CH67
—
—
OMNI2
OMNI OUT 2
INSCH68
InsertOut-CH68
—
—
OMNI3
OMNI OUT 3
INSCH69
InsertOut-CH69
—
—
OMNI4
OMNI OUT 4
INSCH70
InsertOut-CH70
—
—
OMNI5
OMNI OUT 5
INSCH71
InsertOut-CH71
—
—
OMNI6
OMNI OUT 6
INSCH72
InsertOut-CH72
—
—
OMNI7
OMNI OUT 7
INSCH73
InsertOut-CH73
—
—
OMNI8
OMNI OUT 8
INSCH74
InsertOut-CH74
—
—
2TD1L
2TR OUT Dig.1 L
INSCH75
InsertOut-CH75
—
—
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
296
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Direct Outs
Source
2TR Digital Outs
Description
Source
Description
GEQs
Source
Description
2TD1R
2TR OUT Dig.1 R
INSCH76
InsertOut-CH76
—
—
2TD2L
2TR OUT Dig.2 L
INSCH77
InsertOut-CH77
—
—
2TD2R
2TR OUT Dig.2 R
INSCH78
InsertOut-CH78
—
—
2TD3L
2TR OUT Dig.3 L
INSCH79
InsertOut-CH79
—
—
2TD3R
2TR OUT Dig.3 R
INSCH80
InsertOut-CH80
—
—
—
—
INSCH81
InsertOut-CH81
—
—
—
—
INSCH82
InsertOut-CH82
—
—
—
—
INSCH83
InsertOut-CH83
—
—
—
—
INSCH84
InsertOut-CH84
—
—
—
—
INSCH85
InsertOut-CH85
—
—
—
—
INSCH86
InsertOut-CH86
—
—
—
—
INSCH87
InsertOut-CH87
—
—
—
—
INSCH88
InsertOut-CH88
—
—
—
—
INSCH89
InsertOut-CH89
—
—
—
—
INSCH90
InsertOut-CH90
—
—
—
—
INSCH91
InsertOut-CH91
—
—
—
—
INSCH92
InsertOut-CH92
—
—
—
—
INSCH93
InsertOut-CH93
—
—
—
—
INSCH94
InsertOut-CH94
—
—
—
—
INSCH95
InsertOut-CH95
—
—
—
—
INSCH96
InsertOut-CH96
—
—
—
—
INSBUS1
InsertOut-BUS1
—
—
—
—
INSBUS2
InsertOut-BUS2
—
—
—
—
INSBUS3
InsertOut-BUS3
—
—
—
—
INSBUS4
InsertOut-BUS4
—
—
—
—
INSBUS5
InsertOut-BUS5
—
—
—
—
INSBUS6
InsertOut-BUS6
—
—
—
—
INSBUS7
InsertOut-BUS7
—
—
—
—
INSBUS8
InsertOut-BUS8
—
—
—
—
INSAUX1
InsertOut-AUX1
—
—
—
—
INSAUX2
InsertOut-AUX2
—
—
—
—
INSAUX3
InsertOut-AUX3
—
—
—
—
INSAUX4
InsertOut-AUX4
—
—
—
—
INSAUX5
InsertOut-AUX5
—
—
—
—
INSAUX6
InsertOut-AUX6
—
—
—
—
INSAUX7
InsertOut-AUX7
—
—
—
—
INSAUX8
InsertOut-AUX8
—
—
—
—
INSAUX9
InsertOut-AUX9
—
—
—
—
INSAUX10
InsertOut-AUX10
—
—
—
—
INSAUX11
InsertOut-AUX11
—
—
—
—
INSAUX12
InsertOut-AUX12
—
—
—
—
INSMTX1L
InsertOut-MTX1L
—
—
—
—
INSMTX1R
InsertOut-MTX1R
—
—
—
—
INSMTX2L
InsertOut-MTX2L
—
—
—
—
INSMTX2R
InsertOut-MTX2R
—
—
—
—
INSMTX3L
InsertOut-MTX3L
—
—
—
—
INSMTX3R
InsertOut-MTX3R
—
—
—
—
INSMTX4L
InsertOut-MTX4L
—
—
—
—
INSMTX4R
InsertOut-MTX4R
—
—
—
—
INSSTL
InsertOut-STL
—
—
—
—
INSSTR
InsertOut-STR
—
—
—
—
CR-L
Control Room L
—
—
—
—
CR-R
Control Room R
—
—
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Initial Output Patch Settings
297
Initial Output Patch Settings
Slot Outputs
#
Omni Outs
Direct Outs
Source
#
Source
Destination
SLOT1-01
BUS1
1
AUX1
1
SLOT1-01
SLOT1-02
BUS2
2
AUX2
2
SLOT1-02
SLOT1-03
BUS3
3
AUX3
3
SLOT1-04
BUS4
4
AUX4
SLOT1-05
BUS5
5
SLOT1-06
BUS6
6
SLOT1-07
BUS7
SLOT1-08
Slot Outputs
#
Omni Outs
Direct Outs
Source
#
Source
Destination
SLOT4-05
BUS5
—
—
53
NONE
SLOT4-06
BUS6
—
—
54
NONE
SLOT1-03
SLOT4-07
BUS7
—
—
55
NONE
4
SLOT1-04
SLOT4-08
BUS8
—
—
56
NONE
AUX5
5
SLOT1-05
SLOT4-09
BUS1
—
—
57
NONE
AUX6
6
SLOT1-06
SLOT4-10
BUS2
—
—
58
NONE
7
AUX7
7
SLOT1-07
SLOT4-11
BUS3
—
—
59
NONE
BUS8
8
AUX8
8
SLOT1-08
SLOT4-12
BUS4
—
—
60
NONE
SLOT1-09
BUS1
—
—
9
SLOT2-01
SLOT4-13
BUS5
—
—
61
NONE
SLOT1-10
BUS2
—
—
10
SLOT2-02
SLOT4-14
BUS6
—
—
62
NONE
SLOT1-11
BUS3
—
—
11
SLOT2-03
SLOT4-15
BUS7
—
—
63
NONE
SLOT1-12
BUS4
—
—
12
SLOT2-04
SLOT4-16
BUS8
—
—
64
NONE
SLOT1-13
BUS5
—
—
13
SLOT2-05
SLOT5-01
BUS1
—
—
65
NONE
SLOT1-14
BUS6
—
—
14
SLOT2-06
SLOT5-02
BUS2
—
—
66
NONE
SLOT1-15
BUS7
—
—
15
SLOT2-07
SLOT5-03
BUS3
—
—
67
NONE
SLOT1-16
BUS8
—
—
16
SLOT2-08
SLOT5-04
BUS4
—
—
68
NONE
SLOT2-01
BUS1
—
—
17
SLOT3-01
SLOT5-05
BUS5
—
—
69
NONE
SLOT2-02
BUS2
—
—
18
SLOT3-02
SLOT5-06
BUS6
—
—
70
NONE
SLOT2-03
BUS3
—
—
19
SLOT3-03
SLOT5-07
BUS7
—
—
71
NONE
SLOT2-04
BUS4
—
—
20
SLOT3-04
SLOT5-08
BUS8
—
—
72
NONE
SLOT2-05
BUS5
—
—
21
SLOT3-05
SLOT5-09
BUS1
—
—
73
NONE
SLOT2-06
BUS6
—
—
22
SLOT3-06
SLOT5-10
BUS2
—
—
74
NONE
SLOT2-07
BUS7
—
—
23
SLOT3-07
SLOT5-11
BUS3
—
—
75
NONE
SLOT2-08
BUS8
—
—
24
SLOT3-08
SLOT5-12
BUS4
—
—
76
NONE
SLOT2-09
BUS1
—
—
25
SLOT4-01
SLOT5-13
BUS5
—
—
77
NONE
SLOT2-10
BUS2
—
—
26
SLOT4-02
SLOT5-14
BUS6
—
—
78
NONE
SLOT2-11
BUS3
—
—
27
SLOT4-03
SLOT5-15
BUS7
—
—
79
NONE
SLOT2-12
BUS4
—
—
28
SLOT4-04
SLOT5-16
BUS8
—
—
80
NONE
SLOT2-13
BUS5
—
—
29
SLOT4-05
SLOT6-01
BUS1
—
—
81
NONE
SLOT2-14
BUS6
—
—
30
SLOT4-06
SLOT6-02
BUS2
—
—
82
NONE
SLOT2-15
BUS7
—
—
31
SLOT4-07
SLOT6-03
BUS3
—
—
83
NONE
SLOT2-16
BUS8
—
—
32
SLOT4-08
SLOT6-04
BUS4
—
—
84
NONE
SLOT3-01
BUS1
—
—
33
SLOT5-01
SLOT6-05
BUS5
—
—
85
NONE
SLOT3-02
BUS2
—
—
34
SLOT5-02
SLOT6-06
BUS6
—
—
86
NONE
SLOT3-03
BUS3
—
—
35
SLOT5-03
SLOT6-07
BUS7
—
—
87
NONE
SLOT3-04
BUS4
—
—
36
SLOT5-04
SLOT6-08
BUS8
—
—
88
NONE
SLOT3-05
BUS5
—
—
37
SLOT5-05
SLOT6-09
BUS1
—
—
89
NONE
SLOT3-06
BUS6
—
—
38
SLOT5-06
SLOT6-10
BUS2
—
—
90
NONE
SLOT3-07
BUS7
—
—
39
SLOT5-07
SLOT6-11
BUS3
—
—
91
NONE
SLOT3-08
BUS8
—
—
40
SLOT5-08
SLOT6-12
BUS4
—
—
92
NONE
SLOT3-09
BUS1
—
—
41
SLOT6-01
SLOT6-13
BUS5
—
—
93
NONE
SLOT3-10
BUS2
—
—
42
SLOT6-02
SLOT6-14
BUS6
—
—
94
NONE
SLOT3-11
BUS3
—
—
43
SLOT6-03
SLOT6-15
BUS7
—
—
95
NONE
SLOT3-12
BUS4
—
—
44
SLOT6-04
SLOT6-16
BUS8
—
—
96
NONE
SLOT3-13
BUS5
—
—
45
SLOT6-05
SLOT3-14
BUS6
—
—
46
SLOT6-06
SLOT3-15
BUS7
—
—
47
SLOT6-07
SLOT3-16
BUS8
—
—
48
SLOT6-08
SLOT4-01
BUS1
—
—
49
NONE
SLOT4-02
BUS2
—
—
50
NONE
SLOT4-03
BUS3
—
—
51
NONE
SLOT4-04
BUS4
—
—
52
NONE
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
298
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Initial Input Channel Names
Input Channel
ID
Short Name
Long Name
Input Channel
ID
Short Name
Long Name
CH01
CH01
CH01
CH53
CH53
CH53
CH02
CH02
CH02
CH54
CH54
CH54
CH03
CH03
CH03
CH55
CH55
CH55
CH04
CH04
CH04
CH56
CH56
CH56
CH05
CH05
CH05
CH57
CH57
CH57
CH06
CH06
CH06
CH58
CH58
CH58
CH07
CH07
CH07
CH59
CH59
CH59
CH08
CH08
CH08
CH60
CH60
CH60
CH09
CH09
CH09
CH61
CH61
CH61
CH10
CH10
CH10
CH62
CH62
CH62
CH11
CH11
CH11
CH63
CH63
CH63
CH12
CH12
CH12
CH64
CH64
CH64
CH13
CH13
CH13
CH65
CH65
CH65
CH14
CH14
CH14
CH66
CH66
CH66
CH15
CH15
CH15
CH67
CH67
CH67
CH16
CH16
CH16
CH68
CH68
CH68
CH17
CH17
CH17
CH69
CH69
CH69
CH18
CH18
CH18
CH70
CH70
CH70
CH19
CH19
CH19
CH71
CH71
CH71
CH20
CH20
CH20
CH72
CH72
CH72
CH21
CH21
CH21
CH73
CH73
CH73
CH22
CH22
CH22
CH74
CH74
CH74
CH23
CH23
CH23
CH75
CH75
CH75
CH24
CH24
CH24
CH76
CH76
CH76
CH25
CH25
CH25
CH77
CH77
CH77
CH26
CH26
CH26
CH78
CH78
CH78
CH27
CH27
CH27
CH79
CH79
CH79
CH28
CH28
CH28
CH80
CH80
CH80
CH29
CH29
CH29
CH81
CH81
CH81
CH30
CH30
CH30
CH82
CH82
CH82
CH31
CH31
CH31
CH83
CH83
CH83
CH32
CH32
CH32
CH84
CH84
CH84
CH33
CH33
CH33
CH85
CH85
CH85
CH34
CH34
CH34
CH86
CH86
CH86
CH35
CH35
CH35
CH87
CH87
CH87
CH36
CH36
CH36
CH88
CH88
CH88
CH37
CH37
CH37
CH89
CH89
CH89
CH38
CH38
CH38
CH90
CH90
CH90
CH39
CH39
CH39
CH91
CH91
CH91
CH40
CH40
CH40
CH92
CH92
CH92
CH41
CH41
CH41
CH93
CH93
CH93
CH42
CH42
CH42
CH94
CH94
CH94
CH43
CH43
CH43
CH95
CH95
CH95
CH44
CH44
CH44
CH96
CH96
CH96
CH45
CH45
CH45
CH46
CH46
CH46
CH47
CH47
CH47
CH48
CH48
CH48
CH49
CH49
CH49
CH50
CH50
CH50
CH51
CH51
CH51
CH52
CH52
CH52
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Initial Output Channel Names
299
Initial Output Channel Names
Output Channel
ID
Short Name
Long Name
BUS1
BUS1
BUS1
BUS2
BUS2
BUS2
BUS3
BUS3
BUS3
BUS4
BUS4
BUS4
BUS5
BUS5
BUS5
BUS6
BUS6
BUS6
BUS7
BUS7
BUS7
BUS8
BUS8
BUS8
AUX1
AUX1
AUX1
AUX2
AUX2
AUX2
AUX3
AUX3
AUX3
AUX4
AUX4
AUX4
AUX5
AUX5
AUX5
AUX6
AUX6
AUX6
AUX7
AUX7
AUX7
AUX8
AUX8
AUX8
AUX9
AUX9
AUX9
AX10
AX10
AUX10
AX11
AX11
AUX11
AX12
AX12
AUX12
MTX1
MTX1
MATRIX1
MTX2
MTX2
MATRIX2
MTX3
MTX3
MATRIX3
MTX4
MTX4
MATRIX4
ST
ST
STEREO
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
300
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Initial Input Port Names
Port
AD1
AD2
AD3
AD4
AD5
AD6
AD7
AD8
AD9
AD10
AD11
AD12
AD13
AD14
AD15
AD16
AD17
AD18
AD19
AD20
AD21
AD22
AD23
AD24
SLOT1-01
SLOT1-02
SLOT1-03
SLOT1-04
SLOT1-05
SLOT1-06
SLOT1-07
SLOT1-08
SLOT1-09
SLOT1-10
SLOT1-11
SLOT1-12
SLOT1-13
SLOT1-14
SLOT1-15
SLOT1-16
SLOT2-01
SLOT2-02
SLOT2-03
SLOT2-04
SLOT2-05
SLOT2-06
SLOT2-07
SLOT2-08
SLOT2-09
SLOT2-10
SLOT2-11
SLOT2-12
SLOT2-13
SLOT2-14
SLOT2-15
SLOT2-16
SLOT3-01
SLOT3-02
SLOT3-03
SLOT3-04
SLOT3-05
SLOT3-06
SLOT3-07
SLOT3-08
SLOT3-09
PORT ID
AD01
AD02
AD03
AD04
AD05
AD06
AD07
AD08
AD09
AD10
AD11
AD12
AD13
AD14
AD15
AD16
AD17
AD18
AD19
AD20
AD21
AD22
AD23
AD24
S1-1
S1-2
S1-3
S1-4
S1-5
S1-6
S1-7
S1-8
S1-9
S110
S111
S112
S113
S114
S115
S116
S2-1
S2-2
S2-3
S2-4
S2-5
S2-6
S2-7
S2-8
S2-9
S210
S211
S212
S213
S214
S215
S216
S3-1
S3-2
S3-3
S3-4
S3-5
S3-6
S3-7
S3-8
S3-9
Short Name
AD01
AD02
AD03
AD04
AD05
AD06
AD07
AD08
AD09
AD10
AD11
AD12
AD13
AD14
AD15
AD16
AD17
AD18
AD19
AD20
AD21
AD22
AD23
AD24
S1-1
S1-2
S1-3
S1-4
S1-5
S1-6
S1-7
S1-8
S1-9
S110
S111
S112
S113
S114
S115
S116
S2-1
S2-2
S2-3
S2-4
S2-5
S2-6
S2-7
S2-8
S2-9
S210
S211
S212
S213
S214
S215
S216
S3-1
S3-2
S3-3
S3-4
S3-5
S3-6
S3-7
S3-8
S3-9
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Long Name
AD IN 1
AD IN 2
AD IN 3
AD IN 4
AD IN 5
AD IN 6
AD IN 7
AD IN 8
AD IN 9
AD IN 10
AD IN 11
AD IN 12
AD IN 13
AD IN 14
AD IN 15
AD IN 16
AD IN 17
AD IN 18
AD IN 19
AD IN 20
AD IN 21
AD IN 22
AD IN 23
AD IN 24
Slot1 CH1 IN
Slot1 CH2 IN
Slot1 CH3 IN
Slot1 CH4 IN
Slot1 CH5 IN
Slot1 CH6 IN
Slot1 CH7 IN
Slot1 CH8 IN
Slot1 CH9 IN
Slot1 CH10 IN
Slot1 CH11 IN
Slot1 CH12 IN
Slot1 CH13 IN
Slot1 CH14 IN
Slot1 CH15 IN
Slot1 CH16 IN
Slot2 CH1 IN
Slot2 CH2 IN
Slot2 CH3 IN
Slot2 CH4 IN
Slot2 CH5 IN
Slot2 CH6 IN
Slot2 CH7 IN
Slot2 CH8 IN
Slot2 CH9 IN
Slot2 CH10 IN
Slot2 CH11 IN
Slot2 CH12 IN
Slot2 CH13 IN
Slot2 CH14 IN
Slot2 CH15 IN
Slot2 CH16 IN
Slot3 CH1 IN
Slot3 CH2 IN
Slot3 CH3 IN
Slot3 CH4 IN
Slot3 CH5 IN
Slot3 CH6 IN
Slot3 CH7 IN
Slot3 CH8 IN
Slot3 CH9 IN
Port
SLOT3-10
SLOT3-11
SLOT3-12
SLOT3-13
SLOT3-14
SLOT3-15
SLOT3-16
SLOT4-01
SLOT4-02
SLOT4-03
SLOT4-04
SLOT4-05
SLOT4-06
SLOT4-07
SLOT4-08
SLOT4-09
SLOT4-10
SLOT4-11
SLOT4-12
SLOT4-13
SLOT4-14
SLOT4-15
SLOT4-16
SLOT5-01
SLOT5-02
SLOT5-03
SLOT5-04
SLOT5-05
SLOT5-06
SLOT5-07
SLOT5-08
SLOT5-09
SLOT5-10
SLOT5-11
SLOT5-12
SLOT5-13
SLOT5-14
SLOT5-15
SLOT5-16
SLOT6-01
SLOT6-02
SLOT6-03
SLOT6-04
SLOT6-05
SLOT6-06
SLOT6-07
SLOT6-08
SLOT6-09
SLOT6-10
SLOT6-11
SLOT6-12
SLOT6-13
SLOT6-14
SLOT6-15
SLOT6-16
2TD1L
2TD1R
2TD2L
2TD2R
2TD3L
2TD3R
2TA1L
2TA1R
2TA2L
2TA2R
PORT ID
S310
S311
S312
S313
S314
S315
S316
S4-1
S4-2
S4-3
S4-4
S4-5
S4-6
S4-7
S4-8
S4-9
S410
S411
S412
S413
S414
S415
S416
S5-1
S5-2
S5-3
S5-4
S5-5
S5-6
S5-7
S5-8
S5-9
S510
S511
S512
S513
S514
S515
S516
S6-1
S6-2
S6-3
S6-4
S6-5
S6-6
S6-7
S6-8
S6-9
S610
S611
S612
S613
S614
S615
S616
2TD1L
2TD1R
2TD2L
2TD2R
2TD3L
2TD3R
2TA1L
2TA1R
2TA2L
2TA2R
Short Name
S310
S311
S312
S313
S314
S315
S316
S4-1
S4-2
S4-3
S4-4
S4-5
S4-6
S4-7
S4-8
S4-9
S410
S411
S412
S413
S414
S415
S416
S5-1
S5-2
S5-3
S5-4
S5-5
S5-6
S5-7
S5-8
S5-9
S510
S511
S512
S513
S514
S515
S516
S6-1
S6-2
S6-3
S6-4
S6-5
S6-6
S6-7
S6-8
S6-9
S610
S611
S612
S613
S614
S615
S616
2D1L
2D1R
2D2L
2D2R
2D3L
2D3R
2A1L
2A1R
2A2L
2A2R
Long Name
Slot3 CH10 IN
Slot3 CH11 IN
Slot3 CH12 IN
Slot3 CH13 IN
Slot3 CH14 IN
Slot3 CH15 IN
Slot3 CH16 IN
Slot4 CH1 IN
Slot4 CH2 IN
Slot4 CH3 IN
Slot4 CH4 IN
Slot4 CH5 IN
Slot4 CH6 IN
Slot4 CH7 IN
Slot4 CH8 IN
Slot4 CH9 IN
Slot4 CH10 IN
Slot4 CH11 IN
Slot4 CH12 IN
Slot4 CH13 IN
Slot4 CH14 IN
Slot4 CH15 IN
Slot4 CH16 IN
Slot5 CH1 IN
Slot5 CH2 IN
Slot5 CH3 IN
Slot5 CH4 IN
Slot5 CH5 IN
Slot5 CH6 IN
Slot5 CH7 IN
Slot5 CH8 IN
Slot5 CH9 IN
Slot5 CH10 IN
Slot5 CH11 IN
Slot5 CH12 IN
Slot5 CH13 IN
Slot5 CH14 IN
Slot5 CH15 IN
Slot5 CH16 IN
Slot6 CH1 IN
Slot6 CH2 IN
Slot6 CH3 IN
Slot6 CH4 IN
Slot6 CH5 IN
Slot6 CH6 IN
Slot6 CH7 IN
Slot6 CH8 IN
Slot6 CH9 IN
Slot6 CH10 IN
Slot6 CH11 IN
Slot6 CH12 IN
Slot6 CH13 IN
Slot6 CH14 IN
Slot6 CH15 IN
Slot6 CH16 IN
2TR IN Dig.1 L
2TR IN Dig.1 R
2TR IN Dig.2 L
2TR IN Dig.2 R
2TR IN Dig.3 L
2TR IN Dig.3 R
2TR IN Analog1 L
2TR IN Analog1 R
2TR IN Analog2 L
2TR IN Analog2 R
Initial Output Port Names
301
Initial Output Port Names
Long Name
Port
SLOT1-01
Port
S1-01
Port ID
Short Name
S101
Slot1 CH1 OUT
SLOT4-10
S4-10
Port ID
Short Name
S410
Slot4 CH10 OUT
Long Name
SLOT1-02
S1-02
S102
Slot1 CH2 OUT
SLOT4-11
S4-11
S411
Slot4 CH11 OUT
SLOT1-03
S1-03
S103
Slot1 CH3 OUT
SLOT4-12
S4-12
S412
Slot4 CH12 OUT
SLOT1-04
S1-04
S104
Slot1 CH4 OUT
SLOT4-13
S4-13
S413
Slot4 CH13 OUT
SLOT1-05
S1-05
S105
Slot1 CH5 OUT
SLOT4-14
S4-14
S414
Slot4 CH14 OUT
SLOT1-06
S1-06
S106
Slot1 CH6 OUT
SLOT4-15
S4-15
S415
Slot4 CH15 OUT
SLOT1-07
S1-07
S107
Slot1 CH7 OUT
SLOT4-16
S4-16
S416
Slot4 CH16 OUT
SLOT1-08
S1-08
S108
Slot1 CH8 OUT
SLOT5-01
S5-01
S501
Slot5 CH1 OUT
SLOT1-09
S1-09
S109
Slot1 CH9 OUT
SLOT5-02
S5-02
S502
Slot5 CH2 OUT
SLOT1-10
S1-10
S110
Slot1 CH10 OUT
SLOT5-03
S5-03
S503
Slot5 CH3 OUT
SLOT1-11
S1-11
S111
Slot1 CH11 OUT
SLOT5-04
S5-04
S504
Slot5 CH4 OUT
SLOT1-12
S1-12
S112
Slot1 CH12 OUT
SLOT5-05
S5-05
S505
Slot5 CH5 OUT
SLOT1-13
S1-13
S113
Slot1 CH13 OUT
SLOT5-06
S5-06
S506
Slot5 CH6 OUT
SLOT1-14
S1-14
S114
Slot1 CH14 OUT
SLOT5-07
S5-07
S507
Slot5 CH7 OUT
SLOT1-15
S1-15
S115
Slot1 CH15 OUT
SLOT5-08
S5-08
S508
Slot5 CH8 OUT
SLOT1-16
S1-16
S116
Slot1 CH16 OUT
SLOT5-09
S5-09
S509
Slot5 CH9 OUT
SLOT2-01
S2-01
S201
Slot2 CH1 OUT
SLOT5-10
S5-10
S510
Slot5 CH10 OUT
SLOT2-02
S2-02
S202
Slot2 CH2 OUT
SLOT5-11
S5-11
S511
Slot5 CH11 OUT
SLOT2-03
S2-03
S203
Slot2 CH3 OUT
SLOT5-12
S5-12
S512
Slot5 CH12 OUT
SLOT2-04
S2-04
S204
Slot2 CH4 OUT
SLOT5-13
S5-13
S513
Slot5 CH13 OUT
SLOT2-05
S2-05
S205
Slot2 CH5 OUT
SLOT5-14
S5-14
S514
Slot5 CH14 OUT
SLOT2-06
S2-06
S206
Slot2 CH6 OUT
SLOT5-15
S5-15
S515
Slot5 CH15 OUT
SLOT2-07
S2-07
S207
Slot2 CH7 OUT
SLOT5-16
S5-16
S516
Slot5 CH16 OUT
SLOT2-08
S2-08
S208
Slot2 CH8 OUT
SLOT6-01
S6-01
S601
Slot6 CH1 OUT
SLOT2-09
S2-09
S209
Slot2 CH9 OUT
SLOT6-02
S6-02
S602
Slot6 CH2 OUT
SLOT2-10
S2-10
S210
Slot2 CH10 OUT
SLOT6-03
S6-03
S603
Slot6 CH3 OUT
SLOT2-11
S2-11
S211
Slot2 CH11 OUT
SLOT6-04
S6-04
S604
Slot6 CH4 OUT
SLOT2-12
S2-12
S212
Slot2 CH12 OUT
SLOT6-05
S6-05
S605
Slot6 CH5 OUT
SLOT2-13
S2-13
S213
Slot2 CH13 OUT
SLOT6-06
S6-06
S606
Slot6 CH6 OUT
SLOT2-14
S2-14
S214
Slot2 CH14 OUT
SLOT6-07
S6-07
S607
Slot6 CH7 OUT
SLOT2-15
S2-15
S215
Slot2 CH15 OUT
SLOT6-08
S6-08
S608
Slot6 CH8 OUT
SLOT2-16
S2-16
S216
Slot2 CH16 OUT
SLOT6-09
S6-09
S609
Slot6 CH9 OUT
SLOT3-01
S3-01
S301
Slot3 CH1 OUT
SLOT6-10
S6-10
S610
Slot6 CH10 OUT
SLOT3-02
S3-02
S302
Slot3 CH2 OUT
SLOT6-11
S6-11
S611
Slot6 CH11 OUT
SLOT3-03
S3-03
S303
Slot3 CH3 OUT
SLOT6-12
S6-12
S612
Slot6 CH12 OUT
SLOT3-04
S3-04
S304
Slot3 CH4 OUT
SLOT6-13
S6-13
S613
Slot6 CH13 OUT
SLOT3-05
S3-05
S305
Slot3 CH5 OUT
SLOT6-14
S6-14
S614
Slot6 CH14 OUT
SLOT3-06
S3-06
S306
Slot3 CH6 OUT
SLOT6-15
S6-15
S615
Slot6 CH15 OUT
SLOT3-07
S3-07
S307
Slot3 CH7 OUT
SLOT6-16
S6-16
S616
Slot6 CH16 OUT
SLOT3-08
S3-08
S308
Slot3 CH8 OUT
OMNI1
OMNI1
OMN1
OMNI OUT 1
SLOT3-09
S3-09
S309
Slot3 CH9 OUT
OMNI2
OMNI2
OMN2
OMNI OUT 2
SLOT3-10
S3-10
S310
Slot3 CH10 OUT
OMNI3
OMNI3
OMN3
OMNI OUT 3
SLOT3-11
S3-11
S311
Slot3 CH11 OUT
OMNI4
OMNI4
OMN4
OMNI OUT 4
SLOT3-12
S3-12
S312
Slot3 CH12 OUT
OMNI5
OMNI5
OMN5
OMNI OUT 5
SLOT3-13
S3-13
S313
Slot3 CH13 OUT
OMNI6
OMNI6
OMN6
OMNI OUT 6
SLOT3-14
S3-14
S314
Slot3 CH14 OUT
OMNI7
OMNI7
OMN7
OMNI OUT 7
SLOT3-15
S3-15
S315
Slot3 CH15 OUT
OMNI8
OMNI8
OMN8
OMNI OUT 8
SLOT3-16
S3-16
S316
Slot3 CH16 OUT
2TD1L
2TD1L
2D1L
2TR OUT Dig. 1L
SLOT4-01
S4-01
S401
Slot4 CH1 OUT
2TD1R
2TD1R
2D1R
2TR OUT Dig. 1R
SLOT4-02
S4-02
S402
Slot4 CH2 OUT
2TD2L
2TD2L
2D2L
2TR OUT Dig. 2L
SLOT4-03
S4-03
S403
Slot4 CH3 OUT
2TD2R
2TD2R
2D2R
2TR OUT Dig. 2R
SLOT4-04
S4-04
S404
Slot4 CH4 OUT
2TD3L
2TD3L
2D3L
2TR OUT Dig. 3L
SLOT4-05
S4-05
S405
Slot4 CH5 OUT
2TD3R
2TD3R
2D3R
2TR OUT Dig. 3R
SLOT4-06
S4-06
S406
Slot4 CH6 OUT
SLOT4-07
S4-07
S407
Slot4 CH7 OUT
SLOT4-08
S4-08
S408
Slot4 CH8 OUT
SLOT4-09
S4-09
S409
Slot4 CH9 OUT
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
302
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
GPI Trigger Source & Target List
INPUT
#
Target
#
Target
#
Target
#
Target
0
NO ASSIGN
55
CH15 ON
110
CH70 ON
165
CH4 ON UNLATCH
1
TALKBACK
56
CH16 ON
111
CH71 ON
166
CH5 ON UNLATCH
2
SLATE
57
CH17 ON
112
CH72 ON
167
CH6 ON UNLATCH
3
DIMMER
58
CH18 ON
113
CH73 ON
168
CH7 ON UNLATCH
4
MONO
59
CH19 ON
114
CH74 ON
169
CH8 ON UNLATCH
5
SMALL
60
CH20 ON
115
CH75 ON
170
CH9 ON UNLATCH
6
SR BUS
61
CH21 ON
116
CH76 ON
171
CH10 ON UNLATCH
7
SR ASSIGN1
62
CH22 ON
117
CH77 ON
172
CH11 ON UNLATCH
8
SR ASSIGN2
63
CH23 ON
118
CH78 ON
173
CH12 ON UNLATCH
9
CR STEREO
64
CH24 ON
119
CH79 ON
174
CH13 ON UNLATCH
10
CR 2TRD1
65
CH25 ON
120
CH80 ON
175
CH14 ON UNLATCH
11
CR 2TRD2
66
CH26 ON
121
CH81 ON
176
CH15 ON UNLATCH
12
CR 2TRD3
67
CH27 ON
122
CH82 ON
177
CH16 ON UNLATCH
13
CR 2TRA1
68
CH28 ON
123
CH83 ON
178
CH17 ON UNLATCH
14
CR 2TRA2
69
CH29 ON
124
CH84 ON
179
CH18 ON UNLATCH
15
CR ASSIGN1
70
CH30 ON
125
CH85 ON
180
CH19 ON UNLATCH
16
CR ASSIGN2
71
CH31 ON
126
CH86 ON
181
CH20 ON UNLATCH
17
SM C-R
72
CH32 ON
127
CH87 ON
182
CH21 ON UNLATCH
18
SM STEREO
73
CH33 ON
128
CH88 ON
183
CH22 ON UNLATCH
19
SM AUX11
74
CH34 ON
129
CH89 ON
184
CH23 ON UNLATCH
20
SM AUX12
75
CH35 ON
130
CH90 ON
185
CH24 ON UNLATCH
21
TALKBACK UNLATCH
76
CH36 ON
131
CH91 ON
186
CH25 ON UNLATCH
22
SLATE UNLATCH
77
CH37 ON
132
CH92 ON
187
CH26 ON UNLATCH
23
DIMMER UNLATCH
78
CH38 ON
133
CH93 ON
188
CH27 ON UNLATCH
24
MONO UNLATCH
79
CH39 ON
134
CH94 ON
189
CH28 ON UNLATCH
25
SMALL UNLATCH
80
CH40 ON
135
CH95 ON
190
CH29 ON UNLATCH
26
SR BUS UNLATCH
81
CH41 ON
136
CH96 ON
191
CH30 ON UNLATCH
27
SR ASGN1 UNLATCH
82
CH42 ON
137
BUS1 ON
192
CH31 ON UNLATCH
28
SR ASGN2 UNLATCH
83
CH43 ON
138
BUS2 ON
193
CH32 ON UNLATCH
29
CR ST UNLATCH
84
CH44 ON
139
BUS3 ON
194
CH33 ON UNLATCH
30
CR 2TRD1 UNLATCH
85
CH45 ON
140
BUS4 ON
195
CH34 ON UNLATCH
31
CR 2TRD2 UNLATCH
86
CH46 ON
141
BUS5 ON
196
CH35 ON UNLATCH
32
CR 2TRD3 UNLATCH
87
CH47 ON
142
BUS6 ON
197
CH36 ON UNLATCH
33
CR 2TRA1 UNLATCH
88
CH48 ON
143
BUS7 ON
198
CH37 ON UNLATCH
34
CR 2TRA2 UNLATCH
89
CH49 ON
144
BUS8 ON
199
CH38 ON UNLATCH
35
CR ASGN1 UNLATCH
90
CH50 ON
145
AUX1 ON
200
CH39 ON UNLATCH
36
CR ASGN2 UNLATCH
91
CH51 ON
146
AUX2 ON
201
CH40 ON UNLATCH
37
SD C-R UNLATCH
92
CH52 ON
147
AUX3 ON
202
CH41 ON UNLATCH
38
SD ST UNLATCH
93
CH53 ON
148
AUX4 ON
203
CH42 ON UNLATCH
39
SD AUX11 UNLATCH
94
CH54 ON
149
AUX5 ON
204
CH43 ON UNLATCH
40
SD AUX12 UNLATCH
95
CH55 ON
150
AUX6 ON
205
CH44 ON UNLATCH
41
CH1 ON
96
CH56 ON
151
AUX7 ON
206
CH45 ON UNLATCH
42
CH2 ON
97
CH57 ON
152
AUX8 ON
207
CH46 ON UNLATCH
43
CH3 ON
98
CH58 ON
153
AUX9 ON
208
CH47 ON UNLATCH
44
CH4 ON
99
CH59 ON
154
AUX10 ON
209
CH48 ON UNLATCH
45
CH5 ON
100
CH60 ON
155
AUX11 ON
210
CH49 ON UNLATCH
46
CH6 ON
101
CH61 ON
156
AUX12 ON
211
CH50 ON UNLATCH
47
CH7 ON
102
CH62 ON
157
MATRIX1 ON
212
CH51 ON UNLATCH
48
CH8 ON
103
CH63 ON
158
MATRIX2 ON
213
CH52 ON UNLATCH
49
CH9 ON
104
CH64 ON
159
MATRIX3 ON
214
CH53 ON UNLATCH
50
CH10 ON
105
CH65 ON
160
MATRIX4 ON
215
CH54 ON UNLATCH
51
CH11 ON
106
CH66 ON
161
STEREO ON
216
CH55 ON UNLATCH
52
CH12 ON
107
CH67 ON
162
CH1 ON UNLATCH
217
CH56 ON UNLATCH
53
CH13 ON
108
CH68 ON
163
CH2 ON UNLATCH
218
CH57 ON UNLATCH
54
CH14 ON
109
CH69 ON
164
CH3 ON UNLATCH
219
CH58 ON UNLATCH
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
GPI Trigger Source & Target List
#
Target
#
303
Target
220
CH59 ON UNLATCH
279
MTX2 ON UNLATCH
221
CH60 ON UNLATCH
280
MTX3 ON UNLATCH
222
CH61 ON UNLATCH
281
MTX4 ON UNLATCH
223
CH62 ON UNLATCH
282
ST ON UNLATCH
224
CH63 ON UNLATCH
283
UDEF1
225
CH64 ON UNLATCH
284
UDEF2
226
CH65 ON UNLATCH
285
UDEF3
227
CH66 ON UNLATCH
286
UDEF4
228
CH67 ON UNLATCH
287
UDEF5
229
CH68 ON UNLATCH
288
UDEF6
230
CH69 ON UNLATCH
289
UDEF7
231
CH70 ON UNLATCH
290
UDEF8
232
CH71 ON UNLATCH
291
UDEF9
233
CH72 ON UNLATCH
292
UDEF10
234
CH73 ON UNLATCH
293
UDEF11
235
CH74 ON UNLATCH
294
UDEF12
236
CH75 ON UNLATCH
295
UDEF13
237
CH76 ON UNLATCH
296
UDEF14
238
CH77 ON UNLATCH
297
UDEF15
239
CH78 ON UNLATCH
298
UDEF16
240
CH79 ON UNLATCH
241
CH80 ON UNLATCH
242
CH81 ON UNLATCH
243
CH82 ON UNLATCH
244
CH83 ON UNLATCH
245
CH84 ON UNLATCH
246
CH85 ON UNLATCH
247
CH86 ON UNLATCH
248
CH87 ON UNLATCH
249
CH88 ON UNLATCH
250
CH89 ON UNLATCH
251
CH90 ON UNLATCH
252
CH91 ON UNLATCH
253
CH92 ON UNLATCH
254
CH93 ON UNLATCH
255
CH94 ON UNLATCH
256
CH95 ON UNLATCH
257
CH96 ON UNLATCH
258
BUS1 ON UNLATCH
259
BUS2 ON UNLATCH
260
BUS3 ON UNLATCH
261
BUS4 ON UNLATCH
262
BUS5 ON UNLATCH
263
BUS6 ON UNLATCH
264
BUS7 ON UNLATCH
265
BUS8 ON UNLATCH
266
AUX1 ON UNLATCH
267
AUX2 ON UNLATCH
268
AUX3 ON UNLATCH
269
AUX4 ON UNLATCH
270
AUX5 ON UNLATCH
271
AUX6 ON UNLATCH
272
AUX7 ON UNLATCH
273
AUX8 ON UNLATCH
274
AUX9 ON UNLATCH
275
AUX10 ON UNLATCH
276
AUX11 ON UNLATCH
277
AUX12 ON UNLATCH
278
MTX1 ON UNLATCH
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
304
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
OUTPUT
#
Target
#
Target
#
Target
#
Target
0
NO ASSIGN
58
CH58 FADER ON
116
AUX12 FADER ON
174
CH53 FADER OFF
1
CH1 FADER ON
59
CH59 FADER ON
117
MATRIX1 FADER ON
175
CH54 FADER OFF
2
CH2 FADER ON
60
CH60 FADER ON
118
MATRIX2 FADER ON
176
CH55 FADER OFF
3
CH3 FADER ON
61
CH61 FADER ON
119
MATRIX3 FADER ON
177
CH56 FADER OFF
4
CH4 FADER ON
62
CH62 FADER ON
120
MATRIX4 FADER ON
178
CH57 FADER OFF
5
CH5 FADER ON
63
CH63 FADER ON
121
STEREO FADER ON
179
CH58 FADER OFF
6
CH6 FADER ON
64
CH64 FADER ON
122
CH1 FADER OFF
180
CH59 FADER OFF
7
CH7 FADER ON
65
CH65 FADER ON
123
CH2 FADER OFF
181
CH60 FADER OFF
8
CH8 FADER ON
66
CH66 FADER ON
124
CH3 FADER OFF
182
CH61 FADER OFF
9
CH9 FADER ON
67
CH67 FADER ON
125
CH4 FADER OFF
183
CH62 FADER OFF
10
CH10 FADER ON
68
CH68 FADER ON
126
CH5 FADER OFF
184
CH63 FADER OFF
11
CH11 FADER ON
69
CH69 FADER ON
127
CH6 FADER OFF
185
CH64 FADER OFF
12
CH12 FADER ON
70
CH70 FADER ON
128
CH7 FADER OFF
186
CH65 FADER OFF
13
CH13 FADER ON
71
CH71 FADER ON
129
CH8 FADER OFF
187
CH66 FADER OFF
14
CH14 FADER ON
72
CH72 FADER ON
130
CH9 FADER OFF
188
CH67 FADER OFF
15
CH15 FADER ON
73
CH73 FADER ON
131
CH10 FADER OFF
189
CH68 FADER OFF
16
CH16 FADER ON
74
CH74 FADER ON
132
CH11 FADER OFF
190
CH69 FADER OFF
17
CH17 FADER ON
75
CH75 FADER ON
133
CH12 FADER OFF
191
CH70 FADER OFF
18
CH18 FADER ON
76
CH76 FADER ON
134
CH13 FADER OFF
192
CH71 FADER OFF
19
CH19 FADER ON
77
CH77 FADER ON
135
CH14 FADER OFF
193
CH72 FADER OFF
20
CH20 FADER ON
78
CH78 FADER ON
136
CH15 FADER OFF
194
CH73 FADER OFF
21
CH21 FADER ON
79
CH79 FADER ON
137
CH16 FADER OFF
195
CH74 FADER OFF
22
CH22 FADER ON
80
CH80 FADER ON
138
CH17 FADER OFF
196
CH75 FADER OFF
23
CH23 FADER ON
81
CH81 FADER ON
139
CH18 FADER OFF
197
CH76 FADER OFF
24
CH24 FADER ON
82
CH82 FADER ON
140
CH19 FADER OFF
198
CH77 FADER OFF
25
CH25 FADER ON
83
CH83 FADER ON
141
CH20 FADER OFF
199
CH78 FADER OFF
26
CH26 FADER ON
84
CH84 FADER ON
142
CH21 FADER OFF
200
CH79 FADER OFF
27
CH27 FADER ON
85
CH85 FADER ON
143
CH22 FADER OFF
201
CH80 FADER OFF
28
CH28 FADER ON
86
CH86 FADER ON
144
CH23 FADER OFF
202
CH81 FADER OFF
29
CH29 FADER ON
87
CH87 FADER ON
145
CH24 FADER OFF
203
CH82 FADER OFF
30
CH30 FADER ON
88
CH88 FADER ON
146
CH25 FADER OFF
204
CH83 FADER OFF
31
CH31 FADER ON
89
CH89 FADER ON
147
CH26 FADER OFF
205
CH84 FADER OFF
32
CH32 FADER ON
90
CH90 FADER ON
148
CH27 FADER OFF
206
CH85 FADER OFF
33
CH33 FADER ON
91
CH91 FADER ON
149
CH28 FADER OFF
207
CH86 FADER OFF
34
CH34 FADER ON
92
CH92 FADER ON
150
CH29 FADER OFF
208
CH87 FADER OFF
35
CH35 FADER ON
93
CH93 FADER ON
151
CH30 FADER OFF
209
CH88 FADER OFF
36
CH36 FADER ON
94
CH94 FADER ON
152
CH31 FADER OFF
210
CH89 FADER OFF
37
CH37 FADER ON
95
CH95 FADER ON
153
CH32 FADER OFF
211
CH90 FADER OFF
38
CH38 FADER ON
96
CH96 FADER ON
154
CH33 FADER OFF
212
CH91 FADER OFF
39
CH39 FADER ON
97
BUS1 FADER ON
155
CH34 FADER OFF
213
CH92 FADER OFF
40
CH40 FADER ON
98
BUS2 FADER ON
156
CH35 FADER OFF
214
CH93 FADER OFF
41
CH41 FADER ON
99
BUS3 FADER ON
157
CH36 FADER OFF
215
CH94 FADER OFF
42
CH42 FADER ON
100
BUS4 FADER ON
158
CH37 FADER OFF
216
CH95 FADER OFF
43
CH43 FADER ON
101
BUS5 FADER ON
159
CH38 FADER OFF
217
CH96 FADER OFF
44
CH44 FADER ON
102
BUS6 FADER ON
160
CH39 FADER OFF
218
BUS1 FADER OFF
45
CH45 FADER ON
103
BUS7 FADER ON
161
CH40 FADER OFF
219
BUS2 FADER OFF
46
CH46 FADER ON
104
BUS8 FADER ON
162
CH41 FADER OFF
220
BUS3 FADER OFF
47
CH47 FADER ON
105
AUX1 FADER ON
163
CH42 FADER OFF
221
BUS4 FADER OFF
48
CH48 FADER ON
106
AUX2 FADER ON
164
CH43 FADER OFF
222
BUS5 FADER OFF
49
CH49 FADER ON
107
AUX3 FADER ON
165
CH44 FADER OFF
223
BUS6 FADER OFF
50
CH50 FADER ON
108
AUX4 FADER ON
166
CH45 FADER OFF
224
BUS7 FADER OFF
51
CH51 FADER ON
109
AUX5 FADER ON
167
CH46 FADER OFF
225
BUS8 FADER OFF
52
CH52 FADER ON
110
AUX6 FADER ON
168
CH47 FADER OFF
226
AUX1 FADER OFF
53
CH53 FADER ON
111
AUX7 FADER ON
169
CH48 FADER OFF
227
AUX2 FADER OFF
54
CH54 FADER ON
112
AUX8 FADER ON
170
CH49 FADER OFF
228
AUX3 FADER OFF
55
CH55 FADER ON
113
AUX9 FADER ON
171
CH50 FADER OFF
229
AUX4 FADER OFF
56
CH56 FADER ON
114
AUX10 FADER ON
172
CH51 FADER OFF
230
AUX5 FADER OFF
57
CH57 FADER ON
115
AUX11 FADER ON
173
CH52 FADER OFF
231
AUX6 FADER OFF
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
GPI Trigger Source & Target List
#
Target
#
Target
#
305
Target
232
AUX7 FADER OFF
291
CH49 FADER TALLY
350
AUX4 FADER TALLY
233
AUX8 FADER OFF
292
CH50 FADER TALLY
351
AUX5 FADER TALLY
234
AUX9 FADER OFF
293
CH51 FADER TALLY
352
AUX6 FADER TALLY
235
AUX10 FADER OFF
294
CH52 FADER TALLY
353
AUX7 FADER TALLY
236
AUX11 FADER OFF
295
CH53 FADER TALLY
354
AUX8 FADER TALLY
237
AUX12 FADER OFF
296
CH54 FADER TALLY
355
AUX9 FADER TALLY
238
MATRIX1 FADER OFF
297
CH55 FADER TALLY
356
AX10 FADER TALLY
239
MATRIX2 FADER OFF
298
CH56 FADER TALLY
357
AX11 FADER TALLY
240
MATRIX3 FADER OFF
299
CH57 FADER TALLY
358
AX12 FADER TALLY
241
MATRIX4 FADER OFF
300
CH58 FADER TALLY
359
MTX1 FADER TALLY
242
STEREO FADER OFF
301
CH59 FADER TALLY
360
MTX2 FADER TALLY
243
CH1 FADER TALLY
302
CH60 FADER TALLY
361
MTX3 FADER TALLY
244
CH2 FADER TALLY
303
CH61 FADER TALLY
362
MTX4 FADER TALLY
245
CH3 FADER TALLY
304
CH62 FADER TALLY
363
ST FADER TALLY
246
CH4 FADER TALLY
305
CH63 FADER TALLY
364
UDEF1 LATCH
247
CH5 FADER TALLY
306
CH64 FADER TALLY
365
UDEF2 LATCH
248
CH6 FADER TALLY
307
CH65 FADER TALLY
366
UDEF3 LATCH
249
CH7 FADER TALLY
308
CH66 FADER TALLY
367
UDEF4 LATCH
250
CH8 FADER TALLY
309
CH67 FADER TALLY
368
UDEF5 LATCH
251
CH9 FADER TALLY
310
CH68 FADER TALLY
369
UDEF6 LATCH
252
CH10 FADER TALLY
311
CH69 FADER TALLY
370
UDEF7 LATCH
253
CH11 FADER TALLY
312
CH70 FADER TALLY
371
UDEF8 LATCH
254
CH12 FADER TALLY
313
CH71 FADER TALLY
372
UDEF9 LATCH
255
CH13 FADER TALLY
314
CH72 FADER TALLY
373
UDEF10 LATCH
256
CH14 FADER TALLY
315
CH73 FADER TALLY
374
UDEF11 LATCH
257
CH15 FADER TALLY
316
CH74 FADER TALLY
375
UDEF12 LATCH
258
CH16 FADER TALLY
317
CH75 FADER TALLY
376
UDEF13 LATCH
259
CH17 FADER TALLY
318
CH76 FADER TALLY
377
UDEF14 LATCH
260
CH18 FADER TALLY
319
CH77 FADER TALLY
378
UDEF15 LATCH
261
CH19 FADER TALLY
320
CH78 FADER TALLY
379
UDEF16 LATCH
262
CH20 FADER TALLY
321
CH79 FADER TALLY
380
UDEF1 UNLATCH
263
CH21 FADER TALLY
322
CH80 FADER TALLY
381
UDEF2 UNLATCH
264
CH22 FADER TALLY
323
CH81 FADER TALLY
382
UDEF3 UNLATCH
265
CH23 FADER TALLY
324
CH82 FADER TALLY
383
UDEF4 UNLATCH
266
CH24 FADER TALLY
325
CH83 FADER TALLY
384
UDEF5 UNLATCH
267
CH25 FADER TALLY
326
CH84 FADER TALLY
385
UDEF6 UNLATCH
268
CH26 FADER TALLY
327
CH85 FADER TALLY
386
UDEF7 UNLATCH
269
CH27 FADER TALLY
328
CH86 FADER TALLY
387
UDEF8 UNLATCH
270
CH28 FADER TALLY
329
CH87 FADER TALLY
388
UDEF9 UNLATCH
271
CH29 FADER TALLY
330
CH88 FADER TALLY
389
UDEF10 UNLATCH
272
CH30 FADER TALLY
331
CH89 FADER TALLY
390
UDEF11 UNLATCH
273
CH31 FADER TALLY
332
CH90 FADER TALLY
391
UDEF12 UNLATCH
274
CH32 FADER TALLY
333
CH91 FADER TALLY
392
UDEF13 UNLATCH
275
CH33 FADER TALLY
334
CH92 FADER TALLY
393
UDEF14 UNLATCH
276
CH34 FADER TALLY
335
CH93 FADER TALLY
394
UDEF15 UNLATCH
277
CH35 FADER TALLY
336
CH94 FADER TALLY
395
UDEF16 UNLATCH
278
CH36 FADER TALLY
337
CH95 FADER TALLY
396
REC LAMP
279
CH37 FADER TALLY
338
CH96 FADER TALLY
397
POWER ON
280
CH38 FADER TALLY
339
BUS1 FADER TALLY
281
CH39 FADER TALLY
340
BUS2 FADER TALLY
282
CH40 FADER TALLY
341
BUS3 FADER TALLY
283
CH41 FADER TALLY
342
BUS4 FADER TALLY
284
CH42 FADER TALLY
343
BUS5 FADER TALLY
285
CH43 FADER TALLY
344
BUS6 FADER TALLY
286
CH44 FADER TALLY
345
BUS7 FADER TALLY
287
CH45 FADER TALLY
346
BUS8 FADER TALLY
288
CH46 FADER TALLY
347
AUX1 FADER TALLY
289
CH47 FADER TALLY
348
AUX2 FADER TALLY
290
CH48 FADER TALLY
349
AUX3 FADER TALLY
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
306
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
User Defined Remote Layer Initial Bank Settings
Bank 1 (GM Vol & Pan)
ID
Short
Name
Long
RM01 GM01
GM-CH01 VOL&PAN
RM02 GM02
GM-CH02 VOL&PAN
RM03 GM03
GM-CH03 VOL&PAN
RM04 GM04
GM-CH04 VOL&PAN
RM05 GM05
GM-CH05 VOL&PAN
RM06 GM06
GM-CH06 VOL&PAN
RM07 GM07
GM-CH07 VOL&PAN
RM08 GM08
GM-CH08 VOL&PAN
RM09 GM09
GM-CH09 VOL&PAN
RM10 GM10
GM-CH10 VOL&PAN
RM11 GM11
GM-CH11 VOL&PAN
RM12 GM12
GM-CH12 VOL&PAN
RM13 GM13
GM-CH13 VOL&PAN
RM14 GM14
GM-CH14 VOL&PAN
RM15 GM15
GM-CH15 VOL&PAN
RM16 GM16
GM-CH16 VOL&PAN
RM17 GM17
NO ASSIGN
RM18 GM18
NO ASSIGN
RM19 GM19
NO ASSIGN
RM20 GM20
NO ASSIGN
RM21 GM21
NO ASSIGN
RM22 GM22
NO ASSIGN
RM23 GM23
NO ASSIGN
RM24 GM24
NO ASSIGN
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Controller
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
1
2
3
4
5
6
END
B0
B0
END
B1
B1
END
B2
B2
END
B3
B3
END
B4
B4
END
B5
B5
END
B6
B6
END
B7
B7
END
B8
B8
END
B9
B9
END
BA
BA
END
BB
BB
END
BC
BC
END
BD
BD
END
BE
BE
END
BF
BF
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
0A
07
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
Data Format
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
User Defined Remote Layer Initial Bank Settings
307
Bank 2 (GM Vol & Effect 1)
ID
Short
Name
Long
RM01 GM01
GM-CH01 VOL&EFF1
RM02 GM02
GM-CH02 VOL&EFF1
RM03 GM03
GM-CH03 VOL&EFF1
RM04 GM04
GM-CH04 VOL&EFF1
RM05 GM05
GM-CH05 VOL&EFF1
RM06 GM06
GM-CH06 VOL&EFF1
RM07 GM07
GM-CH07 VOL&EFF1
RM08 GM08
GM-CH08 VOL&EFF1
RM09 GM09
GM-CH09 VOL&EFF1
RM10 GM10
GM-CH10 VOL&EFF1
RM11 GM11
GM-CH11 VOL&EFF1
RM12 GM12
GM-CH12 VOL&EFF1
RM13 GM13
GM-CH13 VOL&EFF1
RM14 GM14
GM-CH14 VOL&EFF1
RM15 GM15
GM-CH15 VOL&EFF1
RM16 GM16
GM-CH16 VOL&EFF1
RM17 GM17
NO ASSIGN
RM18 GM18
NO ASSIGN
RM19 GM19
NO ASSIGN
RM20 GM20
NO ASSIGN
RM21 GM21
NO ASSIGN
RM22 GM22
NO ASSIGN
RM23 GM23
NO ASSIGN
RM24 GM24
NO ASSIGN
Controller
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
1
2
3
4
5
6
END
B0
B0
END
B1
B1
END
B2
B2
END
B3
B3
END
B4
B4
END
B5
B5
END
B6
B6
END
B7
B7
END
B8
B8
END
B9
B9
END
BA
BA
END
BB
BB
END
BC
BC
END
BD
BD
END
BE
BE
END
BF
BF
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
0C
07
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
Data Format
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
308
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Bank 3 (XG Vol & Pan)
ID
Short
Name
Long
RM01 XG01
XG-CH01 VOL&PAN
RM02 XG02
XG-CH02 VOL&PAN
RM03 XG03
XG-CH03 VOL&PAN
RM04 XG04
XG-CH04 VOL&PAN
RM05 XG05
XG-CH05 VOL&PAN
RM06 XG06
XG-CH06 VOL&PAN
RM07 XG07
XG-CH07 VOL&PAN
RM08 XG08
XG-CH08 VOL&PAN
RM09 XG09
XG-CH09 VOL&PAN
RM10 XG10
XG-CH10 VOL&PAN
RM11 XG11
XG-CH11 VOL&PAN
RM12 XG12
XG-CH12 VOL&PAN
RM13 XG13
XG-CH13 VOL&PAN
RM14 XG14
XG-CH14 VOL&PAN
RM15 XG15
XG-CH15 VOL&PAN
RM16 XG16
XG-CH16 VOL&PAN
RM17 XG17
XG-CH17 VOL&PAN
RM18 XG18
XG-CH18 VOL&PAN
RM19 XG19
XG-CH19 VOL&PAN
RM20 XG20
XG-CH20 VOL&PAN
RM21 XG21
XG-CH21 VOL&PAN
RM22 XG22
XG-CH22 VOL&PAN
RM23 XG23
XG-CH23 VOL&PAN
RM24 XG24
XG-CH24 VOL&PAN
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Controller
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
1
2
3
4
5
6
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
END
F0
F0
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
43
43
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
10
10
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
4C
4C
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
08
08
NOP
00
00
NOP
01
01
NOP
02
02
NOP
03
03
NOP
04
04
NOP
05
05
NOP
06
06
NOP
07
07
NOP
08
08
NOP
09
09
NOP
0A
0A
NOP
0B
0B
NOP
0C
0C
NOP
0D
0D
NOP
0E
0E
NOP
0F
0F
NOP
10
10
NOP
11
11
NOP
12
12
NOP
13
13
NOP
14
14
NOP
15
15
NOP
16
16
NOP
17
17
Data Format
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
0E
0B
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
ENC
FAD
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
F7
F7
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
END
END
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
User Defined Remote Layer Initial Bank Settings
309
Bank 4 (Nuendo VST Mixer)
ID
Short
Name
Long
RM01 CH1
VST MIXER CH1
RM02 CH2
VST MIXER CH2
RM03 CH3
VST MIXER CH3
RM04 CH4
VST MIXER CH4
RM05 CH5
VST MIXER CH5
RM06 CH6
VST MIXER CH6
RM07 CH7
VST MIXER CH7
RM08 CH8
VST MIXER CH8
RM09 CH9
VST MIXER CH9
RM10 CH10
VST MIXER CH10
RM11 CH11
VST MIXER CH11
RM12 CH12
VST MIXER CH12
RM13 CH13
VST MIXER CH13
RM14 CH14
VST MIXER CH14
RM15 CH15
VST MIXER CH15
RM16 CH16
VST MIXER CH16
RM17 CH17
VST MIXER CH17
RM18 CH18
VST MIXER CH18
RM19 CH19
VST MIXER CH19
RM20 CH20
VST MIXER CH20
RM21 CH21
VST MIXER CH21
RM22 CH22
VST MIXER CH22
RM23 CH23
VST MIXER CH23
RM24 CH24
VST MIXER CH24
Controller
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
ON
ENCODER
FADER
1
2
B0
B0
B0
B1
B1
B1
B2
B2
B2
B3
B3
B3
B4
B4
B4
B5
B5
B5
B6
B6
B6
B7
B7
B7
B8
B8
B8
B9
B9
B9
BA
BA
BA
BB
BB
BB
BC
BC
BC
BD
BD
BD
BE
BE
BE
BF
BF
BF
B0
B0
B0
B1
B1
B1
B2
B2
B2
B3
B3
B3
B4
B4
B4
B5
B5
B5
B6
B6
B6
B7
B7
B7
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
40
0A
07
60
2A
27
60
2A
27
60
2A
27
60
2A
27
60
2A
27
60
2A
27
60
2A
27
60
2A
27
3
4
5
6
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
SW
ENC
FAD
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
END
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
Data Format
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
310
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Effects Parameters
REVERB HALL, REVERB ROOM, REVERB STAGE, REVERB PLATE
One input, two output hall, room, stage, and plate reverb simulations, all with gates.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
LO. RATIO
0.1–2.4
Low-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Reverb diffusion (left–right reverb spread)
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
E/R DLY
0.0–100.0 ms
Delay between early reflections and reverb
E/R BAL.
0–100%
Balance of early reflections and reverb
(0% = all reverb, 100% = all early reflections)
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
GATE LVL
OFF, –60 to 0 dB
Level at which gate kicks in
ATTACK
0–120 ms
Gate opening speed
HOLD
1
Gate open time
DECAY
2
Gate closing speed
1. 0.02 ms–2.13 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 0.02 ms–1.96 s (fs=48 kHz), 0.01 ms–1.06 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 0.01 ms–981 ms
(fs=96 kHz)
2. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz), 3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
EARLY REF.
One input, two output early reflections.
Parameter
Range
Description
TYPE
S-Hall, L-Hall, Random,
Revers, Plate, Spring
Type of early reflection simulation
ROOMSIZE
0.1–20.0
Reflection spacing
LIVENESS
0–10
Early reflections decay characteristics (0 = dead, 10 = live)
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
DIFF.
0–10
Reflection diffusion (left–right reflection spread)
DENSITY
0–100%
Reflection density
ER NUM.
1–19
Number of early reflections
FB GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
GATE REVERB, REVERSE GATE
One input, two output early reflections with gate, and early reflections with reverse gate.
Parameter
Range
Description
TYPE
Type-A, Type-B
Type of early reflection simulation
ROOMSIZE
0.1–20.0
Reflection spacing
LIVENESS
0–10
Early reflections decay characteristics (0 = dead, 10 = live)
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
DIFF.
0–10
Reflection diffusion (left–right reflection spread)
DENSITY
0–100%
Reflection density
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
ER NUM.
1–19
Number of early reflections
FB GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters
311
MONO DELAY
One input, one output basic repeat delay.
Parameter
Range
Description
DELAY
0.0–2730.0 ms
Delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
1.
(Max. value depends on tempo setting)
STEREO DELAY
Two input, two output basic stereo delay.
Parameter
Range
Description
DELAY L
0.0–1350.0 ms
Left channel delay time
DELAY R
0.0–1350.0 ms
Right channel delay time
FB. G L
–99 to +99%
Left channel feedback (plus values for normal-phase feedback,
minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
FB. G R
–99 to +99%
Right channel feedback (plus values for normal-phase feedback,
minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left channel DELAY
NOTE R
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right channel DELAY
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
MOD. DELAY
One input, two output basic repeat delay with modulation.
Parameter
Range
Description
DELAY
0.0–2725.0 ms
Delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
WAVE
Sine/Tri
Modulation waveform
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
DLY.NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
MOD.NOTE
2
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo
setting)
2.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
312
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
DELAY LCR
One input, two output 3-tap delay (left, center, right).
Range
Parameter
Description
DELAY L
0.0–2730.0 ms
Left channel delay time
DELAY C
0.0–2730.0 ms
Center channel delay time
DELAY R
0.0–2730.0 ms
Right channel delay time
FB. DLY
0.0–2730.0 ms
Feedback delay time
LEVEL L
–100 to +100%
Left channel delay level
LEVEL C
–100 to +100%
Center channel delay level
LEVEL R
–100 to +100%
Right channel delay level
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY L
NOTE C
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY C
NOTE R
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY R
NOTE FB
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB. DLY
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo
setting)
ECHO
Two input, two output stereo delay with crossed feedback loop.
Parameter
Range
Description
DELAY L
0.0–1350.0 ms
Left channel delay time
DELAY R
0.0–1350.0 ms
Right channel delay time
FB.DLY L
0.0–1350.0 ms
Left channel feedback delay time
FB.DLY R
0.0–1350.0 ms
Right channel feedback delay time
FB. G L
–99 to +99%
Left channel feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback,
minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
FB. G R
–99 to +99%
Right channel feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
L->R FBG
–99 to +99%
Left to right channel feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
R->L FBG
–99 to +99%
Right to left channel feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase
feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY L
NOTE R
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY R
NOTE FBL
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB. D L
NOTE FBR
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB. D R
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Effects Parameters
313
CHORUS
Two input, two output chorus effect.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
AM DEPTH
0–100%
Amplitude modulation depth
PM DEPTH
0–100%
Pitch modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
LSH F
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G
–12 to +12 dB
Low shelving filter gain
EQ F
100 Hz–8.00 kHz
EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G
–12 to +12 dB
EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q
10.0–0.10
EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
High shelving filter frequency
HSH G
–12 to +12 dB
High shelving filter gain
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
FLANGE
Two input, two output flange effect.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation speed
Modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
LSH F
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G
–12 to +12 dB
Low shelving filter gain
EQ F
100 Hz–8.00 kHz
EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G
–12 to +12 dB
EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q
10.0–0.10
EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
High shelving filter frequency
HSH G
–12 to +12 dB
High shelving filter gain
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
314
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
SYMPHONIC
Two input, two output symphonic effect.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation speed
Modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
LSH F
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G
–12 to +12 dB
Low shelving filter gain
EQ F
100 Hz–8.00 kHz
EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G
–12 to +12 dB
EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q
10.0–0.10
EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
High shelving filter frequency
HSH G
–12 to +12 dB
High shelving filter gain
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
PHASER
Two input, two output 16-stage phaser.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
OFFSET
0–100
Lowest phase-shifted frequency offset
PHASE
0.00–354.38 degrees
Left and right modulation phase balance
STAGE
2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16
Number of phase shift stages
LSH F
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G
–12 to +12 dB
Low shelving filter gain
HSH F
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
High shelving filter frequency
HSH G
–12 to +12 dB
High shelving filter gain
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters
315
AUTOPAN
Two input, two output autopanner.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
DIR.
1
Panning direction
WAVE
Sine, Tri, Square
Modulation waveform
LSH F
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G
–12 to +12 dB
Low shelving filter gain
EQ F
100 Hz–8.00 kHz
EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G
–12 to +12 dB
EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q
10.0–0.10
EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
High shelving filter frequency
HSH G
–12 to +12 dB
High shelving filter gain
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
2
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1. L<->R, L—>R, L<—R, Turn L, Turn R
2.
TREMOLO
Two input, two output tremolo effect.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation speed
Modulation depth
WAVE
Sine, Tri, Square
Modulation waveform
LSH F
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G
–12 to +12 dB
Low shelving filter gain
EQ F
100 Hz–8.00 kHz
EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G
–12 to +12 dB
EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q
10.0–0.10
EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
High shelving filter frequency
HSH G
–12 to +12 dB
High shelving filter gain
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
HQ. PITCH
One input, two output high-quality pitch shifter.
Parameter
Range
Description
PITCH
–12 to +12 semitones
Pitch shift
FINE
–50 to +50 cents
Pitch shift fine
DELAY
0.0–1000.0 ms
Delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
MODE
1–10
Pitch shift precision
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
316
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
DUAL PITCH
Two input, two output pitch shifter.
Parameter
Range
Description
PITCH 1
–24 to +24 semitones
Channel #1 pitch shift
FINE 1
–50 to +50 cents
Channel #1 pitch shift fine
LEVEL 1
–100 to +100%
Channel #1 level (plus values for normal phase, minus values for
reverse phase)
PAN 1
L63 to R63
Channel #1 pan
DELAY 1
0.0–1000.0 ms
Channel #1 delay time
FB. G 1
–99 to +99%
Channel #1 feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback,
minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
PITCH 2
–24 to +24 semitones
Channel #2 pitch shift
FINE 2
–50 to +50 cents
Channel #2 pitch shift fine
LEVEL 2
–100 to +100%
Channel #2 level (plus values for normal phase, minus values for
reverse phase)
PAN 2
L63 to R63
Channel #2 pan
DELAY 2
0.0–1000.0 ms
Channel #2 delay time
FB. G 2
–99 to +99%
Channel #2 feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback,
minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
MODE
1–10
Pitch shift precision
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE 1
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine Channel #1 delay
NOTE 2
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine Channel #2 delay
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
ROTARY
One input, two output rotary speaker simulator.
Parameter
Range
Description
ROTATE
STOP, START
SPEED
SLOW, FAST
Rotation stop, start
Rotation speed (see SLOW and FAST parameters)
SLOW
0.05–10.00 Hz
SLOW rotation speed
FAST
0.05–10.00 Hz
FAST rotation speed
DRIVE
0–100
Overdrive level
ACCEL
0–10
Acceleration at speed changes
LOW
0–100
Low-frequency filter
HIGH
0–100
High-frequency filter
RING MOD.
Two input, two output ring modulator.
Parameter
Range
Description
SOURCE
OSC, SELF
Modulation source: oscillator or input signal
OSC FREQ
0.0–5000.0 Hz
Oscillator frequency
FM FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Oscillator frequency modulation speed
FM DEPTH
0–100%
Oscillator frequency modulation depth
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE FM
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FM FREQ
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters
317
MOD. FILTER
Two input, two output modulation filter.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
PHASE
0.00–354.38 degrees
Left-channel modulation and right-channel modulation phase difference
TYPE
LPF, HPF, BPF
Filter type: low pass, high pass, band pass
OFFSET
0–100
Filter frequency offset
RESO.
0–20
Filter resonance
LEVEL
0–100
Output level
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ
1.
DISTORTION
One input, two output distortion effect.
Parameter
Range
Description
DST TYPE
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
OVD2, CRUNCH
Distortion type (DST = distortion, OVD = overdrive)
DRIVE
0–100
Distortion drive
MASTER
0–100
Master volume
TONE
–10 to +10
Tone
N. GATE
0–20
Noise reduction
AMP SIMULATE
One input, two output guitar amp simulator.
Parameter
Range
Description
AMP TYPE
1
Guitar amp simulation type
DST TYPE
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
OVD2, CRUNCH
Distortion type (DST = distortion, OVD = overdrive)
DRIVE
0–100
Distortion drive
MASTER
0–100
Master volume
BASS
0–100
Bass tone control
MIDDLE
0–100
Middle tone control
TREBLE
0–100
High tone control
CAB DEP
0–100%
Speaker cabinet simulation depth
EQ F
100 Hz–8.0 kHz
EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G
–12 to +12 dB
EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q
10.0–0.10
EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
N. GATE
0–20
Noise reduction
1. STK-M1, STK-M2, THRASH, MIDBST, CMB-PG, CMB-VR, CMB-DX, CMB-TW, MINI, FLAT
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
318
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
DYNA. FILTER
Two input, two output dynamically controlled filter.
Parameter
Range
Description
SOURCE
INPUT, MIDI
SENSE
0–100
Control source: input signal or MIDI Note On velocity
Sensitivity
DIR.
UP, DOWN
Upward or downward frequency change
DECAY
1
Filter frequency change decay speed
TYPE
LPF, HPF, BPF
Filter type
OFFSET
0–100
Filter frequency offset
RESO.
0–20
Filter resonance
LEVEL
0–100
Output Level
1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz), 3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
DYNA. FLANGE
Two input, two output dynamically controlled flanger.
Parameter
Range
Description
SOURCE
INPUT, MIDI
SENSE
0–100
Control source: input signal or MIDI Note On velocity
Sensitivity
DIR.
UP, DOWN
Upward or downward frequency change
DECAY
1
Decay speed
OFFSET
0–100
Delay time offset
FB.GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
LSH F
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G
–12 to +12 dB
Low shelving filter gain
EQ F
100 Hz–8.00 kHz
EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G
–12 to +12 dB
EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q
10.0–0.10
EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
High shelving filter frequency
HSH G
–12 to +12 dB
High shelving filter gain
1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz), 3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
DYNA. PHASER
Two input, two output dynamically controlled phaser.
Parameter
Range
Description
SOURCE
INPUT, MIDI
Control source: input signal or MIDI Note On velocity
SENSE
0–100
Sensitivity
DIR.
UP, DOWN
Upward or downward frequency change
DECAY
1
Decay speed
OFFSET
0–100
Lowest phase-shifted frequency offset
FB.GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
STAGE
2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16
Number of phase shift stages
LSH F
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G
–12 to +12 dB
Low shelving filter gain
HSH F
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
High shelving filter frequency
HSH G
–12 to +12 dB
High shelving filter gain
1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz), 3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters
319
REV+CHORUS
One input, two output reverb and chorus effects in parallel.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV/CHO
0–100%
Reverb and chorus balance (0% = all reverb, 100% = all chorus)
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
AM DEPTH
0–100%
Amplitude modulation depth
PM DEPTH
0–100%
Pitch modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
REV->CHORUS
One input, two output reverb and chorus effects in series.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV.BAL
0–100%
Reverb and chorused reverb balance (0% = all chorused reverb,
100% = all reverb)
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
AM DEPTH
0–100%
Amplitude modulation depth
PM DEPTH
0–100%
Pitch modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
320
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
REV+FLANGE
One input, two output reverb and flanger effects in parallel.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV/FLG
0–100%
Reverb and flange balance (0% = all reverb, 100% = all flange)
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
REV->FLANGE
One input, two output reverb and flanger effects in series.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV.BAL
0–100%
Reverb and flanged reverb balance (0% = all flanged reverb, 100%
= all reverb)
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters
321
REV+SYMPHO.
One input, two output reverb and symphonic effects in parallel.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV/SYM
0–100%
Reverb and symphonic balance (0% = all reverb, 100% = all symphonic)
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
REV->SYMPHO.
One input, two output reverb and symphonic effects in series.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV.BAL
0–100%
Reverb and symphonic reverb balance (0% = all symphonic reverb,
100% = all reverb)
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Modulation delay time
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
322
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
REV->PAN
One input, two output reverb and autopan effects in parallel.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV.BAL
0–100%
Reverb and panned reverb balance (0% = all panned reverb, 100%
= all reverb)
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
DIR.
1
Panning direction
WAVE
Sine, Tri, Square
Modulation waveform
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
2
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1. L<–>R, L–>R, L<–R, Turn L, Turn R
2.
DELAY+ER.
One input, two output delay and early reflections effects in parallel.
Parameter
Range
Description
DELAY L
0.0–1000.0 ms
Left channel delay time
DELAY R
0.0–1000.0 ms
Right channel delay time
FB. DLY
0.0–1000.0 ms
Feedback delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DLY/ER
0–100%
Delay and early reflections balance (0% = all delay, 100% = all early
reflections)
TYPE
S-Hall, L-Hall, Random,
Revers, Plate, Spring
Type of early reflection simulation
ROOMSIZE
0.1–20.0
Reflection spacing
LIVENESS
0–10
Early reflections decay characteristics (0 = dead, 10 = live)
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
ER NUM.
1–19
Number of early reflections
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left channel DELAY L
NOTE R
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right channel DELAY
R
NOTE FB
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB. DLY
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Effects Parameters
323
DELAY->ER.
One input, two output delay and early reflections effects in series.
Parameter
Range
Description
DELAY L
0.0–1000.0 ms
Left channel delay time
DELAY R
0.0–1000.0 ms
Right channel delay time
FB. DLY
0.0–1000.0 ms
Feedback delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DLY.BAL
0–100%
Delay and early reflected delay balance (0% = all early reflected
delay, 100% = all delay)
TYPE
S-Hall, L-Hall, Random,
Revers, Plate, Spring
Type of early reflection simulation
ROOMSIZE
0.1–20.0
Reflection spacing
LIVENESS
0–10
Early reflections decay characteristics (0 = dead, 10 = live)
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
ER NUM.
1–19
Number of early reflections
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left channel DELAY L
NOTE R
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right channel DELAY
R
NOTE FB
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB. DLY
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
DELAY+REV
One input, two output delay and reverb effects in parallel.
Parameter
Range
Description
DELAY L
0.0–1000.0 ms
Left channel delay time
DELAY R
0.0–1000.0 ms
Right channel delay time
FB. DLY
0.0–1000.0 ms
Feedback delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY HI
0.1–1.0
Delay high-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DLY/REV
0–100%
Delay and reverb balance (0% = all delay, 100% = all reverb)
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
REV HI
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left channel DELAY L
NOTE R
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right channel DELAY
R
NOTE FB
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB. DLY
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
324
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
DELAY->REV
One input, two output delay and reverb effects in series.
Parameter
Range
Description
DELAY L
0.0–1000.0 ms
Left channel delay time
DELAY R
0.0–1000.0 ms
Right channel delay time
FB. DLY
0.0–1000.0 ms
Feedback delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY HI
0.1–1.0
Delay high-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DLY.BAL
0–100%
Delay and delayed reverb balance (0% = all delayed reverb, 100% =
all delay)
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
INI. DLY
0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
REV HI
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Spread
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine left channel DELAY L
NOTE R
*1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine right channel DELAY
R
NOTE FB
*1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FB. DLY
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
DIST->DELAY
One input, two output distortion and delay effects in series.
Parameter
Range
Description
DST TYPE
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
OVD2, CRUNCH
Distortion type (DST = distortion, OVD = overdrive)
DRIVE
0–100
Distortion drive
MASTER
0–100
Master volume
TONE
–10 to +10
Tone control
N. GATE
0–20
Noise reduction
DELAY
0.0–2725.0 ms
Delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback ratio
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
DLY.BAL
0–100%
Distortion and delay balance (0% = all distortion, 100% = all
delayed distortion)
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
DLY.NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine DELAY
MOD.NOTE
2
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo
setting)
2.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters
325
MULTI FILTER
Two input, two output 3-band multi-filter (24 dB/octave).
Parameter
Range
Description
TYPE 1
HPF, LPF, BPF
Filter 1 type: high pass, low pass, band pass
TYPE 2
HPF, LPF, BPF
Filter 2 type: high pass, low pass, band pass
TYPE 3
HPF, LPF, BPF
Filter 3 type: high pass, low pass, band pass
FREQ. 1
28.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
Filter 1 frequency
FREQ. 2
28.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
Filter 2 frequency
FREQ. 3
28.0 Hz–16.0 kHz
Filter 3 frequency
LEVEL 1
0–100
Filter 1 level
LEVEL 2
0–100
Filter 2 level
LEVEL 3
0–100
Filter 3 level
RESO. 1
0–20
Filter 1 resonance
RESO. 2
0–20
Filter 2 resonance
RESO. 3
0–20
Filter 3 resonance
FREEZE
One input, one output basic sampler.
Parameter
Range
Description
REC MODE
MANUAL, INPUT
In MANUAL mode, recording is started by pressing the REC and
PLAY buttons. In INPUT mode, Record-Ready mode is engaged by
pressing the REC button, and actual recording is triggered by the
input signal.
REC DLY
–1000 to +1000 ms
Recording delay. For plus values, recording starts after the trigger is
received. For minus values, recording starts before the trigger is
received.
TRG LVL
–60 to 0 dB
Input trigger level (i.e., the signal level required to trigger recording
or playback)
TRG MASK
0–1000 ms
Once playback has been triggered, subsequent triggers are ignored
for the duration of the TRG MASK time.
PLY MODE
MOMENT, CONTI.,
INPUT
In MOMENT mode, the sample plays only while the that the PLAY
button is pressed. In CONT mode, playback continues once the
PLAY button has been pressed. The number of times the sample
plays is set using the LOOP NUM parameter. In INPUT mode, playback is triggered by the input signal.
START
1
Playback start point in milliseconds
END
1
Playback end point in milliseconds
LOOP
1
Loop start point in milliseconds
LOOP
NUM
0–100
Number of times the sample plays
START
[SAMPLE]
0–262000
Playback start point in samples
END
[SAMPLE]
0–262000
Playback end point in samples
LOOP
[SAMPLE]
0–262000
Loop start point in samples
PITCH
–12 to +12 semitones
Playback pitch shift
FINE
–50 to +50 cents
Playback pitch shift fine
MIDI TRG
OFF, C1–C6, ALL
PLAY button can be triggered by using MIDI Note on/off messages.
1. 0.0–5941.0 ms (fs=44.1 kHz), 0.0 ms–5458.3 ms (fs=48 kHz), 0.0–2970.5 ms (fs=88.2 kHz),
0.0 ms–2729.2 ms (fs=96 kHz)
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
326
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
ST REVERB
Two input, two output stereo reverb.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
REV TYPE
Hall, Room, Stage, Plate
Reverb type
INI. DLY
0.0–100.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
LO. RATIO
0.1–2.4
Low-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Reverb diffusion (left–right reverb spread)
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
E/R BAL.
0–100%
Balance of early reflections and reverb
(0% = all reverb, 100% = all early reflections)
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REVERB 5.1
One input, six output reverb for 5.1 surround, with surround panning.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
REV TYPE
Hall, Room, Stage, Plate
Reverb type
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Reverb diffusion (left–right reverb spread)
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DIV.
0–100%
Divergence determines how the front center signal is fed to the
Left, Right, and Center channels. When set to 0%, it’s fed only to
the Left and Right channels (i.e., Phantom Center). When set to
50%, it’s fed equally to the Left, Right, and Center channels. When
set to 100%, it’s fed to only the Center channel (i.e., Real Center).
ROOMSIZE
0.1–20.0
Size of simulated room’s reverb
POS L/R
L63–R63
Left/right listening position
POS F/R
F63–R63
Front/rear listening position
POS CTRL
OFF, NORMAL, INVERT
1
ER L/R
L63–R63
Left/right early reflections position
ER F/R
F63–R63
Front/rear early reflections position
ER LVL
0–100%
Early reflections level
ER CTRL
OFF, NORMAL, INVERT
1
REV L/R
L63–R63
Left/right reverb position
REV F/R
F63–R63
Front/rear reverb position
REV LVL
0–100%
Reverb level
REV CTRL
OFF, NORMAL, INVERT
1
POS RAD.
0–63
Radius of the panning track at the listening position
ER RAD.
0–63
Radius of the panning track for early reflections
REV RAD.
0–63
Radius of the panning track for reverb
1. When set to NOR, the position can be set by using the Joystick so long as the SELECTED CHANNEL PAN/SURROUND [EFFECT] button’s indicator is on. When set to INV, the Joystick will work inversely. When set to OFF,
Joystick control is off. The CTRL button on the Effect Edit page works the same as the [EFFECT] button.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Effects Parameters
327
OCTA REVERB
Eight input, eight output reverb.
Parameter
Range
Description
REV TIME
0.3–99.0 s
Reverb time
REV TYPE
Hall, Room, Stage, Plate
Reverb type
INI. DLY
0.0–100.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO
0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time ratio
LO. RATIO
0.1–2.4
Low-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF.
0–10
Reverb diffusion (left–right reverb spread)
DENSITY
0–100%
Reverb density
E/R BAL.
0–100%
Balance of early reflections and reverb
(0% = all reverb, 100% = all early reflections)
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
AUTO PAN 5.1
Six input, six output autopanner for 5.1 surround. You can reset to the pan position specified by
the OFFSET parameter by pressing the RESET button.
Parameter
Range
Description
SOURCE
OFF, HOLD, INPUT1,
INPUT2, INPUT3,
INPUT4, INPUT5,
INPUT6, MIDI
When set to OFF, the TRIGGER button is used to start autopan.
When set to HOLD, autopan runs continuously. When set to INPUT
1–6, the specified channel’s input signal triggers autopan. When set
to MIDI, a MIDI Note On message can be used to trigger autopan.
TRIG. LVL
–60 to 0 dB
Input trigger level (i.e., the signal level required to trigger panning
when SOURCE set to INPUT)
TRG MASK
0–1000 ms
Trigger Mask specifies the time from when a trigger is received until
the next trigger will be accepted.
TIME
0.0 s–10.0 s
The time after which autopan starts once it’s been triggered
SPEED
0.05 Hz–40.00 Hz
Autopan speed
DIR.
Turn L, Turn R
Autopan direction
OFFSET
–180 to +180 degrees
Pan offset
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
CHORUS 5.1
Six input, six output chorus for 5.1 surround.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
Modulation speed
AM DEPTH
0–100%
Amplitude modulation depth
PM DEPTH
0–100%
Pitch modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–400.0 ms
Modulation delay time
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
328
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
FLANGE 5.1
Six input, six output flanger for 5.1 surround.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation speed
Modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–400.0 ms
Modulation delay time
FB. GAIN
–99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for normal-phase feedback, minus values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
SYMPHO 5.1
Six input, six output symphonic effect for 5.1 surround.
Parameter
Range
Description
FREQ.
0.05–40.00 Hz
DEPTH
0–100%
Modulation depth
MOD. DLY
0.0–400.0 ms
Modulation delay time
WAVE
Sine, Tri
Modulation waveform
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC
OFF/ON
Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO to determine FREQ.
1.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Modulation speed
Effects Parameters
329
M. BAND DYNA.
Two input, two output 3-band dynamics processor, with individual solo and gain reduction metering for each band.
Parameter
Range
Description
LOW GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
Low band level
MID GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
Mid band level
HI. GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
High band level
PRESENCE
–10 to +10
For positive values, the threshold of the high band is lowered and
the threshold of the low band is increased. For negative values, the
opposite will occur. When set to 0, all three bands are affected the
same.
CMP. THRE
–24.0 dB to 0.0 dB
Compressor threshold
CMP. RAT
1:1 to 20:1
Compressor ratio
CMP. ATK
0–120 ms
Compressor attack
CMP. REL
1
Compressor release time
CMP. KNEE
0–5
Compressor knee
LOOKUP
0.0–100.0 ms
Lookup delay
CMP. BYP
ON/OFF
Compressor bypass
L–M XOVR
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low/mid crossover frequency
M–H XOVR
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Mid/high crossover frequency
SLOPE
–6 dB, –12 dB
Filter slope
CEILING
–6.0 dB to 0.0 dB, OFF
Specifies the maximum output level
EXP. THRE
–54.0 dB to –24.0 dB
Expander threshold
EXP. RAT
1:1 to ∞:1
Expander ratio
EXP. REL
1
Expander release time
EXP. BYP
ON/OFF
Expander bypass
LIM. THRE
–12.0 dB to 0.0 dB
Limiter threshold
LIM. ATK
0–120 ms
Limiter attack
LIM. REL
1
Limiter release time
LIM. BYP
ON/OFF
Limiter bypass
LIM. KNEE
0–5
Limiter knee
1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz), 3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
330
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
COMP 5.1
Six input, six output compressor for 5.1 surround, with individual solo for each band, and gain
reduction metering of left and right (L+R), left surround and right surround (LS+RS), center (C),
or LFE channels.
Parameter
Range
Description
LOW GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
Low band level
MID GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
Mid band level
HI. GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
High band level
PRESENCE
–10 to +10
For positive values, the threshold of the high band is lowered and the
threshold of the low band is increased. For negative values, the opposite will occur. When set to 0, all three bands are affected the same.
THRE
–24.0 dB to 0.0 dB
Compressor threshold
RATIO
1:1 to ∞:1
Compressor ratio
ATTACK
0–120 ms
Attack
RELEASE
1
Expander release time
KNEE
0–5
Compressor knee
LOOKUP
0.0–100.0 ms
Lookup delay
KEY LINK
2
Key-in linking
L–M XOVR
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low/mid crossover frequency
M–H XOVR
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Mid/high crossover frequency
SLOPE
–6 dB, –12 dB
Filter slope
CEILING
–6.0 dB to 0.0 dB, OFF
Specifies the maximum output level
1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz), 3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
2. 5.1: key-in of all inputs are linked. 5.0: key-in of the L, C, R, LS, and RS are linked (LFE is independent). 3+2: key-in
of L, C, and R are linked, and LS and RS are linked. 2+2: key-in of L and R are linked, and LS and RS are linked.
COMPAND 5.1
Six input, six output compander for 5.1 surround, with individual solo for each band, and gain
reduction metering of left and right (L+R), left surround and right surround (LS+RS), center (C),
or LFE channels.
Parameter
Range
Description
LOW GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
Low band level
MID GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
Mid band level
HI. GAIN
–96.0 to +12.0 dB
High band level
PRESENCE
–10 to +10
For positive values, the threshold of the high band is lowered and the
threshold of the low band is increased. For negative values, the opposite will occur. When set to 0, all three bands are affected the same.
THRE
–24.0 dB to 0.0 dB
Compressor threshold
RATIO
1:1 to 20:1
Compressor ratio
ATTACK
0–120 ms
Compressor attack
WIDTH
1–90 dB
Width before the expander operates
TYPE
Soft, Hard
Compander type
LOOKUP
0.0–100.0 ms
Lookup delay
KEY LINK
1
Key-in linking
L–M XOVR
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Low/mid crossover frequency
M–H XOVR
21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
Mid/high crossover frequency
SLOPE
–6 dB, –12 dB
Filter slope
CEILING
–6.0 dB to 0.0 dB, OFF
Specifies the maximum output level
1. 5.1: key-in of all inputs are linked. 5.0: key-in of the L, C, R, LS, and RS are linked (LFE is independent). 3+2: key-in
of L, C, and R are linked, and LS and RS are linked. 2+2: key-in of L and R are linked, and LS and RS are linked.
Other preset effects (COMP276, COMP276S, COMP260, COMP260S, EQUALIZER601, OPENDECK, REV-X HALL, REV-X HALL, REV-X ROOM, REV-X PLATE) are optional Add-On
Effects. For more information on these effects, refer to the Owner’s Manual that comes with the
Add-On Effects package.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Effects and tempo synchronization
331
Effects and tempo synchronization
Some of the DM2000’s effects allow you to synchronize the effect with the tempo. There are two such types of effect; delay-type
effects and modulation-type effects. For delay-type effects, the delay time will change according to the tempo. For modulation-type
effects, the frequency of the modulation signal will change according to the tempo.
• Parameters related to tempo synchronization
The following five parameters are related to tempo synchronization.
1) SYNC 2) NOTE 3) TEMPO 4) DELAY 5) FREQ.
SYNC: ............................ This is the on/off switch for tempo synchronization.
NOTE and TEMPO:..... These are the basic parameters for tempo synchronization.
DELAY and FREQ.: ...... DELAY is the delay time, and FREQ. is the frequency of the modulation signal. These directly affect
the way in which the effect sound will change. DELAY is relevant only for delay-type effects, and
FREQ. is relevant only for modulation-type effects.
• How the parameters are related
Tempo synchronization uses TEMPO and NOTE to calculate a value that will be the basis for the tempo, and continues making
adjustments so that this tempo basis stays essentially the same as the DELAY (or FREQ.). This means that when TEMPO, NOTE,
and DELAY (or FREQ.) are synchronized, and you change any of these values, the other parameters will be re-set in order to
maintain the correct relationship. The parameters that are re-set and the calculation method(*a) used are as follows.
If you turn SYNC on → NOTE will be set
If you edit DELAY (or FREQ.) → NOTE will be set
In this case, the NOTE value is calculated as follows.
NOTE = DELAY (or FREQ.)/(4 x (60/TEMPO))
If you edit NOTE → DELAY (or FREQ.) will be set
In this case, the DELAY (or FREQ.) value is calculated as follows.
DELAY (or FREQ.) = NOTE x 4 x (60/TEMPO)
If you edit TEMPO → DELAY (or FREQ.) will be set
In this case, the DELAY (or FREQ.) value is calculated as follows.
DELAY (or FREQ.) = original DELAY (or FREQ.) x (previous TEMPO/new TEMPO)
Example 1: When SYNC=ON, DELAY=250 ms, TEMPO=120, you change NOTE from 8th note to quarter note
DELAY= new NOTE x 4 x (60/TEMPO)
= (1/4) x 4 x (60/120)
= 0.5 (sec)
= 500 ms
Thus, the DELAY will change from 250 ms to 500 ms.
Example 2: When SYNC=ON, DELAY=250 ms, NOTE=8th note, you change TEMPO from 120 to 121
DELAY= original DELAY x (previous TEMPO/new TEMPO)
= 250 x (120/121)
= 247.9 (ms)
Thus, the TEMPO will change from 250 ms to 247.9 ms.
*a Rounded values are used for the calculation results.
• Ranges of the NOTE and TEMPO values
The ranges of the NOTE and TEMPO values are limited by the ranges of the DELAY or FREQ. values. You cannot set NOTE or
TEMPO values that would cause DELAY or FREQ. to exceed their maximum possible values when synchronized to tempo. This
limitation also applies even when SYNC is OFF.
• Special characteristics of the TEMPO parameter
The TEMPO parameter has the following characteristics that are unlike other parameters.
• It is a common value shared by all effects
• You cannot stored it to or recall it from the Effects Library. (You can store it to and recall it from a Scene.)
This means that the TEMPO value may not necessarily be the same when an effect is recalled as when that effect was stored. Here
is an example.
Store the effect: TEMPO=120 → Change TEMPO to 60 → Recall the effect: TEMPO=60
Normally when you change the TEMPO, the DELAY (or FREQ.) will be re-set accordingly. However if the DELAY (or FREQ.)
were changed, the effect would sound differently when recalled than when it was stored. To prevent the effect from changing in
this way between store and recall, the DM2000 does not update the DELAY (or FREQ.) value when an effect is recalled, even if
the TEMPO is no longer the same as when that effect was stored.
* The NOTE parameter is calculated based on the following values.
= 1/48
= 1/24
= 1/16
= 1/12
= 3/32
= 1/8
= 1/6
= 3/16
= 1/4
= 3/8
= 1/2
= 3/4
= 1/1
= 2/1
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
332
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Preset EQ Parameters
#
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
Parameter
Title
Bass Drum 1
Bass Drum 2
Snare Drum
1
Snare Drum
2
Tom-tom 1
Cymbal
High Hat
Percussion
E. Bass 1
E. Bass 2
Syn. Bass 1
Syn. Bass 2
LOW
L-MID
H-MID
HIGH
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+3.5 dB
–3.5 dB
0.0 dB
+4.0 dB
F
100 Hz
265 Hz
1.06 kHz
5.30 kHz
Q
1.2
10
0.9
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
LPF
G
+8.0 dB
–7.0 dB
+6.0 dB
ON
F
80 Hz
400 Hz
2.50 kHz
12.5 kHz
Q
1.4
4.5
2.2
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–0.5 dB
0.0 dB
+3.0 dB
+4.5 dB
F
132 Hz
1.00 kHz
3.15 kHz
5.00 kHz
Q
1.2
4.5
0.11
—
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
+1.5 dB
–8.5 dB
+2.5 dB
+4.0 dB
F
180 Hz
335 Hz
2.36 kHz
4.00 kHz
Q
—
10
0.7
0.1
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
+2.0 dB
–7.5 dB
+2.0 dB
+1.0 dB
F
212 Hz
670 Hz
4.50 kHz
6.30 kHz
Q
1.4
10
1.2
0.28
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–2.0 dB
0.0 dB
0.0 dB
+3.0 dB
F
106 Hz
425 Hz
1.06 kHz
13.2 kHz
Q
—
8
0.9
—
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–4.0 dB
–2.5 dB
+1.0 dB
+0.5 dB
F
95 Hz
425 Hz
2.80 kHz
7.50 kHz
Q
—
0.5
1
—
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–4.5 dB
0.0 dB
+2.0 dB
0.0 dB
F
100 Hz
400 Hz
2.80 kHz
17.0 kHz
Q
—
4.5
0.56
—
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–7.5 dB
+4.5 dB
+2.5 dB
0.0 dB
F
35.5 Hz
112 Hz
2.00 kHz
4.00 kHz
Q
—
5
4.5
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+3.0 dB
0.0 dB
+2.5 dB
+0.5 dB
F
112 Hz
112 Hz
2.24 kHz
4.00 kHz
Q
0.1
5
6.3
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+3.5 dB
+8.5 dB
0.0 dB
0.0 dB
F
85 Hz
950 Hz
4.00 kHz
12.5 kHz
Q
0.1
8
4.5
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+2.5 dB
0.0 dB
+1.5 dB
0.0 dB
F
125 Hz
180 Hz
1.12 kHz
12.5 kHz
Q
1.6
8
2.2
—
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
#
13
Parameter
Title
Piano 1
Piano 2
E. G. Clean
E. G. Crunch
1
E. G. Crunch
2
PEAKING
0.0 dB
+2.0 dB
+4.0 dB
F
95 Hz
950 Hz
3.15 kHz
7.50 kHz
—
8
0.9
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+3.5 dB
–8.5 dB
+1.5 dB
+3.0 dB
F
224 Hz
600 Hz
3.15 kHz
5.30 kHz
5.6
10
0.7
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+2.0 dB
–5.5 dB
+0.5 dB
+2.5 dB
F
265 Hz
400 Hz
1.32 kHz
4.50 kHz
E. G. Dist. 1
E. G. Dist. 2
A. G. Stroke
1
A. G. Stroke
2
0.0 dB
+4.0 dB
+2.0 dB
1.00 kHz
1.90 kHz
5.60 kHz
8
4.5
0.63
9
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+2.5 dB
+1.5 dB
+2.5 dB
0.0 dB
F
125 Hz
450 Hz
3.35 kHz
19.0 kHz
A. G. Arpeg.
1
A. G. Arpeg.
2
Brass Sec.
0.16
—
PEAKING
H.SHELF
+5.0 dB
0.0 dB
+3.5 dB
0.0 dB
355 Hz
950 Hz
3.35 kHz
12.5 kHz
—
9
10
—
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+6.0 dB
–8.5 dB
+4.5 dB
+4.0 dB
F
315 Hz
1.06 kHz
4.25 kHz
12.5 kHz
—
10
4
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–2.0 dB
0.0 dB
+1.0 dB
+4.0 dB
F
106 Hz
1.00 kHz
1.90 kHz
5.30 kHz
0.9
4.5
3.5
—
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–3.5 dB
–2.0 dB
0.0 dB
+2.0 dB
F
300 Hz
750 Hz
2.00 kHz
3.55 kHz
—
9
4.5
—
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
–0.5 dB
0.0 dB
0.0 dB
+2.0 dB
F
224 Hz
1.00 kHz
4.00 kHz
6.70 kHz
—
4.5
4.5
0.12
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
0.0 dB
–5.5 dB
0.0 dB
+4.0 dB
F
180 Hz
355 Hz
4.00 kHz
4.25 kHz
Q
24
0.4
PEAKING
F
Q
23
8
L.SHELF
G
Q
22
—
PEAKING
140 Hz
Q
21
6.3
PEAKING
+4.5 dB
Q
20
10
PEAKING
F
Q
19
0.18
PEAKING
G
Q
18
H.SHELF
PEAKING
Q
17
HIGH
–6.0 dB
Q
16
H-MID
L.SHELF
Q
15
L-MID
G
Q
14
LOW
—
7
4.5
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
–2.0 dB
–1.0 dB
+1.5 dB
+3.0 dB
F
90 Hz
850 Hz
2.12 kHz
4.50 kHz
Q
2.8
2
0.7
7
Preset Gate Parameters (fs = 44.1 kHz)
#
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
Parameter
Title
Male Vocal
1
Male Vocal
2
Female Vo.
1
Female Vo.
2
Chorus &
Harmo
Total EQ 1
Total EQ 3
Bass Drum 3
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
0.0 dB
+2.0 dB
+3.5 dB
F
190 Hz
1.00 kHz
2.00 kHz
6.70 kHz
Q
0.11
4.5
0.56
0.11
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+2.0 dB
–5.0 dB
–2.5 dB
+4.0 dB
F
170 Hz
236 Hz
2.65 kHz
6.70 kHz
Q
0.11
10
5.6
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
–1.0 dB
+1.0 dB
+1.5 dB
+2.0 dB
F
118 Hz
400 Hz
2.65 kHz
6.00 kHz
Q
0.18
0.45
0.56
0.14
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–7.0 dB
+1.5 dB
+1.5 dB
+2.5 dB
F
112 Hz
335 Hz
2.00 kHz
6.70 kHz
Q
—
0.16
0.2
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
–2.0 dB
–1.0 dB
+1.5 dB
+3.0 dB
F
90 Hz
850 Hz
2.12 kHz
4.50 kHz
Q
2.8
2
0.7
7
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–0.5 dB
0.0 dB
+3.0 dB
+6.5 dB
F
95 Hz
950 Hz
2.12 kHz
16.0 kHz
Q
7
2.2
5.6
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
+4.0 dB
+1.5 dB
+2.0 dB
+6.0 dB
F
Snare Drum
3
Tom-tom 2
750 Hz
1.80 kHz
#
36
Parameter
Title
Piano 3
Piano Low
Piano High
Fine-EQ
Cass
Narrator
H.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
–13.0 dB
+4.5 dB
+2.5 dB
F
100 Hz
475 Hz
2.36 kHz
10.0 kHz
8
10
9
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–5.5 dB
+1.5 dB
+6.0 dB
0.0 dB
F
190 Hz
400 Hz
6.70 kHz
12.5 kHz
10
6.3
2.2
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
–5.5 dB
+1.5 dB
+5.0 dB
+3.0 dB
F
190 Hz
400 Hz
6.70 kHz
5.60 kHz
10
6.3
2.2
0.1
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–1.5 dB
0.0 dB
+1.0 dB
+3.0 dB
F
75 Hz
1.00 kHz
4.00 kHz
12.5 kHz
Q
40
HIGH
+4.5 dB
Q
39
H-MID
PEAKING
Q
38
L-MID
G
Q
37
LOW
—
4.5
1.8
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–4.0 dB
–1.0 dB
+2.0 dB
0.0 dB
F
106 Hz
710 Hz
2.50 kHz
10.0 kHz
Q
4
7
0.63
—
Preset Gate Parameters
(fs = 44.1 kHz)
#
Title
Type
18.0 kHz
7
2.8
5.6
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
+1.5 dB
+0.5 dB
+2.0 dB
+4.0 dB
F
67 Hz
850 Hz
1.90 kHz
15.0 kHz
—
0.28
0.7
—
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
+3.5 dB
–10.0 dB
+3.5 dB
0.0 dB
F
118 Hz
315 Hz
4.25 kHz
20.0 kHz
2
10
0.4
0.4
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
PEAKING
G
0.0 dB
+2.0 dB
+3.5 dB
0.0 dB
F
224 Hz
560 Hz
4.25 kHz
4.00 kHz
Q
35
95 Hz
L.SHELF
Q
34
HIGH
–0.5 dB
Q
33
H-MID
PEAKING
Q
32
L-MID
G
G
Total EQ 2
LOW
—
4.5
2.8
0.1
L.SHELF
PEAKING
PEAKING
H.SHELF
G
–9.0 dB
+1.5 dB
+2.0 dB
0.0 dB
F
90 Hz
212 Hz
5.30 kHz
17.0 kHz
Q
—
4.5
1.2
—
333
1
Gate
GATE
2
Ducking
DUCKING
3
A. Dr. BD
GATE
4
A. Dr. SN
GATE
Parameter
Value
Threshold (dB) –26
Range (dB)
–56
Attack (ms)
0
Hold (ms)
2.56
Decay (ms)
331
Threshold (dB) –19
Range (dB)
–22
Attack (ms)
93
Hold (ms)
1.20 S
Decay (ms)
6.32 S
Threshold (dB) –11
Range (dB)
–53
Attack (ms)
0
Hold (ms)
1.93
Decay (ms)
400
Threshold (dB)
–8
Range (dB)
–23
Attack (ms)
1
Hold (ms)
0.63
Decay (ms)
238
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
334
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Preset Compressor Parameters (fs = 44.1 kHz)
#
Title
1
Comp
2
Expand
3
Compander
(H)
4
Compander
(S)
5
A. Dr. BD
6
A. Dr. BD
7
A. Dr. SN
8
A. Dr. SN
9
A. Dr. SN
Type
Parameter
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
COMP
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
EXPAND
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
COMPAND-H
Out gain (dB)
Width (dB)
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
COMPAND-S
Out gain (dB)
Width (dB)
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
COMP
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
COMPAND-H
Out gain (dB)
Width (dB)
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
COMP
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
EXPAND
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
COMPAND-S
Out gain (dB)
Width (dB)
Release (ms)
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Value
–8
2.5
60
0.0
2
250
–23
1.7
1
3.5
2
70
–10
3.5
1
0.0
6
250
–8
4
25
0.0
24
180
–24
3
9
5.5
2
58
–11
3.5
1
–1.5
7
192
–17
2.5
8
3.5
2
12
–23
2
0
0.5
2
151
–8
1.7
11
0.0
10
128
#
Title
Type
10
A. Dr. Tom
EXPAND
11
A. Dr.
OverTop
COMPAND-S
12
E. B. Finger
COMP
13
E. B. Slap
COMP
14
Syn. Bass
COMP
15
Piano1
COMP
16
Piano2
COMP
17
E. Guitar
COMP
18
A. Guitar
COMP
Parameter
Value
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Width (dB)
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
Threshold (dB)
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms)
Out gain (dB)
Knee
Release (ms)
–20
2
2
5.0
2
749
–24
2
38
–3.5
54
842
–12
2
15
4.5
2
470
–12
1.7
6
4.0
hard
133
–10
3.5
9
3.0
hard
250
–9
2.5
17
1.0
hard
238
–18
3.5
7
6.0
2
174
–8
3.5
7
2.5
4
261
–10
2.5
5
1.5
2
238
Preset Compressor Parameters (fs = 44.1 kHz)
#
Title
Type
19
Strings1
COMP
20
Strings2
COMP
21
Strings3
COMP
22
BrassSection
COMP
23
Syn. Pad
COMP
24
SamplingPerc COMPAND-S
25
Sampling BD
COMP
26
Sampling SN
COMP
27
Hip Comp
COMPAND-S
Parameter
Value
Threshold (dB) –11
Ratio ( :1)
2
Attack (ms)
33
Out gain (dB)
1.5
Knee
2
Release (ms)
749
Threshold (dB) –12
Ratio ( :1)
1.5
Attack (ms)
93
Out gain (dB)
1.5
Knee
4
Release (ms)
1.35 S
Threshold (dB) –17
Ratio ( :1)
1.5
Attack (ms)
76
Out gain (dB)
2.5
Knee
2
Release (ms)
186
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1)
1.7
Attack (ms)
18
Out gain (dB)
4.0
Knee
1
Release (ms)
226
Threshold (dB) –13
Ratio ( :1)
2
Attack (ms)
58
Out gain (dB)
2.0
Knee
1
Release (ms)
238
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1)
1.7
Attack (ms)
8
Out gain (dB)
–2.5
Width (dB)
18
Release (ms)
238
Threshold (dB) –14
Ratio ( :1)
2
Attack (ms)
2
Out gain (dB)
3.5
Knee
4
Release (ms)
35
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1)
4
Attack (ms)
8
Out gain (dB)
8.0
Knee
hard
Release (ms)
354
Threshold (dB) –23
Ratio ( :1)
20
Attack (ms)
15
Out gain (dB)
0.0
Width (dB)
15
Release (ms)
163
#
Title
28
Solo Vocal1
29
Solo Vocal2
30
Chorus
31
Click Erase
32
Announcer
33
Limiter1
34
Limiter2
35
Total Comp1
36
Total Comp2
Type
Parameter
335
Value
Threshold (dB) –20
Ratio ( :1)
2.5
Attack (ms)
31
COMP
Out gain (dB)
2.0
Knee
1
Release (ms)
342
Threshold (dB)
–8
Ratio ( :1)
2.5
Attack (ms)
26
COMP
Out gain (dB)
1.5
Knee
3
Release (ms)
331
Threshold (dB)
–9
Ratio ( :1)
1.7
Attack (ms)
39
COMP
Out gain (dB)
2.5
Knee
2
Release (ms)
226
Threshold (dB) –33
Ratio ( :1)
2
Attack (ms)
1
EXPAND
Out gain (dB)
2.0
Knee
2
Release (ms)
284
Threshold (dB) –14
Ratio ( :1)
2.5
Attack (ms)
1
COMPAND-H
Out gain (dB)
–2.5
Width (dB)
18
Release (ms)
180
Threshold (dB)
–9
Ratio ( :1)
3
Attack (ms)
20
COMPAND-S
Out gain (dB)
–3.0
Width (dB)
90
Release (ms)
3.90 s
Threshold (dB)
0
Ratio ( :1)
∞
Attack (ms)
0
COMP
Out gain (dB)
0.0
Knee
hard
Release (ms)
319
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1)
3.5
Attack (ms)
94
COMP
Out gain (dB)
2.5
Knee
hard
Release (ms)
447
Threshold (dB) –16
Ratio ( :1)
6
Attack (ms)
11
COMP
Out gain (dB)
6.0
Knee
1
Release (ms)
180
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
336
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Dynamics Parameters
The dynamics effects for each channel strip include a Gate section (only for Input Channels) and a Comp section. The Gate section includes Gate and Ducking types. The Comp
section includes Compressor, Expander, Compander Hard (COMP. (H)), and Compander
Soft (COMP. (S)) types.
GATE Section (Only for Input Channels)
GATE
A gate attenuates signals below a set THRESHOLD level by a specified amount (RANGE).
Parameter
Range
Description
THRESHOLD (dB)
–54.0 to 0.0 (541 points)
This determines the level at which the gate effect
is applied.
RANGE (dB)
–70 to 0 (71 points)
This determines the amount of attenuation when
the gate closes.
ATTACK (ms)
0–120 (121 points)
This determines how fast the gate opens when the
signal exceeds the threshold level.
HOLD (ms)
44.1kHz: 0.02 ms – 2.13 sec
48kHz: 0.02 ms – 1.96 sec
88.2kHz: 0.01 ms – 1.06 sec
96kHz: 0.01 ms – 981 ms
(160 points)
This determines how long the gate stays open
once the trigger signal has fallen below the threshold.
DECAY (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec
(160 points)
This determines how fast the gate closes once the
hold time has expired. The value is expressed as
the duration required for the level to change by
6 dB.
I/O Characteristics
Time Series Analysis
Output Signal
THRESHOLD
Output Level
Input Level
Output Level
Input Signal
ATTACK
HOLD
DECAY
THRESHOLD
RANGE
RANGE
Input Level
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Time
Time
337
Dynamics Parameters
DUCKING
Ducking is commonly used for voice-over applications in which the background music
level is reduced automatically when an announcer speaks. When the KEY IN source signal
level exceeds the specified THRESHOLD, the output level is attenuated by a specified
amount (RANGE).
Parameter
Range
Description
THRESHOLD (dB)
–54.0 to 0.0 (541 points)
This determines the level of trigger signal (KEY IN)
required to activate ducking.
RANGE (dB)
–70 to 0 (71 points)
This determines the amount of attenuation when
ducking is activated.
ATTACK (ms)
0–120 (121 points)
This determines how soon the signal is ducked
once the ducker has been triggered.
HOLD (ms)
44.1kHz: 0.02 ms – 2.13 sec
48kHz: 0.02 ms – 1.96 sec
88.2kHz: 0.01 ms – 1.06 sec
96kHz: 0.01 ms – 981 ms
(160 points)
This determines how long ducking remains active
once the trigger signal has fallen below the
THRESHOLD level.
DECAY (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec
(160 points)
This determines how soon the ducker returns to its
normal gain once the trigger signal level drops
below the threshold. The value is expressed as the
duration required for the level to change by 6 dB.
I/O Characteristics
Time Series Analysis
Output Level
Output Signal
Input Level
Output Level
Input Signal
THRESHOLD
ATTACK
HOLD
DECAY
THRESHOLD
RANGE
RANGE
Input Level
Time
Time
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
338
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
COMP Section
COMP
The COMP processor attenuates signals above a specified THRESHOLD by a specified
RATIO. The COMP processor can also be used as a limiter, which, with a RATIO of ∞:1,
reduces the level to the threshold. This means that the limiter’s output level never actually
exceeds the threshold.
Parameter
Range
Description
THRESHOLD (dB)
–54.0 to 0.0 (541 points)
This determines the level of input signal required to
trigger the compressor.
RATIO
1.0:1, 1.1:1, 1.3:1, 1.5:1,
1.7:1, 2.0:1, 2.5:1, 3.0:1,
3.5:1, 4.0:1, 5.0:1, 6.0:1,
8.0:1, 10:1, 20:1, ∞:1
(16 points)
This determines the amount of compression, that
is, the change in output signal level relative to
change in input signal level.
ATTACK (ms)
0–120 (121 points)
This determines how soon the signal will be compressed once the compressor has been triggered.
RELEASE (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec
(160 points)
This determines how soon the compressor returns
to its normal gain once the trigger signal level
drops below the threshold. The value is expressed
as the duration required for the level to change by
6 dB.
OUT GAIN (dB)
0.0 to +18.0 (180 points)
This sets the compressor's output signal level.
KNEE
Hard, 1–5 (6 points)
This determines how compression is applied at the
threshold. For higher knee settings, compression is
applied gradually as the signal exceeds the specified threshold, creating a more natural sound.
I/O Characteristics
(KNEE=hard, OUT GAIN=0.0dB)
Time Series Analysis (RATIO=∞:1)
RATIO
Output Level
THRESHOLD
Output Signal
Input Level
Output Level
Input signal
ATTACK
RELEASE
THRESHOLD
Input Level
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Time
Time
Dynamics Parameters
339
EXPAND
An expander attenuates signals below a specified THRESHOLD by a specified RATIO.
Parameter
Range
Description
THRESHOLD (dB)
–54.0 to 0.0 (541 points)
This determines the level of input signal required to
trigger the expander.
RATIO
1.0:1, 1.1:1, 1.3:1, 1.5:1,
1.7:1, 2.0:1, 2.5:1, 3.0:1,
3.5:1, 4.0:1, 5.0:1, 6.0:1,
8.0:1, 10:1, 20:1, ∞:1
(16 points)
This determines the amount of expansion.
ATTACK (ms)
0–120 (121 points)
This determines how soon the expander returns to
its normal gain once the trigger signal level exceeds
the threshold.
RELEASE (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec
(160 points)
This determines how soon the signal is expanded
once the signal level drops below the threshold.
The value is expressed as the duration required for
the level to change by 6 dB.
OUT GAIN (dB)
0.0 to +18.0 (180 points)
This sets the expander's output signal level.
Hard, 1–5 (6 points)
This determines how expansion is applied at the
threshold. For higher knee settings, expansion is
applied gradually as the signal falls below the specified threshold, creating a more natural sound.
KNEE
I/O Characteristics
(KNEE=hard, OUT GAIN=0.0dB)
Time Series Analysis (RATIO=∞:1)
Output Level
THRESHOLD
Output Signal
Input Level
Output Level
Input Signal
ATTACK
RELEASE
THRESHOLD
RATIO
Input Level
Time
Time
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
340
Appendix A: Parameter Lists
Output Level
COMPANDER HARD (H)
COMPANDER SOFT (S)
The hard and soft companders combine the effects of the compressor, expander and limiter.
THRESHOLD
0dB
Input Level
WIDTH
The companders function differently at the following levels:
1 0 dB and higher.....................................Functions as a limiter.
2 Exceeding the threshold .......................Functions as a compressor.
3 Below the threshold and width............Functions as an expander.
The hard compander has an expansion ratio of 5:1, while the soft compander has an expansion ratio of 1.5:1. The expander is essentially turned off when the width is set to maximum.
The compressor has a fixed knee setting of 2.
* The gain is automatically adjusted according to the ratio and threshold values, and can
be increased by up to 18 dB.
* The OUT GAIN parameter enables you to compensate for the overall level change
caused by the compression and expansion processes.
Parameter
Range
Description
THRESHOLD (dB)
–54.0 to 0.0 (541 points)
This determines the level at which compression is
applied.
RATIO
1.0:1, 1.1:1, 1.3:1, 1.5:1,
1.7:1, 2.0:1, 2.5:1, 3.0:1,
3.5:1, 4.0:1, 5.0:1, 6.0:1,
8.0:1, 10:1, 20:1, (15 points)
This determines the amount of compression.
ATTACK (ms)
0–120 (121 points)
This determines how soon the signal is compressed or expanded once the compander has
been triggered.
RELEASE (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec
(160 points)
This determines how soon the compressor or
expander returns to the normal gain once the
trigger signal level drops below or exceeds the
threshold respectively. The value is expressed as
the duration required for the level to change by
6 dB.
OUT GAIN (dB)
–18.0 to 0.0 (180 points)
This sets the compander's output signal level.
0–90 (91 points)
This determines how far below the threshold
expansion will be applied. The expander is activated when the level drops below the threshold
and width.
WIDTH (dB)
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
General Spec
341
Appendix B: Specifications
General Spec
Number of scene memories
99
Internal
Sampling Frequency
External
Normal rate: 44.1 kHz–10% to 48 kHz+6%
Double rate: 88.2 kHz–10% to 96 kHz+6%
Less than 2.3 ms CH INPUT to STEREO OUT (fs=48 kHz)
Signal Delay
Less than 1.2 ms CH INPUT to STEREO OUT (fs=96 kHz)
100 mm motorized with touch sense × 25
Fader
+10 to –138, –∞dB input faders (10bit fader data)
Fader Resolution
Total Harmonic Distortion1
(CH INPUT to STEREO OUT)
(Input Gain=Min.)
44.1 kHz, 48 kHz, 88.2 kHz, 96 kHz
0 to –138, –∞dB master fader (10bit fader data)
fs=48 kHz
Less than 0.05% 20 Hz to 20 kHz @ +14 dB into 600 Ω
Less than 0.01% 1 kHz @ +18 dB into 600 Ω
fs=96 kHz
Less than 0.05% 20 Hz to 40 kHz @ +14 dB into 600 Ω
Less than 0.01% 1 kHz @ +18 dB into 600 Ω
20 Hz–20 kHz, 0.5, –1.5 dB @ +4 dB into 600 Ω (fs=48 kHz)
Frequency Response
(CH INPUT to STEREO OUT)
20 Hz–40 kHz, 0.5, –1.5 dB @ +4 dB into 600 Ω (fs=96 kHz)
110 dB typ. DA Converter (STEREO OUT)
Dynamic Range
(maximum level to noise level)
108 dB typ. AD+DA (to STEREO OUT) @ fs=48 kHz
106 dB typ. AD+DA (to STEREO OUT) @ fs=96 kHz
–128 dB Equivalent Input Noise
Hum & Noise2
(20 Hz–20 kHz)
–92 dB residual output noise. STEREO OUT (STEREO OUT off)
–92 dB (96 dB S/N) STEREO OUT (STEREO fader at nominal level and all
CH INPUT faders at minimum level)
Rs=150 Ω
Input Gain=Max.
Input Pad =0 dB
–64 dB (68 dB S/N) STEREO OUTPUT (STEREO fader at nominal level and
one CH INPUT fader at nominal level)
74 dB CH INPUT (CH1–24) to STEREO OUT/OMNI (BUS) OUT
74 dB CH INPUT (CH1–24) to OMNI (AUX) OUT (via pre input fader)
Maximum Voltage Gain
74 dB CH INPUT (CH1–24) to CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT (via STEREO bus)
Crosstalk
(@ 1 kHz)
–80 dB adjacent input channels (CH1–24)
–80 dB input to output
Input Gain=Min.
Phantom switch
+48 V DC is supplied to A (XLR-3-31 type) input
Pad switch
0/26 dB attenuation
Gain control
44 dB (–60 to –16), detented
Peak indicator
LED (red) turns on when post HA level reaches 3 dB below clipping
Signal indicator
LED (green) turns on when post HA level reaches 20 dB below nominal
Insert
OUT, IN (pre AD converter)
Insert switch
on/off
AD converter
24-bit linear, 128-times oversampling (fs=48 kHz)
Analog Input
(2TR IN ANALOG 1, 2)
AD converter
24-bit linear, 128-times oversampling (fs=48 kHz)
Option Input (SLOT 1–6)
Available cards
Optional digital interface cards (MY16, MY8, MY4 series)
Digital Input
(2TR IN DIGITAL 1–3)
SRC
On/off (1:3 and 3:1 maximum input to output sample rate ratio)
AD Input (1–24: A/B)
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
342
Appendix B: Specifications
Input patch
—
Phase
Normal/reverse
On/off
Gate-type3
Key in: 12 ch Group (1–12, 13–24, 25–36, 37–48, 49–60, 61–72, 73–84,
85–96)/AUX1–12
On/off
Comp-type4
Key in: self /Stereo Link
Pre EQ/pre fader/post fader
Attenuator
EQ
Input Channel CH1–96
0–43400 samples
—
Fader
100 mm motorized (INPUT/AUX1–12)
Pan
OMNI OUT 1–8
CONTROL ROOM
MONITOR OUT (LARGE,
SMALL)
STUDIO MONITOR OUT
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
AUX1–12; pre fader/post fader
On/off
Pre fader/after pan
127 positions (Left= 1–63, Center, Right= 1–63)
127 × 127 positions
LFE level
–∞, –96 dB to +10 dB (256 step)
Routing
STEREO, BUS1–8, DIRECT OUT
Direct out
Pre EQ/pre fader/post fader
Displayed on LCD
Peak hold on/off
Level control
Analog rotary potentiometer
AD converter
24-bit linear, 128-times oversampling
Talkback select
Built-in microphone/AD IN 1–24
On/off
—
Slate
On/off
Level
0 to –96 dB (1 dB step)
On/off
—
Waveform
Sine 100 Hz, sine 1 kHz, sine 10 kHz, pink noise, burst noise
Routing
BUS1–8, AUX1–12, MATRIX 1L–4R, STEREO L, R
DA converter
24-bit linear, 128-times oversampling
Output patch
SURROUND MONITOR, STEREO, BUS1–8, AUX1–12, MATRIX 1L–4R,
DIRECT OUT 1–96, INSERT OUT (CH1–96, BUS1–8, AUX1–12,
MATRIX 1L–4R, STEREO)
DA converter
24-bit linear, 128-times oversampling
Monitor select
STEREO, 2TR IN DIGITAL 1, 2TR IN DIGITAL 2, 2TR IN DIGITAL 3, 2TR I N
ANALOG 1, 2TR IN ANALOG 2, ASSIGN 1, 2 (BUS 1–8/AUX 1–12/MATRIX
1–4)
Solo contrast
–96 to 0 dB (1 dB step)
Mono
On/off
Dimmer
On/off
DA converter
24-bit linear, 128-times oversampling
Level control
Analog rotary potentiometer
Phones level
Analog rotary potentiometer
Small trim
Analog rotary potentiometer
Monitor select
CONTROL ROOM, STEREO, AUX 11, AUX 12
DA converter
24-bit linear, 128-times oversampling
Level control
Analog rotary potentiometer
Dither
2TR OUT DIGITAL 1–3
On/off
Surround pan
Metering
STEREO OUT
On/off
On/off
Solo
OSCILLATOR
4-band PEQ5
Delay
Aux send
TALKBACK
–96.0 to +12.0 dB (0.1 dB step)
On/off
Word length 16, 20, 24-bit
Output patch
STEREO, BUS1–8, AUX 1–12, MATRIX 1L–4R, DIRECT OUT 1–96, INSERT
OUT, CONTROL ROOM
SRC
On/off (1:3 and 3:1 maximum input to output sample rate ratio)
General Spec
Option Output (SLOT 1–6)
343
Available card
Optional digital interface card (MY16, MY8, MY4 series)
Output patch
SURROUND MONITOR, STEREO, BUS1–8, AUX1–12, MATRIX 1L–4R,
DIRECT OUT 1–96, INSERT OUT (CH1–96, BUS1–8, AUX1–12, MATRIX
1L–4R, STEREO)
Dither
Memory card slot
On/off
Word length 16/20/24-bit
SmartMedia
Comp-type4
Attenuator
EQ
On/off
Pre EQ/pre fader/post fader
–96.0 to +12.0 dB (0.1 dB step)
4-band PEQ5
On/off
On/off
STEREO
Fader
100 mm motorized
Balance
127 positions (Left=1–63, Center, Right=1–63)
Delay
0–43400 samples
Pre fader/post fader
Matrix send
Level (–∞, –96 dB to +10 dB)
Pan: 127 positions (Left=1–63, Center, Right=1–63)
Metering
Comp-type4
Attenuator
EQ
BUS1–8
Displayed on LCD
Peak hold on/off
On/off
Pre EQ/pre fader/post fader
–96.0 to +12.0 dB (0.1 dB step)
4-band PEQ5
On/off
On/off
—
Fader
100 mm motorized
Delay
0–43400 samples
Pre fader/post fader
Matrix send
Level (–∞, –96 dB to +10 dB)
Pan: 127 positions (Left=1–63, Center, Right=1–63)
Level (–∞, –130 dB to 0 dB)
Bus to stereo
On/off
Pan: 127 positions (Left=1–63, Center, Right=1–63)
Metering
Comp-type4
Attenuator
EQ
AUX1–12
Displayed on LCD
Peak hold on/off
On/off
Pre EQ/pre fader/post fader
–96.0 to +12.0 dB (0.1 dB step)
4-band PEQ5
On/off
On/off
—
Fader
100 mm motorized
Delay
0–43400 samples
Pre fader/post fader
Matrix send
Level (–∞, –96 dB to +10 dB)
Pan: 127 positions (Left=1–63, Center, Right=1–63)
Metering
Displayed on LCD
Peak hold on/off
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
344
Appendix B: Specifications
Comp-type4
Attenuator
EQ
MATRIX 1L–4R
Power Requirements
Dimensions
–96.0 to +12.0 dB (0.1 dB step)
4-band PEQ5
On/off
—
Fader
100 mm motorized
Balance
127 positions (Left=1–63, Center, Right=1–63)
Delay
0–43400 samples
Displayed on LCD
Peak hold on/off
Mute
On/off
Solo
On/off
Source
BUS1–8, SLOT 1–6
Monitor to C-R
On/off
Oscillator
Pink noise/500–2 kHz/1 kHz
Monitor matrix
6.1→6.1, 6.1→5.1, 6.1→3-1, 6.1→ST, 5.1→5.1, 5.1→3-1, 5.1→ST,
3.1→3.1, 3.1→ST
Bass
management
5 presets
Monitor
alignment
ATT (–12.0 dB to 12 dB 0.1 dB step), Delay (0–30.0 msec, 0.01 msec
step)
Bypass
On/off
SURROUND MONITOR
GRAPHIC EQUALIZERS
(GEQ 1–6)
Pre EQ/pre fader/post fader
On/off
Metering
INTERNAL EFFECTS
(EFFECT 1–8)
On/off
In/out
8-in, 8-out (EFFECT1–2): depends on effects type
2-in, 2-out (EFFECT3–8): depends on effects type
Effect-in from
AUX1–12/INSERT OUT/effect-out
Effect-out to
Input patch/effect-in
On/off
—
Band number
31
Limit
±15 dB, ±12 dB, ±6 dB, –24 dB
Insert position
BUS1–8/AUX1–12/STEREO L, R/MATRIX 1L–4R
U.S./Canada
120 V, 60 Hz 300 W
Other
220–240 V, 50/60 Hz 300 W
(H x D x W)
257 x 821 x 906 mm (10.1" x 32.3" x 35.7")
Net weight
43 kg (94.8 lbs)
Operating free-air temperature range
10–35°C (50–95°F)
Storage temperature range
–20 to 60°C (–4 to 140°F)
Supplied Accessories
AC Cable
CD-ROM (Studio Manager)
Options
Digital interface card (MY16, MY8, MY4 series)
PEAK METER BRIDGE: MB2000
SIDE PANEL: SP2000
1. Total harmonic distortion is measured with a 6 dB/octave filter @ 80 kHz.
2. Hum & Noise are measured with a 6 dB/octave filter @ 12.7 kHz; equivalent to a 20 kHz filter with infinite dB/octave
attenuation.
3. See “Gate Parameters” on page 345.
4. See “Comp Parameters” on page 345.
5. See “EQ Parameters” on page 345.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
General Spec
345
EQ Parameters
LOW/HPF
L-MID
H-MID
0.1–10.0
(41 points)
low shelving
HPF
Q
F
0.1–10.0
(41 points)
HIGH /LPF
0.1–10.0
(41 points)
high shelving
LPF
21.2 Hz–20 kHz (1/12 oct step)
±18 dB
(0.1 dB step)
HPF: on/off
G
±18 dB
(0.1 dB step)
±18 dB
(0.1 dB step)
LPF: on/off
Gate Parameters
Threshold
–54 dB to 0 dB (0.1 dB step)
Range
–70 dB to 0 dB (1 dB step)
Attack
0 ms–120 ms (1 ms step)
0.02 ms–1.96 s (216 points) @ 48 kHz
Gate
Hold
0.02 ms–2.13 s (216 points) @ 44.1 kHz
0.01 ms–981 ms (216 points) @ 96 kHz
0.01 ms–1.06 s (216 points) @ 88.2 kHz
5 ms–42.3 s (160 points) @ 48 kHz
Decay
6 ms–46.0 s (160 points) @ 44.1 kHz
3 ms–21.1 s (160 points) @ 96 kHz
3 ms–23.0 s (160 points) @ 88.2 kHz
Threshold
–54 dB to 0 dB (0.1 dB step)
Range
–70 dB to 0 dB (1 dB step)
Attack
0 ms–120 ms (1 ms step)
0.02 ms–1.96 s (216 points) @ 48 kHz
Ducking
Hold
0.02 ms–2.13 s (216 points) @ 44.1 kHz
0.01 ms–981 ms (216 points) @ 96 kHz
0.01 ms–1.06 s (216 points) @ 88.2 kHz
5 ms–42.3 s (160 points) @ 48 kHz
Decay
6 ms–46.0 s (160 points) @ 44.1 kHz
3 ms–21.1 s (160 points) @ 96 kHz
3 ms–23.0 s (160 points) @ 88.2 kHz
Comp Parameters
Threshold
Compressor
–54 dB to 0 dB (0.1 dB step)
Ratio (x :1)
x=1, 1.1, 1.3, 1.5, 1.7, 2, 2.5, 3, 3.5, 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 20, ∞ (16 points)
Out gain
0 dB to +18 dB (0.1 dB step)
Knee
Hard, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 (6 step)
Attack
0 ms–120 ms (1 ms step)
5 ms–42.3 s (160 points) @ 48 kHz
Release
6 ms–46.0 s (160 points) @ 44.1 kHz
3 ms–21.1 s (160 points) @ 96 kHz
3 ms–23.0 s (160 points) @ 88.2 kHz
Threshold
Expander
–54 dB to 0 dB (0.1 dB step)
Ratio (x :1)
x=1, 1.1, 1.3, 1.5, 1.7, 2, 2.5, 3, 3.5, 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 20, ∞ (16 points)
Out gain
0 dB to +18 dB (0.1 dB step)
Knee
Hard, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 (6 points)
Attack
0 ms–120 ms (1 ms step)
5 ms–42.3 s (160 points) @ 48 kHz
Release
6 ms–46.0 s (160 points) @ 44.1 kHz
3 ms–21.1 s (160 points) @ 96 kHz
3 ms–23.0 s (160 points) @ 88.2 kHz
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
346
Appendix B: Specifications
Compander H
Threshold
–54 dB to 0 dB (0.1 dB step)
Ratio (x :1)
x=1, 1.1, 1.3, 1.5, 1.7, 2, 2.5, 3, 3.5, 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 20, ∞ (16 points)
Out gain
–18 dB to 0 dB (0.1 dB step)
Width
1 dB–90 dB (1 dB step)
Attack
0 ms–120 ms (1 ms step)
5 ms–42.3 s (160 points) @ 48 kHz
Release
6 ms–46.0 s (160 points) @ 44.1 kHz
3 ms–21.1 s (160 points) @ 96 kHz
3 ms–23.0 s (160 points) @ 88.2 kHz
Compander S
Threshold
–54 dB to 0 dB (0.1 dB step)
Ratio (x :1)
x=1, 1.1, 1.3, 1.5, 1.7, 2, 2.5, 3, 3.5, 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 20 (15 points)
Out gain
–18 dB to 0 dB (0.1 dB step)
Width
1 dB–90 dB (1 dB step)
Attack
0 ms–120 ms (1 ms step)
5 ms–42.3 s (160 points) @ 48 kHz
Release
6 ms–46.0 s (160 points) @ 44.1 kHz
3 ms–21.1 s (160 points) @ 96 kHz
3 ms–23.0 s (160 points) @ 88.2 kHz
Libraries
Effect library (EFFECT 1–8)
Compressor library
Gate library
EQ library
Channel library
GEQ library (GEQ 1–6)
Surround Monitor library
Input patch library
Output patch library
Bus to Stereo library
Presets
61 (EFFECT 3–8: 53)1
User memories
67
Presets
36
User memories
92
Presets
4
User memories
124
Presets
40
User memories
160
Presets
2
User memories
127
Presets
1
User memories
128
Presets
1
User memories
32
Presets
1
User memories
32
Presets
1
User memories
32
Presets
1
User memories
32
1. Effects #53–61 are Add-On Effects.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Analog Input Spec
347
Analog Input Spec
Input
PAD
GAIN
Actual Load For Use With
Impedance
Nominal
Sensitivity1
0
3k Ω
–16 dB
Nominal
Connector
Max.
before clip
A: XLR-3-31 type
–70 dB
–60 dB
–46 dB
(0.245 mV) (0.775 mV) (3.88 mV) (Balanced)2
–60 dB
INPUT A/B 1–24
Input level
50–600 Ω
Mics & 600 Ω
Lines
26
–26 dB
(38.8 mV)
–16 dB
(0.123 V)
B: Phone jack (TRS)
–2 dB
(616 mV) (Balanced)3
0dB
(775 mV)
+10 dB
(2.45 V)
+24 dB
(12.28 V)
INSERT IN 1–24
—
10K Ω
600 Ω Lines
–6dB
(388 mV)
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+18 dB
(6.16 V)
Phone jack (TRS)
2TR IN ANALOG 1
[L, R]
—
10K Ω
600 Ω Lines
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+18 dB
(6.16 V)
Phone jack (TRS)
2TR IN ANALOG 2
[L, R]
—
10K Ω
600 Ω Lines
–10 dBV
(0.316 V)
–10 dBV
(0.316 V)
+4 dBV
(1.58 V)
Phono
(Unbalanced)
(Balanced)3
(Balanced)3
1. Sensitivity is the lowest level that will produce an output of +4 dB (1.23 V) or the nominal output level when the unit
is set to maximum gain. (All faders and level controls are maximum position.)
2. XLR-3-31 type connectors are balanced (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD).
3. Phone jacks are balanced (Tip=HOT, Ring=COLD, Sleeve=GND).
In these specifications, when dB represents a specific voltage, 0 dB is referenced to 0.775 Vrms.
For 2TR IN ANALOG 2 levels, 0 dBV is referenced to 1.00 Vrms.
All input AD converters (except INSERT IN 1–24) are 24-bit linear, 128-times oversampling.
+48 V DC (phantom power) is supplied to CH INPUT (1–24) XLR type connectors via individual switches.
Analog Output Spec
Actual Source
Impedance
For Use
With
Nominal
600 Ω
10k Ω Lines
75 Ω
STUDIO MONITOR OUT
[L, R]
Output
Output level
GAIN
SW1
Connector
Nominal
Max.
before clip
—
–10 dBV
(0.316 V)
+4 dBV
(1.58 V)
Phono (Unbalanced)
600 Ω Lines
—
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+18 dB
(6.16 V)
XLR-3-32 type (Balanced)2
150 Ω
10k Ω Lines
—
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+18 dB
(6.16 V)
C-R MONITOR OUT LARGE
[L, R]
75 Ω
600 Ω Lines
—
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+18 dB
(6.16 V)
XLR-3-32 type (Balanced)2
C-R MONITOR OUT SMALL
[L, R]
75 Ω
600 Ω Lines
—
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+18 dB
(6.16 V)
XLR-3-32 type (Balanced)2
+18 dB
(default)
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+18 dB
(6.16 V)
Phone Jack (TRS)
+4 dB
–10 dB
(0.245 V)
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
(Balanced)3
10k Ω Lines
—
+4 dB
(1.23 V)
+18 dB
(6.16 V)
Phone Jack (TRS)
8 Ω Phones
—
4 mW
25 mW
Stereo Phone Jack (TRS)
40 Ω Phones
—
12 mW
75 mW
(Unbalanced)4
STEREO OUT [L, R]
OMNI OUT 1–8
150 Ω
INSERT OUT 1–24
150 Ω
PHONES
100 Ω
1.
2.
3.
4.
10k Ω Lines
Phone Jack (TRS)
(Balanced)3
(Balanced)3
The maximum output level of each OMNI OUT can be set internally.
XLR-3-32 type connectors are balanced (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD).
Phone jacks are balanced (Tip=HOT, Ring=COLD, Sleeve=GND).
PHONES stereo phone jack is unbalanced (Tip=LEFT, Ring=RIGHT, Sleeve=GND).
STEREO OUT [L, R], 0 dBV is referenced to 1.00 Vrms.
In these specifications, when dB represents a specific voltage, 0 dB is referenced to 0.775 Vrms.
All output DA converters (except INSERT OUT 1–24) are 24-bit, 128-times oversampling.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
348
Appendix B: Specifications
Digital Input Spec
Input
2TR IN DIGITAL
Format
Data length
Level
1
AES/EBU
24-bit
RS422
XLR-3-31 type (Balanced)1
2
AES/EBU
24-bit
RS422
XLR-3-31 type (Balanced)1
3
IEC-60958
24-bit
0.5 Vpp/75 Ω
CASCADE IN
Connector
RCA pin jack
RS422
D-SUB Half Pitch Connector 68P
(Female)
Data length
Level
Connector
24-bit2
RS422
XLR-3-32 type (Balanced)3
XLR-3-32 type (Balanced)3
—
—
1. XLR-3-31 type connectors are balanced (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD).
Digital Output Spec
Output
Format
1
2TR OUT DIGITAL
CASCADE OUT
AES/EBU1
Professional use
2
AES/EBU1
Professional use
24-bit2
RS422
3
IEC-609584
Consumer use
24-bit2
0.5V pp/75 Ω
—
—
RS422
1. Channel status of 2TR OUT DIGITAL 1, 2
Type:
2 audio channels
Emphasis:
NO
Sampling rate: depends on the internal configuration
2. Dither:
word length 16/20/24 bit
3. XLR-3-32 type connectors are balanced (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD).
4. Channel status of 2TR OUT DIGITAL 3
Type:
2 audio channels
Category code: 2 channel PCM encoder/decoder
Copy prohibit: NO
Emphasis:
NO
Clock accuracy: Level II (1000 ppm)
Sampling rate: depends on the internal configuration
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
RCA pin jack
D-SUB Half Pitch Connector 68P
(Female)
I/O Slot Spec
349
I/O Slot Spec
Each I/O SLOT accepts a digital interface card. Only SLOT #1 has a serial interface.
Card Name
MY16-AT
Function
Input
ADAT
MY8-AT
16 IN
16OUT (depends on output patch)1
6
8 IN
patch)1
6
ADAT
MY16-TD
TASCAM
16 IN
MY8-TD
TASCAM
8 IN
MY16-AE
AES/EBU
Number of
available cards
Output
16 IN
8 OUT (depends on output
16 OUT (depends on output
8 OUT (depends on output
patch)1
16 OUT (depends on output
MY8-AE
AES/EBU
8 IN
8 OUT (depends on output
MY8-AEB
AES/EBU
8 IN
8 OUT (depends on output
patch)1
MY16-C
CobraNet
16 IN
16 OUT (depends on output patch)1
MY4-AD
ANALOG IN
4 IN
—
MY8-AD
ANALOG IN
8 IN
—
ANALOG OUT
MY8-AD24
ANALOG IN
8 IN
—
—
MY8-AD96
ANALOG IN
8 IN
—
6
patch)1
patch)1
MY4-DA
6
patch)1
6
6
6
1
6
6
4 OUT (depends on output
patch)1
6
6
6
MY8-DA96
ANALOG OUT
8 OUT (depends on output
patch)1
MY8-AE96S
AES/EBU
8 IN
8 OUT (depends on output
patch)1
4
MY8-AE96
AES/EBU
8 IN
8 OUT (depends on output patch)1
6
patch)1
6
—
MY8-mLAN
mLAN
8 IN
MY16-mLAN
mLAN
16 IN
16 OUT (depends on output
Waves Y56K
Effect & I/O
8 IN
8 OUT (depends on output patch)1
patch)1
Waves Y96K
Effect & I/O
8 IN
Apogee AP8AD
ANALOG IN
8 IN
Apogee AP8DA
ANALOG OUT
—
8 OUT (depends on output
8 OUT (depends on output
patch)1
6
3
3
3
—
2
8 OUT (depends on output patch)1
2
1. See the Digital I/O chapter.
Details depend on each interface card.
Control I/O Spec
I/O Port
TO HOST
MIDI
TIME CODE IN
WORD CLOCK
CONTROL
REMOTE
Serial
USB
Format
Level
—
RS422
USB 1.1
0 V~3.3 V
B type USB connector
IN
MIDI
—
DIN Connector 5P
OUT
MIDI
—
DIN Connector 5P
THRU
MIDI
—
DIN Connector 5P
MTC
MIDI
—
DIN Connector 5P
SMPTE
Nominal –10 dB/10k Ω
SMPTE
TTL/75 Ω
(ON/OFF)2
IN
—
OUT 1, 2
—
TTL/75 Ω
—
—
—
RS422
PS/2
—
STORAGE CARD
—
—
METER
—
RS422
KEYBOARD
Connector in Console
Mini DIN Connector 8P
XLR-3-31 type (Balanced)1
BNC Connector
BNC Connector
D-SUB Connector 25P (Female)
D-SUB Connector 9P (Male)
DIN Connector 6P
SmartMedia slot
D-SUB Connector 15P (Female)
1. XLR-3-31 type connectors are balanced (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD).
2. This switch is on the rear panel.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
350
Appendix B: Specifications
Connector Pin Assignments
CASCADE IN
Pin
Signal
CASCADE OUT
Pin
Signal
Pin
Signal
Pin
Signal
1
GND
35
GND
1
GND
35
GND
2
INPUT 1-2(+)
36
INPUT 1-2(–)
2
OUTPUT 1-2(+)
36
OUTPUT 1-2(–)
3
INPUT 3-4(+)
37
INPUT 3-4(–)
3
OUTPUT 3-4(+)
37
OUTPUT 3-4(–)
4
INPUT 5-6(+)
38
INPUT 5-6(–)
4
OUTPUT 5-6(+)
38
OUTPUT 5-6(–)
5
INPUT 7-8(+)
39
INPUT 7-8(–)
5
OUTPUT 7-8(+)
39
OUTPUT 7-8(–)
6
INPUT 9-10(+)
40
INPUT 9-10(–)
6
OUTPUT 9-10(+)
40
OUTPUT 9-10(–)
7
INPUT 11-12(+)
41
INPUT 11-12(–)
7
OUTPUT 11-12(+)
41
OUTPUT 11-12(–)
8
INPUT 13-14(+)
42
INPUT 13-14(–)
8
OUTPUT 13-14(+)
42
OUTPUT 13-14(–)
9
INPUT 15-16(+)
43
INPUT 15-16(–)
9
OUTPUT 15-16(+)
43
OUTPUT 15-16(–)
10
DTR IN(+)
44
DTR IN(–)
10
DTR OUT(+)
44
DTR OUT(–)
11
RTS OUT(+)
45
RTS OUT(–)
11
RTS IN(+)
45
RTS IN(–)
12
GND
46
GND
12
GND
46
GND
13
WORD CLOCK IN(+)
47
WORD CLOCK IN(–)
13
WORD CLOCK OUT(+)
47
WORD CLOCK OUT(–)
14
WORD CLOCK OUT(+)
48
WORD CLOCK OUT(–)
14
WORD CLOCK IN(+)
48
WORD CLOCK IN(–)
15
CONTROL IN(+)
49
CONTROL IN(–)
15
CONTROL OUT(+)
49
CONTROL OUT(–)
16
CONTROL OUT(+)
50
CONTROL OUT(–)
16
CONTROL IN(+)
50
CONTROL IN(–)
17
GND
51
ID6 IN
17
GND
51
ID6 OUT
18
GND
52
ID6 OUT
18
GND
52
ID6 IN
19
INPUT 17-18(+)
53
INPUT 17-18(–)
19
OUTPUT 17-18(+)
53
OUTPUT 17-18(–)
20
INPUT 19-20(+)
54
INPUT 19-20(–)
20
OUTPUT 19-20(+)
54
OUTPUT 19-20(–)
21
INPUT 21-22(+)
55
INPUT 21-22(–)
21
OUTPUT 21-22(+)
55
OUTPUT 21-22(–)
22
INPUT 23-24(+)
56
INPUT 23-24(–)
22
OUTPUT 23-24(+)
56
OUTPUT 23-24(–)
23
RESERVED
57
RESERVED
23
RESERVED
57
RESERVED
24
RESERVED
58
RESERVED
24
RESERVED
58
RESERVED
25
RESERVED
59
RESERVED
25
RESERVED
59
RESERVED
26
RESERVED
60
RESERVED
26
RESERVED
60
RESERVED
27
ID0 IN
61
ID1 IN
27
ID0 OUT
61
ID1 OUT
28
ID2 IN
62
ID3 IN
28
ID2 OUT
62
ID3 OUT
29
ID4 IN
63
ID5 IN
29
ID4 OUT
63
ID5 OUT
30
ID0 OUT
64
ID1 OUT
30
ID0 IN
64
ID1 IN
31
ID2 OUT
65
ID3 OUT
31
ID2 IN
65
ID3 IN
32
ID4 OUT
66
ID5 OUT
32
ID4 IN
66
ID5 IN
33
MSB IN
67
2CH/LINE IN
33
MSB OUT
67
2CH/LINE OUT
34
FG
68
FG
34
FG
68
FG
REMOTE Port
Pin
Signal
1
GND
2
RX–/RX–1
3
4
5
TX–/TX+1
TX+/GND1
CONTROL Port
Pin
Signal
Pin
Signal
Pin
Signal
Signal
6
1
GPO0
10
GPI1
19
GND
7
RTS/RX+1
2
GPO2
11
N.C.
20
GND
CTS/TX–1
3
GPO4
12
SMODE1
21
+5V
8
9
GND
N.C.
1. RS422 (for AD8HR/AD824)/SONY 9-pin protocol (P2).
4
GPO6
13
SPARE1
22
GPI0
5
GND
14
GPO1
23
N.C.
6
GND
15
GPO3
24
SOLO1
7
GND
16
GPO5
25
MAS/SLV1
8
GND
17
GPO7
9
+5V
18
GND
1. For 02R SOLO control.
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
Pin
RX+/GND1
247 mm
371 mm
PAD
MATRIX 2
6
AUX 10
2
1
3
3
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
4
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
INSERT
ASSIGN
4
5
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
DIO
GROUP
REMOTE
SETUP
INPUT
PATCH
METER
SEL
AUTO
6
ON
SOLO
1
5
2
6
7
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
3
7
8
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
8
4
0
OUTPUT
PATCH
VIEW
UTILITY
INSERT
8
SIGNAL
INTERNAL GRAPHIC PLUG INS CHANNEL
EFFECTS EQUALIZERS
INSERTS
EFFECTS / PLUG INS
PAIR
MIDI
DATA
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
INSERT
9
SIGNAL
9
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
INSERT
10
SIGNAL
10
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
12
1
11
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
F1
12
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
2
F2
INSERT
SIGNAL
11
INSERT
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
13
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
3
F3
INSERT
13
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
14
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
F4
4
INSERT
14
SIGNAL
SEL
AUTO
INSERT
15
SIGNAL
ON
15
ON
16
16
1
70 50
2
50 30
50 30
60 40
50
20
30
30 15
40 20
30 15
40 20
15
40
20 10
20 10
10
10
5 5
0
15 5
70 50
60 40
10 0
5
10
5 5
15 5
0
0
10 0
5
3
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
4
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
5
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
6
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
7
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
8
5
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
5
9
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
10
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
11
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
12
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
13
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
14
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
15
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
8
7
COMP ON
L
18
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
EQ ON
ATT.
EQUALIZER
19
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
R
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
INSERT
20
SIGNAL
INSERT
INSERT ON
AUX 9
20
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
125
kHz
Hz
dB
GAIN
R
21
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
22
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
1.00
Q
LINK
ATTACK
23
ON
SOLO
SEL
DECAY
24
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
4.00
Q
10
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
5
17
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
18
968 mm
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
19
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
20
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
21
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
22
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
23
10
5 5
0
70 50
60 40
50 30
40 20
30 15
20 10
15 5
10 0
24
EFFECT
GAIN
HOLD
AUX 11
AUX 7
5
0
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
kHz
Hz
dB
GAIN
5
0
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
REMOTE 4
STEREO
ON
SEL
AUTO
STEREO
MASTER
73 96
REMOTE 2
REMOTE 3
REMOTE 1
49 72
1 24
kHz
Hz
dB
GAIN
LAYER
10.0
Q
FREQUENCY
HIGH
AUX 12
AUX 8
AUX 4 / MATRIX 4
ON
LEVEL
25 48
MIX
FB
AUX 3 / MATRIX 3
ON
LEVEL
HIGH MID
FREQUENCY
GRAB
RELEASE
AUX 10
AUTO
kHz
Hz
dB
GAIN
LOW MID
FREQUENCY
EVEN
ATTACK
ON
AUX 6
ON
OFF
ON
TIME
INSERT
24
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
DELAY
OFF
ON
AUX 2 / MATRIX 2
LEVEL
DISPLAY
INSERT
23
SIGNAL
ON
AUX 5
RATIO
LOW
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
AUX 1 / MATRIX 1
RANGE
BANK
LEVEL
AUX / MATRIX SEND
THRESHOLD
FREQUENCY
22
SIGNAL
GATE / COMP
THRESHOLD
COMP
L
ODD
Q
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SELECTED CHANNEL
INSERT
21
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
PHASE / INSERT
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
GATE
OFF
ON
PAN / SURROUND
GATE ON
DYNAMICS
DIRECT
6
5
STEREO
2
4
1
3
INSERT
19
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
CH17 CH18 CH19 CH20 CH21 CH22 CH23 CH24
17
ON
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
PASTE
COPY
CHANNEL
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
OFF
ON
ROUTING
INSERT
18
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
FOLLOW PAN
DISPLAY
INSERT
17
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
900 mm
16
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
INSERT
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SIGNAL
SOLO
SEL
AUTO
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SOLO
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
10
ON
ON
ASSIGN
SEND ASSIGN
DISPLAY
INSERT
7
SIGNAL
DISPLAY ACCESS
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
10
SOLO
SOLO
12
8
4
6
INSERT
SIGNAL
5
INSERT
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
CH09 CH10 CH11 CH12 CH13 CH14 CH15 CH16
SEL
AUX
AUX
AUX
MATRIX 4
FADER MODE
11
7
3
OFF
ON
FADER AUX/ MTRX
AUX
AUX
AUX
MATRIX 3
INSERT
4
SIGNAL
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
CH01 CH02 CH03 CH04 CH05 CH06 CH07 CH08
AUTO
SEL
OUTPUT
2
SEND LEVEL
ASSIGN
AUX/ MTRX
PAN
INPUT
ASSIGN 1
PAN
ENCODER MODE
AUX 9
AUX
5
AUX
AUX 2
AUX 1
AUX SELECT
MATRIX 1
AUTO
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
OFF
ON
3.3V CARD
INSERT
MATRIX SELECT
INSERT
3
1
INSERT
-60
ON
OFF
GAIN
PEAK
-16
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
2
GAIN
26dB
+ 48V
SIGNAL
-16
ON
OFF
SIGNAL
OFF
ON
-60
26dB
+ 48V
PEAK
GAIN
ON
OFF
PEAK
-16
26dB
+ 48V
B
18
10
2
C
19
11
3
D
20
12
4
TRACK ARMING
10
9
2
END
SCRUB
SHUTTLE
BACK
LATCH
3
FF
ONLINE
IN
READ
12
13
5
ENTER
FORWARD
4
5
QUICK
PUNCH
POST
STOP
LOOP
OUT
RECALL
MASTER
24
16
8
SET
7
15
7
AUX
ON
TRIM
MTR
8
16
8
EQ
OFF
PLAY
DEC
REC
ROLL REHEARSAL MASTER
BACK
6
14
6
PAN SURROUND AUX
4
23
15
7
10
STUDIO
LEVEL
0
RETURN RELATIVE TOUCH
SENSE
OVERWRITE
TOUCH
22
14
6
ALL CLEAR
LOCATE MEMORY
DISPLAY HISTORY
REW
RETURN
TO ZERO
AUDITION PRE
1
11
3
LOCATOR
2
DISPLAY
ON
WRITE
STORE
21
13
5
ABORT/ AUTOUNDO
REC
USER DEFINED KEYS
FADER
SUSPEND
REC
AUTOMIX
00
ENABLE
1
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
SCENE MEMORY
TRACK ARMING GROUP
A
17
9
1
DISPLAY
10
SMALL
TRIM
0
0
10
AUX 12
STEREO
2TR A1
2TR A2
ASSIGN 2
STEREO
BUS
ASSIGN 2
DIMMER
INC
TALKBACK
SLATE
TALKBACK
0
10
CONTROL ROOM LEVEL
SMALL
MONO
SURROUND
MONITOR LEVEL
ASSIGN 1
SURROUND
ASSIGN 1
2TR D3
2TR D2
2TR D1
STEREO
CONTROL ROOM
CLEAR
SOLO CONTRAST
SOLO
AUX 11
CONTROL
ROOM
STUDIO
DISPLAY
10
MONITOR
PHONES
LEVEL
0
PHONES
TALKBACK LEVEL
Dimensions
351
Dimensions
883.2 mm
820.8 mm
Specifications and external appearance subject to change without notice.
For European Model
Purchaser/User Information specified in EN55103-1 and EN55103-2.
Inrush Current: 31 A
Conformed Environment: E1, E2, E3 and E4
DM2000—Owner’s Manual
352
Appendix C: MIDI
Appendix C: MIDI
Scene Memory to Program Change Table
Program
Change #
Initial
Scene #
1
2
User
Scene #
Program
Change #
Initial
Scene #
01
44
02
45
3
03
4
Program
Change#
Initial
Scene #
44
87
87
45
88
88
46
46
89
89
04
47
47
90
90
5
05
48
48
91
91
6
06
49
49
92
92
7
07
50
50
93
93
8
08
51
51
94
94
9
09
52
52
95
95
10
10
53
53
96
96
11
11
54
54
97
97
12
12
55
55
98
98
13
13
56
56
99
99
14
14
57
57
100
00
15
15
58
58
101
—
16
16
59
59
102
—
17
17
60
60
103
—
18
18
61
61
104
—
19
19
62
62
105
—
20
20
63
63
106
—
21
21
64
64
107
—
22
22
65
65
108
—
23
23
66
66
109
—
24
24
67
67
110
—
25
25
68
68
111
—
26
26
69
69
112
—
27
27
70
70
113
—
28
28
71
71
114
—
29
29
72
72
115
—
30
30
73
73
116
—
31
31
74
74
117
—
32
32
75
75
118
—
33
33
76
76
119
—
34
34
77
77
120
—
35
35
78
78
121
—
36
36
79
79
122
—
37
37
80
80
123
—
38
38
81
81
124
—
39
39
82
82
125
—
40
40
83
83
126
—
41
41
84
84
127
—
42
42
85
85
128
—
43
43
86
86
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
User
Scene #
User
Scene #
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
353
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
CHANNEL1
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
MID
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
LOW
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
BUS1
BUS2
BUS3
BUS4
BUS5
BUS6
BUS7
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
MID
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
NO ASSIGN
LOW
BUS1
BUS2
BUS3
BUS4
BUS5
BUS6
BUS7
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
354
Appendix C: MIDI
CHANNEL2
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
MID
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
LOW
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
BUS8
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
AUX5
AUX6
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
MID
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
NO ASSIGN
LOW
BUS8
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
AUX5
AUX6
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
355
CHANNEL3
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
MID
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
LOW
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
AUX7
AUX8
AUX9
AUX10
AUX11
AUX12
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
MID
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
NO ASSIGN
LOW
AUX7
AUX8
AUX9
AUX10
AUX11
AUX12
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
356
Appendix C: MIDI
CHANNEL4
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER H
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
MID
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
LOW
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
MATRIX1
MATRIX2
MATRIX3
MATRIX4
STEREO
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
FADER L
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
MID
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
NO ASSIGN
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
NO ASSIGN
LOW
MATRIX1
MATRIX2
MATRIX3
MATRIX4
STEREO
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
357
CHANNEL5
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
MID
NO ASSIGN
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
NO ASSIGN
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
LOW
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
BUS1
BUS2
BUS3
BUS4
BUS5
BUS6
BUS7
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
MID
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
NO ASSIGN
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
MASTER
LOW
BUS1
BUS2
BUS3
BUS4
BUS5
BUS6
BUS7
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
BUS1
BUS2
BUS3
BUS4
BUS5
BUS6
BUS7
BUS8
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
AUX5
AUX6
AUX7
AUX8
AUX9
AUX10
AUX11
AUX12
MATRIX1
MATRIX2
MATRIX3
MATRIX4
STEREO
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
358
Appendix C: MIDI
CHANNEL6
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
MID
NO ASSIGN
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
NO ASSIGN
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
LOW
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
BUS8
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
AUX5
AUX6
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
MID
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
LOW
BUS8
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
AUX5
AUX6
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
359
CHANNEL7
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
MID
NO ASSIGN
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
LOW
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
AUX7
AUX8
AUX9
AUX10
AUX11
AUX12
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
MID
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
NO ASSIGN
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
LOW
AUX7
AUX8
AUX9
AUX10
AUX11
AUX12
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
360
Appendix C: MIDI
CHANNEL8
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
MID
NO ASSIGN
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
ATT H
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
LOW
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
MATRIX1
MATRIX2
MATRIX3
MATRIX4
STEREO
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
EQ
MID
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
ATT L
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
LOW
MATRIX1
MATRIX2
MATRIX3
MATRIX4
STEREO
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
361
CHANNEL9
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LOW
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
NO ASSIGN
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
NO ASSIGN
LOW
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
362
Appendix C: MIDI
CHANNEL10
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
LOW
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
NO ASSIGN
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
NO ASSIGN
LOW
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
363
CHANNEL11
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LOW
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
NO ASSIGN
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
NO ASSIGN
LOW
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
364
Appendix C: MIDI
CHANNEL12
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
LFE H
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
LFE L
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
LOW
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
DIV F
NO ASSIGN
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
DIV R
NO ASSIGN
LOW
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
365
CHANNEL13
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
LOW
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
NO ASSIGN
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
NO ASSIGN
LOW
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
INPUT1
INPUT2
INPUT3
INPUT4
INPUT5
INPUT6
INPUT7
INPUT8
INPUT9
INPUT10
INPUT11
INPUT12
INPUT13
INPUT14
INPUT15
INPUT16
INPUT17
INPUT18
INPUT19
INPUT20
INPUT21
INPUT22
INPUT23
INPUT24
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
366
Appendix C: MIDI
CHANNEL14
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
LOW
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
NO ASSIGN
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
NO ASSIGN
LOW
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
INPUT25
INPUT26
INPUT27
INPUT28
INPUT29
INPUT30
INPUT31
INPUT32
INPUT33
INPUT34
INPUT35
INPUT36
INPUT37
INPUT38
INPUT39
INPUT40
INPUT41
INPUT42
INPUT43
INPUT44
INPUT45
INPUT46
INPUT47
INPUT48
Initial Parameter to Control Change Table
367
CHANNEL15
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
LOW
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
NO ASSIGN
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
NO ASSIGN
LOW
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
INPUT49
INPUT50
INPUT51
INPUT52
INPUT53
INPUT54
INPUT55
INPUT56
INPUT57
INPUT58
INPUT59
INPUT60
INPUT61
INPUT62
INPUT63
INPUT64
INPUT65
INPUT66
INPUT67
INPUT68
INPUT69
INPUT70
INPUT71
INPUT72
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
368
Appendix C: MIDI
CHANNEL16
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
LR
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
FR
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
LOW
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
#
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
HIGH
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
SURROUND
MID
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
NO ASSIGN
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
WIDTH
NO ASSIGN
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
DEPTH
NO ASSIGN
LOW
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
INPUT73
INPUT74
INPUT75
INPUT76
INPUT77
INPUT78
INPUT79
INPUT80
INPUT81
INPUT82
INPUT83
INPUT84
INPUT85
INPUT86
INPUT87
INPUT88
INPUT89
INPUT90
INPUT91
INPUT92
INPUT93
INPUT94
INPUT95
INPUT96
MIDI Data Format
369
MIDI Data Format
In the following tables, “tx” means that transmission from the DM2000 is
possible, and “rx” means that receiving messages at the DM2000 is possible.
1. CHANNEL MESSAGE
Command
8n NOTE OFF
9n NOTE ON
Bn CONTROL CHANGE
Cn PROGRAM CHANGE
rx/tx
rx
rx
rx/tx
rx/tx
function
Control the internal effects
Control the internal effects
Control parameters
Switch scene memories
2. SYSTEM COMMON MESSAGE
Command
F1 MIDI TIME CODE QUARTER
FRAME
F2 SONG POSITION POINTER
rx/tx
rx
rx
function
Used when TIME REFERENCE
is MTC.
Used when TIME REFERENCE
is MIDI CLOCK.
3. SYSTEM REALTIME MESSAGE
Command
F8 TIMING CLOCK
FA START
FB CONTINUE
FC STOP
FE ACTIVE SENSING
FF SYSTEM RESET
rx/tx
rx
rx*
rx*
rx*
rx
rx
function
MIDI clock
Start automix (from the beginning)
Start automix (from the middle)
Stop automix
Check MIDI cable connections
Clear running status
* Received only when the AUTOMIX TIME REFERENCE setting is
set to MIDI CLOCK.
4. EXCLUSIVE MESSAGE
The DM2000 can correctly process Exclusive Messges of a length of F0
through F7 of 4096 bytes or shorter.
4.1 Real Time System Exclusive
Command
rx/tx
F0 7F dd 06 ... F7 MMC
tx
COMMAND
F0 7F dd 07 ... F7 MMC RESPONSE rx
F0 7F dd 01 ... F7 MIDI TIME CODE rx
function
MMC command
MMC response
Used when TIME REFERENCE
is MTC.
4.2 System Exclusive Message
function
BULK DUMP DATA
BULK DUMP REQUEST
The following data types of bulk dump are used on the DM2000.
Data name
'm'
'S'
'L'
'I'
'V'
'U'
'C'
'P'
'Q'
'Y'
'G'
'E'
'F'
'H'
'R'
'O'
'J'
'K'
'a'
'N'
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
Command
F0 43 1n 3E 06 ... F7
RARAMETER CHANGE
F0 43 3n 3E 06 ... F7
PARAMETER REQUEST
F0 43 1n 3E 7F ... F7
PARAMETER CHANGE
F0 43 3n 3E 7F ... F7
PARAMETER REQUEST
rx/tx
rx/tx
function
DM2000-specific parameter change
rx/tx
DM2000-specific parameter request
rx/tx
General purpose digital mixer parameter
change
General purpose digital mixer parameter
request
rx/tx
The following data types of parameter change are used by the DM2000.
Type (HEX)
1 (01)
2 (02)
3 (03)
4 (04)
16 (10)
17 (11)
18 (12)
19 (13)
20 (14)
32 (20)
33 (21)
34 (22)
35 (23)
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx
rx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
function
Edit buffer
Patch data
Setup memory
Backup memory
Function (recall, store, title, clear)
Function (pair)
Function (effect)
Sort table data
Function (attribute, link)
Key remote
Remote meter
Remote time counter
Automix status
4.2.3 Card Filer
Command
F0 43 5n ... F7 CARD FILER
rx/tx
rx/tx
function
Scene memory & request (compressed data)
Setup memory & request
User defined layer & request
User defined plug-in & request
User defined key & request
User assignable layer & request
Control change table & request
Program change table & request
Equalizer library & request
Compressor library & request
Gate library & request
Effect library & request
GEQ library & request
Channel library & request
Input patch library & request
Output patch library & request
Bus to stereo library & request
Surround monitor library & request
Automix & request (compressed data)
Plug-in effect card & request
function
Packet for card filer
Format Details
1. NOTE OFF
(8n)
Reception
If [OTHER ECHO] is ON, these message are echoed.
If the [Rx CH] matches, these messages are received and used to control
effects.
STATUS
DATA
1000nnnn 8n Note off message
0nnnnnnn nn Note number
0vvvvvvv vv Velocity (ignored)
2. NOTE ON
4.2.1 Bulk Dump
Command
rx/tx
F0 43 0n 7E ... F7 BULK DUMP DATA
rx/tx
F0 43 2n 7E ... F7 BULK DUMP REQUEST rx/tx
4.2.2 PARAMTER CHANGE
(9n)
Reception
If [OTHER ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
If the [Rx CH] matches, these messages are received and used to control
effects.
STATUS
DATA
1001nnnn 9n Note on message
0nnnnnnn nn Note number
0vvvvvvv vv Velocity (1-127:on, 0:off)
3. CONTROL CHANGE
(Bn)
Reception
If [Control Change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
If [TABLE] is selected, these message are received if [Control Change Rx]
is ON, and will control parameters according to the [Control assign table]
settings.
The parameters that can be set are defined in the Control Change Assign
Parameter List.
If [NRPN] is selected, these messages are received if [Control Change Rx]
is ON and the [Rx CH] matches, and will control the parameter that is
specified by the four messages NRPN control number (62h, 63h) and Data
Entry control number (06h, 26h). Parameter settings are defined in the
Control Change Assign Parameter List.
Transmission
If [TABLE] is selected, operating a parameter specified in the [Control assign table] will cause these messages to be transmitted if [Control Change
Tx] is ON. The parameters that can be specified are defined in the Control
Change Assign Parameter List.
If [NRPN] is selected, operating a specified parameter will cause data to be
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
370
Appendix C: MIDI
transmitted on the [Tx CH] if [Control Change Tx] is ON, using the four
messages NRPN control number (62h, 63h) and Data Entry control number (06h, 26h). Parameter settings are defined in the Control Change Assign Parameter List.
This data cannot be transmitted via Program Change to Studio Manager
since there is no guarantee that the contents of the tables will match. (Parameter Change messages will always be used.)
If [TABLE] is selected
STATUS
DATA
1011nnnn Bn Control change
0nnnnnnn nn Control number (0-95, 102-119)
0vvvvvvv vv Control Value (0-127)
Formula for converting Control values into parameter data:
paramSteps= paramMax - paramMin + 1;
add=
paramWidth / paramSteps;
mod=
paramWidth - add * paramSteps;
curValue= parm * add + mod / 2;
(1) When the assigned parameter can be set in 128 steps or less:
paramWidth = 127; rxValue = Control value;
(2) When the assigned parameter can be set in 128 through 16383 steps:
paramWidth = 16383;
(2-1) When both High and Low data are received:
rxValue = Control value (High) * 128 + Control value (Low);
(2-2) When only Low data is received:
rxValue = (curValue & 16256) + Control value (Low);
(2-3) When only High data is received:
rxValue = Control value (High) * 128 + (curValue & 127);
(3) When the assigned parameter can be set in 16384 through 2097151
steps:
paramWidth = 2097151;
(3-1) When High, Middle, and Low data are received:
rxValue = Control value (High) * 16384 + Control value (Middle) *
128 + Control value (Low);
4. PROGRAM CHANGE
Transmission
If [Program Change TX] is ON, this message is transmitted according to
the settings of the [Program Change Table] on the [Tx CH] channel when
a scene memory is recalled.
If the recalled scene has been assigned to more than one program number,
the lowest-numbered program number will be transmitted. Transmission
to Studio Manager using Program Change messages will not be performed
since there is no guarantee that the contents of the tables will match. (Parameter Changes will always be used.)
STATUS
DATA
(3-4) When only High data is received:
rxValue = (curValue & 16383) + Control value (High) * 16384;
(3-5) When Middle and Low data are received:
rxValue = (curValue & 2080768) + Control value (Middle) * 128 +
Control value (Low);
(3-6) When High and Low data are received:
rxValue = (curValue & 16256) + Control value (High) * 16384 +
Control value (Low);
(3-7) When High and Middle data are received:
rxValue = (curValue & 127) + Control value (High) * 16384 + Control value (Middle) * 128;
if ( rxValue > paramWidth)
rxValue = paramWidth;
param = ( rxValue - mod / 2) / add;
If [NRPN] is selected
STATUS
STATUS
DATA
STATUS
DATA
STATUS
DATA
1011nnnn
01100010
0vvvvvvv
1011nnnn
01100011
0vvvvvvv
1011nnnn
00000110
0vvvvvvv
1011nnnn
00100110
0vvvvvvv
Bn
62
vv
Bn
63
vv
Bn
06
vv
Bn
26
vv
1100nnnn Cn Program change
0nnnnnnn nn Program number (0-127)
5 MIDI TIME CODE QUARTER FRAME(F1)
Reception
This is echoed if [OTHER COMMANDS ECHO] is ON.
Automix synchronizes this if the data is received at the port specified by the
TIME REFERENCE setting.
STATUS
DATA
1100nnnn F1 Quarter frame message
0tttdddd td Type & data
6. SONG POSITION POINTER
(F2)
Reception
If this is received when the automix TIME REFERENCE setting is MIDI
CLOCK, the automix will move to the song position that was received.
STATUS
DATA
(3-2) When only Low data is received:
rxValue = (curValue & 2097024) + Control value (Low);
(3-3) When only Middle data is received:
rxValue = (curValue & 2080895) + Control value (Middle) * 128;
(Cn)
Reception
If [Program Change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
If [Program Change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches, these messages
will be received. However if [OMNI] is ON, they will be received regardless
of the channel. When a message is received, a Scene Memory will be recalled according to the settings of the [Program Change Table].
11110010 F2 Song position pointer
0vvvvvvv vv Song position LSB
0vvvvvvv vv Song position MSB
7. TIMING CLOCK
(F8)
Reception
If the automix TIME REFERENCE setting is MIDI CLOCK, this message
is used to synchronize automix. It is also used to control effects. This message is transmitted 24 times per quarter note.
STATUS
11111000 F8 Timing clock
8. START
(FA)
Reception
This message is received if the automix TIME REFERENCE setting is MIDI
CLOCK, and will start the automix. In actuality, automix will start when
the next TIMING CLOCK is received after receiving the START message.
STATUS
11111010 FA Start
9. CONTINUE
(FB)
Control change*1
Reception
This message is received if the automix TIME REFERENCE setting is MIDI
CLOCK, and will cause automix to start from the current song position. In
actuality, automix will start when the next TIMING CLOCK is received after receiving the CONTINUE message.
NRPN MSB
STATUS
Control changeDATA
NRPN LSB
LSB of parameter number
11111011 FB Continue
MSB of parameter number
Control change*1
MSB of data entry
MSB of parameter data
Control change*1
LSB of data entry
LSB of parameter data
*1) The second and subsequent STATUS need not be added during
transmission. Reception must be implemented so that reception occurs whether or not STATUS is present.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
10. STOP
(FC)
Reception
This message is received if the automix TIME REFERENCE setting is MIDI
CLOCK, and will cause automix to stop.
STATUS
11111100 FC Stop
Format Details
11. ACTIVE SENSING
(FE)
Reception
Once this message has been received, the failure to receive any message for
an interval of 400 ms or longer will cause MIDI transmission to be initialized, such as by clearing the Running Status.
STATUS
11111110 FE Active sensing
12. SYSTEM RESET
(FF)
Reception
When this message is received, MIDI communications will be cleared, e.g.,
by clearing the Running Status.
STATUS
11111111 FF System reset
13. SYSTEM EXCLUSIVE MESSAGE (F0)
13.1 MIDI TIME CODE (FULL MESSAGE)
The Automix synchronizes these messages when they are received at a port
specified by the TIME REFERENCE setting.
13.2 MIDI MACHINE CONTROL (MMC)
These messages are transmitted when the Machine Control section of the
DM2000 is operated.
13.3 BULK DUMP
This message sends or receives the contents of various memories stored
within the DM2000.
The basic format is as follows.
Conversion from actual data into bulk data
d[0~6]: actual data
b[0~7]: bulk data
b[0] = 0;
for( I=0; I<7; I++){
if( d[I]&0x80){
b[0] |= 1<<(6-I);
}
b[I+1] = d[I]&0x7F;
}
Restoration from bulk data into actual data
d[0~6]: actual data
b[0~7]: bulk data
for( I=0; I<7; I++){
b[0] <<= 1;
d[I] = b[I+1]+(0x80&b[0]);
}
13.3.1 Scene memory bulk dump format
(compressed data)
The DM2000 can transmit and receive scene memories in compressed
form.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
For DUMP DATA
F0 43 0n 7E cc cc <Model ID> tt mm mm [Data ...]
cs F7
For DUMP REQUEST
F0 43 2n 7E <Model ID> tt mm mm F7
Device Number
n
DATA COUNT (the number of bytes that follow this, ending
cc cc
<Model ID>
tt
mm mm
cs
DATA NAME
DATA TYPE
Reception
This message is received if [Bulk RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the
device number included in the SUB STATUS.
When a bulk dump is received, it is immediately written into the specified
memory.
When a bulk dump request is received, a bulk dump is immediately transmitted.
Transmission
This message is transmitted on the [Tx CH] by key operations in the [MIDI]-[BULK DUMP] screen.
A bulk dump is transmitted on the [Rx CH] in response to a bulk dump
request.
The data area is handled by converting seven words of 8-bit data into eight
words of 7-bit data.
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
6D
mh
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'm'
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt tt total block number (minimum number
is 0)
CHECK SUM
A unique header (Model ID) is used to determine whether the device is a
DM2000.
CHECK SUM is obtained by adding the bytes that follow BYTE COUNT
(LOW) and end before CHECK SUM, taking the binary compliment of
this sum, and then setting bit 7 to 0.
CHECK SUM = (-sum)&0x7F
The DM2000 can transmit and receive BULK data only if the size of a
MIDI packet (F0 - F7) is 4096 bytes or smaller.
If large data consists of multiple MIDI packets, they can be transferred sequentially.
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01101101
0mmmmmmm
m=0-99, 256, 8192 (Scene0-99, EDIT
BUFFER, UNDO)
0mmmmmmm ml Receive is effective 1-99, 256, 8192
before the checksum)
Model ID (for DM2000, 4C 4D 20 20 38 43 31 32)
DATA NUMBER
371
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
DATA
CHECK SUM
EOX
0ddddddd
:
:
0ddddddd
0eeeeeee
11110111
ds Scene data of block[bb]
de
ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
F7 End of exclusive
13.3.2 Scene memory bulk dump request format
(compressed data)
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the scene number
that is being requested. If this is 256, the data of the Edit Buffer will be
bulk-dumped. If this is 8192, the data of the Undo Buffer will be
bulk-dumped.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01101101
0mmmmmmm
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
6D
mh
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'm'
m=0-99, 256, 8192 (Scene0-99, EDIT
BUFFER, UNDO)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
372
Appendix C: MIDI
EOX
0mmmmmmm ml
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.3 Setup memory bulk dump format
Of the setup memory of the DM2000, this bulk-dumps data other than the
User defined layer, User define plug-in, User defined keys, User assignable
layer, Control change table, and Program change table.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01010011
00000010
00000000
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
53
02
00
tt
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01001100
00000000
0bbbbbbb
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
'2'
'L'
b=0-3 (bank no.1-4)
DATA
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'1'
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds User defined layer data of block[bb]
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
31
32
4C
00
bb
tt
'M'
''
13.3.6 User defined layer bulk dump request format
''
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'S'
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
No.256 = Current
DATA
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Setup data of block[bb]
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.4 Setup memory bulk dump request format
System exclusive message
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
01001100
00000000
0bbbbbbb
11110111
4C 'L'
00
bb b=0-3 (bank no.1-4)
F7 End of exclusive
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
DATA NAME
EOX
11110000 F0 System exclusive message
STATUS
ID No.
01000011 43 Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E Universal bulk dump
01001100 4C 'L'
01001101 4D 'M'
00100000 20 ' '
00100000 20 ' '
00111000 38 '8'
01000011 43 'C'
00110001 31 '1'
00110010 32 '2'
DATA NAME 01010011 53 'S'
00000010 02
00000000 00 No.256 = Current
EOX
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.5 User defined layer bulk dump format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
Be aware that the state of the transmission destination will (in some cases)
change if the same bank is being used.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
13.3.7 User defined plug-in bulk dump format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
Be aware that the state of the transmission destination will (in some cases)
change if the same bank is being used.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01001001
00000000
0bbbbbbb
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
'C'
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'I'
b=0-7 (bank no.1-8)
CHECK SUM
EOX
'M'
'8'
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
'L'
''
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
DATA
Universal bulk dump
''
System exclusive message
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds User define plug-in data of block[bb]
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
data count = ch * 128 + cl
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
49
00
bb
tt
Format Details
13.3.8 User defined plug-in bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01001001
00000000
0bbbbbbb
11110111
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
49
00
bb
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'I'
b=0-7 (bank no.1-8)
End of exclusive
13.3.9 User defined keys bulk dump format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
Be aware that the state of the transmission destination will (in some cases)
change if the same bank is being used.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01010110
00000000
0bbbbbbb
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
56
00
bb
tt
System exclusive message
EOX
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
Be aware that the state of the transmission destination will (in some cases)
change if the same bank is being used.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01010101
00000000
0bbbbbbb
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'V'
b=0-7 (bank no.A-H)
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'U'
b=0-3 (bank no.1-4)
13.3.12 User assignable layer bulk dump request
format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
13.3.10 User defined keys bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
DATA NAME
Universal bulk dump
CHECK SUM
EOX
DATA NAME
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
56
00
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
''
DATA
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01010110
00000000
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
'L'
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds User defined key data of block[bb]
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
System exclusive message
DATA
data count = ch * 128 + cl
''
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
55
00
bb
tt
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds User assignable layer data of block[bb]
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
'M'
0bbbbbbb bb b=0-7 (bank no.A-H)
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.11 User assignable layer bulk dump format
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
Universal bulk dump
373
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'V'
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01010101
00000000
0bbbbbbb
11110111
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
55
00
bb
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'U'
b=0-3 (bank no.1-4)
End of exclusive
13.3.13 Control change table bulk dump format
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
374
Appendix C: MIDI
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01000011
00000010
00000000
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
31
32
43
02
00
tt
'1'
'2'
'C'
No.256 = Current
DATA
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Control change table data of block[bb]
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.16 Program change table bulk dump request
format
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
13.3.14 Control change table bulk dump request
format
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01000011
00000010
00000000
11110111
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
43
02
00
F7
System exclusive message
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01010000
00000010
00000000
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
50
02
00
tt
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
50
02
00
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'P'
No.256 = Current
End of exclusive
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
13.3.17 Equalizer library bulk dump format
Universal bulk dump
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number.
0:Library no.1 - 199:Library no.200, 256:CH1 - 351:CH96, 384:BUS1 391:BUS8, 512:AUX1 - 523:AUX12, 640:MATRIX1L - 647:MATRIX4R,
768:STEREO L - 769:STEREO R, 8192:UNDO
256 and up are data for the corresponding channel of the edit buffer (excluding UNDO).
For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (40-199, 256-)
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'C'
No.256 = Current
End of exclusive
13.3.15 Program change table bulk dump format
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01010000
00000010
00000000
11110111
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01010001
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
DATA
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Program change table data of block[bb]
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'Q'
0-199 (EQ Library no.1-200),
256- (Channel current data)
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
'P'
No.256 = Current
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
DATA
'C'
'2'
System exclusive message
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds EQ Library data of block[bb]
'8'
'1'
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
51
mh
ml
tt
13.3.18 Equalizer library bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the bank number. (See above)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
Format Details
DATA NAME
EOX
00110010
01010001
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
32
51
mh
ml
F7
'2'
'Q'
0-199 (EQ Library no.1-200),
256- (Channel current data)
End of exclusive
13.3.19 Compressor library bulk dump format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.1 - 127:Library no.128, 256:CH1 - 351:CH96, 384:BUS1 391:BUS8, 512:AUX1 - 523:AUX12, 640:MATRIX1L - 647:MATRIX4R,
768:STEREO L - 769:STEREO R, 8192:UNDO
256 and following are data for the corresponding channel of the edit buffer. For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (36-127, 256-)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01011001
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
59
mh
ml
tt
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'Y'
0-127 (COMP Library no.1-128),
256- (Channel current data)
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.20 Compressor library bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
DATA NAME
EOX
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
59
mh
ml
F7
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'G'
0-127 (GATE Library no.1-128),
256-351 (Channel current data)
CHECK SUM
EOX
13.3.22 Gate library bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01000111
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
47
mh
ml
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'G'
0-127 (GATE Library no.1-128),
256-351 (Channel current data)
End of exclusive
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'Y'
0-127 (COMP Library no.1-128),
13.3.23 Effect library bulk dump format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.1 - 127:Library no.128, 256:Effect1 - 263:Effect8, 8192:UNDO
256-263 are the data for the corresponding area of the edit buffer.
For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (61-127,
256-263)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
256- (Channel current data)
End of exclusive
13.3.21 Gate library bulk dump format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.1 - 127:Library no.128, 256:CH1 - 351:CH96, 8192:UNDO
256 and following are data for the corresponding channel of the edit buffer. For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (4-127, 256-)
STATUS
ID No.
Universal bulk dump
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
'M'
''
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
DATA
'L'
''
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
47
mh
ml
tt
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds GATE Library data of block[bb]
Universal bulk dump
DATA
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01011001
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01000111
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds COMP Library data of block[bb]
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
375
11110000 F0 System exclusive message
01000011 43 Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
DATA NAME
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01000101
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
45
mh
ml
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'E'
0-127 (Effect Library no.1-128),
256-259 (Effect1-8 current)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
376
Appendix C: MIDI
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt tt total block number (minimum number
DATA
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Effect Library data of block[bb]
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.24 Effect library bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01000101
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
45
mh
ml
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'E'
0-127 (Effect Library no.1-128),
256-259 (Effect1-8 current)
End of exclusive
13.3.25 GEQ library bulk dump format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.0 - 128:Library no.128, 256:GEQ1 - 261:GEQ6, 8192:UNDO
256-261are the data for the corresponding area of the edit buffer.
For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (1-128, 256-261)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01000110
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
46
mh
ml
tt
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
SUB STATUS 0010nnnn 2n
FORMAT No. 01111110 7E
01001100 4C
01001101 4D
00100000 20
00100000 20
00111000 38
01000011 43
00110001 31
00110010 32
DATA NAME 01000110 46
0mmmmmmm mh
0mmmmmmm ml
EOX
11110111 F7
'M'
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01001000
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
'1'
'2'
'F'
0-128 (GEQ Library no.0-128),
256-261 (GEQ1-6 current)
DATA
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds GEQ Library data of block[bb]
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
STATUS
ID No.
11110000 F0 System exclusive message
01000011 43 Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'F'
0-128 (GEQ Library no.0-128),
256-261 (GEQ1-6 current)
End of exclusive
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
48
mh
ml
tt
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'H'
0-128 (Channel Library no.0-128),
256- (Current data)
DATA
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.28 Channel library bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
13.3.26 GEQ library bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
'M'
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Channel Library data of block[bb]
''
'C'
'L'
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.0 - 128:Library no.128, 256:CH1 - 351:CH96, 384:BUS1 391:BUS8, 512:AUX1 - 523:AUX12, 640:MATRIX1L - 647:MATRIX4R,
768:STEREO L - 769:STEREO R, 8192:UNDO
256 and following are data for the corresponding channel of the edit buffer. For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (2-128,256-)
''
'8'
Universal bulk dump
13.3.27 Channel library bulk dump format
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
DATA NAME
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01001000
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
48
mh
ml
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'H'
0-128 (Channel Library no.0-128),
256- (Current data)
End of exclusive
Format Details
13.3.29 Input patch library bulk dump format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.0 - 32:Library no.32, 256:Current data, 8192:UNDO
For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (1-32,256)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01010010
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
52
mh
ml
tt
System exclusive message
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01001111
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
'8'
13.3.32 Output patch library bulk dump request format
'C'
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
'1'
'2'
'R'
0-32 (Input patch Library no.0-32),
256 (Current data)
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
13.3.30 Input patch library bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
DATA NAME
EOX
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
52
mh
ml
F7
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
4F
mh
ml
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'O'
0-32 (Output patch Library no.0-32),
256 (Current data)
End of exclusive
13.3.33 Bus to stereo library bulk dump format
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.0 - 32:Library no.32, 256:Current data, 8192:UNDO
For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (1-32,256)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'R'
0-32 (Input patch Library no.0-32),
256 (Current data)
End of exclusive
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.0 - 32:Library no.32, 256:Current data, 8192:UNDO
For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (1-32,256)
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01001111
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
System exclusive message
13.3.31 Output patch library bulk dump format
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
256 (Current data)
''
DATA
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01010010
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
0-32 (Output patch Library no.0-32),
CHECK SUM
EOX
'L'
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Input patch Library data of block[bb]
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
'O'
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
data count = ch * 128 + cl
''
'2'
DATA
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
'M'
'1'
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Output patch Library data of block[bb]
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
Universal bulk dump
31
32
4F
mh
ml
tt
377
System exclusive message
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
DATA NAME 01001010
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'J'
0-32 (Bus to stereo Library no.0-32),
256 (Current data)
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
''
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
DATA
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
'M'
System exclusive message
total block number (minimum number
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Bus to stereo Library data of block[bb]
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
Universal bulk dump
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
4A
mh
ml
tt
''
'8'
'C'
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
378
Appendix C: MIDI
13.3.34 Bus to stereo library bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01001010
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
4A
mh
ml
F7
DATA NAME
no.0-32),
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
EOX
The second byte of the DATA NAME indicates the library number.
0:Library no.1 - 15:Library no.16, 256:Current automix data
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'J'
0-32 (Bus to stereo Library no.0-32),
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
256 (Current data)
End of exclusive
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number.
0:Library no.0 - 32:Library no.32, 256:Current data, 8192:UNDO
For reception by the DM2000, only the user area is valid. (1-32,256)
DATA NAME
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01001011
0mmmmmmm
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
4B
mh
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'a'
0bbbbbbb bh current block number (0-total block
number)
data count = ch * 128 + cl
0bbbbbbb bl
0ttttttt th total block number (minimum number
'L'
is 0)
'M'
''
DATA
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
CHECK SUM
EOX
0ttttttt
0ddddddd
:
:
0ddddddd
0eeeeeee
11110111
tl
ds Automix memory data of block[bb]
de
ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
F7 End of exclusive
'K'
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
System exclusive message
Universal bulk dump
is 0)
0bbbbbbb bb current block number (0-total block
number)
0ddddddd ds Surround Monitor Library data of
block[bb]
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
F0
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
61
mh
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
13.3.38 Automix bulk dump request format
(compressed data)
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the library number. (See above)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
13.3.36 Surround monitor library bulk dump request
format
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
11110000
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01100001
0mmmmmmm
0-15 (Automix no.1-16), 256 (Current
data)
0mmmmmmm ml BLOCK INFO.
BLOCK INFO. 0ttttttt tt total block number (minimum number
CHECK SUM
EOX
DATA NAME
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
0-32 (Surround Monitor Library
no.0-32),
0mmmmmmm ml 256 (Current data)
DATA
0mmmmmmm ml 256 (Current data)
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.37 Automix bulk dump format
(compressed data)
13.3.35 Surround monitor library bulk dump format
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
00110010 32 '2'
01001011 4B 'K'
0mmmmmmm mh 0-32 (Surround Monitor Library
DATA NAME
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01100001
0mmmmmmm
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
61
mh
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
'1'
'2'
'a'
0-15 (Automix no.1-16), 256 (Current
data)
0mmmmmmm ml
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.3.39 Plug-in effect card bulk dump format
The second byte of the DATA NAME indicates the slot number.
0:SLOT 4 - 2:SLOT 6
The data is not received if the Developer ID and Product ID are different
than the card that is installed in the slot.
The data is not transmitted if a valid plug-in effect card is not installed.
STATUS
11110000 F0 System exclusive message
Format Details
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
COUNT HIGH
COUNT LOW
DATA NAME
01000011
0000nnnn
01111110
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01001110
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
0bbbbbbb
43
0n
7E
ch
cl
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
4E
mh
ml
bh
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
data count = ch * 128 + cl
'L'
'M'
''
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
'C'
'1'
DATA *)
'N'
m=0-2 (SLOT 4-6)
BLOCK INFO.
current block number (0-total block
number)
is 0)
DATA
0ttttttt
0000iiii
0000iiii
0000jjjj
0000jjjj
0ddddddd
CHECK SUM
EOX
:
:
0ddddddd de
0eeeeeee ee ee= (Invert ('L'+...+de)+1)&0x7F
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
Developer id (High)
Developer id (Low)
Product id (High)
Product id (Low)
Plug-in Effect card memory data of
block[bb]
EOX
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
FORMAT No.
DATA NAME
EOX
11110000
01000011
0010nnnn
01111110
01001100
01001101
00100000
00100000
00111000
01000011
00110001
00110010
01001110
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
F0
43
2n
7E
4C
4D
20
20
38
43
31
32
4E
mh
ml
F7
System exclusive message
F0
43
1n
3E
06
tt
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Data type
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
0ddddddd dd data
:
:
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
*) For parameters with a data size of 2 or more, data for that size
will be transmitted.
13.4.2 Parameter Change basic format
(Universal format)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
0ttttttt
0eeeeeee
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
tt
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Data type
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
DATA *)
13.3.40 Plug-in effect card bulk dump request format
The second and third bytes of the DATA NAME indicate the slot number.
(See above)
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
0ttttttt
0eeeeeee
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
'8'
0bbbbbbb bl
0ttttttt th total block number (minimum number
tl
0i
0i
0j
0j
ds
13.4.1 Parameter change basic format
(DM2000-specific)
''
'2'
379
EOX
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
0ddddddd dd data
:
:
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
*) For parameters with a data size of 2 or more, data for that size
will be transmitted.
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
Universal bulk dump
'L'
'M'
''
''
'8'
'C'
13.4.3 Parameter request basic format
(DM2000-specific)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
'1'
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
00000110
0ttttttt
0eeeeeee
F0
43
3n
3E
06
tt
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Data type
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
'2'
'N'
m=0-2 (SLOT 4-6)
EOX
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
End of exclusive
13.4 PARAMETER CHANGE
Reception
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. A specific parameter is controlled when a Parameter Change is received. When
a Parameter Request is received, the current value of the specified parameter will be transmitted as a Parameter Change with the Device Number set
to [Rx CH].
Transmission
If [Parameter change TX] is ON and you operate a parameter for which
Control Change transmission is not enabled, a parameter change will be
transmitted with [Tx CH] as the Device Number.
As a response to a Parameter Request, a parameter change will be transmitted with [Rx CH] as the Device Number.
13.4.4 Parameter request basic format
(Universal format)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
01111111
0ttttttt
0eeeeeee
F0
43
3n
3E
7F
tt
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Data type
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
EOX
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.4.5 Parameter Address
Consult your dealer for parameter address details.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
380
Appendix C: MIDI
13.4.6 Parameter change
(Edit buffer)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the specified parameter will be controlled.
Transmission
If [Parameter change TX] is ON and a parameter that is not assigned in the
[Control Assign Table] is changed, the Parameter Change messages are
transmitted on [Tx CH] device number channel.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
00000001
0eeeeeee
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
01
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
EOX
(Edit buffer)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the value of the specified parameter will be transmitted as a Parameter change.
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
01111111
00000001
0eeeeeee
F0
43
3n
3E
7F
01
ee
(Patch data)
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
00000010
0eeeeeee
F0
43
1n
3E
06
02
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
DATA
EOX
DATA
EOX
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
DM2000
Patch data
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
(Setup memory)
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
00000011
0eeeeeee
F0
43
1n
3E
06
03
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Setup data
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
0ddddddd dd data
:
:
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
(Setup memory)
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
00000110
00000011
0eeeeeee
F0
43
3n
3E
06
03
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Setup data
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
Patch data
EOX
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.4.12 Parameter change
(Backup memory)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the specified parameter will be controlled.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the value of the specified parameter will be transmitted as a Parameter change.
DM2000
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
0ddddddd dd data
:
:
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
13.4.11 Parameter request
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
Edit Buffer
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the specified parameter will be controlled.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
Universal
13.4.8 Parameter change
System exclusive message
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the specified parameter will be controlled.
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
F0
43
3n
3E
06
02
ee
13.4.10 Parameter change
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
EOX
EOX
System exclusive message
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
00000110
00000010
0eeeeeee
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
Edit Buffer
13.4.7 Parameter request
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
Universal
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
0ddddddd dd data
:
:
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
(Patch data)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the value of the specified parameter will be transmitted as a Parameter change.
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
DATA
13.4.9 Parameter request
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
00000100
F0
43
1n
3E
06
04
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Backup data
0eeeeeee ee Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
DATA
EOX
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
0ddddddd dd data
:
:
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.4.13 Parameter request
(Backup memory)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the value of the specified parameter will be transmitted as a Parameter change.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
00000110
00000100
0eeeeeee
F0
43
3n
3E
06
04
ee
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Backup data
Element no. (If ‘ee’ is 0, ‘ee’ is expanded
to two bytes)
0ppppppp pp Parameter no.
EOX
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the specified memory/library will be stored/recalled.
Transmission
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
DATA
EOX
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010000
00ffffff
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
10
ff
mh
ml
ch
cl
F7
0x27
0x28
0x29
0x2A
0x2B
381
number
1-32
1-32
1-32
1-32
1-16
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
channel*1)
256, 16383
256, 16383
256, 16383
256, 16383
256, 16383
*1) 0:CH1 - 95:CH96, 128:BUS1 - 135:BUS8, 256:AUX1 267:AUX12, 384:MATRIX1L - 391:MATRIX4R, 512:STEREO L 513:STEREO R
Use 256 if the recall destination or store source is a single data
item.
Effect is 0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8, GEQ is 0:GEQ1 - 5:GEQ6
If the store destination is 16383 (0x3FFF), this indicates that the
library data has been changed by a external cause (such as bulk
reception) (only transmitted by the DM2000)
*2) This is also transmitted when a program that is not assigned in
the [Program Change Table] is recalled. (Normally, it is transmitted by Program Change messages.)
*3) Varies with the firmware version.
13.4.15 Parameter change
(Function call: title)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the title of the specified memory/library will be
changed.
Transmission
In response to a request, a Parameter Change message will be transmitted
on the [Rx CH].
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
0ccccccc cc Channel no.
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.4.14 Parameter change
(Function call Library: store / recall)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
function
INPATCH LIB STORE
OUTPATCH LIB STORE
Bus to Stereo LIB STORE
Surround Monitor LIB STORE
AUTOMIX LIB STORE
Format Details
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
DATA
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Function call
EOX
function
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010000
0100ffff
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
0ddddddd
:
:
:
0ddddddd
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
10
4f
mh
ml
dd
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Function call
title
number High
number Low
title 1
dd title x (depend on the library)
F7 End of exclusive
number High
number Low
channel High
channel Low
End of exclusive
function
SCENE RECALL
EQ LIB RECALL
GATE LIB RECALL
COMP LIB RECALL
EFF LIB RECALL
GEQ LIB RECALL
CHANNEL LIB RECALL
INPATCH LIB RECALL
OUTPATCH LIB RECALL
Bus to Stereo LIB RECALL
Surround Monitor LIB RECALL
AUTOMIX LIB RECALL
0x00
0x01
0x02
0x03
0x04
0x05
0x06
0x07
0x08
0x09
0x0A
0x0B
number
0-99, 8192
1-200, 8192
1-128, 8192
1-128, 8192
1-128, 8192
0-128, 8192
0-128, 8192
0-32, 8192
0-32, 8192
0-32, 8192
0-32, 8192
1-16
channel*1)
256
0-513
0-95
0-513
0-7
0-5
0-513
256
256
256
256
256
rx/tx
rx/tx*2)
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
SCENE STORE
EQ LIB STORE
GATE LIB STORE
COMP LIB STORE
EFF LIB STORE
GEQ LIB STORE
CHANNEL LIB STORE
0x20
0x21
0x22
0x23
0x24
0x25
0x26
1-99
41-200
5-128
37-128
xx*3) -128
1-128
2-128
256, 16383
0-513, 16383
0-95, 16383
0-513, 16383
0-7, 16383
0-5, 16383
0-513, 16383
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
rx/tx
function
SCENE LIB TITLE
EQ LIB TITLE
GATE LIB TITLE
COMP LIB TITLE
EFF LIB TITLE
GEQ LIB TITLE
CHANNEL LIB TITLE
INPATCH LIB TITLE
OUTPATCH LIB TITLE
Bus to Stereo LIB TITLE
Surround Monitor LIB TITLE
AUTOMIX LIB TITLE
0x40
0x41
0x42
0x43
0x44
0x45
0x46
0x47
0x48
0x49
0x4A
0x4B
number
0-99,256 (0:response only)
1-200 (1-40:response only)
1-128 (1-4:response only)
1-128 (1-36:response only)
1-128 (1-xx(*):response only)
0-128 (0:response only)
0-128 (0-1:response only)
0-32 (0:response only)
0-32 (0:response only)
0-32 (0:response only)
0-32 (0:response only)
1-16
size
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
* Varies with the firmware version.
13.4.16 Parameter request
(Function call: title)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, a Parameter Change message will be transmitted on
the [Rx CH].
Refer to the above table for the Functions and Numbers.
STATUS
ID No.
11110000 F0 System exclusive message
01000011 43 Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
382
Appendix C: MIDI
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
TITLE
EOX
0011nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010000
0100ffff
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
3n
3E
7F
10
4f
mh
ml
F7
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Function call
number High
number Low
End of exclusive
13.4.17 Parameter change
(Function call: scene/library clear)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the specified memory/library will be cleared.
Transmission
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
EOX
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010000
0110ffff
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
10
6f
mh
ml
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
function
PAIR ON with COPY
PAIR ON with RESET BOTH
PAIR OFF
*1) 0:CH1 - 95:CH96, 128:BUS1 - 135:BUS8, 256:AUX1 267:AUX12
• In the case of PAIR, you must specify channels for which pairing
is possible.
• In the case of PAIR ON with COPY, you must specify Source
Channel as the copy source, and Destination Channel as the
copy destination.
13.4.19 Parameter change (Function call: effect)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the corresponding effect’s function activates (depending on the effect type).
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
Function call
clear function
number High
number Low
DATA
End of exclusive
EOX
function
SCENE LIB CLEAR
0x60
number
1-99
EQ LIB CLEAR
GATE LIB CLEAR
COMP LIB CLEAR
EFF LIB CLEAR
GEQ LIB CLEAR
CHANNEL LIB CLEAR
INPATCH LIB CLEAR
OUTPATCH LIB CLEAR
Bus to Stereo LIB CLEAR
Surround Monitor LIB CLEAR
AUTOMIX LIB CLEAR
0x61
0x62
0x63
0x64
0x65
0x66
0x67
0x68
0x69
0x6A
0x6B
41-200
5-128
37-128
xx(*)-128
1-128
2-128
1-32
1-32
1-32
1-32
1-16
* Varies with the firmware version.
13.4.18 Parameter change
(Function call: pair)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, pairing will be enabled/disabled for the specified
channel. (Otherwise, these messages are reserved for future use.)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
DATA
EOX
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010001
0000ffff
0sssssss
0sssssss
0ddddddd
0ddddddd
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
11
0f
sh
sl
dh
dl
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Function call Effect Event
function
Release:0, Press:1
Effect number (0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8)
End of exclusive
0x00
0x01
0x02
0x03
channel
0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8
0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8
0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8
0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8
13.4.20 Parameter Change
(Sort table data)
Transmission
When scene memory sort is executed on the DM2000, the memory sort table will be transmitted to Studio Manager.
Studio Manager will sort the memories according to this data.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
DATA
Destination channel H
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
System exclusive message
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
The Scene memory Sort table is updated as soon as the messages are received.
If Studio Manager performs a scene memory sort, it will transmit this data
to the DM2000.
Source channel L
End of exclusive
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
12
0f
00
pp
00
ee
F7
• This does not activate when the effect type is different.
Source channel H
Destination channel L
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010010
0000ffff
00000000
0ppppppp
00000000
0eeeeeee
11110111
function
Freeze Play button
Freeze Record button
Auto Pan 5.1 Trigger Button
Auto Pan 5.1 Reset Button
Function call Pair
function
channel
*1)
*1)
*1)
0x00
0x01
0x02
EOX
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
00010011
0000ffff
0ddddddd
:
:
0ddddddd
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
06
13
0f
ds
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Library sort table
Library type
Data
de Data
F7 End of exclusive
8-7 conversion is performed on the data area in the same way as for bulk.
Format Details
13.4.21 Parameter Request
(Sort table data)
Reception
This is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches
the device number included in the SUB STATUS.
This is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
Sort table data is transmitted as Parameter Change messages on the [Rx
CH] channel.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
EOX
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
00000110
00010011
0000ffff
11110111
F0
43
3n
3E
06
13
0f
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Library sort table
Transmission
In response to a request, a Parameter Change message will be transmitted
on the [Rx CH].
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
14
0f
mh
ml
th
System exclusive message
DATA
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010100
0000ffff
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
0ttttttt
EOX
0ttttttt tl
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
function
SCENE LIB ATTRIBUTE
AUTOMIX LIB ATTRIBUTE
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
attribute
number High
number Low
attribute (protect:0x0001,
normal:0x0000)
0x00
0x0B
number
0-99 (0:response only)
1-16
Reception
This is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches
the device number included in the SUB STATUS. This is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When this is received, a Parameter Change message will be transmitted on
the [Rx CH].
Refer to the above table for the Functions and Numbers.
ATTRIBUTE
EOX
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010100
0000ffff
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
F0
43
3n
3E
7F
14
0f
mh
ml
F7
13.4.24 Parameter change
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
DATA
EOX
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010100
0010ffff
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
0iiiiiii
0iiiiiii
0ooooooo
0ooooooo
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
7F
14
2f
mh
ml
ih
il
oh
ol
F7
function
SCENE LIB LINK
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Function call
link
number High
number Low
inpatch
outpatch
End of exclusive
0x20
number
0-99 (0:response only)
13.4.25 Parameter request
(Function call: link)
Reception
This is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches
the device number included in the SUB STATUS. This is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When this is received, a Parameter Change message will be transmitted on
the [Rx CH].
Refer to the above table for the Functions and Numbers.
Function call
13.4.23 Parameter request (Function call: attribute)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
Transmission
In response to a request, a Parameter Change message will be transmitted
on the [Rx CH].
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
End of exclusive
Reception
This is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches
the device number included in the SUB STATUS.
This is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When this is received, the attribute of the specified memory/library will be
changed.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
When this is received, the patch link data of the specified scene will be
modified.
Library type
13.4.22 Parameter change (Function call: attribute)
383
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
EOX
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
01111111
00010100
0010ffff
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
11110111
F0
43
3n
3E
7F
14
2f
mh
ml
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Function call
link
number High
number Low
End of exclusive
13.4.26 Parameter change
(Key remote)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the same processing that is executed when the key
specified by Address is pressed (released).
Transmission
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
Universal
Function call
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
number High
number Low
End of exclusive
(Function call: link)
DATA
EOX
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
00100000
0kkkkkkk
0kkkkkkk
0kkkkkkk
0ppppppp
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
06
20
kk
kk
kk
pp
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Key remote
Key address H
Key address M
Key address L
Release:0, Press:1
End of exclusive
Reception
This is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches
the device number included in the SUB STATUS. This is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
384
Appendix C: MIDI
13.4.27 Parameter change
(Remote meter)
When transmission is enabled by receiving a Request of Remote meter, the
specified meter information is transmitted every 50 msec for 10 seconds.
When you want to transmit meter information continuously, a Request
must be transmitted continuously within every 10 seconds.
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
Reception
This is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
Transmission
When transmission has been enabled by a Request, the parameter specified
by Address will be transmitted on the [Rx CH] channel at 50 msec intervals
for a duration of 10 seconds.
Transmission will be disabled if the power is turned off and on again, or if
the PORT setting is changed.
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
DATA
EOX
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
00100001
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
0ddddddd
0ddddddd
:
:
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
06
21
mm
mm
mm
dd
dd
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Remote meter
ADDRESS UL
ADDRESS LU
ADDRESS LL
data1 H
Data1 L
F7 End of exclusive
13.4.28 Parameter request
Transmission
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
EOX
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
00000110
00100001
0mmmmmmm
0mmmmmmm
mmmmmmm
0ccccccc
0ccccccc
11110111
F0
43
3n
3E
06
21
mm
mm
mm
ch
cl
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Remote meter
ADDRESS UL
ADDRESS LU
ADDRESS LL
Count H
Count L
End of exclusive
13.4.29 Parameter change (Remote time counter)
When transmission is enabled by receiving a Request of Remote Time
Counter, the Time Counter data is transmitted every 50 msec for 10 seconds. When you want to transmit Counter information continuously, a
Request must be transmitted within every 10 seconds.
Reception
This is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
Transmission
When transmission is enabled by receiving a Request, the Time Counter
information is transmitted on [RxCH] channel every 50 msec for 10 seconds.
Transmission will be disabled if the power is turned off and on again, or if
the PORT setting is changed.
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
STATUS
EOX
11110000 F0 System exclusive message
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
43
1n
3E
06
22
0t
dd
dd
dd
dd
F7
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Remote Time counter
0:Time code, 1:Measure.Beat.Clock
Hour / Measure H
Minute / Measure L
Second / Beat
Frame / Clock
End of exclusive
13.4.30 Parameter request (Remote time counter)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, the Time Counter information is transmitted on the
[Rx CH] channel every 50 msec for 10 seconds.
When the second byte of Address is received on 0x7F, data transmission
will be halted immediately. (disable)
Transmission
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
(Remote meter)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When this is received, data of the specified address is transmitted on the
[Rx CH] at intervals of 50 msec as a rule, for a period of 10 seconds.
If Address UL= 0x7F is received, transmission of all meter data will be halted immediately. (disable)
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
DATA
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
00100010
0000tttt
0ddddddd
0ddddddd
0ddddddd
0ddddddd
11110111
EOX
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
00000110
00100010
0ddddddd
F0
43
3n
3E
06
22
dd
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Remote Time counter
0:Transmission request,
0x7F:Transmission stop request
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
13.4.31 Parameter change
(Automix status)
When transmission is enabled by receiving a Request of Automix status,
the Automix Status data is transmitted every second for 10 seconds. When
you want to transmit the Automix Status information continuously, the
Request must be transmitted continuously minimum within 10 seconds
interval. The data is transmitted continuously while the transmission is enabled, even when the Automix Status on the DM2000 has been changed.
Reception
This is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
Transmission
When the transmission is set to enable by receiving a Request. The Automix Status data is transmitted on the [Rx CH] channel every second for 10
seconds. The data is transmitted continuously while the transmission is
enabled, even when the Automix Status on the DM2000 has been changed.
Transmission will be disabled if the power is turned off and on again, or if
the PORT setting is changed.
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
EOX
11110000
01000011
0001nnnn
00111110
00000110
00100011
00000000
0000dddd
0000dddd
11110111
F0
43
1n
3E
06
23
00
0d
0d
F7
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Automix status
Automix status H
Automix status L
End of exclusive
Format Details
13.4.32 Parameter request
385
(Automix status)
Reception
If [Parameter change RX] is ON and the [Rx CH] matches the Device
Number included in the SUB STATUS, these messages are received. If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, these messages are echoed.
When the data is received, the Automix Status data is transmitted on the
[Rx CH] every second for 10 seconds.
When the second byte of Address is received on 0x7F, data transmission
will be halted immediately (disable).
Transmission
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, this message will be retransmitted
without change.
STATUS
ID No.
SUB STATUS
GROUP ID
MODEL ID
ADDRESS
EOX
11110000
01000011
0011nnnn
00111110
00000110
00100011
0ddddddd
F0
43
3n
3E
06
23
dd
System exclusive message
Manufacture's ID number (YAMAHA)
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
MODEL ID (digital mixer)
DM2000
Automix status
0:Transmission request,
0x7F:Transmission stop request
11110111 F7 End of exclusive
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
386
Appendix D: Options
Appendix D: Options
MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge
Installation
1
Attach the brackets to the meter bridge.
2
Screw the four fixing screws into the DM2000, but don’t tighten them fully.
3
Align the meter bridge with the four screws, and then tighten the screws.
4
Connect the meter bridge cable to the DM2000’s METER port.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
MB2000 Peak Meter Bridge
387
Meter Bridge Controls
A Channel indicators
BEAT
S
CLOCK
F
LAMP
DIMMER
J
B INPUT METERING POSITION button & indicators
H
CONTROL
ROOM
TIME CODE
MEASURE
M
6
L STEREO
1 48
This button is used to set the metering position for Output
Channels to pre-EQ, pre-fader, or post-fader. It works in unison
with the PRE EQ, PRE FADER, and POST FADER buttons for
Output Channels on the Meter pages. The indicators show the
current setting.
47 48
95 96
45 46
93 94
43 44
91 92
41 42
89 90
D PEAK HOLD button
This button is used to turn the Peak Hold function on and off. Its
indicator lights up when Peak Hold is on. It works in unison with
the PEAK HOLD buttons on the Meter pages.
E LAYER buttons
37 38
85 86
39 40
87 88
MATRIX 3
MATRIX 2
MATRIX 1
AUX 12
35 36
83 84
AUX 11
33 34
81 82
AUX 10
31 32
79 80
OVER
0
3
6
9
12
15
18
24
30
36
48
AUX 9
29 30
77 78
AUX 8
27 28
75 76
25 26
73 74
23 24
71 72
19 20
67 68
BUS 8
15 16
63 64
BUS 7
13 14
61 62
OVER
0
3
6
9
12
15
18
24
30
36
48
17 18
65 66
21 22
69 70
AUX 7
AUX 6
AUX 5
AUX 4
AUX 3
AUX 2
AUX 1
8
32
56
80
7
31
55
79
BUS 6
11 12
59 60
BUS 5
9 10
57 58
5 6
53 54
3 4
51 52
OVER
0
3
6
9
12
15
18
24
30
36
48
BUS 1
1 2
49 50
BUS 3
BUS 2
BUS 4
7 8
55 56
6
30
54
78
3
27
51
75
1
25
49
73
2
26
50
74
4
28
52
76
5
29
53
77
1
This button is used to set the metering position for Input Channels to pre-EQ, pre-fader, or post-fader. It works in unison with
the PRE EQ, PRE FADER, and POST FADER buttons for Input
Channels on the Meter pages. The indicators show the current
setting.
C OUTPUT METERING POSITION button & indicators
49 96
72
36
56
42
48
MASTER
18
30
24
4
REMOTE
8
OVER
0
3
6
9
12
15
18
24
30
36
48
73 96
8
10
12
14
3
REMOTE
REMOTE 2
25 48
49 72
MATRIX 4
PEAK
HOLD
24
48
72
96
23
47
71
95
POST FADER
22
46
70
94
PRE FADER
21
45
69
93
18
42
66
90
17
41
65
89
16
40
64
88
15
39
63
87
POST FADER
PRE FADER
14
38
62
86
11
35
59
83
10
34
58
82
9
33
57
81
INPUT METERING POSITION
12
36
60
84
PRE EQ
2
13
37
61
85
OUTPUT METERING POSITION
19
43
67
91
PRE EQ
3
6
4
2
REMOTE
1
OVER
0
R
9
20
44
68
92
4
1 24
5
These indicators show which channels are currently being
metered: Input Channels 1–24, 25–48, 49–72, 73–96, or the Output Channels (Bus Outs 1–8, Aux Sends 1–12, Matrix Sends
1–4).
7
These button are used to select Layers for metering. The button
indicator for the currently selected Layer lights up. The [1–24],
[25–48], [49–72], and [73–96] buttons select the Input Layers.
The [MASTER] button selects the Master Layer. The REMOTE
[1–4] buttons select the Remote Layers. If the Meter Follow Layer
preference is on (see page 276), these Layers are selected automatically when the LAYER buttons on the DM2000 are pressed.
The [1–48] button selects Input Channels 1–48, and the [49–96]
button selects Input Channels 49–96, allowing you to meter up
to 48 channels simultaneously.
F TIMECODE counter
This counter displays the current timecode position. When the
Pro Tools Remote Layer is selected, it displays the Pro Tools timecode.
G Meters
These 12-segment LED meters display the signals levels of the
channels on the currently selected Layer.
H STEREO meters
These 32-segment meters display the signal levels of the Stereo
Out.
I CONTROL ROOM button
This button is used to display the level of the Control Room signal on the STEREO meters. Its indicator lights up when the STEREO meters are displaying Control Room levels.
J LAMP DIMMER knob
This knob is used to adjust the brightness of the optional LA1800
Light Goosenecks.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
388
Appendix D: Options
SP2000 Wooden Side Panels
Attach the left side panel as shown below. Attach the right side panel in the same way.
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Index
Index
Symbols
+48V ON/OFF switches 21
Numerics
1–24 button 34
25–48 button 34
2TR I/O
channel status 73
dithering outputs 73
patching digital outputs 81
patching direct outs 81
patching inputs 77
sampling rate conversion 69
2TR IN ANALOG 1 +4 dB (BAL) 47
2TR IN ANALOG 2 –10 dBV (UNBAL)
47
2TR IN DIGITAL AES/EBU 1 & 2 49
2TR IN DIGITAL COAXIAL 3 49
2TR OUT DIGITAL AES/EBU 1 & 2 49
2TR OUT DIGITAL COAXIAL 3 48
2TR OUT DIGITAL OUT PATCH page
81
3-1 surround mode 97
31-band GEQs 183
49–72 button 34
5.1 surround mode 97
6.1 surround mode 97
73–96 button 34
96 kHz, 88.2 kHz, 48 kHz, 44.1 kHz,
selecting 67
A
ABORT/UNDO button 36
Absolute mode, automix 196
AC IN connector 50
AD inputs
connectors 46
in detail 64
patching 77
patching output channel insert ins
80
summary 21
talkback 164
AD8HR/AD824 control 267
Adat I/O card 70
Add-On Effects 178
AES/EBU I/O card 70
ALL CLEAR button 35
ALT LAYER 63
AMP SIMULATE 317
Analog I/O & the AD input section
chapter 64
Architecture
channels 17
I/O 17
ASSIGN 1 button, control room 43
ASSIGN 1 button, control room
surround 43
ASSIGN 1–4 buttons, encoder mode 24
ASSIGN 2 button, control room 43
ASSIGN 2 button, control room
surround 43
Assigning
control changes 219
parameters to encoders 62
program changes 218
See also Routing
targets to remote layers 253
user defined keys 270
ATT control 33
ATTACK control 31
Attenuating
cascade inputs 76
channel signals 130
AUDITION button 37
Auto AUX/MATRIX Display preference
275
AUTO buttons
about 21
in detail 199
Pro Tools 226
STEREO 34
using 202
Auto channel select 60
Auto Channel Select preference 275
Auto DELAY Display preference 274
Auto Direct Out On preference 276
Auto DYNAMICS Display preference
275
Auto EQ Edit In preference 277
Auto EQUALIZER Display preference
275
Auto Inc TC Capture preference 277
AUTO PAN 5.1 327
Auto PAN/SURROUND Display
preference 275
Auto PHASE/INSERT Display
preference 274
Auto ROUTING Display preference 274
Auto scene memory update 186
Auto SOLO Display preference 275
Auto WORD CLOCK Display
preference 275
Automix
about 193
absolute mode 196
AUTO buttons 199
cascading consoles 74
copying events 209
deleting events 213
duplicating events 213
erasing events 209
EVENT EDIT page 213
EVENT JOB page 209
event list 213
FADER EDIT pages 199
features 18
inserting events 213
389
library 173
MAIN page 194
MEMORY page 199
merging events 209
motors on/off 200
moving events 209
offline editing 209
overwrite parameters 196
parameter recording 206
playback 208
protecting memories 173
punching individual parameters 207
recording 202
relative mode 196
rerecording 205
return mode 195
storing to smartmedia 271
storing via bulk dump 220
takeover mode 195
time signature map 202
timecode offset 194
timecode source 201
touch sense in/out 200
undo 197
update to end 194
what’s recorded 193
Automix chapter 193
AUTOMIX MAIN page 194
AUTOMIX MEMORY page 173, 199
AUTOMIX page 173
AUTOMIX section
about 36
automix 198
Pro Tools 233
Automix Store Undo preference 278
AUTOPAN 315
AUTO-REC button 36
AUX 11 button 42
AUX 1–12 buttons 23
AUX 12 button 42
AUX button, automix 37
AUX FADER VIEW page 153
AUX ON button, automix 37
AUX PAN CH pages 116
AUX SELECT section
about 23
Pro Tools 228
using 110
AUX SEND CH pages 112
Aux sends
attenuating 130
automix 193
channel library 166
channel strip displays 56
compressors 137
copying 155
Copying channel fader positions 118
delay 141
EQ 131
Excluding certain channels 117
fixed mode 110
follow surround pan 145
grouping faders 146
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
390
Index
grouping mutes 149
inserts 135
link pan to input channels 116
master level setting 119
metering 129
Mix minus 117
muting 112, 119
naming 156
pairing 144
pan modes 116
panning 116
patching GEQs 82
patching to 2TR digital outputs 81
patching to effects 78
patching to input channels 77
patching to omni outs 80
patching to slot outputs 79
pre/post fader 111
scene recall safe 190
setting levels 111
soloing 142
variable mode 110
viewing fader settings 151
viewing parameter settings 150
viewing settings 114
Aux sends chapter 110
AUX/MATRIX SEND section
about 30
muting aux sends 112
muting matrix sends 122
setting aux send levels 111
setting matrix send levels 121
AUX/MTRX button, encoder mode 23
AUX/MTRX button, fader mode 24
B
BACK button 39
Balance
matrix sends 126
stereo out 106
BANK button 30
BANK indicators 30
Bars, time signature map 202
BASS MANAGEMENT 162
BI-DIRECTIONAL, cascade setting 76
Bit shift attenuation 130
Bulk dump 220
BULK DUMP page 220
BUS button, control room surround 43
BUS FADER VIEW page 152
Bus outs
attenuating 130
automix 193
bus to stereo library 169
channel library 166
compressors 137
copying 155
delay 141
EQ 131
grouping faders 146
grouping mutes 149
inserts 135
level setting 108
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
metering 129
muting 108
naming 156
pairing 144
patching GEQs 82
patching to 2TR digital outputs 81
patching to input channels 77
patching to omni outs 80
patching to slot outputs 79
routing to 93
routing to stereo out 109
scene recall safe 190
soloing 142
viewing fader settings 151
viewing parameter settings 150
Bus outs chapter 107
BUS TO STEREO LIBRARY page 169
BUS TO STEREO page 109
Bypassing effects 177
C
CARD Slot. See Smartmedia
Cascade COMM Link preference 276
CASCADE IN page 76
CASCADE IN port 49
CASCADE IN port pin assignments 350
CASCADE OUT page 76
CASCADE OUT port 49
CASCADE OUT port pin assignments
350
Cascading consoles
about 74
attenuating cascade inputs 76
hookup examples 75
linked functions 74
master setting 76
turning off cascade outputs 76
Category, channel status 73
CH DIRECT OUT DESTINATION
pages 81
CH EQUALIZER LIBRARY page 172
CH FADER EDIT pages 199
CH FADER VIEW page 151
CH GATE EDIT page 86
CH PARAMETER VIEW page 150
CH SURROUND EDIT page 100
Channel Copy Parameter preference 276
CHANNEL COPY section
about 33
using 155
Channel ID preference 276
Channel IDs 57
CHANNEL INSERTS button 26
CHANNEL LIBRARY page 166
Channel names
assigning 156
displaying 57
Channel Short Name preference 276
Channel status monitor 73
CHANNEL STATUS MONITOR page
73
Channel strip displays
about 22
displaying channel names 57
in detail 55
Pro Tools 227
user defined remote layers 255
Channel strips
about 21
Pro Tools 225
selecting layers 58
user defined remote layers 254
CHORUS 313
CHORUS 5.1 327
CLEAR button 42
Clear Edit Channel after REC preference
277
Clearing library memories 165
Clearing scene memories 188
Combination effects 175
Common channel functions chapter 127
COMP 5.1 330
COMP EDIT page 139
COMP indicator 31
COMP LIBRARY page 171
COMP ON button 31
COMPAND 5.1 330
Compander 137
Compressors
channel strip displays 55
grouping input channels 88
grouping output channels 140
library 171
order 137
parameter table 345
presets 137
using 137
Confirmation messages 54
Contrast control 27
CONTROL CHANGE ASSIGN TABLE
page 219
Control changes
assignments 219
echoing 217
omni 217
receive enable 217
storing assignments to smartmedia
271
storing assignments via bulk dump
220
transmit enable 217
CONTROL port 49
CONTROL port pin assignments 350
Control room
dimmer level 159
monitoring 158
patching to 2TR digital outputs 81
setup 159
CONTROL ROOM button 42
CONTROL ROOM LEVEL control 44
CONTROL ROOM SETUP page 159
Control surface
features 19
illustration 20
Index
Control surface & rear panel chapter 20
Cooling fan 50
COPY button 33
Copy Initial Fader preference 277
Copy, channel status 73
Copying automix events 209
Copying channels 155
Cubase SX 253
Current scene display 52
Currently selected channel
display 52
name display 52
selecting 59
Currently selected page
page number display 52
selecting 53
title display 52
Cursor buttons 40
D
DATA button 24
Data entry & transport section
about 39
machine transport 257
Pro Tools 237
Date preference 277
DAW
MIDI port setup 216
See Pro tools
DAW CONTROL 256
DEC button 40
DECAY control 31
DEL, title edit window 54
Delay effects 174
DELAY LCR 312
DELAY SCALE 142
DELAY section
about 29
using 141
DELAY+ER. 322
DELAY+REV 323
DELAY->ER. 323
DELAY->REV 324
Delaying channel signals
channel strip displays 55
how to 141
Deleting automix events 213
Digital I/O & cascading chapter 66
Dimensions 351
DIMMER button 44
Dimmer level, control room 159
Dimmer level, talkback 164
DIO button 24
DIO Warning preference 275
DIRECT button 28
Direct outs
patching 81
routing to 93
Display
about 27
confirmation messages 54
history function 53
in detail 52
items 54
parameter windows 54
Pro Tools 224
DISPLAY ACCESS section
about 24
Pro Tools 229
Display Brightness preference 277
DISPLAY buttons
AUTOMIX 36
AUX SELECT 23
AUX/MATRIX SEND 30
DELAY 29
DYNAMICS 30
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS 26
ENCODER MODE 23
EQUALIZER 33
LOCATOR 37
MATRIX SELECT 22
MONITOR 42
PAN/SURROUND 31
PHASE/INSERT 29
ROUTING 28
SCENE MEMORY 35
TRACK ARMING 35
USER DEFINED KEYS 37
DISPLAY HISTORY buttons 39
DIST->DELAY 324
DISTORTION 317
DITHER page 73
Dithering digital outputs 73
DIV (divergence) 101
Double channel 72
Double speed 72
Drop Out Time preference 278
DUAL PITCH 316
Ducking, input channels 85
Duplicating automix events 213
DYNA. FILTER 318
DYNA. FLANGE 318
DYNA. PHASER 318
Dynamic effects 175
DYNAMICS section
about 30
compressors 139
gates 85
Dynamics. See Gates and Compressors
E
EARLY REF. 310
ECHO 312
Edit buffer 185
Edit indicators
display 52
SCENE MEMORY section 185
391
Editing
automix events 209
compressors 137
effects 177
gates 85
GEQs 183
library memory titles 165
plug-ins 181
scene memory titles 188
EFFECT button 32
EFFECT EDIT page 177
EFFECT INPUT PATCH pages 78
EFFECT INPUT/OUTPUT METER
page 129
EFFECT LIBRARY page 168
Effects
about 174
automix 193
bypassing 177
editing 177
features 18
library 168
metering 129
parameter tables 310
patching inputs 78
patching output channel insert ins
80
patching outputs 77
presets 174
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS 1–8 buttons 26
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS section
about 26
editing effects 177
editing GEQs 183
editing plug-ins 181
Pro Tools 230
ÉIÅ 209
Emphasis, channel status 73
ENABLE button 36
ENCODER MODE ASSIGN page 62
ENCODER MODE section
about 23
Pro Tools 228
using 61
Encoder modes, selecting 61
Encoders
about 21
assignable parameter list 63
assigning parameters 62
automix punch in/out 207
channel strip displays 56
panning input channels 95
patching inputs & outputs 83
Pro Tools 226
selecting encoder modes 61
setting aux send levels 111
setting matrix send levels 122
user defined remote layers 254
END button 38
ENTER button 40
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
392
Index
EQ
automix 193
channel strip displays 55
EQUALIZER EDIT page 134
features 18
frequency 133
gain 133
grouping input channels 87
grouping output channels 135
library 172
presets 132
Q 133
using 131
EQ button, automix 37
EQ displays 33
EQ GAIN controls 33
EQ ON button 33
EQUALIZER EDIT page 134
EQUALIZER section
about 33
using 133
Erasing automix events 209
EVENT EDIT page 213
Event editing 209
EVENT JOB page 209
Event list, automix 213
Expander 137
F
F1–F4 buttons 27
FADER button 24
FADER button, automix 37
Fader edit mode 196
FADER MODE section
about 24
Pro Tools 229
using 60
Fader REC Accuracy preference 278
Fader Resolution 218
Fader Touch Sense preference 276
Faders
about 22
auto channel select 60
automix punch in/out 207
aux send master levels 119
bus out levels 108
fader edit mode 196
Group Master 92, 147
grouping input channels 91
grouping output channels 146
input channel levels 90
matrix send master levels 125
motors on/off 200
Pro Tools 226
selecting fader modes 60
setting aux send levels 111
setting matrix send levels 121
STEREO 34
stereo out level 105
touch sense in/out, automix 200
touch sense select 60
user defined remote layers 254
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
Fading scenes 189
Fast Meter Fall Time preference 275
FB/MIX control 29
FB/MIX indicators 29
Features 17
FF button 39
FILE page 273
Fixed mode, aux sends 110
FLANGE 313
FLANGE 5.1 328
Fluorescent displays 22
FOLLOW PAN button 28
FOLLOW SURROUND 78
Follow surround pan, aux sends 145
Formatting smartmedia 273
FORWARD button 39
Frame Jump Error preference 278
Frame rate, automix 201
FREQUENCY controls 33
FREQUENCY indicators 33
FX 174
GRAPHIC EQUALIZER EDIT page 183
GRAPHIC EQUALIZER INSERT page
82
GRAPHIC EQUALIZER LIBRARY page
168
GRAPHIC EQUALIZERS button 26
Grounding screw 50
GROUP button 25
Group Master 90, 92, 147, 149
Grouping
features 18
input channel compressors 88
input channel EQs 87
input channel faders 91
input channel mutes 89
output channel compressors 140
output channel EQs 135
output channel faders 146
output channel mutes 149
track arming 263
Guitar effects 175
G
H
GAIN control, dynamics 31
GAIN controls, AD inputs 21
Gang mode
aux send pan 116
input channel pan 96
GATE indicator 31
GATE LIBRARY page 170
GATE ON button 31
GATE REVERB 310
GATE/COMP button 31
Gates
channel strip displays 55
library 170
parameter table 345
presets 85
using 85
General DAW 253
GEQs
about 183
editing 183
features 18
library 168
linking 183
patching 82
Global Fade Time 190
Global Paste 191
GLOBAL PASTE DESTINATION
SCENE page 192
GLOBAL PASTE SOURCE CH SELECT
page 191
GLOBAL RECALL SAFE 190
GPI 264
REC LAMP 266
GPI SETUP page 264
GR meters
compressors 140
gates 86
GRAB button 32
HA CONTROL page 268
HIGH EQ 131
HIGHER SAMPLE RATE DATA
TRANSFER FORMAT page 72
HIGH-MID EQ 131
History function 53
HOLD control 31
Horizontal pairing 144
HQ. PITCH 315
I
IEEE1394 70
IN button 38
INC button 40
Individual mode
aux send pan 116
input channel pan 96
Initial Data Nominal preference 275
Initializing the DM2000 282
Input & output patching chapter 77
INPUT A & B (BAL) connectors 46
INPUT CH ATTENUATOR/SHIFTER
pages 130
INPUT CH AUX VIEW pages 114
INPUT CH DELAY pages 141
INPUT CH FADE TIME pages 189
INPUT CH FADER GROUP page 91
INPUT CH INSERT IN PATCH pages
78
INPUT CH METER page 128
INPUT CH MUTE GROUP page 89
INPUT CH PAIR pages 145
INPUT CH PAN page 96
INPUT CH PAN pages 96
INPUT CH PHASE pages 84
INPUT CH ROUTING pages 94
INPUT CH SURROUND pages 101
INPUT CHANNEL NAME page 156
Index
Input channels
attenuating 130
automix 193
channel library 166
compressors 137
copying 155
delay 141
EQ 131
gating 85
grouping compressors 88
grouping EQs 87
grouping faders 91
grouping mutes 89
inserts 135
level setting 90
metering 128
muting 88
naming 156
pairing 144
panning 95
patching 77
reversing phase 84
selecting layers 58
soloing 142
viewing fader settings 151
viewing parameter settings 150
Input channels chapter 84
INPUT COMP LINK page 88
INPUT EQUALIZER LINK page 87
INPUT FADER GROUP MASTER page
92
INPUT FADER MASTER 92
INPUT MUTE MASTER 90
INPUT PATCH button 25
INPUT PATCH LIBRARY page 167
INPUT PATCH pages 77
Input patching 77
INPUT PORT NAME page 82
Input port naming 82
INS, title edit window 54
INSERT IN & OUT +4dB (BAL)
connectors 46
INSERT ON button 29
INSERT ON/OFF switches 21
INSERT pages 136
Insert Time Link preference 278
Inserting automix events 213
Inserts
AD insert on/off switches 21
channel strip displays 55
order 137
patching input channel insert ins 78
patching insert outs to effects inputs
78
patching insert outs to omni outs 80
patching insert outs to slot outputs
79
patching output channel insert ins
80
patching outs to 2TR digital outputs
81
using 135
Installing I/O cards 71
INTERNAL EFFECTS button 26
Internal effects, plug-ins & GEQs
chapter 174
Internal timecode source 201
Internet, yamaha web site 6
Inverse gang mode
aux send pan 116
input channel pan 96
Inverting input channel phase 84
J
Joystick
about 32
panning input channels 95
reverb 5.1 effect 326
surround pan 99
Joystick Auto Grab preference 276
K
KEYBOARD connector 48
Keyboard, using 55
Keyin source 86
L
L button 31
LARGE CONTROL ROOM MONITOR
OUT +4 dB (BAL) 47
Last solo mode 143
LAYER section
about 34
selecting layers 58
Layers
encoder modes 61
fader modes 60
selecting 58
selecting channels 59
Learn function
user defined plug-ins 181
user defined remote layers 254
Left Tab Scroll button 27
LEVEL controls, aux/matrix sends 30
LFE 100
Libraries
about 165
automix 173, 193
bus to stereo 169
channel 166
compressor 171
effects 168
EQ 172
gate 170
GEQ 168
input patch 167
output patch 167
specifications 346
storing to smartmedia 271
storing via bulk dump 220
surround monitor 173
using 165
393
Libraries chapter 165
LINK button 32
Link Capture & Locate Memory
preference 277
LISTEN, solo 143
LOAD page 272
Loading from smartmedia 272
LOCATE MEMORY 1–8 buttons 38
LOCATE MEMORY page 260
LOCATOR section
about 37
Pro Tools 235
using 258
Lock Time preference 278
Long channel names
assigning 156
displaying 57
Long port names 82
LOOP button 38
LOW EQ 131
LOW-MID EQ 131
M
M. BAND DYNA. 329
MACHINE CONFIGURATION page
256
MACHINE CONTROL 256
Machine control
about 256
arming tracks 261
locator 258
machine configuration 256
master track arming 262
MTR track arming 262
pre-roll, post-roll, roll-back 260
REMOTE port setup 257
scrub & shuttle 258
setting locate memories 260
track arming groups 263
transport buttons 257
Macintosh
configuring for Pro Tools 221
MIDI port setup 216
USB driver 215
Managing smartmedia 273
MASTER button, layer 34
MASTER button, locator 39
MASTER button, track arming 35
Master layer, selecting 58
MASTER METER page 129
MASTER PARAMETER VIEW page 151
MASTER TRACK ARMING
CONFIGURATION page 262
MATRIX 1–4 buttons 22
MATRIX FADER VIEW page 153
MATRIX PAN page 123
MATRIX SELECT section
about 22
Pro Tools 228
using 121
MATRIX SEND pages 122
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
394
Index
Matrix sends
attenuating 130
automix 193
balance 126
channel library 166
channel strip displays 56
compressors 137
copying 155
delay 141
EQ 131
grouping faders 146
grouping mutes 149
inserts 135
level setting 125
metering 129
muting 122, 125
naming 156
panning 123
patching GEQs 82
patching to 2TR digital outputs 81
patching to omni outs 80
patching to slot outputs 79
pre/post fader 121
scene recall safe 190
setting levels 121
soloing 142
viewing fader settings 151
viewing parameter settings 150
viewing settings 124
Matrix sends chapter 121
MATRIX VIEW page 124
MB2000 peak meter bridge 386
Measures, time signature map 202
Merging automix events 209
METER button 25
Meter Follow Layer preference 276
METER port 49
Meter, time signature map 202
Metering
effects 129
input channels 128
metering position 127
output channels 129
stereo out 130
METERING POSITION page 127
MIDI
bulk dump 220
control change messages 219
data format 369
features 19
I/O ports 215
MIDI SETUP page 217
parameter change messages 219
port setup 216
ports 49
program change messages 218
supported messages 215
MIDI button 25
MIDI chapter 215
MIDI clock
automix timecode source 201
MIDI SETUP page 217
MIDI Warning preference 275
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
MIDI/TO HOST SETUP page 216
mini YGDAI. See Slots
Mix minus 117
Mix solo mode 143
Mix Update Confirmation preference
277
Mixdown, solo status 143
mLAN I/O card 70
MMC. See Machine control
MOD. DELAY 311
MOD. FILTER 317
Modulation-based effects 175
MONITOR ALIGNMENT 163
MONITOR MATRIX 161
MONITOR section 42
Monitoring
configuring surround monitoring
161
control room 158
control room setup 159
studio 159
surround 160
Monitoring & talkback chapter 158
MONO button 44
MONO DELAY 311
Motors on/off 200
Moving automix events 209
MS decoding 146
MS microphone 103
MTC TIME CODE INPUT connector
48
MTC, timecode source 201
MTR button 38
MTR TRACK ARMING
CONFIGURATION page 262
MULTI FILTER 325
Multi-effects 174
Muting
automix 193
aux sends 112, 119
bus outs 108
Group Master 90, 149
grouping input channels 89
grouping output channels 149
input channels 88
matrix sends 122, 125
stereo out 105
N
Name Input Auto Copy 82
Naming channels 156
Naming library memories 165
Naming scene memories 187
NEVER LATCH TALKBACK 164
Nominal Pan preference 275
O
OCTA REVERB 327
Offline editing 209
Offsetting automix timecode 194
OMNI OUT +4dB (BAL) 47
OMNI OUT PATCH page 80
Omni outs
about 65
patching 80
patching direct outs 81
Omni, MIDI 217
OMS
configuring for Pro Tools 222
installing for Pro Tools 221
ON button, automix 37
ON button, delay section 29
ON buttons
Pro Tools 226
See also Grouping
See also Muting
STEREO 34
user defined remote layers 254
ON buttons, aux/matrix sends 30
ONLINE button 38
Operating basics chapter 51
Operation Lock 280
OPERATION LOCK page 280
Options 6
Order, inserts/compressors 137
Oscillator 279
OSCILLATOR page 279
Other functions chapter 269
OUT button 38
OUTPUT ATTENUATOR page 130
OUTPUT CHANNEL NAME page 157
Output channels
attenuating 130
compressors 137
copying 155
delay 141
EQ 131
grouping compressors 140
grouping EQs 135
grouping faders 146
grouping mutes 149
inserts 135
library 166
metering 129
naming 156
pairing 144
selecting master layer 58
soloing 142
viewing fader settings 151
viewing parameter settings 150
OUTPUT COMP LINK page 140
OUTPUT DELAY page 141
OUTPUT EQUALIZER LINK page 135
OUTPUT FADE TIME page 189
OUTPUT FADER GROUP MASTER
page 148
OUTPUT FADER GROUP page 146
OUTPUT FADER MASTER 148
OUTPUT INSERT IN PATCH page 80
OUTPUT MUTE GROUP page 149
OUTPUT MUTE MASTER 149
OUTPUT PAIR page 145
OUTPUT PATCH button 25
OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY page 167
Output patching 79
Index
OUTPUT PORT NAME page 82
Output port naming 82
Overwrite parameters 196
P
P2. See Machine control
Package contents 6
PAD switches 21
Pages
history function 53
page number display 52
page tab scroll arrows 53
selecting 53
tabs 53
title display 52
PAIR button 25
Pair Confirmation preference 275
Pairing channels 144
features 18
pan modes 96
PAN button 23
PAN button, automix 37
PAN control 32
PAN display 31
PAN/SURROUND section
about 31
joystick and surround pan 99
panning input channels 95
Panner 252
Panning
automix 193
aux sends 116
channel strip displays 56
input channels 95
matrix sends 123
modes 96
Parameter boxes 54
Parameter change messages 219
Parameter controls 1–4 27
Parameter Up/Down buttons 26
Parameter wheel 40
Parameter windows 54
PASTE button 33
Patch Confirmation preference 275
PATCH LINK 188
Patch select window 83
Patching
2TR digital outputs 81
direct outs 81
effects inputs 78
features 18
GEQs 82
input channel insert ins 78
input channels 77
input library 167
inputs 77
omni outs 80
output channel insert ins 80
output library 167
outputs 79
patch select window 83
slot outputs 79
surround monitor 163
with the encoders 83
Patterns 100
PC
configuring for Pro Tools 221
MIDI port setup 216
USB driver 215
Peak hold 127
PEAK indicators 21
Phantom power switches 21
Phase button 29
Phase, input channel phase reverse 84
PHASE/INSERT section
about 29
reversing phase 84
using inserts 135
PHASER 314
Phone jacks 45
PHONES jack 41
PHONES LEVEL control 41
Phono connectors 45
Picture of control surface 20
PLAY button, automix 197
PLAY button, transport 39
Playing back an automix 208
PLUG-IN EDIT page 181
PLUG-IN SETUP page 180
Plug-ins
about 179
configuring 180
editing 181
MIDI port setup 216
storing to smartmedia 271
storing via bulk dump 220
PLUG-INS button 26
Port ID preference 276
Port ID/Name on FL Display preference
276
Port IDs 82
Port names 82
Port Short Name preference 276
Position, compressors 139
POST button 38
Post/pre. See Pre/post
Post-roll, machine control 260
Power cord 51
POWER switch 50
Powering up the DM2000 51
PRE button 37
Pre/post
aux sends 111
matrix sends 121
metering 127
solo 143
PREFERENCES1 page 274
PREFERENCES2 page 276
PREFERENCES3 page 277
Pre-roll, machine control 260
395
Presets
compressors 137
effects 174
EQ 132
gates 85
Pro tools
arming parameters for automation
251
assigning inputs to channels 239
assigning inserts/plug-ins 244
assigning outputs to channels 240
assigning send destinations 242
automation 250
AUTOMIX section 233
AUX SELECT section 228
bypassing all plug-ins 246
bypassing individual plug-ins 246
channel strip displays 227
channel strips 225
configuring 222
configuring Macintosh computers
221
configuring sends as pre or post 242
configuring the DM2000 222
configuring Windows computers
221
control surface operation 224
data entry & transport section 237
display 224
DISPLAY ACCESS section 229
editing plug-ins 245
EFFECTS/PLUG-INS section 230
ENCODER MODE section 228
FADER MODE section 229
flip mode 243
LOCATOR section 235
making fine adjustments to the
selected region 248
MATRIX SELECT section 228
muting channels 241
muting sends 243
navigating the edit window 247
OMS 221
Panner 252
panning channels 241
panning sends 243
resetting faders, sends, panpots &
plug-ins 247
scrolling windows 238
scrub & shuttle 249
selecting channels 239
setting channel levels 240
setting send levels 243
setting the automation mode 250
soloing channels 241
TRACK ARMING section 233
trim mode 251
USER DEFINED KEYS section 234
zooming 248
Pro tools remote layer chapter 221
PROGRAM CHANGE ASSIGN TABLE
page 218
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
396
Index
Program changes
assignments 218
echoing 217
omni 217
receive enable 217
storing assignments to smartmedia
271
storing assignments via bulk dump
220
transmit enable 217
Protecting automix memories 173
Protecting scene memories 188
PS/2 keyboard 55
Punch in/out, individual parameters 207
Q
Q controls 33
Q indicators 33
Q, EQ 133
QUICK PUNCH button 38
R
R button 31
RANGE control 31
RATIO control 31
RCA connectors 45
Read-only memories 165
Rear panel 45
REC button, automix 36
REC button, transport 39
REC LAMP 266
RECALL button 36
Recall Confirmation preference 275
RECALL SAFE page 190
Recalling
memory libraries 165
scene memories 187
Receive channel 217
Receive Full Frame Message preference
278
Recording an automix 202
Recording, solo status 143
REHEARSAL button 39
RELATIVE button 36
Relative mode, automix 196
RELEASE control 31
REMOTE 1–4 buttons 34
REMOTE button 24
Remote control chapter 253
Remote layers
about 253
assigning targets 253
MIDI port setup 216
Pro Tools 221
selecting 58
REMOTE page 253
REMOTE page, Pro Tools 224
REMOTE page, user defined 254, 255
REMOTE port 49
REMOTE port pin assignments 350
REMOTE PORT SETUP page 257, 267
Requesting bulk dump 220
Rerecording an automix 205
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
RETURN button 36
Return mode, automix 195
RETURN TO ZERO button 38
REV+CHORUS 319
REV+FLANGE 320
REV+SYMPHO. 321
REV->CHORUS 319
REV->FLANGE 320
REV->PAN 322
REV->SYMPHO. 321
REVERB 5.1 326
Reverb effects 174
REVERB HALL 310
REVERB PLATE 310
REVERB ROOM 310
REVERB STAGE 310
REVERSE GATE 310
Reversing input channel phase 84
REW button 39
Right Tab Scroll button 27
RING MOD. 316
ROLL BACK button 38
Roll-back, machine control 260
ROTARY 316
Routing
channel strip displays 55
input channels 93
ROUTING 1–8 buttons 29
ROUTING page 94
ROUTING section
about 28
using 93
Routing ST Pair Link preference 276
S
Safe channels, automix 200
Safe channels, scene memories 190
Safe channels, solo 143
Sampling rate
2TR I/O SRC 69
display 52
setting 67
slot SRC 72
SAMPLING RATE CONVERTER page
69
SAVE page 271
Saving to smartmedia 271
Scene down button 36
Scene MEM Auto Update preference 276
Scene memories
about 185
auto scene memory update 186
automix 193
cascading consoles 74
current scene display 52
edit buffer 185
edit indicator 185
fading scenes 189
memory #0 186
MIDI program changes 218
protecting 188
recalling 187
safe channels 190
sorting 191
storing 187
storing to smartmedia 271
storing via bulk dump 220
undo memory 186
what’s stored 185
Scene memories chapter 185
Scene memory display 35
SCENE MEMORY page 188
SCENE MEMORY section
about 35
using 187
SCENE MEMORY SORT page 191
Scene up button 36
Scroll arrows, pages 53
SCRUB button 40
SEL buttons
about 21
displaying long channel names 57
pairing channels 144
Pro Tools 226
selecting channels 59
STEREO 60
SEL MODE, solo 143
SELECTED CHANNEL section 28
Selecting
encoder modes 61
fader modes 60
layers 58
pages 53
Selecting channels
auto channel select 60
channel strip displays 55
how to 59
touch sense select 60
SERIAL TO HOST port 48
MIDI 215
timecode source 201
SET button 38
SET SPL85 161
Setting levels
aux send masters 119
aux sends 111
bus outs 108
input channels 90
matrix send masters 125
matrix sends 121
stereo out 105
SETUP button 24
Shadow memories 186
SHIFT LOCK, title edit window 54
Short channel names 156
Short port names 82
Show Compact Size preference 278
SHUTTLE button 39
SIGNAL indicators 21
Slate 163
SLATE button 44
SLOT OUTPUT PATCH pages 79
Index
Slots
about 50, 70
available cards 70
channel status 73
dithering outputs 73
double channel 72
double speed 72
installing cards 71
MIDI 215
patching direct outs 81
patching inputs 77
patching output channel insert ins
80
patching outputs 79
timecode source 201
SMALL button 44
SMALL CONTROL ROOM MONITOR
OUT +4 dB (BAL) 47
SMALL TRIM control 41
Smartmedia
card slot 22
formatting 273
handling 5
loading 272
managing 273
saving 271
SMPTE TIME CODE INPUT connector
48
Solo
cascading consoles 74
configuring 143
safe channels 143
sel mode 143
status 143
trim 143
using 142
Solo Bus to Studio Out preference 276
SOLO buttons
about 22
Pro Tools 226
using 142
SOLO CONTRAST control 42
SOLO indicator 42
SOLO SETUP page 143
SOLO TRIM 143
Soloing channels 142
Sonic Spec 17
Sorting scene memories 191
SP2000 wooden side panels 388
SPEAKER SETUP 161
Specifications 341
SRC. See Sampling rate
STATUS, solo 143
STEREO 2TR A1 button 43
STEREO 2TR A2 button 43
STEREO 2TR D1 button 43
STEREO 2TR D2 button 43
STEREO 2TR D3 button 43
STEREO button, control room 43
STEREO button, routing 28
STEREO button, studio 42
STEREO DELAY 311
STEREO fader 34
STEREO FADER VIEW page 154
Stereo link, compressors 139
Stereo link, gates 86
Stereo link, surround pan 101
STEREO METER page 130
Stereo out
attenuating 130
automix 193
balance 106
channel library 166
compressors 137
copying 155
delay 141
EQ 131
grouping faders 146
grouping mutes 149
inserts 135
level setting 105
metering 129, 130
muting 105
naming 156
patching GEQs 82
patching to 2TR digital outputs 81
patching to omni outs 80
patching to slot outputs 79
routing to 93
scene recall safe 190
viewing fader settings 151
viewing parameter settings 150
STEREO OUT +4 dB (BAL) 47
STEREO OUT –10 dBV (UNBAL) 47
Stereo out chapter 104
STEREO section 34
STOP button, automix 197
STOP button, transport 39
STORE button 36
Store Confirmation preference 275
Storing
library memories 165
scene memories 187
see also Smartmedia
STUDIO LEVEL control 41
Studio manager port setup 216
STUDIO MONITOR OUT +4 dB (BAL)
46
Studio monitoring 159
SURROUND BUS SETUP page 99
SURROUND button, automix 37
SURROUND MODE SELECT page 97
SURROUND MONITOR LEVEL
control 43
SURROUND MONITOR LIBRARY 173
SURROUND MONITOR page 160
SURROUND MONITOR PATCH page
163
SURROUND MONITOR SETUP page
161
Surround monitoring 160
configuring 161
library 173
patching slot inputs 163
patching to omni outs 80
patching to slot outputs 79
397
Surround pan
automix 193
aux send pan 145
channel page 101
edit page 100
features 19
joystick 99
selecting modes 97
using 97
Switching on the DM2000 51
SYMPHO 5.1 328
SYMPHONIC 314
T
Tabs, pages 53
Takeover mode, automix 195
Talkback
AD inputs 164
dimmer level 164
mic 41
setup 164
using 163
TALKBACK button 44
TALKBACK LEVEL control 41
TALKBACK SETUP page 164
Tascam I/O card 70
TC Drop Warning preference 275
Terminating wordclocks 68
THRESHOLD control 31
TIME control 29
TIME REFERENCE page 201
Time signature map, automix 202
TIME SIGNATURE page 202
Timecode
automix source 201
capturing, automix 213
capturing, locate memories 260
display 194
offset 194
Title edit window 54
Titling library memories 165
Titling scene memories 187
TO END 194
TOUCH SENSE button 37
Touch Sense Edit In All preference 278
Touch sense in/out, automix 200
Touch sense select
channel strip displays 55
using 60
TRACK ARMING 1–24 buttons 35
TRACK ARMING GROUP A–D
buttons 35
TRACK ARMING GROUP page 263
TRACK ARMING section
about 35
Pro Tools 233
using 261
Transmit channel 217
Transmitting bulk dump 220
Transport. See Data entry & transport
section
TREMOLO 315
Turning channels on or off. See Muting
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
398
Index
Turning on the DM2000 51
Type I/II EQ 134
U
Undo automix 197
Undo scene memory 186
UPDATE 194
USB TO HOST port 48
drivers 215
MIDI 215
timecode source 201
USER ASSIGNABLE LAYER 269
USER DEFINED KEY ASSIGN page 270
USER DEFINED KEYS 1–16 buttons 37
USER DEFINED KEYS section
about 37
Pro Tools 234
using 270
User defined layers
automix 193
configuring 254
storing to smartmedia 271
storing via bulk dump 220
using 255
User defined plug-ins
about 179
automix 193
configuring 180
editing 181
storing to smartmedia 271
storing via bulk dump 220
UTILITY button 24
V
Variable mode, aux sends 110
Vertical pairing 144
VIEW button 25
Viewing channel fader settings
input channels 151
output channels 151
Viewing channel parameter settings
input channels 150
output channels 150
W
Waves Y56K plug-ins effects card 179
Web site 6
Welcome chapter 17
Windows
configuring for Pro Tools 221
MIDI port setup 216
USB driver 215
WORD CLOCK 75Ω ON/OFF
termination switch 48
WORD CLOCK IN connector 48
WORD CLOCK OUT 1 connector 48
WORD CLOCK OUT 2 connector 48
WORD CLOCK SELECT page 67
Wordclocks
about 66
connections 66
selecting the source 67
terminating 68
DM2000 Version 2—Owner’s Manual
X
XLR connectors 45
Y
Y56K plug-ins effects card 179
Yamaha web site 6
YGDAI. See Slots
A3_Block & Level Diagram_E Page 1 Monday, March 27, 2006 11:29 AM
DM2000 Block Diagram
(Gain Reduction) (Out Meter)
METER METER
INPUT 1(...96)
METER
PAD
0
26
INSERT
OFF
AD Input
1-24
AD
INSERT IN
GATE
AD IN 1(...24)
ON
SLOT1
16
SLOT2
16
SLOT3
16
SLOT4
16
SLOT5
16
SLOT6
96
TO SURROUND MONITOR
METER
FX1 SEND 1-8
ATT
4BAND
EQ
SLOT1 Input
1-16
SLOT2 Input
1-16
SLOT3 Input
1-16
SLOT4 Input
1-16
SLOT5 Input
1-16
SLOT6 Input
1-16
INPUT
DELAY
(Gain Reduction) (Out Meter)
METER METER
COMP
METER METER
PRE/POST
ON
AUX
Keyin
Self or Stereo Link
METER
ATT
DIRECT OUT 1(...96)
126
METER
32
FX3 SEND 1-2
FX4 SEND 1-2
FX5 SEND 1-2
Sur2 Return 1-8
Sur1-2
FX2 Return 1-2
FX3 Return 1-2
FX4 Return 1-2
FX5 Return 1-2
FX6 Return 1-2
FX7 Return 1-2
FX8 Return 1-2
FX6 SEND 1-2
FX7 SEND 1-2
FX8 SEND 1-2
LEVEL
ON
2TR IN DIGITAL 2
2TR IN DIGITAL 3
2
AES/EBU
2
AES/EBU
2
COAXIAL
SRC
2TRD1 L/R
SRC
2TRD2 L/R
ON
AUX1(...12)
METER METER
COMP
INSERT
METER
ATT
isolate
INSERT
4BAND
EQ
from
BUS1(...8)
from
AUX1(...12)
USE AD IN (1-24)
AS TALKBACK
2TRD3 L/R
2TR OUT DIGITAL PATCH
STEREO
BUS1-8
AUX1-12
MTRX1L-4R
DIRECT OUT1-96
INSERT OUT
Same Above
SLATE
AD
SOLO TRIM
2TRA1 L/R
DA
AUX1-12
1
DA
8
12
8
BUS1-8
AUX1-12
MATRIX1L-4R
10
TO MONITOR SELECT
AUX1-12
2
2
2
2
2
2
STEREO
2TR D1
2TR D2
2TR D3
2TR A1
2TR A2
2TRA2 L/R
AD
BUS1-8
INPUT PATCH
SURROUND MONITOR
STEREO
BUS1-8
AUX1-12
MTRX1L-4R
DIRECT OUT 1-96
INSERT OUT
8
8
12
8
2
2
8
12
8
STEREO L
STEREO R
MONITOR SELECT
L
R
4
OMNI OUT
126
DA
5
DA
6
DA
16
16
16
16
16
16
DITHER
DITHER
DITHER
DITHER
DITHER
DITHER
STEREO R
DA
STUDIO LEVEL
BUS1-8
AUX1-12
12
MATRIX1L-4R
8
ASSIGN2
STUDIO MONITOR OUT
DA
R
PHONES LEVEL
PHONES
DA
L
DA
C-R
LEVEL
OUTPUT SOLO
8
L
DA
DA
DA
2TR OUT DIGITAL 3
COAXIAL
R
SMALL
TRIM
L
R
SLOT1 Input 1-16
SLOT2 Input 1-16
SLOT3 Input 1-16
SLOT4 Input 1-16
SLOT5 Input 1-16
SLOT6 Input 1-16
16x8Patch SLOT
8
16
8
16
8
16
8
16
8
16
8
16
CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT
LARGE
CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT
SMALL
SURROUND MONITOR
LEVEL
PINK NOISE
500-2kHz
BPF
1kHz,50Hz
8 BUS
8
MONITOR
MATRIX
BASS
MANAGEMENT
MONITOR
ALLIGNMENT
TO OUTPUT PATCH
R
DA
DITHER SRC
8
SLOT1
SLOT2
SLOT3
SLOT4
SLOT5
SLOT6
L
STEREO L
STEREO
SOLO LOGIC
ASSIGN1
BUS1-8 or STEREO(Surr.Mode:ST)
7
DA
SLOT1
SLOT2
SLOT3
SLOT4
SLOT5
SLOT6
CONTROL
ROOM
AUX12
2TR OUT DIGITAL 2
AES/EBU
2
3
DA
96
AUX11
2TR OUT DIGITAL 1
AES/EBU
DITHER SRC 2
SURROUND MONITOR to C-R
DA
OMNI 1
OMNI 2
OMNI 3
OMNI 4
OMNI 5
OMNI 6
OMNI 7
OMNI 8
TALKBACK DIMM
8
DITHER SRC 2
AUX11
AUX12
OUTPUT PATCH
BUS1-8
2
8
12
8
96
126
CONTROL ROOM 2
TB
MONO
AD
12
MATRIX 1R(...4R)
Same Above
SOLO R
RCA
MATRIX 1L(...4L)
GEQ
L
R
GEQ
OUTPUT
DELAY
Same Above
R
2TR IN ANALOG 2
METER
CASCADE OUT
SOLO L
TRS
INSERT
ON LEVEL
BAL
Same Above
SRC
TO INPUT PATCH
(Gain Reduction) (Out Meter)
LEVEL PAN
To CASCADE OUTPUT
AD IN 1-24
2TR IN ANALOG 1
BUS 1(...8)
BUS to STEREO
AUX1(...12)
CASCADE IN
TALK BACK
L
LEVEL
GEQ
off
2TR IN DIGITAL 1
BUS 1(...8)
TO INPUT PATCH
Same Above
OSCILLATOR
SINE 100Hz
SINE 1kHz
SINE 10kHz
SINE 1kHz/400Hz
Pink Noise
Burst Noise
GEQ
OUTPUT
DELAY
PRE/POST
STEREO GEQ RETURN
AUX1-12 GEQ RETURN
BUS1-8 GEQ RETURN
MATRIX1-4 GEQ RETURN
31BAND
GEQ
METER
INSERT
ON LEVEL
PAN
FX1 Return 1-2
FX1-8
4BAND
EQ
MATRIX1L
MATRIX1R
MATRIX2L
MATRIX2R
MATRIX3L
MATRIX3R
MATRIX4L
MATRIX4R
INSERT OUT
SELECT
FX2 SEND 1-8
12
INSERT
METER
INSERT
Sur1 Return 1-8
AUX1-12
STEREO R
Same as stereo master L
COMP
GEQ 1(...6)
STEREO L
GEQ
PAN
LFE
(Gain Reduction) (Out Meter)
STEREO GEQ SEND
AUX1-12 GEQ SEND
BUS1-8 GEQ SEND
MATRIX1-4 GEQ SEND
EFFECT
INSERT
ON LEVEL
GEQ
OUTPUT
DELAY
PRE/POST
PAN
Keyin
12ch Group(1-12,1 3-24....)
AUX 1-12
Mono in x 96
TO TALKBACK SELECT
16
INSERT
4BAND
EQ
TB
DIMM
INSERT OUT
ATT
PAN
METER
(Out Meter)
METER
SOLO
DIMM
B
METER
(Gain Reduction)
DIMM
GAIN
INPUT
METER
INSERT
ON LEVEL
BAL
INSERT
METER
INSERT
SMALL
SIGNAL
AUX 12
PEAK
AUX 1
ON
A
SOLO L
SOLO R
+48V
PHANTOM
STEREO L
STEREO R
COMP
x 24
BUS1
BUS2
BUS3
BUS4
BUS5
BUS6
BUS7
BUS8
OFF
L
R
STEREO OUT
DM2000 Level Diagram
Analog
Analog
dBu
Digital
dBFS
PAD
GAIN
INSERT
0
–10
+4
0
–20
–10
PHASE
GATE
INSERT
ATT.
EQ
INSERT
COMP
DELAY
ON
LEVEL
INSERT
PAN
CASCADE IN
BUS
Adder
INSERT
ATT.
EQ
INSERT
COMP
MASTER
ON
MASTER
LEVEL
INSERT
BAL
DELAY
GEQ
OUTPUT
PATCH
[+18dBu]
2
[+10dBu]
3
Nominal
Input
5
[+4dBu]
GAIN MIN.,
PAD ON
–20
–50
–30
7
–40
–50
–80
–60
–70
–80
–110
–90
Max.
Input
–100
–40
13
15
–50
Nominal
Input
[–60dBu]
–60
GAIN MAX.,
PAD OFF
–70
17
–80
18
–90
20
–100
21
–130
–110
–140
–120
22
–110
23
–120
24
–150
–130
25
–130
26
–160
–140
–170
27
–140
28
29
–150
–180
–160
–150
30
–160
31
–190
–170
–200
–180
32
33
34
–210
–190
[0dBu = 0.775Vrms]
[0dBFS = Full Scale]
–10
[–46dBu]
19
–120
+4
0
–30
16
–100
+10
–20
12
14
–90
Nominal Output
[+4dBu]
10
11
–70
+24
+20
8
9
–60
Max. Output
[+18dBu]
CONTROL ROOM MONITOR OUT
STEREO OUT
STUDIO MONITOR OUT
OMNI OUT (default setting)
6
–40
Analog
DA
CASCADE OUT
Digital Clipping Level
0
4
–30
INPUT
PATCH
Analog
dBu
1
+10
AD
Digital
Bit
Max.
Input [+24dBu]
+24
+20
Digital
DSP Noise Floor
–170
–180
35
36
–190
YAMAHA [Digital Mixing Console-Internal Parameters]
Model: DM2000
Function...
Date: Feb 01, 2002
MIDI Implementation Chart
Version: 1.0
Transmitted
Recognized
Remarks
1–16
1–16
1–16
1–16
Memorized
Memorized
Basic
Channel
Default
Changed
Mode
Default
Messages
Altered
X
X
**************
OMNI off/OMNI on
X
X
Note
Number
:True Voice
X
**************
0–127
X
Velocity
Note On
Note Off
X
X
O
O
After
Touch
Key’s
Ch’s
X
X
X
X
X
X
O
O
Assignable
0–127
**************
0–127
0–99
Assignable
O
O
*1
Pitch Bend
Control
Change
Prog
Change
0-95,102-119
:True#
System Exclusive
Effect Control
System
Common
:Song Pos
:Song Sel
:Tune
X
X
X
O
X
X
Automix
System
Real Time
:Clock
:Commands
X
X
O
O
Automix,
Effect Control
Aux
Messages
:Local ON/OFF
:All Notes OFF
:Active Sense
:Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
O
O
Notes
MTC quarter frame message is recognized.(MTC IN & MIDI IN)
*1: Bulk Dump/Request, Parameter Change/Request, and MMC.
For MIDI Remote, ALL messages can be transmitted.
Mode 1: OMNI ON, POLY
Mode 3: OMNI OFF, POLY
Mode 2: OMNI ON, MONO
Mode 4: OMNI OFF, MONO
O: Yes
X: No
Explanation of Graphical Symbols
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol
within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert
the user to the presence of uninsulated
“dangerous voltage” within the product’s
enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to
constitute a risk of electric shock to persons.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
The exclamation point within an equilateral
triangle is intended to alert the user to the
presence of important operating and
maintenance (servicing) instructions in the
literature accompanying the product.
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
The above warning is located on the top, side, or rear of the unit.
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Read these instructions.
Keep these instructions.
Heed all warnings.
Follow all instructions.
Do not use this apparatus near water.
Clean only with dry cloth.
Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in
accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators,
heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including
amplifiers) that produce heat.
Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or
grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two blades
with one wider than the other. A grounding type plug
has two blades and a third grounding prong. The wide
blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If
the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult
an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet.
Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched
particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the
point where they exit from the apparatus.
11
12
13
14
Only use attachments/accessories specified by the
manufacturer.
Use only with the cart, stand,
tripod, bracket, or table specified
by the manufacturer, or sold with
the apparatus. When a cart is
used, use caution when moving
the cart/apparatus combination
to avoid injury from tip-over.
Unplug this apparatus during
lightning storms or when unused for long periods of
time.
Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.
Servicing is required when the apparatus has been
damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug
is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have
fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been
exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally,
or has been dropped.
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPARATUS TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
(UL60065_03)
For details of products, please contact your nearest Yamaha
representative or the authorized distributor listed below.
Pour plus de détails sur les produits, veuillez-vous adresser à Yamaha ou
au distributeur le plus proche de vous figurant dans la liste suivante.
NORTH AMERICA
CANADA
Yamaha Canada Music Ltd.
135 Milner Avenue, Scarborough, Ontario,
M1S 3R1, Canada
Tel: 416-298-1311
U.S.A.
Yamaha Corporation of America
6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif. 90620,
U.S.A.
Tel: 714-522-9011
CENTRAL & SOUTH AMERICA
MEXICO
Yamaha de México S.A. de C.V.
Calz. Javier Rojo Gómez #1149,
Col. Guadalupe del Moral
C.P. 09300, México, D.F., México
Tel: 55-5804-0600
Die Einzelheiten zu Produkten sind bei Ihrer unten aufgeführten
Niederlassung und bei Yamaha Vertragshändlern in den jeweiligen
Bestimmungsländern erhältlich.
Para detalles sobre productos, contacte su tienda Yamaha más cercana
o el distribuidor autorizado que se lista debajo.
ASIA
POLAND
Yamaha Music Europe GmbH
Branch Sp.z o.o. Oddzial w Polsce
ul. 17 Stycznia 56, PL-02-146 Warszawa, Poland
Tel: 022-500-2925
THE NETHERLANDS/
BELGIUM/LUXEMBOURG
Yamaha Music Europe Branch Benelux
Clarissenhof 5-b, 4133 AB Vianen, The Netherlands
Tel: 0347-358 040
FRANCE
Yamaha Musique France
BP 70-77312 Marne-la-Vallée Cedex 2, France
Tel: 01-64-61-4000
ITALY
Yamaha Musica Italia S.P.A.
Combo Division
Viale Italia 88, 20020 Lainate (Milano), Italy
Tel: 02-935-771
SPAIN/PORTUGAL
BRAZIL
Yamaha Musical do Brasil Ltda.
Rua Joaquim Floriano, 913 - 4' andar, Itaim Bibi,
CEP 04534-013 Sao Paulo, SP. BRAZIL
Tel: 011-3704-1377
Yamaha Música Ibérica, S.A.
Ctra. de la Coruna km. 17, 200, 28230
Las Rozas (Madrid), Spain
Tel: 91-639-8888
SWEDEN
ARGENTINA
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.
Sucursal de Argentina
Olga Cossettini 1553, Piso 4 Norte
Madero Este-C1107CEK
Buenos Aires, Argentina
Tel: 011-4119-7000
PANAMA AND OTHER LATIN
AMERICAN COUNTRIES/
CARIBBEAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.
Torre Banco General, Piso 7, Urbanización Marbella,
Calle 47 y Aquilino de la Guardia,
Ciudad de Panamá, Panamá
Tel: +507-269-5311
EUROPE
THE UNITED KINGDOM
Yamaha Music U.K. Ltd.
Sherbourne Drive, Tilbrook, Milton Keynes,
MK7 8BL, England
Tel: 01908-366700
Yamaha Scandinavia AB
J. A. Wettergrens Gata 1, Box 30053
S-400 43 Göteborg, Sweden
Tel: 031 89 34 00
DENMARK
YS Copenhagen Liaison Office
Generatorvej 6A, DK-2730 Herlev, Denmark
Tel: 44 92 49 00
NORWAY
Norsk filial av Yamaha Scandinavia AB
Grini Næringspark 1, N-1345 Østerås, Norway
Tel: 67 16 77 70
SWITZERLAND/LIECHTENSTEIN
Yamaha Music Europe GmbH
Branch Switzerland in Zürich
Seefeldstrasse 94, 8008 Zürich, Switzerland
Tel: 01-383 3990
AUSTRIA
Yamaha Music Europe GmbH Branch Austria
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien, Austria
Tel: 01-60203900
CZECH REPUBLIC/SLOVAKIA/
HUNGARY/SLOVENIA
Yamaha Music Europe GmbH Branch Austria
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien, Austria
Tel: 01-602039025
Yamaha Music & Electronics (China) Co.,Ltd.
2F, Yunhedasha, 1818 Xinzha-lu, Jingan-qu,
Shanghai, China
Tel: 021-6247-2211
INDIA
Yamaha Music India Pvt. Ltd.
5F Ambience Corporate Tower Ambience Mall Complex
Ambience Island, NH-8, Gurgaon-122001, Haryana, India
Tel: 0124-466-5551
INDONESIA
PT. Yamaha Musik Indonesia (Distributor)
PT. Nusantik
Gedung Yamaha Music Center, Jalan Jend. Gatot
Subroto Kav. 4, Jakarta 12930, Indonesia
Tel: 021-520-2577
KOREA
Yamaha Music Korea Ltd.
8F, 9F, Dongsung Bldg. 158-9 Samsung-Dong,
Kangnam-Gu, Seoul, Korea
Tel: 02-3467-3300
MALAYSIA
Yamaha Music (Malaysia) Sdn., Bhd.
Lot 8, Jalan Perbandaran, 47301 Kelana Jaya,
Petaling Jaya, Selangor, Malaysia
Tel: 03-78030900
SINGAPORE
Yamaha Music (Asia) Pte., Ltd.
#03-11 A-Z Building
140 Paya Lebor Road, Singapore 409015
Tel: 6747-4374
TAIWAN
Yamaha KHS Music Co., Ltd.
3F, #6, Sec.2, Nan Jing E. Rd. Taipei.
Taiwan 104, R.O.C.
Tel: 02-2511-8688
THAILAND
RUSSIA
Yamaha Music (Russia)
Room 37, bld. 7, Kievskaya street, Moscow,
121059, Russia
Tel: 495 626 5005
OTHER EUROPEAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: +49-4101-3030
GERMANY
Yamaha Music Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
THE PEOPLE’S REPUBLIC OF CHINA
AFRICA
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Sales & Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,
Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2303
MIDDLE EAST
TURKEY/CYPRUS
Yamaha Music Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
OTHER COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Gulf FZE
LOB 16-513, P.O.Box 17328, Jubel Ali,
Dubai, United Arab Emirates
Tel: +971-4-881-5868
Siam Music Yamaha Co., Ltd.
4, 6, 15 and 16th floor, Siam Motors Building,
891/1 Rama 1 Road, Wangmai,
Pathumwan, Bangkok 10330, Thailand
Tel: 02-215-2622
OTHER ASIAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Sales & Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,
Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2303
OCEANIA
AUSTRALIA
Yamaha Music Australia Pty. Ltd.
Level 1, 99 Queensbridge Street, Southbank,
Victoria 3006, Australia
Tel: 3-9693-5111
COUNTRIES AND TRUST
TERRITORIES IN PACIFIC OCEAN
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Sales & Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,
Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2303
HEAD OFFICE Yamaha Corporation, Pro Audio Division
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2441
PA28
Yamaha Pro Audio Global Web Site
http://www.yamahaproaudio.com/
Yamaha Manual Library
http://www.yamaha.co.jp/manual/
U.R.G., Pro Audio Division
© 2004-2010 Yamaha Corporation
011IPTO-G0
Printed in Japan
WC42260